PROVIDENT BANK
S-3/A, 1997-02-20
ASSET-BACKED SECURITIES
Previous: PRICE T ROWE NEW ERA FUND INC, N-30D, 1997-02-20
Next: UNC INC, 8-K, 1997-02-20




   
  AS FILED WITH THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION ON FEBRUARY 20, 1997
                                              REGISTRATION NO. 333-18897     
    

                      SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
                            WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549

   
                               AMENDMENT NO. 1
                                      TO
                                   FORM S-3
    
                            REGISTRATION STATEMENT
                                    UNDER
                          THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933
                              THE PROVIDENT BANK
            (Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)
        Ohio                                          31-0412725             
(STATE OR OTHER JURISDICTION OF INCORPORATION OR ORGANIZATION)
                                         (I.R.S. EMPLOYER IDENTIFICATION NO.)

                            ONE EAST FOURTH STREET
                            CINCINNATI, OHIO 45202
                                (513) 579-2000
 (ADDRESS, INCLUDING ZIP CODE, AND TELEPHONE NUMBER, INCLUDING AREA CODE, OF
REGISTRANT'S PRINCIPAL EXECUTIVE OFFICES)


                             MARK E. MAGEE, ESQ.
                              THE PROVIDENT BANK
                            ONE EAST FOURTH STREET
                            CINCINNATI, OHIO 45202
                                (513) 579-2000
   (NAME, ADDRESS, INCLUDING ZIP CODE, AND TELEPHONE NUMBER, INCLUDING AREA
CODE, OF AGENT FOR SERVICE)


                               WITH A COPY TO:
    JAMES R. WHITAKER, ESQ.               MICHAEL P. BRAUN, ESQ.
    KEATING, MUETHING & KLEKAMP, P.L.L.           BROWN & WOOD LLP
    1800 PROVIDENT TOWER                      ONE WORLD TRADE CENTER
    ONE EAST FOURTH STREET                    NEW YORK, NEW YORK  10048-0557
    CINCINNATI, OHIO 45202


       APPROXIMATE DATE OF COMMENCEMENT OF PROPOSED SALE TO THE PUBLIC:
     From time to time on or after the effective date of the registration
statement, as determined by market conditions.
                                                    
                                 ----------------------

    IF THE ONLY SECURITIES BEING REGISTERED ON THIS FORM ARE BEING OFFERED
PURSUANT TO DIVIDEND OR INTEREST REINVESTMENT PLANS, PLEASE CHECK THE
FOLLOWING BOX. / /
    IF ANY OF THE SECURITIES BEING REGISTERED ON THIS FORM ARE TO BE OFFERED
ON A DELAYED OR CONTINUOUS BASIS PURSUANT TO RULE 415 UNDER THE SECURITIES
ACT OF 1933, PLEASE CHECK THE FOLLOWING BOX. /X/
    IF THIS FORM IS FILED TO REGISTER ADDITIONAL SECURITIES FOR AN OFFERING
PURSUANT TO RULE 462(B) UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT, PLEASE CHECK THE FOLLOWING
BOX AND LIST THE SECURITIES ACT REGISTRATION STATEMENT NUMBER OF THE EARLIER
EFFECTIVE REGISTRATION STATEMENT FOR THE SAME OFFERING./ /____________
    IF THIS FORM IS A POST-EFFECTIVE AMENDMENT FILED PURSUANT TO RULE 462(C)
UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT, CHECK THE FOLLOWING BOX AND LIST THE SECURITIES ACT
REGISTRATION STATEMENT NUMBER OF THE EARLIER EFFECTIVE REGISTRATION STATEMENT
FOR THE SAME OFFERING./ /____________
    IF DELIVERY OF THE PROSPECTUS IS EXPECTED TO BE MADE PURSUANT TO RULE
434, PLEASE CHECK THE FOLLOWING BOX./ /

   
                       CALCULATION OF REGISTRATION FEE


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
<S>                                     <C>           <C>              <C>             <C>
                                                         Proposed        Proposed
                                          Amount          Maximum          Maximum        Amount of
       Title of Each Class of             to be        Offering Price     Aggregate     Registration
     Securities to Be Registered        Registered     Per Unit/(1)/      Offering           Fee
                                                                          Price/(1)/
Asset Backed Notes and Asset Backed
Certificates/(2)/ . . . . . . . . .    $500,000,000         100%        $500,000,000    $151,515.15*

</TABLE>

    (1)    Estimated for the purpose of calculating the registration fee.
    (2)    Not specified as to each class of Asset Backed Securities to be
    registered pursuant to General Instruction II.D of Form S-3.
    *   $303.03 of the Registration Fee was previously paid.
    

    THE REGISTRANT HEREBY AMENDS THIS REGISTRATION STATEMENT ON SUCH DATE OR
DATES AS MAY BE NECESSARY TO DELAY ITS EFFECTIVE DATE UNTIL THE REGISTRANT
SHALL FILE A FURTHER AMENDMENT WHICH SPECIFICALLY STATES THAT THIS
REGISTRATION STATEMENT SHALL THEREAFTER BECOME EFFECTIVE IN ACCORDANCE WITH
SECTION 8(A) OF THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933, OR UNTIL THE REGISTRATION
STATEMENT SHALL BECOME EFFECTIVE ON SUCH DATE AS THE COMMISSION, ACTING 
PURSUANT TO SAID SECTION 8(A), MAY DETERMINE.

   Information contained  herein  is subject  to completion  or amendment.  A
registration statement  relating to these securities has  been filed with the
Securities and Exchange  Commission. These securities may not be sold nor may
offers  to  buy be  accepted  prior to  the  time the  registration statement
becomes effective. This  prospectus shall not constitute an offer  to sell or
the solicitation  of an offer  to buy  nor shall there  be any sale  of these
securities in  any State in which such offer,  solicitation, or sale would be
unlawful prior to registration or qualification under  the securities laws of
any such State.
    

   
                SUBJECT TO COMPLETION, DATED FEBRUARY 20, 1997
    

PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT
(To Prospectus dated ______________, 199__)

                             $___________________
                                (APPROXIMATE)
          HOME EQUITY LOAN ASSET BACKED CERTIFICATES, SERIES 199_-_

                              THE PROVIDENT BANK
                        TRANSFEROR AND MASTER SERVICER

    Each  Home   Equity  Loan   Asset  Backed   Certificate,  Series   199_-_
(collectively, the  "Certificates") will represent  an undivided interest  in
the Provident  Home Equity Loan Trust 199_-_ (the  "Trust Fund") to be formed
pursuant  to a  Pooling and  Servicing Agreement  between The  Provident Bank
("Provident"), as  Transferor and Master Servicer and (                 ), as
Trustee.  The property of  the Trust Fund will include a  pool of (adjustable
rate)  home equity revolving  credit line  loans made  or to  be made  in the
future (the "Mortgage Loans") under certain home equity revolving credit line
loan agreements.   The Mortgage Loans are secured by  either first and second
deeds  of trust or  mortgages on one-  to four-family residential properties.
See "Index of Defined Terms" on Page (S-56) of this Prospectus Supplement and
on Page (85) of the Prospectus for the location of the definitions of certain
capitalized terms.

    The aggregate undivided  interest in  the Trust  Fund represented by  the
Certificates will, as  of ____________, 199_ (the "Cut-Off  Date"), represent
approximately  __% of  the  outstanding principal  balances  of the  Mortgage
Loans.  The remaining undivided interest in the Trust Fund not represented by
the Certificates  (the  "Transferor Interest")  will  initially be  equal  to
$_________________,  which as  of the Cut-Off  Date is _%  of the outstanding
principal balances of the  Mortgage Loans. Only the Certificates  are offered
hereby.

   
    Distributions of  principal and interest on the Certificates will be made
on the __________th day of each month or, if such date is not a Business Day,
then on the succeeding Business Day (each, a "Distribution Date"), commencing
___________, 199_.  On  each Distribution Date,  holders of the  Certificates
will  be  entitled to  receive,  from  and to  the  limited  extent of  funds
available in  the  Collection Account  (as  defined herein  under  "Summary--
Collections"),   distributions  with  respect   to  interest   and  principal
calculated  as  set   forth  under  "Summary--Interest,"  "Summary--Principal
Payments from  Principal Collections" and "Description  of the Certificates--
Distributions  on  the  Certificates"  herein.    The  Certificates  are  not
guaranteed by Provident or any affiliate thereof.  (However, the Certificates
will be  unconditionally and irrevocably guaranteed as  to the payment of the
Guaranteed Distributions  (as defined herein under  "Summary--The Policy") on
each  Distribution  Date  pursuant  to  the terms  of  a  financial  guaranty
insurance policy (the "Policy") to be issued by
                                  (INSURER)
    There is  currently no  market for  the Certificates  offered hereby  and
there can  be no assurance  that such  a market  will develop or  if it  does
develop that  it  will  continue.   See  "Risk  Factors" herein  and  in  the
Prospectus.
    
   
     PROSPECTIVE INVESTORS SHOULD REVIEW THE INFORMATION SET FORTH UNDER
          "RISK FACTORS" ON PAGE S-16 HEREIN AND ON PAGE (12) IN THE
                           ACCOMPANYING PROSPECTUS.
    
      THE CERTIFICATES REPRESENT INTERESTS IN THE TRUST FUND ONLY AND DO
                NOT REPRESENT INTERESTS IN OR OBLIGATIONS OF 
           PROVIDENT, THE TRUSTEE OR ANY AFFILIATE THEREOF, EXCEPT
                 TO THE EXTENT PROVIDED HEREIN.  NEITHER THE
                   CERTIFICATES NOR THE MORTGAGE LOANS ARE 
                        INSURED OR GUARANTEED BY ANY 
                             GOVERNMENTAL AGENCY.
THESE  SECURITIES HAVE NOT BEEN APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED BY THE SECURITIES AND
      EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION NOR HAS THE
          SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES
               COMMISSION PASSED UPON THE ACCURACY OR ADEQUACY
                  OF THIS PROSPECTUS.  ANY REPRESENTATION TO
                     THE CONTRARY IS A CRIMINAL OFFENSE.


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
<S>                                                        <C>          <C>            <C>
                                                             Price to    Underwriting   Proceeds to
                                                             Public (1)    Discount(2)  Provident (3)
Per Certificate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .               %             %              %
Total . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  $             $              $

</TABLE>

(1) Plus accrued interest, if any, from _______________, 199_.
(2) Provident  has  agreed  to  indemnify  the  Underwriter  against  certain
    liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act of 1933.
(3) Before deducting expenses, estimated to be $_______________.

    The Certificates  are offered subject  to prior  sale and subject  to the
Underwriter's right to  reject orders in  whole or in part.   It is  expected
that  delivery of  the Certificates  will  be made  in  book-entry form  only
through the facilities of The  Depository Trust Company, CEDEL Bank,  soci t 
anonyme,  and the  Euroclear System  on  or about  ______________, 199_  (the
"Closing Date").  The Certificates will  be offered in Europe and the  United
States of America.

                                (UNDERWRITER)
_____________, 199_

    IN  CONNECTION  WITH THIS  OFFERING,  THE UNDERWRITER  MAY  OVER-ALLOT OR
EFFECT  TRANSACTIONS WHICH  STABILIZE OR  MAINTAIN  THE MARKET  PRICE OF  THE
CERTIFICATES AT LEVELS ABOVE  THOSE WHICH MIGHT OTHERWISE PREVAIL IN THE OPEN
MARKET.  SUCH STABILIZING, IF COMMENCED, MAY BE DISCONTINUED AT ANY TIME.

    UNTIL NINETY  DAYS  AFTER THE  DATE OF  THIS  PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT,  ALL
DEALERS  EFFECTING   TRANSACTIONS  IN   THE  CERTIFICATES,  WHETHER   OR  NOT
PARTICIPATING  IN THIS DISTRIBUTION, MAY BE  REQUIRED TO DELIVER A PROSPECTUS
SUPPLEMENT AND PROSPECTUS.   THIS IS IN ADDITION TO THE OBLIGATION OF DEALERS
ACTING AS UNDERWRITERS TO DELIVER A PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT AND PROSPECTUS WITH
RESPECT TO THEIR UNSOLD ALLOTMENTS OR SUBSCRIPTIONS.

    The Certificates offered hereby constitute  part of a separate  series of
Home Equity  Loan Asset  Backed Certificates being  offered by  The Provident
Bank  from time  to time  pursuant to  its Prospectus  dated _______________,
199__.   This  Prospectus Supplement  does not  contain complete  information
about the offering  of the Certificates.  Additional information is contained
in  the  Prospectus and  investors are  urged  to read  both  this Prospectus
Supplement and the Prospectus in full.  Sales of the Certificates  may not be
consummated unless the purchaser has received both this Prospectus Supplement
and the Prospectus.

    The  Trustee on behalf of  any Trust Fund will  provide without charge to
each person to whom this  Prospectus Supplement is delivered, on  the written
or  oral request  of  such person,  a copy  of any  or  all of  the documents
referred to in the  Prospectus under "Incorporation  of Certain Documents  by
Reference"  that  have  been or  may  be  incorporated  by reference  in  the
Prospectus (not including exhibits to the information that is incorporated by
reference  unless such  exhibits are  specifically incorporated  by reference
into the information that the Prospectus incorporates).  Such requests should
be directed to  the Corporate Trust Office  of the Trustee at  _____________,
telephone:_________, facsimile number:_____________, attention:__________.


                                   SUMMARY

    The  following summary of  certain pertinent information  is qualified in
its entirety by reference to  the detailed information appearing elsewhere in
this  Prospectus   Supplement  and   the  accompanying   Prospectus.  Certain
capitalized terms used in the Summary are defined elsewhere in the Prospectus
Supplement or in the Prospectus.   See  "Index of Defined Terms" on Page S-56
of  this  Prospectus Supplement  and on  Page 85  of  the Prospectus  for the
location of the definitions of certain capitalized terms. 

Trust Fund       Provident Home Equity  Loan Trust 199_-_ (the  "Trust Fund")
                 will be formed pursuant to a pooling and servicing agreement
                 (the  "Agreement") to  be dated  as of  ______________, 199_
                 (the   "Cut-Off   Date")   between   The    Provident   Bank
                 ("Provident"), as transferor and servicer (together with any
                 successor in such capacity, the "Transferor" and the "Master
                 Servicer", respectively) and (                 ), as trustee
                 (the  "Trustee").   The  property of  the  Trust  Fund  will
                 include:  a pool of (adjustable rate) home equity  revolving
                 credit  line loans  made or  to be made  in the  future (the
                 "Mortgage  Loans"),  under  certain  home  equity  revolving
                 credit line  loan agreements (the "Credit  Line Agreements")
                 and  secured  by  either   first  or  second  mortgages   on
                 residential   properties  that   are  one-   to  four-family
                 properties (the "Mortgaged Properties"); the  collections in
                 respect  of the  Mortgage Loans  received after  the Cut-Off
                 Date (exclusive of payments  in respect of accrued  interest
                 due on or prior to the Cut-Off  Date); property that secured
                 a  Mortgage Loan  which has been acquired  by foreclosure or
                 deed   in   lieu   of  foreclosure;   an   irrevocable   and
                 unconditional  limited financial  guaranty insurance  policy
                 (the  "Policy");  rights   under  certain  hazard  insurance
                 policies covering  the  Mortgaged  Properties;  and  certain
                 other property, as described  more fully under  "Description
                 of the Certificates--General" herein.

   
                 The Trust Fund property will include the unpaid  principal 
                 balance of each  Mortgage  Loan  as  of  the  Cut-Off Date  
                 (the  "Cut-Off  Date Principal  Balance") plus  any 
                 additions thereto  as a  result of new advances made  
                 pursuant to the  applicable Credit Line Agreement (the 
                 "Additional Balances")  during  the life  of the  Trust Fund.
                 With respect  to  any date,  the  "Pool  Balance"  will  be 
                 equal  to  the aggregate of the Principal Balances of all 
                 Mortgage Loans as of  such date.  The aggregate  Cut-Off Date
                 Principal Balance of the  Mortgage Loans  is $______________
                 (the "Cut-Off  Date Pool  Balance").  The "Principal Balance"
                 of a Mortgage  Loan (other than a  Liquidated Mortgage  Loan)
                 on  any day is  equal to  its Cut-Off  Date Principal Balance,
                 plus  (i)  any  Additional  Balances  in  respect  of  such 
                 Mortgage  Loan,  minus   (ii)  all  collections credited  
                 against the Principal  Balance of  such  Mortgage  Loan  in 
                 accordance  with  the related Credit  Line  Agreement prior
                 to such  day.   The  Principal Balance  of  a  Liquidated 
                 Mortgage  Loan  (as  defined herein  under "Description   
                 of    the   Certificates--    Distributions   on   the
                 Certificates")  after final recovery  of related 
                 Liquidation Proceeds (as  defined   herein  under   
                 "Description  of   the  Certificates--Allocations and 
                 Collections") shall be zero.
    

Securities 
  Offered
   
                 Each   of  the   Home  Equity   Loan  Asset   Backed
                 Certificates,  Series  199_-_  offered  hereby  (the
                 "Certificates") represents an  undivided interest in
                 the  Trust Fund.    Each Certificate  represents the
                 right   to  receive  payments  of  interest  at  the
                 variable  rate  described  below  (the  "Certificate
                 Rate"), payable  monthly, and payments  of principal
                 at such time and to the extent provided herein under
                 "Description of  the Certificates--Distributions  on
                 the Certificates".  The aggregate undivided interest
                 in the Trust Fund represented by the Certificates as
                 of  the Closing Date  will equal $__________________
                 (the "Original  Invested Amount"),  which represents
                 __% of the Cut-Off Date Pool Balance.  The "Original
                 Certificate    Principal    Balance"   will    equal
                 $__________________.   Following  the Closing  Date,
                 the  "Invested Amount" with respect to any date will
                 be an  amount equal to the  Original Invested Amount
                 minus   (i)  the   amount   of  Investor   Principal
                 Collections  (as  defined  herein  under  "Summary--
                 Collections")     previously      distributed     to
                 Certificateholders,  and minus (ii)  an amount equal
                 to the product  of the Investor Floating  Allocation
                 Percentage and the Liquidation Loss Amounts (each as
                 defined herein under  "Summary--Collections").   The
                 Transferor will own the remaining undivided interest
                 (the "Transferor  Interest") in the  Mortgage Loans,
                 which  is  equal  to  the  Pool  Balance  minus  the
                 Invested  Amount and  will initially  equal approxi-
                 mately  __% of the  Cut-Off Date Pool  Balance.  The
                 Transferor,  as of  any  date is  the  owner of  the
                 Transferor   Interest   which  initially   will   be
                 Provident.
    

                 The  Certificates will  be issued  pursuant  to the  
                 Agreement.   The principal amount  of the  outstanding
                 Certificates (the  "Certificate Principal Balance")  
                 on any date is equal to the Original Certificate
                 Principal Balance minus the aggregate of amounts actually
                 distributed as principal to the Certificateholders.  See
                 "Description of the Certificates" herein.

Removal of Certain
Mortgage Loans;
Additional
Balances
   
                 In order to permit the Transferor to remove Mortgage
                 Loans from the  Trust Fund at such times, if any, as
                 the overcollateralization exceeds the level required
                 to maintain  the ratings on the Certificates, on any
                 Distribution  Date the Transferor may, but shall not
                 be obligated to, remove from the Trust Fund  certain
                 Mortgage     Loans    without    notice    to    the
                 Certificateholders.  The Transferor is  permitted to
                 designate   the  Mortgage   Loans  to   be  removed.
                 Mortgage  Loans so designated  will only  be removed
                 upon  satisfaction of  the following  conditions (i)
                 the   Rapid  Amortization  Period   shall  not  have
                 commenced; (ii)  the Transferor  Interest as of  the
                 Transfer Date (as defined herein  under "Description
                 of the Certificates--Optional Transfers of  Mortgage
                 Loans to the  Transferor") (after  giving effect  to
                 such   removal)  exceeds   the   Minimum  Transferor
                 Interest (as  defined below); (iii)  the transfer of
                 any Mortgage  Loans on any Transfer  Date during the
                 Managed Amortization Period (as defined herein under

                 "Summary--Principal Payments from Principal 
                 Collections")  shall not, in  the   reasonable  belief
                 of  the  Transferor,  cause   a  Rapid Amortization  
                 Event to occur or  an event which  with notice or lapse
                 of time  or both would  constitute a  Rapid Amortization
                 Event;  (iv) the Transferor  shall have delivered to  the 
                 Trustee a "Mortgage Loan Schedule" containing  a list of 
                 all  Mortgage Loans  remaining in the Trust Fund after such
                 removal; (v) the  Transferor shall  represent and warrant  
                 that no  selection procedures which  are adverse  to the
                 interests of the  Certificateholders or the  Certificate 
                 Insurer were used by  the Transferor  in selecting  such 
                 Mortgage  Loans; (vi)  in connection with  the  first such
                 retransfer of  Mortgage Loans,  the Rating   Agencies  (as
                 defined  herein  under  "Summary--Certificate Rating") shall
                 have been notified  of the proposed transfer and prior
                 to  the Transfer  Date  shall not  have  notified the  
                 Transferor  in writing  that such transfer would result in 
                 a reduction or withdrawal of  the ratings  assigned to the
                 Certificates without  regard to the Policy; and (vii) the 
                 Transferor shall have delivered  to the Trustee and the  
                 Certificate Insurer an  officer's certificate confirming 
                 the conditions  set  forth  in  clauses  (i)  through  
                 (vi)  above.   See "Description  of  the  Certificates--
                 Optional  Transfers of  Mortgage Loans to the Transferor"
                 herein.
    
                 The  "Minimum Transferor Interest" as of  any date is an 
                 amount equal to the  lesser of (a) __%  of the Pool Balance
                 on such  date and (b) the Transferor Interest as of the 
                 Closing Date.

                 During the term of  the Trust Fund, all  Additional Balances
                 will  be transferred to  and become  property  of the  Trust
                 Fund.   The  Pool Balance at any time will generally fluctuate
                 from day  to day because the  amount  of  Additional  Balances
                 and  the  amount  of principal payments with respect to the 
                 Mortgage Loans will usually  differ from day  to day.  
                 Because  the Transferor Interest  is equal  to the Pool
                 Balance minus  the Invested  Amount,  the  amount of  the  
                 Transferor Interest  will  fluctuate  from day  to day  as  
                 draws are  made with respect  to  the  Mortgage Loans  and  as
                 Principal Collections  are received.

The Mortgage 
  Loans          The Mortgage Loans  are secured by first  and second
                 mortgages on  Mortgaged  Properties located  in  ___
                 states.  

   
                 The percentage of the Cut-Off Date Principal Balance of  
                 the Mortgage Loans  secured  by  Mortgaged Properties  
                 located  in  the states  of __________,  ________,  
                 __________, _______,  ______ and  ________ is
                 approximately  ____%,   ____%,   ____%,  ____%,   ____%
                 and   ____%, respectively.   The "Combined Loan-to-Value
                 Ratio" of  each Mortgage Loan is  the  ratio of  (A) the
                 sum of  (i) the  maximum amount  the borrower was permitted
                 to draw  down under the related Credit  Line Agreement (the
                 "Credit Limit")  and (ii) the amounts  of any related
                 senior  mortgage loans  (computed as  of the  date of  
                 origination of each  such Mortgage  Loan) to  (B) the  
                 lesser of  (i)  the appraised  value of the Mortgaged 
                 Property or (ii) in the case  of  a  Mortgaged Property
                 purchased  within  one  year  of the origination of the 
                 related Mortgage Loan, the purchase  price of such Mortgaged
                 Property.  As of  the Cut-Off Date  the Combined  Loan-to-Value
                 Ratios  ranged from ____%  to ______%  and, as  of the  Cut-Off
                 Date,  the  weighted average  Combined Loan-to-Value  Ratio of
                 the Mortgage Loans was approximately ____%.
    
   
                 (Interest on each Mortgage  Loan is payable monthly  and 
                 computed  on the related daily outstanding  Principal Balance
                 for each day in  the billing  cycle at a variable  rate per 
                 annum  (the "Loan Rate") equal at  any time  (subject to  
                 maximum rates,  as described  herein under "Description  of
                 the  Mortgage  Loans--Mortgage  Loan  Terms,"   and further 
                 subject to  applicable usury  limitations) to the sum  of (i)
                 the highest prime rate published in the "Money Rates"  section
                 of The Wall Street Journal  and (ii) a Margin  within the range
                 of ____%  to ____%).   As  of the  Cut-Off Date,  the weighted
                 average Margin was approximately  ____%.  Loan Rates  are 
                 adjusted  monthly on the first business  day of the calendar
                 month preceding the  Due Date.   As to each Mortgage  Loan, 
                 the  "Due Date" is  the (fifteenth) day  of each month.    
                 The Cut-Off  Date  Principal Balances  ranged from  zero to
                 $__________ and averaged  approximately $__________.   Credit
                 Limits under  the  Mortgage Loans  as of  the  Cut-Off Date  
                 ranged from  $__________  to $__________  and averaged  
                 approximately  $__________.  Each   Mortgage   Loan   was    
                 originated   in   the   period   from _______________, 199_ 
                 to  ________________, 199_.  As of the  Cut-Off Date, the  
                 maximum Credit  Limit Utilization Rate (as  defined herein
                 under "Description of  the Mortgage Loans--General") was 
                 100% and the weighted average  Credit  Limit  Utilization 
                 Rate  was  approximately ____%.  As of the  Cut-Off Date, 
                 approximately ____% of  Cut-Off Date Principal Balance  of 
                 the Mortgage  Loans represented  first liens on the related
                 Mortgaged Properties, while  approximately ____% of  the
                 Mortgage Loans  represented second liens.   As  of the 
                 Cut-Off  Date, the Mortgage Loans  had remaining terms to 
                 scheduled maturity ranging from  ___ months  to  ___  months
                 and  had  a  weighted  average  of approximately ___  months.
                 See "Description of the  Mortgage Loans" herein.
    

Denominations    The  Certificates  will   be  offered  for  purchase  in
                 denominations of  $1,000 and  multiples of $1  in excess
                 thereof.  The interest in the Trust Fund evidenced  by a
                 Certificate (the "Percentage Interest") will be equal to
                 the  percentage derived by dividing  the denomination of
                 such Certificate  by the Original  Certificate Principal
                 Balance.

Registration of 
Certificates
   
                 The Certificates  will  initially be  issued
                 in  book-entry  form.     Persons  acquiring
                 beneficial   ownership   interests   in  the
                 Certificates   ("Certificate  Owners")   may
                 elect  to hold  their Certificate  interests
                 through   The   Depository   Trust   Company
                 ("DTC"),  in  the  United  States, or  Cedel
                 Bank,  soci t   anonyme,  ("CEDEL")  or  the
                 Euroclear System  ("Euroclear"), in  Europe.
                 Transfers  within DTC,  CEDEL or  Euroclear,
                 as the case  may be,  will be  in accordance
                 with the  usual rules  and operating  
                 procedures  of  the  relevant  system.    
                 So  long as  the Certificates  are Book-
                 Entry  Certificates (as  defined  herein under
                 "Description  of  the Certificates--Book-
                 Entry  Certificates"),  such Certificates  
                 will   be  evidenced  by   one  or  more   
                 Certificates registered in the name of Cede 
                 & Co. ("Cede"), as  the nominee of DTC or  
                 one of the relevant depositaries (collectively,
                 the "European Depositaries").  Cross-market
                 transfers  between  persons  holding directly
                 or indirectly through DTC, on the one hand,
                 and counterparties  holding  directly  or  
                 indirectly  through  CEDEL  or Euroclear, 
                 on  the other,  will be effected  in DTC  
                 through Citibank N.A.  ("Citibank")  or  
                 The  Chase  Manhattan  Bank   ("Chase"),  
                 the relevant depositaries of  CEDEL or 
                 Euroclear, respectively, and  each a 
                 participating member  of DTC.  The  
                 Certificates will initially be registered
                 in the name of Cede.  The interests of the
                 Certificateholders will be represented by 
                 book  entries  on  the records of DTC and
                 participating members  thereof.  No 
                 Certificate Owner will be entitled to receive
                 a  definitive certificate representing  such
                 person's  interest,  except  in  the  event  
                 that Definitive Certificates (as defined 
                 herein under "Description  of the 
                 Certificates--Book-Entry  Certificates") are
                 issued under the limited circumstances  
                 described  under "Description  of  the  
                 Certificates--Book-Entry  Certificates" 
                 herein.  All references  in this Prospectus
                 Supplement to  any  Certificates reflect  
                 the  rights of  Certificate Owners  only as
                 such rights  may  be exercised  through DTC
                 and its participating  organizations for  so
                 long as  such Certificates are held by DTC.
                 See "Risk Factors--Book-Entry Certificates",
                 "Description  of  the  Certificates--Book-
                 Entry  Certificates" herein and "Annex I" 
                 hereto.
    

Provident
   
                 The   Provident   Bank,   an   Ohio    banking   corporation
                 headquartered in Cincinnati,  Ohio.  The principal executive
                 offices of Provident are located at One East Fourth  Street,
                 Cincinnati, Ohio 45202.  See "Provident" herein.
    

Collections      All collections  on the  Mortgage  Loans will  generally  be
                 allocated  in  accordance  with the  Credit  Line Agreements
                 between amounts collected in respect of interest and amounts
                 collected in  respect of principal.  As  to any Distribution
                 Date,  "Interest Collections"  will be equal to  the amounts
                 collected  during the  related Collection  Period, including
                 the  portion of Net Liquidation  Proceeds (as defined below)
                 allocated to  interest pursuant to  the terms  of the Credit
                 Line  Agreements   less  Servicing  Fees  for   the  related
                 Collection Period.

   
        As to  any Distribution  Date, "Principal Collections" will  be equal
        to   the  sum  of  (i)  the  amounts  collected  during  the  related
        Collection Period,  including the portion of Net Liquidation Proceeds
        allocated  to principal  pursuant to  the terms  of  the Credit  Line
        Agreements and (ii) any Transfer  Deposit Amounts (as  defined herein
        under "Description of the Certificates--Book-Entry Certificates").
    

        "Net Liquidation Proceeds"  with respect to a  Mortgage Loan  are the
        proceeds  (excluding   amounts  drawn  on  the  Policy)  received  in
        connection  with  the  liquidation  of  any  Mortgage  Loan,  whether
        through trustee's  sale, foreclosure  sale or  otherwise, reduced  by
        related expenses,  but not  including the  portion, if  any, of  such
        amount  that exceeds the Principal  Balance of the Mortgage Loan plus
        any accrued and unpaid interest thereon to the end  of the Collection
        Period during which such Mortgage  Loan became a  Liquidated Mortgage
        Loan.

        With  respect to  any  Distribution  Date,  the portion  of  Interest
        Collections  allocable   to  the   Certificates  ("Investor  Interest
        Collections") will equal the product of (a) Interest Collections  for
        such  Distribution Date  and  (b)  the Investor  Floating  Allocation
        Percentage.   With respect  to any Distribution  Date, the  "Investor
        Floating Allocation  Percentage" is  the percentage  equivalent of  a
        fraction determined by  dividing the Invested Amount at the  close of
        business  on the preceding Distribution  Date (or at the Closing Date
        in the case  of the first Distribution  Date) by the Pool Balance  at
        the  beginning of  the  related  Collection  Period.   The  remaining
        amount of  Interest Collections will be  allocated to the  Transferor
        Interest  as   more  fully  described   under  "Description  of   the
        Certificates--Allocations and Collections" herein.

   
        On each Distribution Date, the Investor Interest Collections will  be
        applied in the  following order of priority:   (i) as payment  to the
        Trustee for its fee for services rendered pursuant  to the Agreement;
        (ii) as payment for the premium for the Policy; (iii) as  payment for
        the accrued  interest due  and  any  overdue accrued  interest  (with
        interest  thereon)  on  the  Certificate  Principal  Balance  of  the
        Certificates;  (iv)  to  pay any  Investor  Loss  Amount (as  defined
        herein under  "Summary--Collections") for such Distribution Date; (v)
        as payment for any Investor Loss  Amount for a previous  Distribution
        Date  that  was  not  previously  (a)  funded  by  Investor  Interest
        Collections  allocable to the Certificateholders, (b) absorbed by the
        Overcollateralization  Amount  (as  defined  herein  under  "Summary-
        Collection"), (c) funded by amounts on deposit in  the Spread Account
        or (d) funded by draws on the  Policy; (vi) to reimburse prior  draws
        made from the  Policy (with interest thereon); (vii) to pay principal
        on  the   Certificates  until   the  Invested   Amount  exceeds   the
        Certificate Principal  Balance by the Required  Overcollateralization
        Amount,   each   as  defined   herein   under  "Description   of  the
        Certificates--Distributions  on the  Certificates" (such  amount,  if
        any,  paid pursuant to this clause (vii)  being referred to herein as
        the "Accelerated  Principal Distribution  Amount"); (viii)  any other
        amounts required  to be deposited  in an account  for the benefit  of
        the  Certificate  Insurer  and  Certificateholders  pursuant  to  the
        Agreement or amounts owed to the Certificate Insurer pursuant to  the
        Insurance Agreement; (ix)  certain amounts that may be required to be
        paid to the  Master Servicer pursuant  to the  Agreement; and (x)  to
        the Transferor to the extent permitted  as  described  under  
        "Description  of the  Certificates--Distributions on the Certificates"
        herein.  Investor Interest Collections available after the payment of
        interest  on  the  Certificates may  be  insufficient  to  cover  any
        Investor  Loss  Amount.    If  such  insufficiency  results  in   the
        Certificate Principal Balance  exceeding the Invested  Amount, a draw
        in  an amount equal to such difference will be  made on the Policy in
        accordance with the terms of the Policy.
    

        The "Overcollateralization  Amount" on any  date of determination  is
        the  amount,  if  any, by  which  the  Invested  Amount  exceeds  the
        Certificate   Principal   Balance  on   such   day.     Payments   to
        Certificateholders  pursuant to clause  (iii) above  will be interest
        payments  on   the  Certificates.    Payments  to  Certificateholders
        pursuant to  clauses (iv),  (v) and (vii) will  be principal payments
        on  the  Certificates  and  will  therefore  reduce  the  Certificate
        Principal Balance,  however, payments pursuant  to clause (vii)  will
        not  reduce   the  Invested  Amount.     The  Accelerated   Principal
        Distribution Amount is not guaranteed by the Policy.

        "Liquidation  Loss  Amount"  means  with  respect  to  any Liquidated
        Mortgage Loan, the  unrecovered Principal Balance thereof at the  end
        of the related Collection Period  in which such Mortgage  Loan became
        a  Liquidated  Mortgage  Loan,  after   giving  effect  to   the  Net
        Liquidation Proceeds  in connection  therewith.   The "Investor  Loss
        Amount" shall  be  the product  of the  Investor Floating  Allocation
        Percentage  and the  Liquidation  Loss Amount  for  such Distribution
        Date.   See  "Description of  the Certificates--Distributions  on the
        Certificates" herein.

        Principal    Collections    will    be    allocated    between    the
        Certificateholders   and    the   Transferor   ("Investor   Principal
        Collections"  and  "Transferor Principal  Collections", respectively)
        in accordance with  their percentage interests in the Mortgage  Loans
        of  __% and  __%, respectively, as  of the  Cut-Off Date  (the "Fixed

        Allocation   Percentage"),   but   a  lesser   amount   of  Principal
        Collections  may  be  distributed  to  Certificateholders during  the
        Managed Amortization  Period,  as  described below.    The  "Investor
        Fixed Allocation Percentage" shall be __%.

        The Master Servicer  will deposit Interest Collections and  Principal
        Collections  in  respect  of  the   Mortgage  Loans  in   an  account
        established for  such purpose  under the  Agreement (the  "Collection
        Account").     See  "Description  of  the  Certificates--Payments  on
        Mortgage Loans; Deposits to Collection Account" herein.

Collection Period        As  to any  Distribution Date  other than  the first
                         Distribution  Date, the  "Collection Period"  is the
                         calendar  month   preceding   the  month   of   such
                         Distribution Date.    As to  the first  Distribution
                         Date, the "Collection Period" is the period beginning
                         after the  Cut-Off  Date  and ending  on the  last  
                         day of _____________, 199_.

Interest
   
                 Interest on the Certificates  will be distributed monthly on
                 the  fifteenth day  of each month  or, if such day  is not a
                 Business Day, then the next succeeding Business Day (each, a
                 "Distribution Date"), commencing on ______________, 199_, at
                 the Certificate  Rate for  the related  Interest Period  (as
                 defined below).    The "Certificate  Rate" for  an  Interest
                 Period  will generally  equal the  sum  of  ((a) the  London
                 Interbank offered rate  for one-month  United States  dollar
                 deposits  ("LIBOR") appearing  on the  Telerate Screen  Page
                 3750, as of the second LIBOR Business Day (as defined herein
                 under "Description of the Certificates--Distributions on the
                 Certificates") prior  to  the  first  day of  such  Interest
                 Period (or  as  of  two LIBOR  Business Days  prior  to  the
                 Closing Date,  in the case of the first Interest Period) and
                 (b) ____%.)  Notwithstanding the foregoing, in no event will
                 the amount of interest required to be distributed in respect
                 of the  Certificates  on any  Distribution  Date  exceed  an
                 amount derived from a  rate equal to the weighted average of
                 the  Loan  Rates (net  of the  Servicing  Fee Rate,  the fee
                 payable to  the Trustee and  the rate at  which the  premium
                 payable to  the Certificate Insurer  is calculated) weighted
                 on  the basis  of the  daily balance  of each  Mortgage Loan
                 during the  related billing  cycle prior  to the  Collection
                 Period relating to such  Distribution Date.  Interest on the
                 Certificates in respect of any Distribution Date will accrue
                 from the preceding Distribution Date (or in the  case of the
                 first  Distribution  Date,  from  the  date  of the  initial
                 issuance of  the Certificates  (the "Closing  Date") through
                 the day preceding such Distribution Date (each such  period,
                 an "Interest Period")  on the basis of the actual  number of
                 days in the Interest Period and a 360-day year.  Interest 
                 payments  on the Certificates will  be funded from  Investor
                 Interest Collections, any funds on deposit  in the Spread 
                 Account and from  draws on  the Policy.   See  "Description 
                 of  the Certificates" herein.
    
Principal Payments from
Principal Collections
   
                             For   the   period  beginning   on   the   first
                             Distribution   Date   and,   unless    a   Rapid
                             Amortization Event shall  have earlier occurred,
                             ending    on    the    Distribution    Date   in
                             _____________, 200_  (the "Managed  Amortization
                             Period"),  the amount  of  Principal Collections
                             payable   to   Certificateholders  as   of  each
                             Distribution    Date    during    the    Managed
                             Amortization Period  will equal,  to the  extent
                             funds  are  available  therefor,  the  Scheduled
                             Principal  Collections  Distribution Amount  for
                             such Distribution  Date.   On  any  Distribution
                             Date  during  the Managed  Amortization  Period,
                             the     "Scheduled     Principal     Collections
                             Distribution Amount"  shall equal the  lesser of
                             (i) the  Maximum Principal  Payment (as  defined
                             below)  and   (ii)  the  Alternative   Principal
                             Payment  (as defined  below).   With  respect to
                             any  Distribution  Date, the  "Maximum Principal
                             Payment" will equal the product  of the Investor
                             Fixed   Allocation  Percentage   and   Principal
                             Collections for  such Distribution  Date.   With
                             respect to any Distribution  Date, the  
                             "Alternative Principal  Payment"  will equal the
                             greater  of  (x)  ____%  of the  Certificate  
                             Principal  Balance immediately prior to such  
                             Distribution Date and (y)  the amount, but not less
                             than zero, of Principal Collections for such  
                             Distribution Date less the aggregate of 
                             Additional Balances created during the related 
                             Collection Period.
    

        Beginning with the  first Distribution Date following the end  of the
        Managed  Amortization Period,  the  amount of  Principal  Collections
        payable  to  Certificateholders  on each  Distribution  Date  will be
        equal to  the Maximum  Principal Payment.   See  "Description of  the
        Certificates--Distributions on the Certificates" herein.

        In addition,  to the  extent funds are available  therefor (including
        funds  available under  the  Policy),  on  the Distribution  Date  in
        _____________, 20__, Certificateholders  will be entitled to  receive
        as  payment   of  principal  an   amount  equal  to  the  outstanding
        Certificate Principal Balance.

        Distributions of Principal Collections based upon  the Investor Fixed
        Allocation Percentage  may result  in distributions  of principal  to
        Certificateholders  in amounts  that  are  greater  relative  to  the
        declining  Pool Balance  than  would  be  the  case if  the  Investor
        Floating Allocation  Percentage were used to determine the percentage
        of Principal  Collections  distributed  in respect  of  the  Invested
        Amount.       The   aggregate    distributions   of    principal   to
        Certificateholders   will  not   exceed  the   Original   Certificate
        Principal Balance.

The Certificate Insurer      (Insurer) (the  "Certificate Insurer") is a     
                             insurance  company engaged  exclusively in
                             the  business  of  writing  financial   guaranty
                             insurance, principally in  respect of securities
                             offered in domestic  and foreign  markets.   The
                             Certificate  Insurer's claims-paying  ability is
                             rated  ____ by _________________________________ 
                             and _____ by ___________________________________.
                             See "The  Certificate  Insurer"  in this  
                             Prospectus Supplement.

Policy       On or before the Closing  Date, the Policy will  be issued by the
             Certificate Insurer pursuant  to the provisions of the  Insurance
             and Indemnity Agreement  (the "Insurance Agreement") to be  dated
             as of  _____________, 199_,  among Provident(,  the Trustee)  and
             the Certificate Insurer.

   
        The  Policy will irrevocably and unconditionally guarantee payment on
        each  Distribution  Date  to  the  Trustee  for  the  benefit  of the
        Certificateholders  of  (i)  the  Guaranteed  Principal  Distribution
        Amount  (as defined below) with  respect to the Certificates for such
        Distribution Date  and (ii) accrued  and unpaid  interest due on  the
        Certificates (together,  the "Guaranteed  Distributions"), with  such
        Guaranteed Distributions having  been calculated  in accordance  with
        the original terms of  the Certificates  or the Agreement except  for
        amendments or modifications to which the Certificate Insurer has given
        its prior written consent.   The effect of the Policy is to guarantee
        the  timely  payment  of  interest  on,  and  the ultimate payment of
        the principal amount of, all of the Certificates.
    

        The "Guaranteed  Principal Distribution Amount"  for any Distribution
        Date  shall be the amount  by which the Certificate Principal Balance
        (after  giving  effect   to  all  other   amounts  distributable  and
        allocable  to  principal  on the  Certificates  on  such Distribution
        Date)  exceeds the  Invested Amount for  such Distribution  Date.  In
        addition, the  Policy will  guarantee the payment of  the outstanding
        Certificate   Principal   Balance  on   the   Distribution  Date   in
        ____________,  20__  (after  giving   effect  to  all  other  amounts
        distributable and allocable to principal on such Distribution Date).

   
        (In accordance  with the Agreement, the  Trustee will be required  to
        establish and  maintain  an account  (the "Spread  Account") for  the
        benefit of  the Certificate Insurer  and the  Certificateholders.  As
        specified in the Agreement, the Certificate Insurer  will be entitled
        to  reimbursement  from funds  on deposit  in the  Spread  Account of
        certain amounts previously paid by it.  Further, as specified  in the
        Agreement, the  Trustee may be  required to use  funds on  deposit in
        the  Spread Account  prior to  making  a claim  on  the Policy.   The
        Trustee  shall  deposit  the  amounts  into  the  Spread  Account  as
        required by the Agreement.)
    

        In the absence  of payments under the Policy, Certificateholders will
        directly  bear the  credit  and  other risks  associated  with  their
        undivided  interest  in the  Trust  Fund.   See  "Description  of the
        Certificates--The Policy" herein.

Overcollateralization
Amount       The distribution  of Accelerated  Principal Distribution Amounts,
             if any, to  Certificateholders may result in the Invested  Amount
             being  greater than  the  Certificate Principal  Balance, thereby
             creating     the    Overcollateralization     Amount.         The
             Overcollateralization  Amount,  if  any,  will  be  available  to
             absorb any  Investor Loss Amount not covered by Investor Interest
             Collections.    Payments  of  Accelerated Principal  Distribution
             Amounts  are  not  covered by  the  Policy.   Any  Investor  Loss
             Amounts not  covered  by such  overcollateralization, amounts  on
             deposit  in the  Spread Account or  Investor Interest Collections
             will  be covered  by draws on  the Policy to  the extent provided
             therein.

   
(Pre-Funding Account         On  the  Closing Date,  $__________  (the  "Pre-
                             Funded Amount") will be deposited in  an account
                             (the  "Pre-Funding   Account"),  which   account
                             shall be  in the name  of and maintained  by the
                             Trustee and shall be part of the Trust  Fund and
                             will  be  used  to  acquire Subsequent  Mortgage
                             Loans.    During  the period  beginning  on  the
                             Closing  Date and  terminating on  ____________,
                             19__  (the  "Funding  Period"),  the  Pre-Funded
                             Amount will  be  maintained in  the  Pre-Funding
                             Account.   The Pre-Funded Amount will be reduced
                             during the Funding Period by  the amount thereof
                             used to purchase  Subsequent Mortgage Loans in 
                             accordance with  the Agreement.   Any Pre-Funded
                             Amount remaining at the  end of the Funding 
                             Period  will be distributed to holders of the 
                             classes  of  Certificates   entitled  to  
                             receive  principal  on  the Distribution  Date 
                             in  ________  19__  in  reduction of  the  related
                             Certificate Principal Balances, thus resulting  
                             in   a  partial principal prepayment of the 
                             related Certificates on such date.

Capitalized Interest Account     On the Closing Date there will  be deposited
                                 in  an account  (the  "Capitalized  Interest
                                 Account") maintained  with and  in the  name
                                 of the Trustee on behalf  of the Trust  Fund
                                 a portion  of the  proceeds of  the sale  of
                                 the  Certificates.    The  amount  deposited
                                 therein will  be used by  the Trustee on the
                                 Distribution   Dates  in   __________  19__,
                                 __________,  19__  and  __________  19__  to
                                 cover   shortfalls  in   interest   on   the
                                 Certificates that may  arise as a  result of
                                 the utilization  of the Pre-Funding  Account
                                 for  the  purchase  by  the  Trust  Fund  of
                                 Subsequent Mortgage Loans after  the Closing
                                 Date.     Any  amounts   remaining  in   the
                                 Capitalized Interest  Account at the end  of
                                 the Funding Period  are required to be  paid
                                 directly to Provident.)
    

Record Date      The  last day  preceding  a Distribution  Date  or,  if  the
                 Certificates are no longer Book-Entry Certificates, the last
                 day of the month preceding a Distribution Date.

Servicing        The  Master  Servicer  will  be  responsible for  servicing,
                 managing and making collections  on the Mortgage Loans.  The
                 Master Servicer  will deposit all collections  in respect of
                 the  Mortgage Loans into the Collection Account as described
                 under "Description of the Certificates--Payments on Mortgage
                 Loans; Deposits to Collection Account" herein.  On the third
                 Business   Day  prior   to  each   Distribution   Date  (the
                 "Determination Date"), the Master  Servicer will  calculate,
                 and instruct the Trustee  regarding the amounts available to
                 be  paid,   as   described   under   "Description   of   the
                 Certificates--Payments  on   Mortgage  Loans;   Deposits  to
                 Collection  Account" herein,  to the  Certificateholders  on
                 such  Distribution   Date.      See  "Description   of   the
                 Certificates--Distributions  on  the  Certificates"  herein.
                 With respect to each Collection Period,  the Master Servicer
                 will receive from collections in respect of interest on  the
                 Mortgage  Loans, on  behalf  of  itself, a  portion  of such
                 collections as a monthly servicing fee (the "Servicing Fee")
                 in  the  amount   of  approximately  ____%  per  annum  (the
                 "Servicing Fee Rate") on the aggregate Principal Balances of
                 the  Mortgage  Loans as  of  the  first  day  of  each  such
                 Collection Period.   See "Description  of the Certificates--
                 Servicing Compensation and Payment of Expenses"  herein.  In
                 certain  limited  circumstances,  the  Master  Servicer  may
                 resign or be removed, in which event either the Trustee or a
                 third-party servicer will be appointed as a successor Master
                 Servicer.   See  "Description  of  the Certificates--Certain
                 Matters Regarding  the Master  Servicer and  the Transferor"
                 herein.

Final Payment of
Principal; Termination       The   Trust   Fund   will   terminate   on   the
                             Distribution  Date following  the  later of  (A)
                             payment  in full  of  all amounts  owing  to the
                             Certificate Insurer and (B) the earliest  of (i)
                             the  Distribution Date on  which the Certificate
                             Principal  Balance  has been  reduced  to  zero,
                             (ii) the final  payment or other  liquidation of
                             the last Mortgage Loan in the  Trust Fund, (iii)
                             the optional  retransfer  to the  Transferor  of
                             the Certificates,  as described  below and  (iv)
                             the Distribution  Date in ______________,  20__.
                             The  Certificates will  be  subject to  optional
                             retransfer    to   the    Transferor   on    any
                             Distribution   Date   after    the   Certificate
                             Principal Balance is reduced  to an amount  less
                             than or  equal to $________________ (__%  of the
                             Original Certificate Principal Balance) and  all
                             amounts  due   and  owing  to   the  Certificate
                             Insurer and  unreimbursed draws  on the  Policy,
                             together  with  interest  thereon,  as  provided
                             under  the Insurance Agreement,  have been paid.
                             The retransfer price  will be  equal to the  sum
                             of   the   outstanding   Certificate   Principal
                             Balance and accrued and  unpaid interest thereon
                             at  the   Certificate  Rate   through  the   day
                             preceding  the  final Distribution  Date.    See
                             "Description  of The  Certificates--Termination;
                             Retirement of the Certificates"  herein and "The
                             Agreements--Termination;  Optional  Termination"
                             in the Prospectus.

                             In addition,  the Trust Fund may be liquidated 
                             as a result of certain events  of bankruptcy,  
                             insolvency or  receivership  relating to  the
                             Transferor.  See "Description of the 
                             Certificates--Rapid Amortization Events" herein.

Trustee                      (                         ),  a ________________
                             ____________ (the "Trustee")   will   act    as   
                             Trustee on behalf of the Certificateholders.

Mandatory Retransfer of
Certain Mortgage Loans
   
                             Provident will make certain  representations and
                             warranties  in the Agreement with respect to the
                             Mortgage Loans.   If Provident  breaches certain
                             of  its  representations   and  warranties  with
                             respect  to any  Mortgage Loan  and such  breach
                             materially  and adversely  affects the interests
                             of  the  Certificateholders or  the  Certificate
                             Insurer and  is not  cured within  the specified
                             period, the  Mortgage Loan will  be removed from
                             the  Trust  Fund   upon  the  expiration   of  a
                             specified  period   from  the   date  on   which
                             Provident becomes  aware or  receives notice  of
                             such  breach  and  will  be  reassigned  to  the
                             Transferor.     For   an  explanation   of   the
                             compensation   paid   in    respect   of    such
                             retransferred  Mortgage Loan,  see  "Description
                             of  the  Certificates--Assignment   of  Mortgage
                             Loans" herein.
    

Federal Income Tax
Consequences
   
                     Subject  to  the qualifications  set  forth  in "Federal
                     Income  Tax  Consequences"  herein,  Brown  &  Wood  LLP
                     special tax counsel to Provident is of the opinion that,
                     under existing law,  a Certificate will be  treated as a
                     debt instrument  for federal  income tax purposes  as of
                     the Closing  Date.  Under the Agreement, the Transferor,
                     Provident and the Certificateholders will  agree to  
                     treat the  Certificates  as indebtedness  for federal 
                     income  tax purposes.   Furthermore,  Brown  & Wood  LLP
                     special tax counsel to Provident is  of the opinion that
                     the  Trust Fund will not be treated  as either an 
                     association or a publicly traded partnership taxable as
                     a  corporation  or  as a  taxable  mortgage  pool. See
                     "Federal Income  Tax Consequences"  herein and in the 
                     Prospectus for additional  information concerning the  
                     application of federal income tax laws.
    

ERISA Considerations         The  acquisition of a  Certificate by  a pension
                             or  other  employee  benefit   plan  (a  "Plan")
                             subject  to  the   Employee  Retirement   Income
                             Security  Act  of 1974,  as  amended  ("ERISA"),
                             could,   in   some   instances,   result  in   a
                             "prohibited transaction"  or other  violation of
                             the  fiduciary   responsibility  provisions   of
                             ERISA   and   Code  Section   4975.      Certain
                             exemptions  from   the  prohibited   transaction
                             rules could be applicable to  the acquisition of
                             the   Certificates.      Any   Plan    fiduciary
                             considering whether to  purchase any Certificate
                             on  behalf of  a  Plan should  consult  with its
                             counsel  regarding  the  applicability   of  the
                             provisions  of ERISA and  the Code.   See "ERISA
                             Considerations" herein and in the Prospectus.

Legal Investment
Considerations       The  Certificates will not  constitute "mortgage related
                     securities"  for  purposes  of  the  Secondary  Mortgage
                     Market Enhancement  Act of 1984  ("SMMEA"), because  not
                     all of  the Mortgages  securing the  Mortgage Loans  are
                     first  mortgages.   Accordingly, many  institutions with
                     legal authority to invest in comparably rated securities
                     based solely  on  first  mortgages may  not  be  legally
                     authorized to invest  in the  Certificates.  See  "Legal
                     Investment Considerations" herein and "Legal Investment"
                     in the Prospectus.

Certificate Rating       It  is   a  condition   to  the   issuance  of   the
                         Certificates that  they be rated "___"  by _____ and
                         "___" by  _________ (each  a "Rating  Agency").   In
                         general,  ratings address  credit  risk  and do  not
                         address   the  likelihood   of  prepayments.     See
                         "Ratings"  herein and  "Risk Factors--Rating  of the
                         Securities" in the Prospectus.

Risk Factors
   
                     For a  discussion of  certain risks  associated with  an
                     investment in  the Certificates,  see "Risk Factors"  on
                     Page S-16 herein and on page 12 in the Prospectus.
    


                                 RISK FACTORS

    Investors should  consider  the following  risks in  connection with  the
purchase of Certificates.

   
    Consequences on Liquidity  of Owning  Book-Entry Certificates.   Issuance
of the  Certificates in  book-entry form  may reduce  the  liquidity of  such
Certificates in the secondary trading market since investors may be unwilling
to purchase Certificates for which they cannot  obtain physical certificates.
See "Description  of the  Certificates--Book-Entry  Certificates" herein  and
"Risk Factors-Book-Entry Registration" in the Prospectus.
    

    Since transactions in the  Certificates can be effected only through DTC,
CEDEL,  Euroclear,  participating  organizations, indirect  participants  and
certain banks, the ability of a Certificate Owner  to pledge a Certificate to
persons or entities  that do not participate  in the DTC, CEDEL  or Euroclear
system may  be limited due to lack of a physical certificate representing the
Certificates.  See "Description of the Certificates--Book-Entry Certificates"
herein and "Risk Factors-Book-Entry Registration" in the Prospectus.

   
    Payment   Delay   as  a   Result   of  Owning   Book-Entry  Certificates.
Certificate  Owners   may  experience   some  delay  in   their  receipt   of
distributions  of  interest and  principal  on  the Certificates  since  such
distributions  will be forwarded  by the Trustee  to DTC and  DTC will credit
such  distributions to  the accounts of  its Participants  (as defined herein
under "Description of the  Certificates--Book-Entry Certificates") which will
thereafter credit them to the  accounts of Certificate Owners either directly
or indirectly through indirect participants.  Certificate Owners  will not be
recognized as Certificateholders as such term  is used in the Agreement,  and
Certificate  Owners   will   be  permitted   to   exercise  the   rights   of
Certificateholders only  indirectly through  DTC and its  Participants.   See
"Description of the Certificates--Book-Entry  Certificates" herein and  "Risk
Factors--Book-Entry Registration" in the Prospectus.

    Cash  Flow  Considerations and  Risks  of  Shortfalls.   Minimum  monthly
payments  on the Mortgage  Loans will at  least equal and  may exceed accrued
interest.   Even  assuming that  the  Mortgaged Properties  provide  adequate
security  for the Mortgage Loans, substantial  delays could be encountered in
connection with the  liquidation of  Mortgage Loans that  are delinquent  and
resulting shortfalls in  distributions to  Certificateholders could occur  if
the Certificate  Insurer were unable to perform  on its obligations under the
Policy.   Further,  liquidation expenses  (such  as legal  fees, real  estate
taxes,  and maintenance and  preservation expenses) will  reduce the proceeds
payable  to  Certificateholders  and  thereby reduce  the  security  for  the
Mortgage Loans.  In the event any of the Mortgaged Properties fail to provide
adequate security  for the related  Mortgage Loans,  Certificateholders could
experience a  loss  if the  Certificate Insurer  were unable  to perform  its
obligations under the Policy.

    Prepayment Considerations  and Effect on  Yield to Maturity  and Weighted
Average Life of Certificates.  Substantially all of the Mortgage Loans may be
prepaid in  whole or in part at any time without penalty.  Home equity loans,
such as the Mortgage Loans,  have been originated in significant volume  only
during  the  past few  years  and  Provident is  not  aware  of any  publicly
available studies  or statistics  on the rate  of prepayment  of such  loans.
Generally,  home  equity  loans are  not  viewed  by  borrowers as  permanent
financing.  Accordingly, the Mortgage Loans  may experience a higher rate  of
prepayment  than traditional loans.   The Trust  Fund's prepayment experience
may be  affected by  a wide  variety of  factors, including  general economic
conditions, interest  rates, the  availability of  alternative financing  and
homeowner mobility.   In addition,  substantially all of  the Mortgage  Loans
contain due-on-sale  provisions and  the Master  Servicer intends  to enforce
such  provisions unless (i)  such enforcement is  not permitted by applicable
law or  (ii)  the Master  Servicer, in  a manner  consistent with  reasonable
commercial practice, permits the purchaser  of the related Mortgaged Property
to assume the Mortgage Loan.  To the extent permitted by applicable law, such
assumption will  not release the original borrower  from its obligation under
any such  Mortgage Loan.   See "Description  of the Certificates"  herein and
"Certain Legal Aspects of Loans--Due-on-Sale Clauses" in the Prospectus for a
description of  certain provisions  of the  Credit Line  Agreements that  may
affect  the prepayment  experience  on  the Mortgage  Loans.   The  yield  to
maturity  and weighted  average life  of  the Certificates  will be  affected
primarily by the rate and  timing of prepayments on the Mortgage  Loans.  Any
reinvestment risks resulting from a faster or slower incidence of  prepayment
of  Mortgage Loans will  be borne  entirely by  the Certificateholders.   See
"Maturity and  Prepayment Considerations"  herein and  "Yield and  Prepayment
Considerations" in the Prospectus.

    Certificate  Rating  Based  Primarily  on  Claims-Paying Ability  of  the
Certificate Insurer.  The rating of the Certificates will depend primarily on
an  assessment by  the Rating  Agencies of  the Mortgage  Loans and  upon the
claims-paying ability  of the Certificate Insurer.  Any reduction in a rating
assigned to the claims-paying ability of the Certificate Insurer  below the 
rating initially given to the Certificates may result in a reduction  in the 
rating of the Certificates.   The rating by the Rating Agencies of  the 
Certificates is not a recommendation to purchase, hold or sell the 
Certificates, inasmuch as such rating does not comment as to the market price
or suitability  for a  particular investor.   There  is no assurance that the
ratings will remain in place for any given period of time or that the ratings
will not be lowered or withdrawn by the Rating  Agencies.  In general, the 
ratings address credit risk and do not address the likelihood of prepayments.
The  ratings  of  the  Certificates  do  not  address  the possibility of the
imposition of United States withholding  tax with respect to non-U.S. persons.

    Legal   Considerations  --   Lien   Priority   and  Possible   Delay   in
Distributions or Losses.   The Mortgage Loans are secured by mortgages (which
generally  are second mortgages).   With respect  to Mortgage Loans  that are
secured by first mortgages,  the Master Servicer has the power  under certain
circumstances to  consent to  a new mortgage  lien on the  Mortgaged Property
having priority over  such Mortgage Loan.   Therefore, there is  generally no
limit on the principal amount of prior liens that can be  placed ahead of the
Mortgage Loans.  Mortgage Loans  secured by second mortgages are  entitled to
proceeds that  remain from the  sale of the related  Mortgaged Property after
any  related  senior  mortgage  loan  and  prior statutory  liens  have  been
satisfied.  If such proceeds are insufficient to satisfy such loans and prior
liens in  the aggregate and the Certificate Insurer  is unable to perform its
obligations under  the Policy, the  Certificateholders will bear the  risk of
delay in  distributions while a  deficiency judgment against  the borrower is
obtained and the risk of  loss if the deficiency judgment cannot  be obtained
or is insufficient to satisfy the Mortgage Loan.  See "Certain  Legal Aspects
of the Loans" in the Prospectus.

    Bankruptcy and Insolvency  Risks.  Provident and the Trust will treat the
transfer of  the Mortgage  Loans from Provident  to the  Trust as a  sale for
accounting purposes.   However, in the event of the  insolvency of Provident,
it is  possible that  a receiver  or  conservator (or  similar official)  for
Provident, may attempt to recharacterize the sale of  the Mortgage Loans as a
borrowing by  Provident, secured by a pledge of  the Mortgage Loans.  Certain
provisions of the Federal  Deposit Insurance Act  (state law) may permit  the
FDIC or state  regulator to avoid such security interest.   This position, if
argued or accepted by a  court, could prevent timely payments of  amounts due
on  the  Certificates  and result  in  a  reduction of  payments  due  on the
Certificates.  Provident will, however, mark its records to indicate that the
Mortgage Loans have been sold to the Trust Fund.
    

    In the event of  a bankruptcy or insolvency  of the Master Servicer,  the
bankruptcy trustee or receiver may  have the power to prevent the  Trustee or
the Certificateholders from appointing a  successor Master Servicer.  In  the
event of the insolvency  of the Master Servicer  and if cash collections  are
commingled with the  Master Servicer's own funds  for at least ten  days, the
Trust Fund  will likely not  have a  perfected interest  in such  collections
since such collections would not have  been deposited in a segregated account
within  ten days after the  collection thereof, and  the inclusion thereof in
the bankruptcy estate of the Master Servicer may result in delays  in payment
and failure to pay amounts due on the Certificates.

   
    In  addition, federal  and  state  statutory  provisions,  including  the
federal bankruptcy  laws  and state  laws affording  relief  to debtors,  may
interfere  with  or affect  the  ability of  the  secured mortgage  lender to
realize upon  its security.  For  example, in a proceeding  under the federal
Bankruptcy Code, a lender may  not foreclose on a mortgaged  property without
the permission of the bankruptcy court.  The rehabilitation  plan proposed by
the  debtor may  provide,  if  the mortgaged  property  is  not the  debtor's
principal  residence and the court determines that the value of the mortgaged
property is less than  the principal balance of  the mortgage loan, that  the
secured indebtedness be reduced to the value of the mortgaged property  as of
the date  of  the commencement  of  the bankruptcy,  rendering  the lender  a
general  unsecured  creditor for  the  difference, and  also  may reduce  the
monthly payments due  under such mortgage loan,  change the rate  of interest
and alter  the mortgage  loan repayment  schedule.   The effect  of any  such
proceedings under the federal  Bankruptcy Code, including but not  limited to
any  automatic stay,  could result  in delays  in  receiving payments  on the
Mortgage Loans and reductions in the aggregate amount of such payments.
    

    (Geographic Concentration.   As of the Cut-Off Date, approximately _____%
(by Cut-Off Date Principal  Balance) of the Mortgaged Properties  are located
in the State of __________.  An overall decline in the __________ residential
real  estate  market  could  adversely affect  the  values  of  the Mortgaged
Properties securing such  Mortgage Loans such that the  Principal Balances of
the  related Mortgage  Loans,  together with  any primary  financing  on such
Mortgaged  Properties,  could equal  or exceed  the  value of  such Mortgaged
Properties.   As the  residential real  estate market  is influenced  by many
factors, including the general condition  of the economy and interest  rates,
no assurances may be given that the __________ residential real estate market
will not  weaken.  If  the __________  residential real estate  market should
experience  an  overall  decline  in  property  values  after  the  dates  of
origination of the Mortgage  Loans, the rates  of losses on the  Mortgage 
Loans would  be expected to increase, and could increase substantially.)

    Master Servicer's  Ability to  Change the  Terms of  the Mortgage  Loans.
The  Master Servicer  may agree  to  changes in  the terms  of a  Credit Line
Agreement,  provided  that such  changes  (i)  do  not adversely  affect  the
interest  of the Certificateholders or the  Certificate Insurer, and (ii) are
consistent with  prudent business practice.   There can be no  assurance that
changes in applicable law or the marketplace for home equity loans or prudent
business  practice will not  result in changes  in the terms  of the Mortgage
Loans.   In  addition,  the  Agreement permits  the  Master Servicer,  within
certain limitations  described therein, to  increase the Credit  Limit of the
related Mortgage Loan or reduce the Margin  for such Mortgage Loan.  Any such
increase in the  Credit Line of a  Mortgage Loan would increase  the Loan-to-
Value Ratio  of such Mortgage Loan and,  accordingly, would increase the risk
of  the Trust  Fund's investment  in such  Mortgage Loan.   In  addition, any
reduction in the Margin of a Mortgage Loan would reduce the  excess cash flow
available to absorb losses.

    Delinquent Mortgage Loans.   The Trust  Fund will include  Mortgage Loans
which are 89 or  fewer days delinquent as of  the Cut-Off Date.   The Cut-Off
Date  Principal Balance of  Mortgage Loans which  are between 30  days and 89
days delinquent  as of the Cut-Off Date was $_________________.  If there are
not  sufficient funds  from the  Investor Interest  Collections to  cover the
Investor Loss  Amounts for any  Distribution Date, the  Overcollateralization
Amount and the  amount on deposit in the Spread Account  have been reduced to
zero, and the Certificate Insurer fails to perform  its obligations under the
Policy, the aggregate amount of principal returned  to the Certificateholders
may  be  less  than  the  Certificate  Principal  Balance  on  the  day   the
Certificates are issued.

   
    (Subsequent  Mortgage  Loans.   The  ability  of  the  Trust  to purchase
mortgage loans after the date  of this Prospectus Supplement and on  or prior
to ____________,  19__ that  meet the  requirements for  transfer during  the
Funding  Period under  the  Agreement is  affected by  a variety  of factors,
including  interest rates,  unemployment levels,  the rate  of inflation  and
consumer  perception of economic  conditions generally.   On the Distribution
Date in ____________ 19__, a principal prepayment will be made to the holders
of the Certificates in the amount which represents the excess of the original
Pre-Funded Amount over the Principal Balance of all Subsequent Mortgage Loans
as of  the related Cut-Off  Date (i.e.,  the balance on  deposit in  the Pre-
Funding  Account on  such date  (net of  investment earnings)).   Although no
assurances  can  be  given,  Provident  intends  that no  material  principal
prepayment will be required to  be made to the holders of the Certificates on
the  Distribution Date in ____________ 19__.  Any reinvestment risk resulting
from such prepayment will be borne entirely by the Certificateholders.)
    

    For  a discussion of additional risks pertaining to the Certificates, see
"Risk Factors" in the Prospectus.


                           THE CERTIFICATE INSURER

    The following information set forth in this section has been provided  by
the Certificate  Insurer.   Accordingly,  neither  Provident nor  the  Master
Servicer makes any representation as to the accuracy and completeness of such
information.

                     (Description of Certificate Insurer)


                             THE MASTER SERVICER

GENERAL

    The Master  Servicer will service the  Mortgage Loans in  accordance with
the terms set forth in the Agreement.  The Master Servicer may perform any of
its  obligations under the Agreement through  one or more subservicers.  Not-
withstanding any  such  subservicing arrangement,  the  Master Servicer  will
remain liable for its servicing duties and obligations under the Agreement as
if the Master Servicer alone were servicing the Mortgage Loans.

THE MASTER SERVICER

   
    Provident  will be responsible  for servicing the Mortgage  Loans for the
Trust in accordance with the terms of the Agreement.  Advanta  Mortgage Corp.
USA  (the  "Subservicer")  will  service  the  Mortgage Loans  for  Provident
pursuant to a  Subservicing Agreement,  to be dated  as of  (______________),
between Provident  and the  Subservicer.   The  terms and  conditions of  the
Subservicing Agreement  are consistent with and do not violate the provisions
of the Agreement.  Such  subservicing does not relieve Provident from  any of
its obligations to service the Mortgage Loan in accordance with the terms and
conditions of the Agreement.

    Provident  is the  principal  banking  subsidiary of  Provident  Bancorp,
Inc., a  Cincinnati-based  bank holding  company  registered under  the  Bank
Holding Company  Act.   Provident  Bancorp,  Inc. operates  throughout  Ohio,
Northern Kentucky,  Southeastern Indiana and  Florida.  As of  June 30, 1996,
Provident  Bancorp, Inc.  had total  assets of  $6.4 billion,  net loans  and
leases of  $4.9 billion,  deposits of  $4.2 billion  and total  shareholders'
equity of $458 million.  Provident Bancorp's tier  1 and total capital ratios
were 7.73% and 11.79%, respectively.  For the six months ended June 30, 1996,
Provident Bancorp  had net earnings  of $39.9  million.  As  of December  31,
1995,  Provident  Bancorp had  total assets  of $6.2  billion, net  loans and
leases  of $4.8  billion, deposits  of $4.2  billion and  total shareholders'
equity of $433 million.  Provident Bancorp's tier I and total  capital ratios
were 7.52%  and 11.77%, respectively.  For the fiscal year ended December 31,
1995,  Provident Bancorp, Inc. had net earnings  of $71.9 million.  Provident
represents approximately 96% of Provident Bancorp, Inc.'s assets.
    


                         THE HOME EQUITY LOAN PROGRAM

CREDIT AND UNDERWRITING GUIDELINES

    The   following  is   a  description   of  the   underwriting  guidelines
customarily  employed by Provident  with respect  to Mortgage Loans  which it
purchases or originates.   Each Mortgage Loan  was underwritten according  to
these guidelines.  Provident believes its standards are consistent with those
utilized  by  home equity  lenders generally.    The underwriting  process is
intended to assess both  the prospective borrower's ability to repay  and the
adequacy of the  real property security as  collateral for the  loan granted.
In certain  cases, loans may  be made  outside of those  guidelines with  the
prior approval of an underwriting manager of Provident.

    Provident  generally  originates or  purchases loans  which  either fully
amortize over a period not  to exceed 360 months or provide  for amortization
over a 360  month schedule with a "balloon" payment  required at the maturity
date, which will not be less than fifteen years after  origination.  The loan
amounts generally range  from a minimum of  $10,000 to a maximum  of $500,000
unless  a higher  amount is  specifically  approved by  a senior  official of
Provident.   Provident primarily originates  or purchases  non-purchase money
first  or second mortgage  loans although Provident  also originates purchase
money first mortgage loans.

    The homes used for  collateral to secure the loans may  be either primary
residential (which includes second and vacation homes) or investor owned one-
to  four-family  homes,  condominiums, townhouses  or  manufactured  housing.
Generally,  each home must have a minimum appraised value as described below.
Mobile housing or agricultural land are  not accepted as collateral.  In some
cases,  the  loan  may  be  secured  by  the  owner-occupied  residence  plus
additional real estate collateral.

    Each property proposed as security for a loan  must be appraised not more
than six months  prior to the date of such loan.   The combined loan-to-value
ratio of the first  and second mortgages generally may not exceed  85%.  If a
prior  mortgage exists, Provident  first reviews the  first mortgage history.
If it  contains open-end,  advance or negative  amortization provisions,  the
maximum potential first  mortgage balance is used in calculating the combined
loan-to-value ratio which determines the maximum loan amount.

    For Provident's full documentation process,  each mortgage applicant must
provide, and  Provident  must verify,  personal financial  information.   The
applicant's  total monthly obligations (which includes principal and interest
on each mortgage, tax assessments, other loans, charge accounts and all other
scheduled indebtedness) generally cannot exceed 60% of  the applicant's gross
monthly income.  Applicants who  are salaried employees must provide  current
employment information in addition to two recent years of employment  history
and Provident verifies  this information.  Verifications are based on written
confirmation from employers or a combination of the two most recent pay  
stubs, the  two most recent  years' W-2  tax forms  and telephone confirmation
from  the employer.  Self-employed applicants must be self-employed in the 
same  field  for   a  minimum  of  two  years.    The self-employed applicant 
must provide signed copies of complete federal income tax returns (including 
schedules) filed for the most recent two years.

    For  Provident's non-income verifier  program, proof of  one year history
of employment  plus proof of current  self-employed status is  required.  The
applicant's debt-to-income ratio  is calculated based on  income as certified
by  the borrower  on the  application and  must be  reasonable.   The maximum
Combined Loan-to-Value ratio may not  exceed 80% for the non-income  verifier
program.

    A credit report  by an independent  credit reporting  agency is  required
reflecting the applicant's complete credit history.  The credit report should
reflect all  delinquencies  of 30  days  or more,  repossessions,  judgments,
foreclosures, garnishments, bankruptcies, divorce actions and similar adverse
credit  practices that can be  discovered by a search of  public records.  If
the  report is  obtained more  than 60  days prior to  the loan  closing, the
lender must determine that the reponed information has not changed.   Written
verification is obtained of any first mortgage balance if not reported in the
credit bureau.

   
    Generally, the applicant  should have an acceptable credit  history given
the amount  of equity available,  the strength of  the applicant's employment
history  and the level  of the applicant's  income to debt  obligations.  The
rescission period (generally, a period of three days) must have expired prior
to funding a loan.  The rescission period may not be waived by  the applicant
except as  permitted by  law.  Either  an ALTA  title insurance policy  or an
attorney's opinion of title is required for all loans.
    

    The applicant  is required  to  secure property  insurance in  an  amount
sufficient to cover the new loan  and any prior mortgage.  If the sum  of the
outstanding  first  mortgage,  if  any,  and the  home  equity  loan  exceeds
replacement  value, insurance  equal to  replacement  value may  be accepted.
Provident  must ensure that  its name  and address  is properly added  to the
"Mortgage Clause" of the insurance policy.  In the event Provident's  name is
added to a "Loss  Payee Clause" and the  policy does not provide  for written
notice  of  policy  changes  or  cancellation,  an  endorsement  adding  such
provision is required.

    Provident's  credit  underwriting  guidelines  require   that  any  major
deferred maintenance on  any property must bc cured from  the proceeds of the
loan.

SERVICING OF THE MORTGAGE LOANS

    The Master Servicer  has established standard policies for  the servicing
and collection  of the  home equity loans.   Servicing  includes, but  is not
limited  to, (i) the collection  and aggregation of  payments relating to the
Mortgage  Loans; (ii)  the  supervision of  delinquent  Mortgage Loans,  loss
mitigation   efforts,  foreclosure  proceedings   and,  if   applicable,  the
disposition of Mortgaged Properties; and (iii) the preparation of tax related
information in connection with the Mortgage Loans.

    Billing statements  are  mailed monthly  by  the  Master Servicer.    The
statement details  all debits and  credits and specifies the  minimum payment
due and  the available credit line.  Notice of changes in the applicable loan
rate  are  provided  by  the  Master  Servicer  to  the Mortgagor  with  such
statements.  All payments are due by the fifteenth day of the month.

   
    With  respect  to  Mortgage  Loans,  the  general  policy  of the  Master
Servicer is to initiate foreclosure in the underlying property (i) after such
loan is 75 days  or more delinquent  and satisfactory arrangements cannot  be
made  with the Mortgagor or (ii)  if a notice of default  on a senior lien is
received by the Master Servicer. Foreclosure proceedings may be terminated if
the  delinquency  is  cured.  Mortgage  Loans  to   borrowers  in  bankruptcy
proceedings  may be restructured  in accordance with  law and with  a view to
maximizing recovery of such Mortgage Loans, including any deficiencies.

    Once foreclosure  is  initiated by  the  Master Servicer,  a  foreclosure
tracking  system is used  to monitor  the progress  of the proceedings.   The
system includes state specific parameters to monitor  whether proceedings are
progressing within the time frame typical for the state in which the property
is located.  During the foreclosure proceeding, the Master Servicer determines
the amount of the foreclosure bid and whether to liquidate the Mortgage Loan.
    

    After  foreclosure,  if  the home  equity  loan  is  secured  by a  first
mortgage lien, the Master  Servicer may liquidate the Mortgaged  Property and
charge  off the  home equity  loan balance  which was  not recovered  through
liquidation  proceeds.   If the  Mortgaged Property was  subject to  a senior
lien, the Master Servicer will either directly manage the foreclosure sale of
the property and satisfy  such lien at the time of sale  or take other action
as deemed necessary to protect the interest in the Mortgaged Property.  If in
the judgment of  the Master Servicer, the  cost of maintaining or  purchasing
the senior  lien position  exceeds the economic  benefit of such  action, the
Master Servicer will generally charge off the entire home equity loan and may
seek a money judgment against the borrower.

    Servicing and  charge-off policies  and collection  practices may  change
over  time  in accordance  with, among  other  things, the  Master Servicer's
business  judgment,  changes  in  the  portfolio  and   applicable  laws  and
regulations.

DELINQUENCY EXPERIENCE

    The following table sets forth Provident's  delinquency experience on its
servicing portfolio of mortgage loans (including mortgage  loans serviced for
others) similar  to the Mortgage Loans for the  periods indicated.  There can
be no assurance that the delinquency experience on the Mortgage Loans will be
consistent with the historical information provided below.  Accordingly, this
information should not  be considered to  reflect the  credit quality of  the
Mortgage Loans included in the Trust, or a basis of assessing the likelihood,
amount or severity of  losses on the Mortgage Loans.  The statistical data in
the  table is  based  on all  of  the closed-end  fixed  and adjustable  rate
mortgage loans in Provident's servicing portfolio.

    The information  in the tables below  has not been adjusted  to eliminate
the effect of the significant growth in the size of Provident's mortgage loan
portfolio during the periods shown.  Accordingly, delinquency as a percentage
of aggregate principal  balance of  Mortgage Loans serviced  for each  period
would  be  higher than  those  shown  if  a  group  of  mortgage  loans  were
artificially  isolated  at a  point in  time and  the information  showed the
activity only in that  isolated group.  However,  since most of the  mortgage
loans in  Provident's mortgage  loan portfolio  are not  fully seasoned,  the
delinquency information for such an isolated group would also be distorted to
some  degree.  As of July 31, 1996,  there have been no losses on Provident's
mortgage loan servicing portfolio.

    The  following  table  sets  forth
information relating to the delinquency  experience of mortgage loans similar
to  and including the Mortgage Loans for  the (three) quarters ended December
31, 1995 and March 31, 1996.



<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                            Quarter Ended
                                            March 31, 1996                    December 31, 1995

                                    Number of                            Number of
                                      Loans          Dollar Amount         Loans        Dollar Amount
<S>                                  <C>             <C>                   <C>          <C>
Portfolio . . . . . . . . . .          765            $72,345,012           310          $31,214,760
Delinquency percentage(1) . .

  30-59 days  . . . . . . . .         0.26%              0.28%             0.00%            0.00%
  60-89 days  . . . . . . . .         0.39%              0.42%             0.00%            0.00%
  90 days or more . . . . . .         0.13%              0.13%             0.00%            0.00%
Total . . . . . . . . . . . .         0.78%              0.83%             0.00%            0.00%

</TABLE>

        __________
   
        (1)  The  period of delinquency is  based on  the number of days  the
        payment is contractually past due.
    

                      DESCRIPTION OF THE MORTGAGE LOANS

GENERAL

    The  Mortgage  Loans were  originated  pursuant  to  loan agreements  and
disclosure  statements (the  "Credit  Line Agreements")  and  are secured  by
mortgages or  deeds of trust, which  are either first or  second mortgages or
deeds  of  trust,  on Mortgaged  Properties  located  in  ____  states.   The
Mortgaged  Properties  securing  the Mortgage  Loans  consist  of residential
properties that  are one-  to four-family properties.   See  "--Mortgage Loan
Terms" below.

   
    The  Cut-Off Date Pool Balance is  $______________, which is equal to the
aggregate Principal  Balances of the Mortgage  Loans as of the  Cut-Off Date.
As of  the  Cut-Off Date,  the Mortgage  Loans  were not  more  than 89  days
delinquent.  The average Cut-Off Date Principal Balance was approximately $  
     , the minimum Cut-Off  Date Principal Balance was zero, the maximum Cut-
Off Date Principal  Balance was $            , the minimum Loan  Rate and the
maximum Loan Rate as  of the Cut-Off Date were      % and       %  per annum,
respectively, and the weighted average  Loan Rate as of the Cut-Off  Date was
approximately      % per annum.  As of the Cut-Off Date, the weighted average
Credit Limit Utilization  Rate was approximately       %, the  minimum Credit
Limit Utilization Rate was zero and the maximum Credit Limit Utilization Rate
was 100%.  The "Credit Limit Utilization Rate"  is determined by dividing the
Cut-Off Date Principal Balance of a Mortgage  Loan by the Credit Limit of the
related  Credit Line Agreement.  The remaining term to scheduled maturity for
the Mortgage  Loans as  of the Cut-Off  Date ranged  from      months  to    
months  and the  weighted average  remaining term  to scheduled  maturity was
approximately     months.  As of the Cut-Off Date, the Combined Loan-to-Value
Ratio of  the Mortgage Loans ranged  from      % to ______%  and the weighted
average Combined  Loan-to-Value Ratio was approximately     %.   The Combined
Loan-to-Value  Ratio for  a  Mortgage  Loan  is the  ratio  (expressed  as  a
percentage) of (A) the  sum of (i) the Credit Limit of  the Mortgage Loan and
(ii)  any outstanding  principal balances  of mortgage  loans senior  to such
Mortgage Loan (calculated at the date of origination of the Mortgage Loan) to
(B) the lesser of (i)  the appraised value of the related  Mortgaged Property
as set  forth in the loan  files at such date  of origination or  (ii) in the
case of  a Mortgaged Property purchased within one year of the origination of
the  related Mortgage Loan,  the purchase  price of such  Mortgaged Property.
Credit Limits under the Mortgage Loans as of the Cut-Off Date ranged from $  
     to $             and averaged approximately  $          .   The weighted
average  second mortgage  ratio (which  is the  Credit Limit for  the related
Mortgage Loan,  provided such Mortgage Loan was  in the second lien position,
divided by the sum of such Credit Limit and the outstanding principal balance
of any mortgage loan senior to the related Mortgage Loan) was approximately  
  %.  As of  the Cut-Off Date, approximately      % by Cut-Off Date Principal
Balance  of  the  Mortgage  Loans  represented  first liens  on  the  related
Mortgaged  Properties, while  approximately         %  of the  Mortgage Loans
represented second liens.  As of  the Cut-Off Date, approximately        % of
the  Mortgage Loans  are secured  by Mortgaged  Properties which  are single-
family residences  and ___%  were owner-occupied.   As of  the Cut-Off  Date,
approximately      %,      %,     %,      %,     % and      % by Cut-Off Date
Principal Balance are  located in __________, ________,  __________, _______,
______  and ________), respectively.   In no  event will more than  5% of the
Cut-Off Date  Pool Principal Balance  of the  Mortgage Pool deviate  from the
characteristics of the Mortgage Loans described herein.
    

MORTGAGE LOAN TERMS

    (A borrower  may access a Mortgage Loan  by writing a check  in a minimum
amount of $250.   The Mortgage Loans  bear interest at a variable  rate which
changes monthly on the first  business day of the related month  with changes
in  the applicable Index Rate.   The Mortgage Loans  are subject to a maximum
per annum interest  rate (the "Maximum Rate") ranging from (_____% to _____%)
per  annum and subject  to applicable usury  limitations.  As  of the Cut-Off
Date,  the weighted average  Maximum Rate  was approximately         %.   See
"Certain Legal  Aspects of  the Loans--Applicability  of Usury  Laws" in  the
Prospectus.  The daily periodic rate on the  Mortgage Loans (the "Loan Rate")
is  the sum of the Index Rate  plus the spread (the "Margin") which generally
ranges between ____% and ____%  and had a weighted average, as of the Cut-Off
Date, of approximately     %, divided by 365 days.  The "Index Rate" is based
on the highest "prime rate" published in  the 'Money Rates' table of The Wall
Street Journal as of the first business day of each calendar month.)

    Set  forth below  is  a description  of  certain characteristics  of  the
Mortgage Loans as of the Cut-Off Date:


                        PRINCIPAL BALANCES

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>                                                                                Percent of

         Range of Principal Balances                Number                               by Cut-Off
                                                      of           Cut-Off Date             Date
                                                   Mortgage          Principal            Principal
                                                    Loans             Balance              Balance
<S>                                                <C>          <C>                       <C>
$_______ to $_________  . . . . . . . . . .                      $                             %
$_______ to $_________  . . . . . . . . . .
$_______ to $_________  . . . . . . . . . .
$_______ to $_________  . . . . . . . . . .
$_______ to $_________  . . . . . . . . . .
$_______ to $_________  . . . . . . . . . .
$_______ to $_________  . . . . . . . . . .
$_______ to $_________  . . . . . . . . . .
$_______ to $_________  . . . . . . . . . .
$_______ to $_________  . . . . . . . . . .
$_______ to $_________  . . . . . . . . . .
$_______ to $_________  . . . . . . . . . .
$_______ to $_________  . . . . . . . . . .
$_______ to $_________  . . . . . . . . . .
$_______ to $_________  . . . . . . . . . .
$_______ to $_________  . . . . . . . . . .
$_______ to $_________  . . . . . . . . . .
$_______ to $_________  . . . . . . . . . .
$_______ to $_________  . . . . . . . . . .
$_______ and over . . . . . . . . . . . . .
     Total  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      $                           100.00%


</TABLE>

                          GEOGRAPHIC DISTRIBUTION(1)


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                         Percent of
                                                                                            Pool
                    State                           Number                               by Cut-Off
                                                      of           Cut-Off Date             Date
                                                   Mortgage          Principal            Principal
                                                    Loans             Balance              Balance

<S>                                               <C>           <C>                      <C>
                                                                   $                             %









     Total  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      $                           100.00%

</TABLE>



(1) Geographic  location  is  determined by  the  address  of  the  Mortgaged
    Property securing the related Mortgage Loan.



                       COMBINED LOAN-TO-VALUE RATIOS(1)


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                         Percent of
              Range of Combined                                                             Pool
             Loan-to-Value Ratios                   Number                               by Cut-Off
                                                      of           Cut-Off Date             Date
                                                   Mortgage          Principal            Principal
                                                    Loans             Balance              Balance

<S>                                                <C>          <C>                       <C>
_____% to ______% . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      $                             %
______% to ______%  . . . . . . . . . . . .
______% to ______%  . . . . . . . . . . . .
______% to ______%  . . . . . . . . . . . .
______% to ______%  . . . . . . . . . . . .
______% to ______%  . . . . . . . . . . . .
______% to ______%  . . . . . . . . . . . .
______% to ______%  . . . . . . . . . . . .
______% to ______%  . . . . . . . . . . . .
______% to ______%  . . . . . . . . . . . .
     Total  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      $                           100.00%

</TABLE>

(1) The ratio  (expressed as a percentage) of  (A) the sum of  (i) the Credit
    Limit of the Mortgage Loans  and (ii) any outstanding  principal balances
    of  mortgage loans senior to  the Mortgage Loans  (calculated at the date
    of  origination  of the  Mortgage Loans)  to  (B) the  lesser of  (i) the
    appraised value of the  related Mortgaged Property as  set forth in  loan
    files at  such date of  origination or  (ii) in the  case of a  Mortgaged
    Property  purchased within  one year  of the  origination of  the related
    Mortgage Loan, the purchase price of such Mortgaged Property.


                                PROPERTY TYPE

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                        Percent of
                                                                                            Pool
                Property Type                       Number                               by Cut-Off
                                                      of           Cut-Off Date             Date
                                                   Mortgage          Principal            Principal
                                                    Loans             Balance              Balance
<S>                                                <C>         <C>                       <C>
Single Family . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      $                             %
Two- to Four-Family . . . . . . . . . . . .
Condominium . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
PUD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

     Total  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      $                           100.00%

</TABLE>


                                LIEN PRIORITY

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                         Percent of
                                                                                            Pool
                Lien Priority                       Number                               by Cut-Off
                                                      of           Cut-Off Date             Date
                                                   Mortgage          Principal            Principal
                                                    Loans             Balance              Balance
<S>                                               <C>          <C>                       <C>

First Lien  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      $                             %
Second Lien . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

     Total  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      $                           100.00%

</TABLE>


                                LOAN RATES(1)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                         Percent of
                  Range of                                                                  Pool
                  Loan Rates                        Number                               by Cut-Off
                                                      of           Cut-Off Date             Date
                                                   Mortgage          Principal            Principal
                                                    Loans             Balance              Balance
<S>                                                <C>          <C>                     <C>

_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      $                             %
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
     Total  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      $                           100.00%

</TABLE>


(1) Approximately     %  of the  Mortgage  Loans  by Cut-Off  Date  Principal
    Balance are subject to an introductory rate of _____% per annum.

                                    MARGIN

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                         Percent of
                  Range of                                                                  Pool
                   Margins                          Number                               by Cut-Off
                                                      of           Cut-Off Date             Date
                                                   Mortgage          Principal            Principal
                                                    Loans             Balance              Balance
<S>                                               <C>           <C>                      <C>

_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      $                             %
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
     Total  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      $                           100.00%


</TABLE>


                        CREDIT LIMIT UTILIZATION RATES


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                         Percent of
            Range of Credit Limit                                                           Pool
              Utilization Rates                     Number                               by Cut-Off
                                                      of           Cut-Off Date             Date
                                                   Mortgage          Principal            Principal
                                                    Loans             Balance              Balance
<S>                                              <C>            <C>                     <C>

_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      $                             %
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
     Total  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      $                           100.00%

</TABLE>

                                CREDIT LIMITS

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                         Percent of
                                                                                            Pool
            Range of Credit Limits                  Number                               by Cut-Off
                                                      of           Cut-Off Date             Date
                                                   Mortgage          Principal            Principal
                                                    Loans             Balance              Balance
<S>                                                <C>          <C>                      <C>

$__________to $_________  . . . . . . . . .                      $                             %
$_________ to $_________  . . . . . . . . .
$_________ to $_________  . . . . . . . . .
$_________ to $_________  . . . . . . . . .
$_________ to $_________  . . . . . . . . .
$_________ to $_________  . . . . . . . . .
$_________ to $_________  . . . . . . . . .
$_________ to $_________  . . . . . . . . .
$_________ to $_________  . . . . . . . . .
$_________ to $_________  . . . . . . . . .
$_________ to $_________  . . . . . . . . .
$_________ to $_________  . . . . . . . . .
$_________ to $_________  . . . . . . . . .
$_________ to $_________  . . . . . . . . .
$_________ to $_________  . . . . . . . . .
$_________ to $_________  . . . . . . . . .
$_________ to $_________  . . . . . . . . .
$_________ to $_________  . . . . . . . . .
$_________ to $_________  . . . . . . . . .
$_________ to $_________  . . . . . . . . .
$_________ and over . . . . . . . . . . . .
     Total  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      $                           100.00%

</TABLE>


                                MAXIMUM RATES

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                        Percent of
                                                                                            Pool
                Maximum Rates                       Number                               by Cut-Off
                                                      of           Cut-Off Date             Date
                                                   Mortgage          Principal            Principal
                                                    Loans             Balance              Balance
<S>                                                <C>          <C>                      <C>

_____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      $                             %
_____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

     Total  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      $                           100.00%

</TABLE>

                  MONTHS REMAINING TO SCHEDULED MATURITY(1)


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                         Percent of
               Range of Months                                                              Pool
       Remaining to Scheduled Maturity              Number                               by Cut-Off
                                                      of           Cut-Off Date             Date
                                                   Mortgage          Principal            Principal
                                                    Loans             Balance              Balance
<S>                                               <C>           <C>                      <C>

___ to ___  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      $                             %
___ to ___  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
___ to ___  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
___ to ___  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
___ to ___  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
___ to ___  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
___ to ___  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
___ to ___  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
___ to ___  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
___ to ___  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
     Total  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      $                           100.00%

</TABLE>


(1) Assumes  that the  Draw  Period for  Mortgage Loans  with five  year Draw
    Periods will be extended for an additional five years.

                               ORIGINATION YEAR


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                         Percent of
                                                                                            Pool
               Origination Year                     Number                               by Cut-Off
                                                      of           Cut-Off Date             Date
                                                   Mortgage          Principal            Principal
                                                    Loans             Balance              Balance
<S>                                               <C>           <C>                      <C>

____  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      $                             %
____  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

     Total  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      $                           100.00%

</TABLE>


                              DELINQUENCY STATUS


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                         Percent of
                                                                                            Pool
          Number of Days Delinquent                 Number                               by Cut-Off
                                                      of           Cut-Off Date             Date
                                                   Mortgage          Principal            Principal
                                                    Loans             Balance              Balance
<S>                                                <C>             <C>                   <C>

0 to 29 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      $                             %
30 to 59  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
60 to 89  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

     Total  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      $                           100.00%

</TABLE>

   
(CONVEYANCE OF SUBSEQUENT MORTGAGE LOANS

    The  Agreement  permits  the  Trust  Fund  to  purchase  from  Provident,
subsequent to the date hereof and prior to _______, 19__, Subsequent Mortgage
Loans  in  an amount  not  to  exceed  approximately $________  in  aggregate
principal balance  for inclusion in the Trust Fund.  Each Subsequent Mortgage
Loan  will have been originated or  purchased by Provident in accordance with
the  underwriting guidelines  set forth  above  under "The  Home Equity  Loan
Program--Credit and  Underwriting Guidelines."  Accordingly,  the statistical
characteristics of the Mortgage Pool set forth above are based exclusively on
the  Initial  Mortgage  Loans  and the  statistical  characteristics  of  the
Mortgage  Pool  after giving  effect  to  the acquisition  of  any Subsequent
Mortgage Loans will likely differ from the information  specified herein.    
The  date on  which  Provident transfers  a Subsequent Mortgage Loan to the 
Trust Fund shall be referred to herein as the "Subsequent Transfer Date".

    In  any  event,  each conveyance  of  Subsequent Mortgage  Loans  will be
subject  to,  among  other  things,  the  following  conditions:    (i)  such
Subsequent Mortgage Loans must (a) satisfy the eligibility criteria set forth
in  the Prospectus  under "The  Loan  Program--Representations by  Provident;
Repurchases" and  (b) comply with each representation and  warranty as to the
Mortgage Loans set forth in the Agreement; (ii) such Subsequent Mortgage Loan
must  not have been  selected by  Provident in a  manner that  it believes is
adverse  to  the  interests of  the  Certificateholders,  (iii) no Subsequent
Mortgage Loan  may be ___  or more  days contractually delinquent  as of  the
applicable  Cut-Off  Date;  (iv)  no  Subsequent Mortgage  Loan  may  have  a
remaining term to maturity in excess of ___ years; (v) no Subsequent Mortgage
Loan may have a Mortgage Rate less than ____%; (vi) following the purchase of
such Subsequent Mortgage Loans by the Trust Fund, the Mortgage Loans (a) will
have a weighted  average Mortgage  Rate of at  least ____%; (b)  will have  a
weighted  average Combined  Loan-to-Value Ratio of  not more  than ____%; (c)
will not have  a weighted average remaining  term to stated maturity  of more
than ____ months;  and (d) will,  in each case,  have a principal balance  in
excess of $_______  as of the Cut-Off Date; (vii)  Provident (and the Trustee
shall not have been notified  by either Rating Agency that the  conveyance of
such Subsequent Mortgage  Loans will result in  a qualification, modification
or withdrawal of its then-current rating of any class of Certificates) (shall
have  notified each  Rating  Agency of  such  conveyance as  required by  the
Agreement); and (viii)  the Trustee shall have  received certain opinions  of
counsel as  to, among other  things, the enforceability  and validity of  the
transfer agreements relating  to such conveyance of such  Subsequent Mortgage
Loans.)
    

                    MATURITY AND PREPAYMENT CONSIDERATIONS

    The  Agreement, except as  otherwise described herein,  provides that the
Certificateholders  will be  entitled to  receive on  each Distribution  Date
distributions  of principal, in  the amounts described  under "Description of
the  Certificates--Distributions  on  the  Certificates"  herein,  until  the
Certificate  Principal Balance  is  reduced  to  zero.   During  the  Managed
Amortization  Period, Certificateholders will  receive amounts from Principal
Collections based upon their Fixed Allocation Percentage subject to reduction
as described below.  During the Rapid Amortization Period, Certificateholders
will receive amounts from Principal Collections based solely upon their Fixed
Allocation Percentage.  Because prior  distributions of Principal Collections
to  Certificateholders  serve  to  reduce the  Investor  Floating  Allocation
Percentage but do not change  their Fixed Allocation Percentage,  allocations
of Principal Collections  based on the Fixed Allocation Percentage may result
in distributions of principal to the  Certificateholders in amounts that are,
in most  cases, greater  relative to  the declining  balance of  the Mortgage
Loans than would be  the case if the Investor  Floating Allocation Percentage
were used to determine the percentage of Principal Collections distributed to
Certificateholders.   This is  especially true during  the Rapid Amortization
Period when the Certificateholders are entitled to receive Investor Principal
Collections  and  not  a  lesser  amount.   In  addition,  Investor  Interest
Collections  may   be  distributed  as  principal  to  Certificateholders  in
connection  with the  Accelerated  Principal  Distribution  Amount,  if  any.
Moreover,  to  the extent  of  losses  allocable to  the  Certificateholders,
Certificateholders may  also receive  as payment of  principal the  amount of
such losses either  from Investor Interest Collections or, in some instances,
draws under the Policy.  The level of losses may therefore affect the rate of
payment of principal on the Certificates.

    To  the extent  obligors make  more  draws than  principal payments,  the
Transferor  Interest may grow.  Because  during the Rapid Amortization Period
the Certificateholders share of Principal Collections is based upon its Fixed
Allocation  Percentage (without  reduction),  an increase  in  the Transferor
Interest  due  to  additional  draws may  also  result  in Certificateholders
receiving principal at a greater rate.  The Agreement permits the Transferor,
at  its  option,  but subject  to  the  satisfaction  of  certain  conditions
specified in  the  Agreement, including  the conditions  described below,  to
remove certain Mortgage Loans from the Trust Fund at any time during the life
of the Trust Fund, so long as the Transferor Interest (after giving effect to
such  removal)  is not  less  than the  Minimum  Transferor  Interest.   Such
removals   may  affect  the  rate  at   which  principal  is  distributed  to
Certificateholders by reducing the  overall Pool Balance and thus  the amount
of Principal  Collections.   See "Description  of the  Certificates--Optional
Retransfers of Mortgage Loans to the Transferor" herein.

    All of  the Mortgage Loans may be prepaid in full or in part at any time.
The prepayment experience with  respect to the Mortgage Loans will affect the
weighted average life of the Certificates.

    The  rate  of prepayment  on  the  Mortgage  Loans  cannot be  predicted.
Provident is not aware of any publicly available studies or statistics on the
rate of prepayment of such Mortgage Loans.  Generally,  home equity revolving
credit   lines  are  not   viewed  by   borrowers  as   permanent  financing.
Accordingly, the Mortgage  Loans may experience a  higher rate of  prepayment
than traditional  first  mortgage loans.    On the  other hand,  because  the
Mortgage Loans  amortize  as described  under  "Description of  the  Mortgage
Loans--Mortgage Loan  Terms"  herein,  rates  of  principal  payment  on  the
Mortgage  Loans will  generally be  slower than  those of  traditional fully-
amortizing first  mortgages in the  absence of  prepayments on such  Mortgage
Loans.   The  prepayment experience  of the  Trust Fund  with respect  to the
Mortgage  Loans may  be  affected by  a wide  variety  of factors,  including
general   economic   conditions,  prevailing   interest   rate   levels,  the
availability of alternative financing, homeowner mobility, the  frequency and
amount  of  any future  draws  on  the  Credit  Line Agreements  and  changes
affecting the  deductibility  for Federal  income  tax purposes  of  interest
payments  on home equity  credit lines.   Substantially  all of  the Mortgage
Loans contain  "due-on-sale" provisions,  and, with  respect to  the Mortgage
Loans, the  Master Servicer intends  to enforce such provisions,  unless such
enforcement is  not permitted by applicable law.   The enforcement of a "due-
on-sale" provision will have the  same effect as a prepayment of  the related
Mortgage Loan.  See "Certain Legal Aspects of The Loans--Due-on-Sale Clauses"
in the Prospectus.

    The yield to an investor who purchases the Certificates in  the secondary
market at a price other than par will vary from the anticipated yield if  the
rate of prepayment on the Mortgage Loans is  actually different than the rate
anticipated by such investor at the time such Certificates were purchased.

    Collections on  the Mortgage Loans may  vary because, among other things,
borrowers may make payments  during any month as  low as the minimum  monthly
payment for such month or as high as the entire outstanding principal balance
plus accrued interest and the fees and charges thereon.   It is possible that
borrowers may fail  to make scheduled payments.  Collections  on the Mortgage
Loans may vary due to seasonal purchasing and payment habits of borrowers.

    No assurance  can be given  as to the  level of prepayments that  will be
experienced  by the  Trust Fund  and it  can  be expected  that a  portion of
borrowers will  not prepay  their Mortgage Loans  to any  significant degree.
See "Yield and Prepayment Considerations" in the Prospectus.


                     POOL FACTOR AND TRADING INFORMATION


    The "Pool  Factor" is  a seven-digit  decimal which  the Master  Servicer
will  compute monthly  expressing the  Certificate Principal  Balance of  the
Certificates  as  of each  Distribution  Date  (after  giving effect  to  any
distribution of principal  on such Distribution Date) as  a proportion of the
Original Certificate Principal Balance.  On the Closing Date, the Pool Factor
will  be 1.0000000.   See "Description of  the Certificates--Distributions on
the  Certificates"  herein.   Thereafter,  the Pool  Factor  will decline  to
reflect  reductions in  the related  Certificate Principal  Balance resulting
from  distributions of principal to the  Certificates and the Invested Amount
of any unreimbursed Liquidation Loss Amounts.

    Pursuant  to  the  Agreement,  monthly  reports concerning  the  Invested
Amount, the  Pool Factor and various other items  of information will be made
available  to the Certificateholders.  In addition,  within 60 days after the
end of each calendar year, beginning with the 199_ calendar year, information
for tax reporting purposes will be made available to each person who has been
a Certificateholder of record at any time during the preceding calendar year.
See "Description of the Certificates--Book-Entry Certificates" and "--Reports
to Certificateholders" herein.


                       DESCRIPTION OF THE CERTIFICATES

    The Certificates will be issued pursuant  to the Agreement.  The form  of
the Agreement  has been filed as an exhibit  to the Registration Statement of
which this Prospectus Supplement and the Prospectus is a part.  The following
is  a  description of  the material  provisions of  the Agreement.   Wherever
particular sections or defined terms of  the Agreement are referred to,  such
sections or defined terms are hereby incorporated herein by reference.

GENERAL

    The Certificates will be issued in denominations  of $1,000 and multiples
of $1 in excess  thereof and will evidence  specified undivided interests  in
the Trust  Fund.  The  property of  the Trust  Fund will consist  of, to  the
extent  provided in the Agreement:  (i) each  of the Mortgage Loans that from
time to time  are subject to the Agreement; (ii)  collections on the Mortgage
Loans received after  the Cut-Off Date  (exclusive of payments in  respect of
accrued  interest due  on  or  prior to  the  Cut-Off  Date; (iii)  Mortgaged
Properties relating to the Mortgage Loans that are acquired by foreclosure or
deed in  lieu of foreclosure;  (iv) the Collection  Account and  the Security
Account  for  the Certificates  (excluding  net  earnings thereon);  (v)  the
Policy; and  (vi) the  Spread Account  (for  the benefit  of the  Certificate
Insurer  and the  Certificateholders).   Definitive Certificates  (as defined
below),  if issued, will  be transferable  and exchangeable at  the corporate
trust  office of  the Trustee,  which  will initially  maintain the  Security
Register for  the Certificates.   See "--Book-Entry Certificates"  below.  No
service charge will be made  for any registration of exchange or  transfer of
Certificates,  but the  Trustee may require  payment of  a sum  sufficient to
cover any tax or other governmental charge.

   
    The aggregate  undivided interest in  the Trust Fund  represented by  the
Certificates as of the Closing Date will equal $               (the "Original
Invested  Amount"), which  represents __% of  the Cut-Off  Date Pool Balance.
The "Original Certificate Principal Balance"  will equal $                  .
Following  the  Closing Date,  the  "Invested  Amount"  with respect  to  any
Distribution  Date will be  an amount equal  to the Original  Invested Amount
minus (i) the amount of Investor Principal Collections previously distributed
to Certificateholders,  and minus (ii) an amount equal  to the product of the
Investor  Floating Allocation  Percentage  and the  Liquidation Loss  Amounts
(each as defined herein  under "--Distributions on  the Certificates").   The
principal amount  of the outstanding Certificates (the "Certificate Principal
Balance")  on  any Distribution  Date is  equal  to the  Original Certificate
Principal Balance  minus  the aggregate  of amounts  actually distributed  as
principal   to  the   Certificateholders.   See   "--Distributions   on   the
Certificates"  below.   Each  Certificate  represents  the right  to  receive
payments of interest  at the  Certificate Rate and  payments of principal  as
described below.
    

    The Transferor will own the remaining  undivided interest in the Mortgage
Loans  (the "Transferor Interest"),  which is equal to  the Pool Balance less
the Invested Amount.  The Transferor Interest will initially equal $        ,
which represents _% of the Cut-Off  Date Pool Balance.  The Transferor as  of
any date is the  owner of the Transferor Interest which initially will be the
Transferor.  In general, the  Pool Balance will vary each day as principal is
paid on  the  Mortgage Loans,  liquidation  losses are  incurred,  Additional
Balances are  drawn down by borrowers  and Mortgage Loans are  transferred to
the Trust Fund.

    The Transferor  has the right to  sell or pledge the  Transferor Interest
at  any time, provided (i)  the Rating Agencies  have notified the Transferor
and the Trustee in writing that such action will not result in  the reduction
or  withdrawal of the ratings assigned to  the Certificates, and (ii) certain
other conditions specified in the Agreement are satisfied.

   
    The Certificates will not be listed on any securities exchange.
    

BOOK-ENTRY CERTIFICATES

    The  Certificates  will  be  book-entry  Certificates   (the  "Book-Entry
Certificates").   Persons  acquiring  beneficial ownership  interests in  the
Certificates  ("Certificate Owners")  may  elect to  hold their  Certificates
through the Depository Trust Company  ("DTC") in the United States, or  CEDEL
or  Euroclear  (in  Europe) if  they  are  participants of  such  systems, or
indirectly through organizations which are participants in such systems.  The
Book-Entry Certificates  will be  issued in  one or  more certificates  which
equal the aggregate principal balance  of the Certificates and will initially
be registered  in the name  of Cede  & Co., the  nominee of  DTC.  CEDEL  and
Euroclear will hold omnibus positions on behalf of their participants through
customers' securities accounts in CEDEL's  and Euroclear's names on the books
of their  respective depositaries which  in turn will hold  such positions in
customers' securities  accounts in  the depositaries' names  on the  books of
DTC.  Citibank  will act  as  depositary  for CEDEL  and  Chase  will act  as
depositary  for Euroclear  (in  such capacities,  individually  the "Relevant
Depositary"  and collectively  the "European  Depositaries").   Investors may
hold  such beneficial  interests in  the  Book-Entry Certificates  in minimum
denominations representing  Certificate Principal  Balances of $1,000  and in
multiples of  $1 in  excess thereof.   Except as  described below,  no person
acquiring a  Book-Entry  Certificate (each,  a  "beneficial owner")  will  be
entitled to receive  a physical certificate representing  such Certificate (a
"Definitive Certificate").  Unless  and until Definitive Certificates  are 
issued, it is anticipated that the only "Certificateholder" of the 
Certificates will be Cede & Co., as nominee of DTC.  Certificate Owners will
not be Certificateholders as that term is used in the Agreement.  
Certificate Owners are  only  permitted  to  exercise   their  rights  
indirectly through the participating  organizations  that  utilize the  
services  of  DTC, including securities  brokers  and dealers,  banks  and  
trust companies  and  clearing corporations and certain other organizations
("Participants") and DTC.

    The  beneficial owner's  ownership of  a Book-Entry  Certificate will  be
recorded on  the records of  the brokerage firm, bank,  thrift institution or
other  financial   intermediary  (each,  a  "Financial   Intermediary")  that
maintains  the beneficial  owner's account  for such purpose.   In  turn, the
Financial Intermediary's  ownership of  such Book-Entry  Certificate will  be
recorded on the records of DTC (or of a participating firm that acts as agent
for the Financial Intermediary,  whose interest will  in turn be recorded  on
the records of DTC, if the beneficial owner's Financial Intermediary is not a
DTC participant and on the records of CEDEL or Euroclear, as appropriate).

    Certificate  Owners will receive  all distributions of  principal of, and
interest  on,  the   Certificates  from  the  Trustee  through  DTC  and  DTC
participants.   While  the  Certificates are  outstanding  (except under  the
circumstances described  below), under the rules,  regulations and procedures
creating  and affecting DTC and its operations (the "Rules"), DTC is required
to make book-entry transfers among Participants on whose  behalf it acts with
respect  to  the  Certificates  and  is  required  to  receive  and  transmit
distributions   of  principal   of,  and   interest  on,   the  Certificates.
Participants and organizations which have  indirect access to the DTC system,
such as  banks, brokers,  dealers and trust  companies that clear  through or
maintain  a custodial  relationship with  a  Participant, either  directly or
indirectly  ("Indirect  Participants")  with  whom  Certificate  Owners  have
accounts with respect to  Certificates are similarly  required to make  book-
entry  transfers and  receive and  transmit such  distributions on  behalf of
their  respective  Certificate  Owners.   Accordingly,  although  Certificate
Owners will not  possess certificates, the Rules provide a mechanism by which
Certificate Owners  will receive distributions and  will be able  to transfer
their interest.

    Certificate   Owners  will  not   receive  or  be   entitled  to  receive
certificates  representing their  respective interests  in  the Certificates,
except  under the limited  circumstances described  below.  Unless  and until
Definitive  Certificates  are   issued,  Certificate   Owners  who  are   not
Participants may transfer ownership of Certificates only through Participants
and  Indirect  Participants by  instructing  such  Participants and  Indirect
Participants to  transfer Certificates, by  book-entry transfer, through  DTC
for  the account  of the  purchasers of  such Certificates, which  account is
maintained  with their  respective  Participants.   Under  the  Rules and  in
accordance  with   DTC's  normal  procedures,   transfers  of   ownership  of
Certificates will  be executed through DTC and the accounts of the respective
Participants  at  DTC   will  be  debited  and  credited.     Similarly,  the
Participants  and Indirect Participants  will make debits  or credits, as the
case  may be,  on  their records  on  behalf of  the  selling and  purchasing
Certificate Owners.

    Because  of time  zone  differences, credits  of  securities received  in
CEDEL, or Euroclear  as a result of a transaction with  a Participant will be
made  during,  subsequent  securities  settlement  processing  and dated  the
business  day  following, the  DTC  settlement date.    Such  credits or  any
transactions in  such  securities, settled  during  such processing  will  be
reported to  the relevant Euroclear  or, CEDEL Participants on  such business
day.  Cash received in CEDEL or Euroclear as, a result of sales of securities
by  or  through  a  CEDEL  Participant  (as  defined,  below)  or   Euroclear
Participant  (as defined below) to  a DTC Participant  will be, received with
value on the DTC settlement date but will be available in the, relevant CEDEL
or  Euroclear cash account only as of  the business day following, settlement
in  DTC.   For  information  with respect  to  tax documentation  procedures,
relating to  the Certificates, see "Federal  Income Tax Consequences--Foreign
Investors"  and  "--Backup  Withholding"  herein  and  "Global,    Clearance,
Settlement And  Tax Documentation Procedures--Certain U.S. Federal Income Tax
Documentation Requirements" in Annex I hereto.

    Transfers between Participants will  occur in accordance with  DTC rules.
Transfers between CEDEL Participants and Euroclear Participants will occur in
accordance with their respective rules and operating procedures.

    Cross-market  transfers between  persons holding  directly or  indirectly
through DTC,  on  the one  hand,  and directly  or  indirectly through  CEDEL
Participants or Euroclear Participants, on the other, will be effected in DTC
in accordance with DTC rules on behalf of the relevant European international
clearing  system  by  the  Relevant Depositary;  however,  such  cross market
transactions will require  delivery of instructions to the  relevant European
international  clearing  system  by  the   counterparty  in  such  system  in
accordance with its rules and procedures and within its established deadlines
(European time).   The relevant European international clearing  system will,
if the transaction meets its  settlement requirements, deliver  instructions 
to the Relevant Depositary to take action to effect final settlement on its 
behalf by delivering or receiving securities in DTC, and making or receiving
payment in accordance with normal procedures for same day funds settlement
applicable to DTC.    CEDEL Participants  and  Euroclear  Participants may
not  deliver instructions directly to the European Depositaries.

    DTC  which  is  a  New  York-chartered  limited  purpose  trust  company,
performs  services  for  its  participants,  some  of   which  (and/or  their
representatives) own  DTC. In accordance with  its normal procedures,  DTC is
expected to record the  positions held by each  DTC participant in the  Book-
Entry Certificates,  whether held  for its own  account or  as a  nominee for
another  person.  In general, beneficial ownership of Book-Entry Certificates
will be subject  to the rules, regulations  and procedures governing DTC  and
DTC participants as in effect from time to time.

    CEDEL is  incorporated under  the laws  of Luxembourg  as a  professional
depository.  CEDEL  holds  securities  for  its  participating  organizations
("CEDEL  Participants")  and  facilitates  the  clearance  and  settlement of
securities transactions between CEDEL  Participants through electronic  book-
entry changes in accounts of CEDEL Participants, thereby eliminating the need
for physical movement  of certificates.  Transactions may be settled in CEDEL
in any of 28 currencies, including  United States dollars.  CEDEL provides to
its  CEDEL  Participants,  among  other  things,  services  for  safekeeping,
administration, clearance and settlement of internationally traded securities
and securities lending and borrowing.  CEDEL interfaces with domestic markets
in several  countries.   As a  professional depository,  CEDEL is  subject to
regulation by  the  Luxembourg Monetary  Institute.   CEDEL participants  are
recognized financial  institutions around the world,  including underwriters,
securities brokers and dealers, banks, trust companies, clearing corporations
and certain other organizations.  Indirect access to CEDEL is also  available
to others, such  as banks, brokers,  dealers and  trust companies that  clear
through or maintain a custodial relationship with a CEDEL Participant, either
directly or indirectly.

    Euroclear was  created in  1968 to  hold securities  for participants  of
Euroclear ("Euroclear  Participants") and  to clear  and settle  transactions
between Euroclear  Participants  through simultaneous  electronic  book-entry
delivery against payment, thereby eliminating  the need for physical movement
of  certificates  and  any  risk  from  lack  of  simultaneous  transfers  of
securities  and  cash.    Transactions  may  now  be  settled  in  any  of 32
currencies, including  United States  dollars.   Euroclear  includes  various
other services,  including securities  lending and  borrowing and  interfaces
with   domestic  markets  in  several  countries  generally  similar  to  the
arrangements for cross-market transfers with  DTC described above.  Euroclear
is operated by the Brussels, Belgium  office of Morgan Guaranty Trust Company
of New  York  (the  "Euroclear  Operator"),  under  contract  with  Euroclear
Clearance   Systems    S.C.,   a   Belgian   cooperative   corporation   (the
"Cooperative").  All operations are conducted by the Euroclear Operator,  and
all Euroclear securities  clearance accounts and Euroclear cash  accounts are
accounts with the Euroclear  Operator, not the Cooperative.   The Cooperative
establishes  policy  for  Euroclear  on  behalf  of  Euroclear  Participants.
Euroclear Participants  include banks (including  central banks),  securities
brokers and dealers and other professional financial intermediaries. Indirect
access to  Euroclear is also available  to other firms that  clear through or
maintain  a  custodial relationship  with  a  Euroclear  Participant,  either
directly or indirectly.

    The  Euroclear Operator  is  the Belgian  branch of  a  New York  banking
corporation  which is a member bank of  the Federal Reserve System.  As such,
it is regulated and examined by the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve
System and  the New York  State Banking  Department, as well  as the  Belgian
Banking Commission.

    Securities clearance  accounts  and  cash  accounts  with  the  Euroclear
Operator are governed  by the Terms and Conditions Governing Use of Euroclear
and the related  Operating Procedures of the Euroclear  System and applicable
Belgian law  (collectively,  the "Terms  and  Conditions").   The  Terms  and
Conditions  govern  transfers  of  securities   and  cash  within  Euroclear,
withdrawals  of securities and cash from  Euroclear, and receipts of payments
with respect  to securities in  Euroclear.   All securities in  Euroclear are
held  on a  fungible basis  without attribution  of specific  certificates to
specific  securities clearance accounts.   The Euroclear  Operator acts under
the Terms and Conditions only on behalf of Euroclear Participants, and has no
record   of  or   relationship   with  persons   holding   through  Euroclear
Participants.

    Distributions  on  the  Book-Entry Certificates  will  be  made  on  each
Distribution  Date by  the  Trustee to  DTC.   DTC  will  be responsible  for
crediting the amount of such  payments to the accounts of the  applicable DTC
participants  in  accordance   with  DTC's  normal  procedures.     Each  DTC
participant  will  be  responsible  for  disbursing  such   payments  to  the
beneficial owners  of the Book-Entry Certificates  that it represents  and to
each Financial Intermediary for which it  acts as agent.   Each such 
Financial  Intermediary will be responsible  for disbursing  funds to  the 
beneficial  owners of  the Book-Entry Certificates that it represents.

    Under  a   book-entry  format,  beneficial   owners  of   the  Book-Entry
Certificates  may experience some  delay in their  receipt of payments, since
such payments will be  forwarded by the Trustee to Cede & Co., as nominee for
DTC ("Cede").   Distributions with respect to Certificates held through CEDEL
or Euroclear  will be credited to the cash  accounts of CEDEL Participants or
Euroclear  Participants in accordance  with the  relevant system's  rules and
procedures,  to  the extent  received  by  the  Relevant  Depositary.    Such
distributions will  be subject to  tax reporting in accordance  with relevant
United  States   tax  laws  and   regulations.    See   "Federal  Income  Tax
Consequences--Foreign  Investors" and "--Backup Withholding" herein.  Because
DTC can  only act  on behalf  of Financial Intermediaries,  the ability  of a
beneficial  owner to pledge  Book-Entry Certificates  to persons  or entities
that do not participate in  the Depository system, or otherwise take  actions
in respect of such Book-Entry Certificates, may be limited due to the lack of
physical  certificates  for  such  Book-Entry  Certificates.    In  addition,
issuance  of the  Book-Entry Certificates in  book-entry form  may reduce the
liquidity  of  such  Certificates  in  the  secondary  market  since  certain
potential investors may be unwilling  to purchase Certificates for which they
cannot obtain physical certificates.

    Monthly  and annual  reports  on the  Trust Fund  provided by  the Master
Servicer to  Cede, as nominee  of DTC,  may be made  available to  beneficial
owners upon request, in accordance with the rules, regulations and procedures
creating and affecting the Depository, and to the Financial Intermediaries to
whose DTC accounts the Book-Entry Certificates  of such beneficial owners are
credited.

    DTC has  advised the Transferor  and the Trustee  that, unless  and until
Definitive Certificates are issued, DTC will take any action permitted  to be
taken by the holders of the  Book-Entry Certificates under the Agreement only
at  the direction  of  one  or more  Financial  Intermediaries to  whose  DTC
accounts  the Book-Entry Certificates  are credited, to  the extent that such
actions  are  taken  on  behalf of  Financial  Intermediaries  whose holdings
include such Book-Entry  Certificates.  CEDEL or  the Euroclear Operator,  as
the case  may be,  will take  any other  action permitted  to be  taken by  a
Certificateholder  under the  Agreement on behalf  of a  CEDEL Participant or
Euroclear  Participant  only  in  accordance  with  its  relevant  rules  and
procedures and subject  to the ability of  the Relevant Depositary to  effect
such  actions on  its behalf  through  DTC.   DTC may  take  actions, at  the
direction  of the  related Participants,  with  respect to  some Certificates
which conflict with actions taken with respect to other Certificates.

   
    Definitive  Certificates will be issued to beneficial owners of the Book-
Entry Certificates, or their nominees, rather than to DTC, only if (a) DTC or
the Transferor advises the Trustee in writing that DTC is no  longer willing,
qualified or  able to discharge properly its  responsibilities as nominee and
depository with  respect to the Book-Entry Certificates and the Transferor or
the Trustee is unable to locate a qualified successor, (b) the Transferor, at
its sole  option, elects to terminate a book-entry  system through DTC or (c)
after the occurrence  of an Event of Servicing Termination (as defined herein
under  "--Events   of  Servicing  Termination"),   beneficial  owners  having
Percentage Interests  aggregating  not  less  than  51%  of  the  Certificate
Principal Balance of  the Book-Entry Certificates advise the  Trustee and DTC
through the Financial Intermediaries and the DTC participants in writing that
the continuation of a book-entry system  through DTC (or a successor thereto)
is no longer in the best interests of beneficial owners.
    

    Upon the occurrence  of any of  the events described  in the  immediately
preceding paragraph,  the Trustee will  be required to  notify all beneficial
owners of the occurrence  of such event and  the availability through DTC  of
Definitive Certificates.   Upon surrender by DTC of the global certificate or
certificates representing  the Book-Entry  Certificates and  instructions for
re-registration,  the  Trustee   will  issue  Definitive  Certificates,   and
thereafter  the  Trustee  will  recognize  the  holders  of  such  Definitive
Certificates as Certificateholders under the Agreement.

    Although  DTC,  CEDEL  and   Euroclear  have  agreed  to   the  foregoing
procedures   in  order   to  facilitate   transfers  of   Certificates  among
participants of DTC,  CEDEL and  Euroclear, they are  under no obligation  to
perform  or continue to  perform such procedures  and such procedures  may be
discontinued at any time.

ASSIGNMENT OF MORTGAGE LOANS

    At  the time of issuance of the  Certificates, Provident will transfer to
the Trust  Fund all of its right, title and  interest in and to each Mortgage
Loan  (including any  Additional  Balances arising  in  the future),  related
Credit Line Agreements, mortgages  and other related documents (collectively,
the "Related Documents"), including all collections received on or with respect
to each such Mortgage Loan after the Cut-Off Date  (exclusive of payments in 
respect of accrued interest due on or prior to the Cut-Off Date.   The Trustee,
concurrently with  such transfer, will deliver the Certificates to Provident 
and the Transferor Certificate (as defined in the Agreement) to the 
Transferor.   Each Mortgage Loan transferred to  the  Trust Fund  will be  
identified on  a  schedule (the  "Mortgage Loan Schedule") delivered to the 
Trustee pursuant to the Agreement.  Such schedule will include information  
as to the  Cut-Off Date  Principal Balance of  each Mortgage Loan, as well 
as information with respect to the Loan Rate.  

    Within 90 days of the Closing Date, the  Trustee will review the Mortgage
Loans and the Related Documents and if any  Mortgage Loan or Related Document
is found to be defective in any material respect and such defect is not cured
within  90 days following  notification thereof to  Provident by the Trustee,
the Transferor will be obligated to accept the transfer of such Mortgage Loan
from  the Trust  Fund.   Upon such  transfer, the  Principal Balance  of such
Mortgage  Loan will  be deducted  from the  Pool Balance,  thus  reducing the
amount  of  the Transferor  Interest.    If  the deduction  would  cause  the
Transferor Interest  to become less than  the Minimum Transferor  Interest at
such time  (a "Transfer Deficiency"),  Provident will be obligated  to either
substitute an Eligible  Substitute Mortgage Loan  or make a deposit  into the
Collection Account in the amount (the "Transfer Deposit Amount") equal to the
amount by  which the Transferor  Interest would be  reduced to less  than the
Minimum Transferor Interest at such  time.  Any such deduction,  substitution
or deposit, will be considered a payment  in full of such Mortgage Loan.  Any
Transfer  Deposit  Amount   will  be  treated  as  a   Principal  Collection.
Notwithstanding the foregoing, however, prior to all required deposits to the
Collection Account being made  no such transfer shall  be considered to  have
occurred  unless  such  deposit is  actually  made.   The  obligation  of the
Transferor to  accept a transfer  of a  Defective Mortgage Loan  is the  sole
remedy regarding  any defects  in the  Mortgage Loans  and Related  Documents
available to the Trustee or the Certificateholders.  

    An "Eligible Substitute Mortgage Loan" is a mortgage  loan substituted by
Provident  for a  Defective Mortgage  Loan which  must, on  the date  of such
substitution, (i) have an outstanding Principal Balance (or  in the case of a
substitution of more than one Mortgage Loan for a Defective Mortgage Loan, an
aggregate  Principal  Balance),  not  __%  more  or  less  than  the Transfer
Deficiency relating to such  Defective Mortgage Loan; (ii)  have a Loan  Rate
not less than the Loan Rate of  the Defective Mortgage Loan and not more than
_% in excess of the  Loan Rate of such Defective Mortgage Loan;  (iii) have a
Loan Rate based on the same Index with adjustments  to such Loan Rate made on
the  same Interest  Rate Adjustment Date  as that  of the  Defective Mortgage
Loan; (iv)  have a Margin that is  not less than the  Margin of the Defective
Mortgage Loan and  not more than ___ basis points higher  than the Margin for
the  Defective Mortgage Loan; (v) have a mortgage of the same or higher level
of priority  as the mortgage  relating to  the Defective Mortgage  Loan; (vi)
have a remaining  term to maturity not  more than ___ months earlier  and not
more  than  __  months later  than  the  remaining term  to  maturity  of the
Defective Mortgage Loan;  (vii) comply with each representation  and warranty
as  to the Mortgage Loans set forth in the Agreement (deemed to be made as of
the date of substitution); (viii) in general, have an original Combined Loan-
to-Value Ratio not greater than that of the Defective Mortgage Loan; and (ix)
satisfy certain  other conditions specified in the  Agreement.  To the extent
the Principal  Balance of an Eligible  Substitute Mortgage Loan is  less than
the  Principal Balance  of the  related Defective  Mortgage  Loan and  to the
extent  that  the Transferor  Interest  would  be reduced  below  the Minimum
Transferor Interest, the Transferor will be required to make a deposit to the
Collection Account equal to such difference.

    Provident will  make  certain representations  and warranties  as to  the
accuracy in all  material respects  of certain information  furnished to  the
Trustee  with respect  to each  Mortgage Loan  (e.g., Cut-Off  Date Principal
Balance  and the  Loan Rate).    In addition,  Provident  will represent  and
warrant on  the Closing  Date that  at  the time  of transfer  to the  Trust,
Provident has transferred or assigned  all of its rights, title and  interest
in each Mortgage Loan and the Related Documents, free of any lien (subject to
certain exceptions).   Upon discovery of a breach  of any such representation
and warranty  which materially  and adversely  affects the  interests of  the
Certificateholders  or the Certificate  Insurer in the  related Mortgage Loan
and  Related Documents,  Provident  will  have  a period  of  90  days  after
discovery or notice of the breach to effect a cure.  If the  breach cannot be
cured within the 90-day period, the Transferor will be obligated to  accept a
transfer  of  the Defective  Mortgage Loan  from the  Trust  Fund.   The same
procedure  and  limitations  that  are  set forth  in  the  second  preceding
paragraph  for the  transfer of  Defective Mortgage Loans  will apply  to the
transfer  of a Mortgage  Loan that is  required to be  transferred because of
such breach of a  representation or warranty in the Agreement that materially
and adversely affects the interests of the Certificateholders.  

    Mortgage Loans  required to be  transferred to Provident as  described in
the preceding paragraphs are referred to as "Defective Mortgage Loans."

    Pursuant  to   the  Agreement,  the  Master  Servicer  will  service  and
administer the Mortgage Loans as more fully set forth above.

AMENDMENTS TO CREDIT LINE AGREEMENTS

    Subject to applicable  law, the Master Servicer  may change the terms  of
the  Credit Line Agreements at any time provided that such changes (i) do not
adversely affect  the interest of  the Certificateholders or  the Certificate
Insurer, and (ii) are consistent with prudent business practice. In addition,
the  Agreement  permits  the  Master  Servicer,  within  certain  limitations
described therein, to increase the Credit Limit of the  related Mortgage Loan
or reduce the Margin for such Mortgage Loan.

OPTIONAL TRANSFERS OF MORTGAGE LOANS TO THE TRANSFEROR

   
    In  order to  permit the  Transferor  to remove  Mortgage Loans  from the
Trust Fund at  such times, if any,  as the overcollateralization exceeds  the
level  required  to  maintain  the  ratings  on  the   Certificates,  on  any
Distribution Date  the Transferor may, but shall  not be obligated to, remove
on such Distribution Date (the "Transfer  Date") from the Trust Fund, certain
Mortgage Loans without notice to  the Certificateholders.  The Transferor  is
permitted to designate  the Mortgage Loans to be removed.   Mortgage Loans so
designated  will  only   be  removed  upon  satisfaction   of  the  following
conditions:   (i)  the  Rapid Amortization Period  shall not have  commenced;
(ii) the Transferor Interest as of such Transfer Date (after giving effect to
such removal)  exceeds the Minimum Transferor Interest; (iii) the transfer of
any  Mortgage Loans  on any  Transfer  Date during  the Managed  Amortization
Period shall  not, in the reasonable belief of  the Transferor, cause a Rapid
Amortization Event to occur or an event which with notice or lapse of time or
both would constitute  a Rapid Amortization Event; (iv)  the Transferor shall
have delivered to the Trustee a "Mortgage Loan Schedule" containing a list of
all Mortgage Loans  remaining in the Trust  Fund after such removal;  (v) the
Transferor shall represent and warrant that no selection procedures which the
Transferor  reasonably  believes   are  adverse  to  the  interests   of  the
Certificateholders or the Certificate Insurer were used by the  Transferor in
selecting  such  Mortgage  Loans;  (vi) in  connection  with  the  first such
retransfer of Mortgage Loans, the Rating Agencies shall have been notified of
the proposed transfer and prior to  the Transfer Date shall not have notified
the Transferor in writing that  such transfer would result in a  reduction or
withdrawal of the  ratings assigned to the Certificates without regard to the
Policy; and  (vii) the Transferor shall have delivered to the Trustee and the
Certificate Insurer  an officer's  certificate confirming the  conditions set
forth in clauses (i) through (vi) above.  
    

    As of any date of determination, the  "Minimum Transferor Interest" is an
amount equal to the lesser of (a) _% of the Pool Balance on such date and (b)
the Transferor Interest as of the Closing Date.

PAYMENTS ON MORTGAGE LOANS; DEPOSITS TO COLLECTION ACCOUNT

   
    The  Trustee  shall  establish  and maintain  on  behalf  of  the  Master
Servicer  an  account  (the  "Collection Account")  for  the  benefit  of the
Certificateholders and the Transferor,  as their interests  may appear.   The
Collection Account will  be an Eligible Account (as  defined below).  Subject
to the investment provision described in the following paragraphs, within two
days of receipt by the  Master Servicer of amounts in respect of the Mortgage
Loans (excluding amounts  representing administrative  charges, annual  fees,
taxes,  assessments,  credit insurance  charges,  insurance  proceeds  to  be
applied  to the  restoration or  repair of  a  Mortgaged Property  or similar
items),  the  Master Servicer  will deposit  such  amounts in  the Collection
Account.   Amounts so deposited may  be invested in Eligible  Investments (as
described below) maturing no later than one Business Day prior to the date on
which  the amount  on deposit  therein  is required  to be  deposited  in the
Collection Account or  on such  Distribution Date if  approved by the  Rating
Agencies and the Certificate Insurer.   Not later than the third Business Day
prior  to  each Distribution  Date  (the  "Determination  Date"), the  Master
Servicer will notify the Trustee of the amount of such deposit to be included
in funds available for the related Distribution Date.
    

    An  "Eligible Account"  is  (i) an  account  that  is maintained  with  a
depository  institution whose  debt obligations  at the  time of  any deposit
therein have the highest short-term debt  rating by the Rating Agencies, (ii)
one or more accounts with a depository institution having a minimum long-term
unsecured debt rating of "____" by _______ and  "____" by ___, which accounts
are fully insured by  either the Savings Association Insurance  Fund ("SAIF")
or the Bank Insurance Fund ("BIF") of the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation
established by  such fund, (iii)  a segregated trust  account maintained with
the Trustee or  an Affiliate of the Trustee in its fiduciary capacity or (iv)
otherwise acceptable  to each  Rating Agency and  the Certificate  Insurer as
evidenced by a letter from each Rating Agency  and the Certificate Insurer to
the Trustee, without reduction or withdrawal of their then current ratings of
the Certificates.

   
    "Eligible Investments" are specified in the Agreement and are limited  to
(i) direct  obligations  of, or  obligations fully  guaranteed  as to  timely
payment of  principal and interest  by, the  United States or  any agency  or
instrumentality thereof, provided that such obligations are backed by the full
faith and credit of the United States; (ii) repurchase agreements  on 
obligations  specified in  clause (i)  maturing not  more than three  months 
from the date of  acquisition thereof, provided that the short-term unsecured 
debt obligations of the party agreeing to  repurchase such obligations are at
the time rated by each Rating Agency  in its  highest  short-term rating  
category;  (iii) certificates  of deposit,  time deposits  and bankers'  
acceptances  (which, if  Moody's is  a Rating Agency, shall each have an 
original maturity of  not more than 90 days and, in the case of bankers' 
acceptances, shall in no  event have an original maturity of more  than 
365 days) of any U.S.  depository institution or trust company incorporated
under the laws of the United States or any state thereof and subject to 
supervision and examination  by federal and/or  state banking authorities,
provided that the unsecured short term debt obligations of such depository
institution or trust company at the date of acquisition thereof  have been 
rated by each of the Rating Agencies in its highest unsecured short-term 
debt rating  category;  (iv) commercial  paper (having  original maturities
of not  more than  90 days) of  any corporation incorporated under the laws
of the United States or any state  thereof which on the  date of acquisition
has been rated  by the Rating Agencies  in their highest  short-term  rating
categories;  (v)  short  term  investment  funds ("STIFS") sponsored by any 
trust company or bank incorporated  under the laws of the United States  or
any state thereof which  on the date of  acquisition has  been rated  by the
Rating Agencies in  their respective  highest rating category of long term 
unsecured debt; (vi) interests in any money market fund which at the date of 
acquisition of the interests in such fund and throughout the time as  the 
interest is held  in such fund  has the rating specified  by each  Rating 
Agency;  and  (vii)  other obligations  or  securities that  are acceptable
to each Rating Agency as an Eligible Investment hereunder and will not 
result in a reduction in the then current rating of the Certificates,  as 
evidenced by a letter to such effect from such Rating Agency and with respect
to which  the  Master  Servicer  has  received  confirmation  that,  for  tax
purposes, the investment  complies with the last  clause of this  definition;
provided that no instrument described hereunder shall evidence
either the right to receive (a) only interest with respect to the obligations
underlying  such  instrument or  (b)  both  principal and  interest  payments
derived from  obligations  underlying such  instrument and  the interest  and
principal  payments with  respect  to such  instrument  provided a  yield  to
maturity  at par greater  than 120% of  the yield to  maturity at  par of the
underlying obligations; and provided,  further, that no instrument  described
hereunder may be purchased  at a price greater  than par if such instrument 
may be prepaid or called at a price less than its purchase price prior to its
stated maturity.
    

ALLOCATIONS AND COLLECTIONS

    All collections  on the  Mortgage Loans  will generally  be allocated  in
accordance with  the  Credit Line  Agreements  between amounts  collected  in
respect of interest and amounts collected in respect of principal.  As to any
Distribution  Date,  "Interest Collections"  will  be  equal to  the  amounts
collected during the related Collection Period, including such portion of Net
Liquidation  Proceeds  allocated to  interest pursuant  to  the terms  of the
Credit Line Agreements less Servicing Fees for the related Collection Period.

    As to  any Distribution  Date, "Principal Collections"  will be equal  to
the sum of  (i) the amounts  collected during the related  Collection Period,
including  such portion of  Net Liquidation  Proceeds allocated  to principal
pursuant to  the terms of  the Credit Line  Agreements and (ii)  any Transfer
Deposit Amounts.  "Net Liquidation Proceeds" with respect to  a Mortgage Loan
are equal to  the Liquidation Proceeds, reduced by related  expenses, but not
including  the portion,  if any,  of such amount  that exceeds  the Principal
Balance of the Mortgage Loan plus  accrued and unpaid interest thereon to the
end  of  the  Collection Period  during  which  such Mortgage  Loan  became a
Liquidated Mortgage Loan.  "Liquidation Proceeds" are the proceeds (excluding
any amounts drawn on the Policy) received  in connection with the liquidation
of any  Mortgage Loan, whether  through trustee's  sale, foreclosure sale  or
otherwise.

    With   respect  to  any  Distribution   Date,  the  portion  of  Interest
Collections  allocable to the  Certificates ("Investor Interest Collections")
will equal the product of (a) Interest Collections for such Distribution Date
and (b)  the Investor Floating  Allocation Percentage.   With respect to  any
Distribution Date, the "Investor Floating Allocation Percentage" is the 
percentage equivalent of a fraction determined by dividing the Invested 
Amount  at the close of  business on the preceding  Distribution Date (or the 
Closing Date in the case of  the first Distribution Date) by the Pool  
Balance at  the  beginning  of  the related  Collection  Period.    The
remaining amount of Interest Collections will be  allocated to the Transferor
Interest.

    Principal Collections  will be  allocated between the  Certificateholders
and  the  Transferor   ("Investor  Principal  Collections"  and   "Transferor
Principal Collections", respectively) as described herein.

    The Trustee  will deposit any  amounts drawn  under the  Policy into  the
Collection Account.

    With respect  to  any date,  the  "Pool Balance"  will  be equal  to  the
aggregate of  the Principal Balances of  all Mortgage Loans as  of such date.
The Principal  Balance of a Mortgage  Loan (other than  a Liquidated Mortgage
Loan) on any day is equal to the Cut-Off Date Principal Balance thereof, plus
(i) any Additional Balances in  respect of such Mortgage Loan minus  (ii) all
collections credited against the Principal  Balance of such Mortgage Loan  in
accordance  with the related  Credit Line Agreement  prior to such  day.  The
Principal  Balance of  a  Liquidated Mortgage  Loan after  final  recovery of
related Liquidation Proceeds shall be zero.

DISTRIBUTIONS ON THE CERTIFICATES

    Beginning  with   the  first  Distribution  Date  (which  will  occur  on
__________,  199_), distributions  on the  Certificates will  be made  by the
Trustee or the Paying Agent on each Distribution Date to the persons in whose
names such Certificates are  registered at the close  of business on the  day
prior to  each Distribution Date or, if the  Certificates are no longer Book-
Entry Certificates, at  the close of business  on the last  day of the  month
preceding such Distribution Date (the "Record Date").  The term "Distribution
Date"  means the  (fifteenth) day  of each  month or,  if such  day is  not a
Business Day, then the next  succeeding Business Day.  Distributions  will be
made   by  check  or   money  order  mailed   (or  upon  the   request  of  a
Certificateholder  owning Certificates  having  denominations aggregating  at
least $_________, by wire transfer or otherwise) to the address of the person
entitled thereto (which, in the case of Book-Entry  Certificates, will be DTC
or its  nominee)  as  it  appears  on the  Certificate  Register  in  amounts
calculated as described herein on the Determination Date.  However, the final
distribution  in  respect  of  the  Certificates  will  be  made   only  upon
presentation and surrender thereof at the office or the agency of the Trustee
specified  in the notice  to Certificateholders  of such  final distribution.
For purposes of the  Agreement, a "Business Day" is any day  other than (i) a
Saturday or Sunday or  (ii) a day on which banking  institutions in the State
of California are required or authorized by law to be closed.

    Application  of Interest  Collections.   On each  Distribution Date,  the
Trustee or the Paying Agent  will apply the Investor Interest Collections  in
the following manner and order of priority:

        (i)   as payment  to the Trustee  for its  fee for services  rendered
    pursuant to the Agreement;

        (ii)  as payment for the premium for the Policy;

        (iii)   as  payment  for the  accrued interest  due  and any  overdue
    accrued interest (with interest  thereon to the extent  permitted by law)
    on the Certificate Principal Balance of the Certificates;

        (iv)   to pay  Certificateholders the  Investor Loss Amount  for such
    Distribution Date;

        (v)   as  payment  for  any  Investor  Loss  Amount  for  a  previous
    Distribution  Date  that  was  not  previously  (a)  funded  by  Investor
    Interest Collections,  (b) absorbed by the  Overcollateralization Amount,
    (c) funded by amounts on deposit  in the Spread Account or (d)  funded by
    draws on the Policy;

        (vi)   to reimburse prior draws  made from the  Policy (with interest
    thereon);

        (vii)   to  pay  principal on  the  Certificates until  the  Invested
    Amount  exceeds   the  Certificate  Principal  Balance  by  the  Required
    Overcollateralization  Amount  (such  amount  so  paid, the  "Accelerated
    Principal Distribution Amount");

        (viii)  any other amounts required to be deposited  in an account for
    the  benefit of  the Certificate  Insurer and  the Certificateholders  or
    owed to the Certificate Insurer pursuant to the Insurance Agreement;

        (ix)  certain amounts  that may be required to be paid to  the Master
    Servicer pursuant to the Agreement; and

        (x)  to the Transferor to the extent permitted as described herein.
 
    Payments to  Certificateholders pursuant to clause (iii) will be interest
payments on  the Certificates.   Payments  to Certificateholders  pursuant to
clauses (iv),  (v) and (vii) will  be principal payments on  the Certificates
and  will  therefore  reduce  the  Certificate  Principal  Balance,  however,
payments pursuant to clause (vii)  will not reduce the Invested Amount.   The
Accelerated Principal Distribution Amount is not guaranteed by the Policy.

    To the extent that  Investor Interest Collections are applied to  pay the
interest  on   the  Certificates,  Investor   Interest  Collections  may   be
insufficient to cover  Investor Loss Amounts.  If  such insufficiency results
in  the Certificate Principal  Balance exceeding the  Invested Amount, a draw
will be made on the Policy in accordance with the terms of the Policy.

    The "Required Overcollateralization Amount" shall be  an amount set forth
in  the Agreement.   "Liquidation  Loss  Amount" means  with  respect to  any
Liquidated Mortgage  Loan, the  unrecovered Principal Balance  thereof during
the  Collection  Period in  which  such  Mortgage  Loan became  a  Liquidated
Mortgage Loan,  after  giving  effect  to the  Net  Liquidation  Proceeds  in
connection therewith.  The "Investor Loss Amount" shall be the product of the
Investor Floating Allocation  Percentage and the Liquidation  Loss Amount for
such Distribution Date.

    A "Liquidated  Mortgage Loan"  means, as  to any  Distribution Date,  any
Mortgage Loan in  respect of which the Master  Servicer has determined, based
on the  servicing procedures specified in the Agreement, as of the end of the
preceding Collection Period that all Liquidation Proceeds which it expects to
recover with  respect to  the disposition of  the related  Mortgaged Property
have  been recovered.   The  Investor Loss  Amount will  be allocated  to the
Certificateholders.

    As to any  Distribution Date other than the first  Distribution Date, the
"Collection Period" is  the calendar month preceding  each Distribution Date.
As  to the first  Distribution Date,  the "Collection  Period" is  the period
beginning  after  the   Cut-Off  Date   and  ending  on   the  last  day   of
_______________ 199_.

    Interest   will  be  distributed   on  each  Distribution   Date  at  the
Certificate Rate for  the related Interest  Period (as defined  below).   The
"Certificate Rate"  for a Distribution Date  will generally equal the  sum of
((a) LIBOR,  calculated as specified below,  as of the  second LIBOR Business
Day prior to the immediately preceding Distribution Date  (or as of two LIBOR
Business  Days  prior  to  the  Closing  Date,  in  the  case  of  the  first
Distribution Date) plus (b) ____% per annum.)  Notwithstanding the foregoing,
in no event will the amount of interest required to be distributed in respect
of  the Certificates  on any  Distribution Date  exceed a  rate equal  to the
weighted  average of the Loan Rates  (net of the Servicing  Fee Rate, the fee
payable  to the  Trustee and the  rate at  which the  premium payable  to the
Certificate Insurer is calculated) weighted on the basis of the daily balance
of  each  Mortgage  Loan  during  the  related  billing  cycle  prior to  the
Collection Period relating to such Distribution Date.

    Interest on  the Certificates in  respect of  any Distribution  Date will
accrue on the  Certificate Principal Balance from  the preceding Distribution
Date (or in  the case of  the first Distribution Date,  from the date  of the
initial issuance of  the Certificates (the  "Closing Date")) through  the day
preceding such  Distribution Date (each such period, an "Interest Period") on
the basis of the  actual number of days in the Interest  Period and a 360-day
year.  Interest  payments on the  Certificates will  be funded from  Investor
Interest Collections and, if necessary, from draws on the Policy.

    (Calculation of the  LIBOR Rate.  On each Distribution  Date, LIBOR shall
be established by the Trustee and as to any Interest Period, LIBOR will equal
the rate for United States dollar deposits for one month which appears on the
Telerate Screen  Page 3750 as of 11:00 A.M., London time, on the second LIBOR
Business  Day prior  to the  first day  of such  Interest Period.   "Telerate
Screen Page  3750" means the display designated as  page 3750 on the Telerate
Service (or such  other page as may replace page 3750 on that service for the
purpose  of displaying London  interbank offered rates  of major banks).   If
such rate does not appear on such page (or such other page as may replace 
that page on that service,  or if such service is no  longer offered, such  
other service  for  displaying  LIBOR or  comparable  rates  as may  be
selected by  Provident after consultation with the Trustee), the rate will be
the Reference Bank Rate.  The "Reference Bank Rate" will be determined on the
basis  of the  rates at  which deposits in  U.S. Dollars  are offered  by the
reference banks  (which  shall  be three  major  banks that  are  engaged  in
transactions  in the  London interbank  market, selected  by Provident  after
consultation with the Trustee) as of 11:00 A.M., London time, on the day that
is  two LIBOR Business Days  prior to the  immediately preceding Distribution
Date to  prime banks in the London interbank market for a period of one month
in  amounts approximately equal  to the principal  amount of the Certificates
then  outstanding.  The Trustee  will request the  principal London office of
each of the reference banks to provide a quotation of  its rate.  If at least
two such quotations are provided, the rate will be the arithmetic mean of the
quotations.   If  on such  date fewer  than  two quotations  are provided  as
requested, the rate will be the arithmetic mean of the rates quoted by one or
more major banks in New York  City, selected by Provident after  consultation
with the Trustee,  as of 11:00  A.M., New  York City time,  on such date  for
loans in U.S. Dollars to leading European banks for  a period of one month in
amounts approximately equal to the principal amount of  the Certificates then
outstanding.  If no such quotations  can be obtained, the rate will  be LIBOR
for the  prior Distribution Date.   "LIBOR Business Day" means  any day other
than (i) a  Saturday or a Sunday or (ii) a  day on which banking institutions
in the State  of New York or in  the city of London, England  are required or
authorized by law to be closed.)

    Transferor  Collections.     Collections  allocable   to  the  Transferor
Interest that are  not distributed to Certificateholders  will be distributed
to the Transferor only to  the extent that such distribution will  not reduce
the amount  of the Transferor  Interest as  of the related  Distribution Date
below  the Minimum  Transferor  Interest.   Amounts  not distributed  to  the
Transferor because  of such  limitations will be  retained in  the Collection
Account  until  the  Transferor   Interest  exceeds  the  Minimum  Transferor
Interest, at which time such excess shall be released  to the Transferor.  If
any such  amounts  are still  retained  in the  Collection Account  upon  the
commencement  of the Rapid Amortization Period, such  amounts will be paid to
the Certificateholders as a reduction of the Certificate Principal Balance.

    Overcollateralization.    The distribution  of the  aggregate Accelerated
Principal Distribution  Amount, if any,  to Certificateholders may  result in
the  Invested Amount being  greater than  the Certificate  Principal Balance,
thereby creating overcollateralization.  The Overcollateralization Amount, if
any, will be available to absorb any Investor Loss Amount that is not covered
by Investor Interest Collections.

   
    Distributions of Principal Collections.  For the  period beginning on the
first  Distribution Date  and, unless a  Rapid Amortization  Event shall have
earlier occurred, ending on the Distribution Date in ______________ 20__ (the
"Managed Amortization  Period"), the amount of  Principal Collections payable
to  Certificateholders  as  of  each  Distribution  Date during  the  Managed
Amortization Period will equal,  to the extent funds are  available therefor,
the Scheduled Principal Collections Distribution Amount for such Distribution
Date.  On any Distribution  Date during the Managed Amortization  Period, the
"Scheduled Principal Collections Distribution Amount" shall equal  the lesser
of  (i)  the Maximum  Principal  Payment  (as  defined  below) and  (ii)  the
Alternative  Principal  Payment (as  defined  below).   With  respect  to any
Distribution Date, the "Maximum Principal Payment" will equal the  product of
the Investor Fixed  Allocation Percentage and Principal  Collections for such
Distribution Date.   With respect to any Distribution  Date, the "Alternative
Principal Payment" will  equal the greater  of (x)  0___% of the  Certificate
Principal Balance immediately  prior to  such Distribution Date  and (y)  the
amount,  but  not   less  than  zero,  of  Principal   Collections  for  such
Distribution  Date less the  aggregate of Additional  Balances created during
the related Collection Period.
    

    Beginning  with  the first  Distribution Date  following  the end  of the
Managed Amortization Period,  the amount of Principal  Collections payable to
Certificateholders  on each Distribution  Date will  be equal to  the Maximum
Principal Payment.

    The   amount   of   Principal   Collections   to   be    distributed   to
Certificateholders  on  the first  Distribution  Date will  reflect Principal
Collections and Additional Balances during  the first Collection Period which
is  the period  beginning after  the  Cut-Off Date  through the  last day  of
__________ 199_.

    Distributions  of  Principal Collections  based  upon the  Investor Fixed
Allocation  Percentage   may  result   in  distributions   of  principal   to
Certificateholders in amounts that are greater relative to the declining Pool
Balance than would be the case if the Investor Floating Allocation Percentage
were used to determine the percentage of Principal Collections distributed in
respect  of  the  Invested  Amount.  Principal Collections not allocated to 
the Certificateholders will  be allocated to the Transferor  Interest.  The 
aggregate  distributions  of principal  to  the Certificateholders  will   
not  exceed  the  Original  Certificate  Principal Balance.

    In addition, to the extent of  funds available therefor (including  funds
available under the  Policy), on the Distribution Date  in ____________ 20__,
Certificateholders will be entitled to  receive as a payment of  principal an
amount equal to the outstanding Certificate Principal Balance.

    The Paying  Agent.   The Paying  Agent  shall initially  be the  Trustee,
together with any successor  thereto in such  capacity (the "Paying  Agent").
The Paying  Agent shall have the  revocable power to withdraw  funds from the
Collection   Account  for  the   purpose  of  making   distributions  to  the
Certificateholders.

RAPID AMORTIZATION EVENTS

    As  described  above,  the  Managed  Amortization  Period  will  continue
through the Distribution Date in           20  , unless  a Rapid Amortization
Event occurs prior to such date in which case the Rapid Amortization Period  
will commence prior to such date.  "Rapid Amortization Event" refers to any 
of the following events:

        (a)  failure on the  part of the Transferor (i)  to make a payment  or
    deposit required  under the Agreement  within three  Business Days  after
    the date  such payment  or deposit  is required  to  be made  or (ii)  to
    observe  or  perform in  any  material  respect  any  other covenants  or
    agreements of  the Transferor set forth  in the Agreement,  which failure
    continues unremedied for a period of 60 days after written notice;

        (b)  any  representation or  warranty made  by  the Transferor  in the
    Agreement  proves to  have been  incorrect in  any material  respect when
    made and continues to be incorrect  in any material respect for a  period
    of 60  days after written notice  and as a result  of which the interests
    of  the  Certificateholders   are  materially  and   adversely  affected;
    provided, however,  that a Rapid  Amortization Event shall not  be deemed
    to occur if the Transferor has  purchased or made a substitution for  the
    related Mortgage Loan or Mortgage Loans  if applicable during such period
    (or within an  additional 60  days with the  consent of  the Trustee)  in
    accordance with the provisions of the Agreement;

        (c)  the  occurrence of  certain events  of bankruptcy,  insolvency or
    receivership relating to the Transferor; or

        (d)  the Trust  Fund becomes  subject to regulation by  the Securities
    and Exchange  Commission as an  investment company within the  meaning of
    the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended.

    In  the  case of  any  event  described in  clause  (a) or  (b),  a Rapid
Amortization  Event will  be  deemed  to have  occurred  only if,  after  the
applicable  grace  period,  if any,  described  in such  clauses,  either the
Trustee or  Certificateholders holding Certificates evidencing  more than 51%
of the Percentage Interests or  the Certificate Insurer (so long as  there is
no default by the Certificate  Insurer in the performance of its  obligations
under the Policy),  by written  notice to Provident  and the Master  Servicer
(and to the Trustee, if given by the Certificateholders) declare that a Rapid
Amortization Event  has occurred as of the date of  such notice.  In the case
of any event described in clause (c) or  (d), a Rapid Amortization Event will
be deemed to have occurred without any  notice or other action on the part of
the Trustee or the Certificateholders immediately upon the occurrence of such
event.

    In addition to  the consequences of a  Rapid Amortization Event discussed
above, if the Transferor voluntarily files a bankruptcy petition or goes into
liquidation  or any person  is appointed a receiver  or bankruptcy trustee of
the Transferor,  on the  day of  any such  filing or  appointment no  further
Additional Balances will  be transferred  to the Trust  Fund, the  Transferor
will immediately cease to transfer Additional Balances  to the Trust Fund and
the Transferor will promptly give notice to the Trustee of any such filing or
appointment.   Within  15 days,  the  Trustee will  publish a  notice  of the
liquidation or the filing or appointment stating that  the Trustee intends to
sell, dispose of or  otherwise liquidate the Mortgage Loans in a commercially
reasonable  manner  and  to  the  best  of  its  ability.    Unless otherwise
instructed  within  a  specified period  by  Certificateholders  representing
undivided interests  aggregating  more than  51% of  the aggregate  principal
amount of the  Certificates, the Trustee  will sell, dispose of  or otherwise
liquidate  the Mortgage  Loans in  a  commercially reasonable  manner and  on
commercially reasonable terms.  Any proceeds will be treated as collections 
allocable to the Certificateholders and  the  Investor  Fixed Allocation  
Percentage of such remaining proceeds and  will be distributed to the  
Certificateholders on the date  such proceeds are received (the  "Dissolution
Distribution Date").  (If the portion  of such  proceeds allocable  to the  
Certificateholders are  not sufficient to pay in full  the remaining amount 
due on the  Certificates, the Policy will cover such shortfall.)

    Notwithstanding the foregoing, if a conservator, receiver or  trustee-in-
bankruptcy  is appointed for the  Transferor and no  Rapid Amortization Event
exists  other than such  conservatorship, receivership  or insolvency  of the
Transferor, the  conservator, receiver or trustee-in-bankruptcy  may have the
power to  prevent the commencement  of the Rapid  Amortization Period or  the
sale of Mortgage Loans described above.

THE POLICY

   
    (On  or  before  the Closing  Date,  the  Policy will  be  issued  by the
Certificate  Insurer pursuant  to  the provisions  of the  Agreement  and the
Insurance  and Indemnity Agreement (the "Insurance Agreement") to be dated as
of ____________,  199_, among  Provident, (the Trustee)  and the  Certificate
Insurer.

    The  Policy  will irrevocably  and  unconditionally guarantee  payment on
each   Distribution   Date  to   the   Trustee   for  the   benefit   of  the
Certificateholders  the  full  and  complete payment  of  (i)  the Guaranteed
Principal  Distribution  Amount  (as  defined  below)  with  respect  to  the
Certificates for such Distribution Date  and (ii) accrued and unpaid interest
due on the Certificates (together, the "Guaranteed Distributions"), with such
Guaranteed  Distributions  having been  calculated  in  accordance  with  the
original terms of the Certificates or  the Agreement except for amendments or
modifications  to which the  Certificate Insurer has  given its prior written
consent.  The  effect of the  Policy is  to guarantee the  timely payment  of
interest on, and the  ultimate payment of the principal amount of, all of the
Certificates.
    

    The "Guaranteed  Principal Distribution Amount"  shall be the  amount, if
any, by which  the Certificate Principal Balance (after  giving effect to all
other amounts distributable  and allocable to principal on  the Certificates)
exceeds the Invested Amount as of such Distribution Date (after giving effect
to  all  other  amounts  distributable  and allocable  to  principal  on  the
Certificates for  such  Distribution Date).   In  addition,  the Policy  will
guarantee the payment of the outstanding Certificate Principal Balance on the
Distribution Date in  ______________ 20__ (after giving  effect to all  other
amounts distributable and allocable to principal on such Distribution Date).

    In  accordance  with  the Agreement,  the  Trustee  will  be  required to
establish  and maintain an account (the "Spread  Account") for the benefit of
the  Certificate  Insurer and  the  Certificateholders.   The  Trustee  shall
deposit the amounts into the Spread Account as required by the Agreement.

    Payment of claims on the Policy  will be made by the Certificate  Insurer
following Receipt by the  Certificate Insurer of  the appropriate notice  for
payment on the later to  occur of (i) 12:00 noon, New York  City time, on the
second Business  Day following Receipt  of such notice  for payment  and (ii)
12:00 noon, New York City time, on the relevant Distribution Date.

    If payment of  any amount guaranteed by the Certificate  Insurer pursuant
to the Policy is avoided as a preference payment under applicable bankruptcy,
insolvency, receivership  or similar  law, the Certificate  Insurer will  pay
such amount out of the funds  of the Certificate Insurer on the later  of (a)
the date when due to be  paid pursuant to the Order referred to below  or (b)
the first to occur  of (i) the fourth Business  Day following Receipt by  the
Certificate  Insurer from the  Trustee of (A)  a certified copy  of the order
(the  "Order")  of the  court  or  other  governmental body  which  exercised
jurisdiction  to the effect that the  Certificateholder is required to return
the amount of  any Guaranteed Distributions  distributed with respect to  the
Certificates during the term of the related Policy because such distributions
were avoidable  preference payments  under applicable bankruptcy  law, (B)  a
certificate of the  Certificateholder that the Order has been  entered and is
not subject to any stay and (C) an  assignment duly executed and delivered by
the  Certificateholder, in  such  form  as  is  reasonably  required  by  the
Certificate Insurer and provided to  the Certificateholder by the Certificate
Insurer, irrevocably  assigning  to the  Certificate Insurer  all rights  and
claims of the Certificateholder relating to or arising under the Certificates
against  the debtor  which  made such  preference payment  or  otherwise with
respect  to such  preference payment,  or  (ii) the  date of  Receipt by  the
Certificate Insurer from the Trustee of the items referred to in clauses (A),
(B)  and (C)  above if, at  least four  Business Days  prior to such  date of
Receipt, the Certificate Insurer shall have Received written notice from the 
Trustee that such items  were to be delivered on such date  and such date was
specified in  such notice.  Such payment shall  be disbursed to the receiver,
conservator, debtor-in-possession or trustee in bankruptcy named in the Order
and  not  to  the  Trustee  or  any  Certificateholder  directly  (unless   a
Certificateholder  has   previously  paid  such   amount  to  the   receiver,
conservator, debtor-in-possession or trustee in bankruptcy named in the Order
in which case such payment shall be disbursed to the Trustee for distribution
to such Certificateholder upon proof of such  payment reasonably satisfactory
to the Certificate Insurer).

    The terms  "Receipt" and  "Received", with  respect to  the Policy,  mean
actual delivery  to the Certificate Insurer and to its fiscal agent appointed
by  the Certificate Insurer at  its option, if any,  prior to 12:00 noon, New
York City time, on  a Business Day;  delivery either on a  day that is not  a
Business Day or after  12:00 noon, New York City time, shall  be deemed to be
Receipt on  the next succeeding Business  Day.  If any  notice or certificate
given under  the  Policy by  the Trustee  is not  in  proper form  or is  not
properly completed, executed or delivered it shall be deemed not to have been
Received, and the Certificate  Insurer or the fiscal agent shall  promptly so
advise the Trustee and the Trustee may submit an amended notice.

    Under  the Policy, "Business Day" means any day other than (i) a Saturday
or  Sunday or (ii)  a day on  which banking institutions  in The City  of New
York, New York  are authorized or obligated  by law or executive order  to be
closed.

    The  Certificate Insurer's  obligations under  the  Policy in  respect of
Guaranteed  Distributions  shall  be  discharged  to  the  extent  funds  are
transferred  to the Trustee  as provided in  the Policy, whether  or not such
funds are properly applied by the Trustee.

    The  Certificate  Insurer shall  be  subrogated  to the  rights  of  each
Certificateholder  to  receive  payments   of  principal  and  interest,   as
applicable, with respect  to distributions on the Certificates  to the extent
of  any payment by the  Certificate Insurer under the Policy.   To the extent
the Certificate  Insurer makes  Guaranteed Distributions, either  directly or
indirectly (as by paying through the Trustee), to the Certificateholders, the
Certificate   Insurer   will   be   subrogated   to   the   rights   of   the
Certificateholders,   as  applicable,   with   respect  to   such  Guaranteed
Distributions, shall be deemed  to the extent of the payments so made to be a
registered  Certificateholder for purposes  of payment and  shall receive all
future Guaranteed Distributions  until all  such Guaranteed Distributions  by
the  Certificate  Insurer  have  been fully  reimbursed,  provided  that  the
Certificateholders  have   received  the   full  amount  of   the  Guaranteed
Distributions.

    The terms of  the Policy cannot be  modified, altered or affected  by any
other agreement or instrument, or by the merger, consolidation or dissolution
of the Transferor. The Policy  by its terms may not be cancelled  or revoked.
The Policy is governed by the laws of the State of ________.

    The Policy  is not  covered by  the Property/Casualty Insurance  Security
fund specified in  Article 76 of the New  York Insurance Law.  The  Policy is
not covered by the Florida  Insurance Guaranty Association created under Part
II  of  Chapter  631 of  the  Florida  Insurance  Code.    In the  event  the
Certificate Insurer were to  become insolvent, any  claims arising under  the
Policy  are  excluded from  coverage  by  the  California Insurance  Guaranty
Association, established  pursuant to Article 14.2 of Chapter  1 of part 2 of
Division 1 of the California Insurance Code.

    Pursuant to  the terms  of the  Agreement, unless  a Certificate  Insurer
default exists,  the Certificate Insurer shall be deemed  to be the Holder of
the Certificates for certain purposes (other than with respect  to payment on
the  Certificates),  will   be  entitled  to  exercise  all   rights  of  the
Certificateholders  thereunder, without the  consent of such  Holders and the
Holders  of the Certificates  may exercise  such rights  only with  the prior
written consent  of the Certificate  Insurer.   In addition, the  Certificate
Insurer will have certain additional rights as third party beneficiary to the
Agreement.

    In the  absence  of payments  under the  Policy, Certificateholders  will
bear directly  the credit  and other  risks associated  with their  undivided
interest in the Trust Fund.)

   
(PRE-FUNDING ACCOUNT

    On the  Closing  Date, $___________  (the  "Pre-Funded Amount")  will  be
deposited in an account  (the "Pre-Funding Account"), which account  shall be
in the name of and maintained by the Trustee and shall be part of the 

Trust Fund and will be used to acquire Subsequent Mortgage Loans.  During the
period  beginning on the Closing Date  and terminating on _____________, 19__
(the "Funding Period"),  the Pre-Funded Amount will be reduced  by the amount
thereof used  to purchase  Subsequent Mortgage Loans  in accordance  with the
Agreement.  Any Pre-Funded Amount remaining at the  end of the Funding Period
will be  distributed to holders  of the  classes of Certificates  entitled to
receive principal  on  the  Distribution  Date  in  ______________,  19__  in
reduction of the related Certificate Principal  Balances (thus resulting in a
partial principal prepayment of the related Certificates on such date). 

    Amounts  on  deposit in  the  Pre-Funding  Account will  be  invested  in
Permitted Investments.   All interest  and any  other investment earnings  on
amounts  on  deposit in  the  Pre-Funding Account  will  be deposited  in the
Capitalized Interest Account.

CAPITALIZED INTEREST ACCOUNT

    On  the  Closing  Date  there  will  be  deposited  in  an  account  (the
"Capitalized  Interest  Account") maintained  with  and in  the  name  of the
Trustee on behalf of the Trust Fund a portion of  the proceeds of the sale of
the Certificates.  The amount  deposited therein will be used by  the Trustee
on  the Distribution Dates in __________________ 19__, _____________ 19__ and
______________, 19__ to cover shortfalls in interest on the Certificates that
may  arise as a result of the utilization  of the Pre-Funding Account for the
purchase by  the Trust Fund  of Subsequent  Mortgage Loans after  the Closing
Date.   Any amounts remaining in the Capitalized  Interest Account at the end
of the  Funding  Period which  are  not needed  to  cover shortfalls  on  the
Distribution Date  in ___________ 19__  are required  to be paid  directly to
Provident.)
    

REPORTS TO CERTIFICATEHOLDERS

    Concurrently  with  each  distribution  to  the  Certificateholders,  the
Master  Servicer   will  forward   to  the  Trustee   for  mailing   to  such
Certificateholder a statement setting forth among other items:

        (i)   the Investor Floating  Allocation Percentage  for the preceding
    Collection Period;

        (ii)  the amount being distributed to Certificateholders;

        (iii)   the amount of interest included in  such distribution and the
    related Certificate Rate;

        (iv)  the  amount, if any,  of overdue  accrued interest included  in
    such distribution (and the amount of interest thereon);

        (v)   the amount, if  any, of the  remaining overdue accrued interest
    after giving effect to such distribution;

        (vi)     the  amount,   if  any,  of   principal  included   in  such
    distribution;

        (vii)    the  amount,  if  any,  of  the  reimbursement  of  previous
    Liquidation Loss Amounts included in such distribution;

        (viii)     the  amount,  if   any,  of   the  aggregate  unreimbursed
    Liquidation Loss Amounts after giving effect to such distribution;

        (ix)  the Servicing Fee for such Distribution Date;

        (x)  the Invested Amount and the Certificate  Principal Balance, each
    after giving effect to such distribution;

        (xi)   the Pool Balance  as of  the end  of the preceding  Collection
    Period;

        (xii)  the number  and aggregate Principal Balances  of the  Mortgage
    Loans as to  which the minimum  monthly payment is  delinquent for  30-59
    days,  60-89 days and 90 or more days, respectively, as of the end of the
    preceding Collection Period;

        (xiii)  the book value  of any real estate which  is acquired by  the
    Trust  Fund through foreclosure or grant  of deed in lieu of foreclosure;
    and

        (xiv)  the amount of any draws on the Policy.

    In  the case of  information furnished pursuant  to clauses  (iii), (iv),
(v), (vi), (vii) and (viii) above, the amounts shall be expressed as a dollar
amount per Certificate with a $1,000 denomination.

    Within 60 days after  the end of each  calendar year commencing in  1996,
the Master  Servicer will be required  to forward to the  Trustee a statement
containing the  information  set  forth  in  clauses  (iii)  and  (vi)  above
aggregated for such calendar year.  

COLLECTION AND OTHER SERVICING PROCEDURES ON MORTGAGE LOANS

    The Master Servicer will make reasonable  efforts to collect all payments
called for under the Mortgage Loans and  will, consistent with the Agreement,
follow  such collection  procedures as  it  follows from  time  to time  with
respect to the home equity loans in its servicing portfolio comparable to the
Mortgage Loans.  Consistent  with the above, the  Master Servicer may in  its
discretion waive any  late payment charge or  any assumption or other  fee or
charge that may be collected in the ordinary course of servicing the Mortgage
Loans.  

    With respect to the Mortgage Loans, the Master Servicer  may arrange with
a  borrower a  schedule for  the payment  of interest  due and  unpaid  for a
period, provided  that any  such arrangement  is consistent  with the  Master
Servicer's policies with respect to the home equity mortgage loans it owns or
services.  In accordance with the terms of the Agreement, the Master Servicer
may consent under certain circumstances to the placing of a subsequent senior
lien in respect of a Mortgage Loan.

HAZARD INSURANCE

    The Agreement provides that  the Master Servicer maintain  certain hazard
insurance on the Mortgaged Properties relating to the  Mortgage Loans.  While
the  terms of the related Credit  Line Agreements generally require borrowers
to  maintain certain hazard insurance,  the Master Servicer  will not monitor
the maintenance of such insurance.

    The Agreement requires the Master Servicer  to maintain for any Mortgaged
Property relating to a Mortgage Loan acquired upon  foreclosure of a Mortgage
Loan, or by deed in lieu  of such foreclosure, hazard insurance with extended
coverage in an  amount equal to the lesser of (a) the maximum insurable value
of such Mortgaged  Property or (b) the  outstanding balance of such  Mortgage
Loan  plus  the outstanding  balance  on  any mortgage  loan  senior to  such
Mortgage Loan at the time of foreclosure or deed in lieu of foreclosure, plus
accrued interest and the Master Servicer's good faith estimate of the related
liquidation  expenses to be incurred in  connection therewith.  The Agreement
provides that the Master Servicer may satisfy its obligation  to cause hazard
policies to  be maintained by  maintaining a blanket policy  insuring against
losses on  such Mortgaged  Properties.   If  such blanket  policy contains  a
deductible  clause, the Master  Servicer will be obligated  to deposit in the
Collection  Account the sums which would have  been deposited therein but for
such  clause.    The  Master  Servicer  will satisfy  these  requirements  by
maintaining a blanket policy.   As set forth above, all amounts  collected by
the Master Servicer  (net of any reimbursements to the Master Servicer) under
any  hazard policy (except  for amounts to  be applied to  the restoration or
repair of  the  Mortgaged  Property)  will ultimately  be  deposited  in  the
Collection Account.

    In  general,  the  standard form  of  fire and  extended  coverage policy
covers  physical damage to or destruction of the improvements on the property
by  fire, lightning,  explosion,  smoke, windstorm  and hail,  and  the like,
strike  and  civil  commotion,  subject  to  the  conditions  and  exclusions
specified  in each policy.   Although the  policies relating to  the Mortgage
Loans will  be  underwritten by  different insurers  and  therefore will  not
contain identical terms and conditions,  the basic terms thereof are dictated
by state laws and most  of such policies typically do not cover  any physical
damage resulting from the following:  war,  revolution, governmental actions,
floods and other water-related causes, earth movement (including earthquakes,
landslides and mudflows), nuclear reactions, wet or dry rot, vermin, rodents,
insects or  domestic animals,  theft and,  in certain  cases vandalism.   The
foregoing list is merely  indicative of certain kinds of  uninsured risks and
is not intended to be all-inclusive  or an exact description of the insurance
policies relating to the Mortgaged Properties.

REALIZATION UPON DEFAULTED MORTGAGE LOANS

    The  Master Servicer will foreclose  upon or otherwise comparably convert
to ownership Mortgaged Properties securing such of the Mortgage Loans as come
into default when,  in accordance with applicable  servicing procedures under
the Agreement, no satisfactory arrangements can be made for the collection of
delinquent  payments.     In  connection  with  such  foreclosure   or  other
conversion,  the  Master Servicer  will  follow such  practices  as it  deems
necessary  or advisable and  as are in  keeping with its  general subordinate
mortgage servicing  activities,  provided the  Master  Servicer will  not  be
required  to expend  its own  funds in  connection with foreclosure  or other
conversion,  correction of  default  on  a related  senior  mortgage loan  or
restoration of any property unless,  in its sole judgment, such  foreclosure,
correction or restoration will increase Net Liquidation Proceeds.  The Master
Servicer  will be reimbursed out of  Liquidation Proceeds for advances of its
own funds as  liquidation expenses  before any Net  Liquidation Proceeds  are
distributed to Certificateholders or the Transferor.

   
SERVICING COMPENSATION AND PAYMENT OF EXPENSES
    

    With respect  to each Collection Period, the Master Servicer will receive
from interest collections in respect of the Mortgage Loans a portion  of such
interest  collections  as a  monthly  Servicing Fee  in  the amount  equal to
approximately  ____%  per  annum  ("Servicing  Fee  Rate") on  the  aggregate
Principal  Balances of the Mortgage Loans as of  the first day of the related
Collection  Period (or at the Cut-Off  Date for the first Collection Period).
All assumption  fees, late payment charges and other fees and charges, to the
extent collected from borrowers,  will be retained by the  Master Servicer as
additional servicing compensation.

    The Master  Servicer will pay  certain ongoing  expenses associated  with
the Trust Fund  and incurred by  it in  connection with its  responsibilities
under the Agreement.   In addition, the Master  Servicer will be entitled  to
reimbursement  for  certain  expenses  incurred  by  it  in  connection  with
defaulted Mortgage Loans and in connection with  the restoration of Mortgaged
Properties, such  right  of  reimbursement  being  prior  to  the  rights  of
Certificateholders to receive any related Net Liquidation Proceeds.

EVIDENCE AS TO COMPLIANCE

    The Agreement  provides for  delivery on  or before  ___________ in  each
year, beginning in ___________, 199_,  to the Trustee of an  annual statement
signed  by an officer  of the Master  Servicer to the effect  that the Master
Servicer   has  fulfilled  its  material   obligations  under  the  Agreement
throughout the preceding fiscal year, except as  specified in such statement.

    On or  before _____________  of each  year, beginning  ___________, 199_,
the Master Servicer will  furnish a report prepared  by a firm of  nationally
recognized independent public accountants (who may also render other services
to the Master  Servicer or the  Transferor) to the  Trustee, the  Certificate
Insurer and  the Rating Agencies  to the effect  that such firm  has examined
certain documents and the records relating to servicing of the Mortgage Loans
under  the Agreement and  that, on the  basis of such  examination, such firm
believes that such servicing was  conducted in compliance with the  Agreement
except for (a) such exceptions as such firm believes to be immaterial and (b)
such other exceptions as shall be set forth in such report.  

CERTAIN MATTERS REGARDING THE MASTER SERVICER AND THE TRANSFEROR

    The Agreement provides that the Master  Servicer may not resign from  its
obligations  and duties  thereunder, except  in connection  with a  permitted
transfer of servicing,  unless (i) such duties and obligations  are no longer
permissible  under applicable  law or are  in material conflict  by reason of
applicable  law with  any  other activities  of a  type and  nature presently
carried  on by  it or  its affiliate  or (ii)  upon the  satisfaction of  the
following  conditions:   (a)  the Master  Servicer has  proposed  a successor
servicer  to the Trustee  in writing and such  proposed successor servicer is
reasonably acceptable to the Trustee; (b) the Rating Agencies  have confirmed
to the Trustee that  the appointment of  such proposed successor servicer  as
the  Master Servicer will  not result in  the reduction or  withdrawal of the
then current  rating of  the Certificates;  and (c)  such proposed  successor
servicer  is reasonably  acceptable  to the  Certificate  Insurer.   No  such
resignation will become  effective until the Trustee or  a successor servicer
has assumed the Master Servicer's obligations and duties under the Agreement.

    The  Master Servicer may perform any of  its duties and obligations under
the  Agreement through one  or more subservicers  or delegates, which  may be
affiliates  of the Master Servicer. Notwithstanding any such arrangement, the
Master Servicer  will remain  liable and  obligated to  the  Trustee and  the
Certificateholders for the Master Servicer's duties and obligations under the
Agreement, without  any diminution of such  duties and obligations and  as if
the Master Servicer itself were performing such duties and obligations.  

    The Agreement provides that the Master Servicer  will indemnify the Trust
Fund and the Trustee from and against any loss, liability, expense, damage or
injury suffered or sustained as a result of the Master Servicer's  actions or
omissions in connection with the servicing and administration of the Mortgage
Loans  which are  not in  accordance  with the  provisions of  the Agreement.
Under the Agreement, the  Transferor will indemnify an injured party  for the
entire amount of any losses, claims, damages or liabilities arising out of or
based on  the Agreement (other than losses  resulting from defaults under the
Mortgage  Loans).   In the  event of  an Event  of Servicing  Termination (as
defined  below) resulting  in the  assumption of  servicing obligations  by a
successor Master Servicer,  the successor Master Servicer  will indemnify the
Transferor for any losses, claims, damages and liabilities of  the Transferor
as described in this paragraph  arising from the successor Master  Servicer's
actions or  omissions.   The Agreement provides  that neither  Provident, the
Transferor nor the Master Servicer  nor their directors, officers,  employees
or  agents will be under any other  liability to the Trust Fund, the Trustee,
the  Certificateholders  or any  other  person for  any action  taken  or for
refraining from  taking  any action  pursuant  to  the Agreement.    However,
neither Provident, the  Transferor nor the Master Servicer  will be protected
against any liability which would  otherwise be imposed by reason of  willful
misconduct, bad faith or gross negligence of Provident, the Transferor or the
Master Servicer in the  performance of its duties  under the Agreement or  by
reason of reckless disregard of its obligations thereunder.  In addition, the
Agreement provides that  the Master Servicer will not be under any obligation
to appear in, prosecute or defend any legal action which is not incidental to
its servicing responsibilities  under the Agreement and which  in its opinion
may expose it to any expense or  liability.  The Master Servicer may, in  its
sole discretion, undertake any such legal action which it  may deem necessary
or desirable with respect to the Agreement  and the rights and duties of  the
parties thereto and the interest of the Certificateholders thereunder. 

    Any  corporation  into  which  the  Master  Servicer  may  be  merged  or
consolidated,  or any corporation  resulting from  any merger,  conversion or
consolidation  to  which  the  Master  Servicer  shall be  a  party,  or  any
corporation succeeding to  the business of the  Master Servicer shall  be the
successor of the  Master Servicer hereunder, without the  execution or filing
of any paper  or any further act  on the part  of any of the  parties hereto,
anything in the Agreement to the contrary notwithstanding.  

EVENTS OF SERVICING TERMINATION

    "Events  of Servicing Termination"  will consist of:   (i) any failure by
the Master Servicer to deposit in the Collection Account any deposit required
to be made  under the Agreement, which failure  continues unremedied for five
business  days after  the giving  of written  notice of  such failure  to the
Master  Servicer by the Trustee, or to the Master Servicer and the Trustee by
the  Certificate  Insurer  or  Certificateholders  evidencing  an  aggregate,
undivided  interest in  the Trust  Fund of  at least  25% of  the Certificate
Principal Balance; (ii) any failure by the Master Servicer duly to observe or
perform in any material respect  any other of its covenants or  agreements in
the  Agreement which,  in each  case,  materially and  adversely affects  the
interests  of the Certificateholders or the Certificate Insurer and continues
unremedied for 60 days after the giving of  written notice of such failure to
the Master Servicer by the Trustee, or to the Master Servicer and the Trustee
by the  Certificate Insurer  or Certificateholders  evidencing an  aggregate,
undivided  interest in  the Trust  Fund of  at least  25% of  the Certificate
Principal  Balance; or (iii)  certain events  of insolvency,  readjustment of
debt, marshalling of  assets and liabilities or similar  proceedings relating
to the Master Servicer and certain  actions by the Master Servicer indicating
insolvency,  reorganization  or  inability  to pay  its  obligations.   Under
certain  other circumstances,  the Certificate  Insurer  with the  consent of
holders of Investor Certificates evidencing an  aggregate, undivided interest
in  the Trust Fund of  at least 51% of  the Certificate Principal Balance may
deliver written notice to the Master Servicer terminating  all the rights and
obligations of the Master Servicer under the Agreement.

    Notwithstanding the  foregoing,  a delay  in  or failure  of  performance
referred to  under clause (i)  above for  a period  of ten  Business Days  or
referred  to under clause (ii) above for a  period of 60 Business Days, shall
not constitute  an Event of  Servicing Termination  if such delay  or failure
could not be prevented by the exercise of reasonable diligence by  the Master
Servicer  and such  delay or  failure was caused  by an  act of  God or other
similar  occurrence.   Upon  the  occurrence of  any  such  event the  Master
Servicer shall not be relieved from using its best efforts to  perform its 
obligations in a timely manner in accordance with the terms  of the Agreement
and the Master  Servicer shall provide the Trustee, Provident, the Transferor,
the Certificate Insurer and the Certificateholders prompt notice of such 
failure or delay by  it, together with a description of its efforts to so 
perform its obligations.

RIGHTS UPON AN EVENT OF SERVICING TERMINATION

    So long as  an Event of Servicing  Termination remains unremedied, either
the  Trustee,   or  Certificateholders  evidencing  an  aggregate,  undivided
interest  in the  Trust Fund  of at  least 51%  of the  Certificate Principal
Balance  or the  Certificate Insurer,  may terminate  all of  the  rights and
obligations of  the Master Servicer  under the  Agreement and in  and to  the
Mortgage   Loans,   whereupon  the   Trustee   will   succeed  to   all   the
responsibilities,  duties and liabilities  of the  Master Servicer  under the
Agreement  and will be entitled to similar compensation arrangements.  In the
event that  the Trustee would be obligated to succeed the Master Servicer but
is unwilling  or unable  so to act,  it may appoint,  or petition a  court of
competent jurisdiction  for the appointment  of, a  housing and home  finance
institution or other  mortgage loan  or home  equity loan  servicer with  all
licenses and permits required to perform its obligations under  the Agreement
and  having  a net  worth  of  at least  $__________  and  acceptable to  the
Certificate Insurer  to act  as successor  to the  Master Servicer  under the
Agreement. Pending  such appointment, the Trustee will be obligated to act in
such capacity unless prohibited by  law.  Such successor will be  entitled to
receive the same  compensation that the Master Servicer  would otherwise have
received (or such lesser  compensation as the Trustee and  such successor may
agree).   A receiver or conservator for the  Master Servicer may be empowered
to  prevent the termination and replacement of  the Master Servicer where the
only Event of Servicing Termination that has occurred is an Insolvency Event.

   
AMENDMENT

    The Agreement may be  amended from time to time by  Provident, the Master
Servicer and the Trustee and with the consent of the Certificate Insurer, but
without  the consent  of the  Certificateholders, to  cure any  ambiguity, to
correct or supplement any provisions  therein which may be inconsistent  with
any other provisions of the Agreement, to add to  the duties of Provident, or
the Master  Servicer or to  add or amend  any provisions of the  Agreement as
required by the Rating Agencies in order to maintain or improve any rating of
the Certificates (it  being understood that,  after obtaining the  ratings in
effect  on  the Closing  Date, neither  the Transferor,  the Trustee  nor the
Master Servicer is obligated to obtain, maintain, or improve any such rating)
or to  add any other provisions with respect  to matters or questions arising
under the  Agreement which shall not  be inconsistent with the  provisions of
the Agreement, provided that such action will not, as evidenced by an opinion
of  counsel,   materially  and   adversely  affect   the  interests   of  any
Certificateholder  or  the  Certificate  Insurer;  provided,  that  any  such
amendment  will  not  be  deemed  to  materially  and  adversely  affect  the
Certificateholders  and no such  opinion will be required  to be delivered if
the  person requesting  such  amendment  obtains  a letter  from  the  Rating
Agencies stating that such amendment would not result in a downgrading of the
then current rating of the  Certificates.  The Agreement may also  be amended
from time  to time by Provident,  the Master Servicer, and  the Trustee, with
the consent of Certificateholders evidencing an aggregate, undivided interest
in  the Trust Fund of  at least 51% of the  Certificate Principal Balance and
the Certificate  Insurer for  the  purpose of  adding  any provisions  to  or
changing in any manner or eliminating  any of the provisions of the Agreement
or of modifying in any manner  the rights of the Certificateholders, provided
that no such amendment  will (i) reduce in any manner the amount of, or delay
the timing  of, collections of payments on  the Certificates or distributions
or payments under the Policy which are required to be made on any Certificate
without  the consent of  the holder  of such  Certificate or (ii)  reduce the
aforesaid  percentage required to consent to  any such amendment, without the
consent of the holders of all Certificates then outstanding.  
    

TERMINATION; RETIREMENT OF THE CERTIFICATES

    The Trust  Fund will  terminate on  the Distribution  Date following  the
later of  (A) payment in full of all amounts owing to the Certificate Insurer
and (B) the earliest  of (i) the Distribution  Date on which the  Certificate
Principal Balance  has been reduced to zero, (ii)  the final payment or other
liquidation of the last Mortgage  Loan in the Trust Fund, (iii)  the optional
transfer to the  Transferor of the Certificates, as  described below and (iv)
the Distribution Date in ____________ 20__.

    The  Certificates will be subject  to optional transfer to the Transferor
on any Distribution  Date after the Certificate Principal  Balance is reduced
to an amount less than or equal to 5% of the Original Certificate Principal 
Balance  and  all amounts  due  and  owing  to  the Certificate  Insurer  and
unreimbursed draws on the Policy, together with interest thereon, as provided
under the Insurance Agreement,  have been paid.   The transfer price will  be
equal to the sum of the outstanding Certificate Principal Balance and accrued
and unpaid interest thereon at the Certificate Rate through the day preceding
the  final Distribution  Date.   In no  event, however,  will the  Trust Fund
created by the Agreement  continue for more than 21 years  after the death of
certain individuals named in the Agreement.  Written notice of termination of
the  Agreement  will  be  given  to  each  Certificateholder, and  the  final
distribution  will  be made  only  upon  surrender  and cancellation  of  the
Certificates at an office  or agency appointed by  the Trustee which will  be
specified in the notice of termination.  

    In addition,  the Trust  Fund may be  liquidated as  a result of  certain
events of bankruptcy, insolvency or  receivership relating to the Transferor.
See "--Rapid Amortization Events" herein.

THE TRUSTEE

    (                  ),  a ____________________________ with its  principal
place  of  business  in ________,  has  been  named Trustee  pursuant  to the
Agreement.
    The  commercial  bank  or  trust  company  serving  as  Trustee  may  own
Certificates  and have normal  banking relationships  with Provident  and the
Certificate Insurer and/or their affiliates.

    The Trustee  may resign at  any time,  in which  event Provident will  be
obligated  to appoint  a successor  Trustee, as  approved by  the Certificate
Insurer.  Provident may also remove  the Trustee if the Trustee ceases  to be
eligible to continue as  such under the Agreement  or if the Trustee  becomes
insolvent.   Upon becoming  aware of  such circumstances,  Provident will  be
obligated  to appoint  a successor  Trustee, as  approved by  the Certificate
Insurer.   Any resignation  or removal  of the Trustee  and appointment  of a
successor   Trustee  will  not  become  effective  until  acceptance  of  the
appointment by the successor Trustee.  

    No holder  of a Certificate  will have any  right under the  Agreement to
institute  any proceeding with  respect to  the Agreement unless  such holder
previously has  given to  the Trustee  written notice  of default  and unless
Certificateholders evidencing  an aggregate, undivided interest  in the Trust
Fund of at  least 51% of the Certificate Principal  Balance have made written
requests  upon the Trustee  to institute such  proceeding in its  own name as
Trustee thereunder and have offered  to the Trustee reasonable indemnity  and
the  Trustee  for 60  days has  neglected or  refused  to institute  any such
proceeding.   The Trustee will be under no obligation  to exercise any of the
trusts or powers  vested in it by the Agreement or  to make any investigation
of  matters  arising  thereunder  or  to institute,  conduct  or  defend  any
litigation  thereunder  or  in  relation thereto  at  the  request,  order or
direction of  any of the  Certificateholders, unless  such Certificateholders
have  offered to  the Trustee  reasonable security  or indemnity  against the
cost, expenses and liabilities which may be incurred therein or thereby.  

CERTAIN ACTIVITIES

    The  Trust Fund  will not:    (i) borrow  money; (ii)  make loans;  (iii)
invest in securities for  the purpose of exercising control;  (iv) underwrite
securities; (v)  except as provided in the  Agreement, engage in the purchase
and sale (or turnover) of investments;  (vi) offer securities in exchange for
property (except Certificates for the Mortgage Loans); or (vii) repurchase or
otherwise reacquire its  securities.  See "--Evidence as to Compliance" above
for information regarding reports as to the compliance by the Master Servicer
with the terms of the Agreement.


                               USE OF PROCEEDS

    The net proceeds to  be received from the  sale of the Certificates  will
be applied by Provident towards general corporate purposes.



                       FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES

GENERAL

    The  following discussion,  which summarizes  the  material U.S.  federal
income  tax  aspects  of  the  purchase,  ownership  and disposition  of  the
Certificates,  is based  on the  provisions of the  Internal Revenue  Code of
1986,  as amended  (the  "Code"), the  Treasury  Regulations thereunder,  and
published rulings and court decisions in effect as of the date hereof, all of
which are subject  to change, possibly retroactively.   This discussion  does
not address  every aspect of the  U.S. federal income  tax laws which  may be
relevant  to  Certificate  Owners  in  light  of  their  personal  investment
circumstances or  to certain types of  Certificate Owners subject  to special
treatment under the U.S. federal income tax laws (for example, banks and life
insurance  companies).   Accordingly,  investors  should  consult  their  tax
advisors  regarding U.S.  federal, state,  local, foreign  and any  other tax
consequences to them of investing in the Certificates.

CHARACTERIZATION OF THE CERTIFICATES AS INDEBTEDNESS

    Based on the  application of existing  law to the  facts as set forth  in
the Agreement  and other relevant documents and  assuming compliance with the
terms  of  the  Agreement  as  in effect  on  the  date  of  issuance  of the
Certificates,  Brown &  Wood  LLP,  special tax  counsel  to Provident  ("Tax
Counsel"), is  of the opinion that  the Certificates will be  treated as debt
instruments for  federal income tax purposes  as of such  date.  Accordingly,
upon  issuance, the  Certificates will  be  treated as  "Debt Securities"  as
described in  the Prospectus.  See  "Federal Income Tax Consequences"  in the
Prospectus.

    The Transferor  and the Certificateholders express in the Agreement their
intent  that, for  all tax  purposes, the  Certificates will  be indebtedness
secured  by  the  Mortgage  Loans.     The  Transferor,  Provident  and   the
Certificateholders, by accepting the Certificates, and each Certificate Owner
by its acquisition of a beneficial interest in a Certificate, have  agreed to
treat  the Certificates as indebtedness for U.S. federal income tax purposes.
However, because  different  criteria  are  used  to  determine  the  non-tax
accounting  characterization of  the transaction,  the Transferor  intends to
treat this transaction as a sale of  an interest in the Asset Balances of the
Mortgage Loans for financial accounting and certain regulatory purposes.

    In general, whether  for U.S. federal  income tax purposes a  transaction
constitutes a sale of property or a  loan, the repayment of which is  secured
by property, is a question of fact, the resolution of which is based upon the
economic substance of  the transaction rather than its form  or the manner in
which it is labeled.  While the Internal Revenue Service (the "IRS") and  the
courts have set forth several factors to be taken into account in determining
whether the substance of  a transaction is  a sale of  property or a  secured
loan, the  primary  factor  in  making  this  determination  is  whether  the
transferee has assumed the risk of loss or other economic burdens relating to
the property and has obtained the benefits of ownership thereof.  Tax Counsel
has analyzed and relied on  several factors in reaching its opinion  that the
weight of  the benefits and  burdens of ownership  of the Mortgage  Loans has
been  retained  by  the  Transferor  and  has  not  been  transferred  to the
Certificate Owners.

    In some  instances, courts  have held  that a  taxpayer is  bound by  the
particular form it has chosen for a transaction, even if the substance of the
transaction does not accord with its form.  Tax Counsel has advised that  the
rationale of those cases will not apply to this transaction, because the form
of the transaction as reflected in  the operative provisions of the documents
either accords  with the  characterization  of the  Certificates as  debt  or
otherwise makes the rationale of those cases inapplicable to this situation.

TAXATION OF INTEREST INCOME OF CERTIFICATE OWNERS

    Assuming that the Certificate Owners are  holders of debt obligations for
U.S. federal income tax purposes, the Certificates  generally will be taxable
as Debt Securities.  See "Federal Income Tax Consequences" in the Prospectus.

    While  it is not  anticipated that the  Certificates will be  issued at a
greater  than  de  minimis  discount, under  Treasury  regulations  (the "OID
Regulations")  it is  possible that  the  Certificates could  nevertheless be
deemed to  have  been issued  with  original issue  discount ("OID")  if  the
interest  were  not  treated  as  "unconditionally  payable"  under  the  OID
Regulations.  If such regulations were to apply, all of the taxable income to
be recognized with respect to the  Certificates would be includible in income
of Certificate Owners as OID, but  would not be  includible again when  the 
interest  is actually received.  See  "Federal Income Tax Consequences--
Taxation  of Debt Securities; Interest and  Acquisition  Discount"  in  the  
Prospectus  for  a  discussion  of  the application  of the OID  rules if 
the  Certificates are  in fact issued  at a greater than  de minimis discount
or  are treated as having  been issued with OID under the OID Regulations.  
For purposes of calculating OID, it is likely that the Certificates will be 
treated as Pay-Through Securities.

POSSIBLE CLASSIFICATION OF  THE CERTIFICATES AS A PARTNERSHIP  OR ASSOCIATION
TAXABLE AS A CORPORATION

    The opinion of  Tax Counsel is not binding on the  courts or the IRS.  It
is possible  that the IRS  could assert that,  for purposes of  the Code, the
transaction contemplated by this Prospectus with respect  to the Certificates
constitutes  a sale of  the Mortgage  Loans (or  an interest therein)  to the
Certificate  Owners  and   that  the  proper  classification   of  the  legal
relationship between the Transferor and the Certificate Owners resulting from
this transaction  is that  of a  partnership, a  publicly traded  partnership
treated as a corporation, or an association taxable  as a corporation.  Since
Tax Counsel has opined that the Certificates will be treated as indebtedness
in the hands of the Certificateholders  for U.S. federal income tax purposes,
the  Transferor will  not  attempt to  comply  with U.S.  federal  income tax
reporting requirements applicable to partnerships or corporations.

    If it were determined that this transaction created an entity  classified
as  a  corporation (including  a  publicly traded  partnership  taxable as  a
corporation), the Trust Fund would  be subject to U.S. federal income  tax at
corporate income tax rates on the income it derives from the  Mortgage Loans,
which  would reduce the amounts available for distribution to the Certificate
Owners.   Cash  distributions to  the Certificate  Owners generally  would be
treated as  dividends for tax  purposes to the  extent of  such corporation's
earnings and profits.

    If  the transaction  were treated  as creating a  partnership between the
Certificate Owners and  the Transferor, the  partnership itself would  not be
subject to U.S. federal income tax (unless  it were to be characterized as  a
publicly traded partnership taxable as a corporation); rather, the Transferor
and each  Certificate Owner would  be taxed individually  on their respective
distributive shares of  the partnership's income, gain, loss,  deductions and
credits.   The amount  and timing  of items of  income and  deductions of the
Certificate  Owner could differ  if the Certificates  were held to constitute
partnership interests  rather than  indebtedness.  Assuming  that all  of the
provisions of  the  Agreement, as  in effect  on  the date  of issuance,  are
complied with, it is  the opinion of Tax Counsel that the Trust Fund will not
be  treated  as  either  an  association  or  a   partnership  taxable  as  a
corporation.

POSSIBLE CLASSIFICATION AS A TAXABLE MORTGAGE POOL

    In relevant part,  Section 7701(i) of  the Code provides that  any entity
(or  a portion  of an  entity)  that is  a "taxable  mortgage  pool" will  be
classified as  a taxable  corporation and  will not  be permitted  to file  a
consolidated U.S. federal  income tax return with  another corporation.   Any
entity (or a portion of  any entity) will be a  taxable mortgage pool if  (i)
substantially all of its assets consist of debt instruments, more than 50% of
which are real  estate mortgages, (ii) the  entity is the obligor  under debt
obligations  with two or  more maturities, and  (iii) under the  terms of the
entity's debt  obligations (or an  underlying arrangement), payments  on such
debt obligations bear  a relationship  to the  debt instruments  held by  the
entity.

    Assuming that  all of the  provisions of the  Agreement, as in  effect on
the  date of issuance, are complied with, Tax  Counsel is of the opinion that
the arrangement created by the Agreement will not be a taxable  mortgage pool
under Section  7701(i) of  the Code  because only  one class  of indebtedness
secured by the Mortgage Loans is being issued.

    The opinion of Tax Counsel is  not binding on the IRS or the  courts.  If
the IRS were to contend successfully (or future regulations were to  provide)
that the arrangement  created by the  Agreement is  a taxable mortgage  pool,
such arrangement would be subject to U.S. federal corporate income tax on its
taxable income  generated by  ownership of the  Mortgage Loans.   Such  a tax
might reduce amounts available for distributions to  Certificate Owners.  The
amount  of such a tax would depend  upon whether distributions to Certificate
Owners  would be  deductible  as interest  expense in  computing  the taxable
income of such an arrangement as a taxable mortgage pool.

FOREIGN INVESTORS

    In general, subject to certain exceptions,  Tax Counsel is of the 
opinion that interest (including OID) paid on  a Certificate to  a
nonresident alien  individual, foreign corporation or other  non-United
States person  is not subject  to U.S.  federal income tax, provided that 
such interest  is not  effectively connected  with a trade  or business of 
the recipient  in the United  States and  the Certificate  Owner provides
the required foreign person information certification.  See "Federal Income 
Tax  Consequences--Tax   Treatment  of  Foreign  Investors"   in  the
Prospectus.

    If the interests  of the Certificate Owners were deemed to be partnership
interests, the  partnership would be  required, on a quarterly  basis, to pay
withholding  tax equal  to the  product, for  each foreign  partner, of  such
foreign partner's distributive share of "effectively connected" income of the
partnership multiplied by the highest rate of tax  applicable to that foreign
partner.    In addition,  such foreign  partner  would be  subject  to branch
profits tax.   Each non-foreign partner  would be required to  certify to the
partnership that it  is not  a foreign person.   The  tax withheld from  each
foreign partner would be credited  against such foreign partner's U.S. income
tax liability.

    If  the  Trust Fund  were  taxable  as a  corporation,  distributions  to
foreign persons,  to  the extent  treated as  dividends,  would generally  be
subject to withholding at  the rate of 30%, unless such  rate were reduced by
an applicable tax treaty.

BACKUP WITHHOLDING

    Certain Certificate  Owners may be subject  to backup withholding  at the
rate  of  31% with  respect  to  interest paid  on  the  Certificates if  the
Certificate Owners,  upon issuance, fail to supply  the Trustee or his broker
with  his taxpayer  identification  number,  furnish  an  incorrect  taxpayer
identification  number,   fail  to  report  interest,   dividends,  or  other
"reportable payments" (as defined  in the Code)  properly, or, under  certain
circumstances, fail  to provide the  Trustee or  his broker with  a certified
statement, under  penalty  of  perjury, that  he  is not  subject  to  backup
withholding.

    The Trustee will be required  to report annually to the IRS, and  to each
Certificateholder of record, the amount of interest paid (and OID accrued, if
any)  on the  Certificates (and  the  amount of  interest  withheld for  U.S.
federal income  taxes, if any)  for each calendar  year, except as  to exempt
holders   (generally,  holders  that  are  corporations,  certain  tax-exempt
organizations or  nonresident aliens  who provide  certification as  to their
status  as nonresidents).  As long  as the only "Certificateholder" of record
is Cede,  as nominee for DTC, Certificate Owners and the IRS will receive tax
and  other  information  including  the  amount  of  interest  paid   on  the
Certificates  owned from Participants  and Indirect Participants  rather than
from  the  Trustee.   (The Trustee,  however,  will respond  to  requests for
necessary information  to  enable  Participants,  Indirect  Participants  and
certain  other  persons  to  complete   their  reports.)    Each   non-exempt
Certificate Owner will  be required to provide,  under penalty of  perjury, a
certificate  on IRS  Form W-9 containing  his or  her name,  address, correct
federal taxpayer identification number and a  statement that he or she is not
subject to  backup withholding.  Should a nonexempt Certificate Owner fail to
provide the required certification, the Participants or Indirect Participants
(or the Paying  Agent) will be required to withhold 31%  of the interest (and
principal)  otherwise payable to the holder, and remit the withheld amount to
the IRS as a credit against the holder's federal income tax liability.


                                 STATE TAXES



    Provident makes  no  representations regarding  the  tax consequences  of
purchase, ownership or disposition of the Certificates under  the tax laws of
any  state. Investors considering  an investment  in the  Certificates should
consult their own tax advisors regarding such tax consequences.

    ALL  INVESTORS  SHOULD  CONSULT  THEIR  OWN TAX  ADVISORS  REGARDING  THE
FEDERAL,  STATE, LOCAL OR  FOREIGN INCOME  TAX CONSEQUENCES OF  THE PURCHASE,
OWNERSHIP AND DISPOSITION OF THE CERTIFICATES.


                             ERISA CONSIDERATIONS

    Any Plan fiduciary which proposes  to cause a Plan to acquire  any of the
Certificates should consult  with its counsel  with respect to  the potential
consequences under  the Employee Retirement Income  Security Act of  1974, as
amended ("ERISA"), and  the Code, of  the Plans acquisition and  ownership of
such Certificates.  See "ERISA Considerations" in the Prospectus.

    The   U.S.  Department   of  Labor   has  granted   to  _________________
("Underwriter")  Prohibited  Transaction  Exemption  _____  (the "Exemption")
which  exempts  from the  application  of  the prohibited  transaction  rules
transactions  relating to (1)  the acquisition, sale and  holding by Plans of
certain certificates  representing an  undivided interest  in certain  asset-
backed pass-through trusts,  with respect to which Underwriter  or any of its
affiliates  is  the sole  underwriter  or the  manager or  co-manager  of the
underwriting  syndicate; and (2)  the servicing, operation  and management of
such asset-backed pass-through  trusts, provided that the  general conditions
and certain other conditions set  forth in the Exemption are satisfied.   The
Exemption  will  apply  to  the   acquisition,  holding  and  resale  of  the
Certificates by a Plan provided that certain conditions are met.

    For a general description  of the Exemption and the  conditions that must
be  satisfied for the  Exemption to apply, see  "ERISA Considerations" in the
Prospectus.

    The  Underwriter   believes  that  the   Exemption  will  apply   to  the
acquisition and holding  of the Certificates by Plans and that all conditions
of the Exemption other than those within the control of the investors will be
met.

    Any  Plan fiduciary considering  whether to purchase  any Certificates on
behalf of a Plan should consult  with its counsel regarding the applicability
of  the  fiduciary responsibility  and  prohibited transaction  provisions of
ERISA and the Code to such investment.  Among other things, before purchasing
any  Certificates,   a  fiduciary  of  a   Plan  subject  to   the  fiduciary
responsibility provisions of ERISA or an employee benefit plan subject to the
prohibited   transaction  provisions  of   the  Code  should   make  its  own
determination as to  the availability of the exemptive relief provided in the
Exemption,  and  also  consider  the  availability  of any  other  prohibited
transaction exemptions.


                       LEGAL INVESTMENT CONSIDERATIONS

    Although,  as a  condition to  their issuance,  the Certificates  will be
rated in the highest rating category of the Rating Agencies, the Certificates
will  not  constitute  "mortgage  related securities"  for  purposes  of  the
Secondary  Mortgage Market Enhancement Act of 1984 ("SMMEA"), because not all
of   the  Mortgages  securing   the  Mortgage  Loans   are  first  mortgages.
Accordingly, many institutions  with legal authority to  invest in comparably
rated securities based on first mortgage  loans may not be legally authorized
to  invest in  the Certificates, which  because they evidence  interests in a
pool  that  includes   junior  mortgage  loans  are   not  "mortgage  related
securities" under SMMEA.  See "Legal Investment" in the Prospectus.


                                 UNDERWRITING

   
    Subject  to  the terms  and  conditions  set forth  in  the  underwriting
agreement, dated  ___________, 199_ (the  "Underwriting Agreement"),  between
Provident and (Underwriter) (the "Underwriter"), Provident has agreed to sell
to the Underwriter, and the Underwriter has agreed to purchase from Provident
all the Certificates.  
    

    In the  Underwriting Agreement,  the Underwriter  has agreed, subject  to
the terms and  conditions set forth therein, to purchase all the Certificates
offered hereby if any of the Certificates are purchased.

    Provident has been advised by the Underwriter that it  proposes initially
to offer the Certificates to  the public in Europe  and the United States  at
the offering price set forth on the cover page hereof  and to certain dealers
at  such price  less a discount  not in  excess of  ____% of  the Certificate
denominations.   The Underwriter  may allow  and such  dealers may  reallow a
discount not in excess  of _____% of the Certificate denominations to certain
other dealers.  After the initial public offering, the public offering price,
such concessions and such discounts may be changed.

    The Underwriting  Agreement provides  that Provident  will indemnify  the
Underwriter against certain  civil liabilities,  including liabilities  under
the Act.


                                LEGAL MATTERS

   
    Certain  legal matters with  respect to the  Certificates will  be passed
upon for  Provident by  Brown &  Wood LLP, New  York, New  York and  Keating,
Muething & Klekamp, P.L.L., Cincinnati, Ohio and for the Underwriter by (  ).
    


                                   EXPERTS

    The  consolidated balance  sheets  of (Insurer)  and  Subsidiaries as  of
___________, 199_ and 199_ and the related consolidated statements of income,
changes in  shareholder's equity, and cash flows for  each of the three years
in  the period  ended ___________,  199_, incorporated  by reference  in this
Prospectus Supplement,  have  been incorporated  herein  in reliance  on  the
report  of ________________________,  independent accountants,  given on  the
authority of that firm as experts in accounting and auditing.


                                   RATINGS

    It  is a condition  to issuance that  the Certificates be  rated "___" by
_____ and "___" by _________.

    A  securities  rating  addresses   the  likelihood  of  the   receipt  by
Certificateholders  of distributions on the Mortgage Loans.  The rating takes
into  consideration  the  characteristics  of  the  Mortgage  Loans  and  the
structural,  legal and  tax aspects  associated with  the Certificates.   The
ratings on the Certificates do  not, however, constitute statements regarding
the  likelihood or  frequency  of prepayments  on the  Mortgage Loans  or the
possibility that  Certificateholders might  realize a lower  than anticipated
yield.

    The ratings assigned  to the Certificates will depend primarily  upon the
creditworthiness  of the  Certificate  Insurer.   Any reduction  in  a rating
assigned  to the claims-paying ability  of the Certificate  Insurer below the
ratings initially assigned to the Certificates  may result in a reduction  of
one or more of the ratings assigned to the Certificates.

    A  securities  rating  is not  a  recommendation  to  buy,  sell or  hold
securities and may  be subject to revision or  withdrawal at any time  by the
assigning  rating organization.   Each securities rating  should be evaluated
independently of similar ratings on different securities.

    Provident has not requested  a rating of the  Certificates by any  rating
agency other than the Rating Agencies; there can be no assurance, however, as
to whether any other rating agency will rate the Certificates or, if it does,
what  rating  would be  assigned  by  such other  rating  agency. The  rating
assigned by such other rating agency to the Certificates could be  lower than
the respective ratings assigned by the Rating Agencies.

                            INDEX OF DEFINED TERMS

                                                                         Page
                                                                             
         ---

   
Accelerated Principal Distribution Amount . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-8, S-39
Additional Balances . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-3
Agreement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-3
Alternative Principal Payment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-11, S-41
Beneficial owner  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-32
BIF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-38
Book-Entry Certificates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-32
Business Day  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-39, S-44
Capitalized Interest Account  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-13, S-45
Cede  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-7, S-35
CEDEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-6
CEDEL Participants  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-34
Certificate Insurer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-11
Certificate Owners  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-6, S-32
Certificate Principal Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-4, S-32
Certificate Rate  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-4, S-10, S-40
Certificateholder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-33, S-53
Certificates  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-1, S-4
Chase . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-7
Citibank  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-7
Closing Date  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-1, S-10, S-40
Code  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-51
Collection Account  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-9, S-37
Collection Period . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-9, S-40
Combined Loan-to-Value Ratio  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-5
Cooperative . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-34
Credit Limit  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-5
Credit Limit Utilization Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-22
Credit Line Agreements  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-3, S-22
Cut-Off Date  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-1, S-3
Cut-Off Date Pool Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-3
Cut-Off Date Principal Balance  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-3
Defective Mortgage Loans  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-37
Definitive Certificate  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-32
Determination Date  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-13, S-37
Dissolution Distribution Date . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-43
Distribution Date . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-1, S-10, S-39
DTC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-6, S-32
Due Date  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-6
Eligible Account  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-37
Eligible Investments  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-38
Eligible Substitute Mortgage Loan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-36
ERISA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-15, S-54
Euroclear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-6
Euroclear Operator  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-34
Euroclear Participants  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-34
European Depositaries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-7, S-32
Events of Servicing Termination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-48
Exemption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-54
Financial Intermediary  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-33
Fixed Allocation Percentage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-9
Funding Period  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-12, S-45
Guaranteed Distributions  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-11, S-43
Guaranteed Principal Distribution Amount  . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-12, S-43
Index Rate  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-22
Indirect Participants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-33
Insurance Agreement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-11, S-43
Interest Collections  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-7, S-38
Interest Period . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-10, S-40
Invested Amount . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-4, S-32
Investor Fixed Allocation Percentage  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-9
Investor Floating Allocation Percentage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-8, S-38
Investor Interest Collections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-8, S-38
Investor Loss Amount  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-9, S-40
Investor Principal Collections  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-9, S-39
IRS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-51
LIBOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-10
LIBOR Business Day  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-41
Liquidated Mortgage Loan  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-40
Liquidation Loss Amount . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-9, S-40
Liquidation Proceeds  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-38
Loan Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-6, S-22
Managed Amortization Period . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-10, S-41
Margin  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-22
Master Servicer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-3
Maximum Principal Payment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-10, S-41
Maximum Rate  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-22
Minimum Transferor Interest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-5, S-37
Mortgage Loan Schedule  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-5, S-36, S-37
Mortgage Loans  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-1, S-3
Mortgaged Properties  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-3
Net Liquidation Proceeds  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-8, S-38
OID . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-51
OID Regulations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-51
Order . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-43
Original Certificate Principal Balance  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-4, S-32
Original Invested Amount  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-4, S-32
Overcollateralization Amount  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-9
Participants  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-33
Paying Agent  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-42
Percentage Interest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-6
Plan  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-15
Policy  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-1, S-3
Pool Balance  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-3, S-39
Pool Factor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-31
Pre-Funded Amount . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-12, S-44
Pre-Funding Account . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-12, S-44
Principal Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-3
Principal Collections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-7, S-38
Provident . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-1, S-3, S-19
Rapid Amortization Event  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-42
Rating Agency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-15
Receipt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-44
Received  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-44
Record Date . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-39
Reference Bank Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-41
Related Documents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-35
Relevant Depositary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-32
Required Overcollateralization Amount . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-40
Rules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-33
SAIF  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-37
Scheduled Principal Collections Distribution Amount . . . . . . .  S-10, S-41
Servicing Fee . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-13
Servicing Fee Rate  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-13, S-47
SMMEA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-15, S-54
Spread Account  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-12, S-43
STIFS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-38
Subsequent Transfer Date  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-30
Subservicer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-19
Tax Counsel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-51
Telerate Screen Page 3750 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-40
Terms and Conditions  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-34
Transfer Date . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-37
Transfer Deficiency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-36
Transfer Deposit Amount . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-36
Transferor  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-3
Transferor Interest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-1, S-4, S-32
Transferor Principal Collections  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-9, S-39
Trust Fund  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-1, S-3
Trustee . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-3, S-14
Underwriter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-54
Underwriting Agreement  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-54
    

                                   ANNEX I

        GLOBAL CLEARANCE, SETTLEMENT AND TAX DOCUMENTATION PROCEDURES

    Except in  certain  limited  circumstances,  the  globally  offered  Home
Equity   Loan  Asset   Backed  Certificates,   Series  199_-_   (the  "Global
Securities") will  be available only  in book-entry  form.  Investors  in the
Global  Securities  may  hold  such  Global  Securities  through any  of  The
Depository Trust Company ("DTC"), CEDEL or Euroclear.  The Global  Securities
will be  tradeable as home market  instruments in both the  European and U.S.
domestic markets.  Initial settlement and all secondary trades will settle in
same-day funds.

    Secondary  market  trading between  investors  holding  Global Securities
through  CEDEL  and Euroclear  will  be  conducted  in  the ordinary  way  in
accordance with their normal rules and operating procedures and in accordance
with conventional eurobond practice (i.e., seven calendar day settlement).

    Secondary market  trading  between  investors holding  Global  Securities
through  DTC  will  be  conducted  according  to  the  rules  and  procedures
applicable to  U.S. corporate  debt obligations  and prior  Home Equity  Loan
Asset Backed Certificates issues.

    Secondary  cross-market  trading  between  CEDEL  or  Euroclear  and  DTC
Participants holding  Certificates will  be effected  on a  delivery-against-
payment  basis through the respective Depositaries of CEDEL and Euroclear (in
such capacity) and as DTC Participants.

    Non-U.S.  holders  (as  described  below) of  Global  Securities  will be
subject  to  U.S.   withholding  taxes  unless  such  holders   meet  certain
requirements and  deliver appropriate  U.S. tax  documents to  the securities
clearing organizations or their participants.

INITIAL SETTLEMENT

    All  Global Securities will be held in book-entry form by DTC in the name
of  Cede  & Co.  as  nominee of  DTC.   Investors'  interests  in the  Global
Securities will be represented through financial institutions acting on their
behalf as direct  and indirect Participants in  DTC.  As a result,  CEDEL and
Euroclear  will hold positions on behalf  of their participants through their
respective Depositaries, which in  turn will hold such positions  in accounts
as DTC Participants.

    Investors electing  to  hold their  Global  Securities through  DTC  will
follow the  settlement practices applicable  to prior Home  Equity Loan Asset
Backed Certificates  issues.   Investor securities  custody accounts  will be
credited  with  their holdings  against  payment  in  same-day funds  on  the
settlement date.

    Investors electing  to  hold their  Global  Securities through  CEDEL  or
Euroclear  accounts  will  follow  the settlement  procedures  applicable  to
conventional  eurobonds,  except  that  there will  be  no  temporary  global
security  and no "lock-up"  or restricted period.   Global Securities will be
credited to  the securities custody  accounts on the settlement  date against
payment in same-day funds.

SECONDARY MARKET TRADING

    Since the purchaser determines the place of  delivery, it is important to
establish at the time  of the trade where  both the purchaser's and  seller's
accounts  are located to  ensure that settlement  can be made  on the desired
value date.

    Trading between DTC  Participants.  Secondary market trading  between DTC
Participants will  be settled using  the procedures applicable  to prior Home
Equity Loan Asset Backed Certificates issues in same-day funds.

    Trading between  CEDEL and/or Euroclear  Participants.   Secondary market
trading between CEDEL Participants or  Euroclear Participants will be settled
using the procedures applicable to conventional eurobonds in same-day funds.

    Trading  between DTC  seller  and CEDEL  or  Euroclear  purchaser.   When
Global Securities are to be transferred from the account of a DTC Participant
to  the account  of  a  CEDEL Participant  or  a Euroclear  Participant,  the
purchaser  will send  instructions  to CEDEL  or  Euroclear through  a  CEDEL
Participant  or Euroclear  Participant at  least  one business  day prior  to
settlement.  CEDEL or Euroclear  will instruct the respective Depositary,  as
the case  may be, to receive the Global  Securities against payment.  Payment
will include interest accrued on the Global Securities from and including the
last coupon payment  date to and excluding the settlement  date, on the basis
of the  actual number of  days in such accrual  period and a  year assumed to
consist  of 360 days.   For transactions settling  on the 31st  of the month,
payment will include interest accrued  to and excluding the first day  of the
following month.   Payment will then be made by  the respective Depositary of
the  DTC Participant's  account against  delivery of  the Global  Securities.
After settlement has  been completed, the Global Securities  will be credited
to the respective  clearing system and by the clearing  system, in accordance
with  its  usual   procedures,  to  the  CEDEL   Participant's  or  Euroclear
Participant's  account.    The securities  credit  will appear  the  next day
(European time) and the cash debt will be back-valued to, and the interest on
the Global  Securities will accrue from,  the value date (which  would be the
preceding day  when settlement occurred in  New York).  If  settlement is not
completed on the intended  value date (i.e., the  trade fails), the CEDEL  or
Euroclear cash debt will be valued instead as of the actual settlement date.

    CEDEL  Participants  and   Euroclear  Participants  will  need   to  make
available to the respective clearing  systems the funds necessary to  process
same-day  funds  settlement.  The  most  direct  means  of  doing  so  is  to
preposition  funds for settlement, either from cash on hand or existing lines
of credit,  as  they would  for  any  settlement occurring  within  CEDEL  or
Euroclear.  Under this approach, they may take on credit exposure to CEDEL or
Euroclear until the Global Securities are credited to their accounts one  day
later.

    As  an alternative, if CEDEL  or Euroclear has extended  a line of credit
to  them, CEDEL  Participants  or  Euroclear Participants  can  elect not  to
preposition  funds and allow  that credit line  to be drawn  upon the finance
settlement.     Under  this  procedure,   CEDEL  Participants   or  Euroclear
Participants purchasing Global Securities  would incur overdraft charges  for
one  day, assuming they cleared the overdraft when the Global Securities were
credited to their accounts.  However, interest on the Global Securities would
accrue from the  value date.  Therefore, in many  cases the investment income
on the Global Securities earned  during that one-day period may substantially
reduce or offset the  amount of such overdraft charges, although  this result
will depend on each CEDEL Participant's or Euroclear Participant's particular
cost of funds.

    Since the settlement  is taking place during New York business hours, DTC
Participants can employ their usual procedures for  sending Global Securities
to the respective European  Depositary for the benefit of  CEDEL Participants
or Euroclear Participants.   The sale proceeds will  be available to the  DTC
seller on the settlement date.  Thus, to the DTC Participants  a cross-market
transaction  will  settle  no  differently  than  a  trade  between  two  DTC
Participants.

    Trading  between CEDEL  or Euroclear  Seller and DTC  Purchaser.   Due to
time  zone  differences in  their  favor,  CEDEL Participants  and  Euroclear
Participants may employ their customary procedures for  transactions in which
Global Securities are  to be transferred by  the respective clearing  system,
through the  respective Depositary, to  a DTC Participant.   The  seller will
send  instructions  to CEDEL  or  Euroclear through  a  CEDEL  Participant or
Euroclear  Participant at  least one  business day prior  to settlement.   In
these cases  CEDEL or Euroclear  will instruct the respective  Depositary, as
appropriate,  to  deliver  the  Global Securities  to  the  DTC Participant's
account against payment.  Payment will include interest accrued on the Global
Securities from and  including the last coupon  payment to and excluding  the
settlement date  on the basis  of the actual number  of days in  such accrual
period and a year assumed to consist of 360 days.  For transactions  settling
on  the  31st of  the month,  payment will  include  interest accrued  to and
excluding the first day  of the following  month.  The  payment will then  be
reflected in the  account of the CEDEL  Participant or Euroclear  Participant
the  following  day,  and   receipt  of  the  cash  proceeds  in   the  CEDEL
Participant's or Euroclear Participant's account would be  back-valued to the
value date (which would be the preceding day, when settlement occurred in New
York).  Should the CEDEL Participant or Euroclear  Participant have a line of
credit with  its  respective clearing  system  and elect  to  be in  debt  in
anticipation  of receipt  of  the sale  proceeds  in its  account, the  back-
valuation will  extinguish any overdraft  incurred over that  one-day period.
If settlement is not  completed on the intended  value date (i.e., the  trade
fails), receipt of the cash proceeds in the  CEDEL Participant's or Euroclear
Participant's account  would instead be  valued as  of the actual  settlement
date.

    Finally, day  traders  that  use CEDEL  or  Euroclear and  that  purchase
Global Securities from DTC Participants for delivery to CEDEL Participants or
Euroclear Participants should note that these trades would automatically fail
on  the  sale side  unless affirmative  action were  taken.   At  least three
techniques should be readily available to eliminate this potential problem:

    (a) borrowing through CEDEL or Euroclear for one day (until  the purchase
side of  the day trade is reflected in their  CEDEL or Euroclear accounts) in
accordance with the clearing system's customary procedures;

    (b) borrowing the Global  Securities in  the U.S. from a  DTC Participant
no  later  than one  day prior  to settlement,  which  would give  the Global
Securities  sufficient time  to  be  reflected in  their  CEDEL or  Euroclear
account in order to settle the sale side of the trade; or

    (c) staggering the value  dates for the buy and  sell sides of  the trade
so that the value date for the purchase  from the DTC Participant is at least
one  day prior to  the value date  for the  sale to the  CEDEL Participant or
Euroclear Participant.

CERTAIN U.S. FEDERAL INCOME TAX DOCUMENTATION REQUIREMENTS

    A beneficial owner of Global Securities  holding securities through CEDEL
or Euroclear (or through DTC  if the holder has an address outside  the U.S.)
will be  subject to the  30% U.S. withholding  tax that generally  applies to
payments of interest  (including original issue discount)  on registered debt
issued  by U.S.  Persons,  unless (i)  each  clearing system,  bank  or other
financial institution that holds customers' securities in the ordinary course
of its  trade  or  business  in  the chain  of  intermediaries  between  such
beneficial owner and  the U.S. entity required to  withhold tax complies with
applicable  certification requirements and  (ii) such beneficial  owner takes
one of the following steps to obtain an exemption or reduced tax rate:

    Exemption  for non-U.S. Persons (Form  W-8).  Beneficial owners of Global
Securities that are non-U.S. Persons can obtain a complete exemption from the
withholding tax by filing a signed Form W-8 (Certificate  of Foreign Status).
If the information shown on  Form W-8 changes, a new  Form W-8 must be  filed
within 30 days of such change.

    Exemption  for non-U.S. Persons  with effectively  connected income (Form
4224).  A non-U.S. Person,  including a non-U.S.  corporation or bank  with a
U.S. branch, for which the interest income  is effectively connected with its
conduct of a trade or business in the  United States, can obtain an exemption
from the  withholding tax by filing Form  4224 (Exemption from Withholding of
Tax on Income  Effectively Connected with the Conduct of  a Trade or Business
in the United States).

    Exemption  or  reduced  rate  for  non-U.S. Persons  resident  in  treaty
countries (Form 1001).  Non-U.S. Persons that are Certificate Owners residing
in  a country  that has  a tax treaty  with the  United States  can obtain an
exemption or reduced tax rate (depending on the treaty terms) by  filing Form
1001  (Ownership,  Exemption or  Reduced Rate  Certificate).   If  the treaty
provides only  for a reduced  rate, withholding tax  will be imposed  at that
rate unless the filer alternatively files Form W-8. Form 1001 may be filed by
the Certificate Owners or his agent.

    Exemption  for  U.S. Persons  (Form  W-9).   U.S.  Persons  can  obtain a
complete  exemption  from the  withholding tax  by  filing Form  W-9 (Payer's
Request for Taxpayer Identification Number and Certification).

    U.S. Federal Income Tax Reporting Procedure.   The Certificate Owner of a
Global  Security or, in  the case of  a Form 1001  or a Form  4224 filer, his
agent, files by submitting the appropriate form to the person through whom it
holds (the  clearing agency, in the  case of persons holding  directly on the
books  of the  clearing agency).   Form W-8  and Form 1001  are effective for
three calendar years and Form 4224 is effective for one calendar year.

    The term  "U.S. Person"  means (i) a  citizen or  resident of the  United
States, (ii) a corporation or  partnership organized in or under the  laws of
the United States or any political subdivision thereof or (iii) an estate the
income of which is includible in gross income for United States tax purposes,
regardless of its source or (iv) a  trust if a court within the United States
is able  to exercise primary supervision over the administration of the trust
and one  or  more  United  States trustees  have  authority  to  control  all
substantial decisions  of the trust.   This  summary does not  deal with  all
aspects  of U.S.  federal  income tax  withholding  that may  be  relevant to
foreign holders of the Global Securities.   Investors are advised to consult
their own tax advisors for specific tax advice concerning their holding  and 
disposing of the Global Securities.

      No  dealer,  salesman  or  other
  person  has been authorized  to give
  any  information  or   to  make  any
  representation   not   contained  in
  this  Prospectus Supplement  or  the               PROVIDENT HOME
  Prospectus  and, if  given or  made,         EQUITY LOAN TRUST 199__-__
  such  information  or representation
  must not  be relied  upon as  having
  been  authorized by  the  Company or
  (Underwriter).      This  Prospectus                $___________
  Supplement  and  the  Prospectus  do                (Approximate)
  not  constitute  an  offer  of   any
  securities  other   than  those   to
  which  they  relate or  an  offer to
  sell, or a solicitation of  an offer
  to  buy,  to   any  person  in   any              Home Equity Loan
  jurisdiction where such an offer  or          Asset Backed Certificates
  solicitation   would   be  unlawful.                Series 199_-_
  Neither   the   delivery   of   this
  Prospectus   Supplement   and    the
  Prospectus   nor   any   sale   made
  hereunder    shall,    under     any             THE PROVIDENT BANK
  circumstances,      create       any       Transferor and Master Servicer
  implication  that  the   information
  contained  herein  is correct  as of
  any   time   subsequent   to   their
  respective dates.
                                           ___________________________________

            TABLE OF CONTENTS                   PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT
                                 Page            ___________, 199_
                                 ----      ___________________________________
  PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT
  Summary . . . . . . . . . . .   S-3
  Risk Factors  . . . . . . . .   S-16
  The Certificate Insurer . . .   S-18              (UNDERWRITER)
  The Master Servicer . . . . .   S-18
  The Home Equity Loan Program    S-19
  Description of the Mortgage 
    Loans . . . . . . . . . . .   S-21
  Maturity and Prepayment
   Considerations . . . . . . .   S-28
  Pool Factor and Trading 
   Information . . . . . . . . .  S-30
  Description of the Certificates S-30
  Use of Proceeds . . . . . . .   S-48
  Federal Income Tax Consequences S-49
  State Taxes . . . . . . . . .   S-51
  ERISA Considerations  . . . .   S-52
  Legal Investment Considerations S-52
  Underwriting  . . . . . . . .   S-52
  Legal Matters . . . . . . . .   S-53
  Experts . . . . . . . . . . .   S-53
  Ratings . . . . . . . . . . .   S-53
  Index of Defined Terms  . . .   S-54
  Annex I . . . . . . . . . . .   S-57

  PROSPECTUS
  Prospectus  Supplement   or  Current
  Report on Form 8K . . . . . . .    2
  Available Information . . . . .    2
  Incorporation  of Certain
    Documents by Reference. . . .    2
  Reports to Securityholders  . .    3
  Summary of Terms  . . . . . . .    4
  Risk Factors  . . . . . . . . .   11
  The Trust Fund  . . . . . . . .   17
  Use of Proceeds . . . . . . . .   21
  Loan Program  . . . . . . . . .   22
   
  The Provident Bank  . . . . . . . .
    
  Description of the Securities .   24
  Credit Enhancement  . . . . . .   38
  Yield and Prepayment 
    Considerations  . . . . . . .   43
  The Agreements  . . . . . . . .   45
  Certain Legal Aspects of 
    the Loans . . . . . . . . . .   57
  Federal Income Tax Consequences   71
  State Tax Considerations  . . .   90
  ERISA Considerations  . . . . .   90
  Legal Investment  . . . . . . .   93
  Method of Distribution  . . . .   94
  Legal Matters . . . . . . . . .   95
  Financial Information . . . . .   95
  Ratings . . . . . . . . . . . .   95
  Index of Defined Terms  . . . .   97

INFORMATION CONTAINED HEREIN IS SUBJECT TO COMPLETION OR AMENDMENT. A
REGISTRATION STATMENT RELATING TO THESE SECURITIES HAS BEEN FILED WITH THE
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION.  THESE SECURITIES MAY NOT BE SOLD NOR
MAY OFFERS TO BUY BE ACCEPTED PRIOR TO THE TIME THE REGISTRATION STATEMENT
BECOMES EFFECTIVE.  THIS PROSPECTUS SHALL NOT CONSTITUTE AN OFFER TO SELL OR
THE SOLICITATION OF AN OFFER TO BUY NOR SHALL THERE BE ANY SALE OF THESE
SECURITIES IN ANY STATE IN WHICH SUCH OFFER, SOLICITATION, OR SALE WOULD BE
UNLAWFUL PRIOR TO REGISTRATION OR QUALIFICATION UNDER THE SECURITIES LAWS OF
ANY SUCH STATE.

   
                SUBJECT TO COMPLETION, DATED FEBRUARY 20, 1997
    

PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT
(TO PROSPECTUS DATED (_____________)

                                $            

                  (PROVIDENT HOME EQUITY LOAN TRUST 199___)
$              CLASS A-1      % CERTIFICATES 
$              CLASS A-2      % CERTIFICATES
$              CLASS A-3      % CERTIFICATES
$              CLASS A-4      % CERTIFICATES
$              CLASS A-5      % CERTIFICATES)
$              CLASS A-6 VARIABLE RATE CERTIFICATES

                 HOME EQUITY LOAN ASSET-BACKED CERTIFICATES,
                                SERIES 199___
                              ------------------
                             THE PROVIDENT BANK,
                        AS SELLER AND MASTER SERVICER
                              ------------------

   
     The  Home Equity Loan  Asset-Backed Certificates, Series  _________ (the
"Certificates"),  will consist  of six  Classes (each,  a "Class")  of senior
Certificates:  the Class  A-1 Certificates,  the Class A-2  Certificates, the
Class  A-3   Certificates,  the  Class   A-4  Certificates,  the   Class  A-5
Certificates  and  Class   A-6  Certificates  (collectively,  the   "Class  A
Certificates")  and one  Class  of subordinated  Certificates  (the "Class  R
Certificates").  Only  the Class A Certificates (the  "Offered Certificates")
are being offered hereby.
    

     The  Certificates will evidence  in the aggregate  the entire beneficial
interest  in  a   pool  (the  "Mortgage  Pool")  of   closed-end  fixed-  and
adjustable-rate home  equity loans (the  "Mortgage Loans") consisting  of two
groups  ("Loan Group 1"  and "Loan Group  2", respectively, and  each a "Loan
Group") held by (Provident Home Equity Loan Trust 199___) (the "Trust") to be
formed pursuant to a Pooling and Servicing Agreement among The Provident Bank
("Provident"), as seller  (the "Seller") and as master  servicer (the "Master
Servicer"),  and  ________________________________________, as  trustee  (the
"Trustee").  The  Class A-1, Class  A-2, Class A-3, Class  A-4 and Class  A-5
Certificates  (collectively,  the  "Group  1  Certificates")  will  represent
undivided  ownership interests  in Loan  Group 1  which consists  of Mortgage
Loans with fixed  interest rates.  The  Class A-6 Certificates (the  "Group 2
Certificates") will represent  undivided ownership interests in  Loan Group 2
which consists of Mortgage Loans with adjustable interest rates.   The assets
of the Trust  will also include certain  other property.  The  Mortgage Loans
are secured by first and second deeds of trust or mortgages primarily on one-
to four-family residential properties. 
                                               (Cover continued on next page)
                              ------------------
   
        PROSPECTIVE INVESTORS SHOULD REVIEW THE INFORMATION SET FORTH
           UNDER "RISK FACTORS" ON PAGE S-14 HEREIN AND ON PAGE 12
                       IN THE ACCOMPANYING PROSPECTUS.
    
                              ------------------
 THE CERTIFICATES REPRESENT INTERESTS IN THE TRUST ONLY AND DO NOT REPRESENT
          INTERESTS IN OR OBLIGATIONS OF PROVIDENT, THE TRUSTEE OR
         ANY AFFILIATE THEREOF, EXCEPT TO THE EXTENT PROVIDED HEREIN.
           NEITHER THE CERTIFICATES NOR THE MORTGAGE LOANS ARE IN-
               SURED OR GUARANTEED BY ANY GOVERNMENTAL AGENCY.
                                       
 THESE SECURITIES HAVE NOT BEEN APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED BY THE SECURITIES AND
      EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION NOR HAS THE
       SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COM-
             MISSION PASSED UPON THE ACCURACY OR ADEQUACY OF THIS
                 PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT OR THE PROSPECTUS. ANY
                     REPRESENTATION TO THE CONTRARY IS A
                              CRIMINAL OFFENSE.

     The Offered Certificates are being  offered by the Underwriter from time
to  time in  negotiated transactions  or  otherwise at  varying prices  to be
determined, in each case, at the time of sale.

     The  aggregate  proceeds to  Provident  from  the  sale of  the  Offered
Certificates  will be approximately  $       , plus accrued  interest, before
deducting expenses  payable by  Provident, estimated to  be $          in the
aggregate.
                              ------------------

   
     The Offered Certificates  are offered subject to prior  sale and subject
to the  Underwriter's right  to reject  orders in whole  or in  part.   It is
expected that delivery of the Offered Certificates will be made in book-entry
form only through the facilities of The Depository Trust Company, CEDEL Bank, 
societe anonyme, and  the Euroclear  System  on or  about (__________)  (the
"Closing Date").  The Offered Certificates will  be offered in Europe and the
United States of America.
    
                              ------------------

                                (Underwriter)


(Date)

(Cover continued from previous page)

   
     Distributions on  the Class A Certificates will be  made on the 25th day
of  each month  or, if such  date is  not a  Business Day,  then on  the next
succeeding   Business  Day  (each,  a  "Distribution  Date"),  commencing  in
_____________.    On   each  Distribution  Date,  holders  of   the  Class  A
Certificates will be entitled  to receive, from and to the  limited extent of
funds  available  in  the  Distribution  Account  (as  defined  herein  under
"Description  of   the  Certificates--Deposits  to  Collection   Account  and
Distribution  Account"), distributions with respect to interest and principal
calculated  as set  forth herein.    The Certificates  are not  guaranteed by
Provident, the Trustee or any affiliate of any thereof.  However, the Class A
Certificates  will have  the  benefit  of  an irrevocable  and  unconditional
certificate  guaranty  insurance   policy  (the  "Policy")  issued   by  (the
"Certificate  Insurer")  pursuant  to  which  the  Certificate  Insurer  will
guarantee payments  to the  related Certificateholders  as described  herein.
See "DESCRIPTION OF THE CERTIFICATES--The Policy" herein.

     The effective yield  to the Certificateholders of each Class  of Group I
Certificates  will  be  lower  than  the  yield  otherwise  produced  by  the
Certificate  Rate  for  each  such  Class  and  the  purchase price  of  such
Certificates   because   distributions   will   not   be   payable   to   the
Certificateholders  until the  25th day of  the month following  the month of
accrual (without any additional distribution  of interest or earnings thereon
in respect of such delay).  See "PREPAYMENT AND YIELD CONSIDERATIONS--Payment
Delay Feature of Group I Certificates."
    

     There  is currently no market for the Offered Certificates and there can
be no assurance that such a market will develop or if it does develop that it
will continue.  See "RISK FACTORS" herein.

     An election  will be made to  treat the assets  of the Trust as  a "real
estate  mortgage  investment conduit"  (a  "REMIC")  for federal  income  tax
purposes.  As described more fully herein  and in the Prospectus, the Offered
Certificates will constitute "regular interests"  in the REMIC.  See "Certain
Federal Income Tax Consequences" in the Prospectus.

                     ------------------------------------

     Until  ninety days  after the  date of  this Prospectus  Supplement, all
dealers effecting transactions  in the Offered  Certificates, whether or  not
participating in this  distribution, may be required to  deliver a Prospectus
Supplement and Prospectus.  This is in addition to the obligation  of dealers
acting as underwriters to deliver a Prospectus Supplement and Prospectus with
respect to their unsold allotments or subscriptions.

                     ------------------------------------

     The Offered  Certificates constitute part  of a separate series  of Home
Equity Loan  Asset-Backed Certificates  being offered  by The Provident  Bank
from  time to  time  pursuant to  its  Prospectus dated  ____________.   This
Prospectus  Supplement  does  not  contain  complete  information  about  the
offering of the Offered Certificates.  Additional information is contained in
the Prospectus and investors are urged to read both this Prospectus Supplement
and the Prospectus in full.  Sales of the Offered Certificates may not be 
consummated unless the purchaser has received both this Prospectus Supplement
and the Prospectus.

               INCORPORATION OF CERTAIN DOCUMENTS BY REFERENCE

     There  are incorporated  herein  by  reference  all documents  filed  by
Provident with the  Commission pursuant to Sections 13(a), 13(c), 14 or 15(d)
of the 1934 Act, on or subsequent to the date of this Prospectus and prior to
the termination of  the offering  of the  Offered Certificates  made by  this
Prospectus Supplement.  Provident will  provide without charge to each person
to whom this  Prospectus Supplement and Prospectus are  delivered, on request
of such  person, a copy of any or all of the documents incorporated herein by
reference other than the exhibits to such documents (unless such exhibits are
specifically incorporated by reference in  such documents).  Requests  should
be directed to ______________________________________________________.


                                   SUMMARY

     The following summary  of certain pertinent information is  qualified in
its entirety by reference to  the detailed information appearing elsewhere in
this  Prospectus   Supplement  and   the  accompanying   Prospectus.  Certain
capitalized  terms  used  in  the  Summary  are  defined  elsewhere  in  this
Prospectus Supplement or in  the Prospectus.  Reference is made  to the Index
of Defined Terms herein and the Glossary  of Terms in the Prospectus for  the
definitions of certain capitalized terms.

Trust          (Provident Home Equity  Loan Trust 199___) (the  "Trust") will
               be formed pursuant  to a pooling and servicing  agreement (the
               "Agreement") to be dated as of _________________ (the "Cut-Off
               Date") among The Provident Bank, ("Provident"), as seller (the
               "Seller")  and as master servicer (together with any successor
               in    such    capacity,    the    "Master   Servicer"),    and
               ________________________  ________________,  as  trustee  (the
               "Trustee").  The property of the Trust will include: a pool of
               closed-  end fixed- and adjustable-rate home equity loans (the
               "Mortgage Loans"), secured by first and second deeds  of trust
               or mortgages on residential properties that are primarily one-
               to  four-family   properties  (the   "Mortgaged  Properties");
               payments  in respect  of the  Mortgage Loans  received on  and
               after  the Cut-Off Date  (exclusive of payments  in respect of
               interest on the  Mortgage Loans due prior to  the Cut-Off Date
               and  received thereafter);  property that  secured a  Mortgage
               Loan which has been acquired by foreclosure or deed in lieu of
               foreclosure; rights  under certain  hazard insurance  policies
               covering the Mortgaged Properties; and certain other property,
               as  described more fully  herein.  In  addition, Provident has
               caused the  Certificate Insurer  to issue  an irrevocable  and
               unconditional   financial  guaranty   insurance  policy   (the
               "Policy")  for the  benefit  of  the holders  of  the Class  A
               Certificates, pursuant  to which the Certificate  Insurer will
               guarantee  payments to  such  Certificateholders as  described
               herein.

   
               The  Trust property  initially will  include  the unpaid  
               principal balance of each Mortgage Loan as of the Cut-Off Date.
               With respect to any  date, the  "Pool Principal  Balance" will
               be equal to  the aggregate of the Principal Balances of 
               all Mortgage Loans  as of such  date.  The "Cut-Off  Date 
               Principal Balance" with respect to each Mortgage Loan is the 
               unpaid principal balance thereof as of the Cut-Off Date.  With
               respect to  any date, the  "Loan  Group  1  Principal  Balance"
               and  the  "Loan  Group  2 Principal Balance" will be equal  to
               the aggregate of the Principal Balances of all  Mortgage Loans
               in Loan  Group 1 and Loan  Group 2, respectively, as of such 
               date.  The Loan Group 1 Principal  Balance and the Loan Group 2
               Principal Balance are each sometimes referred to  herein as  a
               "Loan  Group Principal  Balance."   The "Principal Balance" of
               a Mortgage Loan (other than a Liquidated Mortgage Loan) 
               collections  applied in  reduction of  the  Cut-Off Date  
               Principal Balance  of  such  Mortgage  Loan.   The  Principal
               Balance  of  a Liquidated Mortgage Loan  (as defined herein 
               under  "Description of the  Certificates--Principal") after the
               Due Period in  which such Mortgage Loan becomes a Liquidated 
               Mortgage Loan shall be zero.
    

Securities          The  Home Equity  Loan Asset-Backed  Certificates, Series
                    199___  (the "Certificates") will  consist of six Classes
                    of senior  certificates: the Class A-1  Certificates, the
                    Class A-2  Certificates, the Class  A-3 Certificates, the
                    Class A-4  Certificates, the  Class A-5  Certificates and
                    the  Class A-6  Certificates (collectively, the  "Class A
                    Certificates") and one Class of subordinated certificates
                    (the  "Class  R   Certificates").    Only  the   Class  A
                    Certificates  (the  "Offered Certificates")  are  offered
                    hereby.   Each Class  of Offered  Certificates represents
                    the right to  receive payments of  interest at the  rates
                    set forth on the cover  hereof (with respect to each such
                    Class,  the  "Certificate  Rate"), payable  monthly,  and
                    payments of principal to the extent provided below.   The
                    Class A-1, Class A-2, Class  A-3, Class A-4 and Class A-5
                    Certificates (collectively,  the "Group  1 Certificates")
                    will  represent  undivided  ownership  interests in  Loan
                    Group  1  which  consists of  Mortgage  Loans  with fixed
                    interest rates.  The Class A-6 

          Certificates (the "Group 2 Certificates")  will represent undivided
          ownership interests  in  Loan Group  2 which  consists of  Mortgage
          Loans  with adjustable  interest rates.    The aggregate  undivided
          interest in the Trust represented by the Class A Certificates as of
          the Cut-Off  Date will  equal $                  of principal  (the
          "Original Aggregate  Class A  Principal Balance").   The  aggregate
          undivided  interest in  Loan Group  1  represented by  the Group  1
          Certificates  as of the  Cut-Off Date will  equal $              of
          principal.   The  aggregate  undivided interest  in  Loan  Group  2
          represented by  the Class A-3  Certificates as of the  Cut-Off Date
          will equal $        of principal.   The principal amount of a Class
          of Class  A Certificates (each,  a "Class A Principal  Balance") on
          any date  is equal to  the applicable Class A  Principal Balance on
          the   Closing  Date  minus   the  aggregate  of   amounts  actually
          distributed as  principal to the holders  of such Class  of Class A
          Certificates.   On  any  date,  the "Aggregate  Class  A  Principal
          Balance"  is,  with  respect  to  the  Group  1  Certificates,  the
          aggregate  of  the  Class  A  Principal Balances  of  the  Group  1
          Certificates  and with  respect to  the  Group 2  Certificates, the
          Class A-6 Principal Balance on such date.

The Mortgage Loans       The Mortgage Loans are expected to consist of $     
                         in  principal  amount  of  closed-end  fixed-  and
                         adjustable-rate home  equity loans secured  by first
                         and  second deeds of trust or mortgages on Mortgaged
                         Properties located  in  states and  the District  of
                         Columbia.  The Combined  Loan-to-Value Ratio of each
                         Mortgage  Loan, computed on  the date such  loan was
                         originated, taking  into account the amounts  of any
                         related   senior  mortgage   loans  (the   "Combined
                         Loan-to-Value Ratio") did  not exceed       %  as of
                         the  Cut-Off Date.   The  weighted  average original
                         Combined Loan-to-Value  Ratio of the  Mortgage Loans
                         was      % as of the Cut-Off Date.  See "DESCRIPTION
                         OF THE  MORTGAGE LOANS"  herein.   Interest on  each
                         Mortgage Loan is payable  monthly on the outstanding
                         Principal Balance thereof  at a rate per  annum (the
                         "Loan Rate") specified in the related Mortgage Note.
                         As of the Cut-Off Date, the Loan Rates  ranged from
                              % to      % per annum and the weighted average 
                         Loan Rate was       % per annum.  The Cut-Off Date 
                         Principal Balances of the Mortgage  Loans ranged  
                         from $          to  $               and averaged 
                         $            .   Each Mortgage Loan was  originated 
                         in the period from            to               .

                         Loan Group  1.  All of the Mortgage Loans in Loan 
                         Group 1 have Loan Rates which are fixed for  the life
                         of such Mortgage Loans.   As of the Cut-Off  Date, 
                         there are  ___ Mortgage  Loans in Loan  Group 1.  The
                         aggregate Principal Balance of the Mortgage Loans in
                         Loan Group 1 was  $_____________ (the  "Cut-Off Date
                         Loan  Group 1  Principal Balance").   As of the  
                         Cut-Off Date with  respect to the  Mortgage Loans  in
                         Loan  Group   1,  the  average  Principal   Balance  
                         was $_________;  the  Loan  Rates  ranged  from  ____%
                         to _____%;  the weighted  average Loan  Rate  was  
                         ______%;  the  weighted  average Combined 
                         Loan-to-Value Ratio was       %; and the weighted  
                         average remaining term  to stated maturity  was ___ 
                         months.   The remaining terms to  stated maturity  of 
                         the  Mortgage Loans in  Loan Group  1 ranged from ___
                         months to ___ months.   The original term to stated
                         maturity of each Mortgage Loan in Loan Group 1 was 
                         ___ months.  The maximum Principal Balance of the 
                         Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 1 was $__________ and 
                         the minimum Principal Balance of the Mortgage Loans
                         in  Loan Group  1 was  $________.   Approximately
                                  %  of the Mortgage Loans  in Loan  Group 
                         1  are Balloon  Loans.   All of  the Balloon Loans 
                         amortize  over ___ months.  No Mortgage  Loan in Loan
                         Group 1 will mature later than               .

          Loan Group  2.  All of the Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 1 have Loan
          Rates which are subject to  adjustment based on changes in (LIBOR),
          as  further discussed  under "DESCRIPTION  OF  THE MORTGAGE  LOANS"
          herein.  As of the Cut-Off Date,  there are _____ Mortgage Loans in
          Loan  Group 2.   The  aggregate Principal  Balance of  the Mortgage
          Loans in Loan  Group 2 was $______________ (the  "Cut-Off Date Loan
          Group 2 Principal Balance").   As of the Cut-Off  Date with respect
          to the Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 2, the average Principal Balance
          was $_________; the Loan Rates ranged from  ____% to _____%; the 
          weighted average  Loan Rate was _____%; the weighted average 
          Combined Loan-to-Value Ratio  was      %;  and the weighted average
          remaining term  to stated  maturity was  ___ months.   The remaining
          terms  to stated maturity  of the Mortgage Loans  in Loan Group 2 
          ranged from ___ months to ___ months.  The original term to
          stated maturity each Mortgage Loan in Loan Group  2 was ___ months.
          The maximum Principal Balance of the Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 2
          was $__________ and  the minimum Principal Balance of  the Mortgage
          Loans in Loan Group 2 was $________.  None of the Mortgage Loans in
          Loan Group 2 are Balloon Loans.   No Mortgage Loan in Loan Group  2
          will mature later than                  .

          As of the Cut-Off Date,  approximately     % of  the Mortgage Loans
          in Loan Group 2 are secured by first  liens and approximately     %
          of the Mortgage Loans in Loan Group  2 are secured by second liens.
          All of the  Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 2 have minimum and maximum
          Loan Rates.  The weighted average minimum Loan Rate of the Mortgage
          Loans  in Loan  Group 2 is  approximately        %  per annum, with
          minimum Loan Rates that range from approximately    % per annum to 
           %  per annum.   The  weighted  average maximum  Loan  Rate of  the
          Mortgage  Loans in Loan Group 2 is approximately       % per annum,
          with maximum  Loan Rates that range from  approximately       % per
          annum to      % per annum.  The Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 2 have
          a weighted average  gross margin of approximately     %  per annum,
          with gross margins that  range from approximately       % per annum
          to      % per annum.   The  Mortgage Loans in  Loan Group 2  have a
          weighted average periodic cap of approximately    % per annum, with
          periodic  caps that range from approximately       % per annum to  
          % per annum.

          See "DESCRIPTION OF THE MORTGAGE LOANS" herein.

Denominations       The Class A Certificates will be  offered for purchase in
                    denominations of  $1,000 and  multiples of  $1 in  excess
                    thereof.



Registration of
Class A Certificates
   
                              The Class  A  Certificates  will  initially  be
                              issued in  book-entry form.   Persons acquiring
                              beneficial ownership interests  in the Class  A
                              Certificates ("Certificate  Owners") will  hold
                              their Class A Certificate interests through The
                              Depository Trust Company ("DTC"), in the United
                              States, or Cedel Bank societe anonyme ("CEDEL")
                              or  the  Euroclear   System  ("Euroclear"),  in
                              Europe.    Transfers   within  DTC,  CEDEL   or
                              Euroclear,  as  the  case may  be,  will  be in
                              accordance with  the usual rules  and operating
                              procedures  of the relevant system.  So long as
                              the   Class  A   Certificates  are   Book-Entry
                              Certificates   (as    defined   herein    under
                              "Description  of  the  Certificates--Book-Entry
                              Certificates"),  such   Certificates  will   be
                              evidenced   by   one   or   more   Certificates
                              registered  in the name of Cede & Co. ("Cede"),
                              as the  nominee of DTC  or one of  the relevant
                              depositaries   (collectively,   the   "European
                              Depositaries").  Cross-market transfers between
                              persons holding directly  or indirectly through
                              DTC,  on  the   one  hand,  and  counterparties
                              holding directly or indirectly through CEDEL or
                              Euroclear,  on the other,  will be  effected in
                              DTC  through  Citibank   N.A.  ("Citibank")  or
                              Chemical   Bank   ("Chemical"),   the  relevant
                              depositaries    of    CEDEL    and   Euroclear,
                              respectively, and  each a  participating member
                              of    DTC.        The    interests   of    such
                              Certificateholders  will   be  represented   by
                              book-entries   on  the   records  of   DTC  and
                              participating members thereof.   No Certificate
                              Owner will be entitled to receive a  definitive
                              certificate    representing    such    person's
                              interest, except in  the event that  Definitive
                              Certificates   (as    defined   herein    under
                              "Description  of  the  Certificates--Book-Entry
                              Certificates")  are  issued under  the  limited
                              circumstances described herein.  All references
                              in this  Prospectus Supplement  to any Class  A
                              Certificates reflect the  rights of Certificate
                              Owners  only as  such rights  may be  exercised
                              through DTC and its participating organizations
                              for  so long as  such Class A  Certificates are
                              held  by DTC.    See "RISK  FACTORS--Book-Entry
                              Certificates", "DESCRIPTION OF THE CERTIFICATES
                              --Book-Entry Certificates" herein and "ANNEX I"
                              hereto.
    

Provident
   
               The  Provident Bank, an Ohio banking corporation (the "Seller"
               or  the "Master  Servicer"  as  applicable).    The  principal
               executive  offices of  the  Seller  and  Master  Servicer  are
               located  at One  East Fourth  Street,  Cincinnati, Ohio  45202
               (Telephone: (513) 579-2000).  See  "THE PROVIDENT BANK" in the
               Prospectus.
    

Certificate Rate
   
                         The "Certificate Rate" on any Distribution Date with
                         respect to  the Class A-1 Certificates  is     % per
                         annum; the Class A-2 Certificates is    % per annum;
                         the Class  A-3 Certificates is     %  per annum; the
                         Class A-4 Certificates is      % per annum; and  the
                         Class  A-5 Certificates  is      %  per annum.   The
                         "Certificate  Rate" on  any  Distribution Date  with
                         respect to the Class A-6 Certificates will equal the
                         least of (A)  the sum of the LIBOR  Rate (as defined
                         herein under  "DESCRIPTION OF  THE CERTIFICATES--The
                         Certificate  Rate")  plus ____%  (or ____%  for each
                         Distribution Date  occurring after the date on which
                         the Master Servicer  has the right to  terminate the
                         Trust),  (B) the Net Funds Cap for such Distribution
                         Date and (C)  ____% per annum.  The  "Net Funds Cap"
                         for any Distribution Date shall equal the difference
                         between  (A) the average  of the  Loan Rates  of the
                         Mortgage Loans in  Loan Group 2 as of  the first day
                         of   the   month   preceding  the   month   of  such
                         Distribution Date,  weighted  on the  basis  of  the
                         related Principal Balances  as of such date  and (B)
                         the sum of (i) the Master Servicing Fee Rate and the
                         rate  at which  the  Trustee  Fee  and  the  premium
                         payable to  the Certificate  Insurer are  calculated
                         and (ii) commencing with the thirteenth Distribution
                         Date, 0.50%.   Interest on the Group  1 Certificates
                         in respect  of  any Distribution  Date  will  accrue
                         during  each Interest  Period  on  the  basis  of  a
                         360-day  year consisting  of  twelve 30-day  months.
                         Interest on the  Group 2 Certificates in  respect of
                         any  Distribution  Date  will  accrue  during   each
                         Interest Period on  the basis of a 360-day  year and
                         the actual number of days elapsed.
    

          "Interest Period" means, with respect to each Distribution Date and
          the Group  1 Certificates,  the period from  the first  day of  the
          calendar  month preceding  the  month  of  such  Distribution  Date
          through the  last day  of such calendar  month.   "Interest Period"
          means,  with respect  to each  Distribution  Date and  the Group  2
          Certificates, the period  from the Distribution  Date in the  month
          preceding the  month of such Distribution Date  (or, in the case of
          the first Distribution Date, from the Closing Date) through the day
          before such Distribution Date.

Distributions:      On the 25th day of each month, or if such a day is not  a
                    Business  Day,  then the  next  succeeding Business  Day,
                    commencing   in   ____________   (each   such   day,    a
                    "Distribution  Date"), the  Trustee will  be  required to
                    distribute   from   funds  available   therefor   in  the
                    Distribution Account (as described herein) to the holders
                    of  the  Offered   Certificates  of  record  as   of  the
                    applicable  Record  Date,  in  the  priorities  described
                    below, an  aggregate amount equal  to the sum of  (a) the
                    Class  Interest  Distribution for  each Class  of Offered
                    Certificates, and  (b) the Class A Principal Distribution
                    for  each  Certificate  Group.   So  long  as  an Insurer
                    Default has not  occurred and is continuing,  the Class A
                    Principal   Distribution   relating   to   the  Group   1
                    Certificates will  be distributed,  sequentially, to  the
                    Class A-1, Class A-2, Class  A-3, Class A-4 and Class A-5
                    Certificates, in that  order, such that no Class of Group
                    1 Certificates having a  higher numerical designation  is
                    entitled  to distributions of principal until the Class A
                    Principal  Balance of  each  such  Class of  Certificates
                    having  a lower numerical designation has been reduced to
                    zero.  On any Distribution Date during the continuance of
                    an  Insurer Default,  the Class A  Principal Distribution
                    relating  to the Group 1 Certificates will be distributed
                    to the  Group 1  Certificates outstanding on  a pro  rata
                    basis in accordance with the Class A Principal Balance of
                    each  such Class.   The  Class  A Principal  Distribution
                    relating  to the Group 2 Certificates will be distributed
                    to the Class A-6 

          Certificates.  See "DESCRIPTION OF THE CERTIFICATES--Distributions"
          herein.

          Interest

          On  each  Distribution  Date,  to the  extent  of  funds  available
          therefor as  described herein,  interest will  be distributed  with
          respect to each Class of Class A Certificates in an amount (each, a
          "Class Interest Distribution") equal to  the sum of (a) one month's
          interest at  the related  Certificate Rate on  the related  Class A
          Principal  Balance immediately prior to such Distribution Date (the
          "Class  Monthly Interest Distributable  Amount") and (b)  any Class
          Interest Carryover Shortfall for such Class of Class A Certificates
          for such Distribution Date.  As  to any Distribution Date and Class
          of Class A Certificates, Class  Interest Carryover Shortfall is the
          sum  of  (i) the  excess  of  the  related Class  Monthly  Interest
          Distributable  Amount for the  preceding Distribution Rate  and any
          outstanding Class Interest Carryover Shortfall with respect to such
          Class  on such  preceding  Distribution Date,  over  the amount  in
          respect of interest  that is actually distributed to  such Class on
          such preceding Distribution Date plus (ii) one month's  interest on
          such  excess,  to the  extent  permitted  by  law, at  the  related
          Certificate Rate.

          On each Distribution Date, the Class Interest Distribution for each
          Class  of Class  A Certificates in  a particular  Certificate Group
          will  be distributed on an equal  priority and any shortfall in the
          amount required to be distributed  as interest thereon to each such
          Class will  be allocated between such Classes pro rata based on the
          amount each such  Class would have been distributed  in the absence
          of such shortfall.

          Principal


          On each  Distribution  Date,  to  the  extent  of  funds  available
          therefor as described  herein, principal will be distributed to the
          holders of  the Class  A Certificates of  a Certificate  Group then
          entitled to distributions of principal in an amount equal to the 
          lesser of (A) the related Aggregate Class A  Principal Balance and 
          (B) the related Class A Principal Distribution for such Distribution
          Date.  "Class  A Principal Distribution"  means, with respect to any 
          Distribution Date  and Certificate Group, the sum of the related 
          Class A Monthly Principal Distributable Amount for such Distribution
          Date and  any outstanding Class A  Principal Carryover Shortfall as
          of the close of the preceding Distribution Date.

          "Class  A  Monthly  Principal  Distributable  Amount"  means,  with
          respect to  any Distribution  Date and  Certificate  Group, to  the
          extent of funds available therefor  as described herein, the amount
          equal to the  sum of  the following  amounts (without  duplication)
          with respect  to the immediately  preceding Due Period  (as defined
          below): (i) each  payment of  principal on a  Mortgage Loan in  the
          related Loan Group received by  the Master Servicer during such Due
          Period,  including all full and partial principal prepayments, (ii)
          the Principal  Balance as of  the end of the  immediately preceding
          Due Period  of each Mortgage  Loan in the  related Loan Group  that
          became a  Liquidated Mortgage  Loan for the  first time  during the
          related  Due  Period,  (iii)  the portion  of  the  Purchase  Price
          allocable  to principal of all repurchased Defective Mortgage Loans
          in the related Loan Group with respect to such Due Period, (iv) any
          Substitution  Adjustment  Amounts  received  on  or  prior  to  the
          previous Determination Date and not yet distributed with respect to
          the related Loan Group and (v) such portion (not greater than 100%)
          of  Excess  Spread (as  defined  below),  if  any, required  to  be
          distributed on such Distribution Date to satisfy the required level
          of  overcollateralization for  the  related  Loan  Group  for  such
          Distribution Date (the "Distributable Excess Spread").

          If  the required level  of overcollateralization for  a Certificate
          Group    is   reduced   below   the   then   existing   amount   of
          overcollateralization (described below) or if the required level of
          overcollateralization for such Certificate Group is satisfied, the 
          amount  of  the  related Class  A  Monthly  Principal Distributable
          Amount on the  following Distribution Date will  be correspondingly
          reduced by the amount of such reduction or  by the amount necessary
          such  that the overcollateralization  will not exceed  the required
          level of overcollateralization for a Certificate Group after giving
          effect to the distribution in  respect of principal with respect to
          such Certificate Group to be made on such Distribution Date.

          "Due Period"  means,  with respect  to  any Determination  Date  or
          Distribution  Date, the calendar  month immediately  preceding such
          Determination Date or Distribution Date, as the case may be.

          For a description of a "Liquidated  Mortgage Loan" see "DESCRIPTION
          OF THE CERTIFICATES--Principal" herein.

   
          "Excess Spread" means,  with respect to  any Distribution Date  and
          Loan Group, the positive excess, if any, of (x) Available Funds (as
          defined herein under "Description  of the Certificates--Deposits to
          the  Distribution Account") for  the related Certificate  Group for
          such  Distribution   Date  over  (y)  the  amount  required  to  be
          distributed pursuant  to subclause A  items (i) through  (iv), with
          respect  to the  Group 1  Certificates  and subclause  B items  (i)
          through (iv),  with respect  to the Group  2 Certificates,  in each
          case set  forth under  the heading  "DESCRIPTION OF  CERTIFICATES--
          Priority   of   Distributions"    on   such   Distribution    Date.
          Distributions  of Excess  Spread relating  to a  Loan Group  to the
          holders  of Class A  Certificates of the  related Certificate Group
          will result in acceleration of principal payments to the holders of
          such  Class A  Certificates  creating overcollateralization  to the
          extent  required by  the Agreement.    This feature  will have  the
          effect  of reducing  the  weighted  average lives  of  the Class  A
          Certificates.         See     "DESCRIPTION    OF     CERTIFICATES--
          Overcollateralization   Provisions"  and   "PREPAYMENT  AND   YIELD
          CONSIDERATIONS" herein.
    

          The  last scheduled  Distribution Date  for  each Class  of Offered
          Certificates is as follows: Class  A-1 Certificates,
                                ;  Class A-2 Certificates,                ; 
          Class A-3 Certificates,                  ; Class A-4 Certificates,
                         ; Class A-5 Certificates,            ;  and Class 
          A-6 Certificates,                  .  It is expected that the  
          actual last Distribution Date for  each Class of Offered  
          Certificates will  occur significantly  earlier than  such scheduled
          Distribution   Dates.     See   "PREPAYMENT  AND   YIELD
          CONSIDERATIONS."

Overcollateralization         The credit enhancement  provisions of the Trust
                              result in a limited acceleration of the Class A
                              Certificates of a Certificate Group relative to
                              the amortization  of the Mortgage Loans  in the
                              related Loan Group  in the early months  of the
                              transaction.   The accelerated  amortization is
                              achieved  by the  application of  Excess Spread
                              relating   to   a  Loan   Group   to  principal
                              distributions on  the Class  A Certificates  of
                              the   related   Certificate    Group.      This
                              acceleration feature  creates, with  respect to
                              each  Certificate Group,  overcollateralization
                              (i.e., the excess  of the aggregate outstanding
                              Principal Balance  of the Mortgage Loans in the
                              related Loan  Group over the  related Aggregate
                              Class A Principal Balance).   Once the required
                              level of overcollateralization is reached for a
                              Certificate   Group,   and   subject   to   the
                              provisions described in the next paragraph, the
                              acceleration feature for such Certificate Group
                              will  cease, until  necessary  to maintain  the
                              required  level  of  overcollateralization  for
                              such Certificate Group.

          The  Agreement will provide  that, subject to  certain floors, caps
          and  triggers,  the required  level  of overcollateralization  with
          respect to a Certificate Group  may increase or decrease over time.
          An  increase in the  required level of  overcollateralization for a
          Certificate  Group  will  result  if  the  delinquency  or  default
          experience on the Mortgage Loans  in the related Loan Group exceeds
          certain  levels  set  forth  in  the Agreement.    In  that  event,
          amortization  of  the   related  Class  A  Certificates   would  be
          accelerated  relative to  the  Mortgage Loans  until  the level  of
          overcollateralization reaches its  required level.   The required 
          level  of overcollateralization may be decreased under certain  
          circumstances, which will slow  the amortization of the Class A 
          Certificates of the related Certificate Group relative to the 
          Mortgage Loans.

          See "PREPAYMENT AND  YIELD CONSIDERATIONS" and "DESCRIPTION  OF THE
          CERTIFICATES--Overcollateralization Provisions."

Crosscollateralization        In  addition  to the  foregoing,  the Agreement
                              provides for crosscollateralization through the
                              application of  Excess Spread generated  by one
                              Loan  Group  to  fund  shortfalls in  Available
                              Funds  in  the  other  Loan  Group,  subject to
                              certain  prior requirements  of such  Available
                              Funds.  See "DESCRIPTION  OF THE CERTIFICATES--
                              Priority of Distributions"  and "PREPAYMENT AND
                              YIELD CONSIDERATIONS."

The Policy          The Policy will unconditionally and irrevocably guarantee
                    principal payments (as described in the next sentence) on
                    the Class A Certificates plus accrued and unpaid interest
                    due on  the Class A  Certificates.  On  each Distribution
                    Date, a draw will be made on the Policy equal to  the sum
                    of (a) the  amount by which  interest accrued during  the
                    applicable Interest Period at the applicable  Certificate
                    Rate  for  each Class  of  Class  A Certificates  on  the
                    related outstanding Class A Principal Balance exceeds the
                    amount on  deposit in the Distribution  Account available
                    to  be distributed therefor on such Distribution Date and
                    (b)  with respect to  each Certificate Group,  the amount
                    (each, a "Guaranteed Principal Amount"), if any, by which
                    the  Aggregate  Class  A  Principal  Balance exceeds  the
                    related Loan Group  Principal Balance at  the end of  the
                    previous  month  (after  giving  effect  to  all  amounts
                    distributable and  allocable to principal on  the related
                    Class  A Certificates  on such  Distribution  Date).   In
                    addition, the Policy  will guarantee the payment  in full
                    of  the applicable Aggregate Class A Principal Balance to
                    the Group 1  Certificates and the Group 2 Certificates on
                    the Distribution Date in               and              ,
                    respectively (after giving effect to all  other amounts 
                    distributable and allocable  to principal on such Classes
                    on such Distribution Date).

                    In   the  absence   of   payments  under   the   Policy,
                    Class   A Certificateholders  will directly bear  the 
                    credit and  other risks associated  with  their undivided
                    interest  in  the  Trust.    See "DESCRIPTION OF THE 
                    CERTIFICATES--The Policy," herein.

The Certificate Insurer       (______________________________________________
                              __________)(the  "Certificate  Insurer").   See
                              "DESCRIPTION OF  THE CERTIFICATES--The  Policy"
                              and "THE CERTIFICATE INSURER" herein.

   
(Pre-Funding Account          On  the Closing  Date,  $__________ (the  "Pre-
                              Funded Amount") will be deposited in an account
                              (the  "Pre-Funding  Account"),   which  account
                              shall be in the name  of and maintained by  the
                              Trustee and shall be part of the Trust Fund and
                              will  be used  to  acquire Subsequent  Mortgage
                              Loans.   During  the  period beginning  on  the
                              Closing Date  and terminating  on ____________,
                              19__  (the  "Funding Period"),  the  Pre-Funded
                              Amount  will be  maintained in  the Pre-Funding
                              Account.  The Pre-Funded Amount will be reduced
                              during the Funding Period by the amount thereof
                              used to  purchase Subsequent Mortgage  Loans in
                              accordance with the Agreement.   Any Pre-Funded
                              Amount  remaining at  the  end  of the  Funding
                              Period  will be  distributed to holders  of the
                              classes  of  Certificates entitled  to  receive
                              principal on the Distribution Date in  ________
                              19__  in reduction  of the  related Certificate
                              Principal Balances, thus resulting in a partial
                              principal    prepayment    of    the    related
                              Certificates on such date.

Capitalized Interest
Account        On the Closing Date there will be deposited in an account (the
               "Capitalized  Interest  Account") maintained  with and  in the
               name of  the Trustee on behalf of the  Trust Fund a portion of
               the  proceeds of  the sale  of the  Certificates.   The amount
               deposited  therein  will  be  used  by  the  Trustee   on  the
               Distribution Dates in __________ 19__, __________, 19__ and 
               __________ 19__ to cover shortfalls in interest on the 
               Certificates that may arise  as a result of  the utilization 
               of  the Pre-Funding Account for the  purchase by the Trust 
               Fund  of Subsequent Mortgage Loans  after  the Closing  Date.
               Any  amounts remaining  in  the Capitalized Interest Account  
               at the end of the  Funding Period are required to be paid 
               directly to Provident.)
    

Servicing      The   Master  Servicer  will  be  responsible  for  servicing,
               managing and making  collections on the  Mortgage Loans.   The
               Master Servicer will deposit all collections in respect of the
               Mortgage  Loans  into  the  Collection  Account  as  described
               herein.    On  the  eighteenth  day  of  the  month  (each,  a
               "Determination Date"), the Trustee will calculate the  amounts
               to be paid, as described  herein, to the Certificateholders on
               the  next  Distribution   Date.    See  "DESCRIPTION   OF  THE
               CERTIFICATES--Priority  of Distributions."    With respect  to
               each  Due  Period,  the  Master  Servicer  will  receive  from
               payments  in respect  of interest  on the  Mortgage  Loans, on
               behalf  of itself,  a portion  of such  payments as  a monthly
               servicing fee (the "Master Servicing Fee") in the amount of   
               % per annum (the "Master Servicing Fee Rate") on the Principal
               Balance of each Mortgage Loan as of the first day of each such
               Due Period.   See "DESCRIPTION OF THE  CERTIFICATES--Servicing
               Compensation and  Payment of  Expenses."   In certain  limited
               circumstances, the Master  Servicer may resign or  be removed,
               in  which event either  the Trustee or  a third-party servicer
               will  be  appointed   as  successor  master  servicer.     See
               "DESCRIPTION  OF THE  CERTIFICATES--Certain Matters  Regarding
               the Master Servicer" herein.

Trustee        (______________________________________),  a _________________
               (the "Trustee").

Monthly Advances         (The Master  Servicer is  required to  remit to  the
                         Trustee no  later than  two Business  Days prior  to
                         each   Distribution   Date,  for   deposit   in  the
                         Distribution  Account,   an  amount  equal   to  the
                         scheduled installment of  interest and principal due
                         on each Mortgage Loan but not received by the Master
                         Servicer during the related Due Period  (a  "Monthly
                         Advance").   Such  obligation  of the  Master 
                         Servicer continues  with respect to  each Mortgage 
                         Loan  until such Mortgage Loan  becomes  a Liquidated
                         Mortgage  Loan.   The  Master Servicer  is not  
                         required to  make any  Monthly Advances  which it
                         determines   would  be  nonrecoverable.     Monthly
                         Advances  are reimbursable to the  Master Servicer 
                         subject to  certain conditions and restrictions, 
                         and are intended to provide sufficient funds  for
                         the  payment  of  interest  on  the Class  A  
                         Certificates.)    See "DESCRIPTION OF THE 
                         CERTIFICATES--ADVANCES" herein.

Prepayment Interest
Shortfalls          Not  later  than  the  Determination  Date,   the  Master
                    Servicer is required to remit to the Trustee, without any
                    right  of reimbursement, an amount equal to, with respect
                    to  each Mortgage Loan as to which a principal prepayment
                    in  full was received during  the related Due Period, the
                    lesser of (a) the excess, if any, of 30 days' interest on
                    the Principal Balance of such  Mortgage Loan at the  Loan
                    Rate (or at such lower rate as  may be in effect for such
                    Mortgage Loan because of application of the Soldiers' and
                    Sailors' Civil Relief Act of 1940, as amended (the "Civil
                    Relief  Act")), minus the  Master Servicing Fee  for such
                    Mortgage Loan over  the amount of interest  actually paid
                    by  the   related  Mortgagor  in   connection  with  such
                    principal prepayment  (with respect to all  such Mortgage
                    Loans, the "Prepayment  Interest Shortfall") and  (b) the
                    sum of the aggregate Master Servicing Fee received by the
                    Master Servicer in the most recently ended Due Period.

          Civil Relief  Act Interest  Shortfalls will not  be covered  by the
          Policy, although Prepayment Interest  Shortfalls, after application
          of  the Master  Servicing  Fee  will be  so  covered.   The  Master
          Servicer is not obligated to offset any of the Master Servicing Fee
          against, or to provide any other  funds to cover, any shortfalls in
          interest collections on the Mortgage Loans that are attributable to
          the application of the Civil Relief Act ("Civil Relief Act Interest
          Shortfalls").  See  "RISK FACTORS--Payments on the  Mortgage Loans"
          herein.


Optional Termination by the
Master Servicer          The Master  Servicer may,  at its option,  terminate
                         the Agreement  on any  date on  which the  aggregate
                         Principal Balance of the Mortgage Loans is less than
                         5% of the Cut-Off Date Pool Principal Balance at the
                         price  described  herein under  "DESCRIPTION  OF THE
                         CERTIFICATES--Termination;    Retirement   of    the
                         Certificates."

Certain Federal Tax
Considerations      For federal income tax purposes, the Trust created by the
                    Agreement  will be  treated as  a  "real estate  mortgage
                    investment conduit" ("REMIC").   In the opinion of Brown
                    & Wood LLP, tax counsel to Provident ("Tax Counsel") the
                    Class A Certificates
                    will constitute "regular interests" in the REMIC and will
                    be treated  as debt instruments of the  REMIC for federal
                    income  tax purposes with payment terms equivalent to the
                    terms of  such Certificates.   The  Class R  Certificates
                    (the "Residual  Certificates") will  constitute the  sole
                    class of  "residual interests" in  the REMIC and  will be
                    the Class of  Residual Certificates, as described  in the
                    Prospectus.

          The holders of the Offered Certificates will be required to include
          in income  interest on  such  Certificates in  accordance with  the
          accrual method of accounting.

          The Offered Certificates  may, depending on  their issue price,  be
          treated  as having  been  issued with  original issue  discount for
          federal income tax purposes.  For further information regarding the
          federal  income  tax  consequences  of  investing  in  the  Offered
          Certificates,  see  "CERTAIN  FEDERAL  INCOME  TAX  CONSIDERATIONS"
          herein  and  "CERTAIN  FEDERAL  INCOME  TAX  CONSEQUENCES"  in  the
          Prospectus.

ERISA Considerations          The  acquisition of an Offered Certificate by a
                              pension  or  other  employee  benefit  plan  (a
                              "Plan")  subject  to  the  Employee  Retirement
                              Income  Security   Act  of  1974,   as  amended
                              ("ERISA"), could, in some  instances, result in
                              a "prohibited  transaction" or  other violation
                              of the  fiduciary responsibility  provisions of
                              ERISA and Code Section 4975.  Certain exemptions
                              from   the  prohibited   transaction  rules   
                              could  be applicable to the  acquisition of such
                              Offered Certificates.   Any Plan  fiduciary  
                              considering   whether  to  purchase any Offered
                              Certificate on behalf of a Plan should consult 
                              with its counsel regarding the applicability of
                              the provisions  of ERISA  and the Code.

                              Subject to the considerations and conditions 
                              described under "ERISA CONSIDERATIONS" herein,
                              it is expected that the Offered Certificates may
                              be purchased by a Plan.

Legal Investment
Considerations      The  Offered Certificates  will not  constitute "mortgage
                    related  securities"  for   purposes  of  the   Secondary
                    Mortgage  Market  Enhancement  Act  of  1984   ("SMMEA"),
                    because some of the Mortgages securing the Mortgage Loans
                    are not first mortgages.   Accordingly, many institutions
                    with  legal  authority  to  invest  in  comparably  rated
                    securities based  solely on  first mortgages  may not  be
                    legally authorized to invest in the Offered Certificates.
                    See "LEGAL  INVESTMENT CONSIDERATIONS" herein  and "LEGAL
                    INVESTMENT" in the Prospectus.

Certificate Rating       It is  a condition to  the issuance  of the  Offered
                         Certificates that they receive  ratings of "AAA"  by
                         __________________________   and   _____   by   ____
                         _________________________________________________.
                         In general, ratings  address credit risk and  do not
                         address  the   likelihood  of   prepayments.     See
                         "RATINGS" herein  and "RISK  FACTORS--Rating of  the
                         Securities" in the Prospectus.


                                 RISK FACTORS

   
     Consequences  on  Liquidity  and  Payment  Delay  of  Owning  Book-Entry
Certificates.   Issuance of the  Offered Certificates in book-entry  form may
reduce the  liquidity of  such Certificates in  the secondary  trading market
since investors may  be unwilling to purchase Offered  Certificates for which
they cannot obtain  physical certificates. Since transactions  in the Offered
Certificates   can  be   effected  only   through   DTC,  CEDEL,   Euroclear,
participating  organizations, indirect  participants  and certain  banks, the
ability of a Certificate Owner to pledge an Offered Certificate to persons or
entities that do  not participate in  the DTC, CEDEL  or Euroclear system  or
otherwise to take actions in respect of such Certificates, may be limited due
to lack  of  a physical  certificate representing  the Offered  Certificates.
Certificate   Owners  may   experience  some  delay   in  their   receipt  of
distributions  of interest  and principal  on the Offered  Certificates since
such distributions  will be  forwarded by  the Trustee  to DTC  and DTC  will
credit such  distributions to  the accounts of  its Participants  (as defined
herein under  "DESCRIPTION  OF  THE  CERTIFICATES--Book-Entry  Certificates")
which  will thereafter  credit them  to  the accounts  of Certificate  Owners
either  directly   or  indirectly   through  indirect   participants.     See
"DESCRIPTION OF THE CERTIFICATES--Book-Entry Certificates" herein.

     Cash Flow Considerations and Risks of Shortfall.  With respect to      %
of the Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 1 (by Cut-Off Date Loan Group 1 Principal
Balance), collections  on such Mortgage  Loans may vary because,  among other
things, borrowers are not required to make monthly payments of principal that
will  be  sufficient  to  amortize  such Mortgage  Loans  by  their  maturity
(collectively, "Balloon Loans").   The ability of  a borrower to make  such a
payment may depend  on the ability of  the borrower to obtain  refinancing of
the  balance due on a Balloon  Loan.  An increase  in interest rates over the
Loan Rate applicable at  the time a Balloon Loan  was originated may have  an
adverse effect on the borrower's ability to  obtain refinancing or to pay the
required monthly  payment.  Collections on  the Mortgage Loans may  also vary
due to seasonal purchasing and payment habits of borrowers.
    

     With respect to  certain Balloon Loans, general credit  risk may also be
greater  to holders  of Group 1  Certificates than to  holders of instruments
representing  interests  in  level payment  fully  amortizing  first mortgage
loans.  Even assuming that the Mortgaged Properties provide adequate security
for the Mortgage Loans, substantial delays could be encountered in connection
with  the liquidation  of Mortgage  Loans that  are delinquent  and resulting
shortfalls   in  distributions  to  Certificateholders  could  occur  if  the
Certificate Insurer were unable to  perform its obligations under the Policy.
Further, liquidation  expenses (such  as legal fees,  real estate  taxes, and
maintenance and  preservation expenses) will  reduce the proceeds  payable to
Certificateholders and  thereby reduce the  security for the  Mortgage Loans.
In  the  event  any of  the  Mortgaged Properties  fail  to  provide adequate
security for the related Mortgage  Loans, Certificateholders  could experience
a loss if  the Certificate Insurer were unable to perform its obligations under
the Policy.

   
     Risk of  Early Defaults Due  to Recent Origination  and Lack of  Payment
History.  All of the Mortgage Loans were originated within 12 months prior to
the Cut-Off Date.  The weighted average remaining term to stated  maturity of
the Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 1 and Loan Group 2 as of the Cut-Off Date is
approximately    months and    months, respectively.  Although little data is
available, defaults on mortgage loans, including home equity loans similar to
the Mortgage Loans, are generally expected to occur with greater frequency in
the early years of the terms of mortgage loans.

     Prepayment Considerations  and Effect on Yield to  Maturity and Weighted
Average Life of Certificates.   All of the  Mortgage Loans may be prepaid  in
whole  or in part  at any time.   However, approximately __%  of the Mortgage
Loans are  subject to  prepayment penalties which  vary from  jurisdiction to
jurisdiction.   Home  equity loans,  such as  the Mortgage  Loans, have  been
originated in significant volume only during the past few years and Provident
is not aware of any publicly  available studies or statistics on the rate  of
prepayment of  such loans.   Generally, home equity  loans are not  viewed by
borrowers  as  permanent  financing.   Accordingly,  the  Mortgage  Loans may
experience  a higher rate of prepayment than  traditional loans.  The Trust's
prepayment experience may be affected by a wide variety of factors, including
general  economic conditions, interest rates, the availability of alternative
financing and homeowner  mobility.  In  addition, all of  the Mortgage  Loans
contain due-on-sale  provisions and the  Master Servicer will be  required by
the Agreement to enforce such provisions  unless (i) such enforcement is  not
permitted  by  applicable law  or  (ii)  the  Master  Servicer, in  a  manner
consistent with reasonable commercial practice,  permits the purchaser of the
related  Mortgaged Property  to  assume the  Mortgage  Loan.   To the  extent
permitted by  applicable law, such  assumption will not release  the original
borrower from  its obligation  under any  such Mortgage Loan.   See  "CERTAIN
LEGAL  ASPECTS  OF  LOANS--Due-on-Sale  Clauses in  Mortgage  Loans"  in  the
Prospectus.

     Certificate  Rating  Based  Primarily on  Claims-Paying  Ability  of the
Certificate  Insurer.   The rating  of the  Offered Certificates  will depend
primarily on an assessment by the  Rating Agencies of the Mortgage Loans  and
upon the claims-paying ability of the  Certificate Insurer.  Any reduction in
a rating  assigned to  the claims-paying ability  of the  Certificate Insurer
below the rating  initially given to the Offered Certificates may result in a
reduction in  the rating  of the  Offered Certificates.   The  rating by  the
Rating  Agencies of  the  Offered  Certificates is  not  a recommendation  to
purchase, hold or sell the Offered Certificates, inasmuch as such rating does
not comment as to the market price or suitability for a  particular investor.
There is no  assurance that the  ratings will remain in  place for any  given
period of time or that the ratings will not be lowered or withdrawn by the 
Rating Agencies.  In general, the ratings address credit risk and do not 
address the likelihood of prepayments.  The  ratings of  the Offered  
Certificates do  not address  the possibility of the  imposition of United 
States withholding  tax with respect to non-U.S. persons.

     Nature of  Collateral and  Possible Shortfall.   Even assuming  that the
Mortgaged  Properties provide  adequate  security  for  the  Mortgage  Loans,
substantial delays could be encountered in connection with the liquidation of
Mortgage Loans that  are delinquent and resulting shortfalls in distributions
to Class  A Certificateholders  could occur if  the Certificate  Insurer were
unable to  perform its  obligations under the  Policy.   Further, liquidation
expenses  (such  as  legal  fees,  real estate  taxes,  and  maintenance  and
preservation expenses) will reduce the proceeds payable to Certificateholders
and thereby reduce the security for the  Mortgage Loans.  In the event any of
the Mortgaged  Properties fail to  provide adequate security for  the related
Mortgage Loans,  Class A  Certificateholders could experience  a loss  if the
Certificate Insurer were unable to perform its obligations under the Policy.
    

     The Mortgage Loans are secured by first and second mortgages or deeds of
trust (representing approximately      % and      % of the Cut-Off  Date Pool
Principal  Balance of  the Mortgage  Loans, respectively).   With  respect to
Mortgage Loans that are junior in  priority to liens having a first  priority
with respect  to the related  Mortgaged Property ("First Liens"),  the Master
Servicer  has  the power  under  certain circumstances  to consent  to  a new
mortgage lien on  such Mortgaged Property having priority  over such Mortgage
Loan in  connection with the refinancing of such  First Lien.  Mortgage Loans
secured  by second  mortgages are entitled  to proceeds that  remain from the
sale of the related Mortgaged Property after any related senior mortgage loan
and  prior statutory  liens have  been  satisfied.   In the  event  that such
proceeds are  insufficient  to satisfy  such  loans and  prior liens  in  the
aggregate and  the Certificate Insurer  is unable to perform  its obligations
under the  Policy, the Trust  and, accordingly, the  Certificateholders, bear
(i) the risk  of delay in distributions  while a deficiency  judgment against
the borrower is sought  and (ii) the risk of loss  if the deficiency judgment
cannot be  obtained or is not realized  upon.  See "CERTAIN  LEGAL ASPECTS OF
LOANS" in the Prospectus.

     Legal Considerations.  The sale of the Mortgage Loans from the Seller to
the  Trust will  be treated by  the Seller  and the  Trust as  a sale  of the
Mortgage Loans.  The Seller will warrant that such transfer is a  sale of its
interest in the Mortgage Loans.  In the event of an insolvency of the Seller,
it is  possible that  a receiver or  conservator for, or  a creditor  of, the
Seller, may argue that the transaction between the Seller and the Trust, with
respect  to  the  Mortgage Loans  was  a  pledge of  such  Mortgage  Loans in
connection  with a borrowing by the Seller rather  than a true sale.  Such an
attempt, even if unsuccessful, could result in delays in distributions on the
Offered Certificates.

     (The  terms of  the  Agreement  provide that  the  Seller will  maintain
possession of the documentation relating to each Mortgage Loan (the "Mortgage
File"), and no assignment of any Mortgage  is required to be recorded in  the
name of  the Trustee, unless an  Assignment Event occurs.  Within  30 days of
any such occurrence, the Seller, at  its expense, is required to deliver  the
Mortgage File  to the Trustee and to either  cause proper assignments of each
Mortgage to be  recorded, at its expense,  or to deliver assignments  of each
Mortgage, in  recordable form, to  the Trustee, together  with an  opinion of
counsel to the  effect that recordation of such  assignments in not necessary
in order to perfect the  interests of the Trust in such Mortgages.   Prior to
delivery and recording,  the interest  of the Trustee  in the Mortgages,  the
Mortgage Notes  and the  proceeds thereof  may be  subject to  the claims  of
creditors  or  to sale  to  a  third  party, as  well  as  to a  receiver  or
conservator appointed in the event of the insolvency of the Seller.

     An  "Assignment Event" will occur  on the 30th  day following either (i)
the occurrence and continuance of an Event  of Default, (ii) the reduction of
the Seller's long-term unsecured debt rating below "Baa2" by Moody's or "BBB"
by S&P or  (iii) the suspension,  termination or  withdrawal of the  Seller's
long-term unsecured debt rating by Moody's or S&P.

     In an  insolvency proceeding of the  Seller, if the  Mortgage Notes have
not been delivered to the Trustee and the Mortgages have not been assigned of
record  in the  real property recording  office, the  Trust may be  a general
unsecured creditor  of the  Seller.   If the  Trust were  determined to  be a
general unsecured creditor  of the Seller, the Mortgages,  the Mortgage Notes
and the  proceeds thereof  would not  be available  to make  payments on  the
Offered Certificates.)

   
     Payments  on  the Mortgage  Loans  and  Effect  of Reduced  Payments  of
Interest on the Mortgage Loans.  When a principal prepayment  in full is made
on a Mortgage Loan, the Mortgagor is charged interest only  up to the date of
such prepayment, instead of for a full month which may result in a Prepayment
Interest Shortfall.   The Master  Servicer is obligated  to pay, without  any
right  of reimbursement, those shortfalls  in interest collections payable on
the  Class  A  Certificates  that are  attributable  to  Prepayment  Interest
Shortfalls,  but only  to the  extent  of the  Master Servicing  Fee  for the
related Due Period  (any such payment, "Compensating Interest").   The Master
Servicing Fee  will not  be available  to cover  any  shortfalls in  interest
collections on the  Mortgage Loans that are attributable to  Civil Relief Act
Interest  Shortfalls.   Civil  Relief  Act Interest  Shortfalls  will not  be
covered   by  payments  under   the  Policy,  although   Prepayment  Interest
Shortfalls, after application of the Master Servicing Fee as described above,
will be so covered.
    

     Underwriting  Standards.  As described herein, the Seller's underwriting
standards generally  are  less stringent  than those  of FNMA  or FHLMC  with
respect to a borrower's credit history and in certain other respects.   A 
borrower's past  credit history may  not preclude the  Seller  from  making a
loan;  however,  it will  reduce  the  size (and consequently the Combined 
Loan-to-Value Ratio) of the loan that the Seller is willing to make.   As a 
result of this approach to underwriting, the Mortgage Loans  in the  Mortgage
Pool  may experience  higher rates  of delinquencies, defaults  and  
foreclosures  than  mortgage  loans  underwritten  in  a  more traditional 
manner.

     (Geographic Concentration.   The  Mortgaged Properties  relating to  the
Mortgage  Loans  are located  in  __ states  and  the  District of  Columbia.
However, most of the  Mortgaged Properties are located in  (state or region).
Certain regions  of the country,  including (state or region),  recently have
experienced a severe decline in real estate values.  Approximately      % and
   % (by aggregate principal balance as of the Cut-Off Date) of the Mortgaged
Properties relating to the Mortgage Loans are located in          and        
 , respectively.  To the extent that (state or region) has experienced or may
experience  in the  future weaker  economic  conditions or  greater rates  of
decline  in  real estate  values than  the  United States  generally,  such a
concentration  of  the Mortgage  Loans  may  be  expected to  exacerbate  the
foregoing risks.   The Seller can neither  quantify the impact of  any recent
property value declines  on the Mortgage  Loans nor predict whether,  to what
extent or for how long such declines may continue.)

   
     (Subsequent  Mortgage Loans.   The  ability  of the  Seller to  purchase
mortgage loans subsequent to the date hereof and on or prior to ____________,
19__ that meet the requirements for transfer during the  Funding Period under
the Agreement is affected by a variety of factors, including interest  rates,
unemployment  levels,  the  rate  of  inflation and  consumer  perception  of
economic  conditions generally.    On the  Distribution Date  in ____________
19__, a principal prepayment will be made to the holders of  the Certificates
in the amount which represents  the excess of the original Pre-Funded  Amount
over the Principal Balance of all Subsequent Mortgage Loans as of the related
Cut-Off Date (i.e., the balance on deposit in the Pre-Funding Account on such
date (net  of investment  earnings)).  Although  no assurances can  be given,
Provident intends that  no material principal prepayment will  be required to
be  made to  the holders  of  the Certificates  on the  Distribution  Date in
____________ 19__.  Any reinvestment risk resulting from such prepayment will
be borne entirely by the Certificateholders.)
    

     Effect  of Mortgage  Loan Yield  on Class  A-6 Pass-Through  Rate.   The
Certificate  Rate on the Class A-6 Certificates is based upon the value of an
index (one-month  LIBOR)  which is  different  from the  value of  the  index
applicable to the  Mortgage Loans in  Loan Group 2,  as described under  "THE
MORTGAGE POOL--Loan Group  2" (either as a  result of the use of  a different
index, rate determination date, rate adjustment  date or rate cap or  floor).
The Mortgage Loans  in Loan Group  2 adjust semi-annually  based upon a  six-
month LIBOR index, whereas the Certificate Rate on the Class A-6 Certificates
adjusts monthly based  on a one-month LIBOR  index and is limited  by the Net
Funds Cap  (unless the Class A-6 Interest Carryover  (the payment of which is
not insured by the Certificate Insurer and the payment of which is not rated)
are funded in full).  Consequently  the actual Certificate Rate on the  Class
A-6 Certificates  for such Distribution Date may not  equal the rate based on
one-month  LIBOR for  such Distribution  Date.   In particular,  the interest
rates on the Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 2 adjust less  frequently, with the
result that the actual Certificate Rate on the Class A-6 Certificates  may be
lower in a  rising interest rate environment.   In addition, one-month  LIBOR
and the index applicable to the Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 2 may respond to
different  economic and  market factors,  and  there is  not necessarily  any
correlation between  them.  Thus, it is possible, for example, that one-month
LIBOR may rise during periods in  which the index applicable to the  Mortgage
Loans in Loan Group 2 are falling  or that, even if both one-month LIBOR  and
the index applicable  to the Mortgage Loans in  Loan Group 2 rise  during the
same  period,  one-month LIBOR  may  rise much  more  rapidly than  the index
applicable to the Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 2.


                           THE CERTIFICATE INSURER

     The  information  set  forth  in  this  section  and  in  the  financial
statements of the Certificate Insurer set forth in Appendix A and  Appendix B
hereto  have been provided by the Certificate  Insurer.  No representation is
made  by the  Underwriter, the Seller,  the Master  Servicer or any  of their
affiliates as to the accuracy or completeness of any such information.

     _____________ is not obligated to pay the debts of or claims against the
Certificate Insurer.   The Certificate Insurer is  domiciled in the  State of
New  York and licensed  to do  business in  all (50  states, the  District of
Columbia, the Commonwealth  of Puerto Rico, the Commonwealth  of the Northern
Mariana Islands, the Virgin Islands of the United States and the Territory of
Guam).

     The  tables  below   present  selected  financial  information   of  the
Certificate  Insurer  determined  in  accordance  with  statutory  accounting
practices prescribed or permitted by insurance regulatory authorities ("SAP")
and generally accepted accounting principles ("GAAP"):

                                                  SAP
                          December 31, 1996                 Quarterly Report
                              (Audited)                       (Unaudited)
                                            (in millions)

                                                  GAAP
                          December 31, 1996                 Quarterly Report
                              (Audited)                       (Unaudited)
                                              (in millions)

   
     Audited  financial  statements   of  the  Certificate  Insurer  as  of
December  31, 1996 and 1995 and for  each of the  three years in the period
ended  December 31,  1996  are included  herein as  Appendix A.   Unaudited
financial  statements of  the Certificate Insurer  for the (        )-month
period ended (                  ) are included herein as Appendix  B.  Such
financial statements have been prepared on the basis  of generally accepted
accounting principles.   Copies of the  Certificate Insurer's 1996 year-end
audited  financial  statements   prepared  in  accordance   with  statutory
accounting practices are available from the Certificate Insurer.
    

     A  copy  of the  Annual  Report  on Form  10-K  is available  from the
Certificate  Insurer  or  the  Securities  and  Exchange  Commission.   The
a d d r e s s   o f    t h e   C e r t i f i c a t e   I n s u r e r    i s
_______________________________________.

     The  Certificate Insurer  does not  accept any  responsibility for the
accuracy  or  completeness   of  this  Prospectus  or  any  information  or
disclosure  contained herein, or omitted herefrom, other  than with respect
to  the  accuracy   of  the  information  regarding  the  Policy   and  the
Certificate  Insurer  set  forth under  the  headings  "DESCRIPTION OF  THE
CERTIFICATES--The Policy" and in Appendices A and B.

     Moody's Investors  Service, Inc.  rates the claims  paying ability  of
the Certificate Insurer "Aaa".

     Standard & Poor's  Rating Services rates the claims paying  ability of
the Certificate Insurer "AAA".

     Fitch Investors  Service L.P. rates the  claims paying ability of  the
Certificate Insurer "AAA".

     Each   rating  of   the  Certificate   Insurer  should   be  evaluated
independently.  The ratings reflect the respective rating agency's 
current assessment of the creditworthiness  of the Certificate  Insurer and
its  ability  to pay  claims on  its policies  of insurance.    Any further
explanation as  to the significance  of the  above ratings may  be obtained
only from the applicable rating agency.

     The above  ratings are not  recommendations to buy,  sell or hold  the
Certificates, and such ratings may be subject to revision or withdrawal  at
any  time by the  rating agencies.  Any  downward revision or withdrawal of
any of the above ratings may have an adverse effect on the market price  of
the Certificates.   The Certificate  Insurer does  not guaranty the  market
price  of the  Certificates nor  does it guaranty  that the  ratings on the
Certificates will not be revised or withdrawn.


                            THE PROVIDENT BANK

     Provident  will be  responsible for  servicing the Mortgage  Loans for
the  Trust in accordance  with the  terms of the  Agreement.   Beginning on
_______________,   __________________________   (the  "Subservicer")   will
service  the Mortgage  Loans  for  Provident  pursuant  to  a  Subservicing
Agreement,  dated as  of _____________,  199__, between  Provident and  the
Subservicer.   The terms and conditions  of the Subservicing Agreement  are
consistent with and do not  violate the provisions of the Agreement.   Such
subservicing does  not relieve  Provident from  any of  its obligations  to
service  the Mortgage Loan in  accordance with the  terms and conditions of
the Agreement.  See "--Servicing and Collection Procedures."

   
     Provident is  the principal banking  subsidiary of  Provident Bancorp,
Inc., a  Cincinnati based bank  holding company  registered under the  Bank
Holding Company  Act.   Provident Bancorp, Inc.  operates throughout  Ohio,
Northern Kentucky  and Southeastern  Indiana.   As of  September 30,  1996,
Provident Bancorp,  Inc. had total  assets of $____  billion, net  loans of
$_____ billion, deposits of $_____ billion  and total shareholders'  equity
of $____ million.   For the fiscal year ended  December 31, 1995, Provident
Bancorp, Inc.  had net earnings  of $____  million.  At  December 31, 1995,
Provident  Bancorp, Inc.'s tier 1 and total  capital ratios were _____% and
_____%, respectively.   Provident represents approximately 96% of Provident
Bancorp, Inc.'s assets.
    

CREDIT AND UNDERWRITING GUIDELINES

     The  following  is   a  description  of  the  underwriting  guidelines
customarily employed by  Provident with respect to Mortgage Loans  which it
purchases or originates.  Each Mortgage Loan was  underwritten according to
these guidelines.   Provident believes  its standards  are consistent  with
those utilized by home equity lenders generally.   The underwriting process
is intended to assess both the  prospective borrower's ability to repay and
the  adequacy of  the real  property security  as collateral  for the  loan
granted.   In certain cases, loans may be  made outside of those guidelines
with the prior approval of an underwriting manager of Provident.

     Provident generally originates or purchases  loans which either  fully
amortize   over  a  period  not  to   exceed  360  months  or  provide  for
amortization over  a 360 month schedule  with a "balloon" payment  required
at the maturity date, which will not be less than  fifteen (15) years after
origination.  The loan  amounts generally range from  a minimum of  $10,000
to a maximum  of $500,000 unless a  higher amount is specifically  approved
by  a senior  official of  Provident.   Provident  primarily originates  or
purchases non-purchase  money  first  or  second  mortgage  loans  although
Provident also originates certain purchase money first mortgages.

     The  homes used  for  collateral to  secure the  loans  may  be either
primary residential (which includes second and vacation homes) or  investor
owned one- for  four-family homes, condominiums, townhouses or manufactured
housing.   Generally, each  home  must have  a minimum  appraised value  as
described below.  Mobile housing  or agricultural land are not  accepted as
collateral.  In some cases,  the loan may be secured by the  owner-occupied
residence plus additional collateral.

     Each property proposed  as security for  a loan must be  appraised not
more  than six months prior to the  date of such  loan.  The combined loan-
to-value ratio of the first and  second mortgages generally may not  exceed
85%.    If a  prior  mortgage  exists, Provident  first  reviews  the first
mortgage  history.     If  it  contains   open-end,  advance   or  negative
amortization provisions,  the maximum potential  first mortgage  balance is
used  in calculating the  combined loan-to-value ratio which determines the
maximum loan amount.

     For  Provident's full documentation  process, each  mortgage applicant
must provide,  and Provident must  verify, personal  financial information.
The  applicant's total  monthly obligations  (which includes  principal and
interest  on each mortgage,  tax assessments,  other loans, charge accounts
and all  other scheduled indebtedness) generally  cannot exceed 60% of  the
applicant's gross  monthly income.  Applicants  who are salaried  employees
must  provide  current employment  information  in addition  to two  recent
years of  employment  history  and  Provident  verifies  this  information.
Verifications  are  based  on  written  confirmation  from  employers  or a
combination  of the two  most recent pay stubs,  the two most recent years'
W-2 tax forms and telephone confirmation from the  employer.  Self-employed
applicants must  be self-employed in  the same  field for a  minimum of two
years.  The self-employed applicant must provide signed  copies of complete
federal income tax returns (including schedules) filed for  the most recent
two years.

     For  Provident's  non-income  verifier  program,  proof  of  one  year
history  of  employment  plus  proof  of  current  self-employed  status is
required.   The  applicant's debt-to-income  ratio is  calculated  based on
income as  certified  by  the  borrower  on the  application  and  must  be
reasonable.   The maximum combined loan-to-value  ratio may not exceed  80%
for the non-income verifier program.

     A credit report by an independent credit reporting  agency is required
reflecting  the applicant's  complete credit  history.   The  credit report
should  reflect  all  delinquencies of  30  days  or  more,  repossessions,
judgments, foreclosures,  garnishments, bankruptcies,  divorce actions  and
similar  adverse credit  practices that  can be  discovered by  a search of
public records.  If the report  is obtained more than 60 days prior to  the
loan closing, the  lender must determine that the reported  information has
not  changed.   Written  verification is  obtained  of any  first  mortgage
balance if not reported in the credit bureau.

   
     Generally, the  applicant  should have  an  acceptable credit  history
given  the amount  of equity  available, the  strength  of the  applicant's
employment  history  and  the level  of  the  applicant's  income  to  debt
obligations.   The rescission period  (generally, a  period of three  days)
must have  expired prior to funding a loan.  The  rescission period may not
be waived by  the applicant  except as permitted  by law.   Either an  ALTA
title  insurance policy or an  attorney's opinion of  title is required for
all loans.
    

     The applicant  is required to secure  property insurance in an  amount
sufficient  to cover the new  loan and  any prior mortgage.   If the sum of
the outstanding first mortgage,  if any, and  the home equity loan  exceeds
replacement  value, insurance equal  to replacement  value may be accepted.
Provident must ensure that  its name and address is  properly added to  the
"Mortgage Clause" of the  insurance policy.  In the event  Provident's name
is  added to  a "Loss  Payee Clause"  and the policy  does not  provide for
written  notice of  policy changes  or cancellation,  an endorsement adding
such provision is required.

     Provident's  credit underwriting  guidelines  require that  any  major
deferred maintenance  on any property  must be cured  from the proceeds  of
the loan.

SERVICING AND COLLECTION PROCEDURES

     The  following  is  a  description  of  the servicing  and  collection
policies and  procedures customarily and  currently employed  by the Master
Servicer with respect  to its mortgage  loan and servicing portfolio.   The
Master Servicer revises such  policies and procedures from time  to time in
connection with changing economic and market conditions and changing  legal
requirements.

     Centralized controls  and  standards  have  been  established  by  the
Master Servicer for  the servicing and collection of  mortgage loans in its
portfolio.   Servicing  of  the Master  Servicer's  portfolio is  conducted
through its primary  office in San Diego, California.   Servicing includes,
but  is  not  limited  to,   post-origination  loan  processing,   customer
servicer, collections and liquidations.

     The  Master  Servicer's  collection  policy  emphasizes  working  with
borrowers  in default  in an  effort to  bring payments  current and  avoid
foreclosures.   Under the Master  Servicer's current  collection procedures
(which  may  change  from  time  to  time),  collectors  contact  borrowers
according to the following schedule:

       DAYS OF
     DELINQUENCY
     -----------

          7              An initial contact is made  to attempt to  arrange
                         a definite payment arrangement.
          10-20          On the tenth  day of delinquency, if no promise to
                         pay has  been established, a  letter is  sent, and
                         at least three  calls are made within this period,
                         after which  a late charge  is assessed and a late
                         charge notice is mailed.
          20-30          If  the  mortgagor  has  not  been  reached,  skip
                         tracing  begins.     The  credit  application   is
                         consulted for points  of contact.  A credit report
                         is ordered and other creditors are called.
          31             A two  month letter  is mailed.   Follow up  calls
                         are made  on  all accounts  lacking  a promise  to
                         pay.   Property  inspections  are  ordered on  all
                         loans lacking a promise to pay.
          45-50          Demand letters are mailed.
          65-70          Foreclosure  review is performed.  A document file
                         is  assembled  for the  attorney  to  prepare  for
                         foreclosure.     Brokers'   price   opinions   are
                         requested  in order  to determine  property value.
                         If  the  delinquent loan  is  a  second lien,  the
                         first  lienholder  is notified  that  the file  is
                         being prepared for foreclosure.
          75-80          The  file  is referred  to  an  attorney to  begin
                         foreclosure.   All subsequent calls regarding  the
                         loan are referred  to the  attorney.   Foreclosure
                         proceedings are completed  within the  time limits
                         designated by the state.

DELINQUENCY AND LOSS EXPERIENCE

     The following  table  sets  forth  Provident's  delinquency  and  loss
experience  on its  total  home equity  loan  portfolio of  mortgage  loans
similar  to the  Mortgage Loans at  the dates indicated.   There  can be no
assurance that  the delinquency and loss  experience on the Mortgage  Loans
will  be  consistent   with  the  historical  information  provided  below.
Accordingly, this  information should  not  be  considered to  reflect  the
credit quality  of the Mortgage Loans included  in the Trust, or a basis of
assessing the  likelihood, amount  or severity  of losses  on the  Mortgage
Loans.  The statistical  data in the table is based on all  of the loans 
in Provident;s servicing portfolio.  The  Mortgage Loans may, in general, 
be more recently originated  than,  and  are  likely to  have  other  
characteristics  which distinguish them from,  the majority of the loans 
in  Provident's servicing portfolio.

     The  information  in  the  tables  below  has  not  been  adjusted  to
eliminate the effect of the significant  growth in the size of  Provident's
mortgage loan  portfolio during the periods  shown.  Accordingly, loss  and
delinquency  as  shown if  a  group  of mortgage  loans  were  artificially
isolated at a point in  time and the  information showed the activity  only
in  that isolated  group.   However, since  most of  the mortgage  loans in
Provident's   mortgage  loan   portfolio  are   not  fully   seasoned,  the
delinquency  and loss information for such an  isolated group would also be
distorted to some degree.

     The   following  table   sets  forth   information  relating   to  the
delinquency and loss experience of mortgage loans similar  to and including
the  Mortgage Loans  for the  three quarters  ended  December 31,  1995 and
March 31, 1996.

                                                      Quarter Ended
                                         March 31, 1996    December 31, 1995
                                    Number of    Dollar    Number of   Dollar
                                      Loans      Amount      Loans      Amount

Portfolio . . . . . . . . . . . .      765    $72,345,012     310   $31,214,760
Delinquency percentage(1)
  30-59 days  . . . . . . . . . .     0.26%       0.28%       0.00%      0.00%
  60-89 days  . . . . . . . . . .     0.39%       0.42%       0.00%      0.00%
  90 days or more . . . . . . . .     0.13%       0.13%       0.00%      0.00%
Total . . . . . . . . . . . . . .     0.83%       0.83%       0.00%      0.00%
Percentage of Net Gains/
  (Losses) on liquidated
  loans . . . . . . . . . . . . .    _____%      _____%      _____%    _____%

     (1)  The period  of delinquency  is based  on the  number of days  the
          payment is contractually past due.




                     DESCRIPTION OF THE MORTGAGE LOANS

GENERAL

     The statistical  information presented  in this Prospectus  Supplement
is only  with  respect to  the Mortgage  Loans and  describes the  Mortgage
Loans in Loan Group  1 and the Mortgage Loans in  Loan Group 2 and is based
on the characteristics of such Loan Group as of the Cut-Off Date.

     The Mortgage  Loans are divided  into two  Loan Groups.   Loan Group 1
consists  of  Mortgage Loans  with  fixed interest  rates.    Loan Group  2
consists of Mortgage Loans with adjustable interest rates.

     The Mortgage Loans to be purchased by the Trust will  be originated or
purchased by Provident and sold by Provident to the Trust.

   
     The Mortgage Pool consists of        Mortgage Loans with  an aggregate
Principal Balance  as of the Cut-Off Date of $                (the "Cut-Off
Date Pool Principal Balance").   The Mortgage Pool  consists of closed-end,
fixed and adjustable rate home equity  loans with remaining terms to stated
maturity  of not more  than    months  (including both fully amortizing and
Balloon  Loans).  Approximately        % of the  Mortgage Loans (by Cut-Off
Date Pool Principal  Balance) are  secured by first  lien mortgages on  the
Mortgaged Properties and        % (by Cut-Off Date Pool  Principal Balance)
are secured by second liens  on the Mortgaged Properties.  Approximately   
%  of the Mortgage  Loans (by Cut-Off Date  Pool Principal Balance) were 30
to 59 days delinquent.   No Mortgage Loan was  more than 59 days delinquent
as of the Cut-Off Date.   With respect to the  Mortgage Loans, the  average
Cut-Off  Date Principal Balance was $            , the minimum Cut-Off Date
Principal  Balance was  $            , the  maximum Cut-Off  Date Principal
Balance was $            , the minimum Loan  Rate and the maximum Loan Rate
on the Cut-Off Date were     % and       % per annum, respectively, and the
weighted average Loan Rate  as of the Cut-Off Date  was       %  per annum.
The weighted  average Combined  Loan-to-Value Ratio  of the Mortgage  Loans
was       % as of the  Cut-Off Date.  Approximately       % of the Mortgage
Loans  (by Cut-Off Date  Pool Principal Balance)  are Balloon  Loans.  Each
Mortgage Loan was originated  on or after            .  The remaining terms
to stated maturity as of  the Cut-Off Date of the Mortgage Loans range from
  months to      months;  the  weighted average  remaining  term to  stated
maturity of the Mortgage Loans as of the Cut-Off Date is     months.  In no
event  will more than 5% of the Cut-Off Date  Pool Principal Balance of the
Mortgage  Pool deviate  from  the  characteristics of  the  Mortgage  Loans
described herein.
    

     The Mortgage Loans provide  that interest is charged  to the borrowers
thereunder, and  payments are due  from such  borrowers, as of  a scheduled
day  of each  month which is fixed  at the time  of origination.  Scheduled
monthly  payments made  by  the  borrowers  on  the Mortgage  Loans  either
earlier or later than the scheduled due dates thereof  will not affect  the
amortization  schedule or the  relative application of such payments to 
principal and interest.

LOAN GROUP 1 STATISTICS

     The sum of the  columns below may not equal the total indicated due to
rounding.  In  addition, unless otherwise set forth herein, all percentages
set forth herein with  respect to  the Mortgage Loans in  Loan Group 1  are
percentages of the Cut-Off Date Loan Group 1 Principal Balance.

   
     The  Mortgage Loans  in Loan  Group 1  consist of  ___ loans,  and the
related Mortgaged Properties  are located in __ states  and the District of
Columbia.  As of the Cut-Off  Date, the Mortgage Loans in Loan  Group 1 had
an aggregate  Principal Balance  of  $__________  (the "Cut-Off  Date  Loan
Group 1 Principal Balance"),  the maximum Principal Balance  of any of  the
Mortgage  Loans in  Loan Group  1 was  $__________,  the minimum  Principal
Balance thereof was  $________, and the Principal Balance of  such Mortgage
Loans  averaged $_________. As  of the Cut-Off Date,  the Loan Rates on the
Mortgage Loans in Loan  Group 1 ranged from ____%  to _____% per annum, and
the  weighted average  Loan Rate  for Mortgage  Loans in  Loan Group  1 was
______% per  annum.   As of the Cut-Off  Date, the original  term to stated
maturity  of each  Mortgage Loans  in  Loan Group  1  was  ___ months,  the
remaining term  to stated  maturity ranged from  ___ months to  ___ months,
the weighted average  remaining term to stated maturity  was ___ months and
the CLTV (as defined below) ranged from       % to       % with a  weighted
average CLTV of        %.   All of the Mortgage  Loans in Loan Group  1 are
secured by  first liens.         % of the  Mortgage Loans  in Loan  Group 1
require monthly  payments  of  principal  that  will  fully  amortize  such
Mortgage Loans  by their  respective maturity  dates, and         % of  the
Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 1 are Balloon Loans.
    

               CUT-OFF DATE LOAN GROUP 1 PRINCIPAL BALANCES

                                         Cut-Off Date       % of Cut-Off Date
Range of Cut-Off         Number of       Loan Group 1       Loan Group 1
Date Principal Balances  Mortgage Loans  Principal Balance  Principal Balance
- -----------------------  --------------  -----------------  -----------------


                    GEOGRAPHIC DISTRIBUTION BY STATE(1)
                               LOAN GROUP 1

                                   Cut-Off Date        % of Cut-Off Date
                Number of          Loan Group 1        Loan Group 1
State           Mortgage Loans     Principal Balance   Principal Balance
- -----           --------------     -----------------   -----------------


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                     COMBINED LOAN-TO-VALUE RATIOS(1)
                               LOAN GROUP 1

<S>                           <C>              <C>                <C>
                                                Cut-Off Date        % of Cut-Off Date
                               Number of        Loan Group 1        Loan Group 1
Combined Loan-to-Value Ratio   Mortgage Loans   Principal Balance   Principal Balance
- ----------------------------   --------------   -----------------   -----------------

</TABLE>

- ------------------
(1)  The Combined  Loan-to-Value  Ratios ("CLTV")  shown  above are  equal,
     with  respect  to each  Mortgage  Loan,  to (i)  the  sum  of (a)  the
     original  principal balance  of  such Mortgage  Loan  at the  date  of
     origination plus (b)  the remaining balance of the senior  lien(s), if
     any, at the date of origination  of such Mortgage Loan divided by (ii)
     the lesser of (a) the value  of the related Mortgaged Property,  based
     upon  the appraisal made at  the time of origination  of such Mortgage
     Loan  or (b)  the purchase  price of  such Mortgaged  Property if  the
     Mortgage Loan  proceeds from such Mortgage  Loan are used to  purchase
     such Mortgaged Property.



                                LOAN RATES
                               LOAN GROUP 1

                                   Cut-Off Date        % of Cut-Off Date
                Number of          Loan Group 1        Loan Group 1
Loan Rates      Mortgage Loans     Principal Balance   Principal Balance
- ----------      --------------     -----------------   -----------------



                     ORIGINAL TERM TO STATED MATURITY
                               LOAN GROUP 1

                                        Cut-Off Date        % of Cut-Off Date
Original Term to      Number of         Loan Group 1        Loan Group 1
Stated Maturity       Mortgage Loans    Principal Balance   Principal Balance
- ----------------      --------------    -----------------   -----------------



                    REMAINING MONTHS TO STATED MATURITY
                               LOAN GROUP 1

                                     Cut-Off Date        % of Cut-Off Date
Remaining Term to    Number of       Loan Group 1        Loan Group 1
Stated Maturity      Mortgage Loans  Principal Balance   Principal Balance
- -----------------    --------------  -----------------   -----------------


                         MONTHS SINCE ORIGINATION
                               LOAN GROUP 1

                                         Cut-Off Date        % of Cut-Off Date
                          Number of      Loan Group 1        Loan Group 1
Months Since Origination  Mortgage Loans Principal Balance   Principal Balance
- ------------------------  -------------- -----------------   -----------------


                               PROPERTY TYPE
                               LOAN GROUP 1

                                   Cut-Off Date        % of Cut-Off Date
                   Number of       Loan Group 1        Loan Group 1
Property Type      Mortgage Loans  Principal Balance   Principal Balance
- -------------      --------------  -----------------   -----------------


                              OCCUPANCY TYPE
                               LOAN GROUP 1

                                  Cut-Off Date        % of Cut-Off Date
                  Number of       Loan Group 1        Loan Group 1
Occupancy Type    Mortgage Loans  Principal Balance   Principal Balance
- --------------    --------------  -----------------   -----------------


   
     (CONVEYANCE OF SUBSEQUENT MORTGAGE LOANS



     The  Agreement  permits the  Trust Fund  to  purchase  from Provident,
subsequent  to the  date  hereof and  prior  to _______,  19__,  Subsequent
Mortgage  Loans in  an  amount not  to  exceed approximately  $________  in
aggregate  principal  balance  for inclusion  in  the  Trust  Fund.    Each
Subsequent  Mortgage  Loan  will  have  been  originated  or  purchased  by
Provident in  accordance with the underwriting  guidelines set forth  above
under "The Home Equity Loan  Program--Credit and Underwriting  Guidelines."
Accordingly,  the  statistical characteristics  of  the  Mortgage Pool  set
forth above  are based exclusively  on the Initial  Mortgage Loans and  the
statistical characteristics  of the  Mortgage Pool  after giving effect  to
the acquisition  of any Subsequent Mortgage  Loans will likely differ  from
the information specified  herein.  The date on which Provident transfers a
Subsequent Mortgage Loan to  the Trust Fund shall be  referred to herein as
the "Subsequent Transfer Date".

     In any  event, each conveyance  of Subsequent  Mortgage Loans will  be
subject  to,  among other  things,  the  following conditions:    (i)  such
Subsequent Mortgage  Loans must  (a) satisfy the  eligibility criteria  set
forth  in  the  Prospectus  under  "The  Loan  Program--Representations  by
Sellers; Repurchases" and  (b) comply with each representation and warranty
as  to the Mortgage Loans set forth in  the Agreement; (ii) such Subsequent
Mortgage  Loan  must  not  have  been  selected  by either  the  Seller  or
Provident in a manner that it believes  is adverse to the interests  of the
Certificateholders, (iii) no Subsequent  Mortgage Loan  may be ___ or  more
days contractually  delinquent as of the  applicable Cut-Off Date; (iv)  no
Subsequent Mortgage Loan  may have a remaining  term to maturity in  excess
of  ___ years; (v)  no Subsequent  Mortgage Loan may  have a  Mortgage Rate
less than  ____%; (vi) following the  purchase of such Subsequent  Mortgage
Loans  by  the Trust  Fund, the  Mortgage Loans  (a) will  have  a weighted
average  Mortgage Rate of at least ____%; (b)  will have a weighted average
Combined Loan-to-Value Ratio of not  more than ____%;  (c) will not have  a
weighted  average remaining  term  to stated  maturity  of more  than  ____
months; and (d) will, in  each case, have a principal  balance in excess of
$_______ as  of the Cut-Off  Date; (vii)  Provident (and the  Trustee shall
not have been notified by either Rating Agency that the  conveyance of such
Subsequent Mortgage Loans  will result in a qualification, modification  or
withdrawal of its then-current rating of any class  of Certificates) (shall
have notified  each Rating  Agency of  such conveyance  as required by  the
Agreement); and (viii) the Trustee shall have received  certain opinions of
counsel as to, among other  things, the enforceability and validity  of the
transfer  agreements  relating   to  such  conveyance  of  such  Subsequent
Mortgage Loans.)
    

LOAN GROUP 2 STATISTICS

     The sum of  the columns below may not equal the total indicated due to
rounding.  In addition, unless otherwise set forth  herein, all percentages
set forth herein with respect to the Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 2 are 
percentages of the Cut-Off Date  Loan Group 2 Principal Balance.

     The Mortgage  Loans in Loan  Group 2 bear  interest rates that  adjust
based on  the London  interbank offered  rate for  six-month United  States
dollar deposits.

   
     The Mortgage  Loans in Loan Group  2 consist of  _____ loans,  and the
related Mortgaged  Properties are located in 22 states  and the District of
Columbia.  As of the Cut-Off  Date, the Mortgage Loans in Loan  Group 2 had
an aggregate Principal  Balance of $______________  (the "Cut-Off Date Loan
Group 2 Principal Balance"),  the maximum Principal  Balance of any of  the
Mortgage  Loans in  Loan Group  2 was  $__________,  the minimum  Principal
Balance thereof  was $________ and the  Principal Balance of such  Mortgage
Loans averaged $_________.   As of the Cut-Off Date,  the Loan Rates on the
Mortgage  Loans in Loan Group 2 ranged from ____%  to _____% per annum, and
the  weighted average  Loan Rate  for Mortgage  Loans in  Loan Group  2 was
_____%  per annum.   As of the  Cut-Off Date,  the original term  to stated
maturity  of  the Mortgage  Loans  in  Loan Group  2  was  ___ months,  the
remaining term to  stated maturity ranged  from ___ months  to ___  months,
the weighted average remaining  term to stated maturity was ___  months and
the CLTV (as defined  below) ranged from       % to       % with a weighted
average  CLTV of       %.   The  Mortgage Loans in Loan  Group 2 had stated
maturities ranging from                to                .        % of  the
Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 2  are secured by first liens, and        % by
second liens.  (All) of  the Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 2 require monthly
payments  of principal  that will  fully amortize  such  Mortgage Loans  by
their respective maturity dates.   All of the Mortgage  Loans in Loan Group
2  have Loan Rates  which adjust semi-annually.   All of the Mortgage Loans
in Loan Group 2 have minimum and maximum Loan Rates.  The weighted  average
minimum Loan Rate of  the Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 2 is approximately  
  % per  annum, with minimum Loan Rates that range from  approximately    %
per annum to     % per  annum.  The weighted average  maximum Loan Rate  of
the Mortgage  Loans in Loan Group 2 is approximately      % per annum, with
maximum Loan  Rates that range from approximately       % per  annum to    
% per annum.   The Mortgage Loans in  Loan Group 2 have a weighted  average
gross margin  of approximately      % per  annum, with  gross margins  that
range from approximately       % per annum to    % per annum.  The Mortgage
Loans  in   Loan  Group  2  have   a  weighted  average   periodic  cap  of
approximately        %  per  annum,  with  periodic  caps that  range  from
approximately       % per annum to     % per annum.       % of the Mortgage
Loans in  Loan Group 2  adjust after (one)  year;        % of  the Mortgage
Loans in Loan  Group 2 adjust after (three)  years;       % of the Mortgage
Loans  in Loan  Group 2  adjust after (five)  years.   The weighted average
number of  months to  the next  reset date of  the Mortgage  Loans in  Loan
Group 2 is approximately        , with a  maximum number of months  of     
and a minimum number of months of    .
    

               CUT-OFF DATE LOAN GROUP 2 PRINCIPAL BALANCES

                         Cut-Off Date    % of Cut-Off Date
Range of Cut-Off         Number of       Loan Group 2       Loan Group 2
Date Principal Balances  Mortgage Loans  Principal Balance  Principal Balance
- -----------------------  --------------  -----------------  -----------------



                    GEOGRAPHIC DISTRIBUTION BY STATE(1)
                               LOAN GROUP 2

                               Cut-Off Date        % of Cut-Off Date
               Number of       Loan Group 2        Loan Group 2
State          Mortgage Loans  Principal Balance   Principal Balance
- -----          --------------  -----------------   -----------------



- ------------------
(1)     Determined by  property address designated  as such in the  related
Mortgage.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                     COMBINED LOAN-TO-VALUE RATIOS(1)
                               LOAN GROUP 2

<S>                         <C>             <C>                 <C>
                              Cut-Off Date   % of Cut-Off Date
                              Number of      Loan Group 2        Loan Group 2
Combined Loan-to-Value Ratio  Mortgage Loans Principal Balance   Principal Balance
- ----------------------------  -------------- -----------------   -----------------



</TABLE>

- ------------------
(1)  The Combined  Loan-to-Value  Ratios ("CLTV")  shown  above are  equal,
     with  respect  to each  Mortgage  Loan,  to (i)  the  sum  of (a)  the
     original  principal balance  of  such Mortgage  Loan  at the  date  of
     origination plus (b)  the remaining balance of the senior  lien(s), if
     any, at the date of origination  of such Mortgage Loan divided by (ii)
     the lesser of (a) the value  of the related Mortgaged Property,  based
     upon  the appraisal made at  the time of origination  of such Mortgage
     Loan  or (b)  the purchase  price of  such Mortgaged  Property if  the
     Mortgage Loan  proceeds from such Mortgage  Loan are used to  purchase
     such Mortgaged Property.


                                LOAN RATES
                               LOAN GROUP 2

                                   Cut-Off Date        % of Cut-Off Date
                  Number of        Loan Group 2        Loan Group 2
Loan Rates        Mortgage Loans   Principal Balance   Principal Balance
- ----------        --------------   -----------------   -----------------

                     ORIGINAL TERM TO STATED MATURITY
                               LOAN GROUP 2

                                    Cut-Off Date        % of Cut-Off Date
Original Term to    Number of       Loan Group 2        Loan Group 2
Stated Maturity     Mortgage Loans  Principal Balance   Principal Balance
- ----------------    --------------  -----------------   -----------------



                    REMAINING MONTHS TO STATED MATURITY
                               LOAN GROUP 2



                                      Cut-Off Date        % of Cut-Off Date
Remaining Term to     Number of       Loan Group 2        Loan Group 2
Stated Maturity       Mortgage Loans  Principal Balance   Principal Balance
- -----------------     --------------  -----------------   -----------------



                         MONTHS SINCE ORIGINATION
                               LOAN GROUP 2

                                          Cut-Off Date       % of Cut-Off Date
                          Number of       Loan Group 2       Loan Group 2
Months Since Origination  Mortgage Loans  Principal Balance  Principal Balance
- ------------------------  --------------  -----------------  -----------------




                               PROPERTY TYPE
                               LOAN GROUP 2

                                  Cut-Off Date        % of Cut-Off Date
                  Number of       Loan Group 2        Loan Group 2
Property Type     Mortgage Loans  Principal Balance   Principal Balance
- -------------     --------------  -----------------   -----------------




                              OCCUPANCY TYPE
                               LOAN GROUP 2

                                  Cut-Off Date        % of Cut-Off Date
                  Number of       Loan Group 2        Loan Group 2
Occupancy Type    Mortgage Loans  Principal Balance   Principal Balance
- --------------    --------------  -----------------   -----------------



                                  MARGIN
                               LOAN GROUP 2

                             Cut-Off Date        % of Cut-Off Date
             Number of       Loan Group 2        Loan Group 2
Margin       Mortgage Loans  Principal Balance   Principal Balance
- ------       --------------  -----------------   -----------------






                               LIFETIME CAP
                               LOAN GROUP 2


                              Cut-Off Date        % of Cut-Off Date
              Number of       Loan Group 2        Loan Group 2
Lifetime Cap  Mortgage Loans  Principal Balance   Principal Balance
- ------------  --------------  -----------------   -----------------


                                   FLOOR
                               LOAN GROUP 2


                             Cut-Off Date        % of Cut-Off Date
             Number of       Loan Group 2        Loan Group 2
Floor        Mortgage Loans  Principal Balance   Principal Balance
- -----        --------------  -----------------   -----------------




                    PREPAYMENT AND YIELD CONSIDERATIONS

GENERAL

     The rate  of principal payments  on the  Offered Certificates of  each
Class, the  aggregate amount of  distributions on  the Offered Certificates
and  the yield to  maturity of the Offered  Certificates will be related to
the rate and timing of  payments of principal on the  Mortgage Loans in the
related Loan Group.   The rate of principal payments  on the Mortgage Loans
will  in turn  be affected by  the amortization  schedules of  the Mortgage
Loans and by the rate of principal prepayments (including  for this purpose
prepayments resulting from  refinancing, liquidations of the Mortgage Loans
due to defaults,  casualties, condemnations and repurchases by the Seller).
The Mortgage Loans may be prepaid by the  Mortgagors at any time.  However,
approximately  __%  of  the  Mortgage  Loans  are   subject  to  prepayment
penalties which vary from jurisdiction to jurisdiction.

     Prepayments,  liquidations and purchases  of the  Mortgage Loans  in a
Loan Group (including any optional purchase  by the Master Servicer of  the
remaining Mortgage Loans  in connection with the termination of  the Trust)
will  result  in  distributions  on  the  related Offered  Certificates  of
principal amounts which would otherwise  be distributed over  the remaining
terms of such Mortgage  Loans.  Since  the rate of payment of  principal of
the  Mortgage Loans will depend on future events  and a variety of factors,
no  assurance  can be  given  as to  such  rate or  the  rate of  principal
prepayments.   The  extent to  which the  yield to  maturity of  an Offered
Certificate  may vary  from  the anticipated  yield  will depend  upon  the
degree to which a Certificate  is purchased at  a discount or premium,  and
the  degree to  which  the  timing  of  payments thereon  is  sensitive  to
prepayments, liquidations and purchases of such Mortgage Loans.

     The rate  of prepayment  on the  Mortgage Loans  cannot be  predicted.
Home  equity  loans  such as  the Mortgage  Loans  have been  originated in
significant volume  only during  the past  few years  and Provident  is not
aware  of any  publicly available  studies  or  statistics on  the rate  of
prepayment of such Mortgage  Loans.  Generally, home  equity loans are  not
viewed  by borrowers  as permanent  financing.   Accordingly, the  Mortgage
Loans may  experience a higher  rate of  prepayment than traditional  first
mortgage loans.   The prepayment  experience of the  Trust with respect  to
the Mortgage  Loans may be affected by a wide variety of factors, including
economic conditions, prevailing interest rate  levels, the availability  of
alternative financing  and  homeowner mobility  and  changes affecting  the
deductibility for Federal income tax purposes of interest  payments on home
equity loans.  All of the Mortgage Loans  contain "due-on-sale" provisions,
and, with respect to  the Mortgage Loans,  the Master Servicer is  required
by the  Agreement to enforce  such provisions,  unless such enforcement  is
not permitted by applicable law.  The enforcement of a "due-on-sale"  
provision will have  the same effect as  a prepayment of the related 
Mortgage Loan.   See "CERTAIN LEGAL  ASPECTS OF  LOANS--Due-on-Sale
Clauses in Mortgage Loans" in the Prospectus.

     As with fixed rate obligations generally, the  rate of prepayment on a
pool of  mortgage loans with fixed rates  such as the Mortgage Loans in the
Loan Group 1 is  affected by prevailing market rates  for mortgage loans of
a comparable term and  risk level.  When the market interest rate  is below
the  interest  rate  on  a  mortgage,  mortgagors  may  have  an  increased
incentive to  refinance their  mortgage  loans.   Depending  on  prevailing
market rates, the  future outlook for market rates and  economic conditions
generally, some  mortgagors may sell or  refinance mortgaged properties  in
order to realize  their equity  in the mortgaged  properties, to meet  cash
flow needs or to make other investments.

     All of  the Mortgage  Loans in the  Loan Group  2 are  adjustable-rate
mortgage  loans.   As is  the case  with  conventional fixed-rate  mortgage
loans,  adjustable-rate mortgage loans may be  subject to a greater rate of
principal  prepayments in  a  declining  interest  rate environment.    For
example,  if prevailing interest rates  fall significantly, adjustable-rate
mortgage  loans  could  be subject  to  higher  prepayment  rates  than  if
prevailing  interest  rates remain  constant  because  the availability  of
fixed-rate  mortgage  loans at  competitive  interest  rates may  encourage
mortgagors   to  refinance   their   adjustable-rate  mortgage   loans   at
competitive interest  rates  may encourage  mortgagors  to refinance  their
adjustable-rate mortgage  loans to "lock in"  a lower fixed interest  rate.
However,  no assurance can be given as to the level of prepayments that the
Mortgage Loans will experience.

     In addition  to the foregoing factors  affecting the weighted  average
life of  the Offered Certificates, the  use of Distributable Excess  Spread
to pay  principal of the  Offered Certificates  of the related  Certificate
Group  to  the  extent  required  by  the  Agreement  will  result  in  the
acceleration of  the Class A-1 and  Class A-6 Certificates, as  applicable,
relative  to the amortization  of the  Mortgage Loans  in the  related Loan
Group in early months of the transaction as  well as, with respect to Group
1 Certificates, accelerating  the first date on  which each other Class  of
Group 1 Certificates will begin to receive distributions  of principal than
would   otherwise  be  the   case.     This  acceleration  feature  creates
overcollateralization which  results  from  the  excess  of  the  aggregate
Principal Balance  of Mortgage Loans  in a  Loan Group  over the  Aggregate
Class  A Principal  Balance of  the related  Certificate Group.    Once the
required  level  of   overcollateralization  for  a  Certificate  Group  is
reached, the  acceleration feature for  such Certificate  Group will cease,
unless necessary  to maintain the  required level  of overcollateralization
for  such  Certificate   Group.  See  "DESCRIPTION  OF  THE  CERTIFICATES--
Overcollateralization Provisions."

PAYMENT DELAY FEATURE OF GROUP 1 CERTIFICATES

     The effective yield  to the Certificateholders of each Class  of Group
1  Certificates will  be lower  than the  yield otherwise  produced by  the
Certificate  Rate  for  each such  Class  and the  purchase  price  of such
Certificates   because   distributions  will   not   be   payable  to   the
Certificateholders until the 25th day  of the month following the  month of
accrual (without  any  additional  distribution  of  interest  or  earnings
thereon in respect of such delay).

WEIGHTED AVERAGE LIVES

     Generally,  greater  than  anticipated prepayments  of  principal will
increase the  yield on Offered Certificates purchased at  a price less than
par and  will decrease  the yield  on Offered Certificates  purchased at  a
price  greater  than  par.   The  effect  on  an investor's  yield  due  to
principal  prepayments on the  Mortgage Loans  occurring at a  rate that is
faster (or  slower) than the rate anticipated by the investor in the period
immediately  following  the  issuance  of  the  Certificates  will  not  be
entirely offset by  a subsequent like reduction  (or increase) in the  rate
of  principal  payments.    The  weighted  average  life   of  the  Offered
Certificates  will   also  be  affected  by   the  amount  and  timing   of
delinquencies and  defaults on the  Mortgage Loans  and the recoveries,  if
any, on defaulted Mortgage Loans and foreclosed properties.

     The "weighted  average life" of  a Certificate  refers to the  average
amount of time that will elapse  from the date of issuance to the date each
dollar in  respect  of  principal  of  such Certificate  is  repaid.    The
weighted  average life of  any Class  of the Class  A Certificates  will be
influenced by,  among other factors, the  rate at which principal  payments
are  made on  the Mortgage  Loans, including, with  respect to  the Group 1
Certificates, final payments made upon the maturity of Balloon Loans.

     Prepayments on  Mortgage Loans  are  commonly measured  relative to  a
prepayment  standard  or  model.    The  model  used   in  this  Prospectus
Supplement is  the  prepayment  assumption (the  "Prepayment  Assumption"),
which represents an assumed  rate of prepayment each month relative  to the
then outstanding  principal balance of  the pool of mortgage  loans for the
life  of such  mortgage  loans.   A  100% Prepayment  Assumption  assumes a
conditional prepayment  rate ("CPR")  of 4%  per annum  of the  outstanding
principal balance of such mortgage loans in the first month  of the life of
the mortgage loans and an additional 1.45% (precisely  16/11) (expressed as
a percentage per annum) in  each month thereafter until the twelfth  month;
beginning  in the  twelfth month  and in  each month  thereafter during the
life of  the mortgage loans, a conditional prepayment rate of 20% per annum
each  month  is  assumed.   As  used  in  the table  below,  0%  Prepayment
Assumption  assumes  a conditional  prepayment  rate  equal to  0%  of  the
Prepayment  Assumption,  i.e.,  no  prepayments.   Correspondingly,  (200)%
Prepayment  Assumption  assumes prepayment  rates equal  to  (200)%  of the
Prepayment Assumption, and so  forth.  The  Prepayment Assumption does not
purport to be a historical description  of prepayment experience  or a  
prediction of  the anticipated rate  of prepayment of  any pool of mortgage
loans, including the Mortgage Loans.   Provident believes  that no  
existing  statistics of  which it  is aware  provide a  reliable basis  for
holders  of  Offered Certificates  to predict the amount or the timing  of 
receipt of prepayments on the Mortgage Loans.

     Since the tables were prepared on  the basis of the assumptions in the
following  paragraph, there  are discrepancies  between  characteristics of
the actual  Mortgage Loans and  the characteristics  of the Mortgage  Loans
assumed  in preparing the tables.  Any such  discrepancy may have an effect
upon the percentages  of the  Principal Balances  outstanding and  weighted
average  lives of  the Offered  Certificates set forth  in the  tables.  In
addition,   since  the   actual   Mortgage   Loans  in   the   Trust   have
characteristics which  differ from  those assumed  in preparing the  tables
set  forth   below,  the   distributions  of   principal  on   the  Offered
Certificates may be made earlier or later than as indicated in the tables.

     For  the purpose  of the  tables below,  it is  assumed that:  (i) the
Mortgage  Loans consist of  pools of loans  with the  level-pay and balloon
amortization characteristics set  forth below,  (ii) the  Closing Date  for
the Class A Certificates  is ________________, (iii)  distributions on  the
Class  A Certificates are made on  the 25th day of each month regardless of
the  day on  which the  Distribution Date  actually  occurs, commencing  in
_____________ and  are made  in  accordance with  the priorities  described
herein, (iv)  the scheduled monthly payments  of principal and interest  on
the Mortgage Loans will be timely  delivered on the first day of each month
(with no defaults), commencing in _______________, (v) the  Mortgage Loans'
prepayment rates  are a  multiple of  the Prepayment  Assumption, (vi)  all
prepayments are  prepayments in full received on the last day of each month
(commencing ______________)  and include 30  days' interest  thereon, (vii)
no optional  termination is exercised, (viii)  the Class A Certificates  of
each  Class have  the  respective Certificate  Rates  and initial  Class  A
Principal Balances  as  set forth  herein,  (ix) the  overcollateralization
levels are  set initially  as specified  in the  Agreement, and  thereafter
decrease in  accordance with  the provisions  of the  Agreement, ((x)  with
respect   to   pools  of   loans   with   an  assumed   Cut-Off   Date   of
_________________, interest will be  calculated at a rate of   %  per annum
for one month), (xi) six-month  LIBOR for each Interest Period will be     
% and (xii) one-month LIBOR for each Interest Period will be      %.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

<S>                       <C>        <C>          <C>            <C>        <C>
                                                   Original       Original   Remaining
                                                   Amortization   Term to    Term to
Amortization               Principal               Term           Maturity   Maturity
Methodology                Balance    Loan Rate    (months)       (months)   (months)

GROUP 1
  Balloon............    $
  Level Pay..........    $
  Level Pay..........    $

     Subject  to the  foregoing discussion  and assumptions,  the following
table  indicates the  weighted  average  life  of  each Class  of  Class  A
Certificates,  and  sets forth  the  percentages  of the  initial  Class  A
Principal Balance of each such Class  of Class A Certificates that would be
outstanding  after  each of  the  dates  shown at  various  percentages  of
Prepayment Assumption.


</TABLE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

<S>            <C>        <C>    <C>       <C>      <C>     <C>        <C>           <C>       <C>
                                                                       Original      Original  Remaining
                                 Months to          Maximum  Minimum   Amortization  Term to   Term to
Amortization   Principal  Loan   Rate      Gross    Interest Interest  Term          Maturity  Maturity
Methodology    Balance    Rate   Change    Margin   Rate     Rate      (months)      (months)  (months)
- ------------   ---------  ----   --------- ------   -------- --------  ------------  --------  ---------

GROUP 2
  Balloon...... $
  Level Pay.... $
  Level Pay.... $

</TABLE>


            PERCENT OF INITIAL CLASS A PRINCIPAL BALANCE OUTSTANDING
           AT THE FOLLOWING PERCENTAGES OF THE PREPAYMENT ASSUMPTION

                         CLASS A-1                CLASS A-2
DISTRIBUTION DATE     %    %    %    %         %    %    %    %

Initial
 Percentage........   100  100  100  100       100  100  100  100

Weighted Average
 Life (years)*.....

- ------------------
*    The weighted  average life of a Certificate of any class is determined
     by (i)  multiplying the amount  of each  distribution in reduction  of
     the related Class A Principal Balance by the number of  years from the
     date of issuance of the Certificate to the  related Distribution Date,
     (ii)  adding the  results, and (iii)  dividing the sum  by the highest
     related Principal Balance of the Certificate.


                         CLASS A-3                CLASS A-4

DISTRIBUTION DATE        %    %    %    %         %    %    %    %


Initial
 Percentage........      100  100  100  100       100  100  100  100

Weighted Average
 Life (years)*.....

- ------------------
*    The weighted average life of a Certificate of any  class is determined
     by (i)  multiplying the amount  of each  distribution in reduction  of
     the related  Class A Principal Balance by the number of years from the
     date of issuance of the Certificate to the  related Distribution Date,
     (ii) adding  the results, and  (iii) dividing the  sum by  the highest
     related Principal Balance of the Certificate.


                         CLASS A-5                CLASS A-6

DISTRIBUTION DATE        %    %    %    %         %    %    %    %


Initial
 Percentage........      100  100  100  100       100  100  100  100

Weighted Average
 Life (years)*.....

- ------------------
*    The  weighted average life of a Certificate of any class is determined
     by (i)  multiplying the amount  of each  distribution in reduction  of
     the related  Class A Principal Balance by the number of years from the
     date of issuance of the Certificate to the  related Distribution Date,
     (ii) adding  the results, and  (iii) dividing the  sum by the  highest
     related Principal Balance of the Certificate.

     These tables  have been  prepared based on  the assumptions  described
above   (including  the  assumptions   regarding  the  characteristics  and
performance   of  the  Mortgage   Loans,  which   differ  from  the  actual
characteristics and performance thereof)  and should be read in conjunction
therewith.

                      DESCRIPTION OF THE CERTIFICATES

     The Certificates will be  issued pursuant to the Agreement.   The form
of  the  Agreement  has  been  filed  as an  exhibit  to  the  Registration
Statement  of which  this Prospectus  Supplement and  the  Prospectus is  a
part.     The  following  summaries  describe  certain  provisions  of  the
Agreement.   The summaries do not  purport to be  complete and  are subject
to,  and  are qualified  in  their  entirety by  reference  to, all  of the
provisions  of  the Agreement.    Wherever particular  sections or  defined
terms of the Agreement are referred  to, such sections or defined terms are
hereby incorporated herein by reference.

GENERAL

     The Offered  Certificates will  be issued  in denominations  of $1,000
and  multiples  of  $1  in  excess  thereof  and  will  evidence  specified
undivided interests in the  Trust.  The property of  the Trust will consist
of, to the extent provided  in the Agreement: (i) the Mortgage Loans;  (ii)
payments  on the  Mortgage Loans  received on  and after  the Cut-Off  Date
(exclusive  of payments  in respect of  interest on the  Mortgage Loans due
prior  to the  Cut-Off  Date  and  received  thereafter);  (iii)  Mortgaged
Properties relating to the Mortgage Loans that are  acquired by foreclosure
or deed  in  lieu  of foreclosure;  (iv)  the  Collection Account  and  the
Distribution Account and funds  on deposit therein  (excluding net earnings
thereon); and (v) rights under certain  hazard insurance policies  covering
the  Mortgaged  Properties.     In  addition,  Provident  has  caused   the
Certificate Insurer to issue an  irrevocable and unconditional  certificate
guaranty insurance policy (the  "Policy") for the benefit of the holders of
the Class  A Certificates, pursuant to  which the Certificate Insurer  will
guarantee  payments  to  such   Certificateholders  as  described   herein.
Definitive  Certificates  (as  defined  below)  will  be  transferable  and
exchangeable  at the  corporate trust  office of  the  Trustee, which  will
initially act  as Certificate Registrar.   See  "--Book-Entry Certificates"
below.  No service charge will  be made for any registration of exchange or
transfer of  Certificates, but  the Trustee may  require payment  of a  sum
sufficient to cover any tax or other governmental charge.

     Each  Mortgage  Loan in  the  Trust  will be  assigned  to one  of two
mortgage loan groups ("Loan  Group 1" and "Loan Group 2", respectively, and
each a "Loan Group").  The Class A-1,  Class A-2, Class A-3, Class A-4  and
Class A-5  Certificates  (collectively, the  "Group  1 Certificates")  will
represent undivided ownership interests  in the Mortgage  Loans assigned to
Loan  Group 1, all collections thereon (exclusive of payments in respect of
interest on such Mortgage  Loan due prior to the  Cut-Off Date and received
thereafter) and  the proceeds  thereof.   The Class  A-6 Certificates  (the
"Group  2 Certificates")  will represent  undivided ownership  interests in
the  Mortgage Loans  assigned  to Loan  Group  2, all  collections  thereon
(exclusive of payments in respect of interest on  such  Mortgage  Loans  
due  prior  to  the  Cut-Off  Date  and received thereafter) and the 
proceeds thereof.   The principal amount of a Class  of Class  A  
Certificates  (each,  a  "Class  A  Principal  Balance")  on  any 
Distribution Date is equal to  the applicable Class A Principal Balance  on
the Closing  Date minus the  aggregate of  amounts actually distributed  as
principal to the holders  of such Class  of Class A Certificates.   On  any
date, the  "Aggregate Class A  Principal Balance" is,  with respect to  the
Group  1 Certificates, the  aggregate of the Class  A Principal Balances of
the Class A-1, Class A-2,  Class A-3, Class A-4 and Class A-5  Certificates
and  with  respect to  the  Group  2 Certificates,  the  Class A  Principal
Balance of the Class A-6 Certificates.

     The Class  A Certificates  will be  issued in six  Classes, Class  A-1
(the "Class A-1 Certificates"), Class  A-2 (the "Class  A-2 Certificates"),
Class  A-3  (the "Class  A-3  Certificates"),  Class A-4  (the  "Class  A-4
Certificates"),  Class A-5  (the "Class  A-5 Certificates")  and Class  A-6
(the  "Class  A-6 Certificates").    Only  the Class  A  Certificates  (the
"Offered Certificates")  are being offered hereby.   Each Class of  Offered
Certificates represents  the right to receive  payments of interest at  the
Certificate Rate  for such  Class and  payments of  principal as  described
below.

     The Person in whose name  a Certificate is  registered as such in  the
Certificate Register is referred to herein as a "Certificateholder."

     The "Percentage Interest" of  a Class A Certificate as  of any date of
determination will  be equal  to the  percentage obtained  by dividing  the
denomination  of such Certificate by the Class  A Principal Balance for the
related Class as of the Cut-Off Date.

   
     The Certificates will not be listed on any securities exchange.
    

BOOK-ENTRY CERTIFICATES

     The  Offered  Certificates   will  be  book-entry   Certificates  (the
"Book-Entry   Certificates").     Persons  acquiring  beneficial  ownership
interests in  the  Offered Certificates  ("Certificate  Owners") will  hold
their Offered Certificates through the Depository Trust  Company ("DTC") in
the  United  States,  or  CEDEL  or  Euroclear  (in  Europe)  if  they  are
participants  of such  systems, or  indirectly through  organizations which
are participants  in such  systems.   The Book-Entry  Certificates will  be
issued in  one or  more certificates  which equal  the aggregate  principal
balance of  the Offered Certificates  and will  initially be registered  in
the name  of Cede,  the nominee  of  DTC.   CEDEL and  Euroclear will  hold
omnibus positions  on  behalf  of  their  participants  through  customers'
securities accounts in CEDEL's and Euroclear's names on the  books of their
respective  depositaries  which  in  turn  will  hold   such  positions  in
customers' securities accounts  in the depositaries' names on the  books of
DTC.  Citibank will act as depositary for CEDEL  and  Chemical  will  act  
as  depositary  for   Euroclear  (in  such capacities,  individually  the 
"Relevant  Depositary" and  collectively the "European Depositaries").  
Investors may hold such beneficial interests  in the   Book-Entry   
Certificates  in   minimum  denominations   representing Certificate 
Principal Balances of $1,000 and  in multiples of $1 in  excess thereof.   
Except  as described  below, no  person  acquiring a  Book-Entry
Certificate (each,  a "beneficial  owner") will  be entitled  to receive  a
physical  certificate   representing   such   Certificate  (a   "Definitive
Certificate").  Unless and until Definitive Certificates are  issued, it is
anticipated that the only "Certificateholder"  of the Offered  Certificates
will  be Cede,  as  nominee  of  DTC.    Certificate  Owners  will  not  be
Certificateholders as  that term  is used  in the  Agreement.   Certificate
Owners  are only  permitted  to  exercise their  rights  indirectly through
Participants and DTC.

     The  beneficial owner's ownership  of a Book-Entry Certificate will be
recorded on the records of the brokerage  firm, bank, thrift institution or
other  financial  intermediary  (each,  a  "Financial  Intermediary")  that
maintains the  beneficial owner's account  for such purpose.   In turn, the
Financial Intermediary's ownership of such  Book-Entry Certificate will  be
recorded on the records  of DTC (or  of a participating firm  that acts  as
agent  for the  Financial  Intermediary, whose  interest  will in  turn  be
recorded  on  the records  of  DTC,  if the  beneficial  owner's  Financial
Intermediary is  not  a DTC  participant  and on  the records  of CEDEL  or
Euroclear, as appropriate).

     Certificate  Owners will  receive all  distributions of  principal of,
and  interest on, the Offered Certificates from the Trustee through DTC and
DTC participants.  While the Offered  Certificates are outstanding  (except
under the circumstances described below), under the  rules, regulations and
procedures  creating and  affecting DTC  and its operations  (the "Rules"),
DTC is  required to make book-entry  transfers among Participants on  whose
behalf it  acts with respect to the Offered Certificates and is required to
receive and  transmit distributions of principal  of, and interest on,  the
Offered  Certificates.   Participants and  indirect participants  with whom
Certificate Owners  have accounts with  respect to Offered Certificates are
similarly  required to make  book-entry transfers  and receive and transmit
such distributions  on  behalf  of  their  respective  Certificate  Owners.
Accordingly,  although Certificate  Owners will  not possess  certificates,
the Rules  provide a  mechanism by  which Certificate  Owners will  receive
distributions and will be able to transfer their interest.

     Certificate  Owners  will  not  receive  or  be  entitled  to  receive
certificates  representing  their  respective   interests  in  the  Offered
Certificates,  except  under  the  limited circumstances  described  below.
Unless  and until  Definitive Certificates  are issued,  Certificate Owners
who  are not Participants  may transfer  ownership of  Offered Certificates
only  through Participants  and indirect  participants by  instructing such
Participants and indirect participants  to  transfer Offered  Certificates,
by  book-entry transfer, through  DTC   for the account of the purchasers  
of  such   Offered Certificates,   which  account   is   maintained  with 
their   respective Participants.    Under  the Rules  and  in  accordance  
with  DTC's  normal procedures,  transfers  of   ownership  of  Offered  
Certificates  will  be executed through  DTC and the  accounts of  the 
respective Participants  at DTC  will  be  debited and  credited.    
Similarly,  the  Participants  and indirect participants will make debits  
or credits, as the case may be,  on their records on behalf of the selling
and purchasing Certificate Owners.

     Because of time zone  differences, credits of  securities received  in
CEDEL or Euroclear as a result of a transaction with a  Participant will be
made  during  subsequent securities  settlement  processing  and dated  the
business  day following  the  DTC settlement  date.   Such  credits  or any
transactions in  such securities  settled during  such  processing will  be
reported to the  relevant Euroclear or CEDEL Participants on  such business
day.   Cash  received  in  CEDEL or  Euroclear  as  a result  of  sales  of
securities  by  or  through a  CEDEL  Participant  (as  defined  below)  or
Euroclear  Participant (as  defined below)  to a  DTC  Participant will  be
received  with value  on the DTC  settlement date but will  be available in
the relevant CEDEL or  Euroclear cash account only as  of the business  day
following  settlement  in  DTC.    For  information  with  respect  to  tax
documentation   procedures  relating  to  the  Certificates,  see  "CERTAIN
FEDERAL   INCOME   TAX   CONSEQUENCES--Foreign   Investors"   and   "Backup
Withholding"   herein   and   "GLOBAL   CLEARANCE,   SETTLEMENT   AND   TAX
DOCUMENTATION  PROCEDURES--Certain  U.S. Federal  Income Tax  Documentation
Requirements" in Annex I hereto.

     Transfers  between  Participants will  occur  in  accordance with  DTC
rules.   Transfers  between CEDEL  Participants and  Euroclear Participants
will  occur  in  accordance  with  their  respective  rules  and  operating
procedures.

     Cross-market transfers between  persons holding directly or indirectly
through DTC,  on the one  hand, and  directly or  indirectly through  CEDEL
Participants or Euroclear  Participants, on the other, will be  effected in
DTC  in accordance  with  DTC rules  on  behalf  of the  relevant  European
international  clearing system  by the  Relevant Depositary;  however, such
cross  market transactions  will require  delivery of  instructions to  the
relevant European  international  clearing system  by  the counterparty  in
such  system in  accordance with its  rules and  procedures and  within its
established   deadlines   (European   time).      The   relevant   European
international  clearing   system  will,  if   the  transaction   meets  its
settlement requirements,  deliver instructions  to the  Relevant Depositary
to  take action to  effect final settlement on  its behalf by delivering or
receiving securities in DTC, and making or receiving  payment in accordance
with normal  procedures for same  day funds  settlement applicable to  DTC.
CEDEL Participants and  Euroclear Participants may not deliver instructions
directly to the European Depositaries.

     DTC,  which is  a New  York-chartered  limited purpose  trust company,
performs  services for  its  participants,  some  of  which  (and/or  their
representatives) own  DTC.  In accordance  with its normal procedures,  DTC
is expected  to record the  positions held  by each DTC  participant in the
Book-Entry Certificates, whether held  for its own account or as  a nominee
for another  person.    In  general,  beneficial  ownership  of  Book-Entry
Certificates  will be  subject  to the  rules, regulations  and  procedures
governing DTC and DTC participants as in effect from time to time.

     CEDEL is incorporated  under the laws of Luxembourg as  a professional
depository.   CEDEL  holds securities  for its  participating organizations
("CEDEL Participants")  and  facilitates the  clearance  and settlement  of
securities  transactions  between  CEDEL  Participants  through  electronic
book-entry changes in accounts of  CEDEL Participants, thereby  eliminating
the  need for  physical  movement of  certificates.   Transactions  may  be
settled in CEDEL in any of 28 currencies, including  United States dollars.
CEDEL provides to its CEDEL Participants, among other  things, services for
safekeeping,  administration, clearance  and settlement  of internationally
traded securities and securities lending  and borrowing.   CEDEL interfaces
with domestic markets in several countries.  As  a professional depository,
CEDEL  is subject  to  regulation  by the  Luxembourg  Monetary  Institute.
CEDEL participants are  recognized financial institutions around the world,
including  underwriters,  securities  brokers  and  dealers,  banks,  trust
companies,  clearing   corporations   and   certain  other   organizations.
Indirect  access to  CEDEL is  also  available  to others,  such as  banks,
brokers,  dealers and  trust companies  that clear  through  or maintain  a
custodial  relationship  with  a  CEDEL  Participant,  either  directly  or
indirectly.

     Euroclear was created in 1968 to hold securities  for its participants
("Euroclear  Participants") and  to clear  and settle  transactions between
Euroclear Participants through simultaneous electronic book-entry  delivery
against payment,  thereby eliminating  the need  for  physical movement  of
certificates  and  any   risk  from  lack  of  simultaneous  transfers   of
securities and cash.  Transactions may be settled in any  of 32 currencies,
including  United  States   dollars.    Euroclear  includes  various  other
services, including  securities lending and  borrowing and  interfaces with
domestic  markets   in   several  countries   generally   similar  to   the
arrangements   for  cross-market   transfers  with   DTC  described  above.
Euroclear is  operated by the Brussels,  Belgium office of Morgan  Guaranty
Trust Company of  New York (the "Euroclear Operator"), under  contract with
Euroclear Clearance  Systems S.C., a  Belgian cooperative  corporation (the
"Cooperative").   All operations are conducted  by the Euroclear  Operator,
and  all  Euroclear   securities  clearance  accounts  and  Euroclear  cash
accounts  are accounts  with the  Euroclear Operator,  not the Cooperative.
The Cooperative establishes  policy for  Euroclear on  behalf of  Euroclear
Participants.    Euroclear Participants  include  banks  (including central
banks), securities brokers and dealers and other professional  financial 
intermediaries.   Indirect  access to  Euroclear is also available to  
other firms that  clear through or maintain  a custodial relationship with
a Euroclear Participant, either directly or indirectly.

     The Euroclear Operator  is the Belgian  branch of a  New York  banking
corporation  which is  a member  bank of  the Federal  Reserve System.   As
such,  it  is regulated  and  examined by  the Board  of  Governors of  the
Federal Reserve System  and the New York State  Banking Department, as well
as the Belgian Banking Commission.

     Securities  clearance accounts  and cash  accounts with  the Euroclear
Operator  are  governed  by the  Terms  and  Conditions  Governing  Use  of
Euroclear and the related Operating Procedures of the  Euroclear System and
applicable Belgian  law (collectively, the  "Terms and  Conditions").   The
Terms  and  Conditions  govern transfers  of  securities  and  cash  within
Euroclear, withdrawals of securities and cash from Euroclear, and  receipts
of payments with  respect to  securities in Euroclear.   All securities  in
Euroclear are  held on  a fungible  basis without  attribution of  specific
certificates to  specific  securities clearance  accounts.   The  Euroclear
Operator  acts under the Terms  and Conditions only on  behalf of Euroclear
Participants, and  has no record  of or  relationship with persons  holding
through Euroclear Participants.

     Distributions  on the  Book-Entry Certificates  will be  made on  each
Distribution  Date by  the Trustee  to DTC.   DTC  will be  responsible for
crediting the  amount of such  payments to the  accounts of the  applicable
DTC participants  in accordance  with DTC's  normal procedures.   Each  DTC
participant  will  be  responsible for  disbursing  such  payments  to  the
beneficial owners of the Book-Entry Certificates that it  represents and to
each  Financial  Intermediary  for which  it  acts  as  agent.   Each  such
Financial  Intermediary will  be responsible  for  disbursing funds  to the
beneficial owners of the Book-Entry Certificates that it represents.

     Under  a  book-entry  format,  beneficial  owners  of  the  Book-Entry
Certificates may experience some delay in their receipt  of payments, since
such  payments will  be forwarded by  the Trustee  to Cede.   Distributions
with  respect to  Certificates  held through  CEDEL  or Euroclear  will  be
credited   to  the  cash   accounts  of  CEDEL  Participants  or  Euroclear
Participants   in  accordance   with  the   relevant  system's   rules  and
procedures,  to the  extent  received by  the  Relevant Depositary.    Such
distributions will be subject to tax reporting in  accordance with relevant
United  States tax laws and  regulations.  See "CERTAIN  FEDERAL INCOME TAX
CONSEQUENCES--Foreign Investors"  and "Backup Withholding" herein.  Because
DTC  can only act  on behalf of Financial  Intermediaries, the ability of a
beneficial owner to pledge Book-Entry Certificates  to persons or  entities
that  do  not participate  in  the  Depository system,  or  otherwise  take
actions  in respect of such Book-Entry Certificates,  may be limited due to
the lack of physical certificates for such Book-Entry  Certificates.    
In  addition,   issuance  of  the   Book-Entry Certificates  in  book-entry
form  may  reduce  the  liquidity  of   such Certificates in the secondary 
market since certain potential investors  may be  unwilling  to  purchase  
Certificates  for  which  they  cannot  obtain physical certificates.

     Monthly and annual reports on  the Trust will be provided to Cede,  as
nominee  of DTC, and  may be  made available by  Cede to  beneficial owners
upon  request, in  accordance with  the  rules, regulations  and procedures
creating and affecting the Depository,  and to the Financial Intermediaries
to  whose DTC  accounts  the  Book-Entry Certificates  of  such  beneficial
owners are credited.

     DTC  has  advised  the  Trustee  that,  unless  and  until  Definitive
Certificates are  issued, DTC will take any action permitted to be taken by
the holders of the Book-Entry Certificates under the Agreement  only at the
direction of  one or more  Financial Intermediaries  to whose DTC  accounts
the Book-Entry Certificates  are credited, to the extent that  such actions
are  taken on  behalf of  Financial Intermediaries  whose  holdings include
such Book-Entry  Certificates.   CEDEL or  the Euroclear  Operator, as  the
case  may  be, will  take  any  other action  permitted  to be  taken  by a
Certificateholder under the  Agreement on behalf of a CEDEL  Participant or
Euroclear  Participant  only in  accordance  with  its  relevant rules  and
procedures and subject  to the ability of the Relevant Depositary to effect
such actions  on its  behalf through  DTC.  DTC  may take  actions, at  the
direction  of  the related  Participants,  with  respect to  some  Class  A
Certificates which conflict with actions taken with respect  to other Class
A Certificates.

   
     Definitive Certificates  will be  issued to  beneficial owners of  the
Book-Entry Certificates,  or their nominees,  rather than  to DTC, only  if
(a) DTC or Provident advises the Trustee  in writing that DTC is  no longer
willing, qualified  or able to discharge  properly its responsibilities  as
nominee  and depository  with respect  to  the Book-Entry  Certificates and
Provident or  the Trustee is  unable to locate  a qualified  successor, (b)
Provident,  at its sole option, with the consent  of the Trustee, elects to
terminate  a book-entry system  through DTC or (c)  after the occurrence of
an Event of Servicing Termination (as defined under  "--Events of Servicing
Termination), beneficial  owners  having  Percentage Interests  aggregating
not  less  than 51%  of  the  aggregate Class  A  Principal Balance  of the
Book-Entry  Certificates advise  the Trustee and DTC  through the Financial
Intermediaries and the  DTC participants  in writing that the  continuation
of a book-entry system through  DTC (or a  successor thereto) is no  longer
in the best interests of beneficial owners.
    

     Upon the occurrence of any of  the events described in the immediately
preceding paragraph, the Trustee will be required to  notify all beneficial
owners of the occurrence of such  event and the availability through DTC of
Definitive Certificates.  Upon surrender  by DTC  of the  global 
certificate  or certificates representing the  Book-Entry  Certificates  
and  instructions  for  re-registration, the Trustee will  issue  Definitive
Certificates,  and  thereafter the  Trustee will   recognize   the  holders
of   such   Definitive  Certificates   as Certificateholders under the 
Agreement.

     Although DTC,  CEDEL  and  Euroclear  have  agreed  to  the  foregoing
procedures in order  to facilitate transfers of Class A  Certificates among
participants of DTC, CEDEL and  Euroclear, they are under no obligation  to
perform or  continue to perform such procedures  and such procedures may be
discontinued at any time.

   
     Neither Provident, the  Master Servicer nor the Trustee will  have any
responsibility for any aspect  of the records relating to or  payments made
on  account   of   beneficial  ownership   interests   of  the   Book-Entry
Certificates  held  by  Cede, as  nominee  for  DTC,  or  for  maintaining,
supervising or reviewing any records relating to  such beneficial ownership
interests.
    

ASSIGNMENT OF MORTGAGE LOANS

     On the Closing Date  Provident will transfer to the  Trust all of  its
right, title  and  interest  in and  to  each  Mortgage Loan,  the  related
Mortgage Notes,  Mortgages and other  related documents  (collectively, the
"Related Documents"), including  all payments received  on or  with respect
to  each  such  Mortgage  Loan on  or  after  the  applicable Cut-Off  Date
(exclusive  of payments in  respect of  interest on the  Mortgage Loans due
prior  to  the  Cut-Off  Date  and  received  thereafter).    The  Trustee,
concurrently  with  such  transfer,  will   deliver  the  Certificates   to
Provident.  Each Mortgage Loan transferred to the Trust  will be identified
on  a schedule  (the "Mortgage  Loan Schedule")  delivered  to the  Trustee
pursuant  to  the Agreement.    The  Mortgage Loan  Schedule  will  include
information  as to  the Principal Balance  of each Mortgage Loan  as of the
Cut-Off Date, its Loan Rate as well as other information.

     (Under the terms of the Agreement, Provident will  maintain possession
of the documentation  relating to each Mortgage Loan (the  "Mortgage File")
for so long as an Assignment Event has not occurred.   Within 60 days of an
Assignment  Event,  the  Seller will  cause  as  soon  as  practicable  the
Mortgage  Files pertaining  to each Mortgage  Loan to  be delivered  to the
Trustee.  In the Agreement, the Trustee will acknowledge  the assignment of
the  Mortgage  Loans to  the Trust  and Provident  will agree  to  hold the
Mortgage Files for and on behalf of the Trustee.)

     Within  60 days of  an Assignment Event,  the Trustee  will review the
Mortgage Loans  and the Related Documents pursuant to  the Agreement and if
any  Mortgage Loan  or Related  Document is  found to  be defective  in any
material respect  and such  defect is  not cured  within 90 days  following
notification thereof  to the Seller, the Seller will be obligated to either
(i)  substitute  for  such Mortgage  Loan  an Eligible  Substitute Mortgage
Loan; however, such substitution is permitted  only within two  years of  
the Closing Date  and may not be  made unless  an opinion of  counsel is 
provided  to the  effect that  such substitution will not disqualify the 
Trust  as a REMIC or result in  a  prohibited transaction  tax under  the
Code or  (ii) purchase  such Mortgage Loan at  a price (the  "Purchase 
Price") equal to  the outstanding Principal Balance of such  Mortgage Loan 
as of the  date of purchase,  plus all accrued  and unpaid interest thereon,
computed at the Loan Rate, net of the  Master Servicing Fee (if  Provident 
is the Master  Servicer), plus the amount of any unreimbursed Servicing 
Advances made by  the Master Servicer. The Purchase  Price will be 
deposited in the Collection Account on or prior to the  next succeeding 
Determination  Date after  such obligation  arises. The obligation  of the 
Seller to  repurchase or substitute  for a Defective Mortgage  Loan is  
the sole remedy  regarding any  defects in  the Mortgage Loans  and   Related
Documents   available   to  the   Trustee   or   the Certificateholders.

     In  connection  with   the  substitution  of  an  Eligible  Substitute
Mortgage  Loan, the Seller  will be required  to deposit  in the Collection
Account  on or prior to  the next succeeding Determination  Date after such
obligation arises an amount  (the "Substitution Adjustment")  equal to  the
excess of  the Principal  Balance of  the related  Defective Mortgage  Loan
over the Principal Balance of such Eligible Substitute Mortgage Loan.

   
     An "Eligible Substitute Mortgage  Loan" is a Mortgage Loan substituted
by  the Seller  for a Defective  Mortgage Loan which  must, on  the date of
such  substitution, (i) have  an outstanding  Principal Balance (or  in the
case  of a  substitution of  more than  one Mortgage  Loan for  a Defective
Mortgage  Loan, an aggregate Principal  Balance), not in  excess of and not
more than  5% less than  the Principal  Balance of  the Defective  Mortgage
Loan; (ii) have a  Loan Rate not less than  the Loan Rate  of the Defective
Mortgage  Loan and  not more  than 1%  in excess of  the Loan  Rate of such
Defective Mortgage Loan;  (iii) if such Defective Mortgage Loan is  in Loan
Group 2, have a Loan Rate based on  the same Index with adjustments to such
Loan Rate  made on  the same Interest Rate  Adjustment Date as  that of the
Defective Mortgage Loan and  have a Margin that is not less than the Margin
of the Defective Mortgage  Loan and not more than  100 basis points  higher
than the Margin for the  Defective Mortgage Loan;  or (iv) have a  Mortgage
of the  same or higher  level of priority as  the Mortgage  relating to the
Defective  Mortgage Loan at the  time such Mortgage  was transferred to the
Trust;  (v) have  a remaining  term to  maturity not  more than  six months
earlier and not later than the remaining term to maturity  of the Defective
Mortgage Loan; (vi) comply with each representation and  warranty set forth
in Section 2.04 (deemed to be made  as of the date of  substitution); (vii)
have an  original Combined Loan-to-Value Ratio not greater than that of the
Defective Mortgage Loan; (viii)  if such Defective Mortgage Loan is in Loan
Group 2, have  a Lifetime Rate Cap  and a  Periodic Rate Cap no  lower than
the Lifetime  Rate Cap and Periodic  Rate Cap, respectively, applicable  to
such  Defective Mortgage  Loan; and (ix) be  of the same  type of Mortgaged
Property as the Defective Mortgage Loan  or  a  detached single  family  
residence.   More  than  one Eligible  Substitute Mortgage  Loan  may  be 
substituted  for  a  Defective Mortgage  Loan  if  such  Eligible  
Substitute  Mortgage  Loans   meet  the foregoing attributes in the 
aggregate and such substitution  is approved in writing in advance by the 
Certificate Insurer.
    

     The Seller will make certain representations and warranties  as to the
accuracy in all  material respects of certain information furnished  to the
Trustee with  respect to each Mortgage  Loan (e.g., Cut-Off Date  Principal
Balance and  the Loan Rate).   In addition, the  Seller will  represent and
warrant, on the Closing  Date, that, among other things: (i) at the time of
transfer  to the Trust,  the Seller has transferred  or assigned all of its
right, title and interest in each Mortgage  Loan and the Related Documents,
free  of any  lien; and (ii)  each Mortgage Loan  complied, at  the time of
origination, in  all material respects  with applicable  state and  federal
laws.   Upon discovery of a breach of  any such representation and warranty
which materially  and adversely  affects the  interests of  the Trust,  the
Certificateholders or  the Certificate Insurer in the related Mortgage Loan
and  Related Documents,  the Seller  will have  a period  of 60  days after
discovery or notice  of the breach to effect  a cure. If the breach  cannot
be cured  within the 60-day  period, the  Seller will  be obligated to  (i)
substitute  for  such   Defective  Mortgage  Loan  an  Eligible  Substitute
Mortgage  Loan or  (ii)  purchase such  Defective  Mortgage Loan  from  the
Trust.   The same procedure  and limitations  that are set  forth above for
the substitution or  purchase of  Defective Mortgage Loans  as a result  of
deficient documentation relating thereto  will apply to the substitution or
purchase  of a  Defective  Mortgage Loan  as  a result  of  a  breach of  a
representation  or warranty in  the Agreement that materially and adversely
affects  the  interests   of  the  Certificateholders  or  the  Certificate
Insurer.

     Mortgage Loans required  to be transferred to the Seller  as described
in the preceding paragraphs are referred to as "Defective Mortgage Loans."

     Pursuant  to  the Agreement,  the  Master  Servicer  will service  and
administer the Mortgage Loans as more fully set forth above.

PAYMENTS  ON   MORTGAGE   LOANS;  DEPOSITS   TO   COLLECTION  ACCOUNT   AND
DISTRIBUTION ACCOUNT

   
     The Master  Servicer shall establish  and maintain in the  name of the
Trustee  a  separate  trust  account  (the "Collection  Account")  for  the
benefit of  the holders of the  Certificates.  The  Collection Account will
be an  Eligible Account  (as defined  below).   Subject  to the  investment
provision  described in  the  following  paragraphs, upon  receipt  by  the
Master Servicer  of amounts  in respect  of the  Mortgage Loans  (excluding
amounts representing the  Master Servicing  Fee), the Master Servicer  will
deposit such amounts in  the Collection Account.  Amounts  so deposited may
be invested in Eligible Investments  (as  described in  the Agreement)  
maturing no  later than two Business Days prior  to the next succeeding date
on which  amounts on  deposit  therein are  required  to  be deposited  in  
the  Distribution Account.
    

     The  Trustee will  establish an  account (the  "Distribution Account")
into which will be deposited amounts withdrawn from  the Collection Account
for  distribution to  Certificateholders  on  a  Distribution  Date.    The
Distribution  Account will  be an  Eligible Account.    Amounts on  deposit
therein may be invested in Eligible  Investments maturing on or before  the
Business Day prior to the related Distribution Date.

     An "Eligible  Account" is  an account  that is  (i) maintained with  a
depository institution  whose debt obligations at  the time of any  deposit
therein have  the highest short-term  debt rating  by the Rating  Agencies,
and whose  accounts are  fully insured  by either  the Savings  Association
Insurance Fund ("SAIF") or  the Bank Insurance Fund ("BIF") of  the Federal
Deposit  Insurance Corporation  established  by such  fund with  a  minimum
long-term  unsecured  debt  rating  of  "A2" by  Moody's  and  "A"  by S&P,
otherwise acceptable to  each Rating Agency and the Certificate  Insurer as
evidenced by a letter from each  Rating Agency and the Certificate  Insurer
to  the Trustee,  without reduction  or withdrawal  of  their then  current
ratings of the Certificates.

   
     Eligible Investments  are specified in  the Agreement  and are limited
to investments which meet the criteria of the Rating Agencies  from time to
time  as  being   consistent  with  their  then  current  ratings   of  the
Certificates.     "Eligible   Investments"  are   limited  to   (i)  direct
obligations of,  or obligations fully  guaranteed as  to timely payment  of
principal and interest  by, the United  States or any agency  or instrumen-
tality  thereof, provided  that such  obligations are  backed  by the  full
faith and credit of the United States; (ii) repurchase  agreements on 
obligations  specified in clause  (i)  maturing  not  more  than  three  
months  from  the  date   of acquisition thereof,  provided that the  
short-term unsecured  debt obligations of the party agreeing  to repurchase
such obligations  are at the  time rated  by each  Rating  Agency  in its  
highest  short-term  rating  category;  (iii) certificates of deposit,  time 
deposits and bankers' acceptances (which, if Moody's  is a  Rating Agency, 
shall  each have an original  maturity of not more than 90  days and,  in 
the case of  bankers' acceptances, shall  in no event have an original 
maturity  of more than 365 days) of any U.S. depository  institution or  
trust  company incorporated  under  the laws  of  the United  States  or  
any  state  thereof  and  subject  to  supervision  and examination by federal
and/or state banking authorities,  provided that the unsecured short-term 
debt obligations of such depository institution or trust company at the 
date  of acquisition thereof have been rated  by each of the Rating Agencies
in  its highest unsecured  short-term debt rating  category; (iv)  commercial
paper (having original maturities of  not more than 90  days) of any  
corporation incorporated under the laws of the United States or any 
state thereof  which  on the  date  of acquisition  has been  rated by  the
Rating  Agencies in  their highest short-term rating  categories; (v) short
term investment  funds ("STIFS")  sponsored by  any trust  company or  bank
incorporated  under the  laws of  the United  States or  any  state thereof
which  on the date of acquisition has been rated  by the Rating Agencies in
their respective highest rating category of long term  unsecured debt; (vi)
interests in any money  market fund which at the date of acquisition of the
interests in such fund  and throughout the time as the interest is  held in
such  fund has the rating specified by each  Rating Agency; and (vii) other
obligations or securities that  are acceptable to each Rating Agency  as an
Eligible  Investment hereunder  and will not  result in a  reduction in the
then  current rating of the Certificates, as evidenced  by a letter to such
effect  from  such Rating  Agency  and  with respect  to  which the  Master
Servicer  has received confirmation that, for tax  purposes, the investment
complies with the last clause of this definition; provided that no
                                                  --------
instrument described hereunder shall  evidence either the  right to receive
(a)  only  interest  with   respect  to  the  obligations  underlying  such
instrument  or  (b)  both principal  and  interest  payments  derived  from
obligations  underlying  such instrument  and  the  interest and  principal
payments with respect  to such instrument provided  a yield to maturity  at
par greater than 120%  of the  yield to maturity at  par of the  underlying
obligations; and provided, further, that no instrument described hereunder
                 --------  -------
may be purchased  at a price  greater than  par if such  instrument may  be
prepaid or called  at a  price less than  its purchase price  prior to  its
stated maturity.
    

ADVANCES

     Not later than two Business Days  prior to each Distribution Date, the
Master Servicer will remit  to the Trustee for deposit in  the Distribution
Account an  amount, to  be distributed  on the  related Distribution  Date,
equal  to  the sum  of  the  interest accrued  and  principal  due on  each
Mortgage Loan through the related  Due Date but not received by the  Master
Servicer as  of the close of  business on the last  day of the related  Due
Period (net of  the Master Servicing  Fee) (the "Monthly  Advance").   Such
obligation of the  Master Servicer continues with respect to  each Mortgage
Loan until such Mortgage Loan becomes a Liquidated Mortgage Loan.

     In  the course  of performing  its servicing  obligations,  the Master
Servicer will  pay all reasonable and  customary "out-of-pocket" costs  and
expenses  incurred  in   the  performance  of  its  servicing  obligations,
including,  but  not  limited  to,  the  cost  of   (i)  the  preservation,
restoration  and   protection  of  the   Mortgaged  Properties,   (ii)  any
enforcement or judicial  proceedings, including foreclosures, and (iii) the
management   and   liquidation   of  Mortgaged   Properties   acquired   in
satisfaction   of  the  related  Mortgage.    Each  such  expenditure  will
constitute a "Servicing Advance".

     The Master  Servicer's right to  reimbursement for  Servicing Advances
is limited  to late  collections on  the related  Mortgage Loan,  including
Liquidation Proceeds, Insurance  Proceeds and such other amounts as  may be
collected by  the Master Servicer from  the related Mortgagor or  otherwise
relating  to  the Mortgage  Loan  in  respect of  which  such  unreimbursed
amounts  are  owed.   The  Master  Servicer's right  to  reimbursement  for
Monthly  Advances shall be  limited to late collections  of interest on any
Mortgage Loan  and to Liquidation  Proceeds and  Insurance Proceeds on  the
related Mortgage Loan.  The Master Servicer's right  to such reimbursements
is prior to the rights of Certificateholders.

     Notwithstanding  the foregoing, the Master Servicer is not required to
make  any  Monthly  Advance  or Servicing  Advance  if  in  the good  faith
judgment and  sole discretion of the  Master Servicer, the Master  Servicer
determines  that such  advance  will  not be  ultimately  recoverable  from
collections received from the Mortgagor in respect of  the related Mortgage
Loan  or   other  recoveries   in  respect   of  such   Mortgage  Loan   (a
"Nonrecoverable Advance").   However, if any  Servicing Advance  or Monthly
Advance is  determined by  the Master  Servicer to  be nonrecoverable  from
such sources, the  amount of such Nonrecoverable Advance may  be reimbursed
to the  Master Servicer from  other amounts  on deposit  in the  Collection
Account.

DISTRIBUTION DATES

     On each  Distribution  Date, the  Offered  Certificateholders will  be
entitled  to receive,  from amounts  then on  deposit  in the  Distribution
Account, to the extent  of funds available therefor in accordance  with the
priorities   and  in  the   amounts  described  below  under  "Priority  of
Distributions,"  an aggregate  amount  equal to  the sum  of (a)  the Class
Interest Distribution  for each Class of  Offered Certificates and (b)  the
Class  A Principal Distribution for each Certificate  Group.  Distributions
will  be made  (i) in  immediately available  funds to  holders  of Offered
Certificates  holding  Certificates,  the  aggregate  principal balance  of
which  is  at  least $1,000,000,  by  wire transfer  or  otherwise,  to the
account  of such  Certificateholder  at a  domestic  bank or  other  entity
having appropriate  facilities therefor, if  such Certificateholder  has so
notified the  Trustee in accordance  with the Agreement,  or (ii)  by check
mailed to the address  of the person entitled thereto as it appears  on the
register  (the  "Certificate   Register")  maintained  by  the  Trustee  as
registrar (the "Certificate Registrar").

DEPOSITS TO THE DISTRIBUTION ACCOUNT

     No later than  one Business Day prior  to each Distribution Date,  the
following amounts in respect of  a Loan Group  and the previous Due  Period
shall be deposited  into the Distribution Account and shall  constitute the
"Available Funds" for  the related Certificate  Group for such Distribution
Date: (i)  payments of principal and interest on the Mortgage Loans in such
Loan  Group (net  of amounts  representing the  Master  Servicing Fee  with
respect to  each Mortgage  Loan in  the  related Loan  Group and  
reimbursement for related Monthly  Advances  and Servicing  Advances);  (ii)
Net  Liquidation Proceeds and Insurance Proceeds with respect to  the 
Mortgage Loans in such Loan  Group  (net of  amounts applied  to the  
restoration or  repair  of a Mortgaged  Property); (iii)  the Purchase  
Price for  repurchased Defective Mortgage Loans with respect to  the 
Mortgage Loans  in such Loan Group  and any related Substitution Adjustment
Amounts;  (iv) payments from the Master Servicer in connection  with (a) 
Monthly Advances, (b) Prepayment  Interest Shortfalls  and (c)  the  
termination of  the  Trust  with respect  to  the Mortgage  Loans in  such 
Loan Group  as provided in the  Agreement; and (v) any amounts paid  under 
the  Policy in respect  of the related  Certificate Group.

PRIORITY OF DISTRIBUTIONS

     On  each  Distribution  Date  the  Trustee  shall  withdraw  from  the
Distribution  Account the sum  of (a)  the Available Funds  with respect to
the Group 1 Certificates and  (b) the Available  Funds with respect to  the
Group  2   Certificates  (such  sum,  the  "Amount  Available"),  and  make
distributions thereof as  described below and to  the extent of the  Amount
Available:


          A.   With  respect to  the Group  1  Certificates, the  Available
     Funds with  respect to such Certificate  Group in the following  order
     of priority:

               (i)  to the  Trustee, the  Trustee fee  for such  Loan Group
          for such Distribution Date;

               (ii) to  holders of  each Class of Group  1 Certificates, an
          amount  equal to the related Class Interest Distribution for such
          Distribution Date;

               (iii)     sequentially, to the Class  A-1, Class A-2,  Class
          A-3, Class  A-4 and Class  A-5 Certificateholders, in that order,
          until  the respective  Class  A  Principal Balance  of  each such
          Class  is  reduced  to   zero,  the  related  Class  A  Principal
          Distribution   (other   than   the   portion   constituting   the
          Distributable   Excess  Spread)   for  such   Distribution  Date;
          provided, however, that after the occurrence and continuance of
          --------  -------
          an Insurer Default, such portion of the Class A  Principal 
          Distribution for the  Group  1  Certificates will  be distributed
          pro  rata to  the holders thereof based on the respective Class 
          A Principal Balances;

               (iv) to  the Certificate  Insurer, the  amount owing  to the
          Certificate  Insurer  under  the  Insurance  Agreement   for  the
          premium payable in respect of the Group 1 Certificates; and

               (v)  sequentially, to the Class A-1,  Class A-2, Class  A-3,
          Class A-4 and Class A-5 Certificateholders, in that order,  until
          the respective  Class A Principal Balance  of each such Class  is
          reduced to  zero,  the related  Distributable  Excess Spread  for
          such Distribution Date; provided, however, that after the
                                  --------  -------
          occurrence and  continuance  of  an  Insurer  Default,  such  
          Distributable Excess Spread  for the Group 1 Certificates will 
          be distributed pro rata to the holders thereof based on the 
          respective Class A Principal Balances.

          B.   With  respect to  the Group  2  Certificates, the  Available
     Funds with  respect to such Certificate  Group in the following  order
     of priority:

               (i)  to  the Trustee,  the Trustee  fee for such  Loan Group
          for such Distribution Date;

               (ii) to the  holders  of  the  Class  A-6  Certificates,  an
          amount equal to the Class Interest Distribution for  the Class A-
          6 Certificates for such Distribution Date;

               (iii)     to the holders  of the Class A-6 Certificates, the
          Class  A Principal  Distribution for  the Class  A-6 Certificates
          (other  than the  portion constituting  the Distributable  Excess
          Spread);

               (iv) to  the Certificate  Insurer, the  amount owing  to the
          Certificate   Insurer  under  the  Insurance  Agreement  for  the
          premium payable in respect of the Group 2 Certificates; and

               (v)  to the holders of  the Class A-6 Certificates until the
          Class  A-6 Principal  Balance  is reduced  to zero,  the  related
          Distributable Excess Spread for such Distribution Date.

          C.  On any  Distribution Date, to the extent Available  Funds for
     a  Certificate  Group  are  insufficient  to  make  the  distributions
     specified above pursuant  to the applicable subclause, Available Funds
     for   the  other   Certificate  Group   remaining  after   making  the
     distributions  required  to  be  made   pursuant  to  the   applicable
     subclause  for such other  Certificate Group  shall be  distributed to
     the extent  of such  insufficiency in accordance  with the  priorities
     for distribution set forth  in the subclause above with respect to the
     Certificate Group experiencing such insufficiency.

          D.  After  making the distributions referred to in  subclauses A,
     B and  C above, the Trustee shall  make distributions in the following
     order  of priority,  to  the  extent  of  the balance  of  the  Amount
     Available:

               (i)  to  the Master Servicer, the amount of  any accrued and
          unpaid Master Servicing Fee;

               (ii) to  the  Certificate  Insurer,  amounts  owing  to  the
          Certificate  Insurer for  reimbursement for  prior draws  made on
          the Policy;

               (iii)     to   the    Master   Servicer,   the   amount   of
          Nonrecoverable Advances not previously reimbursed;

               (iv) to the Certificate  Insurer, any other amounts owing to
          the Certificate Insurer under the Insurance Agreement;

               (v)  to the  Class  A-6  Certificateholders, the  Class  A-6
          Interest Carryover; and

               (vi) to the Class R Certificateholders, the balance.

     "Class  A-6   Interest   Carryover"  means,   with   respect  to   any
Distribution  Date  on  which  the  Certificate  Rate  for  the  Class  A-6
Certificates is based upon the Net Funds Cap, the excess  of (i) the amount
of interest  the Class  A-6 Certificates  would be  entitled to receive  on
such  Distribution Date  had  such rate  been  calculated pursuant  to  the
lesser of clause (A)  and clause (C) of the  definition of Certificate Rate
over  (ii) the  amount  of interest  the  Class A-6  Certificates  actually
receives on  such Distribution Date, plus  accrued interest thereon at  the
rate determined pursuant to clause (i) above for such Distribution Date.

THE CERTIFICATE RATE

     The "Certificate  Rate" for any Interest  Period with respect to:  the
Class A-1 Certificates will be      % per annum, the Class A-2 Certificates
will be       % per annum,  the Class  A-3 Certificates will be       % per
annum, the Class A-4  Certificates will be      % per  annum and the  Class
A-5 Certificates  will be       % per  annum.  Interest  in respect  of any
Distribution  Date will  accrue on  the Group  1  Certificates during  each
Interest Period on the basis of a 360-day year consisting  of twelve 30-day
months.

     The "Certificate Rate" with respect to the Class  A-6 Certificates for
an Interest Period  will equal the least of  (A) the sum of the LIBOR  Rate
plus  ____% (or ____% for  each Distribution Date occurring  after the date
on  which the  Master Servicer has  the right to terminate  the Trust), (B)
the  Net Funds  Cap for  such Distribution  Date and  (C) ____%  per annum.
With respect  to the  Class A-6  Certificates, interest  in respect  of any
Distribution Date will accrue during  each Interest Period on the  basis of
a 360-day year and the actual number of days elapsed.

     The  "LIBOR Rate"  is the rate  for United States  dollar deposits for
one month which appear on the Telerate Screen LIBO Page 3750 as 

of 11:00 A.M., London  time, on the second LIBOR Business Day prior  to the
first day of  any Interest Period  relating to the  Class A-6  Certificates
(or the second LIBOR  Business Day prior to the  Closing Date, in  the case
of  the first  Distribution Date).   If such  rate does not  appear on such
page (or such  other page as  may replace that page on  that service, or if
such service  is no longer offered,  such other service  for displaying the
LIBOR Rate or comparable rates as  may be reasonably selected by Provident,
after consultation with the  Trustee), the rate will be the  Reference Bank
Rate.   If no such quotations can be obtained and no Reference Bank Rate is
available,  the  LIBOR Rate  will  be  the  LIBOR  Rate applicable  to  the
preceding Distribution Date.  On the second LIBOR  Business Day immediately
preceding each  Distribution Date,  the Trustee shall  determine the  LIBOR
Rate  for the  Interest Period  commencing on  such  Distribution Date  and
inform the Master Servicer of such rate.

INTEREST

     On each Distribution  Date, to the extent of funds  available therefor
as described  herein, interest  will be  distributed with  respect to  each
Class  of Class  A  Certificates  in an  amount  (each, a  "Class  Interest
Distribution") equal to the sum of  (a) one month's interest at the related
Certificate  Rate  on  the related  Class  A Principal  Balance immediately
prior to  such Distribution Date (the "Class Monthly Interest Distributable
Amount") and (b) any Class  Interest Carryover Shortfall for such Class  of
Class A Certificates  for such Distribution  Date.  As to  any Distribution
Date and Class of Class A Certificates, Class  Interest Carryover Shortfall
is  the  sum of  (i)  the  excess of  the  related  Class Monthly  Interest
Distributable  Amount   for  the  preceding   Distribution  Rate   and  any
outstanding  Class Interest Carryover Shortfall with respect  to such Class
on  such  preceding  Distribution Date,  over  the  amount  in  respect  of
interest  that is  actually distributed  to such  Class  on such  preceding
Distribution Date plus  (ii) one month's  interest on  such excess, to  the
extent permitted by law,  at the related Certificate Rate.    The  interest
entitlement described  in (a) above will be reduced by such Class' pro rata
share  of  Civil   Relief  Act  Interest  Shortfalls,  if  any,   for  such
Distribution  Date.   Civil  Relief Act  Interest  Shortfalls will  not  be
covered by payments under the Policy.

     On each  Distribution Date, the Class  Interest Distribution for  each
Class of  Class A Certificates  in a particular  Certificate Group will  be
distributed  on an equal priority and  any shortfall in the amount required
to be distributed as interest thereon  to each such Class will be allocated
between such  Classes pro rata  based on  the amount each  such Class would
have  been  distributed  in  the  absence  of  such  shortfall.    See  "--
Crosscollateralization" below.

PRINCIPAL

     On each Distribution  Date, to the extent of funds  available thereof,
in accordance with the priorities described above under "--Priorities  of  
Distributions," principal  will  be  distributed to  the holders of  
Class A Certificates of each Certificate Group then entitled to
distributions  of principal in  an amount  equal to the  lesser of  (A) the
related Aggregate  Class A Principal  Balance and (B)  the related  Class A
Principal  Distribution for  such Distribution  Date.   "Class  A Principal
Distribution" means, with respect to any Distribution  Date and Certificate
Group,  the sum  of the  related Class  A  Monthly Principal  Distributable
Amount for  such Distribution Date  and any  outstanding Class A  Principal
Carryover  Shortfall  as  of  the  close  of  business   on  the  preceding
Distribution Date.

     "Class A Monthly Principal Distributable  Amount" means, with  respect
to any  Distribution Date  and Certificate  Group, to  the extent  of funds
available therefor as described herein  the amount equal to the sum of  the
following  amounts (without  duplication) with  respect to  the immediately
preceding Due Period (as  defined below): (i) each payment of  principal on
a Mortgage Loan in the  related Loan Group received by the Master  Servicer
during  such  Due  Period,  including  all   full  and  partial   principal
prepayments,  (ii) the Principal Balance  as of the  end of the immediately
preceding Due Period of each  Mortgage Loan in the related Loan Group  that
became a Liquidated  Mortgage Loan for  the first time  during the  related
Due Period, (iii) the portion of the Purchase Price  allocable to principal
of all repurchased Defective Mortgage Loans in the related Loan Group  with
respect  to such  Due  Period,  (iv) any  Substitution  Adjustment  Amounts
received  on  or  prior to  the  previous  Determination Date  and  not yet
distributed with  respect to the  related Loan Group  and (v)  such portion
(not  greater  than  100%)  of  Excess  Spread,  if  any,  required  to  be
distributed on  such Distribution  Date to  satisfy the  required level  of
overcollateralization for  the  related Loan  Group  for such  Distribution
Date (the "Distributable Excess Spread").

     "Class A  Principal Carryover  Shortfall" means,  with respect to  any
Distribution  Date and  Certificate  Group, the  excess of  the sum  of the
related Class A  Monthly Principal Distributable  Amount for  the preceding
Distribution  Date  and  any  outstanding   Class  A  Principal   Carryover
Shortfall  with  respect  to  such  Certificate  Group  on  such  preceding
Distribution Date over the amount in respect of principal  that is actually
distributed to the Class A Certificateholders of such  Certificate Group on
such preceding Distribution Date.

     If  the  required level  of  overcollateralization  for a  Certificate
Group  is reduced below  the then  existing amount of overcollateralization
(described  below) or if  the required  level of  overcollateralization for
such  Certificate Group  is satisfied,  the amount  of the  related Class A
Monthly Principal Distributable Amount on  the following Distribution  Date
will  be correspondingly reduced by the amount of  such reduction or by the
amount necessary  such that the  overcollateralization will  not exceed the
required  level  of overcollateralization  for  a  Certificate Group  after
giving effect to the  distribution in respect  of principal  with respect 
to  such Certificate Group to be made on such Distribution Date.

     The  application  of  Distributable  Excess Spread  in  respect  of  a
Certificate  Group is intended to create overcollateralization to provide a
source of  additional cashflow to cover losses on the Mortgage Loans in the
related Loan Group.   If  the amount of losses  in a particular  Due Period
for such  Loan Group exceeds the  amount of the  related Excess  Spread for
the related  Distribution Date,  subject to the provisions  described below
under  "--Crosscollateralization," the  amount  distributed in  respect  of
principal will be reduced.   A draw on the Policy  in respect of  principal
will not  be made until  the Class  A Principal  Balance of a  Certificates
Group exceeds the aggregate Principal Balance  of the Mortgage Loans in the
related Loan Group.  See "--The  Policy" herein.  Accordingly, there may be
Distribution Dates  on which Class  A Certificateholders  receive little or
no distributions in respect of principal.

     So long  as an Insurer  Default has  not occurred  and is  continuing,
distributions of  the Class A  Principal Distribution  with respect to  the
Group 1 Certificates will be applied, sequentially, to  the distribution of
principal to the Class A-1, Class A-2,  Class A-3, Class A-4 and  Class A-5
Certificates,  in that order,  such that  no Class of  Group 1 Certificates
having a  higher  numerical  designation is  entitled  to distributions  of
principal  until the  Class  A  Principal Balance  of  each  such Class  of
Certificates  having  a lower  numerical designation  has  been  reduced to
zero.  On any Distribution Date  if an Insurer Default has  occurred and is
continuing,  the Class A Principal Distribution with respect to the Group 1
Certificates will be  applied to the distribution of principal of each such
Class outstanding  on a  pro rata  basis  in accordance  with  the Class  A
Principal Balance of each such Class.

     On  each Distribution  Date following  an Insurer  Default, net losses
realized in respect of Liquidated  Mortgage Loans in  a Loan Group (to  the
extent such amount is not covered by Available Funds from  the related Loan
Group  or  the  crosscollateralization  mechanics  described  herein)  will
reduce the  amount of overcollateralization,  if any,  with respect to  the
related Certificate Group.

     "Due  Period"  means,  with  respect  to  any  Determination  Date  or
Distribution   Date,   the  calendar   month  immediately   preceding  such
Determination Date or Distribution Date, as the case may be.

     A  "Liquidated Mortgage  Loan",  as to  any  Distribution Date,  is  a
Mortgage Loan  with respect to which the Master Servicer has determined, in
accordance with the servicing procedures specified in the  Agreement, as of
the end of the  preceding Due Period, that  all Liquidation Proceeds  which
it  expects  to recover  with  respect  to such  Mortgage  Loan  (including
disposition of the related REO Property) have been recovered.

     "Excess Spread" means, with respect to any Distribution  Date and Loan
Group, the  positive excess, if any, of (x) Available Funds for the related
Certificate Group for  such Distribution Date over (y) the  amount required
to be distributed  pursuant to  subclause A  items (i)  through (iv),  with
respect  to the  Group 1  Certificates and  subclause  B items  (i) through
(iv),  with respect  to the  Group 2 Certificates,  in each  case set forth
under the heading "DESCRIPTION OF CERTIFICATES--Priority  of Distributions"
on such Distribution Date.

     An "Insurer Default"  will occur in the event the  Certificate Insurer
fails to make a payment  required under the Policy or if certain events  of
bankruptcy or insolvency occur with respect to the Certificate Insurer.

THE POLICY

   
     The  following  information  has  been  supplied  by  the  Certificate
Insurer for inclusion  in this Prospectus Supplement.  Accordingly, neither
Provident  nor the  Master  Servicer makes  any  representation as  to  the
accuracy and completeness of such information.
    

     The Certificate  Insurer,  in  consideration  of the  payment  of  the
premium and  subject to the  terms of  the Policy, thereby  unconditionally
and irrevocably guarantees to  any Owner that an amount  equal to each full
and     complete     Insured     Payment     will     be     received    by
__________________________,  or its  successor, as  trustee for  the Owners
(the "Trustee"), on  behalf of the Owners from the Certificate Insurer, for
distribution by  the Trustee to  each Owner  of each Owner's  proportionate
share of the Insured Payment.  The Certificate  Insurer's obligations under
the  Policy  with  respect  to  a  particular  Insured   Payment  shall  be
discharged to the extent funds equal to the applicable Insured Payment  are
received by the Trustee, whether or  not such funds are properly applied by
the Trustee.  Insured Payments shall be made only at the time  set forth in
the Policy and no accelerated Insured  Payments shall be made regardless of
any acceleration of  the Class A Certificates, unless such  acceleration is
at the sole option of the Certificate Insurer.

     Notwithstanding  the foregoing  paragraph, the  Policy does  not cover
shortfalls, if any, attributable to the  liability of the Trust, the  REMIC
or  the Trustee  for  withholding taxes,  if  any (including  interest  and
penalties in respect of any such liability).

     The  Certificate  Insurer will  pay  any  Insured Payment  that  is  a
Preference Amount on the Business  Day following receipt on a  Business Day
by the Fiscal  Agent (as described  below) of (i) a  certified copy  of the
order requiring  the return  of a  preference payment, (ii)  an opinion  of
counsel satisfactory  to the Certificate Insurer  that such order is  final
and not subject to appeal, (iii) an  assignment in such  form as is  
reasonably required  by the Certificate Insurer, irrevocably  assigning to 
the Certificate  Insurer all rights  and claims of the Owner relating  to 
or arising under the Class A  Certificates against the  debtor that  made 
such  preference payment  or otherwise  with respect to  such Preference  
Amount  and  (iv) appropriate  instruments  to effect the appointment of 
the  Certificate Insurer as agent for  such Owner in  any   legal  
proceeding  related  to   such  Preference  Amount,   such instruments  being
in  a form  satisfactory  to  the Certificate  Insurer, provided  that if
such documents  are received  after 12:00 noon  New York City time on such 
Business Day,  they will be deemed to be  received on the following Business
Day.   Such payments shall be disbursed  to the receiver or trustee in 
bankruptcy named  in the final order of the court  exercising jurisdiction 
on  behalf of  the Owners and  not any  Owner directly  unless
such  Owner  has  returned  principal or  interest  paid  on  the  Class  A
Certificates to such receiver or trustee in bankruptcy, in which case  such
payment shall be disbursed to such Owner.

     The Certificate  Insurer will pay any  other amount payable under  the
Policy  no later  than 12:00 noon  New York City  time on the  later of the
Distribution  Date on  which the Deficiency  Amount is due  or the Business
Day following receipt  in New York,  New York  on a Business  Day by  State
Street Bank and Trust  Company, N.A., as Fiscal  Agent for the  Certificate
Insurer or any successor fiscal agent appointed by  the Certificate Insurer
(the  "Fiscal Agent")  of a Notice  (as described below);  provided that if
such Notice is  received after 12:00  noon New  York City time  on such 
Business Day, it will  be deemed to be received on  the following Business
Day.  If any such Notice  received by the Fiscal Agent  is not in proper 
form or  is otherwise insufficient for the purpose of making claim under 
the Policy  it shall  be deemed not to have been received by the Fiscal 
Agent for purposes of this paragraph, and the Certificate  Insurer or the 
Fiscal Agent, as the case  may be,  shall promptly  so advise  the Trustee
and the  Trustee may submit an amended Notice.

     Insured Payments due under the Policy unless  otherwise stated therein
will  be disbursed by  the Fiscal  Agent to  the Trustee  on behalf  of the
Owners  by wire transfer  of immediately available  funds in  the amount of
the  Insured  Payment less,  in  respect  of Insured  Payments  related  to
Preference Amounts, any amount held by the Trustee for the  payment of such
Insured Payment and legally available therefor.

     The Fiscal Agent is the agent of the Certificate Insurer  only and the
Fiscal Agent shall in no  event be liable to the Owners for any acts of the
Fiscal Agent  or any failure of the Certificate Insurer to deposit or cause
to be deposited, sufficient funds to make payments due under the Policy.

     As  used in the Policy,  the following terms  shall have the following
meanings:

   
          "Agreement" means the Pooling and  Servicing Agreement, dated  as
     of _________________,  between  The  Provident  Bank,  as  Seller  and
     Master Servicer,  and the Trustee, as  trustee, without regard to  any
     amendment or supplement  thereto unless such amendment or modification
     has been approved in writing by the Certificate Insurer.
    

          "Business Day" means any  day other than a Saturday,  a Sunday or
     a  day on which banking institutions  in New York  City or the city in
     which the  corporate trust office of  the Trustee under the  Agreement
     is located are  authorized or obligated by  law or executive order  to
     close.

          "Deficiency  Amount"  means for  any  Distribution  Date (A)  the
     excess, if any,  of (i)  Class Monthly  Interest Distributable  Amount
     (net  of any  Civil Relief  Act Interest  Shortfalls)  plus any  Class
     Interest  Carryover  Shortfall  over (ii)  funds  on  deposit  in  the
     Distribution  Account  (net  of the  Trustee's  Fee and  the Insurance
     Premium for such Distribution  Date) and (B)  the Guaranteed Principal
     Amount.

          "Guaranteed  Principal Amount"  means for  any Distribution  Date
     (a) the amount which is required to reduce the then outstanding  Class
     A Principal Balance after giving effect to the  distributions, if any,
     to the  Holders in respect of  principal on such  Distribution Date to
     an amount  equal to the  Aggregate Principal  Balance of the  Mortgage
     Loans as of the  last day of the immediately  preceding Due Period and
     (b)  on  __________,  ____  after  all  distributions  have been  made
     including distributions pursuant to clause (a)  of this definition  of
     "Guaranteed   Principal  Amount,"   an  amount   equal  to   the  then
     outstanding Class A Principal Balance.

          "Insured  Payment" means  (i) as  of  any Distribution  Date, any
     Deficiency Amount and (ii) any Preference Amount.

          "Notice"  means the  telephonic or  telegraphic notice,  promptly
     confirmed  in  writing  (in  the  case  of  a  telephonic  notice)  by
     telecopy,  substantially in  the form  of Exhibit  A  attached to  the
     Policy, the original of which is subsequently  delivered by registered
     or certified mail,  from the  Trustee specifying  the Insured  Payment
     which shall be due and owing on the applicable Distribution Date.

          "Owner" means each  Holder (as defined in the Agreement)  who, on
     the applicable Distribution  Date, is entitled under the terms  of the
     applicable Class A Certificates to payment under the Policy.

          "Preference Amount"  means any  amount previously  distributed to
     an Owner on  the Class A Certificates  that is recoverable and  sought
     to be  recovered as a  voidable preference by a  trustee in bankruptcy
     pursuant to the United States Bankruptcy Code (11  U.S.C.), as amended
     from  time to time  in accordance  with  a  final  nonappealable  
     order  of  a  court  having competent jurisdiction.

     Capitalized terms used  in the Policy and not otherwise defined in the
Policy shall have the respective meanings  set forth in the Agreement as of
the  date  of execution  of  the  Policy,  without  giving  effect  to  any
subsequent  amendment  or  modification  to   the  Agreement  unless   such
amendment or modification  has been approved in writing by  the Certificate
Insurer.

     Any notice under the Policy or  service of process on the Fiscal Agent
may be made at  the address listed below for the Fiscal Agent or such other
address  as  the  Certificate Insurer  shall  specify  to  the  Trustee  in
writing.

     The      notice     address     of     the     Fiscal     Agent     is
_________________________________  Attention:  ________________,  or   such
other address as the Fiscal Agent shall specify to the Trustee in writing.

     The  Policy is  being  issued  under and  pursuant  to, and  shall  be
construed under, the laws  of the State of New  York, without giving effect
to the conflict of laws principles thereof.

     The  insurance  provided   by  the  Policy  is  not  covered   by  the
Property/Casualty Insurance Security Fund  specified in Article  76 of  the
New York Insurance Law.

     The  Policy is  not cancelable  for any  reason.   The premium  on the
Policy is  not refundable for  any reason  including payment, or  provision
being made for payment, prior to the maturity of the Class A Certificates.

OVERCOLLATERALIZATION

     The credit  enhancement provisions of  the Trust  result in a  limited
acceleration of  the Class A Certificates  of a Certificate Group  relative
to the amortization of the Mortgage Loans in the related  Loan Group in the
early months of the transaction.  The accelerated  amortization is achieved
by the application of Distributable  Excess Spread relating to a Loan Group
to  principal distributions  on the  Class A  Certificates  of the  related
Certificate  Group.   This  acceleration feature  creates, with  respect to
each Certificate  Group,  overcollateralization (i.e.,  the  excess of  the
aggregate  outstanding Principal  Balance  of  the  Mortgage Loans  in  the
related Loan Group  over the related Aggregate Class A  Principal Balance).
Once  the  required  level  of  overcollateralization  is   reached  for  a
Certificate Group,  and subject  to the  provisions described  in the  next
paragraph, the  acceleration feature for such Certificate Group will cease,
until  necessary to  maintain the  required level  of overcollateralization
for such Certificate Group.

     The  Agreement  provides that,  subject to  certain  floors,  caps and
triggers, the  required level  of overcollateralization with  respect to  a
Certificate Group  may increase or decrease over time.  Any decrease in the
required level  of overcollateralization for a  Loan Group will occur  only
at the sole discretion of the  Certificate Insurer.  Any such decrease will
have the  effect of reducing the  amortization of the  Class A Certificates
of the related Certificate Group below what it otherwise would have been.

CROSSCOLLATERALIZATION

     Excess Spread with respect to a  Loan Group will be available to cover
certain shortfalls  with respect  to the Offered  Certificates relating  to
the  other Loan Group as  described above under the  caption "--Priority of
Distributions".

   
(PRE-FUNDING ACCOUNT

     On the  Closing Date,  $___________ (the "Pre-Funded Amount")  will be
deposited  in an account  (the "Pre-Funding  Account"), which account shall
be in the  name of and maintained by  the Trustee and shall  be part of the
Trust Fund and will  be used to acquire Subsequent  Mortgage Loans.  During
the period beginning on the Closing Date and  terminating on _____________,
19__ (the "Funding Period"), the Pre-Funded  Amount will be reduced by  the
amount thereof used  to purchase  Subsequent Mortgage  Loans in  accordance
with  the Agreement.   Any  Pre-Funded Amount remaining  at the  end of the
Funding  Period  will   be  distributed  to  holders  of  the   classes  of
Certificates entitled  to  receive principal  on the  Distribution Date  in
______________, 19__  in  reduction of  the  related Certificate  Principal
Balances (thus resulting  in a partial principal prepayment of  the related
Certificates on such date). 

     Amounts on  deposit in  the Pre-Funding  Account will  be invested  in
Permitted Investments.   All interest and any other investment  earnings on
amounts on  deposit in the  Pre-Funding Account  will be  deposited in  the
Capitalized Interest Account.

CAPITALIZED INTEREST ACCOUNT

     On  the  Closing  Date there  will  be  deposited in  an  account (the
"Capitalized Interest  Account") maintained  with and  in the  name of  the
Trustee on behalf of the Trust Fund a  portion of the proceeds of the  sale
of the  Certificates.  The  amount deposited  therein will  be used by  the
Trustee   on   the   Distribution   Dates   in   __________________   19__,
_____________  19__  and   ______________,  19__  to  cover  shortfalls  in
interest on  the Certificates that may arise as a result of the utilization
of  the  Pre-Funding  Account  for  the  purchase  by  the  Trust  Fund  of
Subsequent Mortgage  Loans after the Closing  Date.  Any amounts  remaining
in the  Capitalized Interest Account at the end of the Funding Period which
are not needed to  cover shortfalls on  the Distribution  Date in 
___________  19__ are required to be paid directly to Provident.)
    

REPORTS TO CERTIFICATEHOLDERS

     Concurrently  with each  distribution to  the Certificateholders,  the
Trustee will  forward to each Certificateholder  a statement (based  solely
on  information  received from  the  Master Servicer)  setting forth  among
other items with respect to each Distribution Date:

          (i)  the aggregate amount of  the distribution to  each Class  of
     Certificateholders on such Distribution Date;

          (ii) the amount  of distribution set forth in paragraph (i) above
     in respect of interest and the  amount thereof in respect of any Class
     Interest Carryover  Shortfall, and  the amount of  any Class  Interest
     Carryover Shortfall remaining;

          (iii)     the amount of distribution set  forth in paragraph  (i)
     above in  respect of  principal and the  amount thereof in  respect of
     the Class A  Principal Carryover Shortfall, and any remaining  Class A
     Principal Carryover Shortfall;

          (iv) the amount  of Excess  Spread for  each Loan  Group and  the
     amount applied as to a distribution on the Certificates;

          (v)  the   Guaranteed  Principal  Amount  with  respect  to  each
     Certificate Group, if any, for such Distribution Date;

          (vi) the amount paid under the Policy for such Distribution  Date
     in  respect  of the  Class  Interest  Distribution to  each  Class  of
     Certificates;

          (vii)     the Master Servicing Fee;

          (viii)    the Pool Principal  Balance, the Loan Group 1 Principal
     Balance  and the  Loan Group 2  Principal Balance, in each  case as of
     the close of business on the last day of the preceding Due Period;

          (ix) the Aggregate Class  A Principal Balance of each Certificate
     Group after giving effect to payments allocated to principal above;

          (x)  the amount of  overcollateralization relating  to each  Loan
     Group as  of the close  of business  on the  Distribution Date,  after
     giving  effect  to distributions  of  principal  on such  Distribution
     Date;

          (xi) the number and  aggregate Principal Balances of the Mortgage
     Loans as to which the minimum monthly payment is 

     delinquent  for  30-59   days,  60-89  days  and  90  or   more  days,
     respectively, as of the end of the preceding Due Period;

          (xii)     the book value of any real estate which  is acquired by
     the  Trust   through  foreclosure  or  grant   of  deed  in  lieu   of
     foreclosure;

          (xiii)    the  aggregate amount  of prepayments  received on  the
     Mortgage Loans  during the  previous Due  Period  and specifying  such
     amount for each Loan Group; and

          (xiv)     the weighted  average Loan Rate  on the  Mortgage Loans
     and specifying such weighted average Loan Rate for each Loan  Group as
     of the first day of the month prior to the Distribution Date.

     In the  case of  information furnished  pursuant to  clauses (ii)  and
(iii) above,  the  amounts  shall  be expressed  as  a  dollar  amount  per
Certificate with a $1,000 denomination.

     Within 60 days after the  end of each calendar year, the Trustee  will
forward to each Person,  if requested in writing by  such Person, who was a
Certificateholder  during the  prior calendar  year a  statement containing
the information set  forth in clauses (ii)  and (iii) above aggregated  for
such calendar year.

LAST SCHEDULED DISTRIBUTION DATE

     The  last  scheduled  Distribution Date  for  each  Class  of  Offered
Certificates is as follows: Class A-1  Certificates,                ; Class
A-2 Certificates,                ; Class A-3 Certificates,                ;
Class A-4 Certificates,              ; Class A-5 Certificates,             
; and Class A-6  Certificates,                 .   It is expected that  the
actual last Distribution  Date for each Class of Offered  Certificates will
occur significantly  earlier than  such scheduled Distribution Dates.   See
"PREPAYMENT AND YIELD CONSIDERATIONS".

     Such last  scheduled Distribution Dates are  based on a 0%  Prepayment
Assumption  with no  Distributable Excess  Spread used to  make accelerated
payments of  principal to the holders  of the related Offered  Certificates
and  the   assumptions  set  forth   above  under   "PREPAYMENT  AND  YIELD
CONSIDERATIONS--Weighted Average Lives"; provided that the last scheduled
                                         --------
Distribution  Dates  for the  Class  A-5  Certificates and  the  Class  A-6
Certificates have  been calculated assuming that  the Mortgage Loan in  the
related  Loan  Group  having  the  latest  maturity  date  allowed  by  the
Agreement amortizes according to its terms, plus one year.

COLLECTION AND OTHER SERVICING PROCEDURES ON MORTGAGE LOANS

     The  Master Servicer  will  make  reasonable efforts  to  collect  all
payments called for under the Mortgage Loans and will, consistent with  the
Agreement,  follow such  collection  procedures as  it follows from  time 
to  time with respect  to the home  equity loans  in its servicing portfolio
comparable to the Mortgage Loans.   Consistent with the above, the  Master 
Servicer may  in its discretion  waive any late  payment charge or any  
assumption or other fee or  charge that may be collected  in the ordinary 
course of servicing the Mortgage Loans.

     With respect  to the Mortgage  Loans, the  Maser Servicer may  arrange
with a borrower a schedule  for the payment of interest  due and unpaid for
a period, provided that any such arrangement is consistent with  the Master
Servicer's  policies with respect to the home equity mortgage loans it owns
or services.

HAZARD INSURANCE

     The  Master Servicer  will  cause to  be  maintained fire  and  hazard
insurance with extended coverage customary in the area  where the Mortgaged
Property is located, in an  amount which is at least equal to the  least of
(i) the outstanding Principal Balance on  the Mortgage Loan and any related
senior lien(s), (ii) the full insurable value of the  premises securing the
Mortgage  Loan and  (iii) the  minimum amount  required  to compensate  for
damage  or loss on  a replacement cost basis in  each case in an amount not
less  than such  amount as  is necessary  to avoid  the application  of any
co-insurance  clause  contained in  the  related  hazard insurance  policy.
Generally,  if the  Mortgaged  Property is  in an  area  identified  in the
Federal Register  by the Flood  Emergency Management  Agency as FLOOD  ZONE
"A",  such flood insurance has been  made available and the Master Servicer
determines  that such insurance  is necessary  in accordance  with accepted
mortgage servicing  practices of prudent  lending institutions,  the Master
Servicer  will cause  to  be  purchased a  flood  insurance  policy with  a
generally acceptable insurance  carrier, in an amount representing coverage
not less  than the least  of (a)  the outstanding Principal  Balance of the
Mortgage Loan and the First Lien, if any,  (b) the full insurable value  of
the Mortgaged  Property, or (c) the  maximum amount of insurance  available
under the  National Flood Insurance  Act of  1968, as amended.   The Master
Servicer will  also maintain on REO Property, to  the extent such insurance
is  available,  fire  and   hazard  insurance  in  the  applicable  amounts
described  above, liability  insurance  and,  to the  extent  required  and
available under the  National Flood Insurance Act of  1968, as amended, and
the  Master  Servicer  determines  that  such  insurance  is  necessary  in
accordance with  accepted mortgage servicing  practices of  prudent lending
institutions, flood  insurance in an amount  equal to that required  above.
Any  amounts collected  by  the Master  Servicer  under any  such  policies
(other  than amounts  to be  applied to  the restoration  or repair  of the
Mortgaged Property, or to  be released to the Mortgagor  in accordance with
customary  mortgage  servicing  procedures)  will   be  deposited  in   the
Collection Account,  subject to  retention by  the Master  Servicer to  the
extent such amounts constitute  servicing  compensation   or  to  withdrawal
pursuant  to  the Agreement.

     In the event that the Master Servicer obtains and  maintains a blanket
policy  as provided in  the Agreement insuring against  fire and hazards of
extended coverage on all  of the Mortgage Loans, then,  to the extent  such
policy names  the Master Servicer as loss payee and provides coverage in an
amount equal  to the  aggregate unpaid  principal balance  of the  Mortgage
Loans  without coinsurance, and otherwise complies with the requirements of
the first paragraph of this subsection, the Master Servicer  will be deemed
conclusively to  have satisfied its  obligations with  respect to fire  and
hazard insurance coverage.

REALIZATION UPON DEFAULTED MORTGAGE LOANS

     The Master  Servicer  will  foreclose  upon  or  otherwise  comparably
convert to  ownership Mortgaged Properties  securing such  of the  Mortgage
Loans as  come into default when,  in accordance with applicable  servicing
procedures under  the Agreement,  no satisfactory arrangements can  be made
for  the  collection of  delinquent  payments.   In  connection  with  such
foreclosure  or other  conversion, the  Master  Servicer  will follow  such
practices as  it deems necessary  or advisable  and as are  in keeping with
its  general  mortgage  servicing  activities,  provided  that  the  Master
Servicer will not be  required to expend its own  funds in connection  with
foreclosure or other conversion, correction of default on  a related senior
mortgage loan  or restoration of any property unless, in its sole judgment,
such foreclosure, correction or restoration  will increase Net  Liquidation
Proceeds.   The  Master  Servicer will  be  reimbursed out  of  Liquidation
Proceeds for advances of  its own funds as liquidation expenses  before any
Net Liquidation Proceeds are distributed to Certificateholders.

SERVICING COMPENSATION AND PAYMENT OF EXPENSES

     With respect  to each  Due Period,  the Master  Servicer will  receive
from interest payments in respect  of the Mortgage Loans a portion of  such
interest payments as a monthly Master  Servicing Fee in the amount equal to
0.50% per  annum (the "Master Servicing Fee Rate") on the Principal Balance
of each Mortgage Loan  as of the  first day of each  such Due Period.   All
assumption fees, late payment  charges and other fees  and charges, to  the
extent collected  from borrowers, will be  retained by the Master  Servicer
as additional servicing compensation.

     The   Master  Servicer's  right  to   reimbursement  for  unreimbursed
Servicing Advances is  limited to late collections on the  related Mortgage
Loan,  including Liquidation  Proceeds, Insurance  Proceeds and  such other
amounts  as may  be  collected by  the  Master  Servicer from  the  related
Mortgagor or  otherwise relating to  the Mortgage Loan in  respect of which
such  unreimbursed  amounts are  owed.    The Master  Servicer's  right  to
reimbursement for unreimbursed Monthly Advances shall be limited  to late 
collections of interest on  any Mortgage Loan and  to liquidation  proceeds
and  insurance proceeds  on the  related Mortgage  Loan.   The Master  
Servicer's right  to  such reimbursements  is prior  to the  rights of  
Certificateholders.   However,  if any  Servicing Advance  or Monthly  
Advance is  determined by  the  Master Servicer  to be nonrecoverable  from  
such  sources,  the  amount  of  such  nonrecoverable advances may  be 
reimbursed to  the Master Servicer  from other amounts  on deposit in the 
Collection Account. 

     Civil  Relief Act  Interest  Shortfalls will  not  be covered  by  the
Policy, although Prepayment Interest Shortfalls,  after application of  the
Master  Servicing Fee,  will be  so covered.   The  Master Servicer  is not
obligated to offset any of the  Master Servicing Fee against, or to provide
any other funds  to cover,  any shortfalls in  interest collections on  the
Mortgage  Loans that  are  attributable to  the  application of  the  Civil
Relief Act ("Civil  Relief Act Interest Shortfalls").  See  "RISK FACTORS--
Payments on the Mortgage Loans" in this Prospectus Supplement.

EVIDENCE AS TO COMPLIANCE

   
     The Agreement provides for delivery  on or before the last day of  the
fifth  month  following the  end  of  the Master  Servicer's  fiscal  year,
beginning in 1997,  to the Trustee, Provident, the Certificate  Insurer and
the  Rating Agencies  of an  annual statement signed  by an  officer of the
Master Servicer to  the effect that  the Master Servicer has  fulfilled its
material obligations  under the Agreement  throughout the  preceding fiscal
year, except as specified in such statement.
    

     On or before the last day  of the fifth month following the end of the
Master Servicer's fiscal year, beginning in ____, the  Master Servicer will
furnish a  report prepared by a  firm of nationally recognized  independent
public  accountants (who  may  also render  other  services to  the  Master
Servicer or Provident) to  the Trustee, Provident,  the Certificate Insurer
and  the Rating Agencies to the effect that  such firm has examined certain
documents  and the  records relating  to servicing  of  the Mortgage  Loans
under the Uniform Single Attestation Program for Mortgage  Bankers and such
firm's conclusion with respect thereto.

     The Master Servicer's fiscal year is the calendar year.

CERTAIN MATTERS REGARDING THE MASTER SERVICER

     The Agreement  provides that the Master  Servicer may not resign  from
its  obligations  and  duties  thereunder,  except  in  connection  with  a
permitted transfer of  servicing, unless  (i) such  duties and  obligations
are no longer  permissible under applicable law as  evidenced by an opinion
of  counsel  delivered  to  the  Certificate  Insurer  or   (ii)  upon  the
satisfaction  of  the  following conditions:  (a)  the Master  Servicer has
proposed a successor master servicer to the  Trustee in  writing and  such 
proposed  successor  master servicer  is reasonably  acceptable  to  the  
Trustee;  (b)  the  Rating  Agencies  have confirmed to  the Trustee that 
the  appointment of such proposed  successor master servicer  as the Master
Servicer will not result in the reduction or withdrawal of  the then current
rating of the  Certificates; and (c)  such proposed  successor  master   
servicer  is  reasonably  acceptable  to  the Certificate Insurer.   No such
resignation will become effective  until the Trustee or  a successor master 
servicer  has assumed the Master  Servicer's obligations and duties under 
the Agreement.

     The Master  Servicer may  perform any  of its  duties and  obligations
under the  Agreement through one or  more subservicers or delegates,  which
may  be  affiliates of  the  Master  Servicer.   Notwithstanding  any  such
arrangement, the  Master Servicer will remain  liable and obligated to  the
Trustee and  the Certificateholders  for the Master  Servicer's duties  and
obligations under the Agreement, without any diminution of  such duties and
obligations  and as  if the  Master Servicer  itself  were performing  such
duties and obligations.

     The Master  Servicer may permit the  placement of a subsequent  senior
mortgage on any Mortgaged Property, provided that (a)  the related Mortgage
succeeded  to  a  first lien  position  after  the  Closing Date  for  such
Mortgage  Loan  and, immediately  following the  placement  of  such senior
lien, such  Mortgage is  in  a  second lien  position and  the  outstanding
principal amount  of the mortgage  loan secured  by such senior  lien is no
greater than  the outstanding principal amount  of the first mortgage  loan
existing  as   of  the   Closing  Date   and   the  recalculated   combined
loan-to-value  ratio of the Mortgage Loan  is not greater than the Combined
Loan-to-Value  Ratio of such  Mortgage Loan as of  the Closing Date; or (b)
the Mortgage relating to  the Mortgage Loan was in  a second lien  position
as of the Closing Date,  the new senior lien secures  a mortgage loan  that
refinances an existing first  mortgage loan and  the outstanding  principal
amount of such refinanced mortgage loan is no greater than  the outstanding
principal  amount of  the first  mortgage loan  existing as  of the Closing
Date and  the recalculated  combined loan-to-value  ratio of  such Mortgage
Loan is not greater than  the Combined Loan-to-Value Ratio of such Mortgage
Loan as of the Closing Date.

     In addition, the Master Servicer may  agree to changes in the terms of
a Mortgage Loan, provided,  however, that such  changes (i) will not  cause
the  Trust to fail to  qualify as  a REMIC and do  not adversely affect the
interests of  the Certificateholders or the  Certificate Insurer, (ii)  are
consistent with  prudent business  practices and  (iii) do  not change  the
Loan  Rate  of such  Mortgage  Loan or  extend the  maturity  date of  such
Mortgage Loan  in excess  of  one year.    Any changes  to the  terms of  a
Mortgage Loan that  would cause the Trust  to fail  to qualify as a  REMIC,
however, may be agreed to by the Master Servicer, provided  that the Master
Servicer has  determined such changes are  necessary to avoid a  prepayment
of such Mortgage  Loan, such changes are  in accordance with prudent  
business practices  and  the  Master  Servicer  purchases  such  Mortgage  
Loan   in accordance with the terms of the Agreement.

   
     The Agreement provides  that the  Master Servicer  will indemnify  the
Trust  and the  Trustee  from and  against  any loss,  liability,  expense,
damage  or  injury  suffered  or  sustained  as  a  result  of  the  Master
Servicer's  actions  or  omissions in  connection  with  the servicing  and
administration of  the Mortgage Loans which are  not in accordance with the
provisions  of  the  Agreement.     The  Agreement  provides  that  neither
Provident nor the Master Servicer nor their  directors, officers, employees
or agents will be under any other liability to the Trust, the  Trustee, the
Certificateholders  or  any  other person  for  any  action  taken  or  for
refraining from  taking any  action pursuant  to the  Agreement.   However,
neither Provident  nor the Master  Servicer will  be protected against  any
liability  which   would  otherwise  be  imposed   by  reason  of   willful
misconduct,  bad faith  or  gross negligence  of  Provident or  the  Master
Servicer,  as the case may be,  in the performance  of its duties under the
Agreement  or  by   reason  of  reckless   disregard  of   its  obligations
thereunder.  In  addition, the Agreement provides that the  Master Servicer
will  not be  under any  obligation to appear  in, prosecute  or defend any
legal  action which  is  not incidental  to its  servicing responsibilities
under the  Agreement.   The Master Servicer  may, in  its sole  discretion,
undertake any such  legal action which it  may deem necessary or  desirable
with  respect to the  Agreement and  the rights and  duties of  the parties
thereto and the interest of the Certificateholders thereunder.
    

     Any  corporation into  which  the Master  Servicer  may be  merged  or
consolidated, or any  corporation resulting from any merger, conversion  or
consolidation  to  which the  Master  Servicer shall  be  a  party, or  any
corporation  succeeding to the business of the Master Servicer shall be the
successor  of  the   Master  Servicer  under  the  Agreement,  without  the
execution or filing  of any paper or any further  act on the part of any of
the parties to  the Agreement, anything  in the Agreement  to the  contrary
notwithstanding.

EVENTS OF DEFAULT

     "Events of  Default"  will consist  of: (i)  (A)  any  failure of  the
Master  Servicer to  make any  required Monthly  Advance or  (B) any  other
failure  of the  Master Servicer  to deposit  in the Collection  Account or
Distribution Account any  deposit required to be made under  the Agreement,
which failure continues  unremedied for two Business Days after  the giving
of written notice of such  failure to the  Master Servicer by the  Trustee,
or  to the  Master Servicer and  the Trustee by the  Certificate Insurer or
any Certificateholder;  (ii) any  failure by  the Master  Servicer duly  to
observe or perform in any  material respect any  other of its covenants  or
agreements in the  Agreement which, in each case, materially  and adversely
affects  the interests of the Certificateholders or the Certificate Insurer
and continues unremedied for 60 days after the giving of written 
notice of such  failure to the Master  Servicer by  the Trustee, or to  the
Master  Servicer  and  the  Trustee  by  the  Certificate  Insurer  or  any
Certificateholder; (iii)  any failure by  the Master  Servicer to make  any
required Servicing  Advance,  which  failure  continues  unremedied  for  a
period  of 30  days after the giving  of written notice  of such failure to
the  Master Servicer  by the  Trustee, or  to the  Master Servicer  and the
Trustee  by  the  Certificate  Insurer or  any  Certificateholder;  or (iv)
certain events of insolvency, readjustment  of debt, marshalling  of assets
and liabilities or similar proceedings relating to the  Master Servicer and
certain   actions   by   the   Master   Servicer   indicating   insolvency,
reorganization  or  inability   to  pay  its  obligations  (an  "Insolvency
Event").

     Upon  the  occurrence and  continuation  beyond  the applicable  grace
period  of the  event described  in clause  (i) (A)  above, if  any Monthly
Advance  is  not made  by  4:00 P.M.,  New York  City  time, on  the second
Business  Day following  written  notice to  the  Master Servicer  of  such
event, the  Trustee will make  such Monthly Advance and  either the Trustee
or a successor master  servicer will immediately  assume the duties of  the
Master Servicer.

     Upon removal or  resignation of the Master Servicer, the  Trustee will
be the  successor master servicer (the  "Successor Master Servicer").   The
Trustee, as  Successor Master Servicer, will  be obligated to make  Monthly
Advances  and  Servicing  Advances and  certain  other  advances  unless it
determines reasonably  and in good  faith that such  advances would not  be
recoverable.

     Notwithstanding the foregoing,  a delay in  or failure  of performance
referred to under  clause (i) above  for a period of  ten Business  Days or
referred  to under  clause (ii)  above for  a period  of 30  Business Days,
shall not  constitute an Event of  Default if such  delay or  failure could
not be  prevented by  the exercise  of reasonable  diligence by the  Master
Servicer and such  delay or failure was  caused by  an act of God  or other
similar occurrence.   Upon  the occurrence  of  any such  event the  Master
Servicer shall not be  relieved from using its best  efforts to perform its
obligations  in  a timely  manner  in  accordance  with the  terms  of  the
Agreement  and  the  Master  Servicer  shall   provide  the  Trustee,   the
Certificate Insurer  and  the  Certificateholders  prompt  notice  of  such
failure or delay  by it, together with a  description of its  efforts to so
perform its obligations.

RIGHTS UPON AN EVENT OF DEFAULT

     So  long  as  an Event  of  Default  remains  unremedied,  either  the
Trustee, Certificateholders  holding Certificates  evidencing at least  51%
of  the Percentage  Interests  in  the  Trust,  with  the  consent  of  the
Certificate Insurer,  or the Certificate Insurer  may terminate all of  the
rights  and obligations of  the Master Servicer under  the Agreement and in
and to the Mortgage  Loans, whereupon the Trustee will  succeed to all  the
responsibilities, duties and liabilities  of  the  Master Servicer  under  
the  Agreement  and  will  be entitled  to similar  compensation 
arrangements.   In  the  event that  the Trustee would be  obligated to 
succeed to all the  responsibilities, duties and liabilities  of the Master
Servicer  but is unwilling  or unable  so to act, it  may appoint, or 
petition a court of competent jurisdiction for the appointment of,  a 
housing and home  finance institution or other  mortgage loan or home  
equity loan servicer with  all licenses and permits  required to perform 
its obligations under  the Agreement and  having a net worth  of
at least $50,000,000  and acceptable to  the Certificate Insurer to  act as
successor  to  the Master  Servicer  under  the Agreement.    Pending  such
appointment, the Trustee will be obligated  to act in such capacity  unless
prohibited  by law.   Such successor  will be entitled to  receive the same
compensation  that the Master  Servicer would  otherwise have  received (or
such lesser compensation as  the Trustee and such successor  may agree).  A
receiver  or  conservator for  the  Master  Servicer may  be  empowered  to
prevent the termination and  replacement of the Master Servicer if the only
Event of Default that has occurred is an Insolvency Event.

AMENDMENT

     The  Agreement may  be amended  from time to  time by  the Seller, the
Master Servicer, and  the Trustee and with  the consent of  the Certificate
Insurer, but  without the consent  of the  Certificateholders, to cure  any
ambiguity, to  correct or supplement  any provisions  therein which may  be
inconsistent with  any other  provisions of  the Agreement,  to add to  the
duties  of  the   Seller  or  the  Master  Servicer   to  comply  with  any
requirements  imposed by  the  Internal  Revenue  Code  or  any  regulation
thereunder, or to add or amend  any provisions of the Agreement as required
by the Rating Agencies in  order to maintain  or improve any rating of  the
Offered  Certificates  (it  being  understood  that,  after  obtaining  the
ratings in effect  on the  Closing Date, neither  the Seller, the  Trustee,
the Certificate  Insurer nor the  Master Servicer  is obligated to  obtain,
maintain, or improve any such  rating) or to add any other provisions  with
respect to  matters or questions  arising under  the Agreement which  shall
not be  inconsistent with the  provisions of  the Agreement; provided  that
such action  will not, as  evidenced by  an opinion  of counsel,  
materially and adversely affect  the interests of any Certificateholder or 
the Certificate Insurer; provided, further, that any such amendment will not
be deemed to materially and adversely  affect the Certificateholders and 
no such opinion will be required to  be delivered if the  person requesting
such  amendment obtains  a letter  from the  Rating Agencies  stating  that
such  amendment would  not  result in  a  downgrading  of the  then  
current rating  of the Offered Certificates.  The Agreement may also be 
amended from  time to time by the Seller, the  Master Servicer, and the 
Trustee,  with the consent  of Certificateholders evidencing at  least 
51% of the Percentage Interests  of each Class affected thereby and the 
Certificate  Insurer for the purpose of adding any provisions to  or 
changing in any manner  or eliminating any  of the provisions of the 
Agreement or of modifying in any manner the  rights of the Certificate-
holders, provided that no such amendment will (i) reduce in any  manner 
the amount of, or delay the timing of, collections of payments on the 
Certificates or distributions or payments  under the Policy which are
required to be  made on  any Certificate without  the consent of
the  Certificateholder or (ii)  reduce the aforesaid percentage required to
consent to any such  amendment, without the consent of  the holders of  all
Offered Certificates then outstanding.

TERMINATION; PURCHASE OF MORTGAGE LOANS

     The Trust will terminate on the Distribution Date  following the later
of  (A) payment in  full of  all amounts owing  to the  Certificate Insurer
unless  the  Certificate  Insurer  shall  otherwise  consent  and  (B)  the
earliest  of  (i) the  Distribution Date  on  which the  Aggregate Class  A
Principal  Balance has  been  reduced to  zero, (ii)  the final  payment or
other  liquidation  of the  last  Mortgage  Loan in  the  Trust, (iii)  the
optional  purchase  by  the Master  Servicer  of  the  Mortgage  Loans,  as
described below and (iv) the Distribution Date in  (        ) on which date
the  Policy will  be available  to pay  the outstanding  Aggregate Class  A
Principal Balance of the Class A Certificates.

     Subject to provisions  in the Agreement concerning adopting a  plan of
complete  liquidation, the  Master Servicer  may, at its  option, terminate
the Agreement on any date on which the Pool Principal  Balance is less than
5%  of the sum of the Cut-Off Date Pool Principal Balance by purchasing, on
the  next succeeding  Distribution Date,  all of  the  outstanding Mortgage
Loans  at a  price equal  to  the sum  of  the  outstanding Pool  Principal
Balance (subject to reduction as  provided in the Agreement if the purchase
price is based in part on the appraised  value of any REO Property included
in the Trust and  such appraised value is less  than the Principal  Balance
of the  related Mortgage Loan)  and accrued and unpaid  interest thereon at
the weighted average  of the Loan Rates through  the end of the Due  Period
preceding the  final Distribution Date  together with  all amounts due  and
owing to the Certificate Insurer.

     Any  such  purchase   shall  be  accomplished  by  deposit  into   the
Distribution Account of the purchase price specified above.

THE TRUSTEE

     ________________________________________,   has  been   named  Trustee
pursuant to the Agreement.

     The  Trustee may have normal banking relationships  with Provident and
the Master Servicer.

     The Trustee may resign at  any time, in which event Provident will  be
obligated to  appoint a successor Trustee,  as approved by the  Certificate
Insurer.  Provident may also  remove the Trustee  if the Trustee ceases  to
be eligible to continue as such under the Agreement or  if the  Trustee 
becomes  insolvent.  Upon  becoming aware  of such  circumstances, Provident
will be  obligated to  appoint  a successor Trustee,  as approved  by  the 
Certificate  Insurer.   Any  resignation  or removal  of the Trustee  and 
appointment  of a  successor Trustee  will not become  effective until  
acceptance  of  the appointment  by  the successor Trustee.

     No holder  of a Certificate will have any right under the Agreement to
institute any proceeding  with respect to the Agreement unless  such holder
previously has given  to the Trustee written  notice of default and  unless
Certificateholders holding  Certificates  evidencing at  least  51% of  the
Percentage  Interests in  the Trust  have made  written  requests upon  the
Trustee to institute  such proceeding in its own name as Trustee thereunder
and have offered  to the Trustee reasonable  indemnity and the  Trustee for
60  days has  neglected or refused  to institute any such  proceeding.  The
Trustee will  be under  no obligation  to  exercise any  of  the trusts  or
powers vested  in  it by  the  Agreement or  to make  any investigation  of
matters  arising  thereunder  or  to   institute,  conduct  or  defend  any
litigation  thereunder or  in relation  thereto at  the  request, order  or
direction of any  of the Certificateholders, unless such Certificateholders
have offered  to the Trustee reasonable  security or indemnity against  the
cost, expenses and liabilities which may be incurred therein or thereby.


                              USE OF PROCEEDS

   
     The net  proceeds to  be received  from the sale  of the  Certificates
will be applied by Provident towards general corporate purposes.
    


                  CERTAIN FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES

     An  election  will be  made  to  treat the  Trust  as  a "real  estate
mortgage  investment conduit"  ("REMIC") for  federal income  tax purposes 
under the Internal Revenue  Code  of 1986,  as  amended (the  "Code"). In
the opinion of the Tax Counsel,the Class  A Certificates will  be designated
as  "regular interests"  in the REMIC  and the  Class R Certificates will be
designated as  the sole class of residual interests in  the REMIC.   See
"CERTAIN  FEDERAL INCOME TAX  CONSEQUENCES-- Taxation of the REMIC and its
Holders" in the Prospectus.

     The   Offered  Certificates   generally  will   be  treated   as  debt
instruments issued by the  REMIC for Federal income  tax purposes.   Income
on  such  Certificates  must  be  reported  under  an   accrual  method  of
accounting.

     The  Offered Certificates  may,  depending on  their issue  price,  be
issued  with  original  issue  discount  ("OID")  for  federal  income  tax
purposes.   Holders of such  Certificates issued with OID  will be required
to include OID in income as it accrues under a constant yield  method, in  
advance  of  the receipt  of cash  attributable  to such income.    The  
OID  Regulations  do  not contain  provisions  specifically interpreting   
Code  Section   1272(a)(6)  which   applies  to   prepayable securities 
such  as the Offered  Certificates.   Until the Treasury  issues guidance 
to the contrary, the  Trustee intends to base its OID  computation on  
Code Section  1272(a)(6) and  the OID  Regulations as  described in the
Prospectus.    However, because  no  regulatory  guidance currently  exists
under  Code  Section  1272(a)(6), there  can  be  no  assurance  that  such
methodology represents the correct manner of calculating OID.

     The  yield  used  to calculate  accruals of  OID  with respect  to the
Offered  Certificates with OID  will be  the original yield  to maturity of
such Certificates, determined  by assuming that the Mortgage Loans  in Loan
Group 1 will  prepay in accordance with     % of  the Prepayment Assumption
and that  the Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 2 will prepay in accordance with
  %  of the  Prepayment Assumption.   No representation  is made  as to the
actual rate at which the Mortgage Loans will prepay.

     Prepayments  on  mortgage loans  are commonly  measured relative  to a
prepayment standard  or model.   The  Prepayment Assumption  model used  in
this  Prospectus is  based on  a  Constant Prepayment  Rate ("CPR").    CPR
represents  a constant rate of prepayment  on the Mortgage Loans each month
relative to  the aggregate  outstanding principal balance  of the  Mortgage
Loans.  CPR does not purport to be  either an historical description of the
prepayment experience of any pool of mortgage loans or a  prediction of the
anticipated rate  of prepayment of  any pool  of mortgage loans,  including
the Mortgage  Loans, and there is no assurance that the Mortgage Loans will
prepay at  the specified CPR.   Provident does not  make any representation
about the appropriateness of the CPR model.

     In the opinion of Tax Counsel, the Offered  Certificates will be  
treated as  regular interests in  a REMIC  under  section   860G  of  the 
Code.    Accordingly,   the  Offered Certificates will be  treated as (i)
assets described  in section 7701(a)(19)(C) of  the Code, and (ii) "real
estate  assets" within the meaning  of section 856(c)(5) of the  Code, in
each  case to the extent described in the Prospectus.  Interest on the
Offered Certificates will  be treated as  interest on obligations secured 
by mortgages on real  property within  the meaning of section 856(c)(3)(B)
of the  Code to the same extent that the  Offered Certificates  are treated 
as real  estate  assets.   See "Certain Federal Income Tax Consequences" in
the Prospectus.

BACKUP WITHHOLDING

     Certain  Certificate Owners  may be  subject to  backup withholding at
the rate of 31%  with respect to interest paid  on the Offered Certificates
if the  Certificate Owners, upon  issuance, fail to  supply the Trustee  or
their broker with their taxpayer identification   number,  furnish   an  
incorrect  taxpayer  identification number,  fails  to  report  interest,   
dividends,  or  other   "reportable payments"  (as   defined  in   the  
Code)  properly,   or,  under   certain circumstances,  fails  to  provide
the  Trustee  or  their  broker  with  a certified statement,  under penalty
of perjury,  that they are not  subject to backup withholding.

     The Trustee  will be required to  report annually to  the IRS,  and to
each Offered Certificateholder of record, the amount of  interest paid (and
OID  accrued,  if  any) on  the  Offered Certificates  (and  the  amount of
interest  withheld for  Federal income  taxes, if  any)  for each  calendar
year,  except   as  to   exempt  holders  (generally,   holders  that   are
corporations, certain  tax-exempt organizations or  nonresident aliens  who
provide certification as to their status  as nonresidents).  As long as the
only  "Class A  Certificateholder" of record  is Cede, as  nominee for DTC,
Certificate  Owners and  the IRS  will receive  tax  and other  information
including  the amount  of interest  paid on  such  Certificates owned  from
Participants and Indirect Participants rather than from the  Trustee.  (The
Trustee, however,  will respond  to requests  for necessary  information to
enable  Participants, Indirect  Participants and  certain other  persons to
complete  their  reports.)   Each  non-exempt  Certificate  Owner  will  be
required to provide, under  penalty of perjury,  a certificate on IRS  Form
W-9   containing  his  or  her  name,  address,  correct  Federal  taxpayer
identification number  and a statement  that he  or she  is not subject  to
backup withholding.   Should a nonexempt Certificate Owner fail  to provide
the required certification, the Participants  or Indirect Participants  (or
the Paying  Agent) will be  required to  withhold 31% of  the interest (and
principal) otherwise payable  to the holder, and remit the  withheld amount
to the IRS as a credit against the holder's Federal income tax liability.

     Such  amounts will  be deemed distributed to  the affected Certificate
owner for all purposes of the Certificates, the Agreement and the Policy.

FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES TO FOREIGN INVESTORS

     The following information describes the  United States federal  income
tax  treatment of  holders that  are not  United  States persons  ("Foreign
Investors").   The term "Foreign Investor" means  any person other than (i)
a  citizen  or   resident  of  the  United  States,  (ii)   a  corporation,
partnership  or other entity  organized in or under  the laws of the United
States or any state or political  subdivision thereof, (iii) an estate 
the income of  which is includible in gross  income for United States
federal income tax purposes, regardless of its source, or (iv) a trust if
a court within the United States is able to exercise primary supervision 
over the administration of the trust and one or more United States trustees
have authority to control all substantial decisions of the trust.

     The Code  and Treasury regulations  generally subject interest paid to
a Foreign Investor to a withholding tax at  a rate of 30% (unless such rate
were changed by  an applicable treaty).   The withholding tax, however,  is
eliminated with respect to certain "portfolio  debt investments" issued to 
Foreign Investors.   Portfolio debt investments include  debt instruments 
issued in  registered form for  which the United States payor receives  a 
statement that the beneficial owner  of the instrument is  a Foreign  
Investor.  The  Offered Certificates will  be issued in  registered form, 
therefore  if the  information required by  the Code  is furnished  
(as described  below) and  no  other exceptions  to the withholding tax 
exemption are applicable, no withholding tax  will apply to the Offered 
Certificates.

     For the Offered  Certificates to constitute portfolio debt investments
exempt from the  United States withholding tax, the withholding  agent must
receive from the Certificate  Owner an executed IRS  Form W-8 signed  under
penalty of  perjury by the Certificate  Owner stating that the  Certificate
Owner is  a Foreign Investor  and providing  such Certificate Owner's  name
and address.  The statement  must be received  by the withholding agent  in
the calendar year  in which the interest payment  is made, or  in either of
the two preceding calendar years.

     A  Certificate  Owner  that   is  a  nonresident   alien  or   foreign
corporation will  not be  subject to  United States  federal income tax  on
gain  realized  on  the sale,  exchange,  or  redemption  of  such  Offered
Certificate, provided that (i) such gain is not  effectively connected with
a  trade or  business carried  on by  the Certificate  Owner in  the United
States, (ii)  in the case  of a  Certificate Owner  that is an  individual,
such Certificate Owner is not present in the United States for  183 days or
more during the  taxable year  in which such  sale, exchange or  redemption
occurs and  (iii) in the  case of  gain representing accrued  interest, the
conditions described in the immediately preceding paragraph are satisfied.


                                STATE TAXES

     Provident makes no representations regarding  the tax consequences  of
purchase,  ownership or  disposition of the Offered  Certificates under the
tax  laws  of any  state.    Investors  considering an  investment  in  the
Certificates should  consult their  own  tax  advisors regarding  such  tax
consequences.

     All investors  should  consult their  own tax  advisors regarding  the
Federal, state, local  or foreign income tax consequences of  the purchase,
ownership and disposition of the Certificates.


                           ERISA CONSIDERATIONS

     Any  Plan fiduciary which  proposes to cause a  Plan to acquire any of
the Offered  Certificates should consult with  its counsel with respect  to
the potential  consequences under the  Employee Retirement  Income Security
Act of 1974, as amended ("ERISA"), and the Code,  of the  Plans acquisition
and ownership  of such  Certificates.  See "ERISA CONSIDERATIONS" in the 
Prospectus.

     The U.S. Department  of Labor has granted to _________________________
(____________)  Prohibited  Transaction Exemption  _____ (the  "Exemption")
which  exempts from  the application  of the  prohibited transaction  rules
transactions relating to (1) the acquisition, sale and holding  by Plans of
certain  certificates  representing   an  undivided  interest   in  certain
asset-backed pass-through  trusts, with respect  to which  _____________ or
any of  its affiliates is the sole underwriter or the manager or co-manager
of  the  underwriting  syndicate;  and (2)  the  servicing,  operation  and
management of  such  asset-backed pass-through  trusts,  provided that  the
general conditions and certain other conditions set forth  in the Exemption
are satisfied.   The Exemption  will apply to the  acquisition, holding and
resale  of the  Class  A  Certificates by  a  Plan, provided  that  certain
conditions (certain of which are described below) are met.

     Among the  conditions which  must be  satisfied for  the Exemption  to
apply are the following:


          (1)  The  acquisition of the Class A Certificates by a Plan is on
     terms (including  the price for such  Certificates) that are at  least
     as  favorable  to  the   investing  Plan  as  they  would  be   in  an
     arm's-length transaction with an unrelated party;

          (2)    The  rights  and  interests  evidenced  by   the  Class  A
     Certificates acquired by  the Plan are not subordinated to  the rights
     and interests evidenced by other certificates of the Trust;

          (3)  The Class A Certificates acquired by the Plan have  received
     a rating at the time of  such acquisition that is in one  of the three
     highest generic rating categories from either S&P, Moody's,  or Duff &
     Phelps Credit Rating Co.;

          (4)    The sum  of  all  payments made  to  and  retained by  the
     Underwriter  in  connection  with the  distribution  of  the  Class  A
     Certificates represents  not  more  than reasonable  compensation  for
     underwriting such  Certificates; the sum of  all payments made to  and
     retained by the Seller  pursuant to the sale of  the Mortgage Loans to
     the  Trust represents  not more  than the  fair market  value of  such
     Mortgage Loans; the sum  of all payments made to  and retained by  the
     Master Servicer  represent not more  than reasonable  compensation for
     the Master Servicer's services under  the Agreement and  reimbursement
     of the Master Servicer's reasonable expenses in connection therewith;

          (5)   The  Trustee is  not an  affiliate of any  Underwriter, the
     Seller, the Master Servicer, the Certificate Insurer, any borrower  
     whose   obligations  under  one   or  more   Mortgage  Loans  constitute
     more  than  5%  of  the  aggregate  unamortized  principal balance  of 
     the  assets  in the  Trust,  or  any of  their  respective affiliates 
     (the "Restricted Group"); and

          (6)    The  Plan investing  in  the  Class A  Certificates  is an
     "accredited investor" as defined in Rule 501(a)(1) of  Regulation D of
     the  Securities and  Exchange Commission  under the  Securities Act of
     1933, as amended.

     The  Underwriter  believes  that  the  Exemption  will  apply  to  the
acquisition and holding of  the Class A Certificates by  Plans and that all
conditions of  the Exemption  other than those  within the  control of  the
investors will be met.  Any Plan fiduciary considering  whether to purchase
any Class  A  Certificates on  behalf  of a  Plan should  consult with  its
counsel  regarding the  applicability of  the fiduciary  responsibility and
prohibited  transaction  provisions   of  ERISA   and  the  Code  to   such
investment.    Among   other  things,   before  purchasing   any  Class   A
Certificates,   a   fiduciary  of   a  Plan   subject   to   the  fiduciary
responsibility provisions of  ERISA or an employee benefit plan  subject to
the  prohibited transaction  provisions of  the Code  should  make its  own
determination as  to the availability of  the exemptive relief provided  in
the Exemption, and  also consider the availability of any  other prohibited
transaction exemptions.


                      LEGAL INVESTMENT CONSIDERATIONS

     Although, as a  condition to their issuance, the Offered  Certificates
will be rated in the  highest rating category  of the Rating Agencies,  the
Offered Certificates will  not constitute "mortgage related securities" for
purposes  of  the  Secondary   Mortgage  Market  Enhancement  Act  of  1984
("SMMEA"), because  not all of  the Mortgages  securing the Mortgage  Loans
are  first mortgages.   Accordingly, many institutions with legal authority
to invest in comparably rated securities based  on first mortgage loans may
not be  legally authorized  to invest  in the  Offered Certificates,  which
because they  evidence interests in  a pool  that includes junior  mortgage
loans  are not  "mortgage  related securities"  under  SMMEA.   See  "LEGAL
INVESTMENT" in the Prospectus.


                               UNDERWRITING


     Subject to  the terms  and conditions  set forth  in the  underwriting
agreement,  dated  ____________________  (the   "Underwriting  Agreement"),
between   Provident   and   ______________________   (the   "Underwriter"),
Provident  has agreed  to sell to  the Underwriter and  the Underwriter has
agreed to purchase from Provident the Class A Certificates.



     Distributions of  the Offered Certificates will  be made from time  to
time  in negotiated  transactions  or otherwise  at  varying prices  to  be
determined at the time  of sale.   Proceeds to Provident  from the sale  of
the Offered Certificates will  be approximately $            , plus accrued
interest, before  deducting expenses payable  by Provident, estimated to be
$          in the aggregate.  In  connection with the  purchase and sale of
the Offered  Certificates, the Underwriter may  be deemed to have  received
compensation from Provident in the form of underwriting discounts.

     Provident  has  been  advised  by the  Underwriter  that  it presently
intends to make a market  in the Offered  Certificates; however, it is  not
obligated to do so, any market-making may be discontinued at  any time, and
there  can be no  assurance that  an active public  market for  the Offered
Certificates will develop.

     The Underwriting Agreement  provides that Provident will indemnify the
Underwriter against certain civil liabilities, including  liabilities under
the Act.


                                  EXPERTS

                               (__________)


                               LEGAL MATTERS

     Certain legal  matters with respect to  the Class A Certificates  will
be passed upon for Provident  by Brown & Wood LLP, New York, New  York, and
Keating, Muething  & Klekamp,  P.L.L. Cincinnati,  Ohio, York  and for  the
Underwriter by ____________________.


                                  RATINGS

     It  is a  condition to the  issuance of the Class  A Certificates that
they receive ratings of "AAA" by _______ and "Aaa" by ______.

     A securities rating  addresses the likelihood of the receipt  by Class
A Certificateholders  of distributions on the  Mortgage Loans.  The  rating
takes into consideration the characteristics of the Mortgage  Loans and the
structural,  legal   and  tax   aspects   associated  with   the  Class   A
Certificates.   The ratings  on the Class  A Certificates  do not, however,
constitute statements regarding  the likelihood or frequency of prepayments
on the  Mortgage Loans or the  possibility that Class A  Certificateholders
might realize a lower than anticipated yield.

     The  ratings  assigned  to  the   Class  A  Certificates  will  depend
primarily  upon the  creditworthiness  of  the Certificate  Insurer.    Any
reduction  in  a  rating assigned  to  the  claims-paying  ability  of  the
Certificate Insurer below the ratings initially assigned to the 
Class  A Certificates  may result  in a  reduction  of one  or more  of the
ratings assigned to the Class A Certificates.

     A  securities rating  is not  a recommendation  to buy,  sell or  hold
securities and may be subject to revision or withdrawal at any  time by the
assigning rating organization.  Each securities rating  should be evaluated
independently of similar ratings on different securities.


                          INDEX OF DEFINED TERMS


TERMS                                                                PAGE
- -----                                                                ----
   
Aggregate Class A Principal Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   S-4, S-41
Agreement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   S-3
Amount Available  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-49
Assignment Event  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-16
Available Funds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-49
Balloon Loans . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-14
Beneficial owner  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-42
BIF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-47
Book-Entry Certificates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-42
Capitalized Interest Account  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-11, S-56
Cede  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   S-6
CEDEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   S-6
CEDEL Participants  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-43
Certificate Insurer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   S-2, S-10
Certificate Owners  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   S-6, S-42
Certificate Rate  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-4, S-6, S-50, S-51
Certificate Register  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-48
Certificate Registrar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-48
Certificateholder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-41, S-42
Certificates  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  1, S-3
Chemical  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   S-6
Citibank  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   S-6
Civil Relief Act  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-12
Civil Relief Act Interest Shortfalls  . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-12, S-59
Class . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   1
Class A Certificateholder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-64
Class A Certificates  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  1, S-3
Class A Monthly Principal Distributable Amount  . . . . . . . .   S-8, S-51
Class A Principal Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   S-4, S-41
Class A Principal Carryover Shortfall . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-52
Class A Principal Distribution  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   S-8, S-51
Class A-1 Certificates  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-41
Class A-2 Certificates  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-41
Class A-3 Certificates  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-41
Class A-4 Certificates  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-41
Class A-5 Certificates  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-41
Class A-6 Certificates  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-41
Class A-6 Interest Carryover  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-50
Class Interest Distribution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   S-7, S-51
Class Monthly Interest Distributable Amount . . . . . . . . . .   S-7, S-51
Class R Certificates  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  1, S-3
Closing Date  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   2
CLTV  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-25, S-32
Code  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-63
Collection Account  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-47
Combined Loan-to-Value Ratio  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   S-4
Compensating Interest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-16
Cooperative . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-44
CPR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-38, S-63
Cut-Off Date  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   S-3
Cut-Off Date Loan Group 1 Principal Balance . . . . . . . . . .   S-4, S-22
Cut-Off Date Loan Group 2 Principal Balance . . . . . . . . . .   S-5, S-28
Cut-Off Date Pool Principal Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-22
Cut-Off Date Principal Balance  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   S-3
Defective Mortgage Loans  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-47
Definitive Certificate  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-42
Determination Date  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-11
Distributable Excess Spread . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   S-8, S-52
Distribution Account  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-47
Distribution Date . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-2, S-7
DTC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   S-6, S-42
Due Period  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   S-9, S-52
Eligible Account  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-47
Eligible Substitute Mortgage Loan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-46
ERISA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-13, S-65
Euroclear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   S-6
Euroclear Operator  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-44
Euroclear Participants  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-43
European Depositaries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   S-6, S-42
Events of Default . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-60
Excess Spread . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   S-9, S-53
Exemption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-65
Financial Intermediary  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-42
First Liens . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-15
Fiscal Agent  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-53
Foreign Investors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-64
Funding Period  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-11, S-56
GAAP  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-17
Group 1 Certificates  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  1, S-4, S-41
Group 2 Certificates  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  1, S-4, S-41
Guaranteed Principal Amount . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-10
Insolvency Event  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-61
Insurer Default . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-53
Interest Period . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   S-7
LIBOR Rate  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-51
Liquidated Mortgage Loan  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   S-9, S-52
Loan Group  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   1, S-41
Loan Group 1  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   1, S-41
Loan Group 1 Principal Balance  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   S-3
Loan Group 2  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   1, S-41
Loan Group 2 Principal Balance  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   S-3
Loan Group Principal Balance  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   S-3
Loan Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   S-4
Master Servicer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   1, S-3, S-6
Master Servicing Fee  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-11
Master Servicing Fee Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-11, S-58
Monthly Advance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-12, S-48
Mortgage File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-15, S-45
Mortgage Loan Schedule  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-45
Mortgage Loans  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  1, S-3
Mortgage Pool . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   1
Mortgaged Properties  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   S-3
Net Funds Cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   S-6
Nonrecoverable Advance  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-48
Offered Certificates  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  1, S-4, S-41
OID . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-63
Original Aggregate Class A Principal Balance  . . . . . . . . . . . .   S-4
Percentage Interest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-42
Plan  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-13
Policy  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-2, S-3, S-41
Pool Principal Balance  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   S-3
Pre-Funded Amount . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-11, S-55
Pre-Funding Account . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-11, S-55
Prepayment Assumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-38
Prepayment Interest Shortfall . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-12
Principal Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   S-3
Provident . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  1, S-3
Purchase Price  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-46
Related Documents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-45
Relevant Depositary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-42
REMIC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   S-2, S-12
Residual Certificates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-12
Restricted Group  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-66
Rules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-42
SAIF  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-47
SAP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-17
Seller  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   1, S-3, S-6
Servicing Advance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-48
SMMEA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-13, S-66
STIFS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-47
Subsequent Transfer Date  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-28
Subservicer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-18
Substitution Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-46
Successor Master Servicer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-61
Terms and Conditions  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-44
Trust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  1, S-3
Trustee . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  1, S-3, S-11, S-53
Underwriter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-66
Underwriting Agreement  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-66
Weighted average life . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-38
    

                                  ANNEX I

GLOBAL CLEARANCE, SETTLEMENT AND TAX DOCUMENTATION PROCEDURES

     Except   in  certain  limited  circumstances,   the  globally  offered
Provident Home  Equity Loan Asset-Backed  Certificates, Series  199___ (the
"Global Securities") will be available only in book-entry  form.  Investors
in the  Global Securities may  hold such  Global Securities through  any of
DTC,  CEDEL or Euroclear.  The Global Securities  will be tradeable as home
market  instruments  in  both  the  European  and  U.S.  domestic  markets.
Initial settlement and all secondary trades will settle in same-day funds.

     Secondary market  trading between investors  holding Global Securities
through  CEDEL and  Euroclear will  be  conducted  in the  ordinary way  in
accordance  with  their  normal  rules  and  operating  procedures  and  in
accordance with  conventional eurobond practice  (i.e., seven  calendar day
settlement).

     Secondary  market trading between investors  holding Global Securities
through  DTC  will be  conducted  according  to the  rules  and  procedures
applicable to  U.S. corporate debt obligations  and prior Home Equity  Loan
Asset-Backed Certificates issues.

     Secondary cross-market  trading  between CEDEL  or  Euroclear and  DTC
Participants    holding    Certificates    will   be    effected    on    a
delivery-against-payment  basis  through  the  respective  Depositaries  of
CEDEL and Euroclear (in such capacity) and as DTC Participants.

     Non-U.S. holders  (as described below)  of Global  Securities will  be
subject  to  U.S.  withholding  taxes  unless  such  holders  meet  certain
requirements and  deliver appropriate U.S.  tax documents to the securities
clearing organizations or their participants.

INITIAL SETTLEMENT

     All Global Securities will  be held in book-entry form  by DTC in  the
name of Cede & Co. as  nominee of DTC.  Investors' interests  in the Global
Securities  will be  represented through  financial institutions  acting on
their  behalf as direct  and indirect  Participants in DTC.   As  a result,
CEDEL and  Euroclear will hold  positions on  behalf of their  participants
through  their  respective  Depositaries,  which  in  turn  will hold  such
positions in accounts as DTC Participants.

     Investors  electing to  hold their Global Securities  through DTC will
follow  the  settlement  practices  applicable to  prior  Home  Equity Loan
Asset-Backed  Certificates  issues.   Investor securities  custody accounts
will be credited with their  holdings against payment in same-day  funds on
the settlement date.

     Investors  electing to hold  their Global  Securities through CEDEL or
Euroclear accounts will follow the settlement procedures applicable  to  
conventional  eurobonds,  except  that  there  will  be  no temporary 
global  security and no "lock-up"  or restricted period.   Global
Securities  will be  credited to  the securities  custody  accounts on  the
settlement date against payment in same-day funds.

SECONDARY MARKET TRADING

     Since the purchaser determines the place of delivery,  it is important
to establish  at  the time  of  the trade  where both  the purchaser's  and
seller's accounts  are located to ensure that settlement can be made on the
desired value date.

     Trading between  DTC Participants.   Secondary market  trading between
DTC Participants will  be settled using the procedures applicable  to prior
Home Equity Loan Asset-Backed Certificates issues in same-day funds.

     Trading  between  CEDEL  and/or  Euroclear  Participants.    Secondary
market trading  between CEDEL Participants  or Euroclear  Participants will
be settled using  the procedures  applicable to  conventional eurobonds  in
same-day funds.

     Trading between  DTC seller and  CEDEL or  Euroclear purchaser.   When
Global  Securities  are  to  be transferred  from  the  account  of  a  DTC
Participant  to  the  account  of  a  CEDEL  Participant   or  a  Euroclear
Participant, the  purchaser will  send instructions to  CEDEL or  Euroclear
through a CEDEL Participant or Euroclear Participant at  least one business
day prior to settlement.  CEDEL  or Euroclear will instruct the  respective
Depositary,  as the case may  be, to receive the  Global Securities against
payment.   Payment will include interest  accrued on the Global  Securities
from  and  including  the last  coupon payment  date  to and  excluding the
settlement date, on the basis of  either the actual number of  days in such
accrual period and a year assumed to consist of 360 days  or a 360-day year
of  12  30-day  months  as  applicable  to  the  related  class  of  Global
Securities.  For  transactions settling on the  31st of the month,  payment
will  include  interest accrued  to  and excluding  the  first  day of  the
following month.   Payment will then  be made by the  respective Depositary
of  the   DTC  Participant's  account   against  delivery   of  the  Global
Securities.   After settlement has  been completed,  the Global  Securities
will be  credited to  the respective clearing  system and  by the  clearing
system,  in   accordance   with  its   usual  procedures,   to  the   CEDEL
Participant's or  Euroclear Participant's account.   The  securities credit
will  appear  the next  day  (European  time) and  the  cash  debt will  be
back-valued  to, and  the interest  on the  Global  Securities will  accrue
from,  the value  date (which would  be the  preceding day  when settlement
occurred  in New York).   If  settlement is not  completed on  the intended
value date (i.e., the  trade fails), the CEDEL or  Euroclear cash debt will
be valued instead as of the actual settlement date.

     CEDEL Participants  and  Euroclear  Participants  will  need  to  make
available  to  the  respective clearing  systems  the  funds  necessary  to
process  same-day funds settlement.   The most direct  means of doing so is
to preposition funds for settlement,  either from cash on hand  or existing
lines of credit, as  they would for any  settlement occurring within  CEDEL
or  Euroclear.   Under this approach,  they may take on  credit exposure to
CEDEL  or Euroclear  until  the Global  Securities  are credited  to  their
accounts one day later.

     As  an  alternative, if  CEDEL or  Euroclear  has  extended a  line of
credit to them, CEDEL Participants or Euroclear Participants  can elect not
to  preposition  funds and  allow that  credit line  to be  drawn  upon the
finance  settlement.  Under this procedure, CEDEL Participants or Euroclear
Participants  purchasing  Global Securities  would incur  overdraft charges
for  one  day,  assuming  they  cleared  the  overdraft   when  the  Global
Securities  were credited  to their  accounts.   However,  interest on  the
Global Securities  would accrue from  the value date.   Therefore, in  many
cases the  investment income on  the Global  Securities earned during  that
one-day  period may  substantially  reduce or  offset  the amount  of  such
overdraft  charges,  although  this  result  will  depend   on  each  CEDEL
Participant's or Euroclear Participant's particular cost of funds.

     Since the settlement  is taking place during New York  business hours,
DTC  Participants  can employ  their usual  procedures  for  sending Global
Securities to the  respective European Depositary for the benefit  of CEDEL
Participants  or  Euroclear  Participants.    The  sale  proceeds  will  be
available  to the  DTC seller  on the  settlement date.   Thus, to  the DTC
Participants a cross-market transaction will settle  no differently than  a
trade between two DTC Participants.

     Trading between CEDEL or Euroclear  Seller and DTC Purchaser.   Due to
time  zone differences  in their  favor, CEDEL  Participants  and Euroclear
Participants may  employ  their customary  procedures  for transactions  in
which Global  Securities are to be  transferred by the respective  clearing
system,  through the  respective Depositary,  to a  DTC  Participant.   The
seller  will  send instructions  to  CEDEL  or Euroclear  through  a  CEDEL
Participant or  Euroclear Participant at  least one  business day prior  to
settlement.    In  these  cases  CEDEL  or  Euroclear   will  instruct  the
respective  Depositary, as appropriate, to deliver the Global Securities to
the  DTC Participant's  account  against  payment.   Payment  will  include
interest  accrued on  the Global  Securities from  and  including the  last
coupon payment to and excluding the  settlement date on the basis of either
the  actual number  of days in  such accrual  period and a  year assumed to
consist of  360 days or a 360-day year of 12 30-day months as applicable to
the related class of Global  Securities.  For transactions settling on  the
31st of  the month, payment will include  interest accrued to and excluding
the first day of the following month.   The payment will then  be reflected
in the account of the CEDEL Participant or Euroclear Participant the 
following day, and receipt of the cash proceeds in  the CEDEL Participant's
or Euroclear Participant's  account would be back-valued to the  value date
(which would be  the preceding day, when settlement  occurred in New York).
Should  the CEDEL  Participant  or Euroclear  Participant  have a  line  of
credit  with its  respective clearing  system and  elect to  be in  debt in
anticipation  of  receipt  of  the  sale  proceeds  in   its  account,  the
back-valuation  will extinguish  any overdraft  incurred over  that one-day
period.   If settlement is not completed on  the intended value date (i.e.,
the trade fails), receipt  of the cash proceeds in  the CEDEL Participant's
or  Euroclear Participant's  account  would instead  be  valued as  of  the
actual settlement date.

     Finally, day  traders that use  CEDEL or  Euroclear and that  purchase
Global Securities from DTC  Participants for delivery to CEDEL Participants
or   Euroclear   Participants  should   note   that   these  trades   would
automatically fail on  the sale side unless affirmative action  were taken.
At least  three techniques should  be readily  available to eliminate  this
potential problem:

     (a)   borrowing  through CEDEL  or  Euroclear for  one day  (until the
purchase side  of the day  trade is  reflected in their  CEDEL or Euroclear
accounts) in accordance with the clearing system's customary procedures;

     (b)    borrowing  the  Global  Securities  in  the  U.S.  from  a  DTC
Participant  no later than  one day  prior to settlement,  which would give
the Global Securities  sufficient time to  be reflected  in their CEDEL  or
Euroclear account in order to settle the sale side of the trade; or

     (c)   staggering the  value dates for  the buy  and sell sides  of the
trade so that the  value date for the purchase from the DTC  Participant is
at  least one  day  prior to  the value  date  for  the sale  to the  CEDEL
Participant or Euroclear Participant.

CERTAIN U.S. FEDERAL INCOME TAX DOCUMENTATION REQUIREMENTS

     A  beneficial owner  of Global  Securities holding  securities through
CEDEL  or Euroclear  (or through DTC  if the holder has  an address outside
the U.S.) will be  subject to the 30% U.S.  withholding tax that  generally
applies to  payments  of interest  (including original  issue discount)  on
registered debt  issued by U.S. Persons,  unless (i) each clearing  system,
bank  or other financial  institution that  holds customers'  securities in
the  ordinary   course  of  its   trade  or   business  in  the   chain  of
intermediaries  between such beneficial  owner and the U.S. entity required
to  withhold tax  complies with  applicable certification  requirements and
(ii) such beneficial owner takes  one of the  following steps to obtain  an
exemption or reduced tax rate:

     Exemption  for  non-U.S.  Persons (Form  W-8).   Beneficial  owners of
Global Securities that are non-U.S. Persons can obtain a complete exemption
from  the withholding tax  by filing  a signed Form  W-8 (Certificate  of 
Foreign  Status).  If  the information  shown on  Form W-8 changes, a new 
Form W-8 must be filed within 30 days of such change.

     Exemption  for  non-U.S.  Persons  with  effectively  connected income
(Form 4224).  A  non-U.S. Person, including a non-U.S.  corporation or bank
with a U.S. branch, for  which the interest income is effectively connected
with its  conduct of a  trade or business in the  United States, can obtain
an exemption from the  withholding tax by filing Form 4224  (Exemption from
Withholding of  Tax on Income  Effectively Connected with the  Conduct of a
Trade or Business in the United States).

     Exemption or  reduced  rate for  non-U.S. Persons  resident in  treaty
countries (Form  1001).    Non-U.S.  Persons that  are  Certificate  Owners
residing in a  country that  has a tax  treaty with the  United States  can
obtain an  exemption or reduced tax rate (depending on the treaty terms) by
filing Form  1001 (Ownership, Exemption or  Reduced Rate Certificate).   If
the  treaty  provides only  for a  reduced  rate,  withholding tax  will be
imposed at that rate  unless the filer alternatively files  Form W-8.  Form
1001 may be filed by the Certificate Owners or his agent.

     Exemption for  U.S. Persons  (Form W-9).   U.S.  Persons can  obtain a
complete exemption  from the withholding  tax by  filing Form W-9  (Payer's
Request for Taxpayer Identification Number and Certification).

     U.S.  Federal Income  Tax Reporting Procedure.   The Certificate Owner
of a Global Security  or, in the case of a  Form 1001 or a Form 4224 filer,
his agent, files by  submitting the appropriate form to  the person through
whom  it  holds  (the clearing  agency,  in  the  case  of persons  holding
directly on the books of the clearing agency).  Form W-8  and Form 1001 are
effective  for three  calendar years  and Form  4224 is  effective for  one
calendar year.

     The term "U.S. Person"  means (i) a citizen or  resident of the United
States, (ii) a corporation  or partnership organized in  or under the  laws
of  the United  States or  any political  subdivision thereof,  (iii)  an
estate  the income  of which  is includible  in gross  income for United
States tax  purposes, regardless of  its source, or (iv) a trust if a court
within the United States is able to exercise primary supervision over the
administration of the trust and one or more United States trustees have
authority to control all substantial decisions of the trust.  This  summary
does not  deal with all aspects of U.S. Federal  income tax withholding that
may be  relevant to foreign  holders of the  Global Securities.   Investors
are advised  to  consult  their  own  tax  advisors  for  specific  tax 
advice concerning their holding and disposing of the Global Securities.


       No dealer, salesman or  other 
  person  has  been  authorized   to 
  give  any information  or to  make 
  any  representation  not contained
  in  this Prospectus  Supplement or 
  the  Prospectus and,  if given  or 
  made,    such    information    or
  representation must not be  relied             PROVIDENT HOME EQUITY
  upon as having been  authorized by               LOAN TRUST 199___
  Provident   or   the  Underwriter.   
  This  Prospectus  Supplement   and                   $
  the  Prospectus do  not constitute    
  an offer  of any securities  other
  than  those to  which they               $   CLASS A-1   % CERTIFICATES
  or  an   offer  to   sell,  or   a       $   CLASS A-2   % CERTIFICATES
  solicitation of  an offer to  buy,       $   CLASS A-3   % CERTIFICATES
  to any person in  any jurisdiction       $   CLASS A-4   % CERTIFICATES
  where    such    an    offer    or       $   CLASS A-5   % CERTIFICATES
  solicitation  would  be  unlawful.       $   CLASS A-6 VARIABLE RATE
  Neither   the  delivery   of  this                     CERTIFICATES
  Prospectus   Supplement  and   the 
  Prospectus   nor  any   sale  made 
  hereunder    shall,   under    any 
  circumstances,     create      any 
  implication  that the  information
  contained herein is correct  as of
  any   time  subsequent   to  their
  respective dates.                                      HOME EQUITY LOAN
                                                    ASSET-BACKED CERTIFICATES
            TABLE OF CONTENTS
                                                            SERIES 199___
                                PAGE
                                ----
  PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT
  Incorporation of Certain 
    Documents by Reference . .  S-2
  Summary . . . . . . . . . .   S-3                   THE PROVIDENT BANK
  Risk Factors  . . . . . . .   S-15                     AS SELLER AND
  The Certificate Insurer . .   S-18                    MASTER SERVICER
  The Provident Bank. . . . .   S-18
  Description of the Mortgage 
    Loans . . . . . . . . . .   S-21
  Prepayment and  Yield
    Considerations  . . . . .   S-28
  Description of the Certificates S-32
  Use of Proceeds . . . . . .   S-51
  Certain Federal Income Tax
    Consequences  . . . . . .   S-52
  State Taxes . . . . . . . .   S-54
  ERISA Considerations  . . .   S-54
  Legal Investment 
    Considerations . . . . .    S-55                  
  Underwriting  . . . . . . .   S-55
  Experts . . . . . . . . . .   S-56
  Legal Matters . . . . . . .   S-56
  Ratings . . . . . . . . . .   S-56       
  Index of Defined Terms  . .   S-57 
  Annex I . . . . . . . . . .   S-60
                                                  ------------------------
  PROSPECTUS                                       PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT
  Prospectus Supplement . . . . .  2              ------------------------
  Available Information . . . . .  2
  Reports to Holders  . . . . . .  2
  Summary of Terms  . . . . . . .  3      
  Risk Factors  . . . . . . . .   11 
  Description of the Securities   14 
  The Trust Funds . . . . . . .   17 
  Enhancement . . . . . . . . .   22 
  Servicing of Loans  . . . . .   24 
  The Agreements  . . . . . . .   30 
  Certain Legal Aspects of Loans  38 
  The Provident Bank  . . . . .   46                [UNDERWRITER]
  Use of Proceeds . . . . . . .   46 
  Certain    Federal   Income    Tax 
  Considerations  . . . . . . .   47 
  State Tax Considerations  . .   64                                      
  ERISA Considerations  . . . .   65 
  Legal Investment  . . . . . .   67
  Plan of Distribution  . . . .   67
  Legal Matters . . . . . . . .   67
  Experts . . . . . . . . . . .   67 
  Additional Information  . . .   67         
  Glossary of Terms . . . . . .   68

INFORMATION CONTAINED HEREIN IS SUBJECT TO COMPLETION OR AMENDMENT. A
REGISTRATION STATMENT RELATING TO THESE SECURITIES HAS BEEN FILED WITH THE
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION.  THESE SECURITIES MAY NOT BE SOLD NOR
MAY OFFERS TO BUY BE ACCEPTED PRIOR TO THE TIME THE REGISTRATION STATEMENT
BECOMES EFFECTIVE.  THIS PROSPECTUS SHALL NOT CONSTITUTE AN OFFER TO SELL OR
THE SOLICITATION OF AN OFFER TO BUY NOR SHALL THERE BE ANY SALE OF THESE
SECURITIES IN ANY STATE IN WHICH SUCH OFFER, SOLICITATION, OR SALE WOULD BE
UNLAWFUL PRIOR TO REGISTRATION OR QUALIFICATION UNDER THE SECURITIES LAWS OF
ANY SUCH STATE.

   
                SUBJECT TO COMPLETION, DATED FEBRUARY 20, 1997
    

PROSPECTUS

                           Asset Backed Securities
                             (Issuable in Series)

   
     This Prospectus  relates to  the issuance  of Asset  Backed Certificates
(the "Certificates") and  Asset Backed Notes (the "Notes"  and, together with
the Certificates, the "Securities"), which may be issued from time to time in
one or more series (each, a "Series") by The Provident Bank  ("Provident") or
by a Trust Fund  created by Provident (as defined below)  on terms determined
at  the  time  of sale  and  described  in this  Prospectus  and  the related
Prospectus  Supplement.    The  Securities   of  a  Series  will  consist  of
Certificates which evidence  beneficial ownership of  a trust established  by
Provident (each, a "Trust Fund"),  and Notes secured by the assets of a Trust
Fund.  As specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the Trust  Fund for
a Series of Securities will include certain assets (the "Trust Fund  Assets")
which  will consist  of the following  types of single  family mortgage loans
(the "Loans"):  (i)  mortgage loans secured by first and/or subordinate liens
on one- to four-family residential properties (the "Mortgage Loans") and (ii)
closed-end loans (the "Closed-End Loans")  and/or revolving home equity loans
or certain balances thereof (the "Revolving Credit Line Loans", together with
the  Closed-End  Loans,  the  "Home   Equity  Loans")  secured  by  first  or
subordinate liens on  one- to four-family residential properties.   The Trust
Fund Assets will  be originated or be  acquired by Provident and  conveyed by
Provident to the related Trust Fund.  A Trust Fund also may include insurance
policies, surety  bonds, cash  accounts, reinvestment  income, guaranties  or
letters  of  credit  to  the  extent  described  in  the  related  Prospectus
Supplement.  See "Index of Defined Terms"  on Page 85 of this Prospectus  for
the location of the definitions of certain capitalized terms.
    

     Each Series  of Securities will be issued in one  or more classes.  Each
class of Certificates  of a Series  will evidence beneficial  ownership of  a
specified percentage (which may be 0%) or portion of future interest payments
and a specified percentage  (which may be 0%) or portion  of future principal
payments on the related Trust Fund  Assets.  Each class of Notes of  a Series
will be secured by  the related Trust Fund Assets or, if  so specified in the
related Prospectus Supplement, a portion thereof.  A Series of Securities may
include one  or more classes that  are senior in  right of payment to  one or
more other classes  of Securities  of such Series.   One  or more classes  of
Securities of a Series may be entitled to receive distributions of principal,
interest or  any combination thereof  prior to one  or more other  classes of
Securities of such Series on or after the occurrence of specified  events, in
each case as specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.

     Distributions  to Securityholders will be made monthly, quarterly, semi-
annually or at such other intervals and on the dates specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement.  Distributions  on the Securities of a Series  will be
made from  the related Trust Fund Assets or  proceeds thereof pledged for the
benefit  of  the  Securityholders  as  specified  in  the  related Prospectus
Supplement.

     The  related  Prospectus  Supplement  will  describe  any  insurance  or
guarantee  provided  with  respect  to  the  related  Series   of  Securities
including, without  limitation, any  insurance or guarantee  provided by  the
Department of Housing and Urban  Development, the United States Department of
Veterans' Affairs or  any private insurer or guarantor.  The only obligations
of Provident  with respect to a Series of Securities  will be to make certain
representations  and warranties  to the  Trustee  for the  related Series  of
Securities.   The principal obligations  of the Master Servicer  named in the
related  Prospectus  Supplement  with  respect   to  the  related  Series  of
Securities will be limited to obligations pursuant to certain representations
and warranties  and to its  contractual servicing obligations,  including any
obligation it  may have to advance  delinquent payments on the  related Trust
Fund Assets.

     The yield on  each class of Securities of a Series  will be affected by,
among other things, the rate of payments of principal (including prepayments)
on the related Trust Fund Assets and  the timing of receipt of such  payments
as  described under "Risk  Factors--Prepayment and Yield  Considerations" and
"Yield and Prepayment  Considerations" herein and  in the related  Prospectus
Supplement.   A Trust  Fund may  be subject  to early  termination under  the
circumstances   described   under  "The   Agreements--Termination;   Optional
Termination" herein and in the related Prospectus Supplement.

     If specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, one or more elections
may be made to treat  a Trust Fund or specified  portions thereof as a  "real
estate   mortgage  investment  conduit"  ("REMIC")  for  federal  income  tax
purposes.  See "Federal Income Tax Consequences."

    FOR A DISCUSSION OF CERTAIN RISKS ASSOCIATED WITH AN INVESTMENT IN THE
SECURITIES, SEE THE INFORMATION UNDER "RISK FACTORS" ON PAGE 13.

  THE CERTIFICATES OF A GIVEN SERIES WILL REPRESENT BENEFICIAL INTERESTS IN,
 AND THE NOTES OF A  GIVEN SERIES WILL REPRESENT OBLIGATIONS OF, THE RELATED
    TRUST FUND ONLY AND WILL NOT REPRESENT INTERESTS IN OR OBLIGATIONS OF
                       PROVIDENT, THE MASTER SERVICER,
       OR ANY AFFILIATES THEREOF, EXCEPT TO THE EXTENT DESCRIBED IN THE
  RELATED PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT.  THE SECURITIES AND THE LOANS WILL NOT BE 
    INSURED OR GUARANTEED BY THE FEDERAL INSURANCE DEPOSIT CORPORATION OR 
      ANY GOVERNMENTAL AGENCY OR INSTRUMENTALITY OR BY PROVIDENT OR ANY 
     OTHER PERSON OR ENTITY, EXCEPT IN EACH CASE TO THE EXTENT DESCRIBED 
                    IN THE RELATED PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT.

 THESE SECURITIES HAVE NOT BEEN APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED BY THE SECURITIES AND
EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION NOR HAS THE SECURITIES
AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR  ANY STATE SECURITIES  COMMISSION PASSED UPON  THE
ACCURACY OR ADEQUACY OF THIS PROSPECTUS OR THE RELATED PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT.
          ANY REPRESENTATION TO THE CONTRARY IS A CRIMINAL OFFENSE.

     Prior to issuance there will have  been no market for the Securities  of
any Series  and there  can be no  assurance that  a secondary market  for any
Securities will develop,  or if  it does  develop, that it  will continue  or
provide  Securityholders with a sufficient level  of liquidity of investment.
This Prospectus  may not  be used to  consummate sales  of Securities  of any
Series  unless  accompanied  by  a  Prospectus  Supplement.   Offers  of  the
Securities  may  be made  through one  or  more different  methods, including
offerings through  underwriters,  as more  fully described  under "Method  of
Distribution" herein and in the related Prospectus Supplement.


________________, 1997

     UNTIL 90 DAYS AFTER THE DATE  OF EACH PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT, ALL DEALERS
EFFECTING  TRANSACTIONS  IN   THE  SECURITIES  COVERED  BY   SUCH  PROSPECTUS
SUPPLEMENT, WHETHER OR NOT PARTICIPATING IN  THE DISTRIBUTION THEREOF, MAY BE
REQUIRED  TO DELIVER SUCH PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT AND THIS PROSPECTUS.  THIS IS
IN  ADDITION  TO  THE  OBLIGATION  OF DEALERS  TO  DELIVER  A  PROSPECTUS AND
PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT WHEN ACTING  AS UNDERWRITERS AND WITH RESPECT  TO THEIR
UNSOLD ALLOTMENTS OR SUBSCRIPTIONS.


             PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT OR CURRENT REPORT ON FORM 8-K

     The Prospectus Supplement or Current Report  on Form 8-K relating to the
Securities of each Series to  be offered hereunder will, among other  things,
set forth with respect to such Securities, as appropriate: (i)  the aggregate
principal amount, interest rate and authorized denominations of each class of
such Series of Securities; (ii) information  as to the assets comprising  the
Trust Fund, including the  general characteristics of the related  Trust Fund
Assets included  therein and, if  applicable, the insurance  policies, surety
bonds, guaranties,  letters  of credit  or  other instruments  or  agreements
included in the  Trust Fund or otherwise,  and the amount  and source of  any
reserve account or other cash account; (iii) the circumstances, if any, under
which  the  Trust  Fund  may  be  subject  to  early  termination;  (iv)  the
circumstances, if any,  under which the Notes  of such Series are  subject to
redemption; (v) the  method used to calculate  the amount of principal  to be
distributed or paid with respect to each class of Securities; (vi)  the order
of application of  distributions or  payments to each  of the classes  within
such   Series,  whether  sequential,  pro  rata,   or  otherwise;  (vii)  the
Distribution Dates with respect to such Series; (viii) additional information
with respect  to the method of distribution  of such Securities; (ix) whether
one or more REMIC  elections will be made with respect to the Trust Fund and,
if so, the designation of the  regular interests and the residual  interests;
(x) the aggregate original percentage ownership interest in the Trust Fund to
be evidenced by  each class of Certificates; (xi) the stated maturity of each
class of Notes of such Series; (xii) information as to  the nature and extent
of subordination with respect to any class of Securities that is  subordinate
in right  of payment  to any other  class; and (xiii)  information as  to the
Master Servicer and the Trustee.


                            AVAILABLE INFORMATION

     Provident  has filed  with the  Securities and Exchange  Commission (the
"Commission") a Registration  Statement under the Securities Act  of 1933, as
amended, with respect to the Securities.  This Prospectus, which forms a part
of the Registration Statement, and the Prospectus Supplement relating to each
Series  of Securities  contain  descriptions  of the  material  terms of  the
documents referred  to herein  and therein,  but do  not contain  all of  the
information set forth in the Registration Statement pursuant to the Rules and
Regulations of the Commission.  For further information, reference is made to
such Registration  Statement and  the  exhibits thereto.   Such  Registration
Statement and exhibits can be inspected and copied at prescribed rates at the
public  reference  facilities maintained  by  the  Commission at  its  Public
Reference Section, 450 Fifth Street, N.W., Washington, D.C. 20549, and at its
Regional  Offices located  as follows:    Midwest Regional  Office, 500  West
Madison Street, Suite  1400, Chicago, Illinois 60661; and  Northeast Regional
Office, Seven World  Trade Center, Suite 1300, New York, New York 10048.  The
Commission also  maintains a Web  site at http://www.sec.gov from  which such
Registration Statement and exhibits may be obtained.

     No person  has been authorized  to give any  information or to  make any
representation  other  than  those  contained  in  this  Prospectus  and  any
Prospectus  Supplement  with respect  hereto  and,  if  given or  made,  such
information  or representations must not be relied upon.  This Prospectus and
any Prospectus Supplement with respect hereto  do not constitute an offer  to
sell  or a solicitation  of an  offer to  buy any  securities other  than the
Securities offered hereby and thereby nor  an offer of the Securities to  any
person  in any  state or  other  jurisdiction in  which such  offer  would be
unlawful.   The delivery of this Prospectus  at any time does  not imply that
information herein is correct as of any time subsequent to its date.


               INCORPORATION OF CERTAIN DOCUMENTS BY REFERENCE

     All documents  subsequently filed  by or  on  behalf of  the Trust  Fund
referred to  in the  accompanying Prospectus  Supplement with  the Commission
pursuant to Section 13(a), 13(c), 14 or 15(d) of the Securities  Exchange Act
of 1934, as amended  (the "Exchange Act"), after the date  of this Prospectus
and prior to the termination of any offering of the Securities issued by such
Trust Fund shall be deemed to be incorporated by reference in this Prospectus
and  to be  a part of  this Prospectus  from the date  of the  filing of such
documents.   Any statement contained in a  document incorporated or deemed to
be  incorporated by  reference  herein  shall be  deemed  to  be modified  or
superseded for all purposes of this Prospectus to the extent that a statement
contained herein  (or in  the accompanying Prospectus  Supplement) or  in any
other  subsequently  filed  document  which  also  is  or  is  deemed  to  be
incorporated  by reference  modifies or  replaces such  statement.   Any such
statement  so modified  or  superseded  shall not  be  deemed,  except as  so
modified or superseded,  to constitute a  part of  this Prospectus.   Neither
Provident nor the  Master Servicer for  any Series intends  to file with  the
Commission periodic reports with respect  to the related Trust Fund following
completion of the reporting period  required by Rule 15d-1 or  Regulation 15D
under the Exchange Act.

     The Trustee  or such  other entity specified  in the  related Prospectus
Supplement on behalf  of any Trust Fund  will provide without charge  to each
person to whom this Prospectus is  delivered, on the written or oral  request
of such person, a copy of any or  all of the documents referred to above that
have  been or  may  be  incorporated by  reference  in  this Prospectus  (not
including  exhibits to  the  information that  is  incorporated by  reference
unless  such exhibits  are specifically  incorporated by  reference into  the
information  that  this Prospectus  incorporates).   Such requests  should be
directed to the Corporate Trust Office of  the Trustee or the address of such
other entity specified  in the accompanying Prospectus Supplement.   Included
in the  accompanying Prospectus  Supplement is  the name, address,  telephone
number, and, if available, facsimile  number of the office or contact  person
at the Corporate Trust Office of the Trustee or such other entity.


                          REPORTS TO SECURITYHOLDERS

     Periodic  and annual  reports concerning  the related  Trust Fund  for a
Series of  Securities will  be forwarded to  Securityholders.   However, such
reports  will neither  be examined nor  reported on by  an independent public
accountant.  See "Description of the Securities--Reports to Securityholders".

                               SUMMARY OF TERMS

     This summary is qualified  in its entirety by reference  to the detailed
information  appearing  elsewhere  in  this  Prospectus and  in  the  related
Prospectus Supplement  with  respect  to  the Series  of  Securities  offered
thereby and to  the related Agreement (as  such term is defined  below) which
will  be prepared  in  connection with  each  Series of  Securities.   Unless
otherwise specified, capitalized  terms used and not defined  in this Summary
of Terms  have the  meanings given  to  them in  this Prospectus  and in  the
related Prospectus Supplement.   See "Index of  Defined Terms" on Page  85 of
this Prospectus  for the location  of the definitions of  certain capitalized
terms.

Title of Securities      Asset Backed  Certificates (the  "Certificates") and
                         Asset Backed  Notes (the "Notes" and,  together with
                         the  Certificates,  the   "Securities"),  which  are
                         issuable in Series.

Provident                The Provident  Bank ("Provident"),  an Ohio  banking
                         corporation  in its  capacity as  transferor of  the
                         Loans to the Trust Fund.

Trustee                  The  trustee(s) (the  "Trustee") for each  Series of
                         Securities   will  be   specified  in   the  related
                         Prospectus Supplement.  See  "The Agreements" herein
                         for  a  description  of  the  Trustee's  rights  and
                         obligations.

Master Servicer          The entity or entities named as Master Servicer (the
                         "Master   Servicer")  in   the  related   Prospectus
                         Supplement, which may  be Provident or an  affiliate
                         thereof.    See   "The  Agreements--Certain  Matters
                         Regarding the Master Servicer and Provident".

Trust Fund Assets        Assets  of the Trust Fund for a Series of Securities
                         will  include  certain   assets  (the  "Trust   Fund
                         Assets") which  will consist of  the Loans, together
                         with  payments in respect of such Trust Fund Assets,
                         as specified in  the related Prospectus  Supplement.
                         At  the time  of issuance  of the Securities  of the
                         Series, Provident  will assign the  Loans comprising
                         the  related  Trust  Fund  to  the Trustee,  without
                         recourse.   The Loans will  be collected  in a  pool
                         (each, a "Pool") as of the first day of the month of
                         the  issuance of the related Series of Securities or
                         such  other date specified in the related Prospectus
                         Supplement (the "Cut-Off Date").  

                         Trust  Fund   Assets  also  may   include  insurance
                         policies, surety bonds,  cash accounts, reinvestment
                         income,  guaranties  or  letters  of  credit  to the
                         extent   described   in   the   related   Prospectus
                         Supplement.  See "Credit Enhancement".  In addition,
                         if the  related Prospectus  Supplement so  provides,
                         the related Trust Fund Assets will include the funds
                         on  deposit in an  account (a "Pre-Funding Account")
                         which  will be  used  to  purchase additional  Loans
                         during  the  period  specified  in  such  Prospectus
                         Supplement.      See   "The  Agreements--Pre-Funding
                         Account".

Loans                    
   
                         The Loans will consist of (i) mortgage loans secured
                         by first and/or  subordinate liens on one-  to four-
                         family  residential  properties (each,  a  "Mortgage
                         Loan")  and (ii)  closed-end loans  (the "Closed-End
                         Loans")  and/or  revolving  home   equity  loans  or
                         certain balances thereof (the "Revolving Credit Line
                         Loans",  together  with  the Closed-End  Loans,  the
                         "Home  Equity Loans").   All  Loans  will have  been
                         originated   or  purchased   by  Provident,   either
                         directly or through an affiliate.

                         As specified  in the related  Prospectus Supplement,
                         the Home Equity  Loans will be secured  by mortgages
                         or  deeds  of   trust  or  other  similar   security
                         instruments creating a lien on a Mortgaged Property,
                         which  may be  subordinated to  one  or more  senior
                         liens on the Mortgaged Property, as described in the
                         related Prospectus Supplement.
    

Description of
  the Securities         Each Security will represent a beneficial  ownership
                         interest in, or be secured by the assets of, a Trust
                         Fund  created by Provident  pursuant to an Agreement
                         among Provident, the Master Servicer and the Trustee
                         for  the  related  Series.   The  Securities  of any
                         Series  may  be issued  in  one or  more  classes as
                         specified in the  related Prospectus Supplement.   A
                         Series of Securities may include one or more classes
                         of  senior  Securities  (collectively,  the  "Senior
                         Securities") and one or more classes  of subordinate
                         Securities    (collectively,    the    "Subordinated
                         Securities").     Certain  Series   or  classes   of
                         Securities may  be covered by insurance  policies or
                         other forms of  credit enhancement, in each  case as
                         described under "Credit  Enhancement" herein and  in
                         the related Prospectus Supplement.

                         One or more classes of Securities of each Series (i)
                         may be  entitled to receive  distributions allocable
                         only  to principal,  only  to  interest  or  to  any
                         combination thereof; (ii) may be entitled to receive
                         distributions  only  of   prepayments  of  principal
                         throughout  the lives  of the  Securities or  during
                         specified  periods; (iii) may be subordinated in the
                         right to receive distributions of scheduled payments
                         of principal, prepayments  of principal, interest or
                         any combination thereof to one or more other classes
                         of Securities of such Series throughout the lives of
                         the Securities or during specified periods; (iv) may
                         be entitled to receive such distributions only after
                         the  occurrence of  events specified in  the related
                         Prospectus  Supplement;  (v)   may  be  entitled  to
                         receive distributions in accordance  with a schedule
                         or  formula  or  on the  basis  of  collections from
                         designated  portions  of   the  related  Trust  Fund
                         Assets;   (vi)   as   to   Securities  entitled   to
                         distributions allocable to interest, may be entitled
                         to receive interest  at a fixed rate or  a rate that
                         is subject to change from time to time; and (vii) as
                         to Securities entitled to distributions allocable to
                         interest, may be entitled to distributions allocable
                         to  interest only  after  the  occurrence of  events
                         specified in  the related Prospectus  Supplement and
                         may accrue interest until such events occur, in each
                         case  as   specified  in   the  related   Prospectus
                         Supplement.    The   timing  and  amounts  of   such
                         distributions may vary among  classes or over  time,
                         as specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.

Distributions on
  the Securities         Distributions  on  the Securities  entitled  thereto
                         will be made monthly, quarterly, semi-annually or at
                         such other intervals  and on the dates  specified in
                         the   related   Prospectus   Supplement   (each,   a
                         "Distribution Date") out of the payments received in
                         respect of the  assets of the related Trust  Fund or
                         other  assets   pledged  for  the   benefit  of  the
                         Securities as  described under  "Credit Enhancement"
                         herein  to  the  extent  specified  in  the  related
                         Prospectus  Supplement.    The  amount allocable  to
                         payments  of   principal   and   interest   on   any
                         Distribution Date will be determined as specified in
                         the related Prospectus  Supplement.  The  Prospectus
                         Supplement for a Series of Securities will  describe
                         the  method   for  allocating   distributions  among
                         Securities of  different  classes  as  well  as  the
                         method for allocating distributions among Securities
                         for any particular class.  
   
                         The aggregate  original  principal  balance  of  the
                         Securities   will    not   exceed    the   aggregate
                         distributions  allocable  to   principal  that  such
                         Securities  will  be   entitled  to  receive.     If
                         specified in the  related Prospectus Supplement, the
                         Securities will have an aggregate original principal
                         balance equal  to  the  aggregate  unpaid  principal
                         balance of the Trust Fund  Assets as of the  related
                         Cut-Off Date and will bear interest in the aggregate
                         at a  rate equal to  the interest rate borne  by the
                         underlying  Loans  (the  "Loan  Rate")  net  of  the
                         aggregate  servicing  fees  and  any  other  amounts
                         specified in the related Prospectus Supplement or at
                         such other interest rate as may be specified in such
                         Prospectus Supplement.  
    
                         The rate at which interest will be passed through or
                         paid  to  Securityholders   (each,  a  "Pass-Through
                         Rate") entitled  thereto may  be a  fixed rate  or a
                         rate  that is subject  to change  from time  to time
                         from the time and for  the periods, in each case, as
                         specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.  Any
                         such rate  may be  calculated on  a loan-by-loan  or
                         weighted  average basis or a notional amount in each
                         case  as   described  in   the  related   Prospectus
                         Supplement.

Credit Enhancement       The Trust  Fund Assets or  the Securities of  one or
                         more  classes in  the related  Series  may have  the
                         benefit of one  or more types of  credit enhancement
                         as described  in the related  Prospectus Supplement.
                         The protection  against losses afforded by  any such
                         credit   support  may   be   limited.     The  type,
                         characteristics  and  amount of  credit  enhancement
                         will be determined  based on the  characteristics of
                         the Loans comprising the Trust Fund Assets and other
                         factors  and will  be established  on  the basis  of
                         requirements  of  each   Rating  Agency  rating  the
                         Securities   of   such   Series.       See   "Credit
                         Enhancement."

                         If specified in  the related Prospectus  Supplement,
                         the coverage provided by one or more of the forms of
                         credit enhancement described  in this Prospectus may
                         apply concurrently  to  two or  more separate  Trust
                         Funds.    If  applicable,  the  related   Prospectus
                         Supplement will  identify the Trust  Funds to  which
                         such credit  enhancement relates  and the  manner of
                         determining  the amount of coverage provided to such
                         Trust Funds thereby  and of the application  of such
                         coverage to the identified Trust Funds.  

A. Subordination         A  Series of Securities  may consist of  one or more
                         classes  of Senior    Securities  and  one  or  more
                         classes of  Subordinated Securities.  The  rights of
                         the  holders  of the  Subordinated  Securities of  a
                         Series to receive distributions with  respect to the
                         related Trust  Fund Assets  will be subordinated  to
                         such  rights of the holders of the Senior Securities
                         of the same  Series to the  extent described in  the
                         related Prospectus  Supplement.   This subordination
                         is  intended to  enhance the  likelihood of  regular
                         receipt  by  holders of  Senior  Securities of  such
                         Series of  the full  amount of  monthly payments  of
                         principal  and interest  due them.    The protection
                         afforded  to the holders  of Senior Securities  of a
                         Series by means of the subordination feature will be
                         accomplished by  (i) the preferential  right of such
                         holders to receive, prior  to any distribution being
                         made  in   respect  of   the  related   Subordinated
                         Securities, the amounts of interest and/or principal
                         due them on  each Distribution Date out of the funds
                         available  for  distribution  on  such  date in  the
                         related   Security  Account   and,  to   the  extent
                         described in the  related Prospectus Supplement,  by
                         the  right   of  such  holders  to   receive  future
                         distributions  on the related Trust Fund Assets that
                         would  otherwise have been payable to the holders of
                         Subordinated Securities; (ii) reducing the ownership
                         interest (if applicable) of the related Subordinated
                         Securities; or  (iii) a  combination of  clauses (i)
                         and  (ii) above.   If  so specified  in the  related
                         Prospectus Supplement, subordination  may apply only
                         in the event  of certain types of losses not covered
                         by other  forms of  credit support,  such as  hazard
                         losses  not  covered  by standard  hazard  insurance
                         policies or losses due to the bankruptcy or fraud of
                         the  borrower.   The  related Prospectus  Supplement
                         will set  forth information concerning,  among other
                         things,  the amount of  subordination of a  class or
                         classes of Subordinated Securities  in a Series, the
                         circumstances  in which  such subordination  will be
                         applicable, and  the manner,  if any,  in which  the
                         amount of subordination will decrease over time.

B. Reserve Account       One  or more reserve accounts or other cash accounts
                         (each,  a "Reserve Account")  may be established and
                         maintained  for  each  Series of  Securities.    The
                         related Prospectus  Supplement will  specify whether
                         or not such Reserve Accounts will be included in the
                         corpus  of the Trust  Fund for such  Series and will
                         also  specify  the manner  of  funding  such Reserve
                         Accounts and  the conditions under which the amounts
                         in  any such Reserve  Accounts will be  used to make
                         distributions  to   holders  of   Securities  of   a
                         particular  class  or  released  from  such  Reserve
                         Accounts.

C. Letter of Credit      If  so   specified   in   the   related   Prospectus
                         Supplement,  credit support  for  a  Series  may  be
                         provided by one or more letters of credit.  A letter
                         of  credit may  provide  limited protection  against
                         certain  losses in addition  to or in  lieu of other
                         credit  support,  such  as   losses  resulting  from
                         delinquent  payments  on the  Loans  in the  related
                         Trust  Fund,  losses  from  risks   not  covered  by
                         standard hazard  insurance policies,  losses due  to
                         bankruptcy of a borrower and application  of certain
                         provisions  of  the  federal  Bankruptcy  Code,  and
                         losses  due to denial  of insurance coverage  due to
                         misrepresentations  made  in   connection  with  the
                         origination or  sale of a  Loan.  The issuer  of the
                         letter  of credit (the "L/C Bank") will be obligated
                         to  honor demands  with respect  to  such letter  of
                         credit,  to  the  extent  of  the  amount  available
                         thereunder to provide funds  under the circumstances
                         and subject to  such conditions as are  specified in
                         the related Prospectus Supplement.  The liability of
                         the  L/C Bank  under its  letter of  credit  will be
                         reduced  by  the  amount  of  unreimbursed  payments
                         thereunder.

                         The maximum liability of a L/C Bank under its letter
                         of credit  will be an  amount equal to  a percentage
                         specified in  the related  Prospectus Supplement  of
                         the initial aggregate  outstanding principal balance
                         of the  Loans in  the related Trust  Fund or  one or
                         more Classes  of Securities  of the related  Series.
                         The maximum amount available at  any time to be paid
                         under a letter of credit  will be determined in  the
                         manner  specified   therein  and   in  the   related
                         Prospectus Supplement.

D. Insurance Policies; 
   Surety Bonds and 
   Guarantees            If   so   specified   in  the   related   Prospectus
                         Supplement,  credit  support  for a  Series  may  be
                         provided by an insurance policy and/or a surety bond
                         issued  by  one  or  more  insurance   companies  or
                         sureties.  Such  certificate guarantee insurance  or
                         surety bond  will guarantee timely  distributions of
                         interest and/or  full distributions of  principal on
                         the basis of  a schedule of  principal distributions
                         set forth in  or determined in the  manner specified
                         in the  related Prospectus Supplement.  If specified
                         in  the related Prospectus  Supplement, one  or more
                         bankruptcy bonds, special hazard insurance policies,
                         other  insurance or  third-party  guarantees may  be
                         used to provide coverage for the risks of default or
                         types   of  losses  set  forth  in  such  Prospectus
                         Supplement.

E. Over-
     Collateralization   If  so provided in  the Prospectus Supplement  for a
                         Series  of Securities,  a  portion of  the  interest
                         payment on each Loan may be applied as an additional
                         distribution in respect  of principal to  reduce the
                         principal balance of  a certain class or  classes of
                         such Series  of Securities and, thus, accelerate the
                         rate  of payment  of  principal  on  such  class  or
                         classes of such Series of Securities.

F. Mortgage Pool
   Insurance Policy      A  mortgage pool insurance policy or policies may be
                         obtained  and maintained for  Loans relating  to any
                         Series  of Securities,  which  shall  be limited  in
                         scope  and shall cover defaults on the related Loans
                         in an initial amount equal to a specified percentage
                         of  the  aggregate principal  balance  of all  Loans
                         included in the Pool as of the related Cut-Off Date.

G. Cross-
     Collateralization   If specified in  the related Prospectus  Supplement,
                         separate  classes  of  a Series  of  Securities  may
                         evidence  the beneficial ownership of, or be secured
                         by,  separate groups of  assets included in  a Trust
                         Fund.   In such case, credit support may be provided
                         by a cross-collateralization  feature which requires
                         that distributions be made  to Securities evidencing
                         a beneficial  ownership interest in,  or secured by,
                         one or more  asset groups prior to  distributions to
                         Subordinated  Securities  evidencing   a  beneficial
                         ownership interest in,  or secured  by, other  asset
                         groups  within the  same Trust  Fund.   See  "Credit
                         Enhancement--Cross-Collateralization."

Advances                 The  Master   Servicer  and,  if   applicable,  each
                         mortgage servicing institution that  services a Loan
                         in a Pool on behalf  of the Master Servicer (each, a
                         "Sub-Servicer") may be  obligated to advance amounts
                         (each,  an  "Advance") corresponding  to  delinquent
                         interest and/or  principal  payments  on  such  Loan
                         until  the   date,  as  specified  in   the  related
                         Prospectus Supplement, on which the related Property
                         is sold at a foreclosure sale or the related Loan is
                         otherwise  liquidated.     Any  obligation  to  make
                         Advances may be subject to  limitations as specified
                         in  the   related  Prospectus  Supplement.    If  so
                         specified  in  the  related  Prospectus  Supplement,
                         Advances  may be drawn from a cash account available
                         for  such purpose  as  described in  such Prospectus
                         Supplement.   Advances will  be reimbursable  to the
                         extent   described   under   "Description   of   the
                         Securities--Advances"  herein  and  in  the  related
                         Prospectus Supplement.

                         In  the  event the  Master Servicer  or Sub-Servicer
                         fails to make a required Advance, the Trustee may be
                         obligated to advance such amounts otherwise required
                         to   be  advanced   by   the   Master  Servicer   or
                         Sub-Servicer.  See  "Description of the Securities--
                         Advances."

Optional Termination     The  Master Servicer or  the party specified  in the
                         related Prospectus Supplement,  including the holder
                         of the  residual interest in  a REMIC, may  have the
                         option to  effect early  retirement of  a Series  of
                         Securities through  the purchase of  the Trust  Fund
                         Assets.    The  Master  Servicer  will  deposit  the
                         proceeds  of  any  such  purchase  in  the  Security
                         Account  for each Trust Fund as described under "The
                         Agreements--Payments on  Loans; Deposit  to Security
                         Account."   Any such  purchase of Trust  Fund Assets
                         and  property  acquired  in respect  of  Trust  Fund
                         Assets evidenced by  a Series of Securities  will be
                         made  at the  option of  the  Master Servicer,  such
                         other person or,  if applicable, such holder  of the
                         REMIC residual interest, at a price specified in the
                         related Prospectus Supplement.  The exercise of such
                         right will effect early retirement of the Securities
                         of   that  Series,  but  the  right  of  the  Master
                         Servicer, such other person or, if applicable,  such
                         holder  of  the  REMIC   residual  interest,  to  so
                         purchase  is subject to the principal balance of the
                         related  Trust  Fund  Assets  being  less  than  the
                         percentage  specified  in   the  related  Prospectus
                         Supplement of the aggregate principal balance of the
                         Trust  Fund Assets  at  the  Cut-Off  Date  for  the
                         Series.  The  foregoing is subject to  the provision
                         that if a  REMIC election is made with  respect to a
                         Trust Fund, any such purchase  will be made only  in
                         connection  with  a "qualified  liquidation"  of the
                         REMIC within  the meaning  of Section 860F(g)(4)  of
                         the Internal Revenue  Code of 1986, as  amended (the
                         "Code"). 

Legal Investment         The  Prospectus   Supplement  for  each   Series  of
                         Securities  will  specify  which,  if  any,  of  the
                         classes  of  Securities offered  thereby  constitute
                         "mortgage  related securities"  for purposes  of the
                         Secondary Mortgage  Market Enhancement  Act of  1984
                         ("SMMEA").   Classes of  Securities that  qualify as
                         "mortgage   related   securities"  will   be   legal
                         investments  for  certain   types  of  institutional
                         investors  to the extent provided in SMMEA, subject,
                         in  any case,  to any  other  regulations which  may
                         govern investments by  such institutional investors.
                         Institutions whose investment activities are subject
                         to  review by  federal or  state authorities  should
                         consult  with  their   counsel  or  the   applicable
                         authorities to determine whether  an investment in a
                         particular  class of Securities (whether or not such
                         class  constitutes  a "mortgage  related  security")
                         complies   with   applicable    guidelines,   policy
                         statements or restrictions.  See "Legal Investment."

Federal Income Tax
  Consequences           The    federal    income   tax    consequences    to
                         Securityholders will vary  depending on whether  one
                         or more elections  are made to treat  the Trust Fund
                         or specified portions  thereof as a REMIC  under the
                         provisions of the  Code.  The  Prospectus Supplement
                         for each Series  of Securities will specify  whether
                         such an election will be made.

                         If a REMIC election is made, Securities representing
                         regular  interests  in  a  REMIC  will  generally be
                         taxable to holders  in the same manner  as evidences
                         of   indebtedness  issued  by  the  REMIC.    Stated
                         interest on such  regular interests will be  taxable
                         as  ordinary income and taken into account using the
                         accrual method  of  accounting,  regardless  of  the
                         holder's  normal accounting  method.    If no  REMIC
                         election  is  made,  interest  (other than  original
                         issue  discount  ("OID"))  on  Securities  that  are
                         characterized as indebtedness for federal income tax
                         purposes  will  be includible  in income  by holders
                         thereof  in accordance  with their  usual  method of
                         accounting.

                         Certain  classes of  Securities  may be  issued with
                         OID.  A Securityholder should be aware that the Code
                         and the Treasury  regulations promulgated thereunder
                         do not adequately address certain issues relevant to
                         prepayable securities, such as the Securities.

                         Securityholders that  will  be  required  to  report
                         income with respect to the related Securities  under
                         the  accrual method of accounting will do so without
                         giving  effect   to   delays   and   reductions   in
                         distributions   attributable   to   a   default   or
                         delinquency  on the  Loans, except  possibly  to the
                         extent  that it can be established that such amounts
                         are  uncollectible.    As a  result,  the  amount of
                         income (including OID) reported  by a Securityholder
                         in any period could  significantly exceed the amount
                         of cash distributed  to such Securityholder  in that
                         period.

                         In  the opinion  of Brown  &  Wood LLP,  if a  REMIC
                         election  is  made  with  respect  to  a  Series  of
                         Securities,  then  the  arrangement  by  which  such
                         Securities  are issued will be treated as a REMIC as
                         long  as all  of the  provisions  of the  applicable
                         Agreement are complied  with and  the statutory  and
                         regulatory requirements  are satisfied.   Securities
                         will  be  designated   as  "regular  interests"   or
                         "residual interests" in a  REMIC.  A REMIC will  not
                         be subject to entity-level tax.  Rather, the taxable
                         income or  net loss  of a REMIC  will be  taken into
                         account  by the holders of residual interests.  Such
                         holders will report their proportionate share of the
                         taxable  income of  the REMIC  whether  or not  they
                         receive   cash   distributions    from   the   REMIC
                         attributable to  such income.   The  portion of  the
                         REMIC   taxable   income   consisting   of   "excess
                         inclusions"  may   not  be   offset  against   other
                         deductions  or losses  of the holder,  including the
                         net operating losses.

                         In the opinion of Brown & Wood LLP, if a REMIC  or a
                         partnership election is  not made with respect  to a
                         Series of Securities, then the arrangement by  which
                         such Securities are  issued will be classified  as a
                         grantor  trust under Subpart E, Part I of Subchapter
                         J of the Code and not as an association taxable as a
                         corporation.    If  so provided  in  the  Prospectus
                         Supplement for a Series, there will be no separation
                         of the principal and interest payments on the Loans.
                         In  such circumstances,  the Securityholder  will be
                         considered  to have purchased  a pro  rata undivided
                         interest in each of the Loans.  In other cases, sale
                         of the Securities  will produce a separation  in the
                         ownership  of  all  or a  portion  of  the principal
                         payments  from  all  or a  portion  of  the interest
                         payments on the Loans.

                         In the opinion of Brown & Wood LLP, if a partnership
                         election is made, the Trust Fund will not be treated
                         as an  association or a  publicly traded partnership
                         taxable  as a  corporation  as long  as  all of  the
                         provisions of the  applicable Agreement are complied
                         with and the  statutory and regulatory  requirements
                         are satisfied.   If Notes  are issued by  such Trust
                         Fund, such Notes will be treated as indebtedness for
                         federal income  tax purposes.   The  holders of  the
                         Certificates issued by such Trust Fund, if any, will
                         agree to treat the  Certificates as equity interests
                         in a partnership.

                         The Securities will be  treated as assets  described
                         in  Section 7701(a)(19)(C) of  the Code and  as real
                         estate  assets described  in  Section 856(c) of  the
                         Code.

                         Generally, gain or loss will be recognized on a sale
                         of  Securities in the amount equal to the difference
                         between  the amount  realized and  the  seller's tax
                         basis in the Securities sold.

                         The  material  federal income  tax  consequences for
                         investors  associated with  the purchase,  ownership
                         and  disposition  of the  Securities  are set  forth
                         herein under "Federal Income Tax Consequences".  The
                         material   federal  income   tax  consequences   for
                         investors  associated with  the purchase,  ownership
                         and  disposition  of  Securities  of any  particular
                         Series  will be set forth under the heading "Federal
                         Income Tax  Consequences" in the  related Prospectus
                         Supplement.  See "Federal Income Tax Consequences".

ERISA Considerations     A  fiduciary of any  employee benefit plan  or other
                         retirement  plan  or  arrangement   subject  to  the
                         Employee Retirement Income Security  Act of 1974, as
                         amended  ("ERISA"),  or  the Code  should  carefully
                         review with its legal  advisors whether the purchase
                         or  holding of  Securities  could  give  rise  to  a
                         transaction prohibited or  not otherwise permissible
                         under   ERISA   or   the    Code.      See    "ERISA
                         Considerations".  Certain classes of Securities  may
                         not be  transferred unless the Trustee  is furnished
                         with a  letter of  representation or  an opinion  of
                         counsel  to the effect  that such transfer  will not
                         result  in a violation of the prohibited transaction
                         provisions  of ERISA  and  the  Code  and  will  not
                         subject  the   Trustee,  Provident  or   the  Master
                         Servicer   to    additional   obligations.       See
                         "Description of the  Securities--General" and "ERISA
                         Considerations".

Risk Factors             
   
                         For a discussion of certain risks associated with an
                         investment in the Securities,  see "Risk Factors" on
                         Page  12  herein  and  in  the  related   Prospectus
                         Supplement.
    

                                 RISK FACTORS

     Investors should consider the  following factors in connection  with the
purchase of the Securities.

LIMITED LIQUIDITY

     There will be no  market for the Securities  of any Series prior  to the
issuance thereof, and there can be no  assurance that a secondary market will
develop or, if  it does develop,  that it  will provide Securityholders  with
liquidity of investment  or will continue for  the life of the  Securities of
such Series.

LIMITED SOURCE OF PAYMENTS--NO RECOURSE TO PROVIDENT OR MASTER SERVICER

   
     As  further  described   in  the  related  Prospectus   Supplement,  the
Securities  of a Series will  be payable solely from the  Trust Fund for such
Series and will not have any claim  against or security interest in any trust
fund for  any other Series.   There will be  no recourse to  Provident or any
other  person for  any failure  to receive  distributions on  the Securities.
Further, at the times set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement, certain
Trust  Fund Assets  and/or  any  balance remaining  in  the Security  Account
immediately after making  all payments due on the  Securities of such Series,
after making  adequate provision  for future payments  on certain  classes of
Securities  and after  making any  other  payments specified  in the  related
Prospectus Supplement, may be promptly released or remitted to Provident, the
Master Servicer, any credit enhancement provider or any other person entitled
thereto   and  will   no  longer   be  available   for  making   payments  to
Securityholders.   Consequently, holders  of Securities  of each  Series must
rely solely upon payments with respect to the Trust Fund Assets and the other
assets constituting the Trust Fund for  a Series of Securities, including, if
applicable, any amounts available pursuant to any credit enhancement for such
Series, for the  payment of principal  of and interest  on the Securities  of
such Series.
    

     The  Securities will  not  represent  an interest  in  or obligation  of
Provident, the  Master Servicer or any  of their respective affiliates.   The
only obligation,  if any, of Provident with respect  to the Trust Fund Assets
or the  Securities of any Series will  be pursuant to certain representations
and warranties and certain document delivery requirements.

     Provident may be required to repurchase  or substitute for any Loan with
respect to  which such  representations and  warranties or  document delivery
requirements are  breached.  There  is no assurance, however,  that Provident
will have the financial ability to effect such repurchase or substitution.

CREDIT ENHANCEMENT

     Although credit enhancement is intended to reduce the risk of delinquent
payments or losses to holders of Securities entitled to 

the benefit thereof, the amount of  such credit enhancement will be  limited,
as set  forth in  the related Prospectus  Supplement, and  may be  subject to
periodic  reduction in  accordance with  a schedule  or formula  or otherwise
decline,  and could  be depleted  under  certain circumstances  prior to  the
payment  in  full  of the  related  Series  of Securities,  and  as  a result
Securityholders  of the  related Series  may suffer  losses.   Moreover, such
credit enhancement may not cover all potential losses or risks.  For example,
credit enhancement  may  or may  not  cover fraud  or  negligence by  a  loan
originator  or other parties.   In  addition, the  Trustee will  generally be
permitted to reduce, terminate or substitute  all or a portion of the  credit
enhancement  for any  Series of  Securities,  provided the  applicable Rating
Agency  indicates that  the then-current  rating  of the  Securities of  such
Series will not be adversely affected.  See "Credit Enhancement".

PREPAYMENT AND YIELD CONSIDERATIONS

   
     The timing  of principal payments of the Securities  of a Series will be
affected by a number  of factors, including the following: (i)  the extent of
prepayments   (including  for   this  purpose   prepayments  resulting   from
refinancing or  liquidations  of  the  Loans  due  to  defaults,  casualties,
condemnations and  repurchases by  Provident or the  Master Servicer)  of the
Loans comprising  the Trust Fund,  which prepayments may  be influenced by  a
variety of factors including general economic conditions, prevailing interest
rate   levels,  the  availability  of  alternative  financing  and  homeowner
mobility, (ii) the  manner of allocating principal and/or  payments among the
classes of  Securities of a  Series as  specified in  the related  Prospectus
Supplement, (iii) the exercise by the party  entitled thereto of any right of
optional  termination and  (iv) the rate  and timing of  payment defaults and
losses  incurred with respect  to the Trust  Fund Assets.   The repurchase of
Loans by  Provident or  the Master  Servicer may  result from  repurchases of
Trust Fund  Assets  due to  material breaches  of Provident's  or the  Master
Servicer's representations  and  warranties, as  applicable.   The yields  to
maturity  and weighted  average  lives  of the  Securities  will be  affected
primarily by the  rate and timing of  prepayment of the Loans  comprising the
Trust Fund Assets.  In addition, the yields to maturity and  weighted average
lives  of  the Securities  will be  affected by  the distribution  of amounts
remaining in any Pre-Funding Account following the end of the related Funding
Period.  Any  reinvestment risks resulting from a  faster or slower incidence
of  prepayment of Loans  held by a Trust  Fund will be  borne entirely by the
holders of  one or more  classes of  the related Series  of Securities.   See
"Yield  and  Prepayment   Considerations"  and  "The  Agreements--Pre-Funding
Account."
    

     Interest  payable on the Securities  of a Series  on a Distribution Date
will include all  interest accrued during the period specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement.   In the event  interest accrues over a  period ending
two or  more  days prior  to  a Distribution  Date,  the effective  yield  to
Securityholders  will be  reduced  from  the yield  that  would otherwise  be
obtainable if interest  payable on the Securities were  to accrue through the
day immediately preceding each Distribution Date, and the effective yield (at
par) to Securityholders  will be less  than the indicated  coupon rate.   See
"Description of the Securities--Distributions on Securities--Distributions of
Interest".

BALLOON PAYMENTS

     Certain  of the Loans  as of the  related Cut-Off Date may  not be fully
amortizing over their  terms to maturity and, thus,  will require substantial
principal payments (i.e., balloon payments)  at their stated maturity.  Loans
with balloon payments involve a greater degree of risk because the ability of
a borrower to make a balloon  payment typically will depend upon its  ability
either to  timely refinance the loan or to  timely sell the related Property.
The  ability  of a  borrower  to accomplish  either  of these  goals  will be
affected  by a number  of factors, including the  level of available mortgage
rates  at the  time of  sale  or refinancing,  the borrower's  equity  in the
related  Property, the  financial condition  of  the borrower  and tax  laws.
Losses on such Loans that are not otherwise covered by the credit enhancement
described  in the  applicable  Prospectus  Supplement will  be  borne by  the
holders of one or more classes of Securities of the related Series.

NATURE OF MORTGAGES

     Property Values.  There are  several factors that could adversely affect
the value  of Properties  such that  the outstanding  balance of  the related
Loans, together with  any senior financing on the  Properties, if applicable,
would equal or exceed  the value of the Properties.   Among the factors  that
could adversely affect the value of the Properties are an overall  decline in
the residential real estate  market in the areas in which  the Properties are
located or a decline in the general  condition of the Properties as a  result
of failure of borrowers  to maintain adequately the Properties or  of natural
disasters that are not necessarily  covered by insurance, such as earthquakes
and floods.  In the case of Home Equity Loans, such decline  could extinguish
the value of the interest of a junior mortgagee in the Property before having
any effect  on  the interest  of the  related senior  mortgagee.   If such  a
decline occurs, the actual rates of delinquencies, foreclosures and losses on
all  Loans could be  higher than those currently  experienced in the mortgage
lending industry in  general.  Losses  on such Loans  that are not  otherwise
covered  by the  credit enhancement  described in  the applicable  Prospectus
Supplement will be borne by  the holder of one or more  classes of Securities
of the related Series.

     Delays Due  to Liquidation.   Even assuming that the  Properties provide
adequate security for  the Loans, substantial delays could  be encountered in
connection  with the liquidation of defaulted  Loans and corresponding delays
in the receipt of related proceeds by Securityholders could occur.  An action
to foreclose on a Property securing a Loan is regulated by state statutes and
rules and is subject to many of the delays and expenses of  other lawsuits if
defenses or counterclaims  are interposed, sometimes requiring  several years
to complete.   Furthermore, in some states  an action to obtain  a deficiency
judgment is not permitted following a nonjudicial sale of a Property.  In the
event of a default by a borrower, these restrictions, among other things, may
impede  the  ability of  the  Master Servicer  to  foreclose on  or  sell the
Property or  to obtain liquidation  proceeds sufficient to repay  all amounts
due on  the related Loan.  In addition,  the Master Servicer will be entitled
to deduct from  related liquidation proceeds all expenses reasonably incurred
in attempting to recover amounts due  on defaulted Loans and not yet  repaid,
including  payments to  senior lienholders,  legal  fees and  costs of  legal
action, real estate taxes and maintenance and preservation expenses.

     Disproportionate Effect of  Liquidation Expenses.  Liquidation  expenses
with respect  to defaulted  Loans do not  vary directly with  the outstanding
principal balance of  the Loan at the  time of default.   Therefore, assuming
that a servicer took the same steps in realizing upon a defaulted Loan having
a small remaining  principal balance as it  would in the case of  a defaulted
Loan having  a large remaining  principal balance, the amount  realized after
expenses of liquidation would be  smaller as a percentage of  the outstanding
principal balance of the small Loan than would be the case with the defaulted
Loan having a large remaining principal balance.    

     Home Equity Loans; Junior Liens.  Since the mortgages and deeds of trust
securing  the Home Equity Loans will be primarily junior liens subordinate to
the rights of the mortgagee under  the related senior mortgage(s) or  deed(s)
of trust,  the  proceeds  from any  liquidation,  insurance  or  condemnation
proceeds will be available to satisfy the  outstanding balance of such junior
lien only to the  extent that the claims of such  senior mortgagees have been
satisfied in full,  including any related foreclosure costs.   In addition, a
junior mortgagee may not foreclose on the property securing a junior mortgage
unless it forecloses  subject to any senior  mortgage, in which case  it must
either pay the entire amount due on any senior mortgage to the related senior
mortgagee at or  prior to the foreclosure sale or undertake the obligation to
make  payments on any such senior  mortgage in the event  the mortgagor is in
default thereunder.   The Trust  Fund will  not have any  source of  funds to
satisfy any senior  mortgages or make payments  due to any  senior mortgagees
and may therefore be prevented from foreclosing on the related property. 

     Consumer  Protection Laws.   Applicable  state  laws generally  regulate
interest rates  and other charges,  require certain disclosures,  and require
licensing of certain originators and  servicers of Loans.  In  addition, most
states  have other  laws,  public  policy and  general  principles of  equity
relating to the  protection of consumers, unfair and  deceptive practices and
practices which may apply to the origination, servicing and collection of the
Loans.  Depending  on the provisions of  the applicable law and  the specific
facts  and circumstances  involved, violations  of  these laws,  policies and
principles may limit  the ability of  the Master Servicer  to collect all  or
part of the principal of or interest  on the Loans, may entitle the  borrower
to a refund  of amounts previously paid  and, in addition, could  subject the
Master Servicer to damages and  administrative sanctions.  See "Certain Legal
Aspects of the Loans".

ENVIRONMENTAL RISKS

     Real property pledged as security to a lender may be subject  to certain
environmental risks.   Under the laws  of certain states, contamination  of a
property  may give  rise to a  lien on  the property  to assure the  costs of
cleanup.  In  several states, such a  lien has priority  over the lien of  an
existing mortgage against such property.  In addition, under the laws of some
states  and   under   the  federal   Comprehensive  Environmental   Response,
Compensation and Liability Act of 1980 ("CERCLA"), a lender may be liable, as
an  "owner" or  "operator", for  costs of  addressing releases  or threatened
releases of hazardous substances that require remedy at a property, if agents
or  employees  of  the  lender  have  become  sufficiently  involved  in  the
operations of the borrower, regardless of whether the environmental damage or
threat was caused by a prior owner.  Such costs could result in a loss to the
holders of one or more classes of Securities of the related Series.  A lender
also  risks such  liability  on foreclosure  of  the related  property.   See
"Certain Legal Aspects of the Loans--Environmental Risks".

CERTAIN OTHER LEGAL ASPECTS OF THE LOANS

     Consumer Protection  Laws.   The Loans may  also be  subject to  federal
laws, including:

          (i)  the Federal Truth in Lending Act and  Regulation Z promulgated
     thereunder, which require certain disclosures to the borrowers regarding
     the terms of the Loans;

          (ii) the  Equal Credit Opportunity Act and Regulation B promulgated
     thereunder, which  prohibit discrimination on  the basis  of age,  race,
     color, sex, religion, marital status, national origin, receipt of public
     assistance  or the  exercise  of  any right  under  the Consumer  Credit
     Protection Act, in the extension of credit;

          (iii)     the  Fair Credit Reporting  Act, which regulates  the use
     and   reporting  of  information   related  to  the   borrower's  credit
     experience; and

          (iv) for Loans  that were originated  or closed  after November  7,
     1989,  the Home  Equity  Loan  Consumer Protection  Act  of 1988,  which
     requires  additional application disclosures, limits changes that may be
     made to the Loan documents  without the borrower's consent and restricts
     a  lender's ability  to declare  a  default or  to suspend  or  reduce a
     borrower's credit limit to certain enumerated events.

     The  Riegle Act.   Certain Mortgage Loans  may be subject  to the Riegle
Community Development and  Regulatory Improvement  Act of  1994 (the  "Riegle
Act")  which incorporates  the Home  Ownership and  Equity Protection  Act of
1994.  These  provisions impose additional disclosure and  other requirements
on  creditors with  respect to  non-purchase money  mortgage loans  with high
interest  rates or  high up-front fees  and charges.   The provisions  of the
Riegle Act apply on a mandatory basis to all Mortgage Loans originated  on or
after  October 1,  1995.    These provisions  can  impose specific  statutory
liabilities  upon creditors who fail to  comply with their provisions and may
affect the enforceability of the related Loans.  In addition, any assignee of
the creditor would generally  be subject to all claims and  defenses that the
consumer  could assert against  the creditor, including,  without limitation,
the right to rescind the Mortgage Loan.

   
    

RATING OF THE SECURITIES


     It will be a condition to the issuance of a class of Securities  offered
hereby that they be rated in one of the four highest rating categories by the
Rating  Agency identified  in the  related Prospectus  Supplement.   Any such
rating would  be based on, among  other things, the adequacy of  the value of
the related Trust Fund Assets and any credit enhancement with respect to such
class  and will  represent  such  Rating Agency's  assessment  solely of  the
likelihood that  holders of such class of Securities will receive payments to
which such  Securityholders are entitled  under the related Agreement.   Such
rating will  not constitute  an assessment of  the likelihood  that principal
prepayments on the related  Loans will be made, the degree  to which the rate
of  such prepayments  might differ  from that  originally anticipated  or the
likelihood of early optional  termination of the Series of  Securities.  Such
rating  shall  not be  deemed  a  recommendation to  purchase,  hold or  sell
Securities, inasmuch as it does not address market price or suitability for a
particular  investor.   Such rating  will  not address  the possibility  that
prepayment at higher or lower rates than anticipated by an investor may cause
such  investor  to  experience a  lower  than anticipated  yield  or  that an
investor purchasing  a Security at a significant premium might fail to recoup
its initial investment under certain prepayment scenarios.

     There is also  no assurance that any  such rating will remain  in effect
for  any given period  of time  or that  it may not  be lowered  or withdrawn
entirely by the Rating Agency in the  future if in its judgment circumstances
in the future so warrant.  In  addition to being lowered or withdrawn due  to
any erosion in  the adequacy of  the value of  the Trust Fund  Assets or  any
credit enhancement with respect to a Series  of Securities, such rating might
also be  lowered or withdrawn  because of,  among other  reasons, an  adverse
change in the  financial or other condition of  a credit enhancement provider
or a change  in the rating  of such credit  enhancement provider's long  term
debt.

     The amount, type  and nature of credit enhancement,  if any, established
with  respect to a  class of Securities  will be  determined on the  basis of
criteria established  by each  Rating Agency rating  classes of  such Series.
Such criteria are  sometimes based upon an actuarial analysis of the behavior
of similar  loans in a larger group.   Such analysis is often  the basis upon
which each Rating Agency determines the amount of credit enhancement required
with respect  to  each  such class.    There can  be  no assurance  that  the
historical  data supporting  any  such  actuarial  analysis  will  accurately
reflect future  experience nor  any assurance  that the data  derived from  a
large pool of similar loans accurately predicts the delinquency,  foreclosure
or loss  experience of any  particular pool  of Loans.   No assurance can  be
given that the values of any Properties have remained or will remain at their
levels on the respective  dates of origination of the related  Loans.  If the
residential  real estate  markets  should experience  an  overall decline  in
property values such  that the outstanding principal balances of the Loans in
a particular  Trust Fund and  any other  financing on the  related Properties
become equal to  or greater than  the value of  the Properties, the  rates of
delinquencies,  foreclosures  and  losses  could  be  higher than  those  now
generally experienced in the mortgage lending industry.  In addition, adverse
economic conditions  (which may or may  not affect real  property values) may
affect the  timely payment by  mortgagors of scheduled payments  of principal
and  interest on  the Loans  and,  accordingly, the  rates of  delinquencies,
foreclosures and  losses with respect to any Trust  Fund.  To the extent that
such losses are not covered by credit enhancement, such losses will be borne,
at least in part, by the holders of one or more classes  of Securities of the
related Series.  See "Rating".

BOOK-ENTRY REGISTRATION

     If issued in book-entry form, such registration may reduce the liquidity
of the  Securities in  the secondary  trading market since  investors may  be
unwilling to  purchase  Securities  for  which they  cannot  obtain  physical
certificates.   Since transactions  in Book-Entry Securities  can be effected
only   through   the   Depository  Trust   Company   ("DTC"),   participating
organizations, Financial Intermediaries  and certain banks, the  ability of a
Securityholder to pledge a Book-Entry Security to persons or entities that do
not participate in  the DTC system may  be limited due to lack  of a physical
certificate  representing  such Securities.    Security  Owners will  not  be
recognized as Securityholders as such term is  used in the related Agreement,
and  Security   Owners  will   be  permitted  to   exercise  the   rights  of
Securityholders only indirectly through DTC and its Participants.

     In addition, Securityholders may experience some  delay in their receipt
of distributions  of interest and  principal on  Book-Entry Securities  since
distributions are required to be forwarded by the Trustee to DTC and DTC will
then be  required to credit such distributions  to the accounts of Depository
participants which thereafter will be required to credit them to the accounts
of   Securityholders   either  directly   or  indirectly   through  Financial
Intermediaries.   See "Description of the Securities--Book-Entry Registration
of Securities".

PRE-FUNDING ACCOUNTS

     If  so provided  in the  related Prospectus  Supplement, on  the related
Closing  Date Provident  will  deposit  cash in  an  amount (the  "Pre-Funded
Amount") specified in  such Prospectus Supplement into an  account (the "Pre-
Funding Account").  In no event shall the Pre-Funded Amount exceed 50% of the
initial aggregate  principal amount of  the Certificates and/or Notes  of the
related Series of Securities.  The Pre-Funded Amount will be used to purchase
Loans  ("Subsequent Loans") in  a period from  the related Closing  Date to a
date  not  more than  one  year after  such  Closing Date  (such  period, the
"Funding Period") from Provident.  The Pre-Funding Account will be maintained
with the Trustee for the related Series of Securities and is  designed solely
to hold  funds to be applied by such Trustee during the Funding Period to pay
to Provident the purchase price for  Subsequent Loans.  Monies on deposit  in
the  Pre-Funding Account  will not  be  available to  cover losses  on  or in
respect of  the related  Loans.   To the  extent that  the entire  Pre-Funded
Amount has not been applied to the purchase of Subsequent Loans by the end of
the related Funding Period, any  amounts remaining in the Pre-Funding Account
will  be  distributed as  a prepayment  of  principal to  the holders  of the
related Securities on the Distribution  Date immediately following the end of
the Funding  Period, in the amounts and pursuant  to the priorities set forth
in the related  Prospectus Supplement.  Any reinvestment  risk resulting from
such prepayment will be borne entirely by the  holders of one or more classes
of the related Series of Securities.

BANKRUPTCY AND INSOLVENCY RISKS

     Provident and  the Trust  Fund  will treat  the transfer  of Loans  from
Provident to  the Trust Fund as a sale for  accounting purposes.  However, in
the  event of the insolvency of Provident,  it is possible that a receiver or
conservator   (or   similar   official)  for   Provident,   may   attempt  to
recharacterize the sale  of the Loans as a borrowing by Provident, secured by
a pledge  of the Loans.  Certain provisions  of the Federal Deposit Insurance
Act  may permit the FDIC to avoid such  security interest.  This position, if
argued before  and/or accepted by a  court, could prevent  timely payments of
amounts due on the  Securities and result in  a reduction of payments  due on
the Securities.   Provident will, however, mark its records  to indicate that
the Trust Fund Assets relating to each Series have been sold to a Trust Fund.

     In the event of  a bankruptcy or insolvency of the  Master Servicer, the
bankruptcy trustee or receiver may have  the power to prevent the Trustee  or
the Securityholders  from appointing a  successor Master Servicer.   The time
period  during which  cash  collections  may be  commingled  with the  Master
Servicer's own funds prior to each Distribution Date will be specified in the
related Prospectus Supplement.  In the event of the insolvency of  the Master
Servicer  and  if  such  cash  collections are  commingled  with  the  Master
Servicer's own  funds for at least ten  days, the Trust Fund  will likely not
have a  perfected interest in  such collections since such  collections would
not have been  deposited in a  segregated account within  ten days after  the
collection thereof, and the inclusion thereof in the bankruptcy estate of the
Master Servicer may  result in delays in  payment and failure to  pay amounts
due on the Securities of the related Series.

     In  addition,  federal  and state  statutory  provisions,  including the
federal  bankruptcy laws  and state  laws  affording relief  to debtors,  may
interfere with  or  affect the  ability  of the  secured  mortgage lender  to
realize upon its  security.  For example,  in a proceeding under  the federal
Bankruptcy  Code, a lender may not foreclose  on a mortgaged property without
the permission of the bankruptcy court.   The rehabilitation plan proposed by
the debtor  may  provide, if  the  mortgaged  property is  not  the  debtor's
principal residence and the court determines that the value of  the mortgaged
property is  less than the  principal balance of  the mortgage loan,  for the
reduction of the  secured indebtedness to the value of the mortgaged property
as of the date of the commencement of the bankruptcy, rendering the lender  a
general  unsecured creditor  for  the  difference, and  also  may reduce  the
monthly payments  due under such  mortgage loan, change the  rate of interest
and alter  the mortgage  loan repayment  schedule.   The effect  of any  such
proceedings under the  federal Bankruptcy Code, including but  not limited to
any automatic stay, could result in delays in receiving payments on the Loans
underlying a  Series of Securities  and possible reductions in  the aggregate
amount of such payments.

CONSEQUENCES OF OWNING ORIGINAL ISSUE DISCOUNT SECURITIES 

     Debt  Securities that  are  Compound Interest  Securities  will be,  and
certain  of  the other  Debt Securities  may be,  issued with  original issue
discount for federal income tax purposes.  A holder of Debt Securities issued
with  original issue  discount will  be  required to  include original  issue
discount  in ordinary  gross income  for federal  income  tax purposes  as it
accrues,  in advance  of receipt  of the  cash attributable  to  such income.
Accrued but unpaid interest on the Debt Securities that are Compound Interest
Securities  generally will  be treated  as original  issue discount  for this
purpose.  See "Federal Income Tax Consequences--Taxation of Debt Securities--
Interest and Acquisition Discount" and "--Market Discount" herein.

VALUE OF TRUST FUND ASSETS

     There is no  assurance that the market value of the Trust Fund Assets or
any other assets  relating to a Series of  Securities described under "Credit
Enhancement"  herein  will  at any  time  be  equal to  or  greater  than the
principal  amount of  the Securities  of such  Series then  outstanding, plus
accrued  interest thereon.   Moreover,  upon an  event of  default under  the
Agreement for a Series  of Securities and  a sale of  the related Trust  Fund
Assets  or  upon a  sale  of the  assets  of a  Trust  Fund for  a  Series of
Securities, the  Trustee, the Master  Servicer, the credit enhancer,  if any,
and any other service provider specified in the related Prospectus Supplement
generally will be entitled to  receive the proceeds of  any such sale to  the
extent of  unpaid fees  and other  amounts owing  to such  persons under  the
related Agreement prior  to distributions to Securityholders.   Upon any such
sale, the proceeds thereof  may be insufficient to pay in  full the principal
of and interest on the Securities of such Series.


                                THE TRUST FUND

GENERAL

   
     The Securities of each Series will  represent interests in the assets of
the related Trust Fund, and the Notes  of each Series will be secured by  the
pledge of the  assets of the  related Trust Fund.   The Trust  Fund for  each
Series  will  be  held  by  the  Trustee  for  the  benefit  of  the  related
Securityholders.   Each Trust Fund will consist of certain assets (the "Trust
Fund Assets")  consisting of a  pool (each, a  "Pool") comprised of  Loans as
specified in  the related  Prospectus Supplement, together  with payments  in
respect of  such Loans,  as specified in  the related  Prospectus Supplement.
The Pool will be created on the first day of the month of the issuance of the
related  Series of  Securities or  such other date  specified in  the related
Prospectus Supplement (the "Cut-Off Date").   The Securities will be entitled
to payment from the assets of the related Trust Fund  or other assets pledged
for the benefit of the Securityholders as specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement and will not  be entitled to payments in respect  of the assets of
any other trust fund established by Provident. 
    

     Each  Loan  will  have  been  originated or  acquired  by  Provident  in
accordance  with  the  underwriting  criteria  specified  below  under  "Loan
Program--Underwriting Standards"  or as  otherwise described  in the  related
Prospectus  Supplement.   See "Loan  Program--Underwriting  Standards".   The
Trust Fund  Assets will  be conveyed  without  recourse by  Provident to  the
related Trust Fund.

     Provident will assign  the Trust Fund Assets to the Trustee named in the
related  Prospectus  Supplement  for  the  benefit  of  the  holders  of  the
Securities of the related  Series.  The Master Servicer named  in the related
Prospectus Supplement will service the  Trust Fund Assets, either directly or
through  Sub-Servicers, pursuant to  a Pooling and  Servicing Agreement among
Provident,  the Master  Servicer and  the Trustee  with respect  to a  Series
consisting of Certificates, or a  master servicing agreement (each, a "Master
Servicing  Agreement")  between  the  Trustee and  the  Master  Servicer with
respect to a Series consisting of Certificates  and Notes, and will receive a
fee for  such  services.   See "Loan  Program" and  "The  Agreements".   With
respect to Loans serviced by the  Master Servicer through a Sub-Servicer, the
Master Servicer  will remain liable  for its servicing obligations  under the
related Agreement as if the Master Servicer alone were servicing such Loans.

     As used herein,  "Agreement" means, with respect to  a Series consisting
of  Certificates, the Pooling and Servicing Agreement,  and with respect to a
Series  consisting  of  Certificates  and  Notes,  the Trust  Agreement,  the
Indenture and the Master Servicing Agreement, as the context requires.

     If  so specified  in the  related  Prospectus Supplement,  a Trust  Fund
relating to a Series  of Securities may be a business trust  formed under the
laws of the state specified in  the related Prospectus Supplement pursuant to
a  trust agreement  (each, a  "Trust  Agreement") between  Provident and  the
trustee of such Trust Fund.

     With respect to  each Trust Fund, prior  to the initial offering  of the
related  Series  of  Securities, the  Trust  Fund  will  have  no  assets  or
liabilities.   No Trust Fund  is expected to  engage in any  activities other
than acquiring, managing and holding the related Trust  Fund Assets and other
assets contemplated herein specified and in the related Prospectus Supplement
and  the  proceeds  thereof,  issuing  Securities  and  making  payments  and
distributions  thereon and  certain related  activities.   No  Trust Fund  is
expected to have any source of capital other than  its assets and any related
credit enhancement.

   
     The only obligations of Provident with respect to a Series of Securities
will  be to  make certain representations  and warranties to  the Trustee for
such Series of Securities.  With respect to any breach of a representation or
warranty  which  materially  and   adversely  affects  the  interests   of  a
Securityholder, Provident will be obligated to cure such breach or repurchase
or  substitute for  the  affected  Loan  or Loans.    See  "The  Agreements--
Assignment of the Trust Fund Assets".  The obligations of the Master Servicer
with  respect  to the  Loans  will  consist  principally of  its  contractual
servicing obligations under  the related Agreement (including  its obligation
to enforce the  obligations of the  Sub-Servicers or  Provident, or both,  as
more  fully   described  herein   under  "Loan   Program--Representations  by
Provident;  Repurchases"  and   "The  Agreements--Sub-Servicing"  and     "--
Assignment of the  Trust Fund Assets")  and its obligation,  if any, to  make
certain cash advances  in the event of  delinquencies in payments on  or with
respect to  the Loans in the  amounts described herein under  "Description of
the Securities--Advances".   The obligations  of the Master Servicer  to make
advances may  be subject to limitations to the  extent provided herein and in
the related Prospectus Supplement.
    

     The  following  is a  brief  description of  the assets  expected  to be
included  in the Trust Funds.   If specific information respecting Trust Fund
Assets is not known at the time the related Series of Securities initially is
offered,  more general  information of  the  nature described  below will  be
provided in the related Prospectus Supplement,  and specific information will
be set  forth in a  report on Form  8-K to be  filed with the  Securities and
Exchange Commission  within fifteen days  after the initial issuance  of such
Securities  (the "Detailed  Description").    A copy  of  the Agreement  with
respect  to each Series of  Securities will be  attached to the  Form 8-K and
will be available for inspection at the corporate trust office of the Trustee
specified in  the related  Prospectus Supplement.   A  schedule of  the Loans
relating to such  Series will be attached  to the Agreement delivered  to the
Trustee upon delivery of the Securities.

THE LOANS

     General.
               Loans will consist of  Mortgage Loans and Home  Equity Loans.
As more fully described in the related Prospectus  Supplement, the Loans will
be "conventional" loans.

     The Loans in a Pool will have  monthly payments due on the first day  of
each  month  or on  such  other day  of the  month  specified in  the related
Prospectus Supplement.  The  payment terms of the  Loans to be included  in a
Trust Fund  will be described  in the related  Prospectus Supplement  and may
include  any of  the  following  features (or  combination  thereof), all  as
described below or in the related Prospectus Supplement:
    

          (a)  Interest may  be payable  at a fixed  rate, a  rate adjustable
     from time to  time in relation to an  index (which will be  specified in
     the related Prospectus Supplement), a rate that is fixed for a period of
     time or  under certain  circumstances and is  followed by  an adjustable
     rate, a rate that otherwise varies from time to time, or a  rate that is
     convertible  from an  adjustable rate to  a fixed  rate.  Changes  to an
     adjustable rate may  be subject to periodic limitations,  maximum rates,
     minimum rates  or a combination  of such limitations.   Accrued interest
     may be deferred and  added to the principal  of a Loan for  such periods
     and  under  such  circumstances  as  may be  specified  in  the  related
     Prospectus Supplement.  Loans may provide for the payment of interest at
     a rate lower  than the specified interest  rate borne by such  Loan (the
     "Loan Rate") for a  period of time or for the life of  the Loan, and the
     amount of  any difference may be contributed  from funds supplied by the
     seller of the Property or another source.

          (b)  Principal  may be  payable on  a level  debt service  basis to
     fully amortize the Loan over its term, may be calculated on the basis of
     an assumed amortization schedule that  is significantly longer than  the
     original term to maturity or on an  interest rate that is different from
     the Loan  Rate or may not  be amortized during  all or a portion  of the
     original term.  Payment of all or a substantial portion of the principal
     may  be due  on maturity  ("balloon  payment").   Principal may  include
     interest  that has been  deferred and added to  the principal balance of
     the Loan.

          (c)  Monthly payments  of principal and  interest may be  fixed for
     the life of  the Loan, may increase over  a specified period of  time or
     may change from period to period.   Loans may include limits on periodic
     increases or decreases in the amount of monthly payments and may include
     maximum or minimum amounts of monthly payments.

          (d)  Prepayments  of principal may be subject  to a prepayment fee,
     which may  be fixed for the life  of the Loan or may  decline over time,
     and may be prohibited  for the life of  the Loan or for  certain periods
     ("Lockout  Periods").    Certain  Loans  may  permit  prepayments  after
     expiration of the applicable Lockout  Period and may require the payment
     of a prepayment  fee in connection with any  such subsequent prepayment.
     Other Loans may  permit prepayments without payment of a  fee unless the
     prepayment occurs during specified time  periods.  The Loans may include
     "due-on-sale" clauses which  permit the mortgagee  to demand payment  of
     the entire Loan  in connection with the sale or certain transfers of the
     related Property.  Other Loans  may be assumable by persons  meeting the
     then applicable standards set forth in the Agreement.

     A Trust  Fund may contain  certain Loans ("Buydown Loans")  that include
provisions whereby a third party partially subsidizes the monthly payments of
the  borrowers on  such  Loans during  the  early years  of  such Loans,  the
difference to be made up  from a fund (a "Buydown Fund")  contributed by such
third  party at the time of origination of  the Loan.  A Buydown Fund will be
in an amount equal either to the discounted value or full aggregate amount of
future payment subsidies.  The underlying assumption of buydown plans is that
the income  of the  borrower will  increase during  the buydown  period as  a
result  of  normal increases  in  compensation  and  inflation, so  that  the
borrower will  be able  to meet  the full  loan payments  at the  end of  the
buydown period.  To the extent that this assumption as to increased income is
not fulfilled,  the possibility  of defaults on  Buydown Loans  is increased.
The  related Prospectus Supplement  will contain information  with respect to
any  Buydown Loan  concerning limitations  on the interest  rate paid  by the
borrower initially,  on annual  increases in  the interest  rate  and on  the
length of the buydown period.

   
     The real property which secures repayment of the Loans is referred to as
the "Mortgaged Properties".  The Loans will be secured by mortgages  or deeds
of trust or other similar security instruments creating a lien on a Mortgaged
Property.  In the  case of Home  Equity Loans, such  liens generally will  be
subordinated to one or more senior  liens on the related Mortgaged Properties
as described in the related  Prospectus Supplement.  The Mortgaged Properties
are referred to herein as the "Properties".  The Properties relating to Loans
will consist of detached or semi-detached one- to four-family dwelling units,
townhouses,  rowhouses,  individual  condominium units,  individual  units in
planned  unit developments,  manufactured homes  and  certain other  dwelling
units ("Single Family Properties").  Such Properties may include vacation and
second  homes, investment  properties, and  dwellings  situated on  leasehold
estates.  In the case of leasehold interests,  the term of the leasehold will
exceed the  scheduled maturity  of the Loan  by at  least five  years, unless
otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.  The Properties may
be  located in any one of  the fifty states, the  District of Columbia, Guam,
Puerto Rico or any other territory of the United States.
    

     Loans  with  certain  Loan-to-Value  Ratios  and/or  certain   principal
balances  may be  covered wholly  or partially  by primary  mortgage guaranty
insurance policies  (each,  a  "Primary Mortgage  Insurance  Policy").    The
existence, extent and  duration of any such coverage will be described in the
applicable Prospectus Supplement.

   
     The aggregate principal balance of  Loans secured by Properties that are
owner-occupied may  be disclosed in  the related Prospectus Supplement.   The
basis for a representation that a given percentage of the Loans is secured by
Single  Family Properties  that are  owner-occupied  will be  either (i)  the
making of a representation by the borrower at origination of the  Loan either
that the underlying Property will be used by the borrower for a  period of at
least six months every year or that  the borrower intends to use the Property
as a  primary residence or (ii) a finding that  the address of the underlying
Property is the borrower's mailing address.  
    

     Home Equity Loans.   As more fully  described in the related  Prospectus
Supplement,   interest  on  each   Revolving  Credit  Line   Loan,  excluding
introduction rates offered  from time to time during  promotional periods, is
computed and  payable  monthly on  the  average daily  outstanding  principal
balance of such Loan.  Principal amounts on  a Revolving Credit Line Loan may
be drawn down (up to a maximum amount as set  forth in the related Prospectus
Supplement)  or repaid  under each  Revolving Credit Line  Loan from  time to
time, but may be subject to a  minimum periodic payment.  As specified in the
related  Prospectus  Supplement,  the  Trust Fund  may  include  any  amounts
borrowed under a Revolving Credit Line Loan after the Cut-Off Date.  The full
amount of  a Closed-End  Loan is advanced  at the inception  of the  Loan and
generally is repayable  in equal (or substantially equal)  installments of an
amount to  fully amortize such Loan  at its stated  maturity or is  a Balloon
Loan.  As more fully described in the related Prospectus Supplement, interest
on  each Closed-End  Loan  is  calculated on  the  basis  of the  outstanding
principal balance  of  such Loan  multiplied  by the  Loan Rate  thereon  and
further multiplied by either a fraction, the numerator of which is the number
of days  in the period  elapsed since the  preceding payment of  interest was
made and the denominator of which is the  number of days in the annual period
for which interest accrues on such Loan, or a fraction which is  30 over 360.
Except  to the  extent provided  in  the related  Prospectus Supplement,  the
original  terms to  stated maturity  of Closed-End  Loans generally  will not
exceed 360  months.   Under certain circumstances,  under either  a Revolving
Credit Line Loan or a Closed-End Loan, a borrower may choose an interest only
payment option  and is  obligated to pay  only the  amount of  interest which
accrues on  the Loan  during the  billing cycle.   An  interest only  payment
option may be available for a specified period before the borrower must begin
paying at least the minimum monthly payment of a specified percentage  of the
average outstanding balance of the Loan.

   
    

     Additional  Information.    Each   Prospectus  Supplement  will  contain
information, as of the  date of such Prospectus Supplement and  to the extent
then specifically known to Provident, with respect to the  Loans contained in
the related Pool,  including (i) the aggregate outstanding  principal balance
and  the  average  outstanding  principal balance  of  the  Loans  as of  the
applicable  Cut-Off Date, (ii) the type of  property securing the Loan (e.g.,
single  family   residences,  individual  units   in  condominium   apartment
buildings, two-  to four-family dwelling  units, other real property  or Home
Improvements), (iii) the  original terms to  maturity of the Loans,  (iv) the
largest  principal balance and the  smallest principal balance  of any of the
Loans, (v) the earliest  origination date and latest maturity date  of any of
the Loans, (vi) the Loan-to-Value Ratios or Combined Loan-to-Value Ratios, as
applicable, of the  Loans, (vii) the  Loan Rates  or annual percentage  rates
("APR")  or range  of Loan  Rates or  APR's borne  by  the Loans,  (viii) the
maximum and minimum per annum Loan Rates, and (ix) the geographical  location
of the Loans.   If specific information respecting the Loans  is not known to
Provident  at the  time the  related Securities  are initially  offered, more
general information  of the nature  described above  will be provided  in the
related Prospectus Supplement, and specific  information will be set forth in
the Detailed Description.

   
     Generally, the "Loan-to-Value Ratio" of a Loan at any given time  is the
fraction, expressed as  a percentage, the numerator of which  is the original
principal balance  of the related  Loan and the  denominator of which  is the
Collateral Value of the related  Property.  Generally, the "Combined Loan-to-
Value Ratio"  of  a Loan  at any  given time  is  the ratio,  expressed as  a
percentage, of (i)  the sum of (a) the original principal balance of the Loan
(or, in the case of a Revolving Credit  Line Loan, the maximum amount thereof
available)  and  (b)  the  outstanding  principal  balance  at  the  date  of
origination of the Loan of any senior mortgage loan(s) or, in the case of any
open-ended senior  mortgage loan, the  maximum available line of  credit with
respect  to such  mortgage loan,  regardless  of any  lesser amount  actually
outstanding at the  date of origination of  the Loan, to (ii)  the Collateral
Value of the related Property.  The "Collateral Value" of the Property, other
than  with  respect to  certain  Loans the  proceeds  of which  were  used to
refinance an existing mortgage loan (each, a "Refinance Loan"), is the lesser
of (a) the appraised value determined in an appraisal obtained at origination
of  such Loan  and (b) the  sales price  for such Property.   In  the case of
Refinance  Loans, the  "Collateral  Value"  of the  related  Property is  the
appraised value  thereof determined in an  appraisal obtained at the  time of
refinancing.
    

     No assurance can be given that values of the Properties have remained or
will remain at their levels on the dates of origination of the related Loans.
If the residential real estate market should experience an overall decline in
property values such  that the sum of  the outstanding principal balances  of
the  Loans and  any  primary or  secondary  financing on  the Properties,  as
applicable, in a particular Pool become equal to or greater than the value of
the Properties,  the actual rates  of delinquencies, foreclosures  and losses
could be higher than  those now generally experienced in the mortgage lending
industry.  In addition, adverse  economic conditions and other factors (which
may or may not affect real property  values) may affect the timely payment by
borrowers of  scheduled payments of principal and  interest on the Loans and,
accordingly, the actual rates of  delinquencies, foreclosures and losses with
respect to any  Pool.   To the  extent that such  losses are  not covered  by
subordination provisions  or alternative  arrangements, such  losses will  be
borne, at  least in part,  by the holders  of the  Securities of the  related
Series.

SUBSTITUTION OF TRUST FUND ASSETS

     Substitution of  Trust Fund  Assets will  be permitted  in the  event of
breaches of representations and warranties with respect to any original Trust
Fund Asset or in  the event the documentation with respect to  any Trust Fund
Asset is determined by the Trustee to be incomplete.  The period during which
such  substitution will  be  permitted  generally will  be  indicated in  the
related Prospectus Supplement.  

                               USE OF PROCEEDS

     The net  proceeds to be received from the sale of the Securities will be
applied by Provident to the purchase of Trust Fund Assets  or will be used by
Provident  for  general  corporate  purposes.    Provident  expects  to  sell
Securities  in  Series  from time  to  time,  but the  timing  and  amount of
offerings of  Securities will depend  on a number  of factors, including  the
volume of Trust  Fund Assets originated or acquired  by Provident, prevailing
interest rates, availability of funds and general market conditions.


   
                              THE PROVIDENT BANK
    

     Provident,  an  Ohio  banking  corporation,  is  the  principal  banking
subsidiary  of Provident  Bancorp,  Inc.,  a  Cincinnati-based  bank  holding
company registered  under the Bank  Holding Company Act.   Provident Bancorp,
Inc.  operates throughout Ohio,  Northern Kentucky, Southeastern  Indiana and
Florida.   The principal executive  offices of Provident  are located at  One
East Fourth Street, Cincinnati, Ohio 45202 (Telephone: (513) 579-2000).

     Neither  Provident nor  any  of Provident's  affiliates  will insure  or
guarantee distributions on the Securities of any Series.


                                 LOAN PROGRAM

   
     The Loans  will have been  originated or purchased by  Provident, either
directly or  through affiliates.    The Loans  so originated  or acquired  by
Provident  will  have been  originated  in accordance  with  the underwriting
criteria  specified below  under  "Underwriting  Standards"  and  as  further
described in the related Prospectus Supplement.
    

UNDERWRITING STANDARDS

   
     Underwriting standards  are applied  by  or on  behalf  of a  lender  to
evaluate the borrower's credit standing  and repayment ability, and the value
and  adequacy  of  the  related  Property  as  collateral.    In  general,  a
prospective borrower applying for  a Loan is required to fill  out a detailed
application designed to provide to  the underwriting officer pertinent credit
information, including the principal balance and payment history with respect
to any senior mortgage, if any, which will be verified by Provident.  As part
of  the  description of  the  borrower's  financial condition,  the  borrower
generally is required to provide a current list of assets and liabilities and
a statement of income and expenses, as  well as an authorization to apply for
a credit  report which  summarizes the borrower's  credit history  with local
merchants  and lenders  and any  record  of bankruptcy.   In  most  cases, an
employment verification is obtained from an independent source (typically the
borrower's  employer) which  verification reports,  among  other things,  the
length  of  employment with  that  organization  and  the borrower's  current
salary.   If  a prospective borrower  is self-employed,  the borrower  may be
required to submit  copies of signed tax  returns.  The borrower may  also be
required  to authorize  verification of  deposits  at financial  institutions
where the borrower has demand or savings accounts.
    

     In determining the adequacy of the property to be used as collateral, an
appraisal will generally  be made of each property  considered for financing.
The appraiser is generally required  to inspect the property, issue  a report
on its condition and, if  applicable, verify construction has been completed.
The appraisal is based on the market value of comparable homes, the estimated
rental  income (if considered  applicable by the  appraiser) and  the cost of
replacing  the  property.   The  value of  the  property  being financed,  as
indicated by the appraisal,  must be such that it currently  supports, and is
anticipated to support in the future, the outstanding loan balance.

     The maximum  loan amount  will vary depending  upon a  borrower's credit
grade and loan program but will not generally exceed $750,000.  Variations in
maximum loan amount  limits will be permitted based  on compensating factors.
Compensating factors  may generally include,  to the extent specified  in the
related Prospectus  Supplement, low  loan-to-value ratio,  low debt-to-income
ratio,  stable employment,  favorable credit  history and  the nature  of the
underlying first mortgage loan, if applicable.

     Provident's underwriting standards generally permit  loans with loan-to-
value ratios at origination of up to 100% depending on the loan program, type
and use of the property,  creditworthiness of the borrower and debt-to-income
ratio.  

     After  obtaining   all  applicable   employment,  credit   and  property
information,  Provident  will  use  a  debt-to-income  ratio   to  assist  in
determining  whether the prospective  borrower has sufficient  monthly income
available to support  the payments of principal and interest  on the Mortgage
Loan in  addition to other  monthly credit obligations.   The "debt-to-income
ratio"  is the  ratio  of  the borrower's  total  monthly obligations  (which
includes  principal and  interest  on each  mortgage, tax  assessments, other
loans,   charge  accounts  and  all  other  scheduled  indebtedness)  to  the
borrower's gross monthly  income.  The  maximum monthly debt-to-income  ratio
will vary depending  upon a borrower's credit grade and loan program but will
not generally  exceed 60%.   Variations in  the monthly  debt-to-income ratio
limit will be permitted based on compensating factors to the extent specified
in the related Prospectus Supplement.

     If  specified in  the related  Prospectus Supplement,  a portion  of the
Loans in a  Trust Fund may have been originated under a limited documentation
program.   Under a limited documentation program,  more emphasis is placed on
the value  and adequacy on the property as collateral and other assets of the
borrower than on credit underwriting.  Under a limited documentation program,
certain  credit  underwriting  documentation   concerning  income  or  income
verification and/or employment verification is waived.

   
     In  the case of a Loan secured by a leasehold interest in real property,
the title to which is held by  a third party lessor, Provident will represent
and warrant, among other things, that the remaining term of the lease and any
sublease is at least five years longer than the remaining term on the Loan.
    

     Certain of the types of Loans  that may be included in a Trust  Fund are
recently developed and  may involve additional  uncertainties not present  in
traditional types of loans.  For  example, certain of such Loans may  provide
for escalating or  variable payments by the  borrower.  These types  of Loans
are underwritten  on the  basis of  a judgment  that the  borrowers have  the
ability to make the monthly payments required initially.  In some  instances,
a borrower's income may not  be sufficient to permit continued  Loan payments
as such payments  increase.  These  types of Loans  may also be  underwritten
primarily upon  the basis of  Loan-to-Value Ratios or other  favorable credit
factors.

QUALIFICATIONS OF PROVIDENT

   
     Provident  will be  required to  satisfy  the following  qualifications.
Provident is,  and  each entity  from which  it acquires  Loans  must be,  an
institution  experienced  in originating  and  servicing  loans of  the  type
contained  in the  related Pool  in  accordance with  accepted practices  and
prudent  guidelines, and must  maintain satisfactory facilities  to originate
and service  those loans.   Provident  is a  seller/servicer approved by  the
Federal  National Mortgage  Association ("FNMA")  and the  Federal  Home Loan
Mortgage Corporation  ("FHLMC").   Provident is a  mortgagee approved  by the
Federal Housing Authority and is an institution the deposit accounts in which
are insured by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation ("FDIC").
    

REPRESENTATIONS BY PROVIDENT; REPURCHASES

   
     Provident will  have made representations  and warranties in  respect of
the  Loans sold by  Provident to the  Trust Fund and  evidenced by  all, or a
part,  of a  Series of Securities.   Such representations  and warranties may
include,  among other  things: (i) that  title insurance  (or in the  case of
Properties located in areas where  such policies are generally not available,
an attorney's certificate of title)  and any required hazard insurance policy
were  effective  at  origination  of  each  Loan  and  that  each policy  (or
certificate of  title  as  applicable) remained  in  effect on  the  date  of
purchase of the  Loan from Provident; (ii)  that Provident had good  title to
each  such  Loan  and  such  Loan   was  subject  to  no  offsets,  defenses,
counterclaims or rights of  rescission except to the extent that  any buydown
agreement may  forgive certain  indebtedness of a  borrower; (iii)  that each
Loan  constituted a  valid lien  on,  or a  perfected security  interest with
respect to,  the Property  (subject only to  permissible liens  disclosed, if
applicable,  title insurance  exceptions, if  applicable,  and certain  other
exceptions described  in the  Agreement), (iv) the  Property is  undamaged by
waste, fire, earthquake,  earth movement, windstorm, flood,  tornado or other
casualty, so as to affect adversely the value of the Property; (v) that there
were no delinquent tax or assessment liens against the Property; (vi) that no
required  payment on  a Loan  was  delinquent more  than the  number  of days
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement;  and (vii) that each Loan was
made in compliance with,  and is enforceable under, all applicable  state and
federal laws and regulations in all material respects.

     The Master Servicer or the Trustee will promptly notify Provident of any
breach of any  representation or  warranty made by  it in respect  of a  Loan
which materially and adversely  affects the interests of  the Securityholders
in  such  Loan.    Unless  otherwise  specified  in  the  related  Prospectus
Supplement, if Provident  cannot cure such  breach within the number  of days
specified  in the  related Prospectus  Supplement following  notice  from the
Master Servicer or  the Trustee, as the  case may be, then  Provident will be
obligated either  (i) to repurchase such Loan from the  Trust Fund at a price
(the "Purchase Price") equal to 100% of  the unpaid principal balance thereof
as of the date of the  repurchase plus accrued interest thereon to  the first
day of the month following the month of repurchase at the Loan Rate (less any
Advances or amount payable as  related servicing compensation if Provident is
the Master Servicer) or (ii) substitute for such Loan a replacement loan that
satisfies the criteria specified in the  related Prospectus Supplement.  If a
REMIC  election  is to  be made  with  respect to  a  Trust Fund,  the Master
Servicer or a  holder of the  related residual certificate generally  will be
obligated to pay any prohibited transaction tax which may arise in connection
with any such repurchase or substitution and the Trustee must have received a
satisfactory opinion of counsel that such repurchase or substitution will not
cause the Trust Fund  to lose its status as a REMIC  or otherwise subject the
Trust Fund to a prohibited transaction tax.  This  repurchase or substitution
obligation will constitute the sole remedy available to holders of Securities
or the Trustee for a breach of representation by Provident.
    

     Neither the Trustee nor the  Master Servicer (unless the Master Servicer
is Provident) will be obligated to purchase or substitute a Loan if Provident
defaults  on its  obligation to do  so, and  no assurance  can be  given that
Provident   will  carry  out   its  respective  repurchase   or  substitution
obligations with respect to Loans.


                        DESCRIPTION OF THE SECURITIES

     Each  Series  of  Certificates  will  be  issued  pursuant  to  separate
agreements (each, a "Pooling and Servicing Agreement" or a "Trust Agreement")
among Provident, the Master  Servicer and the Trustee.  A form of Pooling and
Servicing Agreement and Trust Agreement has  been filed as an exhibit to  the
Registration Statement of which this Prospectus forms a part.  Each Series of
Notes will be issued  pursuant to an indenture (the  "Indenture") between the
related Trust Fund  and the entity named in the related Prospectus Supplement
as trustee (the "Trustee") with respect to such Series, and the related Loans
will  be  serviced by  the  Master Servicer  pursuant to  a  Master Servicing
Agreement.  A form of Indenture and Master Servicing Agreement has been filed
as an exhibit to the Registration Statement of which this Prospectus  forms a
part.  

     A Series of Securities may consist of both Notes and Certificates.  Each
Agreement, dated as of the related Cut-Off Date, will be among Provident, the
Master  Servicer and  the  Trustee for  the  benefit of  the  holders of  the
Securities  of such  Series.   The  provisions  of each  Agreement  will vary
depending upon the nature  of the Securities to be issued  thereunder and the
nature  of the  related Trust Fund.   The  following are descriptions  of the
material provisions which may appear in each Agreement.  The descriptions are
subject to, and are qualified in  their entirety by reference to, all of  the
provisions of the Agreement for each Series of Securities and the  applicable
Prospectus  Supplement.   Provident  will  provide a  copy  of the  Agreement
(without exhibits) relating  to any Series of Securities  without charge upon
written request of a holder of record of a Security  of such Series addressed
to  The Provident  Bank,  One  East Fourth  Street,  Cincinnati, Ohio  45202,
Attention: Secretary.

GENERAL

   
     As described  in the  related Prospectus  Supplement, the  Securities of
each  Series will be  issued in book-entry  or fully registered  form, in the
authorized denominations  specified  in the  related  Prospectus  Supplement,
will, in  the case of  Certificates, evidence specified  beneficial ownership
interests in,  and in the  case of Notes,  be secured  by, the assets  of the
related  Trust Fund  created  pursuant  to each  Agreement  and  will not  be
entitled to  payments in respect  of the assets  included in any  other Trust
Fund established  by Provident.   Unless otherwise  specified in  the related
Prospectus  Supplement,  the  Securities will  not  represent  obligations of
Provident  or any  affiliate  of Provident.    Certain of  the  Loans may  be
guaranteed  or insured  as set  forth in  the related  Prospectus Supplement.
Each  Trust  Fund will  consist of,  to  the extent  provided in  the related
Agreement, (i) the Trust Fund Assets, as from time to time are subject to the
related  Agreement  (exclusive  of  any  amounts  specified  in  the  related
Prospectus  Supplement  ("Retained  Interest")),  including all  payments  of
interest  and principal received with respect to  the Loans after the Cut-Off
Date (to the  extent not applied in  computing the principal balance  of such
Loans  as of the  Cut-Off Date (the "Cut-Off  Date Principal Balance")); (ii)
such assets as from time to time are required to  be deposited in the related
Security  Account,  as  described below  under  "The  Agreements--Payments on
Loans; Deposits to Security Account"; (iii) property which secured a Loan and
which is acquired  on behalf of the Securityholders by foreclosure or deed in
lieu of foreclosure and (iv) any insurance policies or other forms  of credit
enhancement required to be maintained pursuant to the related  Agreement.  If
so specified  in the  related Prospectus Supplement,  a Trust  Fund may  also
include one  or more  of  the following:    reinvestment income  on  payments
received  on  the  Trust Fund  Assets,  a  Reserve Account,  a  mortgage pool
insurance policy, a  special hazard insurance policy, a  bankruptcy bond, one
or more letters of credit, a surety bond, guaranties or similar instruments.
    

     Each Series of Securities will be  issued in one or more classes.   Each
class of  Certificates of  a Series will  evidence beneficial ownership  of a
specified percentage (which may be 0%) or portion of future interest payments
and a specified percentage (which may  be 0%) or portion of future  principal
payments on,  and each class  of Notes  of a Series  will be secured  by, the
related Trust  Fund Assets.  A  Series of Securities may include  one or more
classes that are senior  in right to payment to one or  more other classes of
Securities of such  Series.  Certain Series  or classes of Securities  may be
covered  by  insurance  policies,  surety  bonds or  other  forms  of  credit
enhancement, in each case as  described under "Credit Enhancement" herein and
in the related Prospectus Supplement.  One or more classes of Securities of a
Series may be entitled to receive distributions of principal, interest or any
combination thereof.   Distributions on  one or more  classes of a  Series of
Securities  may  be  made prior  to  one  or more  other  classes,  after the
occurrence of specified events,  in accordance with a schedule or  formula or
on the  basis of collections  from designated portions  of the  related Trust
Fund Assets, in each case as specified in the related Prospectus  Supplement.
The timing and amounts  of such distributions may vary among  classes or over
time as specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.

     Distributions  of principal  and  interest  (or,  where  applicable,  of
principal only or  interest only) on the  related Securities will be  made by
the  Trustee  on each  Distribution  Date  (i.e., monthly,  quarterly,  semi-
annually or at such other intervals and on the dates as are  specified in the
related Prospectus Supplement) in proportion to the percentages  specified in
the related Prospectus Supplement.  Distributions will be made to the persons
in whose names  the Securities are registered at the close of business on the
dates specified in the related Prospectus Supplement (each, a "Record Date").
Distributions will  be made in the manner specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement to the persons  entitled thereto at the  address appearing in  the
register maintained  for Securityholders (the "Security Register"); provided,
however, that the final distribution in retirement of  the Securities will be
made only upon presentation and surrender of  the Securities at the office or
agency  of  the  Trustee   or  other  person  specified  in   the  notice  to
Securityholders of such final distribution.

     The  Securities will  be  freely transferable  and  exchangeable at  the
Corporate Trust Office of the Trustee as set forth in the  related Prospectus
Supplement.  No service charge will be  made for any registration of exchange
or transfer of  Securities of any Series, but the Trustee may require payment
of a sum sufficient to cover any related tax or other governmental charge.

     As  to each Series, an  election may be made  to treat the related Trust
Fund or  designated portions  thereof as a  "real estate  mortgage investment
conduit" or "REMIC" as  defined in the Code.  The  related Prospectus Supple-
ment will specify whether a REMIC election is to be made.  Alternatively, the
Agreement for a Series of Securities may provide that a REMIC election may be
made at the discretion  of Provident or the  Master Servicer and may only  be
made if certain conditions are satisfied.   As to any such Series,  the terms
and provisions applicable to the making of a REMIC election will be set forth
in the  related Prospectus  Supplement.   If such  an election  is made  with
respect  to a Series of Securities, one of  the classes will be designated as
evidencing the  sole class of "residual  interests" in the related  REMIC, as
defined in the Code.   All other classes of Securities in  such a Series will
constitute "regular interests" in the related REMIC, as defined in  the Code.
As to  each Series of Securities with respect to which a REMIC election is to
be made, the Master Servicer, the Trustee or a holder of the related residual
certificate will be obligated to take all actions required in order to comply
with applicable laws and regulations.

DISTRIBUTIONS ON SECURITIES

     General.    In  general,  the   method  of  determining  the  amount  of
distributions on a particular Series of Securities will depend on the type of
credit  support, if  any, that  is used  with respect  to such  Series.   See
"Credit Enhancement".   Set forth  below are descriptions of  various methods
that may be used to determine  the amount of distributions on the  Securities
of  a  particular Series.    The  Prospectus Supplement  for  each Series  of
Securities will describe the  method to be used in determining  the amount of
distributions on the Securities of such Series.

     Distributions allocable to principal and interest on the Securities will
be made  by the  Trustee out  of, and  only to the  extent of,  funds in  the
related  Security Account, including  any funds transferred  from any Reserve
Account.    As  between  Securities  of  different  classes  and  as  between
distributions  of principal  (and, if  applicable,  between distributions  of
Principal Prepayments, as defined below, and scheduled payments of principal)
and  interest, distributions made on any Distribution Date will be applied as
specified in  the related Prospectus  Supplement.  The  Prospectus Supplement
will also describe  the method for allocating  distributions among Securities
of a particular class.

     Available Funds.  All distributions on the Securities of each Series  on
each Distribution Date will be made from the Available Funds described below,
in accordance with  the terms described in the  related Prospectus Supplement
and specified in the Agreement.  "Available Funds" for each Distribution Date
will generally equal the amount on deposit in the related Security Account on
such Distribution  Date (net  of  related fees  and expenses  payable by  the
related Trust Fund) other than amounts to be held therein for distribution on
future Distribution Dates.

     Distributions  of  Interest.   Interest  will  accrue  on the  aggregate
principal  balance of the Securities (or,  in the case of Securities entitled
only to distributions  allocable to interest, the  aggregate notional amount)
of  each class  of  Securities  (the "Class  Security  Balance") entitled  to
interest  from  the  date, at  the  Pass-Through  Rate or  interest  rate, as
applicable  (which in either case may  be a fixed rate  or rate adjustable as
specified in  such Prospectus Supplement),  and for the periods  specified in
such  Prospectus Supplement.   To  the extent  funds are  available therefor,
interest  accrued  during  each  such  specified  period  on  each  class  of
Securities  entitled to  interest  (other  than a  class  of Securities  that
provides for interest that accrues, but is not currently payable, referred to
hereafter as "Accrual Securities") will  be distributable on the Distribution
Dates specified  in  the related  Prospectus Supplement  until the  aggregate
Class Security Balance  of the Securities of such  class has been distributed
in  full  or,  in  the case  of  Securities  entitled  only to  distributions
allocable to interest, until the aggregate notional amount of such Securities
is reduced  to zero  or for  the  period of  time designated  in the  related
Prospectus Supplement.  The original  Class Security Balance of each Security
will equal the  aggregate distributions allocable to principal  to which such
Security is entitled.   Distributions allocable to interest  on each Security
that  is  not  entitled  to  distributions allocable  to  principal  will  be
calculated  based on  the notional  amount of  such Security.   The  notional
amount of  a Security  will not  evidence an  interest in  or entitlement  to
distributions allocable to principal but  will be used solely for convenience
in expressing the calculation of interest and for certain other purposes.

     Interest payable on the  Securities of a Series  on a Distribution  Date
will include all interest accrued during  the period specified in the related
Prospectus  Supplement.  In  the event interest accrues  over a period ending
two  or more  days  prior to  a  Distribution Date,  the  effective yield  to
Securityholders  will be  reduced  from  the yield  that  would otherwise  be
obtainable if interest payable on the Security were to accrue through the day
immediately preceding  such Distribution  Date, and  the effective  yield (at
par) to Securityholders will be less than the indicated coupon rate.

     With  respect to any  class of Accrual  Securities, if specified  in the
related Prospectus  Supplement, any interest that has accrued but is not paid
on a given  Distribution Date will be  added to the aggregate  Class Security
Balance of such class of Securities on that Distribution Date.  Distributions
of interest  on any class of Accrual Securities  will commence only after the
occurrence of  the events specified in such  Prospectus Supplement.  Prior to
such time,  the  beneficial  ownership interest  in  the Trust  Fund  or  the
principal balance,  as applicable,  of such class  of Accrued  Securities, as
reflected in  the aggregate Class Security  Balance of such class  of Accrual
Securities, will increase on each Distribution Date by the amount of interest
that  accrued  on such  class  of  Accrual  Securities during  the  preceding
interest accrual period but  that was not required to be  distributed to such
class on such Distribution Date.   Any such class of Accrual Securities  will
thereafter accrue  interest on its  outstanding Class Security Balance  as so
adjusted.

   
     Distributions  of Principal.   The  related  Prospectus Supplement  will
specify the method by which the amount  of principal to be distributed on the
Securities on  each Distribution  Date will be  calculated and the  manner in
which such amount will be allocated  among the classes of Securities entitled
to distributions of principal.   The aggregate Class Security Balance  of any
class of Securities entitled to  distributions of principal generally will be
the aggregate  original Class  Security Balance of  such class  of Securities
specified  in  such  Prospectus  Supplement,  reduced  by  all  distributions
reported to the holders of such Securities as allocable to principal and, (i)
in the  case of Accrual  Securities, as  described in the  related Prospectus
Supplement, increased by interest accrued  but not then distributable on such
Accrual  Securities and  (ii)  in  the case  of  adjustable rate  Securities,
subject to the effect of negative amortization, if applicable.  
    

     If so provided in the related Prospectus Supplement, one or more classes
of  Securities  will  be  entitled  to  receive  all  or  a  disproportionate
percentage of the payments of principal which are received  from borrowers in
advance  of their  scheduled due  dates  and are  not accompanied  by amounts
representing  scheduled  interest  due  after  the  month  of  such  payments
("Principal Prepayments")  in the percentages and under  the circumstances or
for the periods specified in such Prospectus Supplement.  Any such allocation
of Principal Prepayments to such class or classes of Securities will have the
effect of accelerating the  amortization of such Securities  while increasing
the interests  evidenced by one  or more other  classes of Securities  in the
Trust  Fund.   Increasing the  interests of  the other classes  of Securities
relative  to  that  of  certain   Securities  is  intended  to  preserve  the
availability of  the subordination  provided by such  other Securities.   See
"Credit Enhancement--Subordination".

     Unscheduled  Distributions.    If specified  in  the  related Prospectus
Supplement, the Securities will be subject to receipt of distributions before
the  next scheduled  Distribution Date  under  the circumstances  and in  the
manner described below and in such Prospectus Supplement.  If applicable, the
Trustee will be  required to make  such unscheduled distributions on  the day
and in the amount  specified in the related Prospectus Supplement  if, due to
substantial  payments of principal  (including Principal Prepayments)  on the
Trust Fund  Assets, the Trustee  or the  Master Servicer determines  that the
funds available or anticipated to be available from the Security Account and,
if  applicable, any  Reserve Account,  may be  insufficient to  make required
distributions on the Securities on  such Distribution Date.  Unless otherwise
specified  in the  related  Prospectus  Supplement, the  amount  of any  such
unscheduled distribution that  is allocable to principal will  not exceed the
amount that would otherwise have been required to be distributed as principal
on the Securities on the next Distribution Date.   Unless otherwise specified
in  the related  Prospectus Supplement,  the  unscheduled distributions  will
include interest  at the  applicable Pass-Through Rate  (if any)  or interest
rate  (if any)  on the  amount of  the unscheduled distribution  allocable to
principal  for the  period  and  to the  date  specified  in such  Prospectus
Supplement.

ADVANCES

     To the extent provided in  the related Prospectus Supplement, the Master
Servicer will  be required  to advance  on or  before each  Distribution Date
(from  its own funds,  funds advanced by  Sub-Servicers or funds  held in the
Security Account for future distributions to the holders of Securities of the
related  Series) an  amount equal  to the aggregate  of payments  of interest
and/or principal that  were delinquent on the related  Determination Date (as
such  term is  defined in  the related  Prospectus Supplement)  and were  not
advanced by  any Sub-Servicer, subject to the Master Servicer's determination
that such  advances may be  recoverable out  of late  payments by  borrowers,
Liquidation Proceeds, Insurance Proceeds or otherwise.

     In  making Advances,  the Master  Servicer will  endeavor to  maintain a
regular flow of scheduled interest and principal payments to Securityholders,
rather than to guarantee or insure  against losses.  If Advances are  made by
the  Master  Servicer  from  cash  being  held  for  future  distribution  to
Securityholders, the Master Servicer will replace such funds on or before any
future Distribution Date  to the extent that funds in the applicable Security
Account on  such Distribution Date would be less  than the amount required to
be available for distributions  to Securityholders on such date.   Any Master
Servicer funds  advanced will be  reimbursable to the Master  Servicer out of
recoveries  on the specific  Loans with respect  to which such  Advances were
made (e.g., late payments made by the related borrower, any related Insurance
Proceeds, Liquidation Proceeds or proceeds of any Loan purchased by Provident
or a Sub-Servicer pursuant to the related Agreement).  Advances by the Master
Servicer  (and any advances  by a Sub-Servicer) also  will be reimbursable to
the Master  Servicer (or Sub-Servicer)  from cash otherwise  distributable to
Securityholders (including  the holders of  Senior Securities) to  the extent
that the  Master Servicer determines  that any such Advances  previously made
are not ultimately recoverable as described above.  To the extent provided in
the related Prospectus Supplement, the Master Servicer also will be obligated
to  make Advances,  to  the  extent recoverable  out  of Insurance  Proceeds,
Liquidation Proceeds or otherwise, in  respect of certain taxes and insurance
premiums not paid  by borrowers  on a timely  basis.   Funds so advanced  are
reimbursable to the Master  Servicer to the extent  permitted by the  related
Agreement.  The  obligations of the Master  Servicer to make advances  may be
supported by a cash advance reserve fund, a surety bond or  other arrangement
of  the type  described herein under  "Credit Enhancement",  in each  case as
described in the related Prospectus Supplement.

   
     In the  event the  Master Servicer  or a  Sub-Servicer fails  to make  a
required Advance, the Trustee will be  obligated to make such Advance in  its
capacity as  successor servicer  if it is  acting in such  capacity.   If the
Trustee makes such an Advance, it will be entitled to be  reimbursed for such
Advance  to  the  same  extent  and  degree  as  the  Master  Servicer  or  a
Sub-Servicer is entitled to  be reimbursed for Advances.  See "Description of
the Securities--Distributions on Securities".
    

REPORTS TO SECURITYHOLDERS

     Prior to or concurrently with  each distribution on a Distribution Date,
the Master  Servicer or the  Trustee will  furnish to each  Securityholder of
record  of  the related  Series  a  statement setting  forth,  to  the extent
applicable to such Series of Securities, among other things:

          (i)  the  amount  of  such  distribution  allocable  to  principal,
     separately identifying the aggregate amount of any Principal Prepayments
     and,   if  so  specified  in  the  related  Prospectus  Supplement,  any
     applicable prepayment penalties included therein;

          (ii) the amount of such distribution allocable to interest;

          (iii)     the amount of any Advance;

          (iv) the  aggregate   amount  (a)   otherwise   allocable  to   the
     Subordinated  Securityholders  on   such  Distribution  Date,  and   (b)
     withdrawn from  the Reserve  Account, if  any, that is  included in  the
     amounts distributed to the Senior Securityholders;

          (v)  the outstanding principal  balance or notional amount  of each
     class of the  related Series of  Securities after giving  effect to  the
     distribution of principal on such Distribution Date;

          (vi) the percentage of  principal payments on the  Loans (excluding
     prepayments), if any, which each such class  will be entitled to receive
     on the following Distribution Date;

          (vii)     the  percentage of Principal Prepayments on the Loans, if
     any, which each such class will be entitled to receive on  the following
     Distribution Date;

          (viii)    the related amount of the servicing compensation retained
     or withdrawn from the  Security Account by the Master  Servicer, and the
     amount  of  additional  servicing compensation  received  by  the Master
     Servicer attributable  to penalties,  fees, excess  Liquidation Proceeds
     and other similar charges and items;

          (ix) the number  and aggregate  principal balances of  Loans as  to
     which the minimum  monthly payment is delinquent 30-59  days, 60-89 days
     and 90  or more days, respectively,  as of the close of  business on the
     last day of the calendar month preceding such Distribution Date;

          (x)  the book value of any real estate acquired through foreclosure
     or grant of a deed in lieu of foreclosure;

          (xi) the  Pass-Through Rate  or interest  rate,  as applicable,  if
     adjusted from the date of the last statement, of any such class expected
     to be applicable to the next distribution to such class;

          (xii)     if  applicable,  the  amount  remaining  in  any  Reserve
     Account at the close of business on the Distribution Date;

          (xiii)    the Pass-Through Rate or interest rate, as applicable, as
     of the day prior to the immediately preceding Distribution Date; and

          (xiv)     any  amounts  remaining  under letters  of  credit,  Pool
     policies or other forms of credit enhancement.

     Where  applicable, any  amount  set forth  above may  be expressed  as a
dollar amount per single Security of the relevant class having the Percentage
Interest  specified in  the related  Prospectus  Supplement.   The report  to
Securityholders for any Series of  Securities may include additional or other
information of a similar nature to that specified above.

     In addition, within  a reasonable period of  time after the end  of each
calendar year,  the  Master  Servicer  or  the  Trustee  will  mail  to  each
Securityholder of record at any time  during such calendar year a report  (a)
as to the  aggregate of amounts reported pursuant  to (i) and (ii)  above for
such calendar  year or,  in the  event such  person was  a Securityholder  of
record  only during  a  portion of  such  calendar year,  for the  applicable
portion of  such year  and (b)  such other  customary information  as may  be
deemed  necessary  or  desirable for  Securityholders  to  prepare their  tax
returns.

CATEGORIES OF CLASSES OF SECURITIES

     The Securities of  any Series may be  comprised of one or  more classes.
Such  classes, in  general, fall  into different  categories.   The following
chart  identifies  and   generally  defines  certain  of   the  more  typical
categories.    The Prospectus  Supplement  for  a  Series of  Securities  may
identify the classes which comprise such Series by reference to the following
categories:

CATEGORIES OF CLASSES              DEFINITION

                         PRINCIPAL TYPES

Accretion Directed       A  class that  receives principal payments  from the
                         accreted interest from  specified classes of Accrual
                         Securities.   An Accretion  Directed class also  may
                         receive principal  payments from  principal paid  on
                         the  underlying Trust  Fund Assets  for the  related
                         Series.

Component Securities     A  class consisting of "Components."  The Components
                         of  a  class   of  Component  Securities  may   have
                         different   principal   and/or    interest   payment
                         characteristics  but  together constitute  a  single
                         class.    Each  Component of  a  class  of Component
                         Securities  may be identified as falling into one or
                         more of the categories in this chart.

Notional Amount
  Securities             A  class  having  no principal  balance  and bearing
                         interest  on  the  related  notional  amount.    The
                         notional  amount   is  used  for  purposes   of  the
                         determination of interest distributions.

Planned Principal Class
  (also sometimes
  referred to as "PACs") A  class  that  is  designed  to  receive  principal
                         payments  using  a predetermined  principal  balance
                         schedule derived by assuming two constant prepayment
                         rates for the  underlying Trust Fund Assets.   These
                         two  rates are  the endpoints  for the  "structuring
                         range" for the Planned Principal Class.  The Planned
                         Principal Classes in any Series of Securities may be
                         subdivided into different  categories (e.g., Primary
                         Planned   Principal   Classes,   Secondary   Planned
                         Principal  Classes  and so  forth)  having different
                         effective structuring ranges and different principal
                         payment priorities.   The structuring range  for the
                         Secondary Planned  Principal Class  of  a Series  of
                         Securities  will  be  narrower  than  that  for  the
                         Primary Planned Principal Class of such Series.

Scheduled Principal 
   Class                 A  class  that  is  designed  to  receive  principal
                         payments  using  a predetermined  principal  balance
                         schedule  but  is   not  designated  as   a  Planned
                         Principal  Class  or Targeted  Principal Class.   In
                         many  cases, the schedule is derived by assuming two
                         constant prepayment  rates for the  underlying Trust
                         Fund Assets.  These two rates are  the endpoints for
                         the "structuring range" for  the Scheduled Principal
                         Class.

Sequential Pay           Classes  that  receive   principal  payments  in   a
                         prescribed sequence, that do not have  predetermined
                         principal  balance  schedules  and  that  under  all
                         circumstances   receive   payments    of   principal
                         continuously  from the  first  Distribution Date  on
                         which they receive principal until they are retired.
                         A  single  class  that  receives principal  payments
                         before or after all other classes in the same Series
                         of  Securities may be identified as a Sequential Pay
                         class.

Strip                    A  class  that  receives a  constant  proportion, or
                         "strip," of the principal payments on the underlying
                         Trust Fund Assets.

Support Class (also
  sometimes referred to
  as "Companion 
  Classes")              A  class  that  receives principal  payments  on any
                         Distribution Date  only if  scheduled payments  have
                         been  made on  specified Planned  Principal Classes,
                         Targeted   Principal   Classes    and/or   Scheduled
                         Principal Classes.

Targeted Principal Class
  (also sometimes
  referred to as 
  "TACs")                A  class  that  is  designed  to  receive  principal
                         payments  using  a predetermined  principal  balance
                         schedule  derived  by  assuming  a  single  constant
                         prepayment  rate  for  the   underlying  Trust  Fund
                         Assets.

                         INTEREST TYPES

Fixed Rate               A   class  with  an  interest  rate  that  is  fixed
                         throughout the life of the class.

Floating Rate            A   class   with  an   interest  rate   that  resets
                         periodically based  upon a designated index and that
                         varies directly with changes in such index.

Inverse Floating Rate    A   class  with   an   interest  rate   that  resets
                         periodically based upon a  designated index and that
                         varies inversely with changes in such index.

Variable Rate            A   class  with   an  interest   rate   that  resets
                         periodically  and is calculated  by reference to the
                         rate or  rates of  interest applicable  to specified
                         assets or instruments (e.g., the Loan Rates borne by
                         the underlying Loans).

Interest Only            A class  that receives some  or all of  the interest
                         payments made  on the  underlying Trust Fund  Assets
                         and little or  no principal.  Interest  Only Classes
                         have  either  a  nominal   principal  balance  or  a
                         notional  amount.     A  nominal  principal  balance
                         represents actual principal that will be paid on the
                         class.   It is  referred to as  nominal since  it is
                         extremely  small  compared  to  other  classes.    A
                         notional amount is the amount used as a reference to
                         calculate  the amount of interest due on an Interest
                         Only Class that is not entitled to any distributions
                         in respect of principal.

Principal Only           A class that does not  bear interest and is entitled
                         to  receive   only  distributions   in  respect   of
                         principal.

Partial Accrual          A class  that accretes  a portion  of the amount  of
                         accrued interest thereon, which amount will be added
                         to  the  principal  balance of  such  class  on each
                         applicable Distribution Date, with  the remainder of
                         such accrued interest to be distributed currently as
                         interest on such class.  Such accretion may continue
                         until a specified  event has occurred or  until such
                         Partial Accrual Class is retired.

Accrual                  A class that accretes the amount of accrued interest
                         otherwise distributable on such class, which  amount
                         will  be added as principal to the principal balance
                         of such class on each applicable Distribution  Date.
                         Such accretion  may  continue until  some specified
                         event has  occurred  or until such Accrual Class is 
                         retired.

BOOK-ENTRY REGISTRATION OF SECURITIES

     As  described in  the related  Prospectus Supplement,  if not  issued in
fully  registered  form, each  class  of  Securities  will be  registered  as
book-entry  certificates (the  "Book-Entry Securities").    Persons acquiring
beneficial ownership  interests in  the Securities  ("Security Owners")  will
hold  their Securities  through  DTC in  the  United States,  or  Cedel Bank,
soci t  anonyme ("CEDEL"), or  the Euroclear System ("Euroclear") in  Europe,
if they are participants of such systems, or indirectly through organizations
which are participants  in such systems.   The Book-Entry Securities will  be
issued  in one  or  more  certificates which  equal  the aggregate  principal
balance  of the Securities  and will initially  be registered in  the name of
Cede  & Co.,  the  nominee of  DTC.   CEDEL and  Euroclear will  hold omnibus
positions  on  behalf  of their  participants  through  customers' securities
accounts in  CEDEL's and Euroclear's names  on the books of  their respective
depositaries which in turn will  hold such positions in customers' securities
accounts in  the depositaries' names  on the books  of DTC.   Citibank, N.A.,
will  act as depositary  for CEDEL and  The Chase Manhattan Bank  will act as
depositary  for Euroclear  (in such  capacities,  individually the  "Relevant
Depositary"  and  collectively  the  "European  Depositaries").    Except  as
described   below,  no  person  acquiring  a  Book-Entry  Security  (each,  a
"beneficial owner")  will  be  entitled to  receive  a  physical  certificate
representing  such Security  (a  "Definitive Security").    Unless and  until
Definitive   Securities  are  issued,   it  is  anticipated   that  the  only
"Securityholder" of the  Securities will be  Cede & Co.,  as nominee of  DTC.
Security  Owners  are  only permitted  to  exercise  their  rights indirectly
through Participants and DTC.

     The beneficial  owner's  ownership  of  a Book-Entry  Security  will  be
recorded on the  records of the brokerage  firm, bank, thrift  institution or
other  financial  intermediary   (each,  a  "Financial   Intermediary")  that
maintains the beneficial  owner's account  for such  purpose.   In turn,  the
Financial  Intermediary's ownership  of  such  Book-Entry  Security  will  be
recorded on the records of DTC (or of a participating firm that acts as agent
for the  Financial Intermediary, whose interest  will in turn  be recorded on
the records of DTC, if the beneficial owner's Financial Intermediary is not a
DTC participant, and on the records of CEDEL or Euroclear, as appropriate).

     Security  Owners will  receive all  distributions  of principal  of, and
interest  on,   the  Securities  from   the  Trustee  through  DTC   and  DTC
participants.    While  the  Securities are  outstanding  (except  under  the
circumstances described below),  under the rules, regulations  and procedures
creating and affecting DTC and its operations  (the "Rules"), DTC is required
to make book-entry transfers among Participants on whose behalf  it acts with
respect  to  the   Securities  and  is  required  to   receive  and  transmit
distributions of principal of, and interest on, the Securities.  Participants
and indirect  participants  with  whom  Security Owners  have  accounts  with
respect to Securities are similarly required to make book-entry transfers and
receive  and  transmit such  distributions  on  behalf  of  their  respective
Security  Owners.   Accordingly, although  Security Owners  will not  possess
certificates, the  Rules provide  a mechanism by  which Security  Owners will
receive distributions and will be able to transfer their interest.

     Security Owners will not receive  or be entitled to receive certificates
representing their  respective interests in the Securities,  except under the
limited  circumstances  described   below.    Unless  and   until  Definitive
Securities are issued, Security Owners  who are not Participants may transfer
ownership of Securities  only through Participants and  indirect participants
by  instructing such  Participants  and  indirect  participants  to  transfer
Securities,  by book-entry  transfer,  through  DTC for  the  account of  the
purchasers  of  such Securities,  which  account  is  maintained  with  their
respective Participants.  Under the Rules and in accordance with DTC's normal
procedures, transfers of ownership of Securities will be executed through DTC
and the accounts  of the respective Participants  at DTC will be  debited and
credited.   Similarly, the Participants  and indirect participants  will make
debits or  credits, as the  case may  be, on their  records on behalf  of the
selling and purchasing Security Owners.

     Because  of time  zone differences,  credits  of securities  received in
CEDEL or Euroclear as  a result of a  transaction with a Participant will  be
made  during  subsequent  securities  settlement  processing  and  dated  the
business  day following  the  DTC  settlement  date.   Such  credits  or  any
transactions  in such  securities  settled  during  such processing  will  be
reported to  the relevant  Euroclear or CEDEL  Participants on  such business
day.  Cash received in CEDEL or Euroclear as a result of sales of  securities
by  or  through  a  CEDEL   Participant  (as  defined  herein)  or  Euroclear
Participant (as  defined herein) to  a DTC Participant will  be received with
value on the DTC settlement  date but will be available in the relevant CEDEL
or Euroclear  cash account only as  of the business  day following settlement
with DTC.  

     Transfers between Participants will occur in accordance with DTC  rules.
Transfers between CEDEL Participants and Euroclear Participants will occur in
accordance with their respective rules and operating procedures.

     Cross-market  transfers between persons  holding directly  or indirectly
through  DTC,  on the  one  hand, and  directly or  indirectly  through CEDEL
Participants or Euroclear Participants, on the other, will be effected in DTC
in accordance with DTC rules on behalf of the relevant European international
clearing  system by  the  Relevant  Depositary;  however,  such  cross-market
transactions will  require delivery of instructions to  the relevant European
international  clearing   system  by  the  counterparty  in  such  system  in
accordance with its rules and procedures and within its established deadlines
(European time).  The  relevant European international clearing  system will,
if the transaction meets its settlement requirements, deliver instructions to
the  Relevant Depositary  to take  action to  effect final settlement  on its
behalf by delivering or receiving securities  in DTC, and making or receiving
payment in  accordance with normal  procedures for same day  funds settlement
applicable to  DTC.   CEDEL Participants and  Euroclear Participants  may not
deliver instructions directly to the European Depositaries.

     CEDEL is  incorporated under  the laws of  Luxembourg as  a professional
depository.    CEDEL  holds securities  for  its  participating organizations
("CEDEL  Participants") and  facilitates  the  clearance  and  settlement  of
securities  transactions   between  CEDEL  Participants   through  electronic
book-entry changes in accounts of CEDEL Participants, thereby eliminating the
need for physical movement of certificates.   Transactions may be settled  in
CEDEL  in any  of  28 currencies,  including United  States  dollars.   CEDEL
provides  to  its  CEDEL  Participants,  among  other  things,  services  for
safekeeping, administration,  clearance  and  settlement  of  internationally
traded securities  and securities  lending and  borrowing.   CEDEL interfaces
with domestic  markets in several  countries.  As a  professional depository,
CEDEL  is subject to regulation by the  Luxembourg Monetary Institute.  CEDEL
participants   are  recognized  financial   institutions  around  the  world,
including  underwriters,   securities  brokers  and  dealers,   banks,  trust
companies, clearing corporations  and certain other organizations.   Indirect
access to CEDEL is also available to others, such as banks,  brokers, dealers
and trust companies  that clear through or maintain  a custodial relationship
with a CEDEL Participant, either directly or indirectly.

     Euroclear was  created in 1968  to hold securities for  its participants
("Euroclear  Participants")  and  to clear  and  settle  transactions between
Euroclear  Participants through  simultaneous electronic  book-entry delivery
against  payment,  thereby  eliminating the  need  for  physical movement  of
certificates and any  risk from lack of simultaneous  transfers of securities
and  cash.  Transactions  may be settled  in any of  32 currencies, including
United States dollars.   Euroclear includes various other services, including
securities  lending and  borrowing and  interfaces with  domestic markets  in
several  countries generally  similar to  the  arrangements for  cross-market
transfers with DTC  described above.  Euroclear is operated  by the Brussels,
Belgium office of  Morgan Guaranty Trust Company of New York ("Morgan" and in
such  capacity,  the  "Euroclear Operator"),  under  contract  with Euroclear
Clearance  Systems  S.C.,  a Belgian  cooperative  corporation  (the "Belgian
Cooperative").   All operations  are conducted by  Morgan, and  all Euroclear
securities clearance accounts  and Euroclear cash accounts are  accounts with
the Euroclear Operator, not the Belgian Cooperative.  The Belgian Cooperative
establishes  policy  for  Euroclear  on  behalf  of  Euroclear  Participants.
Euroclear  Participants include banks  (including central  banks), securities
brokers  and   dealers  and  other  professional   financial  intermediaries.
Indirect  access to  Euroclear is  also available  to other firms  that clear
through or  maintain a custodial  relationship with a  Euroclear Participant,
either directly or indirectly.

     Morgan is the Belgian branch of a New York banking corporation  which is
a member  bank of the Federal Reserve  System.  As such, it  is regulated and
examined by  the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System and the New
York State Banking Department, as well as the Belgian Banking Commission.

     Securities clearance accounts and cash accounts with Morgan are governed
by  the Terms  and  Conditions Governing  Use  of Euroclear  and  the related
Operating  Procedures  of the  Euroclear  System and  applicable  Belgian law
(collectively, the "Terms and Conditions").   The Terms and Conditions govern
transfers  of securities and cash within Euroclear, withdrawals of securities
and cash from Euroclear, and receipts of payments with  respect to securities
in Euroclear.   All  securities in  Euroclear are  held on  a fungible  basis
without attribution of specific certificates to specific securities clearance
accounts.  The Euroclear Operator acts under the Terms and Conditions only on
behalf of Euroclear  Participants, and has no record of  or relationship with
persons holding through Euroclear Participants.

     Under  a  book-entry   format,  beneficial  owners  of   the  Book-Entry
Securities may experience some delay in their receipt of payments, since such
payments  will be forwarded by the Trustee to  Cede & Co., as nominee of DTC.
Distributions with respect to Securities held through CEDEL or Euroclear will
be  credited  to  the  cash  accounts  of  CEDEL  Participants  or  Euroclear
Participants in  accordance with the relevant system's  rules and procedures,
to the extent received by  the Relevant Depositary.  Such  distributions will
be subject to  tax reporting  in accordance with  relevant United States  tax
laws and regulations.  See "Federal Income Tax Consequences -Tax Treatment of
Foreign Investors"  and "--Tax Consequences  to Holders of  the Notes--Backup
Withholding"  herein.   Because  DTC  can only  act  on  behalf of  Financial
Intermediaries, the  ability  of  a beneficial  owner  to  pledge  Book-Entry
Securities to persons or entities that  do not participate in the  Depository
system may  be limited  due to  the lack  of physical  certificates for  such
Book-Entry Securities.  In addition, issuance of the Book-Entry Securities in
book-entry form may reduce the liquidity of such Securities  in the secondary
market  since  certain  potential  investors may  be  unwilling  to  purchase
Securities for which they cannot obtain physical certificates.

     Monthly and annual  reports on the Trust will be provided to Cede & Co.,
as nominee  of DTC, and  may be  made available by  Cede & Co.  to beneficial
owners upon request, in accordance with the rules, regulations and procedures
creating and affecting the Depository, and to the Financial Intermediaries to
whose DTC  accounts the Book-Entry  Securities of such beneficial  owners are
credited.

     DTC has advised the Trustee that, unless and until Definitive Securities
are issued, DTC will take any action permitted  to be taken by the holders of
the  Book-Entry  Securities  under  the  applicable  Agreement  only  at  the
direction  of one or more Financial Intermediaries  to whose DTC accounts the
Book-Entry Securities are credited, to the extent that such actions are taken
on  behalf of Financial Intermediaries whose holdings include such Book-Entry
Securities.   CEDEL or the Euroclear Operator, as  the case may be, will take
any  other  action  permitted to  be  taken  by  a Securityholder  under  the
Agreement on behalf of a CEDEL  Participant or Euroclear Participant only  in
accordance with its relevant rules and  procedures and subject to the ability
of the Relevant  Depositary to effect such actions on its behalf through DTC.
DTC may  take actions, at  the direction  of the  related Participants,  with
respect to some Securities which conflict with actions taken with respect  to
other Securities.

     Upon the  occurrence of any of  the events described in  the immediately
preceding paragraph,  the Trustee will  be required to notify  all beneficial
owners of the  occurrence of such event  and the availability through  DTC of
Definitive  Securities.  Upon surrender  by DTC of  the global certificate or
certificates  representing the  Book-Entry  Securities and  instructions  for
re-registration, the Trustee will issue Definitive Securities, and thereafter
the  Trustee will  recognize the  holders  of such  Definitive Securities  as
Securityholders under the applicable Agreement.

     Although  DTC,  CEDEL   and  Euroclear  have  agreed  to  the  foregoing
procedures in order to facilitate  transfers of Securities among participants
of DTC,  CEDEL and  Euroclear, they  are under  no obligation  to perform  or
continue to perform  such procedures and such procedures  may be discontinued
at any time.

     None  of the  Master Servicer,  Provident or  the Trustee will  have any
responsibility for any  aspect of the records relating to or payments made on
account of beneficial  ownership interests of the Book-Entry  Securities held
by  Cede  &  Co., as  nominee  of  DTC, or  for  maintaining,  supervising or
reviewing any records relating to such beneficial ownership interests.


                              CREDIT ENHANCEMENT

GENERAL

     Credit enhancement may be provided with  respect to one or more  classes
of a Series of Securities or  with respect to the related Trust  Fund Assets.
Credit enhancement may  be in the form of a limited financial guaranty policy
issued  by  an  entity  named  in  the  related  Prospectus  Supplement,  the
subordination of one  or more classes of  the Securities of such  Series, the
establishment of one or more Reserve Accounts, the use of a cross-collateral-
ization feature,  use of a  mortgage pool insurance policy,  bankruptcy bond,
special hazard insurance  policy, surety bond,  letter of credit,  guaranteed
investment contract,  overcollateralization,  or  another  method  of  credit
enhancement  contemplated  herein  and described  in  the  related Prospectus
Supplement, or any combination of  the foregoing.  Unless otherwise specified
in the  related Prospectus  Supplement, credit  enhancement will  not provide
protection against all risks of loss and will not guarantee repayment  of the
entire principal balance of  the Securities and interest thereon.   If losses
occur which exceed  the amount covered by credit enhancement or which are not
covered by the credit enhancement,  Securityholders will bear their allocable
share of any deficiencies.

     If specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the coverage provided
by  one  or  more  of the  forms  of  credit  enhancement  described in  this
Prospectus may apply  concurrently to two or  more separate Trust Funds.   If
applicable, the related  Prospectus Supplement will identify the  Trust Funds
to which such  credit enhancement relates and  the manner of  determining the
amount  of  coverage  provided  to  such  Trust  Funds  thereby  and  of  the
application of such coverage to the identified Trust Funds.

SUBORDINATION

     If  so  specified  in  the  related  Prospectus  Supplement,  protection
afforded to holders of one or more classes of Securities of a Series by means
of the subordination feature may be accomplished by the preferential right of
holders of one or more other classes of such Series (the "Senior Securities")
to  distributions in respect  of scheduled principal,  Principal Prepayments,
interest or any combination thereof that otherwise would have been payable to
holders of Subordinated Securities under  the circumstances and to the extent
specified  in the  related Prospectus  Supplement.   Protection  may also  be
afforded to the holders of Senior Securities of a Series by: (i) reducing the
ownership  interest (if applicable)  of the related  Subordinated Securities;
(ii)  a combination  of the  immediately  preceding sentence  and clause  (i)
above; or (iii) as otherwise  described in the related Prospectus Supplement.
If so  specified in the related  Prospectus Supplement, delays in  receipt of
scheduled payments on  the Loans and losses  on defaulted Loans may  be borne
first by the various classes of Subordinated Securities and thereafter by the
various classes  of Senior Securities,  in each case under  the circumstances
and subject to  the limitations specified in such Prospectus Supplement.  The
aggregate distributions in  respect of delinquent payments on  the Loans over
the lives of the Securities  or at any time, the aggregate  losses in respect
of defaulted  Loans which must  be borne  by the  Subordinated Securities  by
virtue of  subordination  and  the  amount  of  the  distributions  otherwise
distributable  to the Subordinated Securityholders that will be distributable
to  Senior  Securityholders  on  any  Distribution Date  may  be  limited  as
specified in the related Prospectus  Supplement.  If aggregate  distributions
in respect of delinquent payments on the Loans or aggregate losses in respect
of such Loans  were to exceed an  amount specified in the  related Prospectus
Supplement,  Senior  Securityholders   would  experience   losses  on   their
Securities.

     In  addition to  or in lieu  of the  foregoing, if  so specified  in the
related Prospectus Supplement,  all or any portion of distributions otherwise
payable to Subordinated Securityholders on  any Distribution Date may instead
be deposited into one or  more Reserve Accounts established with  the Trustee
or distributed to Senior Securityholders.  Such  deposits may be made on each
Distribution Date, for specified periods or  until the balance in the Reserve
Account  has reached  a specified  amount  and, following  payments from  the
Reserve Account to  Senior Securityholders  or otherwise,  thereafter to  the
extent  necessary to restore the  balance in the  Reserve Account to required
levels,  in each  case as  specified  in the  related Prospectus  Supplement.
Amounts on deposit in the Reserve  Account may be released to the  holders of
certain  classes of  Securities  at  the times  and  under the  circumstances
specified in such Prospectus Supplement.

     If specified  in the related  Prospectus Supplement, various  classes of
Senior Securities and  Subordinated Securities may themselves  be subordinate
in their  right to receive certain  distributions to other classes  of Senior
and Subordinated Securities, respectively, through a  cross-collateralization
mechanism or  otherwise.   As  between classes  of Senior  Securities and  as
between  classes of Subordinated  Securities, distributions may  be allocated
among such  classes (i)  in the order  of their scheduled  final Distribution
Dates, (ii) in  accordance with a schedule  or formula, (iii) in  relation to
the occurrence of events, or (iv) otherwise, in each case as specified in the
related   Prospectus  Supplement.     As  between  classes   of  Subordinated
Securities,  payments  to   holders  of  Senior  Securities   on  account  of
delinquencies or losses and payments to any Reserve Account will be allocated
as specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.

LETTER OF CREDIT

     The  letter of credit,  if any, with  respect to a  Series of Securities
will be issued by the bank or  financial institution specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement (the  "L/C Bank").  Under the letter of credit, the L/C
Bank will be  obligated to honor  drawings thereunder  in an aggregate  fixed
dollar  amount,  net  of  unreimbursed  payments  thereunder,  equal  to  the
percentage  specified  in  the  related  Prospectus  Supplement  (i)  of  the
aggregate principal balance of the Loans on the related Cut-Off Date  or (ii)
of one  or  more Classes  of Securities.    If so  specified  in the  related
Prospectus Supplement, the letter of credit  may permit drawings in the event
of losses not covered by insurance policies or other credit support,  such as
losses arising from damage not covered by standard hazard insurance policies,
losses resulting  from the bankruptcy  of a borrower  and the application  of
certain provisions of  the federal Bankruptcy Code, or  losses resulting from
denial of insurance coverage due to misrepresentations in connection with the
origination of a Loan.  The amount available under the letter of credit will,
in  all  cases,  be  reduced  to  the  extent  of the  unreimbursed  payments
thereunder.  The obligations of  the L/C Bank under the letter of  credit for
each Series of Securities will expire at the earlier of the date specified in
the related Prospectus Supplement or the termination of the Trust Fund.   See
"The Agreements--Termination: Optional Termination."  A copy of the letter of
credit for a Series, if any, will be filed with the Commission  as an exhibit
to a Current Report on Form 8-K to be filed within 15 days of issuance of the
Securities of the related Series.

INSURANCE POLICIES, SURETY BONDS AND GUARANTIES

     If so provided in the Prospectus Supplement for a  Series of Securities,
deficiencies in  amounts  otherwise payable  on  such Securities  or  certain
classes thereof  will be  covered by insurance  policies and/or  surety bonds
provided by one or  more insurance companies or  sureties.  Such  instruments
may cover, with respect  to one or more classes of  Securities of the related
Series,  timely  distributions  of  interest  and/or  full  distributions  of
principal on the  basis of a schedule of principal distributions set forth in
or determined in  the manner specified in the  related Prospectus Supplement.
In addition, if  specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, a Trust Fund
may  also include bankruptcy bonds, special  hazard insurance policies, other
insurance or guaranties for  the purpose of (i)  maintaining  timely payments
or providing additional  protection against losses on the  assets included in
such Trust Fund, (ii) paying  administrative expenses or (iii) establishing a
minimum reinvestment  rate on the payments made in  respect of such assets or
principal  payment  rate on  such  assets.    Such arrangements  may  include
agreements  under which  Securityholders  are  entitled  to  receive  amounts
deposited in various accounts held by the Trustee upon the terms specified in
such Prospectus Supplement.  A copy of  any such instrument for a Series will
be filed with the Commission as an exhibit to a Current Report on Form 8-K to
be filed with the  Commission within 15 days of issuance of the Securities of
the related Series.

OVER-COLLATERALIZATION

     If so  provided in the Prospectus Supplement for a Series of Securities,
a  portion  of  the interest  payment  on  each Loan  may  be  applied as  an
additional  distribution  in respect  of  principal to  reduce  the principal
balance of a certain class or classes of Securities and, thus, accelerate the
rate of payment of principal on such class or classes of  Securities relative
to the principal balance of the Loans in the related Trust Fund.

RESERVE ACCOUNTS

     If specified in the  related Prospectus Supplement, credit support  with
respect to  a Series of Securities will be  provided by the establishment and
maintenance with the Trustee for such Series  of Securities, in trust, of one
or more Reserve Accounts  for such Series.  The related Prospectus Supplement
will specify whether or not any such Reserve Accounts will be included in the
Trust Fund for such Series.

     The Reserve  Account for  a Series  will be  funded (i)  by the  deposit
therein  of cash, United  States Treasury securities,  instruments evidencing
ownership  of principal  or  interest payments  thereon,  letters of  credit,
demand  notes,  certificates of  deposit  or  a  combination thereof  in  the
aggregate amount specified in the  related Prospectus Supplement, (ii) by the
deposit therein  from time to  time of certain  amounts, as specified  in the
related Prospectus Supplement  to which the Subordinated  Securityholders, if
any,  would otherwise be  entitled or  (iii) in such  other manner as  may be
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.

   
     Any amounts on  deposit in the Reserve  Account and the proceeds  of any
other instrument upon  maturity will be held  in cash or will be  invested in
"Permitted Investments"  which  may include  (i)  direct obligations  of,  or
obligations fully guaranteed  as to timely payment of  principal and interest
by, the United States or any agency or instrumentality thereof, provided that
such  obligations are  backed by  the  full faith  and credit  of  the United
States; (ii) repurchase  agreements on  obligations specified  in clause  (i)
maturing  not more  than three months  from the date  of acquisition thereof,
provided that the short-term unsecured debt obligations of the party agreeing
to repurchase such obligations are at the time rated by each Rating Agency in
its highest short-term  rating category; (iii) certificates  of deposit, time
deposits  and bankers'  acceptances (which,  if Moody's  is a  Rating Agency,
shall each  have an original maturity  of not more  than 90 days and,  in the
case of bankers'  acceptances, shall in no event have an original maturity of
more  than 365  days) of  any U.S.  depository institution  or trust  company
incorporated under the  laws of the  United States or  any state thereof  and
subject to  supervision  and  examination  by federal  and/or  state  banking
authorities,  provided that the unsecured short-term debt obligations of such
depository institution  or trust company  at the date of  acquisition thereof
have been rated  by each  Rating Agency in  its highest unsecured  short-term
debt  rating category; (iv)  commercial paper (having  original maturities of
not more than 90 days) of any corporation incorporated under the laws  of the
United States or any  state thereof which on the date of acquisition has been
rated by the  Rating Agencies in their highest  short-term rating categories;
(v) short-term investment  funds ("STIFS") sponsored by any  trust company or
bank incorporated under  the laws of the  United States or any  state thereof
which on the  date of acquisition  has been rated  by the Rating Agencies  in
their respective highest  rating category of  long-term unsecured debt;  (vi)
interests in any money  market fund which at  the date of acquisition  of the
interests in  such fund and  throughout the time  as the interest  is held in
such fund has the  rating specified in the  related Prospectus Supplement  by
each  Rating Agency;  and  (vii)  other obligations  or  securities that  are
acceptable to each Rating Agency as a Permitted Investment hereunder and will
not result in  a reduction in the  then current rating of  the Securities, as
evidenced by a letter to such effect from such Rating Agency and with respect
to  which  the  Master  Servicer  has received  confirmation  that,  for  tax
purposes, the  investment complies with  the last clause of  this definition;
provided that  no instrument  described hereunder  shall evidence  either the
right to receive (a) only interest with respect to the obligations underlying
such  instrument or  (b) both  principal and  interest payments  derived from
obligations  underlying  such  instrument  and  the  interest  and  principal
payments with respect to such instrument provided a yield to maturity  at par
greater than  120% of the  yield to maturity  at par of  the underlying obli-
gations; and provided, further, that no instrument described hereunder may be
purchased  at a price greater than  par if such instrument  may be prepaid or
called at  a price less than its purchase price prior to its stated maturity.
Unless   otherwise  specified  in  the  related  Prospectus  Supplement,  any
instrument  deposited therein  will  name  the Trustee,  in  its capacity  as
trustee for the holders of the Securities,  as beneficiary and will be issued
by an entity  acceptable to each Rating  Agency that rates the  Securities of
the related Series.  Additional  information with respect to such instruments
deposited in the Reserve Accounts will be set forth in the related Prospectus
Supplement.
    

     Any amounts so  deposited and payments on instruments  so deposited will
be available for withdrawal from the Reserve Account for distribution  to the
holders of  Securities of the related Series for  the purposes, in the manner
and at the times specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.

POOL INSURANCE POLICIES

     If  specified in  the  related Prospectus  Supplement,  a separate  pool
insurance policy  ("Pool Insurance Policy") will be obtained for the Pool and
issued  by  the  insurer  (the  "Pool  Insurer")  named  in  such  Prospectus
Supplement.   Each  Pool Insurance  Policy will,  subject to  the limitations
described below, cover loss  by reason of default in payment  on Loans in the
Pool  in an  amount  equal  to  a percentage  specified  in  such  Prospectus
Supplement  of the aggregate principal  balance of such  Loans on the Cut-Off
Date which are  not covered as to their entire outstanding principal balances
by Primary Mortgage  Insurance Policies.  As more fully  described below, the
Master Servicer will present claims thereunder to  the Pool Insurer on behalf
of itself,  the Trustee  and the  holders of  the Securities  of the  related
Series.   The  Pool Insurance  Policies,  however, are  not blanket  policies
against loss, since claims thereunder  may only be made respecting particular
defaulted  Loans and only  upon satisfaction of  certain conditions precedent
described below.  The Pool Insurance Policies generally will not cover losses
due  to a  failure to  pay  or denial  of a  claim under  a  Primary Mortgage
Insurance Policy.

   
     The Pool Insurance Policies generally will provide that no claims may be
validly presented unless  (i) any required Primary  Mortgage Insurance Policy
is in effect for the defaulted Loan and a claim thereunder has been submitted
and settled; (ii) hazard insurance on  the related Property has been kept  in
force and  real estate taxes  and other protection and  preservation expenses
have  been paid;  (iii)  if there  has been  physical loss  or damage  to the
Property, it has been restored to its physical condition (reasonable wear and
tear excepted) at  the time of issuance  of the policy; and  (iv) the insured
has acquired good  and merchantable title to  the Property free and  clear of
liens except  certain permitted  encumbrances.   Upon  satisfaction of  these
conditions, the Pool Insurer will have the option either (a) to  purchase the
property  securing the  defaulted Loan  at  a price  equal  to the  principal
balance thereof plus accrued and unpaid interest at the Loan Rate to the date
of such purchase  and certain  expenses incurred  by the  Master Servicer  on
behalf of the  Trustee and Securityholders, or (b) to pay the amount by which
the sum  of the  principal balance  of the  defaulted Loan  plus accrued  and
unpaid interest at the Loan Rate to the  date of payment of the claim and the
aforementioned expenses  exceeds the proceeds received from  an approved sale
of the  Property, in either  case net of  certain amounts paid or  assumed to
have been  paid under the related Primary Mortgage  Insurance Policy.  If any
Property securing a defaulted Loan is damaged  and proceeds, if any, from the
related hazard  insurance policy or  the applicable special  hazard insurance
policy  are insufficient  to  restore  the damaged  Property  to a  condition
sufficient to  permit recovery  under the Pool  Insurance Policy,  the Master
Servicer  will not be required to expend its own funds to restore the damaged
Property unless  it determines  that (i) such  restoration will  increase the
proceeds to Securityholders on liquidation of the Loan after reimbursement of
the  Master Servicer  for  its  expenses  and  (ii)  such  expenses  will  be
recoverable by it through proceeds of the sale of the Property or proceeds of
the related Pool  Insurance Policy or any related  Primary Mortgage Insurance
Policy.

     The Pool Insurance Policies generally  will not insure (and many Primary
Mortgage Insurance Policies  do not insure) against loss  sustained by reason
of a default arising from, among other things, (i) fraud or negligence in the
origination  or servicing  of  a  Loan,  including misrepresentation  by  the
borrower, the originator  or persons involved in the  origination thereof, or
(ii)  failure  to   construct  a  Property  in  accordance   with  plans  and
specifications.  A failure of  coverage attributable to one of  the foregoing
events  might result  in  a breach  of Provident's  representations described
above, and,  in such events might give  rise to an obligation on  the part of
Provident to repurchase the  defaulted Loan if the breach cannot  be cured by
Provident.  No  Pool Insurance Policy  will cover (and many  Primary Mortgage
Insurance Policies  do not  cover) a  claim in  respect of  a defaulted  Loan
occurring  when  the  servicer  of such  Loan,  at  the  time  of default  or
thereafter, was not approved by the applicable insurer.

     The  original  amount  of  coverage  under  each  Pool  Insurance Policy
generally  will be  reduced over the  life of  the related Securities  by the
aggregate dollar amount of claims paid less the aggregate of the  net amounts
realized by the  Pool Insurer upon disposition of  all foreclosed properties.
The  amount of  claims paid  will include  certain expenses  incurred by  the
Master Servicer  as well as accrued interest on  delinquent Loans to the date
of  payment of  the  claim  or  such other  date  set  forth in  the  related
Prospectus Supplement.   Accordingly, if aggregate net claims  paid under any
Pool Insurance  Policy reach the  original policy limit, coverage  under that
Pool Insurance Policy will be exhausted and  any further losses will be borne
by the related Securityholders.
    

CROSS-COLLATERALIZATION

     If  specified in  the  related  Prospectus  Supplement,  the  beneficial
ownership  of  separate groups  of assets  included  in a  Trust Fund  may be
evidenced by separate classes of the  related Series of Securities.  In  such
case,  credit support may  be provided  by a  cross-collateralization feature
which  requires  that  distributions  be  made  to  Securities  evidencing  a
beneficial ownership  interest in,  or secured by,  one or more  asset groups
within the same Trust Fund  prior to distributions to Subordinated Securities
evidencing a beneficial  ownership interest in,  or secured  by, one or  more
other asset  groups within such  Trust Fund.  Cross-collateralization  may be
provided by (i) the allocation of certain excess amounts generated by  one or
more asset  groups to one  or more other  asset groups within the  same Trust
Fund  or (ii)  the allocation  of losses  with respect to  one or  more asset
groups to  one or more  other asset groups within  the same Trust  Fund.  The
Prospectus  Supplement  for   a  Series  of   Securities  which  includes   a
cross-collateralization feature will  describe the manner and  conditions for
applying such cross-collateralization feature.


                     YIELD AND PREPAYMENT CONSIDERATIONS

     The yields to maturity and weighted average lives of the Securities will
be affected primarily by the amount and timing of principal payments received
on or in respect of the Trust Fund Assets included in the related Trust Fund.
The  original terms  to  maturity of  the Loans  in  a given  Pool  will vary
depending  upon  the  type  of  Loans  included  therein.    Each  Prospectus
Supplement will contain  information with respect to the  type and maturities
of the  Loans in the  related Pool.   The related Prospectus  Supplement will
specify  the circumstances,  if any,  under which  the related Loans  will be
subject to prepayment penalties.  The prepayment experience on the Loans in a
Pool  will  affect  the  weighted  average  life of  the  related  Series  of
Securities.

     The rate of  prepayment on the Loans  cannot be predicted.   Home equity
loans  and home  improvement contracts  have been  originated in  significant
volume  only during  the past  few years and  Provident is  not aware  of any
publicly  available studies or  statistics on the rate  of prepayment of such
loans.   Generally, home equity loans and  home improvement contracts are not
viewed  by borrowers  as permanent  financing.   Accordingly, such  Loans may
experience a higher rate of prepayment than traditional first mortgage loans.
On  the other hand,  because home equity  loans such as  the Revolving Credit
Line  Loans generally  are not  fully  amortizing, the  absence of  voluntary
borrower prepayments could  cause rates of principal payments  lower than, or
similar to, those of traditional  fully-amortizing first mortgage loans.  The
prepayment experience of  the related Trust  Fund may be  affected by a  wide
variety  of   factors,  including  general  economic  conditions,  prevailing
interest  rate levels, the  availability of alternative  financing, homeowner
mobility and the  frequency and amount of  any future draws on  any Revolving
Credit Line  Loans.   Other  factors that  might be  expected  to affect  the
prepayment rate  of a pool of home equity  mortgage loans or home improvement
contracts  include the  amounts of,  and  interest rates  on, the  underlying
senior  mortgage loans,  and the  use of  first mortgage  loans as  long-term
financing  for home purchase  and subordinate mortgage  loans as shorter-term
financing for a  variety of purposes,  including home improvement,  education
expenses   and  purchases   of  consumer   durables   such  as   automobiles.
Accordingly,  such Loans  may experience  a  higher rate  of prepayment  than
traditional fixed-rate mortgage loans.   In addition, any  future limitations
on the right  of borrowers to deduct  interest payments on home  equity loans
for federal income tax purposes may further increase  the rate of prepayments
of the Loans.   The enforcement  of a "due-on-sale"  provision (as  described
below) will have the  same effect as a prepayment  of the related Loan.   See
"Certain Legal Aspects of the Loans--Due-on-Sale Clauses".  

     The  yield to  an investor  who  purchases Securities  in the  secondary
market at a price other than par  will vary from the anticipated yield if the
rate  of  prepayment  on  the  Loans  is  actually  different  than  the rate
anticipated by such investor at the time such Securities were purchased.

     Collections on Home  Equity Loans may vary because,  among other things,
borrowers may  (i)  make payments  during any  month as  low  as the  minimum
monthly  payment for  such  month  or, during  the  interest-only period  for
certain  Revolving  Credit Line  Loans  and, in  more  limited circumstances,
Closed-End Loans, with  respect to which an interest-only  payment option has
been selected, the interest and the  fees and charges for such month or  (ii)
make  payments as  high  as  the entire  outstanding  principal balance  plus
accrued interest and the fees and charges thereon.   In addition, collections
on  the Loans may vary  due to seasonal purchasing  and the payment habits of
borrowers.

   
     As  specified  in  the  related Prospectus  Supplement,  certain  of the
conventional  Loans  will  contain "due-on-sale"  provisions  permitting  the
mortgagee  to  accelerate the  maturity  of the  Loan  upon  sale or  certain
transfers by  the  borrower of  the  related Property.    Thus, the  rate  of
prepayments  on such  Loans may  be  lower than  that  of conventional  Loans
bearing comparable  interest  rates.    The Master  Servicer  generally  will
enforce any  due-on-sale or  due-on-encumbrance clause to  the extent  it has
knowledge of the conveyance or further encumbrance or the proposed conveyance
or proposed further encumbrance of  the Property and reasonably believes that
it  is  entitled  to do  so  under  applicable law.    See  "The Agreements--
Collection  Procedures"  and "Certain  Legal  Aspects  of  the Loans"  for  a
description  of certain  provisions  of  each  Agreement  and  certain  legal
developments that may affect the prepayment experience on the Loans.
    

     The rate of prepayments with  respect to conventional mortgage loans has
fluctuated significantly  in recent years.   In general, if  prevailing rates
fall significantly below  the Loan Rates borne  by the Loans, such  Loans are
more  likely  to be  subject to  higher prepayment  rates than  if prevailing
interest rates remain at or above such Loan Rates.  Conversely, if prevailing
interest rates rise appreciably above the Loan Rates borne by the Loans, such
Loans  are more  likely  to  experience  a  lower  prepayment  rate  than  if
prevailing rates remain at or  below such Loan Rates.  However,  there can be
no assurance that such will be the case.

   
     When  a full  prepayment is  made  on a  Loan, the  borrower  is charged
interest on the principal amount  of the Loan so prepaid only for  the number
of days  in the  month actually  elapsed up  to the  date of  the prepayment,
rather than for a  full month.  The effect of prepayments in  full will be to
reduce the amount of  interest passed through or paid in  the following month
to holders of Securities because interest on the principal amount of any Loan
so  prepaid will generally be  paid only to the date  of prepayment.  Partial
prepayments in  a given  month may  be applied to  the outstanding  principal
balances of  the Loans so prepaid on the first day of the month of receipt or
the month  following receipt.  In  the latter case, partial  prepayments will
not reduce  the amount  of interest  passed through  or paid  in such  month.
Generally, neither  full nor  partial prepayments will  be passed  through or
paid until the month following receipt.
    

     Even assuming  that  the Properties  provide adequate  security for  the
Loans,  substantial  delays  could  be  encountered  in  connection  with the
liquidation of  defaulted Loans  and corresponding delays  in the  receipt of
related proceeds by Securityholders could occur.  An action to foreclose on a
Property securing a  Loan is  regulated by  state statutes and  rules and  is
subject to many of  the delays and expenses of other lawsuits  if defenses or
counterclaims  are interposed, sometimes requiring several years to complete.
Furthermore, in some states an action to  obtain a deficiency judgment is not
permitted following a  nonjudicial sale of  a property.   In the  event of  a
default by a borrower, these restrictions, among other things, may impede the
ability of  the Master Servicer  to foreclose on  or sell the  Property or to
obtain  liquidation proceeds  sufficient  to  repay all  amounts  due on  the
related Loan.   In addition, the Master  Servicer will be entitled  to deduct
from  related  liquidation  proceeds  all  expenses  reasonably  incurred  in
attempting to  recover amounts  due on  defaulted Loans and  not yet  repaid,
including  payments to  senior lienholders,  legal  fees and  costs of  legal
action, real estate taxes and maintenance and preservation expenses.

     Liquidation  expenses with respect  to defaulted  mortgage loans  do not
vary directly with the outstanding principal balance  of the loan at the time
of default.   Therefore,  assuming that  a servicer  took the  same steps  in
realizing upon a  defaulted mortgage loan having a  small remaining principal
balance  as it would in the case of  a defaulted mortgage loan having a large
remaining   principal  balance,  the   amount  realized  after   expenses  of
liquidation  would be  smaller as  a  percentage of  the remaining  principal
balance of the small mortgage loan than would be the  case with the defaulted
mortgage loan having a large remaining principal balance.

     Applicable  state laws  generally  regulate  interest  rates  and  other
charges,  require certain  disclosures,  and  require  licensing  of  certain
originators and  servicers of  Loans.   In  addition, most  have other  laws,
public policy and  general principles of equity relating to the protection of
consumers, unfair  and deceptive practices  and practices which may  apply to
originating, servicing and collecting Loans.   Depending on the provisions of
the  applicable  law and  the  specific  facts  and  circumstances  involved,
violations of these laws,  policies and principles  may limit the ability  of
the Master Servicer to collect all or part of the principal of or interest on
the Loans, may  entitle the borrower to  a refund of amounts  previously paid
and,  in  addition,  could  subject   the  Master  Servicer  to  damages  and
administrative sanctions.

     If the  rate at which interest is passed through  or paid to the holders
of  Securities   of  a  Series   is  calculated  on  a   Loan-by-Loan  basis,
disproportionate  principal prepayments among Loans with different Loan Rates
will affect the yield on such Securities.  In most cases, the effective yield
to Securityholders  will be lower  than the yield  otherwise produced  by the
applicable  Pass-Through Rate  or interest rate  and purchase  price, because
while interest  will accrue  on each  Loan from  the first day  of the  month
(unless  otherwise specified  in  the  related  Prospectus  Supplement),  the
distribution  of such  interest  will  not be  made  earlier  than the  month
following the month of accrual.

     Under certain  circumstances, the  Master Servicer,  the holders of  the
residual  interests  in  a  REMIC  or any  person  specified  in  the related
Prospectus Supplement  may have the option to purchase  the assets of a Trust
Fund  and  thereby  affect  earlier  retirement  of  the  related  Series  of
Securities.  See "The Agreements--Termination; Optional Termination".

     The  relative contribution of  the various factors  affecting prepayment
may  vary from time  to time.   There can be  no assurance as  to the rate of
payment of principal of the Trust  Fund Assets at any time or over  the lives
of the Securities.

     The  Prospectus  Supplement relating  to  a  Series  of Securities  will
discuss in greater  detail the  effect of  the rate and  timing of  principal
payments  (including prepayments),  delinquencies and  losses  on the  yield,
weighted average lives and maturities of such Securities.


                                THE AGREEMENTS

     Set forth  below is  a description  of the  material provisions  of each
Agreement  which  are  not  described  elsewhere in  this  Prospectus.    The
description is subject to, and qualified in its entirety by reference to, the
provisions of each Agreement.   Where particular provisions or  terms used in
the Agreements are referred to, such provisions or terms are as  specified in
the Agreements.

ASSIGNMENT OF THE TRUST FUND ASSETS

     Assignment of the Loans.  At the time of issuance of the Securities of a
Series, Provident will assign  the Loans comprising the related Trust Fund to
the  Trustee,  without recourse,  together  with all  principal  and interest
received by or on behalf of Provident on or with respect to  such Loans after
the Cut-Off Date, other than principal and interest due on or before the Cut-
Off  Date and  other  than any  Retained  Interest specified  in  the related
Prospectus Supplement.   The Trustee will, concurrently with such assignment,
deliver such Securities  to Provident in exchange  for the Loans.   Each Loan
will be  identified in  a schedule  appearing as  an exhibit  to the  related
Agreement.   Such  schedule will  include information  as to  the outstanding
principal balance of each Loan after application of payments due on or before
the Cut-Off Date, as well as information regarding the Loan  Rate or APR, the
maturity  of the  Loan, the  Loan-to-Value Ratios  or Combined  Loan-to-Value
Ratios, as applicable, at origination and certain other information.

     Unless otherwise  specified in  the related  Prospectus Supplement,  the
Agreement  will  require that,  within  the  time period  specified  therein,
Provident  will also deliver or  cause to be delivered to  the Trustee (or to
the  custodian hereinafter  referred to)  as to  each Mortgage  Loan or  Home
Equity Loan, among other  things, (i) the mortgage note or  contract endorsed
without recourse in  blank or to the order of the Trustee, (ii) the mortgage,
deed of trust or similar instrument (a "Mortgage") with evidence of recording
indicated  thereon (except  for any  Mortgage  not returned  from the  public
recording  office,  in  which case  Provident  will  deliver or  cause  to be
delivered  a copy  of  such Mortgage  together with  a  certificate that  the
original of such Mortgage was  delivered to such recording office), (iii)  an
assignment  of  the Mortgage  to  the Trustee,  which  assignment will  be in
recordable form  in the case  of a Mortgage  assignment, and (iv)  such other
security documents, including  those relating to any senior  interests in the
Property, as  may be specified  in the  related Prospectus Supplement  or the
related  Agreement.   Unless otherwise  specified in  the related  Prospectus
Supplement,  Provident  will  not  promptly  cause  the  assignments  of  the
Mortgages to be  recorded in the appropriate public  office for real property
records.  If specified in the  related Prospectus Supplement, some or all  of
the  Loan documents  may not  be  delivered to  the Trustee  until  after the
occurrence of certain events specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.

   
    

     The Trustee (or the custodian  hereinafter referred to) will review such
Loan documents  within the  time period specified  in the  related Prospectus
Supplement after receipt thereof, and the Trustee will hold such documents in
trust  for the  benefit of  the  related Securityholders.   Unless  otherwise
specified in the  related Prospectus  Supplement,   if any  such document  is
found to  be missing or  defective in any  material respect, the  Trustee (or
such custodian) will notify the Master Servicer and Provident.  If  Provident
cannot cure the  omission or defect within  the time period specified  in the
related Prospectus Supplement after receipt of such notice, Provident will be
obligated to either  (i) purchase the related Loan from the Trust Fund at the
Purchase Price or (ii) if so specified in  the related Prospectus Supplement,
remove such Loan from the Trust Fund and substitute in  its place one or more
other Loans that meets certain requirements set forth therein.  There  can be
no assurance  that  Provident  will fulfill  this  purchase  or  substitution
obligation.  Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement,
this obligation to  cure, purchase or substitute constitutes  the sole remedy
available  to the  Securityholders  or the  Trustee  for  omission of,  or  a
material defect in, a constituent document.

     The Trustee  will be  authorized to  appoint a  custodian pursuant to  a
custodial agreement to  maintain possession of and, if  applicable, to review
the documents relating to the Loans as agent of the Trustee.

     Notwithstanding the foregoing  provisions, with respect to  a Trust Fund
for which a REMIC  election is to be  made, no purchase or substitution  of a
Loan  will  be  made if  such  purchase  or substitution  would  result  in a
prohibited transaction tax under the Code.

   
     No Recourse to  Provident or Master Servicer.   As described above under
"--Assignment of the  Loans," Provident will assign the  Loans comprising the
related Trust Fund to the Trustee, without recourse.  However, Provident will
be obligated to  repurchase or substitute  for any Loan  as to which  certain
representations and warranties are breached or for failure to deliver certain
documents relating to the Loans as described herein under "Assignment  of the
Loans"  and "Loan Program--Representations by Provident; Repurchases."  These
obligations to purchase or substitute constitute the sole remedy available to
the Securityholders or the Trustee for a breach of any such representation or
warranty or failure to deliver a constituent document.
    

PAYMENTS ON LOANS; DEPOSITS TO SECURITY ACCOUNT

     The  Master  Servicer  will  establish  and  maintain  or  cause  to  be
established and maintained with respect to  the related Trust Fund a separate
account or accounts for the collection of  payments on the related Trust Fund
Assets in  the Trust  Fund (the "Security  Account") which,  unless otherwise
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, must be either (i) maintained
with a depository institution whose short-term debt obligations and long-term
debt obligations at the time of  any deposit therein and throughout the  time
the interest is maintained  are rated as specified in the  related Prospectus
Supplement  by the  Rating  Agencies, and  the  deposits in  such account  or
accounts are fully insured by either  the Bank Insurance Fund (the "BIF")  or
the Savings Association Insurance Fund  ("SAIF") (as successor to the Federal
Savings and Loan  Insurance Corporation) and  which is any  of (a) a  federal
savings and  loan association  duly organized, validly  existing and  in good
standing under the applicable banking  laws of any state, (b) an  institution
duly organized,  validly existing and  in good standing under  the applicable
banking laws of any state, (c) a national banking association duly organized,
validly existing and in good standing under the federal banking laws or (d) a
principal  subsidiary of  a bank  holding  company, (ii)  a segregated  trust
account maintained with the corporate trust department  of a federal or state
chartered depository or trust company, having capital and surplus of not less
than  $50,000,000, acting  in its  fiduciary  capacity, or  (iii) an  account
otherwise acceptable to each Rating Agency as evidenced by a letter from each
Rating Agency to  the Trustee,  without reduction or  withdrawal of the  then
current ratings of the Securities.  The collateral eligible to secure amounts
in  the Security Account  is limited  to Permitted  Investments.   A Security
Account may be  maintained as an interest  bearing account or the  funds held
therein  may  be  invested  pending  each  succeeding  Distribution  Date  in
Permitted Investments.  Unless otherwise  specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement, the Master  Servicer or its designee will be  entitled to receive
any such interest or  other income earned on funds in the Security Account as
additional  compensation and  will be  obligated to  deposit in  the Security
Account the amount of any loss immediately as realized.  The Security Account
may be maintained with the  Master Servicer or with a  depository institution
that is an  affiliate of the Master Servicer, provided it meets the standards
set forth above.

     The Master  Servicer  will  deposit or  cause  to be  deposited  in  the
Security Account  for each  Trust Fund, to  the extent applicable  and unless
otherwise  specified  in  the related  Prospectus  Supplement,  the following
payments and  collections received  or advances made  by or  on behalf  of it
subsequent to the Cut-Off Date (other than  certain payments due on or before
the  Cut-Off   Date  and  exclusive  of  any  amounts  representing  Retained
Interest):

          (i)  all  payments on  account  of  principal, including  Principal
     Prepayments  and, if specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, any
     applicable prepayment penalties, on the Loans;

          (ii) all  payments on  account of  interest  on the  Loans, net  of
     applicable servicing compensation;

          (iii)     all proceeds  (net of  unreimbursed payments  of property
     taxes,  insurance  premiums  and  similar  items  ("Insured   Expenses")
     incurred, and  unreimbursed Advances made,  by the  Master Servicer,  if
     any) of the hazard insurance policies and any Primary Mortgage Insurance
     Policies, to the extent such proceeds are not applied to the restoration
     of  the property or  released to  the Mortgagor  in accordance  with the
     Master Servicer's normal  servicing procedures (collectively, "Insurance
     Proceeds") and  all other  cash  amounts (net  of unreimbursed  expenses
     incurred  in connection  with  liquidation or  foreclosure ("Liquidation
     Expenses") and  unreimbursed Advances made,  by the Master  Servicer, if
     any)  received  and  retained  in  connection with  the  liquidation  of
     defaulted Loans, by  foreclosure or otherwise ("Liquidation  Proceeds"),
     together with any net proceeds received on a monthly basis with  respect
     to  any  properties   acquired  on  behalf  of  the  Securityholders  by
     foreclosure or deed in lieu of foreclosure;

          (iv) all  proceeds of  any  Loan  or  property in  respect  thereof
     purchased by Provident as described under "Loan Program--Representations
     by Provident; Repurchases" or "--Assignment  of Trust Fund Assets" above
     and  all  proceeds  of  any  Loan repurchased  as  described  under  "--
     Termination; Optional Termination" below;

          (v)  all payments required  to be deposited in the Security Account
     with respect  to any deductible  clause in any blanket  insurance policy
     described under "--Hazard Insurance" below;

          (vi) any amount required to be  deposited by the Master Servicer in
     connection with  losses realized on  investments for the benefit  of the
     Master Servicer of funds held in the Security Account and, to the extent
     specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, any payments required to
     be made  by the Master  Servicer in connection with  prepayment interest
     shortfalls; and

          (vii)     all  other  amounts  required  to  be  deposited  in  the
     Security Account pursuant to the Agreement.

     The Master Servicer may  from time to time  direct the institution  that
maintains the  Security Account to  withdraw funds from the  Security Account
for the following purposes:

          (i)  to pay to the Master  Servicer the servicing fees described in
     the related Prospectus Supplement, the master servicing fees (subject to
     reduction) and,  as additional  servicing compensation,  earnings on  or
     investment income with respect to funds in the Security Account credited
     thereto;

          (ii) to reimburse the Master  Servicer for Advances, such  right of
     reimbursement with respect to any Loan being limited to amounts received
     that  represent late recoveries of payments of principal and/or interest
     on such Loan (or Insurance Proceeds or Liquidation Proceeds with respect
     thereto) with respect to which such Advance was made;

          (iii)     to  reimburse  the  Master  Servicer  for   any  Advances
     previously  made  which   the  Master  Servicer  has  determined  to  be
     nonrecoverable;

          (iv) to reimburse the  Master Servicer from Insurance  Proceeds for
     expenses  incurred by  the Master  Servicer and  covered by  the related
     insurance policies;

          (v)  to reimburse the  Master Servicer for unpaid  master servicing
     fees and unreimbursed  out-of-pocket costs and expenses incurred  by the
     Master Servicer in  the performance of  its servicing obligations,  such
     right  of reimbursement being  limited to amounts  received representing
     late recoveries of the payments for which such advances were made;

          (vi) to pay to  the Master Servicer, with  respect to each Loan  or
     property  acquired in  respect thereof  that has  been purchased  by the
     Master Servicer pursuant to the Agreement,  all amounts received thereon
     and not  taken into account in determining the principal balance of such
     repurchased Loan;

          (vii)     to  reimburse   the  Master  Servicer  or  Provident  for
     expenses incurred and reimbursable pursuant to the Agreement;

          (viii)    to  withdraw any amount deposited in the Security Account
     and not required to be deposited therein; and

          (ix) to clear and  terminate the Security Account  upon termination
     of the Agreement.

     In  addition, unless  otherwise  specified  in  the  related  Prospectus
Supplement,  on or  prior  to  the business  day  immediately preceding  each
Distribution  Date,  the Master  Servicer  shall withdraw  from  the Security
Account the amount  of Available Funds, to the extent on deposit, for deposit
in an account maintained by the Trustee for the related Series of Securities.

     The applicable  Agreement may require  the Master Servicer  to establish
and  maintain one  or  more  escrow accounts  into  which Mortgagors  deposit
amounts sufficient to  pay taxes, assessments,  hazard insurance premiums  or
comparable  items.   Withdrawals  from  the  escrow accounts  maintained  for
Mortgagors  may be  made to effect  timely payment of  taxes, assessments and
hazard  insurance premiums  or  comparable  items,  to reimburse  the  Master
Servicer out  of related  assessments for  maintaining  hazard insurance,  to
refund  to  Mortgagors  amounts  determined  to  be  overages,  to  remit  to
Mortgagors, if required, interest  earned, if any, on balances in  any of the
escrow accounts, to repair or otherwise protect the Property and to clear and
terminate  any of the  escrow accounts.   The Master Servicer  will be solely
responsible for administration of the escrow accounts and will be expected to
make advances to such account when a deficiency exists therein.

PRE-FUNDING ACCOUNT

     If so provided in the related Prospectus Supplement, the Master Servicer
will establish and maintain a Pre-Funding Account, in the name of the related
Trustee on behalf  of the related Securityholders, into  which Provident will
deposit cash  in an  amount equal  to the  Pre-Funded Amount  on the  related
Closing  Date.  The Pre-Funding  Account will be  maintained with the Trustee
for the related Series of Securities and  is designed solely to hold funds to
be applied by such Trustee during the Funding Period to pay to Provident the 
purchase  price for Subsequent Loans.  Monies on deposit in the Pre-Funding 
Account will not be available to cover losses on or in respect of the related 
Loans.  The Pre-Funded Amount  will not exceed 50% of the initial aggregate 
principal amount of the Securities of the related Series.  The Pre-Funded 
Amount  will be  used by  the related  Trustee to  purchase Subsequent
Loans  from  Provident from  time to  time  during the  Funding Period.   The
Funding Period, if any,  for a Trust Fund will  begin on the related  Closing
Date and will end on the date specified in the related Prospectus Supplement,
which in no  event will be  later than the  date that is  one year after  the
related Closing Date.   Monies on deposit  in the Pre-Funding Account  may be
invested in Permitted  Investments under the circumstances and  in the manner
described in the related  Agreement.  Earnings on investment of  funds in the
Pre-Funding Account  will be deposited  into the related Security  Account or
such other trust account as is specified in the related Prospectus Supplement
and losses will  be charged against the  funds on deposit in  the Pre-Funding
Account.   Any amounts remaining in the Pre-Funding Account at the end of the
Funding  Period will  be distributed  to the  related Securityholders  in the
manner  and priority  specified in  the related  Prospectus Supplement,  as a
prepayment of principal of the related Securities.

     In addition, if so provided in the related Prospectus Supplement, on the
related Closing Date  Provident will deposit in an  account (the "Capitalized
Interest Account") cash in such amount as is necessary to cover shortfalls in
interest on  the related Series of  Securities that may arise as  a result of
utilization of the  Pre-Funding Account as described above.   The Capitalized
Interest Account shall be  maintained with the Trustee for the related Series
of Securities  and is designed  solely to cover the  above-mentioned interest
shortfalls.  Monies on deposit  in the Capitalized Interest Account will  not
be available to cover  losses on or in respect of the related  Loans.  To the
extent  that the entire amount on deposit in the Capitalized Interest Account
has not been applied to cover shortfalls in interest on the related Series of
Securities  by the end  of the Funding  Period, any amounts  remaining in the
Capitalized Interest Account will be paid to Provident.

SUB-SERVICING

     The  Master  Servicer may  enter  into  an agreement  (a  "Sub-Servicing
Agreement") with any servicing entity which  will act as the Sub-Servicer for
the related Loans,  which Sub-Servicing Agreement will not  contain any terms
inconsistent   with  the  related   Agreement.    Notwithstanding   any  such
subservicing arrangement, unless otherwise provided in the related Prospectus
Supplement, the Master  Servicer will remain liable for  its servicing duties
and  obligations  under the  Master  Servicing  Agreement  as if  the  Master
Servicer alone were servicing the Loans.


COLLECTION PROCEDURES

     The Master Servicer, directly or through one or more Sub-Servicers, will
make  reasonable efforts to  collect all payments called  for under the Loans
and  will, consistent  with each  Agreement  and any  Pool Insurance  Policy,
Primary   Mortgage  Insurance   Policy,   bankruptcy  bond   or   alternative
arrangements, follow such collection procedures as are customary with respect
to loans that are comparable  to the Loans.   Consistent with the above,  the
Master Servicer may,  in its discretion, (i)  waive any assumption fee,  late
payment or other charge in connection with a Loan and (ii) to  the extent not
inconsistent  with the  coverage of  such  Loan by  a Pool  Insurance Policy,
Primary   Mortgage  Insurance   Policy,   bankruptcy   bond  or   alternative
arrangements,  if applicable,  arrange with  a  borrower a  schedule for  the
liquidation of delinquencies  consistent with the Master  Servicer's policies
with  respect to the mortgage loans it owns  and services for others.  To the
extent the Master Servicer is obligated to make or cause to be made Advances,
such obligation will remain during any period of such an arrangement.

     In any case in  which property securing a Loan has been,  or is about to
be, conveyed by  the mortgagor or obligor,  the Master Servicer will,  to the
extent it has  knowledge of such conveyance or  proposed conveyance, exercise
or cause to be  exercised its rights to accelerate the maturity  of such Loan
under any  due-on-sale clause applicable thereto, but only if the exercise of
such rights is permitted by applicable law.  If these conditions  are not met
or if the  Master Servicer reasonably believes it is  unable under applicable
law to enforce such due-on-sale  clause, the Master Servicer will enter  into
or cause to be entered into an assumption and modification agreement with the
person to whom such property has been or is about to be conveyed, pursuant to
which such person becomes liable for repayment of the Loan and, to the extent
permitted by applicable  law, the mortgagor remains liable thereon.   Any fee
collected by  or  on behalf  of  the Master  Servicer  for entering  into  an
assumption agreement will be retained by or  on behalf of the Master Servicer
as  additional servicing  compensation.   See "Certain  Legal Aspects  of the
Loans--Due-on-Sale Clauses".   In  connection with  any such  assumption, the
terms of the related Loan may not be changed.

HAZARD INSURANCE

     Except as otherwise specified in  the related Prospectus Supplement, the
Master  Servicer  will require  the  mortgagor  or obligor  on  each Loan  to
maintain a hazard insurance policy providing for no less than the coverage of
the standard form  of fire insurance policy with  extended coverage customary
for the  type of Property  in the  state in which  such Property is  located.
Such coverage  will be in an amount  that is at least equal  to the lesser of
(i) the maximum insurable value  of the improvements securing such  Loan from
time to time, (ii) the combined principal balance owing on such Loan  and any
mortgage loan senior  to such Loan and  (iii) the minimum amount  required to
compensate for  damage or  loss on  a replacement  cost basis.   All  amounts
collected by the Master Servicer under any hazard policy (except  for amounts
to be applied to the restoration or repair of the Property or released to the
mortgagor  or  obligor  in  accordance  with  the  Master  Servicer's  normal
servicing procedures) will  be deposited in the related  Security Account. In
the  event that  the  Master  Servicer maintains  a  blanket policy  insuring
against hazard losses on  all the Loans comprising part  of a Trust Fund,  it
will conclusively be deemed to have satisfied its obligation relating to  the
maintenance  of  hazard  insurance.    Such  blanket  policy  may  contain  a
deductible clause,  in which  case the  Master Servicer  will be required  to
deposit from  its own  funds into  the related  Security Account  the amounts
which would have been deposited therein but for such clause.

     In  general, the  standard form  of  fire and  extended coverage  policy
covers physical damage  to or destruction of the improvements securing a Loan
by fire,  lightning, explosion, smoke,  windstorm and hail, riot,  strike and
civil commotion, subject  to the conditions and exclusions  particularized in
each policy.   Although  the policies  relating to  the Loans  may have  been
underwritten by different  insurers under different state  laws in accordance
with different applicable forms and therefore may not contain identical terms
and  conditions, the  basic terms  thereof are  dictated by  respective state
laws,  and most  such policies  typically do  not cover  any physical  damage
resulting from the following:   war, revolution, governmental actions, floods
and  other  water-related  causes,  earth  movement  (including  earthquakes,
landslides  and  mud flows),  nuclear  reactions,  wet  or dry  rot,  vermin,
rodents, insects or domestic animals, theft and, in certain cases, vandalism.
The foregoing list  is merely indicative of certain kinds  of uninsured risks
and is  not intended to be all inclusive.  If the Property securing a Loan is
located  in  a  federally  designated  special  flood  area  at the  time  of
origination, the  Master Servicer  will require the  mortgagor or  obligor to
obtain and maintain flood insurance.

     The hazard  insurance policies  covering properties  securing the  Loans
typically contain a clause which in  effect requires the insured at all  time
to carry insurance  of a specified percentage  (generally 80% to 90%)  of the
full replacement value of  the insured property in order to  recover the full
amount of  any partial  loss.   If the  insured's coverage  falls below  this
specified percentage,  then the insurer's  liability in the event  of partial
loss will  not exceed  the larger  of (i)  the actual  cash value  (generally
defined  as replacement  cost at the  time and  place of loss,  less physical
depreciation)  of  the  improvements  damaged   or  destroyed  or  (ii)  such
proportion  of  the loss  as the  amount  of insurance  carried bears  to the
specified  percentage of  the  full replacement  cost  of such  improvements.
Since the  amount of  hazard insurance the  Master Servicer  may cause  to be
maintained on the  improvements securing the Loans declines  as the principal
balances owing thereon decrease, and since improved real estate generally has
appreciated in value over time in the past, the effect of this requirement in
the event  of partial  loss may  be that  hazard insurance  proceeds will  be
insufficient to  restore fully  the damaged  property.   If specified  in the
related Prospectus  Supplement,  a special  hazard insurance  policy will  be
obtained to  insure against certain  of the uninsured risks  described above.
See "Credit Enhancement."

     If the Property securing  a defaulted Loan is  damaged and proceeds,  if
any, from the related hazard insurance policy are insufficient to restore the
damaged Property, the Master Servicer is not required to expend its own funds
to  restore  the  damaged  Property   unless  it  determines  (i)  that  such
restoration will increase  the proceeds to Securityholders  on liquidation of
the Loan after reimbursement of the Master Servicer for its expenses and (ii)
that such expenses will be recoverable  by it from related Insurance Proceeds
or Liquidation Proceeds.

     If recovery on a  defaulted Loan under  any related Insurance Policy  is
not available,  or  if the  defaulted Loan  is not  covered  by an  Insurance
Policy,  the Master  Servicer will  be  obligated to  follow or  cause  to be
followed  such normal  practices  and  procedures as  it  deems necessary  or
advisable  to realize  upon  the defaulted  Loan.   If  the  proceeds of  any
liquidation of the  Property securing the  defaulted Loan are  less than  the
principal  balance of such Loan plus interest accrued thereon that is payable
to Securityholders, the Trust Fund will realize a loss in the  amount of such
difference plus the aggregate of expenses  incurred by the Master Servicer in
connection with such proceedings which are  reimbursable under the Agreement.
In the unlikely  event that any such  proceedings result in a  total recovery
which is,  after reimbursement  to the Master  Servicer of  its expenses,  in
excess of  the principal balance of  such Loan plus  interest accrued thereon
that  is payable to Securityholders, the Master  Servicer will be entitled to
withdraw or retain from the  Security Account amounts representing its normal
servicing  compensation with  respect  to  such  Loan and,  unless  otherwise
specified  in the  related Prospectus  Supplement,  amounts representing  the
balance of  such  excess, exclusive  of  any amount  required  by law  to  be
forwarded to the related borrower, as additional servicing compensation.

     If the  Master  Servicer or  its  designee recovers  Insurance  Proceeds
which, when added to any related Liquidation Proceeds and  after deduction of
certain expenses  reimbursable to the  Master Servicer, exceed  the principal
balance  of such  Loan  plus  interest accrued  thereon  that is  payable  to
Securityholders, the Master  Servicer will be entitled to  withdraw or retain
from  the  Security   Account  amounts  representing  its   normal  servicing
compensation with  respect  to such  Loan.   In  the  event that  the  Master
Servicer has expended its own funds to  restore the damaged Property and such
funds  have not been reimbursed under the related hazard insurance policy, it
will  be  entitled to  withdraw  from  the Security  Account  out of  related
Liquidation Proceeds or  Insurance Proceeds an amount equal  to such expenses
incurred by  it, in which event the  Trust Fund may realize a  loss up to the
amount so charged.  Since  Insurance Proceeds cannot exceed deficiency claims
and certain  expenses incurred  by the Master  Servicer, no  such payment  or
recovery will  result  in a  recovery to  the Trust  Fund  which exceeds  the
principal  balance  of the  defaulted  Loan  together with  accrued  interest
thereon.  See "Credit Enhancement".

     The proceeds  from any  liquidation of  a Loan  will be  applied in  the
following order of priority:  first, to reimburse the Master Servicer for any
unreimbursed expenses incurred  by it to restore the related Property and any
unreimbursed  servicing  compensation  payable to  the  Master  Servicer with
respect  to  such Loan;  second,  to reimburse  the Master  Servicer  for any
unreimbursed Advances with respect to such Loan; third, to accrued and unpaid
interest (to the  extent no Advance  has been made  for such amount)  on such
Loan; and fourth, as a recovery of principal of such Loan.

REALIZATION UPON DEFAULTED LOANS

     Primary Mortgage  Insurance Policies.   If so  specified in  the related
Prospectus  Supplement, the  Master Servicer  will  maintain or  cause to  be
maintained, as the case may be, in full force and  effect, a Primary Mortgage
Insurance  Policy  with  regard to  each  Loan  for  which  such coverage  is
required.    Primary  Mortgage Insurance  Policies  reimburse  certain losses
sustained  by  reason  of defaults  in  payments by  borrowers.    The Master
Servicer  will not  cancel  or  refuse to  renew  any such  Primary  Mortgage
Insurance Policy in effect at the time of the initial issuance of a Series of
Securities  that  is required  to  be  kept  in  force under  the  applicable
Agreement unless the  replacement Primary Mortgage Insurance Policy  for such
cancelled or  nonrenewed policy is  maintained with an insurer  whose claims-
paying ability is sufficient to maintain the current rating of the classes of
Securities of such Series that have been rated.

SERVICING AND OTHER COMPENSATION AND PAYMENT OF EXPENSES

     The principal servicing  compensation to be paid to  the Master Servicer
in respect of its master  servicing activities for each Series  of Securities
will be equal to the percentage per annum described in the related Prospectus
Supplement (which may  vary under certain  circumstances) of the  outstanding
principal balance of  each Loan, and such compensation will be retained by it
from collections  of interest  on such Loan  in the  related Trust  Fund (the
"Master  Servicing Fee").  As  compensation for its  servicing duties, a Sub-
Servicer, if any, will be entitled to a monthly servicing fee as described in
the related Prospectus Supplement.  In  addition, the Master Servicer or Sub-
Servicer will retain all prepayment charges, assumption fees and late payment
charges, to  the extent collected  from borrowers, and  any benefit  that may
accrue as  a result  of the investment  of funds  in the  applicable Security
Account (unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement).

     The  Master Servicer  will  pay  or cause  to  be  paid certain  ongoing
expenses  associated with each  Trust Fund and  incurred by  it in connection
with its  responsibilities under  the related  Agreement, including,  without
limitation, and if so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, payment
of any  fee or  other amount  payable in  respect of  any credit  enhancement
arrangements, payment  of the  fees and  disbursements of   the  Trustee, any
custodian appointed by the Trustee,  the certificate registrar and any paying
agent, and payment of expenses incurred in enforcing the  obligations of Sub-
Servicers.  The Master Servicer will be entitled to reimbursement of expenses
incurred in enforcing the obligations of Sub-Servicers  under certain limited
circumstances.

EVIDENCE AS TO COMPLIANCE

     Each Agreement will provide that on  or before a specified date in  each
year, a firm  of independent public accountants  will furnish a  statement to
the Trustee to the  effect that, on the basis of the examination by such firm
conducted substantially  in compliance  with the  Uniform Single  Attestation
Program for Mortgage Bankers or the Audit Program for  Mortgages serviced for
FHLMC, the servicing by or on behalf of the Master Servicer of the Trust Fund
Assets pursuant to the Agreement was conducted in compliance therewith except
for any  significant exceptions or errors in records  that, in the opinion of
the firm, the Audit Program for Mortgages  serviced for FHLMC, or the Uniform
Single Attestation  Program for Mortgage  Bankers, it is required  to report.
In rendering its statement such firm may rely, as to  matters relating to the
direct servicing of  Loans by Sub-Servicers,  upon comparable statements  for
examinations  conducted substantially in  compliance with the  Uniform Single
Attestation Program for  Mortgage Bankers or the Audit  Program for Mortgages
serviced for FHLMC (rendered  within one year of such statement)  of firms of
independent public accountants with respect to the related Sub-Servicer.

     Each Agreement  will also  provide for  delivery to the  Trustee, on  or
before a  specified date in each year,  of an annual statement  signed by two
officers of the  Master Servicer to the  effect that the Master  Servicer has
fulfilled its obligations under the Agreement throughout the preceding year.

     Copies of  the  annual  accountants'  statement  and  the  statement  of
officers of  the Master  Servicer may be  obtained by Securityholders  of the
related Series without charge upon written  request to the Master Servicer at
the address set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement.

CERTAIN MATTERS REGARDING THE MASTER SERVICER AND PROVIDENT

   
     The Master Servicer under each Pooling and Servicing Agreement or Master
Servicing Agreement, as  applicable, will be named in  the related Prospectus
Supplement.   Any of  Provident, an affiliate of  Provident or another entity
may serve as Master Servicer.
    

     Each Agreement will provide that the Master Servicer may not resign from
its obligations and duties under the Agreement except upon (a) appointment of
a successor  servicer and receipt by the Trustee  of a letter from the Rating
Agency  that such resignation and appointment  will not result in a downgrade
of the Securities and  (b) a determination that its duties  thereunder are no
longer permissible under  applicable law.  The Master  Servicer may, however,
be removed from its obligations and duties as set forth in the  Agreement. No
such  resignation will  become effective  until  the Trustee  or a  successor
servicer has assumed  the Master Servicer's obligations and  duties under the
Agreement.

     Each Agreement  will further provide  that neither the  Master Servicer,
Provident  nor  any director,  officer,  employee,  or  agent of  the  Master
Servicer or Provident will  be under any liability to the  related Trust Fund
or Securityholders for  any action taken or for refraining from the taking of
any  action  in  good faith  pursuant  to  the Agreement,  or  for  errors in
judgment; provided, however,  that neither the Master Servicer, Provident nor
any such person will be protected against any liability which would otherwise
be imposed by reason of wilful misfeasance, bad faith or gross  negligence in
the  performance of duties  thereunder or by reason  of reckless disregard of
obligations and duties thereunder.   Each Agreement will further provide that
the Master Servicer,  Provident and any director, officer,  employee or agent
of the Master  Servicer or Provident will  be entitled to  indemnification by
the related Trust  Fund and will be held harmless against any loss, liability
or  expense  incurred in  connection with  any legal  action relating  to the
Agreement  or the  Securities,  other  than any  loss,  liability or  expense
related to  any specific Loan  or Loans (except  any such loss,  liability or
expense otherwise  reimbursable  pursuant to  the  Agreement) and  any  loss,
liability or expense incurred  by reason of willful misfeasance, bad faith or
gross negligence  in the  performance of  duties thereunder  or by  reason of
reckless disregard of  obligations and duties thereunder.   In addition, each
Agreement will provide that neither the Master Servicer nor Provident will be
under any obligation to appear in, prosecute or defend any legal action which
is not incidental to its  respective responsibilities under the Agreement and
which in its opinion  may involve it in any expense or liability.  The Master
Servicer  or Provident  may, however,  in its  discretion undertake  any such
action which it may deem necessary or desirable with respect to the Agreement
and the rights  and duties of  the parties thereto  and the interests of  the
Securityholders thereunder.  In such  event, the legal expenses and  costs of
such action and any liability resulting therefrom will be expenses, costs and
liabilities of the Trust  Fund, and the Master Servicer or  Provident, as the
case  may  be,  will be  entitled  to  be reimbursed  therefor  out  of funds
otherwise distributable to Securityholders.

     Except as otherwise specified in  the related Prospectus Supplement, any
person into  which the Master Servicer may be  merged or consolidated, or any
person  resulting  from any  merger  or  consolidation  to which  the  Master
Servicer is a party, or any  person succeeding to the business of  the Master
Servicer, will be the successor of the Master Servicer under each  Agreement,
provided that such person is qualified to sell mortgage loans to, and service
mortgage loans  on behalf of,  FNMA or FHLMC  and further provided  that such
merger,  consolidation  or succession  does  not  adversely  affect the  then
current rating  or ratings  of the  class or  classes of  Securities of  such
Series that have been rated.


EVENTS OF DEFAULT; RIGHTS UPON EVENT OF DEFAULT

     Pooling and Servicing Agreement; Master  Servicing Agreement.  Except as
otherwise specified in the related  Prospectus Supplement, Events of  Default
under each Agreement will  consist of (i) any failure by  the Master Servicer
to make any required deposit pursuant to the related Agreement (other than an
Advance) which continues unremedied for five days after the giving of written
notice  of such failure  to the  Master Servicer  by the  Trustee, or  to the
Master  Servicer and the Trustee by a holder of the Securities of the related
Series; (ii)  any  failure by  the  Master Servicer  to  make an  Advance  as
required under  the Agreement; (iii) any failure  by the Master Servicer duly
to observe or perform in any  material respect any of its other covenants  or
agreements in the Agreement which  continues unremedied for thirty days after
the giving of written  notice of such failure to  the Master Servicer by  the
Trustee,  or to  the  Master Servicer  and  the Trustee  by a  holder  of the
Securities  of the  related Series;  and (iv)  certain events  of insolvency,
readjustments  of  debt, marshalling  of  assets and  liabilities  or similar
proceedings and  certain actions  by  or on  behalf  of the  Master  Servicer
indicating  its   insolvency,  reorganization   or  inability   to  pay   its
obligations.

     If  specified in the  related Prospectus Supplement,  the Agreement will
permit the Trustee to  sell the Trust Fund Assets in  the event that payments
in  respect  thereto  are  insufficient  to make  payments  required  in  the
Agreement.   The Trust Fund Assets will be  sold only under the circumstances
and in the manner specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.

     Unless  otherwise provided in the related Prospectus Supplement, so long
as an Event of Default under an Agreement remains unremedied, the Trustee may
(and at the direction of holders  of Securities evidencing not less than  51%
of the aggregate  Percentage Interests and under such  other circumstances as
may be specified in  such Agreement, the Trustee shall) terminate  all of the
rights and obligations of the Master Servicer under the Agreement relating to
such Trust Fund and in  and to the related  Trust Fund Assets, whereupon  the
Trustee will succeed  to all of the responsibilities,  duties and liabilities
of the  Master Servicer under the  Agreement, including, if specified  in the
related Prospectus Supplement,  the obligation to make Advances,  and will be
entitled to similar compensation arrangements; provided, however, that if the
Event of  Default  results from  the  Master Servicer's  failure  to make  an
Advance, the Trustee shall terminate the Master Servicer.  In the  event that
the Trustee is unwilling or  unable so to act, it may appoint,  or petition a
court  of competent  jurisdiction for  the  appointment of,  a mortgage  loan
servicing institution  with a  net worth  of a  least $50,000,000  to act  as
successor  to  the  Master  Servicer  under  the  Agreement.    Pending  such
appointment, the Trustee is obligated to  act in such capacity.  The  Trustee
and any such successor may agree upon the servicing compensation to  be paid,
which in no event may be greater than the  compensation payable to the Master
Servicer under the Agreement.

     Unless  otherwise  provided  in the  related  Prospectus  Supplement, no
Securityholder, solely by virtue of such holder's status as a Securityholder,
will have  any right  under any  Agreement to  institute any proceeding  with
respect to  such Agreement, unless  such holder  previously has given  to the
Trustee written notice of default and unless the holders of Securities of any
class of such Series evidencing not less than 25% of the aggregate Percentage
Interests constituting such class have  made written request upon the Trustee
to institute such proceeding in its  own name as Trustee thereunder and  have
offered to the Trustee reasonable indemnity, and the Trustee for 60  days has
neglected or refused to institute any such proceeding.

     Indenture.   Except  as otherwise  specified in  the related  Prospectus
Supplement, Events  of Default under the  Indenture for each  Series of Notes
include:  (i) a default in the payment of any principal of or interest on any
Note of  such Series which continues  unremedied for five days  after written
notice of  such  default is  given  as specified  in the  related  Prospectus
Supplement;  (ii)  failure to  perform  in  any  material respect  any  other
covenant of Provident or the Trust Fund in the Indenture which  continues for
a period of thirty days  after notice thereof is given in accordance with the
procedures  described in  the related  Prospectus  Supplement; (iii)  certain
events of bankruptcy, insolvency, receivership or liquidation of Provident or
the Trust Fund; or  (iv) any other Event of Default  provided with respect to
Notes of  that Series including  but not limited  to certain defaults  on the
part  of the  issuer, if any,  of a credit  enhancement instrument supporting
such Notes.

     If  an Event of Default with  respect to the Notes  of any Series at the
time outstanding occurs and is continuing, either the Trustee or  the holders
of a majority of the then  aggregate outstanding amount of the Notes of  such
Series may declare the principal amount (or, if the Notes of that Series have
an interest  rate of  0%, such  portion  of the  principal amount  as may  be
specified in the  terms of that Series, as provided in the related Prospectus
Supplement)  of  all  the  Notes  of  such  Series  to  be  due  and  payable
immediately.  Such declaration may, under certain circumstances, be rescinded
and annulled by the  holders of more than 50% of  the Percentage Interests of
the Notes of such Series.

     If, following an Event of Default  with respect to any Series of  Notes,
the  Notes of  such Series  have been  declared  to be  due and  payable, the
Trustee may,  in its discretion, notwithstanding such  acceleration, elect to
maintain possession of the collateral securing  the Notes of such Series  and
to continue to apply distributions on such collateral as if there had been no
declaration  of  acceleration   if  such  collateral  continues   to  provide
sufficient funds for the payment of principal of and interest on the Notes of
such Series  as they  would have  become due  if there  had not  been such  a
declaration.   In addition, the Trustee  may not sell  or otherwise liquidate
the collateral securing  the Notes of a Series following an Event of Default,
other than a default in the payment of any principal  or interest on any Note
of such Series which continues unremedied for five  days after written notice
of such  default is given as specified  in the related Prospectus Supplement,
unless (a) the holders of  100% of the Percentage  Interests of the Notes  of
such  Series  consent  to  such  sale,  (b)  the proceeds  of  such  sale  or
liquidation  are sufficient  to  pay in  full the  principal  of and  accrued
interest, due and unpaid, on the outstanding Notes of such Series at the date
of such sale  or (c) the Trustee determines that such collateral would not be
sufficient on an  ongoing basis to  make all payments on  such Notes as  such
payments would have become  due if such Notes had  not been declared due  and
payable, and the Trustee obtains  the consent of the holders of 662/3% of the
Percentage Interests of the Notes of such Series.

     In the  event that the  Trustee liquidates the collateral  in connection
with an  Event of Default involving a default in  the payment of principal of
or interest on the Notes of a Series which continues unremedied for five days
after written notice  of such default  is given as  specified in the  related
Prospectus Supplement,  the Indenture provides  that the Trustee will  have a
prior  lien on  the proceeds  of  any such  liquidation for  unpaid  fees and
expenses.   As a result, upon the occurrence of such an Event of Default, the
amount available for distribution to the Noteholders would be less than would
otherwise be  the case.  However, the Trustee  may not institute a proceeding
for the enforcement  of its lien except  in connection with a  proceeding for
the enforcement  of  the  lien  of  the Indenture  for  the  benefit  of  the
Noteholders after the occurrence of such an Event of Default.

     Except as otherwise  specified in the related  Prospectus Supplement, in
the event the principal of the Notes  of a Series is declared due and payable
as  described above, the holders of any  such Notes issued at a discount from
par may  be entitled to receive  no more than  an amount equal to  the unpaid
principal  amount  thereof  less  the   amount  of  such  discount  which  is
unamortized.

     Subject to the provisions of the Indenture relating to the duties of the
Trustee, in  case an  Event of  Default shall  occur and  be continuing  with
respect to  a Series of  Notes, the Trustee  shall be under  no obligation to
exercise any of the  rights or powers under the  Indenture at the request  or
direction of  any of the holders of Notes  of such Series unless such holders
offered to the  Trustee security or indemnity satisfactory to  it against the
costs, expenses and  liabilities which might be  incurred by it in  complying
with  such   request  or   direction.    Subject   to  such   provisions  for
indemnification  and  certain  limitations contained  in  the  Indenture, the
holders of  a majority of the then aggregate  outstanding amount of the Notes
of such Series shall have the  right to direct the time, method and  place of
conducting  any  proceeding  for  any  remedy available  to  the  Trustee  or
exercising any trust  or power conferred on  the Trustee with respect  to the
Notes of such  Series, and the  holders of a  majority of the then  aggregate
outstanding amount of the Notes of  such Series may, in certain cases,  waive
any  default  with  respect  thereto,  except a  default  in  the  payment of
principal or interest  or a default in respect of a  covenant or provision of
the Indenture that  cannot be modified without  the waiver or consent  of all
the holders of the outstanding Notes of such Series affected thereby.

AMENDMENT

   
     Except as otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, each
Agreement may be amended by  Provident, the Master Servicer and the  Trustee,
without the consent of any of the Securityholders, (i) to cure any ambiguity;
(ii) to correct or supplement any provision therein which may be defective or
inconsistent with  any other  provision therein; or  (iii) to make  any other
revisions with respect to matters or questions arising under the  Agreement  
which  are  not  inconsistent  with  the provisions  thereof, provided that 
such  action will not adversely affect  in any material respect the interests
of  any Securityholder.   An  amendment will be  deemed not  to adversely 
affect in any material respect the interests of the Securityholders if the  
person requesting such  amendment obtains  a letter from  each Rating Agency 
requested to  rate the class or  classes of Securities of  such Series stating
that such amendment will not result in the downgrading  or withdrawal
of the respective ratings then assigned to such Securities.  In  addition, to
the extent  provided in  the related Agreement,  an Agreement may  be amended
without the  consent of any  of the Securityholders  to change the  manner in
which the Security Account is maintained, provided  that any such change does
not adversely  affect the  then current  rating on  the class  or classes  of
Securities of such  Series that  have been rated.   In addition,  if a  REMIC
election is made  with respect to a Trust Fund, the  related Agreement may be
amended to  modify, eliminate or add to any  of its provisions to such extent
as may be necessary to maintain  the qualification of the related Trust  Fund
as a REMIC, provided that  the Trustee has received an opinion of  counsel to
the  effect that  such  action  is  necessary or  helpful  to  maintain  such
qualification. Each  Agreement may also  be amended by Provident,  the Master
Servicer and the Trustee with consent of holders of Securities of such Series
evidencing not  less than 51% of  the aggregate Percentage Interests  of each
class  affected  thereby for  the  purpose  of adding  any  provisions  to or
changing in  an manner or eliminating any of  the provisions of the Agreement
or of  modifying in  any  manner the  rights of  the holders  of the  related
Securities; provided, however, that no such amendment may (i) reduce in any
            --------  -------
manner the amount of or delay the timing of, payments received on Loans which
are required  to be distributed  on any Security  without the consent  of the
holder  of  such  Security,  or  (ii)  reduce  the  aforesaid  percentage  of
Securities of any class the  holders of which are required to consent  to any
such amendment without the consent of  the holders of all Securities of  such
class  covered by such  Agreement then outstanding.   If a  REMIC election is
made with  respect to  a Trust  Fund, the  Trustee will  not  be entitled  to
consent  to  an amendment  to  the  related  Agreement without  having  first
received  an opinion of  counsel to the  effect that such  amendment will not
cause such Trust Fund to fail to qualify as a REMIC.
    

TERMINATION; OPTIONAL TERMINATION

     Pooling  and Servicing  Agreement; Trust  Agreement.   Unless  otherwise
specified in the  related Agreement, the obligations created  by each Pooling
and Servicing  Agreement and  Trust Agreement for  each Series  of Securities
will terminate upon the payment to the related Securityholders of all amounts
held in the Security  Account by the Master Servicer and  required to be paid
to them  pursuant to  such Agreement  following the  later of  (i) the  final
payment of or other  liquidation of the last of the Trust Fund Assets subject
thereto  or the disposition of all property  acquired upon foreclosure of any
such Trust Fund Assets  remaining in the Trust Fund and (ii)  the purchase by
the Master Servicer or, if REMIC treatment has been elected and  if specified
in the related Prospectus Supplement, by the holder of the  residual interest
in the REMIC  or any other party  specified to have such right  (see "Federal
Income Tax Consequences"  below), from the related  Trust Fund of all  of the
remaining Trust  Fund Assets  and all  property acquired  in respect  of such
Trust Fund Assets.

     Unless otherwise  specified by  the related  Prospectus Supplement,  any
such purchase of  Trust Fund Assets and property acquired in respect of Trust
Fund Assets evidenced by a Series of Securities will be made at the option of
the Master Servicer, such other person or,  if applicable, such holder of the
REMIC  residual interest,  at a  price  specified in  the related  Prospectus
Supplement.   The exercise of such right will  affect early retirement of the
Securities of that Series,  but the right of the Master  Servicer, such other
person or, if applicable, such holder  of the REMIC residual interest, to  so
purchase is subject to the principal balance of the related Trust Fund Assets
being less than the percentage specified in the related Prospectus Supplement
of the aggregate  principal balance of the  Trust Fund Assets at  the Cut-Off
Date for the Series.   The foregoing  is subject to the  provision that if  a
REMIC election is made with respect to  a Trust Fund, any repurchase pursuant
to clause  (ii)  above will  be made  only in  connection  with a  "qualified
liquidation" of  the REMIC within  the meaning  of Section 860F(g)(4)  of the
Code.

     Indenture.  The Indenture will be discharged with respect to a Series of
Notes  (except with  respect to  certain continuing  rights specified  in the
Indenture) upon the delivery to the Trustee for cancellation of all the Notes
of such Series or, with certain limitations, upon deposit with the Trustee of
funds sufficient for the payment in full of all of the Notes of such Series.

     In  addition to such  discharge with certain  limitations, the Indenture
will provide  that, if so specified with respect  to the Notes of any Series,
the related  Trust Fund will  be discharged from  any and all  obligations in
respect of the Notes of such Series (except  for certain obligations relating
to temporary Notes  and exchange  of Notes,  to register the  transfer of  or
exchange Notes of  such Series, to replace stolen, lost or mutilated Notes of
such Series, to  maintain paying agencies and  to hold monies for  payment in
trust) upon the  deposit with the Trustee,  in trust, of money  and/or direct
obligations  of or  obligations guaranteed  by the  United States  of America
which through  the payment of  interest and principal  in respect  thereof in
accordance with their terms will provide money in an amount sufficient to pay
the principal of and each installment of interest on the Notes of such Series
on the last scheduled Distribution Date for such Notes and any installment of
interest on such Notes in accordance with the terms of the Indenture and  the
Notes  of such Series.  In the event  of any such defeasance and discharge of
Notes of such Series, holders  of Notes of such Series would be  able to look
only to  such money and/or  direct obligations for  payment of principal  and
interest, if any, on their Notes until maturity.

THE TRUSTEE

     The  Trustee  under each  Agreement  will  be  named in  the  applicable
Prospectus  Supplement.   The commercial  bank  or trust  company serving  as
Trustee  may have  normal  banking relationships  with Provident,  the Master
Servicer and any of their respective affiliates.

                      CERTAIN LEGAL ASPECTS OF THE LOANS

     The  following discussion  contains  summaries,  which  are  general  in
nature, of  certain legal matters relating to the  Loans.  Because such legal
aspects are governed primarily by applicable state law (which laws may differ
substantially), the  descriptions do not, except as expressly provided below,
reflect  the laws of any particular state,  nor do they encompass the laws of
all states in which the security for the Loans is situated.  The descriptions
are qualified in  their entirety by reference to the  applicable federal laws
and the appropriate laws of the states in which Loans may be originated.

GENERAL

     The Loans for  a Series  may be  secured by deeds  of trust,  mortgages,
security  deeds  or deeds  to  secure  debt,  depending upon  the  prevailing
practice in the state in which the  property subject to the loan is  located.
Deeds  of  trust  are  used  almost  exclusively  in  California  instead  of
mortgages.  A  mortgage creates a lien  upon the real property  encumbered by
the mortgage,  which lien is generally not prior to  the lien for real estate
taxes and assessments.  Priority between mortgages depends on their terms and
generally on the order of recording with a state or county office.  There are
two  parties to a mortgage,  the mortgagor, who is the  borrower and owner of
the mortgaged property,  and the  mortgagee, who  is the lender.   Under  the
mortgage instrument, the mortgagor delivers to  the mortgagee a note or  bond
and the mortgage.  Although a deed of  trust is similar to a mortgage, a deed
of trust formally  has three parties, the borrower-property  owner called the
trustor (similar  to a mortgagor),  a lender (similar to  a mortgagee) called
the beneficiary, and a third-party grantee called the trustee.  Under  a deed
of  trust, the  borrower grants the  property, irrevocably until  the debt is
paid, in  trust, generally with  a power  of sale, to  the trustee  to secure
payment of  the obligation.   A security deed and  a deed to  secure debt are
special types of deeds which indicate on their face that they are  granted to
secure an underlying debt.   By executing a  security deed or deed to  secure
debt, the  grantor conveys  title to, as  opposed to  merely creating  a lien
upon, the subject property  to the grantee until such time  as the underlying
debt is  repaid.    The  trustee's  authority under  a  deed  of  trust,  the
mortgagee's authority  under a mortgage  and the grantee's authority  under a
security deed or deed to secure debt are governed by law and, with respect to
some deeds of trust, the directions of the beneficiary.

FORECLOSURE/REPOSSESSION

     Deed of Trust.  Foreclosure of a deed of trust is generally accomplished
by a non-judicial sale under a specific  provision in the deed of trust which
authorizes  the trustee  to  sell the  property  at public  auction  upon any
default by  the borrower under the  terms of the note  or deed of trust.   In
certain states, such foreclosure also  may be accomplished by judicial action
in  the manner  provided for foreclosure  of mortgages.   In addition  to any
notice  requirements contained in  a deed of  trust, in some  states (such as
California),  the trustee must record a notice of  default and send a copy to
the borrower-trustor, to  any person who has recorded a request for a copy of
any notice of default and notice of sale, to any successor in interest to the
borrower-trustor,  to the  beneficiary of  any junior  deed of  trust and  to
certain other persons.  In  some states (including California), the borrower-
trustor  has the right  to reinstate the  loan at any  time following default
until shortly before  the trustee's sale.   In general, the borrower,  or any
other person having  a junior encumbrance on  the real estate, may,  during a
statutorily  prescribed  reinstatement  period, cure  a  monetary  default by
paying the entire amount in arrears plus  other designated costs and expenses
incurred  in enforcing  the obligation.   Generally,  state law  controls the
amount of  foreclosure expenses and  costs, including attorney's  fees, which
may be recovered  by a lender.   After the  reinstatement period has  expired
without  the default having been cured, the  borrower or junior lienholder no
longer has the right  to reinstate the loan and must pay the  loan in full to
prevent  the  scheduled  foreclosure sale.    If  the deed  of  trust  is not
reinstated within any applicable cure period, a notice of sale must be posted
in a public place and, in most states (including California), published for a
specific period  of time in one or more  newspapers.  In addition, some state
laws require  that a copy of the notice of sale be posted on the property and
sent to all parties having  an interest of record in  the real property.   In
California, the entire process  from recording a notice of default  to a non-
judicial sale usually takes four to five months.

     Mortgages.    Foreclosure of  a  mortgage is  generally  accomplished by
judicial action.  The action is  initiated by the service of legal  pleadings
upon  all  parties  having an  interest  in  the real  property.    Delays in
completion of the  foreclosure may occasionally  result from difficulties  in
locating necessary parties.   Judicial foreclosure proceedings  are often not
contested by  any of the parties.  When  the mortgagee's right to foreclosure
is contested,  the legal proceedings  necessary to  resolve the issue  can be
time consuming.   After the completion of a  judicial foreclosure proceeding,
the  court generally issues a judgment  of foreclosure and appoints a referee
or other court officer to conduct the sale of the  property.  In some states,
mortgages  may also  be foreclosed by  advertisement, pursuant to  a power of
sale provided in the mortgage.

     Although foreclosure  sales are  typically public  sales, frequently  no
third party  purchaser bids  in excess of  the lender's  lien because  of the
difficulty  of determining  the exact  status of title  to the  property, the
possible deterioration of the property during the foreclosure proceedings and
a requirement that the purchaser pay for the property in cash or by cashier's
check.  Thus  the foreclosing lender  often purchases  the property from  the
trustee or  referee for an  amount equal to the  principal amount outstanding
under the loan,  accrued and unpaid interest and  the expenses of foreclosure
in which event  the mortgagor's debt will  be extinguished or the  lender may
purchase  for a  lesser  amount in  order  to preserve  its  right against  a
borrower  to seek  a deficiency  judgment in  states where  such judgment  is
available.  Thereafter, subject  to the right of the borrower  in some states
to remain in possession during the redemption period, the lender  will assume
the burden of ownership, including obtaining hazard insurance and making such
repairs at its own  expense as are necessary to render  the property suitable
for sale.   The  lender will commonly  obtain the services  of a  real estate
broker  and pay the  broker's commission in  connection with the  sale of the
property.   Depending upon  market conditions, the  ultimate proceeds  of the
sale of the property may not  equal the lender's investment in the  property.
Any  loss may be  reduced by the  receipt of any  mortgage guaranty insurance
proceeds.

     Courts have imposed general equitable principles upon foreclosure, which
are generally designed to mitigate the legal consequences to the  borrower of
the  borrower's defaults  under the  loan documents.   Some courts  have been
faced with  the issue of  whether federal or state  constitutional provisions
reflecting due process concerns for  fair notice require that borrowers under
deeds of trust receive notice longer than that prescribed by statute. For the
most part, these cases have upheld the notice provisions  as being reasonable
or  have found  that the sale  by a  trustee under a  deed of  trust does not
involve sufficient  state action to  afford constitutional protection  to the
borrower.

     When the beneficiary  under a junior mortgage or deed of trust cures the
default  and reinstates or  redeems by paying  the full amount  of the senior
mortgage or  deed of trust, the amount paid by  the beneficiary so to cure or
redeem becomes a part of the  indebtedness secured by the junior mortgage  or
deed of trust.  See "Junior Mortgages; Rights of Senior Mortgagees" below.

ENVIRONMENTAL RISKS

     Real  property  pledged  as  security to  a  lender  may  be subject  to
unforeseen   environmental  risks.    Under  the   laws  of  certain  states,
contamination of a property may give rise to a lien on the property to assure
the payment  of the costs  of clean-up.   In several  states such a  lien has
priority over  the lien of  an existing mortgage  against such property.   In
addition, under  CERCLA, the  United States  Environmental Protection  Agency
("EPA") may impose a lien on property  where EPA has incurred clean-up costs.
However, a  CERCLA lien  is subordinate  to pre-existing,  perfected security
interests.

     Under the laws of some states and under CERCLA, it is conceivable that a
secured  lender may be held liable as  an "owner" or "operator" for the costs
of addressing  releases or threatened  releases of hazardous substances  at a
property, even  though the  environmental damage  or threat  was caused  by a
prior or current owner or operator.  CERCLA imposes liability for  such costs
on any and  all "responsible parties,"  including owners or operators.   How-
ever,  CERCLA excludes from the  definition of "owner  or operator" a secured
creditor who  holds indicia  of ownership primarily  to protect  its security
interest but without  "participating in the management" of  the Property (the
"Secured  Creditor Exclusion").   Thus,  if  a lender's  activities begin  to
encroach on the actual management of a contaminated facility or property, the
lender may incur liability as an "owner or operator" under CERCLA. Similarly,
if  a  lender  forecloses  and takes  title  to  a  contaminated facility  or
property, the  lender may  incur CERCLA liability  in various  circumstances,
including,  but not limited to, when it  holds the facility or property as an
investment (including  leasing the  facility or property  to third  party) or
fails to market the property in a timely fashion.

     Whether actions taken by a  lender would constitute participation in the
management  of a mortgaged property  or the business  of a borrower  so as to
render the secured  creditor exemption  unavailable to  a lender  has been  a
matter of  judicial  interpretation  of  the statutory  language,  and  court
decisions have  been inconsistent.   In 1990,  the Court  of Appeals  for the
Eleventh Circuit  suggested that the mere capacity of the lender to influence
a  borrower's  decisions  regarding  disposal  of  hazardous  substances  was
sufficient participation in the management of the borrower's business to deny
the protection of the Secured Creditor Exclusion to the lender.

     This ambiguity  appears to have  been resolved by  the enactment of  the
Asset Conservation, Lender Liability and Deposit  Insurance Protection Act of
1996, which was signed into law  by President Clinton on September 30,  1996.
The new legislation provides that in order to be deemed to  have participated
in the management of a mortgaged property, a lender must actually participate
in the operational  affairs of the property or the borrower.  The legislation
also provides that participation in  the management of the property  does not
include "merely  having the  capacity to influence,  or unexercised  right to
control"  operations.   Rather,  a lender  will lose  the  protection of  the
Secured Creditor Exclusion only if  it exercises decision-making control over
the  borrower's environmental compliance and hazardous substance handling and
disposal  practices,  or  assumes day-to-day  management  of  all operational
functions of the mortgaged property.    If a lender is or becomes liable, it
can bring an  action for  contribution against any  other "responsible  
parties," including a  previous owner or  operator, who created the 
environmental hazard, but  those persons or  entities may be bankrupt  or
otherwise judgment  proof.  The  costs associated with  environmental cleanup
may be  substantial.   It is  conceivable that  such costs  arising from  the
circumstances set forth above would result in a loss to Securityholders.

     CERCLA does  not apply to  petroleum products, and the  Secured Creditor
Exclusion  does not  govern liability  for cleanup  costs under  federal laws
other  than  CERCLA,  in  particular  Subtitle  I  of  the  federal  Resource
Conservation and Recovery Act ("RCRA"), which regulates underground petroleum
storage tanks  (except heating  oil tanks).   The  EPA has  adopted a  lender
liability rule for underground storage tanks under Subtitle I of RCRA.  Under
such  rule, a holder of a security interest in an underground storage tank or
real property  containing an  underground storage tank  is not  considered an
operator of the  underground storage tank as  long as petroleum is  not added
to, stored  in or  dispensed from  the tank.   In addition,  under the  Asset
Conservation, Lender Liability  and Deposit Insurance Protection Act of 1996,
the protections accorded  to lenders under  CERCLA are also  accorded to  the
holders of  security interests in  underground storage tanks.   Liability for
cleanup of  petroleum contamination may,  however, be governed by  state law,
which may not provide for any specific protection for secured creditors.

     Except as  otherwise specified in the related  Prospectus Supplement, at
the  time the  Loans were  originated, no  environmental assessments  or very
limited environmental assessments of the Properties were conducted.

RIGHTS OF REDEMPTION

     In some states, after sale pursuant to a deed of trust or foreclosure of
a  mortgage, the borrower and foreclosed junior lienors are given a statutory
period in which to redeem the property from the foreclosure sale.  In certain
other states (including California), this right of redemption applies only to
sales following judicial  foreclosure and  not to  sales pursuant  to a  non-
judicial power  of sale.   In most  states where the  right of redemption  is
available, statutory redemption  may occur  upon payment  of the  foreclosure
purchase price,  accrued interest and taxes.  In other states, redemption may
be  authorized if the  former borrower pays  only a portion  of the sums due.
The  effect of a statutory right of  redemption is to diminish the ability of
the  lender to sell  the foreclosed  property.   The exercise  of a  right of
redemption would defeat the title of any purchaser from the lender subsequent
to foreclosure or  sale under a deed  of trust.  Consequently,  the practical
effect of the redemption right is to force the lender to  retain the property
and pay the  expenses of ownership until  the redemption period has run.   In
some states, there  is no  right to  redeem property after  a trustee's  sale
under a deed of trust.

ANTI-DEFICIENCY LEGISLATION; BANKRUPTCY LAWS; TAX LIENS

     Certain states  have imposed  statutory and  judicial restrictions  that
limit the  remedies of  a beneficiary under  a deed  of trust or  a mortgagee
under a mortgage.   In some  states, including California, statutes  and case
law limit the  right of the beneficiary  or mortgagee to obtain  a deficiency
judgment  against  borrowers financing  the  purchase of  their  residence or
following  sale  under   a  deed  of  trust  or   certain  other  foreclosure
proceedings.   A  deficiency  judgment  is a  personal  judgment against  the
borrower equal in  most cases to the difference between the amount due to the
lender and the  fair market value  of the real  property at the  time of  the
foreclosure sale.  As a result of these prohibitions, it is  anticipated that
in  most  instances  the  Master  Servicer  will  utilize  the   non-judicial
foreclosure remedy  and will not seek deficiency judgments against defaulting
borrowers.  

     Some state statutes require the  beneficiary or mortgagee to exhaust the
security afforded  under a  deed of trust  or mortgage  by foreclosure  in an
attempt to  satisfy the full debt  before bringing a personal  action against
the borrower.  In certain other states, the lender has the option of bringing
a  personal action against the borrower  on the debt without first exhausting
such  security; however,  in  some  of these  states,  the lender,  following
judgment on such  personal action, may be deemed to have elected a remedy and
may  be precluded  from exercising  remedies  with respect  to the  security.
Consequently,   the  practical  effect  of  the  election  requirement,  when
applicable, is that  lenders will usually proceed first  against the security
rather than bringing a personal action against the borrower.  In some states,
exceptions to  the  anti-deficiency  statutes are  provided  for  in  certain
instances where the  value of the lender's security has been impaired by acts
or omissions  of the  borrower, for example,  in the  event of  waste of  the
property.  Finally, other statutory provisions limit any deficiency  judgment
against the former borrower following a foreclosure sale to the excess of the
outstanding  debt over the fair  market value of the property  at the time of
the public  sale.  The  purpose of these statutes  is generally to  prevent a
beneficiary or a mortgagee from obtaining a large deficiency judgment against
the former borrower as a result of low or no bids at the foreclosure sale.  

     In addition to  anti-deficiency and related legislation,  numerous other
federal and state statutory provisions, including the federal bankruptcy laws
and state laws affording relief to debtors, may interfere with or  affect the
ability of the  secured mortgage lender  to realize upon  its security.   For
example, in a  proceeding under the federal Bankruptcy Code, a lender may not
foreclose on  a mortgaged property  without the permission of  the bankruptcy
court.  The  rehabilitation plan proposed by  the debtor may provide,  if the
mortgaged  property is  not the  debtor's principal  residence and  the court
determines  that  the  value  of the  mortgaged  property  is  less than  the
principal balance  of the  mortgage loan,  for the  reduction of the  secured
indebtedness to the  value of the  mortgaged property as  of the date  of the
commencement  of the  bankruptcy, rendering  the  lender a  general unsecured
creditor for the  difference, and also  may reduce the  monthly payments  due
under such mortgage  loan, change the rate of interest and alter the mortgage
loan  repayment schedule.   The  effect  of any  such  proceedings under  the
federal Bankruptcy  Code, including  but not limited  to any  automatic stay,
could result in delays in receiving payments on the Loans underlying a Series
of  Securities  and possible  reductions  in  the  aggregate amount  of  such
payments.

     The federal tax laws provide priority to certain tax liens over the lien
of a mortgage or secured party.  

DUE-ON-SALE CLAUSES

   
     Each conventional Loan generally will contain a due-on-sale clause which
will generally provide  that if the mortgagor or obligor  sells, transfers or
conveys  the  Property,  the Loan  or  contract  may  be  accelerated by  the
mortgagee or  secured party.   Court decisions  and legislative  actions have
placed  substantial restrictions  on the  right  of lenders  to enforce  such
clauses in many states.  For instance, the California Supreme Court in August
1978 held  that due-on-sale clauses  were generally unenforceable.   However,
the Garn-St Germain Depository Institutions Act of 1982 (the "Garn-St Germain
Act"),  subject   to  certain  exceptions,  preempts   state  constitutional,
statutory and  case law prohibiting  the enforcement of  due-on-sale clauses.
As a  result, due-on-sale clauses  are generally enforceable except  in those
states  whose  legislatures   exercised  their  authority  to   regulate  the
enforceability of such  clauses  with respect to mortgage loans that were (i)
originated or  assumed during the  "window period" under the  Garn-St Germain
Act  which ended  in all  cases not  later than  October  15, 1982,  and (ii)
originated by lenders other than national banks, federal savings institutions
and  federal credit unions.   FHLMC has  taken the position  in its published
mortgage servicing standards that,  out of a total  of eleven "window  period
states," five states (Arizona, Michigan, Minnesota, New Mexico and Utah) have
enacted statutes  extending, on  various terms and  for varying  periods, the
prohibition on enforcement  of due-on-sale  clauses with  respect to  certain
categories  of "window  period loans".   Also, the  Garn-St Germain  Act does
"encourage" lenders  to permit  assumption of loans  at the original  rate of
interest or at some other rate less than the average of the original rate and
the market rate.
    

     As to loans secured by  an owner-occupied residence, the Garn-St Germain
Act sets forth  nine specific instances in  which a mortgagee covered  by the
Act may not  exercise its rights under a  due-on-sale clause, notwithstanding
the fact that a transfer of the property may have occurred.  The inability to
enforce a due-on-sale clause may  result in transfer of the related  Property
to an uncreditworthy  person, which could increase the  likelihood of default
or may result in a mortgage bearing an interest rate below the current market
rate being  assumed by a new home buyer, which may affect the average life of
the Loans and the number of Loans which may extend to maturity.

     In addition, under federal  bankruptcy law, due-on-sale clauses may  not
be   enforceable   in   bankruptcy  proceedings   and   may,   under  certain
circumstances, be eliminated  in any  modified mortgage  resulting from  such
bankruptcy proceeding.

ENFORCEABILITY OF PREPAYMENT AND LATE PAYMENT FEES

     Forms of notes, mortgages and deeds of trust used by lenders may contain
provisions obligating the borrower  to pay a late charge if  payments are not
timely made,  and in some  circumstances may  provide for prepayment  fees or
penalties if the  obligation is paid prior  to maturity.  In  certain states,
there are or may be specific limitations upon the late charges which a lender
may  collect from a  borrower for delinquent  payments.  Certain  states also
limit the amounts that  a lender may collect from a borrower as an additional
charge if the loan is prepaid.   Under certain state laws, prepayment charges
may not be imposed after a  certain period of time following the  origination
of mortgage  loans  with respect  to prepayments  on loans  secured by  liens
encumbering  owner-occupied  residential  properties.    Since  many  of  the
Properties will be owner-occupied, it  is anticipated that prepayment charges
may not be imposed with respect to many of the Loans.  The  absence of such a
restraint on prepayment, particularly with respect to fixed rate Loans having
higher Loan Rates, may increase the likelihood  of refinancing or other early
retirement of such Loans or contracts.  Late charges and prepayment  fees are
typically retained by servicers as additional servicing compensation.

APPLICABILITY OF USURY LAWS

     Title V of the Depository Institutions Deregulation and Monetary Control
Act of 1980 ("Title V") provides that state usury limitations shall not apply
to certain  types of residential  first mortgage loans originated  by certain
lenders after March 31, 1980.  The Office of Thrift Supervision, as successor
to the  Federal  Home Loan  Bank  Board, is  authorized  to issue  rules  and
regulations  and to publish interpretations governing implementation of Title
V.   Title  V  authorized the  states  to reimpose  interest  rate limits  by
adopting,  before April  1, 1983,  a  law or  constitutional provision  which
expressly rejects  application of  the federal law.   Fifteen  states adopted
such a  law prior to  the April  1, 1983 deadline.   In addition,  even where
Title V was  not so rejected, any state  is authorized by the law  to adopt a
provision limiting discount points or other charges on mortgage loans covered
by Title  V.   Certain states  have taken  action to  reimpose interest  rate
limits and/or to limit discount points or other charges.

   
    

SOLDIERS' AND SAILORS' CIVIL RELIEF ACT

     Generally, under  the terms of  the Soldiers' and Sailors'  Civil Relief
Act of 1940,  as amended (the "Relief  Act"), a borrower who  enters military
service after the  origination of such borrower's Loan  (including a borrower
who is a member of the National Guard or is in reserve status  at the time of
the origination of  the Loan and is later  called to active duty)  may not be
charged interest  above  an annual  rate  of 6%  during  the period  of  such
borrower's  active  duty  status,  unless  a   court  orders  otherwise  upon
application of the lender.  It is possible that such interest rate limitation
could have an effect,  for an indeterminate period of time, on the ability of
the Master Servicer  to collect full  amounts of interest  on certain of  the
Loans.  Unless  otherwise provided in the related  Prospectus Supplement, any
shortfall in  interest  collections resulting  from  the application  of  the
Relief Act could  result in losses to  Securityholders.  The Relief  Act also
imposes limitations  which would impair the ability of the Master Servicer to
foreclose on an  affected Loan  during the borrower's  period of active  duty
status.  Moreover, the Relief Act permits  the extension of a Loan's maturity
and  the re-adjustment  of  its  payment schedule  beyond  the completion  of
military service.   Thus, in  the event that  such a Loan goes  into default,
there may be  delays and losses occasioned  by the inability to  realize upon
the Property in a timely fashion.

JUNIOR MORTGAGES; RIGHTS OF SENIOR MORTGAGEES

     To  the extent that the Loans comprising the Trust Fund for a Series are
secured by  mortgages which  are  junior to  other  mortgages held  by  other
lenders  or  institutional investors,  the  rights  of  the Trust  Fund  (and
therefore  the Securityholders) as  mortgagee under any  such junior mortgage
are subordinate to  those of any  mortgagee under any  senior mortgage.   The
senior mortgagee has  the right to receive hazard  insurance and condemnation
proceeds and to cause the property securing the Loan to be sold upon  default
of the mortgagor,  thereby extinguishing the  junior mortgagee's lien  unless
the  junior mortgagee  asserts its  subordinate interest  in the  property in
foreclosure  litigation   and,  possibly,  satisfies  the   defaulted  senior
mortgage.  A  junior mortgagee may  satisfy a defaulted  senior loan in  full
and, in some states, may cure a default and bring the senior loan current, in
either  event adding the  amounts expended to  the balance due  on the junior
loan.  In most states, absent  a provision in the mortgage or deed  of trust,
no notice of default is required to be given to a junior mortgagee.

     The standard  form of  the mortgage used  by most  institutional lenders
confers on  the mortgagee the  right both to  receive all proceeds  collected
under  any hazard  insurance policy  and all  awards made in  connection with
condemnation  proceedings, and  to  apply  such proceeds  and  awards to  any
indebtedness secured by  the mortgage,  in such  order as  the mortgagee  may
determine.  Thus,  in the event improvements  on the property are  damaged or
destroyed by fire or other casualty, or in the event the property is taken by
condemnation, the mortgagee or beneficiary  under a senior mortgage will have
the prior  right to  collect any  insurance proceeds  payable under a  hazard
insurance policy and any award of damages in connection with the condemnation
and to  apply the same  to the indebtedness  secured by the  senior mortgage.
Proceeds in excess  of the amount  of senior mortgage  indebtedness, in  most
cases, may be applied to the indebtedness of a junior mortgage.

     Another provision sometimes found in the form of the mortgage or deed of
trust used  by institutional  lenders obligates the  mortgagor to  pay before
delinquency all  taxes and assessments  on the  property and,  when due,  all
encumbrances,  charges and liens  on the property  which appear prior  to the
mortgage or deed  of trust,  to provide  and maintain fire  insurance on  the
property, to maintain and repair the property and not to commit or permit any
waste  thereof,  and  to  appear  in and  defend  any  action  or  proceeding
purporting to affect  the property or the  rights of the mortgagee  under the
mortgage.    Upon  a failure  of  the  mortgagor  to  perform  any  of  these
obligations,  the mortgagee  is given  the right  under certain  mortgages to
perform  the  obligation  itself,   at  its  election,  with   the  mortgagor
reimbursing the mortgagee for any sums expended by the mortgagee on behalf of
the  mortgagor.   All sums so  expended by  the mortgagee become  part of the
indebtedness secured by the mortgage.

     The form of  credit line trust deed  or mortgage generally used  by most
institutional  lenders which  make  Revolving  Credit  Line  Loans  typically
contains  a  "future  advance"  clause,  which  provides,  in  essence,  that
additional  amounts  advanced  to  or  on  behalf  of  the  borrower  by  the
beneficiary or  lender are to  be secured by the  deed of trust  or mortgage.
Any amounts so advanced after the  Cut-Off Date with respect to any  Mortgage
will not be included in  the Trust Fund.  The  priority of the lien  securing
any advance made under the  clause may depend in  most states on whether  the
deed of trust  or mortgage is called  and recorded as  a credit line deed  of
trust or mortgage.  If the beneficiary or lender advances additional amounts,
the  advance is entitled  to receive the  same priority as  amounts initially
advanced  under the  trust deed  or mortgage,  notwithstanding the  fact that
there may be junior trust deeds or mortgages and other liens  which intervene
between the date of  recording of the trust deed or mortgage  and the date of
the future  advance, and notwithstanding  that the beneficiary or  lender had
actual  knowledge of  such intervening  junior trust  deeds or  mortgages and
other liens  at the time of the  advance.  In most states,  the trust deed or
mortgage lien securing  mortgage loans of the type which includes home equity
credit lines applies  retroactively to the date of the  original recording of
the trust deed or mortgage, provided that  the total amount of advances under
the  home equity credit line does  not exceed the maximum specified principal
amount  of the recorded trust deed or mortgage and except as to advances made
after receipt by the lender of a written  notice of lien from a judgment lien
creditor of the trustor.

CONSUMER PROTECTION LAWS

     Numerous federal and  state consumer protection laws  impose substantive
requirements  upon mortgage lenders in connection with originating, servicing
and enforcing loans secured by Single  Family Properties.  These laws include
the federal  Truth-in-Lending Act  and Regulation  Z promulgated  thereunder,
Real   Estate  Settlement  Procedures   Act  and  Regulation   B  promulgated
thereunder,  Equal Credit  Opportunity  Act, Fair  Credit  Billing Act,  Fair
Credit Reporting  Act and related  statutes and regulations.   In particular,
Regulation Z requires certain disclosures to borrowers regarding terms of the
Loans;  the  Equal  Credit  Opportunity  Act  and  Regulation  B  promulgated
thereunder prohibit discrimination in the extension of credit on the basis of
age, race, color, sex, religion,  marital status, national origin, receipt of
public  assistance or  the exercise  of any right  under the  Consumer Credit
Protection Act;  and the  Fair Credit  Reporting Act  regulates  the use  and
reporting  of  information  related  to  the  borrower's  credit  experience.
Certain provisions of these  laws impose specific statutory liabilities  upon
lenders who  fail to comply therewith.  In  addition, violations of such laws
may limit the ability of Provident to collect all or part of the principal of
or interest on  the Loans and could  subject Provident and in  some cases its
assignees to damages and administrative enforcement.


                       FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES

GENERAL

     The following  is a summary  of the anticipated material  federal income
tax  consequences  of  the  purchase,  ownership,  and  disposition   of  the
Securities  and is based  on advice of  Brown & Wood LLP,  special counsel to
Provident.    The summary  is  based upon  the  provisions of  the  Code, the
regulations  promulgated thereunder,  including,  where applicable,  proposed
regulations, and the judicial and administrative rulings and decisions now in
effect,  all   of  which  are   subject  to  change  or   possible  differing
interpretations.   The statutory provisions, regulations, and interpretations
on which  this interpretation  is based  are subject  to change,  and such  a
change could apply retroactively.

     The summary does not purport to deal with all aspects of  federal income
taxation that  may affect particular  investors in light of  their individual
circumstances,  nor  with  certain  types of  investors  subject  to  special
treatment under  the federal income tax laws.  This summary focuses primarily
upon  investors  who will  hold  Securities as  "capital  assets" (generally,
property held for investment) within the meaning of Section 1221 of the Code,
but  much  of  the  discussion is  applicable  to  other  investors  as well.
Prospective  investors  are  advised  to  consult   their  own  tax  advisers
concerning the federal, state,  local and any other tax  consequences to them
of the purchase, ownership and disposition of the Securities.

     The federal  income tax consequences  to Holders will vary  depending on
whether  (i) the Securities of a  Series are classified as indebtedness; (ii)
an  election is made to treat the Trust  Fund relating to a particular Series
of Securities as  a REMIC under the  Code; (iii) the Securities  represent an
ownership interest in some  or all of the  assets included in the  Trust Fund
for a Series; or (iv) an election is made to treat the Trust Fund relating to
a  particular  Series of  Certificates  as  a  partnership.   The  Prospectus
Supplement for each Series of Securities will specify how the Securities will
be treated for federal  income tax purposes and will discuss  whether a REMIC
election,  if any,  will be  made  with respect  to  such Series.   Prior  to
issuance  of  each  Series  of  Securities, Provident  shall  file  with  the
Commission a  Form 8-K  on behalf  of the  related Trust  Fund containing  an
opinion of Brown & Wood LLP with  respect to the validity of the  information
set forth under  "Federal Income Tax Consequences" herein  and in the related
Prospectus Supplement.

TAXATION OF DEBT SECURITIES

     Status  as Real Property Loans.  Except to the extent otherwise provided
in  the related  Prospectus Supplement,  Brown & Wood  LLP will  have advised
Provident  that:   (i)  Securities  held  by  a  domestic building  and  loan
association  will  constitute  "loans...  secured  by  an  interest  in  real
property" within  the meaning  of  Code section  7701(a)(19)(C)(v); and  (ii)
Securities  held by  a real  estate  investment trust  will constitute  "real
estate assets" within  the meaning of Code section  856(c)(5)(A) and interest
on such  Securities will  be considered "interest  on obligations  secured by
mortgages  on real  property or  on interests  in real  property" within  the
meaning of Code section 856(c)(3)(B).

     The Small Business  Job Protection Act of 1996, as part of the repeal of
the bad debt reserve method for thrift institutions, repealed the application
of Code section 593(d) to any taxable year beginning after December 31, 1995.

     Interest  and Acquisition  Discount.    Securities representing  regular
interests in a REMIC ("Regular Interest Securities") are generally taxable to
Holders in the  same manner as evidences of indebtedness issued by the REMIC.
Stated  interest  on the  Regular  Interest  Securities  will be  taxable  as
ordinary  income  and  taken  into   account  using  the  accrual  method  of
accounting, regardless  of the Holder's  normal accounting method.   Interest
(other  than  original  issue  discount) on  Securities  (other  than Regular
Interest  Securities)  that  are characterized  as  indebtedness  for federal
income  tax purposes  will be  includible  in income  by  Holders thereof  in
accordance with their usual methods  of accounting.  Securities characterized
as debt for federal income tax purposes  and Regular Interest Securities will
be referred to hereinafter collectively as "Debt Securities."

     Debt Securities that  are Compound Interest Securities will, and certain
of the other Debt  Securities may, be issued  with "original issue  discount"
("OID").  The  following discussion is based  in part on the  rules governing
OID which are  set forth in Sections 1271-1275  of the Code and  the Treasury
regulations issued thereunder on February 2, 1994 (the "OID Regulations").  A
Holder should be aware,  however, that the OID Regulations  do not adequately
address certain  issues relevant to  prepayable securities, such as  the Debt
Securities.

     In general,  OID, if any,  will equal the difference  between the stated
redemption price at  maturity of  a Debt  Security and  its issue  price.   A
Holder of a  Debt Security must include such OID in  gross income as ordinary
interest income as it accrues under a  method taking into account an economic
accrual of  the discount.   In general,  OID must  be included  in income  in
advance of the receipt of  the cash representing that income.  The  amount of
OID on a  Debt Security will be considered to be zero if it is less than a de
minimis amount determined under the Code.

     The issue  price  of a  Debt Security  is  the first  price  at which  a
substantial amount of  Debt Securities of that  class are sold to  the public
(excluding bond houses, brokers, underwriters  or wholesalers).  If less than
a substantial amount  of a particular  class of Debt  Securities is sold  for
cash on or prior to the related  Closing Date, the issue price for such class
will be treated as the fair market value of such  class on such Closing Date.
The issue  price of  a Debt  Security  also includes  the amount  paid by  an
initial  Debt Security Holder  for accrued interest that  relates to a period
prior to the issue date of the Debt Security.  The stated redemption price at
maturity of  a Debt Security  includes the original  principal amount of  the
Debt Security,  but generally will  not include distributions of  interest if
such distributions constitute "qualified stated interest."

     Under the  OID Regulations,  qualified stated  interest generally  means
interest payable  at  a single  fixed  rate or  qualified  variable rate  (as
described below)  provided that  such interest  payments are  unconditionally
payable at  intervals of one year or less during  the entire term of the Debt
Security.     The   OID  Regulations   state   that  interest   payments  are
unconditionally payable only if a  late payment or nonpayment is expected  to
be penalized or  reasonable remedies exist  to compel payment.   Certain Debt
Securities may  provide for default remedies in the  event of late payment or
nonpayment  of  interest.   The  interest  on such  Debt  Securities will  be
unconditionally  payable and constitute  qualified stated interest,  not OID.
However, absent clarification of the  OID Regulations, where Debt  Securities
do  not provide for default remedies,  the interest payments will be included
in the Debt  Security's stated redemption price at maturity and taxed as OID.
Interest  is payable at  a single fixed  rate only if  the rate appropriately
takes   into   account  the   length  of   the  interval   between  payments.
Distributions of interest  on Debt Securities with respect  to which deferred
interest will accrue, will not constitute qualified stated interest payments,
in which case the stated redemption price at maturity of such Debt Securities
includes all distributions of  interest as well as principal  thereon.  Where
the interval between the issue date and the first Distribution Date on a Debt
Security is  either longer  or shorter than  the interval  between subsequent
Distribution Dates, all or part  of the interest foregone, in the case of the
longer interval,  and all  of the  additional interest,  in the  case of  the
shorter interval, will be included in the stated redemption price at maturity
and tested  under the de minimis rule described below.  In the case of a Debt
Security with a  long first period which  has non-de minimis OID,  all stated
interest in excess of interest payable at the effective interest rate for the
long first period will be included in the stated redemption price at maturity
and the Debt  Security will generally have  OID.  Holders of  Debt Securities
should consult their own tax advisors to determine the issue price and stated
redemption price at maturity of a Debt Security.

     Under the de minimis rule, OID on a  Debt Security will be considered to
be zero if  such OID is  less than  0.25% of the  stated redemption price  at
maturity of the Debt Security multiplied by the weighted average maturity  of
the Debt Security.   For this purpose,  the weighted average maturity  of the
Debt Security is computed as the sum of the amounts determined by multiplying
the number  of full years (i.e., rounding down  partial years) from the issue
date  until each  distribution in  reduction  of stated  redemption price  at
maturity is scheduled to be made by a fraction, the numerator of which is the
amount  of each  distribution  included  in the  stated  redemption price  at
maturity of the  Debt Security  and the  denominator of which  is the  stated
redemption price  at maturity of the  Debt Security.  Holders  generally must
report de  minimis OID pro rata as principal  payments are received, and such
income will be capital gain if the Debt Security is  held as a capital asset.
However, accrual  method Holders may  elect to accrue  all de minimis  OID as
well as market discount under a constant interest method.

   
     Debt Securities may  provide for interest based on  a qualified variable
rate.   Under  the OID  Regulations,  interest is  treated  as payable  at  a
qualified variable  rate and  not as contingent  interest if,  generally, (i)
such interest  is unconditionally payable  at least annually, (ii)  the issue
price  of  the  debt  instrument  does not  exceed  the  total  noncontingent
principal  payments and  (iii) interest  is  based on  a "qualified  floating
rate," an  "objective rate," or  a combination of "qualified  floating rates"
that do  not operate in  a manner  that significantly  accelerates or  defers
interest payments on  such Debt Security.   In the case of  Compound Interest
Securities, certain Interest Weighted Securities (as defined herein under "--
Interest Weighted  Securities"), and  certain of  the other  Debt Securities,
none of the payments under the instrument will be considered qualified stated
interest, and thus the aggregate amount  of all payments will be included  in
the stated redemption price.
    

     The  Internal  Revenue   Service  (the  "IRS")  recently   issued  final
regulations (the "Contingent  Regulations") governing the calculation  of OID
on  instruments  having   contingent  interest  payments.     The  Contingent
Regulations specifically do not apply for purposes of calculating OID on debt
instruments subject  to Code Section  1272(a)(6), such as the  Debt Security.
Additionally,  the OID  Regulations do  not  contain provisions  specifically
interpreting Code Section 1272(a)(6).   Until the Treasury issues guidance to
the contrary,  the Trustee intends  to base  its computation on  Code Section
1272(a)(6) and the OID Regulations as described in this Prospectus.  However,
because   no  regulatory  guidance   currently  exists  under   Code  Section
1272(a)(6), there  can be no  assurance that such methodology  represents the
correct manner of calculating OID.

     The Holder  of a  Debt Security issued  with OID  must include  in gross
income, for  all days  during its taxable  year on which  it holds  such Debt
Security, the sum  of the "daily portions"  of such OID.   The amount of  OID
includible  in income by a Holder will  be computed by allocating to each day
during a taxable year a pro  rata portion of the OID that accrued  during the
relevant  accrual period.   In  the case  of a  Debt Security  that is  not a
Regular Interest Security and the principal payments on which are not subject
to acceleration resulting  from prepayments on  the Loans, the amount  of OID
includible in income  of a Holder for an accrual period (generally the period
over which interest accrues on the debt instrument) will equal the product of
the yield to maturity  of the Debt Security and  the adjusted issue price  of
the Debt Security, reduced by any payments of qualified stated interest.  The
adjusted issue  price is the  sum of its  issue price plus prior  accruals or
OID, reduced by the total payments made with respect to such Debt Security in
all prior periods, other than qualified stated interest payments.

     The  amount  of OID  to be  included in  income  by a  Holder of  a debt
instrument, such as certain Classes  of the Debt Securities, that is  subject
to acceleration  due to prepayments  on other debt obligations  securing such
instruments (a "Pay-Through  Security"), is computed  by taking into  account
the anticipated  rate of prepayments  assumed in pricing the  debt instrument
(the "Prepayment Assumption").  The amount of OID that will accrue  during an
accrual period on a Pay-Through Security is the excess (if any) of the sum of
(a) the present value of all payments remaining to be made on the Pay-Through
Security  as of the close  of the accrual period  and (b) the payments during
the accrual period of amounts included in  the stated redemption price of the
Pay-Through  Security,  over the  adjusted  issue  price of  the  Pay-Through
Security at the  beginning of the accrual  period.  The present  value of the
remaining payments is  to be determined on the  basis of three factors:   (i)
the original yield to maturity of the Pay-Through Security (determined on the
basis of compounding at the end of each accrual period and  properly adjusted
for the length of the accrual period), (ii) events which have occurred before
the end  of the accrual  period and (iii)  the assumption that  the remaining
payments will be made in  accordance with the original Prepayment Assumption.
The effect of this method is to  increase the portions of OID required to  be
included in income  by a Holder to take into account prepayments with respect
to the  Loans  at a  rate  that exceeds  the  Prepayment Assumption,  and  to
decrease (but not below zero  for any period) the portions of OID required to
be included  in income by  a Holder  of a Pay-Through  Security to take  into
account prepayments with respect to  the Loans at a rate that is  slower than
the Prepayment  Assumption.   Although  OID will  be reported  to Holders  of
Pay-Through  Securities based on the Prepayment Assumption, no representation
is made to  Holders that Loans will be  prepaid at that rate or  at any other
rate.

     Provident may  adjust the accrual of OID on  a Class of Regular Interest
Securities  (or  other regular  interests in  a  REMIC) in  a manner  that it
believes to be appropriate to take  account of realized losses on the  Loans,
although the OID Regulations do not provide for such adjustments.  If the IRS
were to require  that OID be  accrued without such  adjustments, the rate  of
accrual of OID for a Class of Regular Interest Securities could increase.

     Certain  classes of Regular Interest  Securities may represent more than
one class  of REMIC  regular interests.   Unless  otherwise  provided in  the
related  Prospectus  Supplement,  the  Trustee  intends,  based  on  the  OID
Regulations,  to  calculate OID  on  such Securities  as if,  solely  for the
purposes of computing OID, the separate regular interests were  a single debt
instrument.

     A subsequent Holder  of a Debt Security will also be required to include
OID in gross income, but such  a Holder who purchases such Debt Security  for
an amount that exceeds its adjusted issue price  will be entitled (as will an
initial Holder who  pays more than a  Debt Security's issue price)  to offset
such OID by comparable economic accruals of portions of such excess.

     Effects  of Defaults  and Delinquencies.   Holders  will be  required to
report income with respect to the related Securities under  an accrual method
without giving  effect to delays and reductions in distributions attributable
to a default or  delinquency on the Loans, except possibly to the extent that
it can be established that such amounts are uncollectible.   As a result, the
amount of income (including  OID) reported by a Holder of such  a Security in
any period could significantly exceed the amount of  cash distributed to such
Holder in that period.  The Holder will eventually be allowed a loss (or will
be  allowed to  report a  lesser amount  of income)  to  the extent  that the
aggregate amount of distributions on the  Securities is deducted as a  result
of  a Loan  default.   However, the timing  and character  of such  losses or
reductions in  income are uncertain  and, accordingly, Holders  of Securities
should consult their own tax advisors on this point.

     Interest Weighted  Securities.   It is  not clear how  income should  be
accrued  with respect to  Regular Interest Securities  or Stripped Securities
(as defined  under "--Tax  Status as  a Grantor  Trust; General"  herein) the
payments on which consist solely or  primarily of a specified portion of  the
interest  payments  on qualified  mortgages  held by  the  REMIC or  on Loans
underlying  Pass-Through Securities  ("Interest Weighted  Securities").   The
Issuer intends  to take the position that  all of the income  derived from an
Interest Weighted  Security should be treated as OID  and that the amount and
rate of accrual  of such OID  should be calculated  by treating the  Interest
Weighted Security as a Compound Interest  Security.  However, in the case  of
Interest Weighted Securities that are  entitled to some payments of principal
and that  are Regular Interest Securities,  the IRS could  assert that income
derived from an  Interest Weighted  Security should be  calculated as if  the
Security were a  security purchased at a  premium equal to the  excess of the
price paid by such Holder for such Security over its stated principal amount,
if any.   Under this approach,  a Holder would  be entitled to  amortize such
premium only if it  has in effect an  election under Section 171 of  the Code
with  respect  to  all  taxable  debt instruments  held  by  such  Holder, as
described  below.   Alternatively,  the  IRS could  assert  that an  Interest
Weighted Security  should be taxable  under the rules governing  bonds issued
with contingent payments.  Such treatment  may be more likely in the case  of
Interest Weighted Securities that are Stripped Securities as described below.
See  "--Tax Status  as a Grantor  Trust; Discount or  Premium on Pass-Through
Securities."

     Variable Rate Debt Securities.   In the case of Debt Securities  bearing
interest at a rate  that varies directly, according to a  fixed formula, with
an objective index,  it appears that (i) the  yield to maturity of  such Debt
Securities and (ii)  in the case of Pay-Through Securities, the present value
of all  payments remaining  to be  made on  such Debt  Securities, should  be
calculated as if  the interest index  remained at its  value as of  the issue
date of such Securities.  Because the proper method of adjusting  accruals of
OID on a variable  rate Debt Security is uncertain, Holders  of variable rate
Debt  Securities   should  consult  their  own  tax  advisers  regarding  the
appropriate treatment of such Securities for federal income tax purposes.

     Market Discount.  
   
                       A purchaser of a Security may be subject to the market
discount rules of Sections 1276-1278 of the  Code.  A Holder that acquires  a
Debt  Security with  more  than a  prescribed  de minimis  amount  of "market
discount" (generally, the excess of the principal amount of the Debt Security
over  the purchaser's  purchase price)  will be  required to  include accrued
market discount in income as ordinary income in each month, but limited to an
amount not exceeding the principal payments on the Debt  Security received in
that month and, if  the Securities are sold, the gain realized.   Such market
discount would accrue in a manner to be provided in Treasury regulations but,
until  such regulations  are issued,  such market  discount would  in general
accrue  either  (i) on  the basis  of  a constant  yield  (in the  case  of a
Pay-Through Security, taking into account a prepayment assumption) or (ii) in
the ratio  of (a) in the case of Securities (or in the case of a Pass-Through
Security (as defined herein under "--Tax Status as a Grantor Trust"),  as set
forth below, the  Loans underlying such Security) not  originally issued with
OID, stated interest payable in the  relevant period to total stated interest
remaining to  be paid at the  beginning of the period  or (b) in the  case of
Securities  (or, in the case of  a Pass-Through Security, as described below,
the Loans underlying  such Security) originally issued at  a discount, OID in
the relevant period to total OID remaining to be paid.
    

     Section 1277  of the Code  provides that, regardless of  the origination
date of the  Debt Security (or, in  the case of a  Pass-Through Security, the
Loans),  the  excess of  interest  paid or  accrued  to purchase  or  carry a
Security (or, in the case of a Pass-Through Security, as described below, the
underlying  Loans)  with  market  discount  over  interest received  on  such
Security is allowed as a current deduction only to the extent such excess  is
greater than the  market discount  that accrued  during the  taxable year  in
which  such interest expense was incurred.   In general, the deferred portion
of  any interest  expense will  be  deductible when  such market  discount is
included in income, including upon the sale, disposition, or repayment of the
Security (or in the case of a Pass-Through Security, an underlying Loan).   A
Holder  may elect  to  include  market discount  in  income  currently as  it
accrues, on  all market discount  obligations acquired by such  Holder during
the taxable  year such  election is made  and thereafter,  in which  case the
interest deferral rule will not apply.

     Premium.  A Holder who purchases a Debt Security (other than an Interest
Weighted Security to the  extent described above) at a cost  greater than its
stated redemption  price at  maturity, generally will  be considered  to have
purchased the Security  at a premium, which  it may elect  to amortize as  an
offset to interest income  on such Security (and not as  a separate deduction
item) on a  constant yield  method.  Although  no regulations addressing  the
computation of premium  accrual on securities similar to  the Securities have
been issued, the legislative history  of the 1986 Act indicates that  premium
is  to be accrued  in the same  manner as  market discount.   Accordingly, it
appears that the accrual of premium on a Class of Pay-Through Securities will
be calculated using the Prepayment Assumption used in pricing such Class.  If
a Holder  makes an  election to  amortize premium  on a  Debt Security,  such
election  will apply  to all  taxable debt  instruments (including  all REMIC
regular interests  and all pass-through  certificates representing  ownership
interests  in a  trust holding debt  obligations) held  by the Holder  at the
beginning  of the  taxable year  in which the  election is  made, and  to all
taxable  debt instruments  acquired thereafter  by such  Holder, and  will be
irrevocable without the consent of the IRS.  Purchasers who pay a premium for
the Securities  should consult their  tax advisers regarding the  election to
amortize premium and the method to be employed.

     On June 27, 1996, the  IRS issued proposed regulations (the "Amortizable
Bond  Premium Regulations")  dealing with  amortizable bond  premium.   These
regulations specifically do not apply  to prepayable debt instruments subject
to  Code Section 1272(a)(6) such as  the Securities.  Absent further guidance
from the IRS, the Trustee intends to  account for amortizable bond premium in
the manner described above.   Prospective purchasers of the Securities should
consult  their  tax  advisors  regarding  the  possible  application  of  the
Amortizable Bond Premium Regulations.

     Election  to Treat  All Interest as  Original Issue  Discount.   The OID
Regulations  permit  a Holder  of  a Debt  Security  to elect  to  accrue all
interest, discount (including  de minimis market or  original issue discount)
and  premium income as  interest, based on  a constant yield  method for Debt
Securities acquired on or after April 4,  1994.  If such an election were  to
be made with respect to a  Debt Security with market discount, the  Holder of
the  Debt Security would  be deemed  to have made  an election  to include in
income currently market  discount with respect to all  other debt instruments
having market discount that  such Holder of the Debt Security acquires during
the  year of  the election  or thereafter.   Similarly,  a  Holder of  a Debt
Security that makes this election  for a Debt Security that is  acquired at a
premium will be deemed to have made an election to amortize bond premium with
respect to  all debt  instruments having amortizable  bond premium  that such
Holder owns  or acquires.   The  election to  accrue  interest, discount  and
premium  on a  constant  yield method  with  respect to  a  Debt Security  is
irrevocable.

TAXATION OF THE REMIC AND ITS HOLDERS

     General.    In  the opinion  of  Brown &  Wood LLP,  special  counsel to
Provident,  if  a  REMIC election  is  made  with  respect  to  a  Series  of
Securities, then the arrangement by  which the Securities of that Series  are
issued will be  treated as a  REMIC as long as  all of the provisions  of the
applicable  Agreement are  complied  with and  the  statutory and  regulatory
requirements  are  satisfied.    Securities will  be  designated  as "Regular
Interests" or  "Residual Interests" in a  REMIC, as specified in  the related
Prospectus Supplement.

     Except to the extent specified  otherwise in a Prospectus Supplement, if
a  REMIC  election  is made  with  respect  to a  Series  of  Securities, (i)
Securities held by  a domestic building and loan  association will constitute
"a  regular or a  residual interest in  a REMIC"  within the meaning  of Code
Section 7701(a)(19)(C)(xi) (assuming that at  least 95% of the REMIC's assets
consist of cash, government securities, "loans secured by an interest in real
property,"   and   other  types   of   assets  described   in   Code  Section
7701(a)(19)(C)); and (ii)  Securities held by a real  estate investment trust
will  constitute "real  estate assets"  within  the meaning  of Code  Section
856(c)(6)(B), and  income with respect  to the Securities will  be considered
"interest  on  obligations  secured  by  mortgages on  real  property  or  on
interests in real  property" within the meaning of  Code Section 856(c)(3)(B)
(assuming, for both  purposes, that at  least 95% of  the REMIC's assets  are
qualifying assets).  If less than 95% of the REMIC's assets consist of assets
described in  (i) or  (ii) above, then  a Security will  qualify for  the tax
treatment described in (i),  (ii) or (iii) in the proportion  that such REMIC
assets are qualifying assets.

     The  Small Business Job Protection Act of 1996, as part of the repeal of
the bad debt reserve method for thrift institutions, repealed the application
of Code Section 593(d) to any taxable year beginning after December 31, 1995.

REMIC EXPENSES; SINGLE CLASS REMICS

     As a general  rule, all of the  expenses of a  REMIC will be taken  into
account by  Holders of the  Residual Interest Securities.   In the case  of a
"single class REMIC," however, the expenses will be allocated, under Treasury
regulations, among  the Holders  of the Regular  Interest Securities  and the
Holders  of the Residual Interest  Securities (as defined  herein) on a daily
basis in proportion to the relative amounts of income accruing to each Holder
on  that day.  In the case of a  Holder of a Regular Interest Security who is
an   individual  or  a  "pass-through  interest  holder"  (including  certain
pass-through entities, but not including real estate investment trusts), such
expenses will be deductible only to the extent that such expenses, plus other
"miscellaneous itemized deductions" of the Holder, exceed 2% of such Holder's
adjusted  gross income.    In  addition, for  taxable  years beginning  after
December 31, 1990, the amount  of itemized deductions otherwise allowable for
the  taxable year for  an individual whose adjusted  gross income exceeds the
applicable amount  (which amount will  be adjusted for inflation  for taxable
years beginning after  1990) will be reduced by  the lesser of (i)  3% of the
excess of adjusted gross income over the applicable amount or (ii) 80% of the
amount of itemized deductions otherwise allowable for such taxable year.  The
reduction or disallowance of this deduction may  have a significant impact on
the  yield of the  Regular Interest  Security to such  a Holder.   In general
terms,  a single  class REMIC  is  one that  either (i)  would  qualify under
existing Treasury  regulations as  a grantor  trust if  it were  not a  REMIC
(treating  all  interests as  ownership  interests,  even  if they  would  be
classified  as debt for  federal income tax  purposes) or (ii)  is similar to
such a trust and  which is structured with the principal  purpose of avoiding
the  single class  REMIC rules.   Unless otherwise  specified in  the related
Prospectus Supplement, the expenses of the REMIC will be allocated to Holders
of the related Residual Interest Securities.

TAXATION OF THE REMIC

     General.  Although a REMIC is  a separate entity for federal income  tax
purposes, a REMIC is not generally subject to entity-level tax.   Rather, the
taxable income or net loss of a REMIC is taken into account by the Holders of
Residual Interests.  As described  above, the Regular Interests are generally
taxable as debt of the REMIC.

     Calculation of REMIC  Income.  The taxable income or net loss of a REMIC
is determined under an accrual method of accounting and in the same manner as
in the case  of an  individual, with  certain adjustments.   In general,  the
taxable income  or net  loss will  be the  difference between  (i) the  gross
income produced by the REMIC's assets, including stated interest  and any OID
or market discount on Loans and other assets, and (ii) deductions,  including
stated interest and OID accrued on Regular Interest  Securities, amortization
of any  premium with respect to Loans, and  servicing fees and other expenses
of the REMIC.  A Holder of a Residual Interest Security that is an individual
or a "pass-through interest holder" (including certain pass-through entities,
but not including  real estate investment  trusts) will be  unable to  deduct
servicing fees payable on  the Loans or other administrative  expenses of the
REMIC for  a  given taxable  year, to  the extent  that  such expenses,  when
aggregated with  such Holder's  other miscellaneous  itemized deductions  for
that year, do not exceed two percent of such Holder's adjusted gross income.

     For purposes  of computing  its taxable income  or net  loss, the  REMIC
should  have  an initial  aggregate  tax basis  in  its assets  equal  to the
aggregate  fair  market value  of  the  Regular  Interests and  the  Residual
Interests  on the  Startup Day  (generally, the  day that  the interests  are
issued).  That  aggregate basis  will be  allocated among the  assets of  the
REMIC in proportion to their respective fair market values.

     The OID provisions  of the Code apply to loans of individuals originated
on or after March 2, 1984, and  the market discount provisions apply to loans
originated after July  18, 1984.  Subject  to possible application of  the de
minimis rules, the method of accrual by the REMIC of OID income on such Loans
will  be  equivalent  to  the  method  under  which  Holders  of  Pay-Through
Securities  accrue OID  (i.e., under  the constant  yield method  taking into
account the Prepayment Assumption).  The REMIC will deduct OID on the Regular
Interest  Securities in  the  same manner  that the  Holders  of the  Regular
Interest Securities  include such discount  in income, but without  regard to
the de minimis rules.   See "Taxation of Debt Securities"  above.  However, a
REMIC that  acquires Loans  at a  market  discount must  include such  market
discount in income currently, as it accrues, on a constant interest basis.

     To the extent  that the REMIC's basis  allocable to Loans that  it holds
exceeds  their principal amounts,  the resulting premium,  if attributable to
mortgages originated  after September  27, 1985, will  be amortized  over the
life of  the Loans  (taking  into account  the  Prepayment Assumption)  on  a
constant  yield method.    Although  the law  is  somewhat unclear  regarding
recovery of premium attributable to Loans  originated on or before such date,
it is possible that such premium  may be recovered in proportion to  payments
of Loan principal.

     Prohibited  Transactions  and Contributions  Tax.    The REMIC  will  be
subject  to  a  100%  tax  on  any  net  income  derived  from  a "prohibited
transaction." For this purpose, net  income will be calculated without taking
into  account  any  losses from  prohibited  transactions  or  any deductions
attributable  to any  prohibited transaction  that  resulted in  a loss.   In
general, prohibited transactions include:  (i) subject to limited exceptions,
the sale or other  disposition of any qualified  mortgage transferred to  the
REMIC; (ii) subject to limited exceptions, the sale or other disposition of a
cash flow  investment;  (iii) the  receipt  of  any income  from  assets  not
permitted to be held by the REMIC  pursuant to the Code; or (iv) the  receipt
of any  fees or other compensation for services rendered by the REMIC.  It is
anticipated that a  REMIC will not engage  in any prohibited  transactions in
which it  would recognize  a material  amount of  net income.   In  addition,
subject to a  number of exceptions, a tax  is imposed at the rate  of 100% on
amounts contributed  to a REMIC  after the  close of  the three-month  period
beginning on the Startup  Day.  The  Holders of Residual Interest  Securities
will generally be  responsible for the payment  of any such taxes  imposed on
the  REMIC.  To  the extent not  paid by such Holders  or otherwise, however,
such taxes  will be paid out of the Trust Fund and will be allocated pro rata
to all outstanding classes of Securities of such REMIC.

TAXATION OF HOLDERS OF RESIDUAL INTEREST SECURITIES

     The Holder of  a Security representing a Residual  Interest (a "Residual
Interest Security") will take into account the "daily portion" of the taxable
income or net loss of the REMIC for each day during the taxable year in which
such Holder  held  the Residual  Interest  Security.   The  daily portion  is
determined by  allocating to  each day  in any calendar  quarter its  ratable
portion of the taxable  income or net loss of the REMIC for such quarter, and
by allocating that  amount among the  Holders (on such  day) of the  Residual
Interest Securities in proportion to their respective holdings on such day.

     The Holder of a Residual Interest Security must report its proportionate
share  of the  taxable income of  the REMIC  whether or not  it receives cash
distributions  from the  REMIC  attributable to  such income  or  loss.   The
reporting  of taxable income without corresponding distributions could occur,
for example,  in certain REMIC  issues in which  the Loans held  by the REMIC
were  issued or  acquired at  a  discount, since  mortgage prepayments  cause
recognition of  discount  income,  while the  corresponding  portion  of  the
prepayment could  be used in whole  or in part to make  principal payments on
Regular Interests issued without any discount or at an insubstantial discount
(if  this occurs, it  is likely that  cash distributions  will exceed taxable
income in later years).   Taxable income may also be greater in earlier years
of certain  REMIC  issues as  a  result of  the  fact that  interest  expense
deductions,  as  a percentage  of outstanding  principal on  Regular Interest
Securities, will  typically increase over  time as lower  yielding Securities
are paid, whereas interest income with respect to Loans will generally remain
constant over time as a percentage of Loan principal.

     In any event, because the Holder of a Residual Interest is taxed on  the
net income of the REMIC, the taxable  income derived from a Residual Interest
Security in  a given taxable  year will  not be equal  to the taxable  income
associated with investment in a  corporate bond or stripped instrument having
similar cash flow characteristics and pretax yield.  Therefore, the after-tax
yield on the Residual Interest Security may be less than  that of such a bond
or instrument.

     Limitation on Losses.  The amount of the REMIC's net loss  that a Holder
may take into  account currently is limited to the Holder's adjusted basis at
the end of the calendar quarter in which such loss  arises.  A Holder's basis
in a Residual  Interest Security will initially equal  such Holder's purchase
price, and  will  subsequently be  increased  by the  amount of  the  REMIC's
taxable income allocated to the Holder, and decreased (but not below zero) by
the amount  of distributions  made and  the amount  of the  REMIC's net  loss
allocated  to  the  Holder.    Any disallowed  loss  may  be  carried forward
indefinitely, but may be used only to offset income of the REMIC generated by
the same REMIC.   The ability of  Holders of Residual Interest  Securities to
deduct net losses may be subject to additional limitations under the Code, as
to which such Holders should consult their tax advisers.

     Distributions.  Distributions  on a Residual Interest  Security (whether
at their scheduled  times or as a  result of prepayments) will  generally not
result in any  additional taxable income  or loss to a  Holder of a  Residual
Interest Security.  If the amount of such payment exceeds a Holder's adjusted
basis in the  Residual Interest Security, however, the  Holder will recognize
gain (treated as gain from the sale of the Residual Interest Security) to the
extent of such excess.

     Sale  or Exchange.    A Holder  of  a  Residual Interest  Security  will
recognize  gain or  loss  on the  sale  or exchange  of  a Residual  Interest
Security  equal to  the difference, if  any, between the  amount realized and
such Holder's adjusted basis in the Residual Interest Security at the time of
such sale or exchange.  Except  to the extent provided in regulations,  which
have not yet  been issued, any loss  upon disposition of a  Residual Interest
Security  will be  disallowed if  the  selling Holder  acquires any  residual
interest  in a  REMIC or similar  mortgage pool  within six months  before or
after such disposition.

     Excess Inclusions.   The portion of the REMIC taxable income of a Holder
of a Residual  Interest Security consisting of "excess  inclusion" income may
not be offset by other deductions or losses, including net operating  losses,
on such  Holder's federal  income tax return.   Further, if  the Holder  of a
Residual Interest Security is an organization subject to the tax on unrelated
business income imposed  by Code Section 511, such  holder's excess inclusion
income will be treated as  unrelated business taxable income of such  Holder.
In addition, under  Treasury regulations yet to  be issued, if a  real estate
investment trust,  a regulated  investment company, a  common trust  fund, or
certain cooperatives were to own a  Residual Interest Security, a portion  of
dividends (or other  distributions) paid by the real  estate investment trust
(or other entity) would be treated as excess inclusion income.  If a Residual
Security is owned  by a foreign person, excess inclusion income is subject to
tax at a rate of  30% which may not be reduced by treaty, is not eligible for
treatment as  "portfolio  interest"  and is  subject  to  certain  additional
limitations.   See "Tax Treatment of Foreign  Investors."  The Small Business
Job Protection Act of 1996 has eliminated the special rule permitting Section
593 institutions  ("thrift institutions")  to  use net  operating losses  and
other allowable deductions to offset their excess inclusion income from REMIC
residual certificates that have "significant value" within the meaning of the
REMIC Regulations, effective for  taxable years beginning after  December 31,
1995, except  with respect  to residual certificates  continuously held  by a
thrift institution since November 1, 1995.

     In  addition, the  Small Business  Job Protection  Act of  1996 provides
three  rules  for  determining  the   effect  of  excess  inclusions  on  the
alternative minimum taxable income of  a residual Holder.  First, alternative
minimum taxable income for such  residual Holder is determined without regard
to  the  special  rule  that  taxable  income  cannot  be  less  than  excess
inclusions.  Second, a  residual Holder's alternative minimum  taxable income
for  a tax year cannot be  less than excess inclusions  for the year.  Third,
the amount of  any alternative minimum tax net operating loss deductions must
be  computed without  regard  to  any excess  inclusions.    These rules  are
effective for tax years beginning after December  31, 1986, unless a residual
Holder elects  to have  such rules apply  only to  tax years  beginning after
August 20, 1996.

     The  excess inclusion portion of a REMIC's  income is generally equal to
the  excess,  if any,  of  REMIC  taxable  income  for the  quarterly  period
allocable to a Residual Interest  Security, over the daily accruals for  such
quarterly period of (i) 120% of the long-term applicable federal rate  on the
Startup  Day multiplied  by (ii)  the adjusted issue  price of  such Residual
Interest Security at  the beginning of such  quarterly period.   The adjusted
issue price of a Residual Interest at the beginning of each  calendar quarter
will  equal  its  issue  price  (calculated  in a  manner  analogous  to  the
determination of  the issue price  of a Regular  Interest), increased  by the
aggregate of  the daily accruals  for prior calendar quarters,  and decreased
(but not below  zero) by the  amount of  loss allocated to  a Holder and  the
amount of  distributions made  on the Residual  Interest Security  before the
beginning of  the quarter.   The long-term  federal rate, which  is announced
monthly by the Treasury Department, is an interest  rate that is based on the
average  market yield  of outstanding  marketable  obligations of  the United
States government having remaining maturities in excess of nine years.

     Under  the REMIC  Regulations, in  certain  circumstances, transfers  of
Residual Securities may be disregarded.  See "--Restrictions on Ownership and
Transfer  of Residual  Interest Securities"  and "--Tax Treatment  of Foreign
Investors" below.

     Restrictions  on Ownership and Transfer of Residual Interest Securities.
As a condition to qualification  as a REMIC, reasonable arrangements must  be
made to prevent  the ownership of  a Residual Interest  by any  "Disqualified
Organization."   Disqualified Organizations  include the  United States,  any
State  or  political   subdivision  thereof,  any  foreign   government,  any
international organization,  or any agency  or instrumentality of any  of the
foregoing,  a rural  electric or  telephone cooperative described  in Section
1381(a)(2)(C) of  the Code,  or any  entity exempt  from the  tax imposed  by
Sections 1-1399  of the Code,  if such entity  is not  subject to tax  on its
unrelated business income.  Accordingly, the applicable Pooling and Servicing
Agreement will  prohibit Disqualified  Organizations from  owning a  Residual
Interest Security.  In addition, no  transfer of a Residual Interest Security
will be permitted unless the proposed transferee shall  have furnished to the
Trustee  an  affidavit representing  and  warranting  that  it is  neither  a
Disqualified Organization  nor an  agent or  nominee  acting on  behalf of  a
Disqualified Organization.

     If  a  Residual  Interest  Security  is transferred  to  a  Disqualified
Organization   (in  violation  of  the  restrictions   set  forth  above),  a
substantial tax will  be imposed on the transferor  of such Residual Interest
Security  at  the time  of  the transfer.    In addition,  if  a Disqualified
Organization holds  an interest  in a  pass-through entity  (including, among
others,  a  partnership,  trust,  real  estate  investment  trust,  regulated
investment company, or any person  holding as nominee), that owns a  Residual
Interest Security, the pass-through entity will be required to pay  an annual
tax on its allocable share of the excess inclusion income of the REMIC.

     Under  the REMIC  Regulations,  if  a Residual  Interest  Security is  a
"noneconomic residual interest," as described below, a transfer of a Residual
Interest  Security to  a  United States  person will  be disregarded  for all
Federal  tax purposes unless  no significant purpose  of the transfer  was to
impede the assessment or collection of tax.  A Residual Interest  Security is
a "noneconomic residual interest" unless at the  time of the transfer (i) the
present value of  the expected future distributions on  the Residual Interest
Security at least equals the product of the present value of  the anticipated
excess inclusions  and the  highest rate  of tax  for the  year in  which the
transfer  occurs,  and  (ii)  the  transferor  reasonably  expects  that  the
transferee will receive distributions from the REMIC at or after the  time at
which the  taxes accrue  on the  anticipated excess  inclusions in  an amount
sufficient  to satisfy  the  accrued taxes.    If a  transfer  of a  Residual
Interest  is disregarded,  the transferor  would  be liable  for any  Federal
income  tax imposed upon  taxable income derived  by the transferee  from the
REMIC.  The REMIC Regulations provide no guidance as to how to determine if a
significant  purpose of a transfer is to  impede the assessment or collection
of  tax.    A similar  type  of  limitation exists  with  respect  to certain
transfers of Residual Interests by  foreign persons to United States persons.
See "--Tax Treatment of Foreign Investors."

     Mark to  Market Rules.   Prospective purchasers  of a  Residual Interest
Security should be aware that  the IRS recently released proposed regulations
(the "Proposed  Mark-to-Market Regulations")  which provide  that a  Residual
Interest Security  acquired after January 3, 1995 cannot be marked-to-market.
The Proposed  Mark-to-Market Regulations  replace  the temporary  regulations
which allowed a  Residual Interest Security  to be marked-to-market  provided
that it was not a negative value Residual Interest and did not  have the same
economic effect  as a negative value Residual Interest.   The IRS could issue
subsequent regulations, which could apply retroactively, providing additional
or different requirements with respect to such deemed negative value Residual
Interests.   Prospective purchasers  of a Residual  Interest Security  should
consult their tax advisors regarding the possible application of the Proposed
Mark-to-Market Regulations.

ADMINISTRATIVE MATTERS

     The REMIC's books  must be maintained on  a calendar year basis  and the
REMIC must  file an annual federal income tax return.  The REMIC will also be
subject to the procedural and administrative  rules of the Code applicable to
partnerships,  including the determination of any adjustments to, among other
things, items of REMIC  income, gain, loss, deduction, or credit,  by the IRS
in a unified administrative proceeding.

TAX STATUS AS A GRANTOR TRUST

     General.   As specified in the  related Prospectus Supplement if a REMIC
or partnership election  is not  made, in  the opinion of  Brown & Wood  LLP,
special  counsel  to  Provident,  the Trust  Fund  relating  to  a Series  of
Securities will be classified  for federal income tax  purposes as a  grantor
trust  under Subpart  E, Part I  of Subchapter  J of the  Code and  not as an
association taxable as  a corporation (the Securities of  such Series, "Pass-
Through Securities").   In  some Series there  will be  no separation  of the
principal and  interest payments  on the  Loans.   In  such circumstances,  a
Holder will be  considered to have purchased a pro rata undivided interest in
each of  the Loans.   In  other cases  ("Stripped Securities"),  sale of  the
Securities will produce a separation in the ownership  of all or a portion of
the principal payments from all or a portion of the interest payments on  the
Loans.

     Each Holder must  report on its federal  income tax return its  share of
the gross income derived from the Loans (not reduced by the amount payable as
fees  to the Trustee  and the  Servicer and  similar fees  (collectively, the
"Servicing Fees")),  at the same time  and in the  same manner as  such items
would have been reported under the Holder's tax accounting method had it held
its  interest in  the Loans  directly,  received directly  its  share of  the
amounts received with  respect to the Loans,  and paid directly its  share of
the  Servicing  Fees.   In  the case  of Pass-Through  Securities  other than
Stripped Securities, such income will consist  of a pro rata share of all  of
the  income  derived from  all of  the  Loans and,  in  the case  of Stripped
Securities,  such income  will consist  of  a pro  rata share  of  the income
derived from each stripped  bond or stripped coupon in which  the Holder owns
an interest.  The holder of a  Security will generally be entitled to  deduct
such  Servicing Fees  under Section  162 or  Section 212 of  the Code  to the
extent that such Servicing  Fees represent "reasonable" compensation  for the
services rendered by  the Trustee and the Servicer (or third parties that are
compensated for the performance of services).  In the case of  a noncorporate
Holder,  however, Servicing  Fees (to  the extent  not  otherwise disallowed,
e.g.,  because they  exceed reasonable  compensation) will  be deductible  in
computing such  Holder's regular tax  liability only to the  extent that such
fees, when  added to  other miscellaneous itemized  deductions, exceed  2% of
adjusted gross income  and may not be  deductible to any extent  in computing
such Holder's alternative minimum  tax liability.  In addition, the amount of
itemized  deductions  otherwise  allowable  for  the   taxable  year  for  an
individual  whose adjusted gross income exceeds  the applicable amount (which
amount will be adjusted for inflation) will  be reduced by the lesser of  (i)
3% of  the excess of adjusted gross income over the applicable amount or (ii)
80% of the amount of itemized deductions otherwise allowable for such taxable
year.

     Discount or Premium on  Pass-Through Securities.  The Holder's  purchase
price  of a  Pass-Through Security  is  to be  allocated among  the  Loans in
proportion to their fair market values determined  as of the time of purchase
of the Securities.  In the typical case, the Trustee (to the extent necessary
to fulfill  its reporting obligations) will treat each  Loan as having a fair
market value proportional to the share of the aggregate principal balances of
all of  the Loans that it represents,  since the Securities, unless otherwise
specified  in  the related  Prospectus  Supplement,  will  have a  relatively
uniform interest rate and other common  characteristics.  To the extent  that
the portion of the purchase price  of a Pass-Through Security allocated to  a
Loan (other than to a  right to receive any accrued interest thereon  and any
undistributed principal payments) is less than or greater than the portion of
the principal balance  of the Loan allocable to the Security, the interest in
the Loan  allocable to the Pass-Through Security will  be deemed to have been
acquired at a discount or premium, respectively.

     The  treatment of  any  discount  will depend  on  whether the  discount
represents OID or market discount.  In the case of a Loan  with OID in excess
of a  prescribed de  minimis amount  or a  Stripped Security, a  Holder of  a
Security will  be required to report as interest  income in each taxable year
its share of  the amount of OID that  accrues during that year  in the manner
described above.   OID with respect to  a Loan could  arise, for example,  by
virtue of the financing of points by the originator of the Loan, or by virtue
of the charging of points by the originator of the  Loan in an amount greater
than  a statutory  de minimis  exception,  in circumstances  under which  the
points are not  currently deductible pursuant to applicable  Code provisions.
Any  market  discount or  premium on  a  Loan will  be includible  in income,
generally in  the manner described  above, except that  in the case  of Pass-
Through Securities, market  discount is calculated with respect  to the Loans
underlying  the Certificate,  rather than  with respect to  the Security.   A
Holder that  acquires an interest  in a Loan  originated after July  18, 1984
with more than a de minimis amount of market discount (generally,  the excess
of the principal amount  of the Loan over the purchaser's  allocable purchase
price) will be required to include  accrued market discount in income in  the
manner set forth above.  See "--Taxation of Debt Securities; Market Discount"
and "--Premium" above.

     In the case  of market discount on a  Pass-Through Security attributable
to Loans originated on or before July 18, 1984, the Holder generally  will be
required to allocate the portion of such discount that is allocable to a Loan
among  the  principal  payments on  the  Loan  and  to include  the  discount
allocable to  each principal  payment in  ordinary income  at  the time  such
principal payment is made.  Such treatment would generally result in discount
being included in income at a slower rate than discount would  be required to
be included in income using the method described in the preceding paragraph.

     Stripped  Securities.   A Stripped  Security  may represent  a right  to
receive only  a portion of  the interest payments  on the  Loans, a right  to
receive only principal payments on the  Loans, or a right to receive  certain
payments of both interest and principal.  Certain Stripped Securities ("Ratio
Strip Securities") may represent a  right to receive differing percentages of
both the interest  and principal on each Loan.   Pursuant to Section  1286 of
the Code, the separation of ownership of the right to receive some or all  of
the interest payments on an obligation from ownership of the right to receive
some or all  of the principal payments  results in the creation  of "stripped
bonds" with respect to principal payments and "stripped coupons" with respect
to  interest payments.   Section 1286  of the  Code applies the  OID rules to
stripped bonds  and stripped  coupons.   For  purposes  of computing  OID,  a
stripped bond or a stripped coupon is treated  as a debt instrument issued on
the date that such  stripped interest is purchased with an  issue price equal
to its purchase  price or, if more  than one stripped interest  is purchased,
the ratable share of the purchase price allocable to such stripped interest.

     Servicing Fees in excess of reasonable Servicing Fees ("Excess Servicing
Fees")  will  be  treated under  the  stripped  bond rules.    If  the Excess
Servicing Fees are less  than 100 basis points (i.e., 1% interest on the Loan
principal balance)  or the Securities  are initially sold  with a  de minimis
discount (assuming no Prepayment Assumption  is required), any non-de minimis
discount  arising from  a subsequent  transfer  of the  Securities should  be
treated  as market  discount.   The IRS  appears to  require  that reasonable
Servicing Fees be  calculated on a Loan-by-Loan basis, which  could result in
some Loans being  treated as having  more than 100  basis points of  interest
stripped off.


     The Code,  OID  Regulations and  judicial  decisions provide  no  direct
guidance  as to  how the  interest and  OID rules  are to  apply  to Stripped
Securities and  other Pass-Through  Securities.   Under the  method described
above for Pay-Through Securities (the  "Cash Flow Bond Method"), a Prepayment
Assumption  is used  and periodic  recalculations  are made  which take  into
account with respect to each accrual period the effect of prepayments  during
such period.   However, the 1986  Act does not,  absent Treasury regulations,
appear  specifically  to cover  instruments such  as the  Stripped Securities
which  technically represent  ownership interests  in  the underlying  Loans,
rather than being  debt instruments "secured by" those  Loans.  Nevertheless,
it  is believed  that the Cash  Flow Bond  Method is  a reasonable  method of
reporting income  for such Securities,  and it is  expected that OID  will be
reported on that  basis unless otherwise specified in  the related Prospectus
Supplement.   In applying  the  calculation to  Pass-Through Securities,  the
Trustee  will treat all payments  to be received by  a Holder with respect to
the underlying Loans as payments on a single installment obligation.  The IRS
could, however, assert  that OID must be calculated  separately for each Loan
underlying a Security.

     Under certain circumstances,  if the Loans prepay at a  rate faster than
the  Prepayment  Assumption,  the  use  of  the  Cash Flow  Bond  Method  may
accelerate a  Holder's recognition of income.   If, however, the Loans prepay
at  a rate slower than  the Prepayment Assumption,  in some circumstances the
use of this method may decelerate a Holder's recognition of income.

     In  the  case  of a  Stripped  Security  that  is  an Interest  Weighted
Security, the Trustee intends, absent contrary authority, to report income to
Securityholders as OID,  in the manner described above  for Interest Weighted
Securities.

     Possible Alternative  Characterizations.  The  characterizations of  the
Stripped Securities described above are not the only possible interpretations
of the applicable Code provisions.  Among other possibilities, the  IRS could
contend that  (i) in certain  Series, each non-Interest Weighted  Security is
composed  of an  unstripped  undivided  ownership interest  in  Loans and  an
installment  obligation consisting of  stripped principal payments;  (ii) the
non-Interest  Weighted Securities  are  subject  to  the  contingent  payment
provisions of  the Contingent  Regulations; or  (iii) each Interest  Weighted
Stripped Security is  composed of an unstripped  undivided ownership interest
in  Loans  and  an  installment obligation  consisting  of  stripped interest
payments.

     Given  the  variety  of  alternatives  for  treatment  of  the  Stripped
Securities and the different federal income tax consequences that result from
each alternative,  potential purchasers  are urged to  consult their  own tax
advisers regarding the proper treatment  of the Securities for federal income
tax purposes.

     Character  as Qualifying  Loans.   In the  case of  Stripped Securities,
there is no specific legal authority existing regarding whether the character
of the Securities, for federal income  tax purposes, will be the same as  the
Loans.  The  IRS could  take the position  that the Loans'  character is  not
carried  over  to  the  Securities  in   such  circumstances.    Pass-Through
Securities will be, and, although the matter is not free from doubt, Stripped
Securities should be, considered to represent "real estate assets" within the
meaning of Section 856(c)(6)(B) of the Code and "loans secured by an interest
in  real property"  within the  meaning of  Section 7701(a)(19)(C)(v)  of the
Code; and interest income attributable to the Securities should be considered
to represent "interest  on obligations secured by mortgages  on real property
or on interests in real property" within the meaning  of Section 856(c)(3)(B)
of the  Code.   Reserves  or  funds underlying  the  Securities may  cause  a
proportionate reduction in  the above-described qualifying status  categories
of Securities.

SALE OR EXCHANGE

     Subject to the discussion below with respect to Trust Funds as  to which
a partnership  election is made, a Holder's tax  basis in its Security is the
price  such Holder  pays for a  Security, plus  amounts of original  issue or
market  discount included  in income  and  reduced by  any payments  received
(other than qualified  stated interest payments)  and any amortized  premium.
Gain or  loss recognized on  a sale, exchange,  or redemption of  a Security,
measured by  the difference  between the amount  realized and  the Security's
basis as so adjusted,  will generally be capital gain or  loss, assuming that
the Security is held as a capital asset.  In the case of a Security held by a
bank,  thrift, or similar  institution described in Section  582 of the Code,
however, gain or loss realized on the sale or exchange of  a Regular Interest
Security will be  taxable as ordinary income or loss.  In addition, gain from
the  disposition of  a  Regular  Interest Security  that  might otherwise  be
capital gain will be treated as ordinary income to the extent of the  excess,
if any, of  (i) the amount that  would have been  includible in the  Holder's
income if the yield on such Regular Interest Security had equaled 110% of the
applicable federal rate as of the beginning of such Holder's holding  period,
over  the amount  of ordinary income  actually recognized by  the Holder with
respect to such Regular Interest Security.  For taxable years beginning after
December 31,  1993, the maximum  tax rate  on ordinary income  for individual
taxpayers is  39.6%  and the  maximum  tax rate  on long-term  capital  gains
reported  after December 31, 1990 for such taxpayers is 28%.  The maximum tax
rate  on  both ordinary  income  and  long-term  capital gains  of  corporate
taxpayers is 35%.

MISCELLANEOUS TAX ASPECTS

     Backup Withholding.   Subject  to the discussion  below with  respect to
Trust Funds as to which a partnership election is made,  a Holder, other than
a Holder of  a Residual Interest Security, may,  under certain circumstances,
be  subject  to "backup  withholding"  at  a  rate  of 31%  with  respect  to
distributions or the proceeds of a sale of certificates to or through brokers
that represent interest or OID on the Securities.  This withholding generally
applies if the Holder of a Security (i) fails to furnish the Trustee with its
taxpayer  identification  number  ("TIN");  (ii)  furnishes  the  Trustee  an
incorrect TIN;  (iii) fails to  report properly interest, dividends  or other
"reportable  payments"  as  defined  in  the  Code;  or  (iv)  under  certain
circumstances,  fails  to provide  the  Trustee or  such  Holder's securities
broker with a certified statement, signed under penalty of perjury, that  the
TIN provided is  its correct  number and that  the Holder  is not subject  to
backup withholding.  Backup withholding will not apply, however, with respect
to certain  payments made  to Holders, including  payments to  certain exempt
recipients (such  as exempt  organizations) and  to certain  Nonresidents (as
defined  below).   Holders  should  consult their  tax  advisers as  to their
qualification for  exemption from backup  withholding and  the procedure  for
obtaining the exemption.

     The  Trustee will  report to the  Holders and  to the Servicer  for each
calendar year  the amount of  any "reportable payments" during  such year and
the  amount  of  tax  withheld, if  any,  with  respect  to  payments on  the
Securities.

TAX TREATMENT OF FOREIGN INVESTORS

     Subject to the discussion below with respect to Trust Funds as  to which
a partnership  election is made,  under the Code, unless  interest (including
OID)  paid  on  a  Security  (other than  a  Residual  Interest  Security) is
considered to be  "effectively connected" with a trade  or business conducted
in the United  States by a nonresident alien  individual, foreign partnership
or  foreign corporation ("Nonresidents"), such interest will normally qualify
as portfolio interest  (except where (i) the recipient  is a holder, directly
or by attribution, of 10%  or more of the capital or profits  interest in the
issuer, or (ii) the  recipient is a controlled  foreign corporation to  which
the issuer is a related person)  and will be exempt from federal income  tax.
Upon receipt of appropriate ownership statements, the issuer normally will be
relieved of  obligations to withhold tax from  such interest payments.  These
provisions supersede the generally applicable provisions of United States law
that would otherwise  require the issuer  to withhold at  a 30% rate  (unless
such rate were reduced or eliminated  by an applicable tax treaty) on,  among
other things,  interest and other  fixed or determinable, annual  or periodic
income paid to Nonresidents.  Holders of Pass-Through Securities and Stripped
Securities, including  Ratio Strip  Securities, however,  may  be subject  to
withholding to the  extent that the Loans  were originated on or  before July
18, 1984.

     Interest and  OID of Holders who are foreign  persons are not subject to
withholding if they  are effectively connected with a  United States business
conducted by  the Holder.   They will, however,  generally be subject  to the
regular United States income tax.

     Payments to  Holders of  Residual Interest  Securities  who are  foreign
persons  will generally be  treated as interest  for purposes of  the 30% (or
lower treaty rate) United States withholding tax.  Holders should assume that
such income does not qualify for exemption from United States withholding tax
as "portfolio  interest." It  is clear  that, to  the extent  that a  payment
represents  a  portion  of  REMIC  taxable  income  that  constitutes  excess
inclusion income,  a  Holder of  a  Residual Interest  Security will  not  be
entitled  to an exemption from or reduction of the 30% (or lower treaty rate)
withholding tax  rule.    If  the  payments  are  subject  to  United  States
withholding tax,  they generally will  be taken into account  for withholding
tax purposes  only when paid  or distributed  (or when the  Residual Interest
Security is disposed of).  The Treasury  has statutory authority, however, to
promulgate  regulations which  would require  such amounts  to be  taken into
account at an  earlier time in order to  prevent the avoidance of  tax.  Such
regulations could, for example, require withholding prior to the distribution
of  cash  in  the case  of  Residual  Interest Securities  that  do  not have
significant  value.   Under the  REMIC  Regulations, if  a Residual  Interest
Security  has tax  avoidance potential,  a  transfer of  a Residual  Interest
Security to  a Nonresident will be disregarded  for all federal tax purposes.
A  Residual Interest Security has tax avoidance potential unless, at the time
of  the transfer,  the  transferor  reasonably expects  that  the REMIC  will
distribute to  the transferee amounts  that will equal  at least 30%  of each
excess inclusion,  and that such amounts will be  distributed at or after the
time at which  the excess inclusions accrue  and not later than  the calendar
year following the  calendar year of accrual.   If a Nonresident  transfers a
Residual Interest Security to a United States person, and if the transfer has
the effect  of  allowing  the  transferor  to avoid  tax  on  accrued  excess
inclusions, then the transfer is  disregarded and the transferor continues to
be treated as the owner of the Residual Interest Security for purposes of the
withholding tax provisions of the Code.  See "--Excess Inclusions."

TAX CHARACTERIZATION OF THE TRUST FUND AS A PARTNERSHIP

     Brown & Wood LLP, special counsel to Provident, will deliver its opinion
that a Trust Fund  for which a  partnership election is made  will not be  an
association  (or publicly  traded partnership) taxable  as a  corporation for
federal income tax  purposes.  This opinion  will be based on  the assumption
that the terms of the Trust Agreement and related documents will  be complied
with, and on  counsel's conclusions  that (1)  the Trust Fund  will not  have
certain characteristics necessary for a business trust to be classified as an
association taxable as a corporation and (2) the nature of  the income of the
Trust  Fund  will  exempt it  from  the  rule  that certain  publicly  traded
partnerships are  taxable as corporations  or the issuance of  the Securities
has been structured as a private placement under an IRS safe harbor,  so that
the Trust Fund  will not be  characterized as  a publicly traded  partnership
taxable as a corporation.

     If the Trust Fund  were taxable as a corporation for  federal income tax
purposes,  the Trust  Fund would be  subject to  corporate income tax  on its
taxable  income.   The  Trust Fund's  taxable income  would  include all  its
income, possibly reduced  by its  interest expense  on the Notes.   Any  such
corporate income tax could materially  reduce cash available to make payments
on  the Notes and  distributions on the  Certificates, and Certificateholders
could be liable for any such tax that is unpaid by the Trust Fund.

TAX CONSEQUENCES TO HOLDERS OF THE NOTES

   
     Treatment of the  Notes as Indebtedness.  The Trust Fund will agree, and
the Noteholders will agree  by their purchase of Notes, to treat the Notes as
debt for federal income tax purposes.   Brown & Wood LLP, special  counsel to
Provident,  will, except  as  otherwise provided  in  the related  Prospectus
Supplement,  advise Provident that  the Notes will be  classified as debt for
federal   income  tax   purposes.     The  discussion   below   assumes  this
characterization of the Notes is correct.
    

     OID, Indexed  Securities, etc.   The discussion  below assumes  that all
payments on the Notes are denominated in U.S. dollars, and that the Notes are
not Indexed Securities or Strip Notes.  Moreover, the discussion assumes that
the  interest formula  for the  Notes meets  the requirements  for "qualified
stated interest"  under the OID  Regulations, and that  any OID on  the Notes
(i.e., any  excess of  the principal  amount of  the Notes  over their  issue
price) does not  exceed a de minimis  amount (i.e., 0.25% of  their principal
amount multiplied by  the number of full  years included in their  term), all
within the  meaning of  the OID  Regulations.   If these  conditions are  not
satisfied  with  respect  to  any  given  series  of  Notes,  additional  tax
considerations with respect to such Notes will be disclosed in the applicable
Prospectus Supplement.

     Interest Income on the Notes.  Based on the above assumptions, except as
discussed in the following paragraph, the Notes will not be considered issued
with OID.   The stated  interest thereon will  be taxable to a  Noteholder as
ordinary interest  income when  received or accrued  in accordance  with such
Noteholder's method of  tax accounting.  Under the OID  Regulations, a Holder
of a Note  issued with a  de minimis amount of  OID must include such  OID in
income, on  a pro rata basis, as principal payments are made on the Note.  It
is believed  that any  prepayment premium  paid as  a result  of a  mandatory
redemption will be taxable as contingent  interest when it becomes fixed  and
unconditionally payable.  A  purchaser who buys a Note for  more or less than
its principal amount will generally  be subject, respectively, to the premium
amortization or market discount rules of the Code.

     A Holder of a  Note that has a fixed maturity date of  not more than one
year from the issue date of such Note (a "Short-Term Note") may be subject to
special rules.   An accrual  basis Holder of  a Short-Term Note  (and certain
cash method Holders,  including regulated investment companies,  as set forth
in Section 1281 of  the Code) generally would be required  to report interest
income as  interest accrues on  a straight-line basis  over the term  of each
interest  period.  Other  cash basis Holders  of a Short-Term  Note would, in
general, be required  to report interest income  as interest is paid  (or, if
earlier, upon the  taxable disposition of the  Short-Term Note).  However,  a
cash  basis Holder of  a Short-Term Note  reporting interest income  as it is
paid may be  required to defer  a portion of  any interest expense  otherwise
deductible on indebtedness incurred to  purchase or carry the Short-Term Note
until the taxable disposition of the Short-Term Note.  A cash  basis taxpayer
may elect  under Section 1281  of the Code  to accrue interest  income on all
nongovernment debt obligations with a term of one year or less, in which case
the taxpayer would  include interest on the  Short-Term Note in income  as it
accrues, but  would not  be subject  to  the interest  expense deferral  rule
referred  to in  the preceding sentence.   Certain  special rules apply  if a
Short-Term Note is purchased for more or less than its principal amount.

     Sale or  Other Disposition.   If a Noteholder  sells a Note,  the Holder
will  recognize gain or loss in an amount equal to the difference between the
amount realized on the sale and the  Holder's adjusted tax basis in the Note.
The adjusted  tax basis of a Note  to a particular Noteholder  will equal the
Holder's cost  for the  Note, increased by  any market  discount, acquisition
discount, OID and gain previously included by such  Noteholder in income with
respect to the  Note and  decreased by the  amount of  bond premium (if  any)
previously amortized  and  by the  amount  of principal  payments  previously
received by such Noteholder with respect to such Note.  Any such gain or loss
will be  capital gain or loss if the Note was held as a capital asset, except
for  gain  representing  accrued  interest and  accrued  market  discount not
previously included in income.  Capital losses  generally may be used only to
offset capital gains.

     Foreign Holders.   Interest payments  made (or accrued) to  a Noteholder
who is  a nonresident alien,  foreign corporation or other  non-United States
person  (a  "foreign   person")  generally  will  be   considered  "portfolio
interest", and generally will not be subject to United States  federal income
tax and withholding tax if the interest is not effectively connected with the
conduct of a trade or business within the United States by the foreign person
and the foreign  person (i) is not  actually or constructively a  "10 percent
shareholder" of the Trust Fund or Provident (including a Holder of 10% of the
outstanding  Certificates) or a "controlled foreign corporation" with respect
to which the Trust Fund or Provident is a "related person" within the meaning
of  the Code  and (ii)  provides the  Owner Trustee  or other  person who  is
otherwise  required to withhold  U.S. tax with  respect to the  Notes with an
appropriate statement (on Form W-8 or a similar form), signed under penalties
of perjury,  certifying that the  beneficial owner of  the Note is  a foreign
person and providing  the foreign person's  name and address.   If a  Note is
held through a  securities clearing organization  or certain other  financial
institutions, the organization or institution may provide the relevant signed
statement  to  the withholding  agent;  in  that  case, however,  the  signed
statement must be  accompanied by a Form  W-8 or substitute form  provided by
the foreign  person that owns  the Note.   If such interest  is not portfolio
interest,  then  it  will be  subject  to United  States  federal  income and
withholding  tax at  a  rate  of 30  percent,  unless reduced  or  eliminated
pursuant to an applicable tax treaty.

     Any capital gain  realized on the sale, redemption,  retirement or other
taxable disposition of a  Note by a foreign person will be exempt from United
States federal income and withholding tax, provided that (i) such gain is not
effectively connected with the  conduct of a trade or business  in the United
States by the  foreign person and (ii)  in the case of  an individual foreign
person,  the foreign person is not present in  the United States for 183 days
or more in the taxable year.

     Backup Withholding.  Each Holder of a Note (other than an  exempt Holder
such  as  a  corporation,  tax-exempt  organization,  qualified  pension  and
profit-sharing  trust, individual retirement account or nonresident alien who
provides  certification as to  status as a  nonresident) will  be required to
provide, under penalties  of perjury, a  certificate containing the  Holder's
name, address, correct federal taxpayer identification number and a statement
that  the Holder is  not subject to  backup withholding.   Should a nonexempt
Noteholder fail to provide the required certification, the Trust Fund will be
required  to  withhold 31  percent  of the  amount otherwise  payable  to the
Holder, and  remit the  withheld amount to  the IRS as  a credit  against the
Holder's federal income tax liability.

   
     Possible  Alternative Treatments  of the  Notes.   If,  contrary to  the
opinion  of  Brown &   Wood  LLP  special  counsel  to   Provident,  the  IRS
successfully asserted that  one or more of  the Notes did not  represent debt
for  federal  income tax  purposes,  the Notes  might  be  treated as  equity
interests in the Trust Fund.  If so treated, the Trust Fund  might be taxable
as  a corporation  with the  adverse  consequences described  above (and  the
taxable  corporation would  not  be  able to  reduce  its  taxable income  by
deductions   for  interest  expense  on  Notes  recharacterized  as  equity).
Alternatively,  and most likely in the  view of special counsel to Provident,
the Trust  Fund might be treated as a  publicly traded partnership that would
not be  taxable as  a corporation  because it would  meet certain  qualifying
income tests.   Nonetheless, treatment  of the Notes  as equity interests  in
such a  publicly traded  partnership could have  adverse tax  consequences to
certain  Holders.    For  example,  income  to  certain  tax-exempt  entities
(including  pension  funds)  would be  "unrelated  business  taxable income",
income to foreign Holders generally would be subject to U.S. tax and U.S. tax
return  filing and withholding requirements,  and individual Holders might be
subject to certain  limitations on their ability to deduct their share of the
Trust Fund's expenses.
    

TAX CONSEQUENCES TO HOLDERS OF THE CERTIFICATES

     Treatment of the Trust Fund  as a Partnership.   The Trust Fund and  the
Master Servicer  will agree, and  the Certificateholders will agree  by their
purchase of  Certificates,  to treat  the  Trust Fund  as a  partnership  for
purposes of federal  and state income  tax, franchise tax  and any other  tax
measured in whole  or in part by  income, with the assets of  the partnership
being the  assets held  by the Trust  Fund, the  partners of  the partnership
being the  Certificateholders, and the  Notes being debt of  the partnership.
However, the proper characterization  of the arrangement involving the  Trust
Fund,  the Certificates, the  Notes, the Trust  Fund and the  Servicer is not
clear because  there is  no authority on  transactions closely  comparable to
that contemplated herein.

     A  variety of alternative characterizations  are possible.  For example,
because the  Certificates have certain  features characteristic of  debt, the
Certificates  might  be  considered  debt  of  the  Trust  Fund.    Any  such
characterization would  not result in materially adverse  tax consequences to
Certificateholders as  compared to  the consequences  from  treatment of  the
Certificates  as equity  in a  partnership, described  below.   The following
discussion  assumes  that the  Certificates represent  equity interests  in a
partnership.

     Indexed  Securities, etc.   The  following discussion  assumes  that all
payments on the  Certificates are  denominated in U.S.  dollars, none of  the
Certificates are Indexed Securities or  Strip Certificates, and that a Series
of Securities includes a single  class of Certificates.  If these  conditions
are  not  satisfied  with  respect  to  any  given  Series  of  Certificates,
additional  tax considerations  with  respect to  such  Certificates will  be
disclosed in the applicable Prospectus Supplement.

     Partnership Taxation.   As a  partnership, the  Trust Fund  will not  be
subject  to federal  income  tax.   Rather,  each  Certificateholder will  be
required to  separately take  into account such  Holder's allocated  share of
income, gains,  losses, deductions and credits of the  Trust Fund.  The Trust
Fund's income will  consist primarily of interest and  finance charges earned
on the Loans (including appropriate  adjustments for market discount, OID and
bond premium)  and any  gain upon collection  or disposition  of Loans.   The
Trust  Fund's  deductions will  consist primarily  of interest  accruing with
respect to the Notes, servicing and other fees, and losses or deductions upon
collection or disposition of Loans.

     The  tax  items  of a  partnership  are  allocable  to  the partners  in
accordance with the Code, Treasury regulations and  the partnership agreement
(here, the Trust Agreement and related documents).  The Trust Agreement  will
provide, in  general, that the  Certificateholders will be  allocated taxable
income of the Trust Fund for each month  equal to the sum of (i) the interest
that accrues  on the  Certificates in  accordance with  their terms  for such
month, including  interest accruing at  the Pass-Through Rate for  such month
and  interest  on amounts  previously  due on  the  Certificates but  not yet
distributed; (ii) any Trust Fund income attributable to discount on the Loans
that corresponds to  any excess of the  principal amount of  the Certificates
over  their initial  issue  price  (iii) prepayment  premium  payable to  the
Certificateholders  for such  month; and  (iv)  any other  amounts of  income
payable to  the Certificateholders for  such month.  Such  allocation will be
reduced  by any  amortization by  the  Trust Fund  of premium  on  Loans that
corresponds  to any  excess of  the issue  price  of Certificates  over their
principal amount.   All remaining  taxable income of  the Trust Fund  will be
allocated to  Provident.  Based on  the economic arrangement of  the parties,
this approach  for allocating Trust  Fund income should be  permissible under
applicable Treasury regulations, although no  assurance can be given that the
IRS  would  not require  a  greater  amount  of  income to  be  allocated  to
Certificateholders.  Moreover, even under the foregoing method of allocation,
Certificateholders may be  allocated income equal to  the entire Pass-Through
Rate plus the  other items described above  even though the Trust  Fund might
not  have sufficient cash to make  current cash distributions of such amount.
Thus, cash basis Holders will in effect be required to report income from the
Certificates on  the accrual basis  and Certificateholders may  become liable
for taxes on Trust Fund income  even if they have not received cash  from the
Trust Fund to pay  such taxes.  In addition, because tax  allocations and tax
reporting  will be done  on a  uniform basis  for all  Certificateholders but
Certificateholders  may be purchasing Certificates  at different times and at
different prices, Certificateholders  may be required to report  on their tax
returns taxable income  that is greater or  less than the amount  reported to
them by the Trust Fund.

     All of  the taxable income  allocated to a  Certificateholder that  is a
pension, profit sharing  or employee benefit plan or  other tax-exempt entity
(including  an  individual  retirement account)  will  constitute  "unrelated
business taxable income" generally taxable to a Holder under the Code.

     An individual taxpayer's share of  expenses of the Trust Fund (including
fees  to  the Servicer  but  not  interest  expense) would  be  miscellaneous
itemized deductions.   Such deductions might be disallowed  to the individual
in whole  or in part and might result in such Holder being taxed on an amount
of income that exceeds the amount of cash actually distributed to such Holder
over the life of the Trust Fund.

     The Trust Fund  intends to make all tax  calculations relating to income
and allocations to Certificateholders on an aggregate basis.  If the IRS were
to require that such calculations be made separately for each Loan, the Trust
Fund might be  required to incur additional  expense but it is  believed that
there would not be a material adverse effect on Certificateholders.

     Discount  and Premium.   It is believed  that the Loans  were not issued
with  OID,  and,  therefore,  the  Trust Fund  should  not  have  OID income.
However, the  purchase price  paid by  the Trust  Fund for  the Loans  may be
greater or less than the remaining principal balance of the Loans at the time
of  purchase.   If  so, the  Loan will  have been  acquired  at a  premium or
discount, as the case may be.  (As indicated above, the Trust Fund will  make
this calculation on an aggregate basis, but might be required to recompute it
on a Loan by Loan basis.)

     If the Trust  Fund acquires the Loans  at a market discount  or premium,
the Trust Fund will elect to include any such discount in income currently as
it accrues over the life of the  Loans or to offset any such premium  against
interest  income on the Loans.  As  indicated above, a portion of such market
discount income or premium deduction may be allocated to Certificateholders.

     Section 708 Termination.  Under Section 708 of the Code, the  Trust Fund
will be deemed to terminate for federal income tax purposes if 50% or more of
the capital  and profits interests  in the Trust  Fund are sold  or exchanged
within a 12-month period.  If such a  termination occurs, the Trust Fund will
be considered to  distribute its assets  to the partners,  who would then  be
treated  as  recontributing  those  assets  to  the  Trust   Fund  as  a  new
partnership.    The  Trust  Fund  will  not  comply  with  certain  technical
requirements that might  apply when such  a constructive termination  occurs.
As a result, the Trust Fund  may be subject to certain tax penalties  and may
incur  additional   expenses  if  it   is  required  to  comply   with  those
requirements.  Furthermore, the Trust Fund might not be able to comply due to
lack of data.

     Disposition of  Certificates.  Generally,  capital gain or loss  will be
recognized on  a sale of  Certificates in an  amount equal to  the difference
between the  amount realized and the  seller's tax basis in  the Certificates
sold.  A Certificateholder's tax basis in a  Certificate will generally equal
the  Holder's  cost increased  by  the Holder's  share  of Trust  Fund income
(includible in  income)  and decreased  by  any distributions  received  with
respect  to  such  Certificate.   In  addition,  both the  tax  basis  in the
Certificates and the amount realized on a sale of a Certificate would include
the Holder's share of  the Notes and other liabilities of the  Trust Fund.  A
Holder acquiring Certificates at different prices may be required to maintain
a single aggregate adjusted tax basis in such Certificates, and, upon sale or
other  disposition of  some of the  Certificates, allocate a  portion of such
aggregate  tax basis  to the  Certificates  sold (rather  than maintaining  a
separate tax basis in each Certificate for purposes of computing gain or loss
on a sale of that Certificate).

     Any gain on the sale of a Certificate attributable to the Holder's share
of  unrecognized accrued  market discount  on  the Loans  would generally  be
treated as ordinary  income to the Holder and would give  rise to special tax
reporting requirements.   The Trust  Fund does not  expect to have  any other
assets that would give rise to such special reporting requirements.  Thus, to
avoid  those special  reporting requirements,  the Trust  Fund will  elect to
include market discount in income as it accrues.

     If a Certificateholder  is required to recognize an  aggregate amount of
income (not including  income attributable to disallowed  itemized deductions
described above) over the life of the Certificates that exceeds the aggregate
cash distributions with respect thereto, such excess will generally give rise
to a capital loss upon the retirement of the Certificates.

     Allocations Between Transferors and Transferees.   In general, the Trust
Fund's taxable income and losses will be determined monthly and the tax items
for   a   particular  calendar   month   will   be   apportioned  among   the
Certificateholders  in proportion  to the  principal  amount of  Certificates
owned by them as of the close of the last day of such month.  As a result,  a
Holder purchasing Certificates may be  allocated tax items (which will affect
its  tax liability and  tax basis) attributable to  periods before the actual
transaction.

     The use of  such a monthly convention  may not be permitted  by existing
regulations.   If  a monthly convention  is not  allowed (or only  applies to
transfers of less  than all  of the  partner's interest),  taxable income  or
losses of the  Trust Fund might be reallocated  among the Certificateholders.
The Trust Fund's method of allocation between transferors and transferees may
be revised to conform to a method permitted by future regulations.

     Section 754 Election.   In the event that a  Certificateholder sells its
Certificates at a profit (loss), the purchasing Certificateholder will have a
higher (lower) basis in  the Certificates than the  selling Certificateholder
had.   The tax  basis of  the Trust  Fund's assets  will not  be adjusted  to
reflect that higher (or  lower) basis unless the  Trust Fund were to file  an
election under Section 754 of the Code.  In order to avoid the administrative
complexities that would  be involved in keeping  accurate accounting records,
as well as potentially onerous information reporting  requirements, the Trust
Fund will not make  such election.  As a result,  Certificateholders might be
allocated a  greater or  lesser amount  of Trust  Fund income  than would  be
appropriate based on their own purchase price for Certificates.

     Administrative Matters.  The Owner  Trustee is required to keep or  have
kept complete  and accurate books  of the  Trust Fund.   Such  books will  be
maintained for financial reporting  and tax purposes on an  accrual basis and
the  fiscal year of  the Trust Fund will  be the calendar  year.  The Trustee
will file  a partnership information return (IRS Form  1065) with the IRS for
each taxable year of the Trust Fund  and will report each Certificateholder's
allocable share of items of Trust Fund income and  expense to Holders and the
IRS  on  Schedule  K-1.    The  Trust  Fund  will  provide  the  Schedule K-l
information  to  nominees  that  fail to  provide  the  Trust  Fund with  the
information statement described  below and such nominees will  be required to
forward  such  information to  the  beneficial  owners  of the  Certificates.
Generally,  Holders  must file  tax  returns  that  are consistent  with  the
information return filed by the Trust Fund or be subject to  penalties unless
the Holder notifies the IRS of all such inconsistencies.

     Under Section 6031 of the Code, any person that holds Certificates  as a
nominee at any time  during a calendar year is required  to furnish the Trust
Fund  with a  statement containing  certain information  on the  nominee, the
beneficial owners  and the Certificates  so held.  Such  information includes
(i)  the name, address and taxpayer identification  number of the nominee and
(ii) as  to each beneficial  owner (x)  the name, address  and identification
number of such person,  (y) whether such person is a  United States person, a
tax-exempt entity or  a foreign government, an international organization, or
any  wholly owned agency or  instrumentality of either  of the foregoing, and
(z) certain  information on  Certificates that were  held, bought or  sold on
behalf  of  such person  throughout  the  year.    In addition,  brokers  and
financial institutions  that hold Certificates through a nominee are required
to furnish directly to the Trust Fund information as to themselves  and their
ownership of Certificates.  A clearing agency registered under Section 17A of
the Exchange Act is not required to furnish any such information statement to
the Trust Fund.  The information referred to above for any calendar year must
be  furnished  to the  Trust  Fund on  or  before the  following  January 31.
Nominees, brokers and  financial institutions that fail to  provide the Trust
Fund with the information described above may be subject to penalties.

   
     Provident or the Trustee will be  designated as the tax matters  partner
in  the  related Trust  Agreement  and,  as  such,  will be  responsible  for
representing the Certificateholders  in any dispute with  the IRS.  The  Code
provides   for  administrative  examination  of  a   partnership  as  if  the
partnership were a separate and distinct taxpayer.  Generally, the statute of
limitations for  partnership items does  not expire before three  years after
the date on which the partnership  information return is filed.  Any  adverse
determination following  an audit  of the  return of  the Trust  Fund by  the
appropriate taxing authorities  could result in an adjustment  of the returns
of    the   Certificateholders,   and,   under   certain   circumstances,   a
Certificateholder  may be  precluded from  separately  litigating a  proposed
adjustment to the items  of the Trust Fund.  An adjustment  could also result
in an  audit of a  Certificateholder's returns  and adjustments of  items not
related to the income and losses of the Trust Fund.
    

     Tax Consequences to Foreign Certificateholders.  It is not clear whether
the Trust Fund would  be considered to be engaged  in a trade or business  in
the  United States for purposes of federal  withholding taxes with respect to
non-U.S. persons because there is no  clear authority dealing with that issue
under facts substantially similar to those described herein.   Although it is
not expected that the  Trust Fund would be engaged in a  trade or business in
the United States  for such purposes, the Trust  Fund will withhold as  if it
were so  engaged in  order to protect  the Trust  Fund from  possible adverse
consequences of a failure to withhold.  The Trust Fund expects to withhold on
the   portion  of   its  taxable   income  that   is  allocable   to  foreign
Certificateholders pursuant  to Section 1446  of the Code, as  if such income
were effectively  connected to a U.S. trade or business, at a rate of 35% for
foreign holders  that are  taxable as  corporations and 39.6%  for all  other
foreign holders.  Subsequent adoption of Treasury regulations or the issuance
of other administrative  pronouncements may require the Trust  Fund to change
its withholding  procedures.  In  determining a Holder's  withholding status,
the  Trust  Fund may  rely on  IRS Form  W-8,  IRS Form  W-9 or  the Holder's
certification of nonforeign status signed under penalties of perjury.

     The term "U.S. Person" means a citizen or resident of the United States,
a corporation, partnership or  other entity created or organized in  or under
the laws  of the United  States or any  political subdivision thereof,  or an
estate whose  income is subject to U.S. federal  income tax regardless of its
source  of income, or a trust if a  court within the United States is able to
exercise primary supervision of  the administration of the  trust and one  or
more United States fiduciaries have  the authority to control all substantial
decisions of the trust.

     Each foreign  Holder might  be required  to  file a  U.S. individual  or
corporate income  tax return  (including, in the  case of a  corporation, the
branch  profits tax) on its share  of the Trust Fund's  income.  Each foreign
Holder must obtain a  taxpayer identification number from the IRS  and submit
that number  to the  Trust Fund on  Form W-8 in  order to  assure appropriate
crediting  of  the  taxes withheld.    A foreign  Holder  generally  would be
entitled to  file with  the IRS  a claim  for refund  with  respect to  taxes
withheld by the Trust Fund taking the position that no taxes were due because
the Trust  Fund  was not  engaged in  a  U.S. trade  or business.    However,
interest payments made (or accrued)  to a Certificateholder who is a  foreign
person generally  will be considered  guaranteed payments to the  extent such
payments are determined without regard to  the income of the Trust Fund.   If
these  interest payments are  properly characterized as  guaranteed payments,
then the interest  will not be considered "portfolio interest."  As a result,
Certificateholders will  be subject to  United States federal income  tax and
withholding  tax at  a  rate of  30  percent,  unless reduced  or  eliminated
pursuant to  an applicable treaty.  In such case, a foreign Holder would only
be entitled  to claim a refund for that portion of the taxes in excess of the
taxes that should be withheld with respect to the guaranteed payments.

     Backup Withholding.  Distributions made on the Certificates and proceeds
from the  sale of the Certificates will be  subject to a "backup" withholding
tax of 31% if, in general, the Certificateholder fails to comply with certain
identification  procedures, unless  the Holder  is an exempt  recipient under
applicable provisions of the Code.

                           STATE TAX CONSIDERATIONS

     In addition to the federal income tax consequences described in "Federal
Income Tax Consequences,"  potential investors should consider  the state and
local income tax consequences of the acquisition,  ownership, and disposition
of the Securities.   State and local income tax law  may differ substantially
from the  corresponding federal law, and this  discussion does not purport to
describe  any  aspect  of the  income  tax  laws of  any  state  or locality.
Therefore, potential investors  should consult  their own  tax advisors  with
respect to the various state and  local tax consequences of an investment  in
the Securities.

                             ERISA CONSIDERATIONS

     The following describes certain considerations under ERISA and the Code,
which  apply  only  to Securities  of  a  Series that  are  not  divided into
subclasses.    If  Securities  are   divided  into  subclasses,  the  related
Prospectus  Supplement  will  contain  information concerning  considerations
relating to ERISA and the Code that are applicable to such Securities.

     ERISA imposes  requirements on  employee benefit  plans (and on  certain
other  retirement  plans and  arrangements,  including  individual retirement
accounts and  annuities,  Keogh plans  and  collective investment  funds  and
separate accounts in which such plans, accounts or arrangements are invested)
(collectively "Plans")  subject to ERISA  and on persons who  are fiduciaries
with respect to such Plans.  Generally, ERISA applies to investments  made by
Plans.  Among  other things, ERISA requires that the assets  of Plans be held
in trust  and  that the  trustee, or  other duly  authorized fiduciary,  have
exclusive authority  and discretion to manage and  control the assets of such
Plans.  ERISA also  imposes certain duties on persons who  are fiduciaries of
Plans.   Under  ERISA, any  person  who exercises  any  authority or  control
respecting  the  management  or  disposition  of the  assets  of  a  Plan  is
considered to be a fiduciary of such  Plan (subject to certain exceptions not
here relevant).   Certain employee benefit plans, such  as governmental plans
(as defined in ERISA  Section 3(32)) and, if no election has  been made under
Section 410(d) of the Code, church plans (as defined in ERISA Section 3(33)),
are not subject to ERISA requirements.  Accordingly, assets of such plans may
be  invested  in  Securities  without  regard  to  the  ERISA  considerations
described above and below, subject to the provisions of applicable state law.
Any such plan which is qualified and exempt from taxation under Code Sections
401(a) and  501(a), however, is  subject to the prohibited  transaction rules
set forth in Code Section 503. 

     On November 13, 1986, the United States  Department of Labor (the "DOL")
issued final regulations  concerning the definition  of what constitutes  the
assets of a Plan.  (Labor  Reg. Section 2510.3-101).  Under this  regulation,
the  underlying assets  and  properties  of  corporations,  partnerships  and
certain other entities in which a Plan  makes an "equity" investment could be
deemed  for purposes of ERISA  to be assets of the  investing Plan in certain
circumstances.   However, the regulation provides that, generally, the assets
of a  corporation or partnership in which  a Plan invests will  not be deemed
for  purposes of  ERISA to  be assets  of such  Plan  if the  equity interest
acquired  by  the   investing  Plan  is  a  publicly-offered   security.    A
publicly-offered security,  as defined in the Labor  Reg. Section 2510.3-101,
is a security that  is widely held, freely transferable and  registered under
the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.

     In  addition  to  the  imposition  of  general  fiduciary  standards  of
investment prudence  and diversification,  ERISA prohibits a  broad range  of
transactions involving Plan assets and persons ("Parties in Interest") having
certain specified relationships to a Plan and imposes additional prohibitions
where Parties in Interest are fiduciaries with respect to such Plan.  Because
the Loans may be  deemed Plan assets of each Plan  that purchases Securities,
an investment in the Securities by  a Plan might be a prohibited  transaction
under ERISA Sections  406 and 407  and subject  to an excise  tax under  Code
Section 4975 unless a statutory or administrative exemption applies.

   
     In Prohibited  Transaction Exemption  83-1 ("PTE  83-1"), which  amended
Prohibited   Transaction  Exemption  81-7,  the  DOL  exempted  from  ERISA's
prohibited transaction rules  certain transactions relating to  the operation
of residential  mortgage pool  investment trusts and  the purchase,  sale and
holding of "mortgage pool pass-through certificates" in the initial  issuance
of  such certificates.   PTE  83-1  permits, subject  to certain  conditions,
transactions which might otherwise be prohibited between Plans and Parties in
Interest with respect to those  Plans related to the origination, maintenance
and termination  of mortgage  pools consisting of  mortgage loans  secured by
first  or second  mortgages or  deeds of  trust on  single-family residential
property,  and the  acquisition and  holding of  certain mortgage  pool pass-
through  certificates representing  an  interest in  such  mortgage pools  by
Plans.   If  the  general  conditions  (discussed  below)  of  PTE  83-1  are
satisfied, investments by a  Plan in Securities that represent interests in a
Pool consisting of Loans ("Single Family Securities") will be exempt from the
prohibitions  of  ERISA  Sections  406(a)  and  407  (relating  generally  to
transactions with Parties  in Interest who  are not fiduciaries) if  the Plan
purchases the Single  Family Securities at no more than fair market value and
will  be exempt  from the  prohibitions of  ERISA Sections 406(b)(1)  and (2)
(relating generally to  transactions with fiduciaries)  if, in addition,  the
purchase is approved by an independent fiduciary, no sales commission is paid
to the  pool sponsor, the Plan does not purchase  more than 25% of all Single
Family  Securities, and  at least  50%  of all  Single Family  Securities are
purchased by persons  independent of the pool  sponsor or pool trustee.   PTE
83-1 does  not provide  an exemption  for transactions  involving Subordinate
Securities.  Accordingly, no transfer of a Subordinate Security or a Security
which is not a  Single Family Security may be made to a Plan unless specified
in the related Prospectus Supplement.
    

     The discussion in this and the next succeeding paragraph applies only to
Single Family Securities.  Provident believes that, for purposes of PTE 83-1,
the  term "mortgage pass-through  certificate" would include:  (i) Securities
issued in a Series consisting of only a single  class of Securities; and (ii)
Securities  issued in  a Series  in which  there  is only  one class  of such
Securities; provided that the Securities in the case of       clause  (i), or
the Securities in the  case of clause (ii), evidence the beneficial ownership
of both a specified percentage of  future interest payments (greater than 0%)
and a specified percentage (greater than 0%) of  future principal payments on
the Loans.  It is not clear whether a class  of Securities that evidences the
beneficial ownership  in a  Trust Fund divided  into Loan  groups, beneficial
ownership of  a specified percentage  of interest payments only  or principal
payments only, or a notional amount of either principal or interest payments,
or  a  class of  Securities  entitled  to receive  payments  of  interest and
principal on the  Loans only  after payments  to other classes  or after  the
occurrence of  certain specified  events would  be  a "mortgage  pass-through
certificate" for purposes of PTE 83-1.

     PTE 83-1 sets forth three general conditions which must be satisfied for
any transaction to be eligible for exemption: (i) the maintenance of a system
of insurance  or other protection for the  pooled mortgage loans and property
securing  such loans, and for indemnifying Securityholders against reductions
in pass-through payments  due to property damage or defaults in loan payments
in an  amount not  less than  the  greater of  one percent  of the  aggregate
principal  balance of  all covered  pooled  mortgage loans  or the  principal
balance of the largest covered pooled mortgage loan; (ii) the existence  of a
pool  trustee who  is  not an  affiliate of  the  pool sponsor;  and (iii)  a
limitation  on the  amount  of  the payment  retained  by the  pool  sponsor,
together with  other funds inuring to its benefit,  to not more than adequate
consideration for selling the mortgage loans plus reasonable compensation for
services provided by the pool sponsor  to the pool.  Provident believes  that
the first general condition referred to above will be satisfied  with respect
to the Securities in a Series issued  without a subordination feature, or the
Securities only  in a  Series issued with  a subordination  feature, provided
that  the subordination  and Reserve  Account, subordination  by shifting  of
interests, the pool  insurance or other form of  credit enhancement described
under  "Credit Enhancement"  herein (such  subordination,  pool insurance  or
other  form of  credit enhancement  being  the system  of insurance  or other
protection  referred to  above) with  respect to  a  Series of  Securities is
maintained  in an  amount not  less than  the greater of  one percent  of the
aggregate principal  balance of  the Loans  or the  principal balance  of the
largest Loan.  See "Description of the Securities" herein.  In the absence of
a  ruling that the system of insurance  or other protection with respect to a
Series of Securities satisfies the first general condition referred to above,
there can  be no assurance that these features will  be so viewed by the DOL.
The Trustee will not be affiliated with Provident.

     Each  Plan  fiduciary who  is  responsible  for  making  the  investment
decisions whether to purchase or commit to purchase and to hold Single Family
Securities must make its own determination as to whether the first  and third
general conditions,  and the  specific  conditions described  briefly in  the
preceding  paragraphs,  of  PTE  83-1  have been  satisfied,  or  as  to  the
availability  of any  other  prohibited transaction  exemptions.   Each  Plan
fiduciary   should  also  determine  whether,  under  the  general  fiduciary
standards of  investment prudence and  diversification, an investment  in the
Securities  is appropriate  for the  Plan,  taking into  account the  overall
investment policy  of the Plan and  the composition of the  Plan's investment
portfolio.

     The  DOL has granted  to certain underwriters  individual administrative
exemptions  (the "Underwriter  Exemptions") from  certain  of the  prohibited
transaction  rules of ERISA and the related  excise tax provisions of Section
4975 of the Code  with respect to the initial  purchase, the holding and  the
subsequent resale  by  Plans  of  certificates in  pass-through  trusts  that
consist of  certain receivables,  loans and other  obligations that  meet the
conditions and requirements of the Underwriter Exemptions.

     While each Underwriter  Exemption is an individual  exemption separately
granted to a  specific underwriter, the terms and  conditions which generally
apply to the Underwriter Exemptions are substantially the following:

          (1)  the  acquisition of  the certificates  by a  Plan is  on terms
     (including  the  price  for  the  certificates) that  are  at  least  as
     favorable to  the Plan as they  would be in an  arm's-length transaction
     with an unrelated party;

          (2)  the  rights  and  interests  evidenced  by   the  certificates
     acquired by the  Plan are not subordinated  to the rights  and interests
     evidenced by other certificates of the trust fund;

          (3)  the certificates  required by the Plan have  received a rating
     at the time of such acquisition that is one of the three highest generic
     rating categories  from Standard &  Poor's Ratings Group, a  Division of
     The  McGraw-Hill  Companies  ("S&P"),  Moody's  Investors Service,  Inc.
     ("Moody's"), Duff & Phelps Credit  Rating Co. ("DCR") or Fitch Investors
     Service, Inc. ("Fitch");

          (4)  the  trustee must not be  an affiliate of  any other member of
     the Restricted Group as defined below;

          (5)  the  sum  of  all  payments   made  to  and  retained  by  the
     underwriters in  connection with  the distribution  of the  certificates
     represents  not more than  reasonable compensation for  underwriting the
     certificates; the sum of all payments made to and retained by the seller
     pursuant to the assignment of the loans to the trust fund represents not
     more  than the fair market value of  such loans; the sum of all payments
     made to and retained by  the servicer and any other servicer  represents
     not more than reasonable compensation  for such person's services  under
     the agreement pursuant to which  the loans are pooled and reimbursements
     of such person's reasonable expenses in connection therewith; and

          (6)  the  Plan  investing  in the  certificates  is  an "accredited
     investor" as defined in Rule 501(a)(1) of Regulation D of the Securities
     and Exchange Commission under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.

     The trust fund must also meet the following requirements:

     (i)  the corpus  of the trust fund must consist solely  of assets of the
type that have been included in other investment pools;

     (ii)  certificates in such other  investment pools must have been  rated
in one of the  three highest rating categories of S&P,  Moody's, Fitch or DCR
for at least one year prior to the Plan's acquisition of certificates; and

     (iii)  certificates evidencing interests  in such other investment pools
must have been purchased by investors other than Plans for at least one  year
prior to any Plan's acquisition of certificates.

     Moreover,  the  Underwriter  Exemptions  generally  provide relief  from
certain self-dealing/conflict  of interest  prohibited transactions  that may
occur  when the  Plan fiduciary causes  a Plan  to acquire certificates  in a
trust  as to  which the  fiduciary (or  its affiliate)  is an obligor  on the
receivables held in  the trust, provided that, among  other requirements: (i)
in  the case  of an acquisition  in connection  with the initial  issuance of
certificates,  at least fifty percent (50%)  of each class of certificates in
which  Plans  have  invested  is  acquired  by  persons  independent  of  the
Restricted Group (as  defined below), (ii) such fiduciary  (or its affiliate)
is  an obligor with respect to  five percent (5%) or  less of the fair market
value of the obligations contained in  the trust; (iii) the Plan's investment
in certificates of any class does not exceed twenty-five percent (25%) of all
of the certificates of that class outstanding at the time of the acquisition;
and (iv) immediately after the  acquisition, no more than twenty-five percent
(25%) of  the assets  of the  Plan with  respect to  which such  person is  a
fiduciary is invested in certificates representing an interest in one or more
trusts  containing  assets  sold  or  serviced  by  the  same  entity.    The
Underwriter  Exemptions do  not apply  to Plans  sponsored by  Provident, the
related  Underwriter, the  Trustee,  the Master  Servicer,  any insurer  with
respect to the Loans, any obligor with respect to Loans included in the Trust
Fund constituting  more than five  percent (5%) of the  aggregate unamortized
principal balance of the assets in  the Trust Fund, or any affiliate of  such
parties (the "Restricted Group").

     The  Prospectus Supplement for  each Series of  Securities will indicate
the classes of Securities, if any, offered thereby as to which it is expected
that an Underwriter Exemption will apply.

     The Underwriter Exemption  contains several requirements, some  of which
differ  from  those  in PTE  83-l.   The  Underwriter  Exemption  contains an
expanded  definition  of  "certificate"  which  includes  an  interest  which
entitles the holder  to pass-through payments  of principal, interest  and/or
other payments.  The Underwriter Exemption contains an expanded definition of
"trust"  which  permits the  trust  corpus  to  consist of  secured  consumer
receivables.   The  definition  of  "trust", however,  does  not include  any
investment  pool unless, inter alia, (i) the investment pool consists only of
assets of  the type which have been included  in other investment pools, (ii)
certificates evidencing interests  in such other  investment pools have  been
purchased  by investors other than  Plans for at least  one year prior to the
Plan's acquisition of certificates pursuant to the Underwriter Exemption, and
(iii) certificates in such  other investment pools have been rated  in one of
the  three  highest generic  rating  categories  of  the four  credit  rating
agencies noted  below.  Generally,  the Underwriter Exemption holds  that the
acquisition of the  certificates by a  Plan must be  on terms (including  the
price  for the certificates)  that are at  least as favorable to  the Plan as
they  would be in an  arm's length transaction with an  unrelated party.  The
Underwriter Exemption requires that the rights and interests evidenced by the
certificates not be  "subordinated" to the rights and  interests evidenced by
other certificates  of the  same trust.   The Underwriter  Exemption requires
that certificates acquired by  a Plan have received  a rating at the  time of
their acquisition  that  is  in  one of  the  three  highest  generic  rating
categories  of  S&P,  Moody's,  Fitch  or DCR.    The  Underwriter  Exemption
specifies that the pool trustee must not be an affiliate of the pool sponsor,
nor an  affiliate of  the Underwriter,  the pool  servicer, any obligor  with
respect to mortgage  loans included in the trust constituting  more than five
percent (5%) of the aggregate unamortized principal balance  of the assets in
the trust,  or any  affiliate  of such  entities.   Finally, the  Underwriter
Exemption stipulates that any  Plan investing in the certificates  must be an
"accredited investor"  as defined  in Rule 501(a)(1)  of Regulation D  of the
Securities  and Exchange  Commission under  the  Securities Act  of 1933,  as
amended.

     Any Plan fiduciary which proposes to cause a Plan to purchase Securities
should consult  with their  counsel concerning  the impact of  ERISA and  the
Code, the applicability of  PTE 83-1 and the  Underwriter Exemption, and  the
potential consequences  in their specific circumstances, prior to making such
investment.  Moreover, each Plan fiduciary should determine whether under the
general fiduciary  standards of  investment prudence  and diversification  an
investment in the Securities is appropriate for the Plan, taking into account
the overall  investment policy of the Plan and  the composition of the Plan's
investment portfolio.


                               LEGAL INVESTMENT

     The Prospectus  Supplement for  each Series  of Securities  will specify
which,  if any,  of  the  classes of  Securities  offered thereby  constitute
"mortgage  related securities" for purposes of  the Secondary Mortgage Market
Enhancement Act of  1984 ("SMMEA").   Classes of Securities  that qualify  as
"mortgage related securities"  will be legal investments for persons, trusts,
corporations,  partnerships,  associations,  business  trusts,  and  business
entities  (including depository  institutions, life  insurance companies  and
pension funds) created pursuant  to or existing under the laws  of the United
States or of any state (including  the District of Columbia and Puerto  Rico)
whose authorized  investments are  subject to state  regulations to  the same
extent as,  under applicable law, obligations  issued by or  guaranteed as to
principal  and interest  by the United  States or  any such entities.   Under
SMMEA, if a  state enacted legislation prior to October  4, 1991 specifically
limiting the legal investment authority of any such  entities with respect to
"mortgage related  securities", Securities will  constitute legal investments
for entities subject to such legislation only to the extent provided therein.
Approximately twenty-one states adopted such legislation prior to the October
4, 1991 deadline.

     SMMEA also amended the legal investment authority of federally-chartered
depository institutions as follows: federal savings and loan associations and
federal  savings banks  may invest in,  sell or otherwise  deal in Securities
without limitations as to the percentage of their assets represented thereby,
federal credit  unions  may  invest  "in mortgage  related  securities",  and
national banks may  purchase securities for their own  account without regard
to the limitations generally applicable to investment securities set forth in
12 U.S.C. 24  (Seventh), subject   in each  case to such  regulations as  the
applicable federal  authority  may prescribe.   In  this connection,  federal
credit unions should review the National Credit Union Administration ("NCUA")
Letter  to Credit Unions No.  96, as modified by  Letter to Credit Unions No.
108,  which includes  guidelines to  assist federal  credit unions  in making
investment  decisions  for  "mortgage  related  securities"  and  the  NCUA's
regulation "Investment  and Deposit Activities"  (12 C.F.R. Part  703), which
sets forth  certain restrictions on  investments by federal credit  unions in
"mortgage  related securities"  (in each  case whether  or not  the class  of
Securities under consideration  for purchase constituted a  "mortgage related
security").

     All  depository institutions considering an investment in the Securities
(whether  or not  the class  of Securities  under consideration  for purchase
constitutes   a  "mortgage  related  security")  should  review  the  Federal
Financial Institutions Examination Council's Supervisory  Policy Statement on
the  Securities  Activities  (to  the  extent  adopted  by  their  respective
regulators) (the "Policy Statement") setting forth, in relevant part, certain
securities trading and sales practices deemed unsuitable for an institution's
investment portfolio, and guidelines for  (and restrictions on) investing  in
mortgage derivative products, including  "mortgage related securities", which
are  "high-risk mortgage  securities"  as defined  in  the Policy  Statement.
According  to  the  Policy Statement,  such  "high-risk  mortgage securities"
include securities such as Securities not entitled to distributions allocated
to  principal or  interest, or  Subordinated  Securities.   Under the  Policy
Statement, it  is  the  responsibility  of  each  depository  institution  to
determine, prior to purchase (and  at stated intervals thereafter), whether a
particular  mortgage derivative product  is a "high-risk  mortgage security",
and whether the purchase (or retention) of such a product would be consistent
with the Policy Statement.

     The  foregoing does  not take  into consideration  the applicability  of
statutes,  rules, regulations,  orders,  guidelines  or agreements  generally
governing  investments made  by  a particular  investor,  including, but  not
limited to  "prudent  investor" provisions  which  may restrict  or  prohibit
investment in securities which are not "interest bearing" or "income paying".

     There may  be other  restrictions on the  ability of  certain investors,
including  depository institutions,  either  to  purchase  Securities  or  to
purchase Securities  representing more  than a  specified  percentage of  the
investor's  assets.   Investors should  consult their  own legal  advisors in
determining  whether  and  to what  extent  the  Securities constitute  legal
investments for such investors.


                            METHOD OF DISTRIBUTION

     Securities are being  offered hereby in Series  from time to time  (each
Series evidencing or  relating to a separate  Trust Fund) through any  of the
following methods:

          1.    By   negotiated  firm  commitment  underwriting   and  public
     reoffering by underwriters;

          2.   By  agency placements  through one or  more   placement agents
     primarily with institutional investors and dealers; and

          3.    By   placement  directly  by  Provident   with  institutional
     investors.

     A  Prospectus Supplement  will be  prepared for  each Series  which will
describe the method of offering being used for that Series and will set forth
the identity of any underwriters thereof  and either the price at which  such
Series is being offered, the nature and amount  of any underwriting discounts
or  additional compensation  to such  underwriters  and the  proceeds of  the
offering  to  Provident,  or the  method  by  which the  price  at  which the
underwriters will  sell the Securities  will be determined.   Each Prospectus
Supplement  for  an  underwritten  offering  will  also  contain  information
regarding  the  nature   of  the  underwriters'  obligations,   any  material
relationship  between Provident and  any underwriter and,  where appropriate,
information regarding any discounts or concessions to be allowed or reallowed
to dealers  or others and  any arrangements to  stabilize the market  for the
Securities  so  offered.   In  firm  commitment  underwritten offerings,  the
underwriters will  be obligated  to purchase  all of  the Securities  of such
Series if any such Securities are  purchased.  Securities may be acquired  by
the underwriters for their  own accounts and may be resold from  time to time
in one  or more transactions,  including negotiated transactions, at  a fixed
public offering price or at varying prices determined at the time of sale.

     Underwriters and agents  may be entitled  under agreements entered  into
with   Provident  to  indemnification  by  Provident  against  certain  civil
liabilities, including  liabilities  under the  Securities  Act of  1933,  as
amended, or to contribution with  respect to payments which such underwriters
or agents may be required to make in respect thereof.

     If a Series  is offered other than through  underwriters, the Prospectus
Supplement relating  thereto will contain information regarding the nature of
such offering  and any agreements  to be entered  into between Provident  and
purchasers of Securities of such Series.


                                LEGAL MATTERS

   
     Certain legal  matters relating to the Securities of each Series will be
passed upon for Provident by Keating, Muething & Klekamp, P.L.L., Cincinnati,
Ohio.    Certain  legal  matters  relating  to  certain  federal  income  tax
consequences with respect to the Securities will be passed upon for Provident
by Brown & Wood LLP, New York, New York.
    


                            FINANCIAL INFORMATION

     A  new  Trust Fund  will  be  formed  with  respect to  each  Series  of
Securities and no Trust  Fund will engage in any business  activities or have
any  assets or  obligations prior to  the issuance  of the related  Series of
Securities.  Accordingly,  no financial statements with respect  to any Trust
Fund  will be  included  in  this Prospectus  or  in  the related  Prospectus
Supplement.


                                    RATING

     It is  a condition  to the  issuance of  the Securities  of each  Series
offered hereby  and by the  Prospectus Supplement that  they shall  have been
rated  in  one of  the  four  highest  rating categories  by  the  nationally
recognized statistical rating  agency or agencies  (each, a "Rating  Agency")
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.

     Any such rating would  be based on, among other things,  the adequacy of
the value of the Trust Fund Assets and any credit enhancement with respect to
such class  and will reflect  such Rating Agency's  assessment solely of  the
likelihood that  Holders of  a class of  Securities will receive  payments to
which such  Securityholders are entitled  under the related Agreement.   Such
rating will  not constitute  an assessment of  the likelihood  that principal
prepayments on the related  Loans will be made, the degree  to which the rate
of  such prepayments  might differ  from that  originally anticipated  or the
likelihood of early optional termination  of the Series of Securities.   Such
rating  should  not be  deemed a  recommendation  to purchase,  hold  or sell
Securities, inasmuch as it does not address market price or suitability for a
particular  investor.  Each security rating should be evaluated independently
of any other security  rating.  Such rating will not  address the possibility
that prepayment at  higher or lower rates than anticipated by an investor may
cause such  investor to experience a lower than  anticipated yield or that an
investor purchasing a Security at a  significant premium might fail to recoup
its initial investment under certain prepayment scenarios.

     There is also  no assurance that any  such rating will remain  in effect
for any  given period  of time  or that it  may not  be lowered  or withdrawn
entirely by the Rating Agency in the future if in its  judgment circumstances
in the future so warrant.   In addition to being lowered or  withdrawn due to
any  erosion in the  adequacy of the  value of the  Trust Fund  Assets or any
credit  enhancement  with respect  to  a Series,  such  rating might  also be
lowered or  withdrawn for other  reasons, including, but  not limited to,  an
adverse change in  the financial or other  condition of a  credit enhancement
provider or  a change  in the  rating of  such credit  enhancement provider's
long-term debt.

     The amount, type  and nature of credit enhancement,  if any, established
with respect  to a Series  of Securities will  be determined on the  basis of
criteria established  by each  Rating Agency rating  classes of  such Series.
Such criteria are sometimes based upon  an actuarial analysis of the behavior
of mortgage loans in  a larger group.  Such analysis is  often the basis upon
which each Rating Agency determines the amount of credit enhancement required
with respect  to  each such  class.   There  can  be  no assurance  that  the
historical  data supporting  any  such  actuarial  analysis  will  accurately
reflect future  experience nor  any assurance  that the  data derived  from a
large pool of mortgage loans accurately predicts the delinquency, foreclosure
or loss experience  of any particular  pool of  Loans.  No  assurance can  be
given that  values of any  Properties have remained  or will remain  at their
levels on the  respective dates of origination of the related  Loans.  If the
residential  real  estate markets  should  experience an  overall  decline in
property values such that the outstanding  principal balances of the Loans in
a particular Trust Fund and any secondary financing on the related Properties
become equal  to or greater  than the value of  the Properties, the  rates of
delinquencies,  foreclosures  and  losses  could  be  higher  than those  now
generally experienced  in  the mortgage  lending  industry.   In  additional,
adverse  economic conditions  (which  may  or may  not  affect real  property
values) may affect the timely payment by  mortgagors of scheduled payments of
principal  and  interest  on  the   Loans  and,  accordingly,  the  rates  of
delinquencies, foreclosures and losses  with respect to  any Trust Fund.   To
the  extent that  such losses  are not  covered  by credit  enhancement, such
losses will be borne, at least in part, by the Holders of one or more classes
of the Securities of the related Series.

                            INDEX OF DEFINED TERMS

Term                                                                      Page
- ----                                                                      ---

   
Accrual Securities  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  26
Advance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
Agreement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  18
Amortizable Bond Premium Regulations  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  63
APR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  21
Available Funds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  26
Balloon payment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  19
Belgian Cooperative . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  33
Beneficial owner  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  32
BIF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  42
Book-Entry Securities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  32
Buydown Fund  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  20
Buydown Loans . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  20
Capitalized Interest Account  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  45
Cash Flow Bond Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  69
CEDEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  32
CEDEL Participants  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  33
CERCLA  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  14
Certificates  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  1, 4
Class Security Balance  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  26
Closed-End Loans  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  1, 4
Code  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
Collateral Value  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  21
Combined Loan-to-Value Ratio  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  21
Commission  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
Companion Classes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  30
Components  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  29
Contingent Regulations  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  61
Cut-Off Date  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4, 18
Cut-Off Date Principal Balance  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  25
DCR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  80
Debt Securities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  59
Debt-to-income ratio  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  23
Definitive Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  32
Detailed Description  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  19
Distribution Date . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
DOL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  78
DTC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  16
EPA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  54
ERISA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  11
Euroclear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  32
Euroclear Operator  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  33
Euroclear Participants  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  33
European Depositaries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  32
Excess Servicing Fees . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  69
Exchange Act  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
FDIC  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  23
FHLMC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  23
Financial Intermediary  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  32
Fitch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  80
FNMA  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  23
Foreign person  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  73
Funding Period  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  16
Garn-St Germain Act . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  56
Home Equity Loans . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  1, 4
Indenture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  24
Insurance Proceeds  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  43
Insured Expenses  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  43
Interest Weighted Securities  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  62
IRS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  61
L/C Bank  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7, 36
Liquidation Expenses  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  43
Liquidation Proceeds  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  43
Loan Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6, 19
Loan-to-Value Ratio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  21
Loans . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Lockout Periods . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  19
Master Servicer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Master Servicing Agreement  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  18
Master Servicing Fee  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  47
Moody's . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  80
Morgan  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  33
Mortgage  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  41
Mortgage Loan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Mortgage Loans  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Mortgaged Properties  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  20
NCUA  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  82
Nonresidents  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  71
Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  1, 4
OID . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9, 59
OID Regulations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  59
PACs  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  30
Parties in Interest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  78
Pass-Through Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
Pass-Through Securities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  68
Pay-Through Security  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  61
Permitted Investments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  37
Plans . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  78
Policy Statement  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  82
Pool  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4, 17
Pool Insurance Policy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  38
Pool Insurer  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  38
Pooling and Servicing Agreement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  24
Pre-Funded Amount . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  16
Pre-Funding Account . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4, 16
Prepayment Assumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  61
Primary Mortgage Insurance Policy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  20
Principal Prepayments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  27
Properties  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  20
Proposed Mark-to-Market Regulations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  67
Provident . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  1, 4
PTE 83-1  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  78
Purchase Price  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  24
Rating Agency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  83
Ratio Strip Securities  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  69
RCRA  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  55
Record Date . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  25
Refinance Loan  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  21
Regular Interest Securities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  59
Relevant Depositary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  32
Relief Act  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  57
REMIC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Reserve Account . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7
Residual Interest Security  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  65
Restricted Group  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  80
Retained Interest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  25
Revolving Credit Line Loans . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  1, 4
Riegle Act  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  15
Rules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  32
S&P . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  80
SAIF  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  42
Secured Creditor Exclusion  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  54
Securities  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  1, 4
Security Account  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  42
Security Owners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  32
Security Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  25
Senior Securities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5, 35
Series  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Servicing Fees  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  68
Short-Term Note . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  72
Single Family Properties  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  20
Single Family Securities  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  78
SMMEA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9, 81
STIFS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  37
Stripped Securities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  68
Sub-Servicer  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
Sub-Servicing Agreement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  45
Subordinated Securities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
Subsequent Loans  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  16
TACs  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  31
Terms and Conditions  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  34
Thrift institutions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  66
TIN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  71
Title V . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  57
Trust Agreement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  18, 24
Trust Fund  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Trust Fund Assets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  1, 4, 17
Trustee . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4, 24
U.S. Person . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  77
Underwriter Exemptions  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  79
    



                                   PART II

                    INFORMATION NOT REQUIRED IN PROSPECTUS

ITEM 14.  OTHER EXPENSES OF ISSUANCE AND DISTRIBUTION*

     The following table sets forth the estimated expenses in connection with
the issuance and  distribution of the Securities being  registered under this
Registration Statement, other than underwriting discounts and commissions:

   
SEC Registration Fee                    $    151,515.15
Printing and Engraving Expenses         $    125,000.00
Legal Fees and Expenses                 $    500,000.00
Trustee Fees and Expenses               $     50,000.00
Accounting Fees and Expenses            $    125,000.00
Blue Sky Fees and Expenses              $     15,000.00
Rating Agency Fees                      $    200,000.00
Miscellaneous                           $    100,000.00
                                        ---------------
Total                                   $  1,266,515.15
    

____________

   
*    All amounts  except the SEC  Registration Fee are estimates  of expenses
     incurred in connection with the issuance and distribution of a Series of
     Securities in an  aggregate principal amount assumed for  these purposes
     to be equal to $500,000,000 of Securities registered hereby.
    

ITEM 15.  INDEMNIFICATION OF DIRECTORS AND OFFICERS.

     The Registrant's  Code of  Regulations provides  for indemnification  of
directors  and officers of the Registrant to  the fullest extent permitted by
law.  In particular, the Code of Regulations provides for indemnification for
any  person who was or is a party or is  threatened to be made a party to any
threatened, pending or  completed action, suit or proceeding,  whether civil,
criminal, administrative or investigative,  by reason of the fact  that he is
or was a director, officer, employee or agent of the Registrant, or is or was
serving at  the request of  the Registrant  as a director,  trustee, officer,
employee or agent  of another corporation, domestic or  foreign non-profit or
for profit, partnership,joint  venture, trust or other  enterprise; provided,
however, that the Registrant  shall indemnify any  such agent (as opposed  to
any director,  officer or  employee) of  the Company  to an  extent that  the
directors may, in their discretion, so determine.


ITEM 16.  EXHIBITS.

   
    1.1   Form of Underwriting Agreement.**
    4.1   Form  of Pooling and  Servicing Agreement  relating to  Home Equity
          Loan Asset Backed Certificates.**
    4.2   Form of  Pooling and Servicing Agreement relating to Mortgage Pass-
          Through Certificates.**
    4.3   Form of Trust Agreement.**
    4.4   Form of Indenture.**
    4.5   Form of Master Servicing Agreement.**
    5.1   Opinion of Keating,  Muething & Klekamp, P.L.L. as  to the legality
          of the Securities.**
    8.1   Opinion of Brown & Wood LLP as to certain tax matters.**
   23.1   Consent of Brown & Wood LLP (included in Exhibit 8.1 hereof).**
   23.2   Consent of Keating, Muething & Klekamp, P.L.L. (included in Exhibit
          5.1).**
   24.1   Power of Attorney.
    

__________________________
**To be filed by amendment.

ITEM 17.  UNDERTAKINGS.

     (a) The undersigned Registrant hereby undertakes:

          (1)  To file, during any period in  which offers or sales are being
     made, a post-effective amendment to this Registration Statement;

                (i) To include any prospectus required by Section 10(a)(3) of
          the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the "Act");

               (ii) To reflect in the prospectus any facts  or events arising
          after  the effective  date of this  Registration Statement  (or the
          most recent post-effective amendment hereof) which, individually or
          in the aggregate, represent a fundamental change in the information
          set  forth in  this Registration  Statement.   Notwithstanding  the
          foregoing, any increase or decrease in volume of securities offered
          (if the total  dollar value of securities offered  would not exceed
          that  which was registered) and any  deviation from the low or high
          and of the estimated maximum offering range may be reflected in the
          form of  prospectus  filed with  the  Commission pursuant  to  Rule
          424(b)  if, in  the  aggregate,  the changes  in  volume and  price
          represent no more  than 20 percent change in  the maximum aggregate
          offering price set  forth in the "Calculation  of Registration Fee"
          table in the effective Registration Statement;

              (iii) To include  any material information with respect  to the
          plan  of distribution not previously disclosed in this Registration
          Statement  or  any material  change  to  such information  in  this
          Registration Statement;

provided, however, that  paragraphs (a)(1)(i) and (a)(1)(ii) do  not apply if
the  information required  to be  included in  a post-effective  amendment by
those paragraphs is contained in periodic  reports filed with or furnished to
the Commission  by the  Registrant pursuant  to Section  13 or  15(d) of  the
Securities Exchange Act  of 1934 that  are incorporated by reference  in this
Registration Statement.

          (2)  That, for the purpose of  determining any liability under  the
     Act, each such  post-effective amendment  shall be  deemed to  be a  new
     registration statement relating  to the securities offered  therein, and
     the offering of such  securities at that time shall be deemed  to be the
     initial bona fide offering thereof.

          (3)  To  remove  from  registration by  means  of  a post-effective
     amendment any of the securities  being registered which remain unsold at
     the termination of the offering.

     (b) The undersigned  Registrant hereby undertakes that, for  purposes of
determining any liability under the Act, each filing of a Trust Fund's annual
report pursuant to Section 13(a) or  Section 15(d) of the Securities Exchange
Act of 1934 that is incorporated by  reference in this Registration Statement
shall be deemed to be a new registration statement relating to the securities
offered therein, and  the offering of such  securities at that time  shall be
deemed to be the initial bona fide offering thereof.

     (c) Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Act may
be permitted to directors, officers and controlling persons of the Registrant
pursuant to the  foregoing provisions, or otherwise, the  Registrant has been
advised  that in the opinion  of the Securities  and Exchange Commission such
indemnification  is against  public policy  as expressed  in the Act  and is,
therefore,  unenforceable.   In the  event that  a claim  for indemnification
against  such  liabilities (other  than  the  payment  by the  Registrant  of
expenses incurred or paid by a director, officer or controlling person of the
Registrant in the successful  defense of any  action, suit or proceeding)  is
asserted by such  director, officer or controlling person  in connection with
the securities being  registered, the Registrant will, unless  in the opinion
of its counsel  the matter has been settled by  controlling precedent, submit
to  a   court  of   appropriate  jurisdiction   the  question   whether  such
indemnification by it  is against public policy  as expressed in the  Act and
will be governed by the final adjudication of such issue.

     (d) The undersigned Registrant hereby  undertakes to file an application
for the purpose  of determining the eligibility  of the trustee to  act under
subsection (a)  of  Section  310  of  the Trust  Indenture  Act  of  1939  in
accordance with the rules and  regulations prescribed by the Commission under
Section 305(b)(2) of the Trust Indenture Act of 1939.

                                  SIGNATURES

   
     Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933,  as amended,
the Registrant  certifies that (i)  it reasonably believes that  the security
rating requirement of Transaction Requirement B.5 of  Form S-3 will be met by
the  time of  sale of each  Series of  Securities to which  this Registration
Statement relates and (ii) it has reasonable grounds to believe that it meets
all of  the requirements  for filing  on Form  S-3 and has  duly caused  this
Amendment to  the Registration Statement  to be signed  on its behalf  by the
undersigned, thereunto duly  authorized, in Cincinnati, Ohio on  the 19th day
of February, 1997.
    


                              THE PROVIDENT BANK

   
                              By  /s/ Mark E. Magee      
                                  -------------------------
                              Name: Mark E. Magee
                                    Senior Vice President


     Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, as  amended,
this Amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following
persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated.

     SIGNATURES                        TITLE                        DATE
     ----------                        -----                        ----

        *                          President                 February 19, 1997
- ----------------------
Allen L. Davis                  (Principal Executive Officer) 
                                   and Director


        *                       Senior Vice President and    February 19, 1997
- -----------------------            Chief
John R. Farrenkopf

                               Financial Officer (Principal
                                Accounting Officer)
        *                          Director                          
- -----------------------                                      February 19, 1997
Jack M. Cook

        *                          Director     
- -----------------------                                      February 19, 1997
Thomas D. Grote, Jr.

        *                          Director                          
- -----------------------                                      February 19, 1997
Joseph A. Steger

        *                          Director                          
- -----------------------                                      February 19, 1997
Philip R. Myers

        *                          Director                          
- -----------------------                                      February 19, 1997
Joseph A. Pedoto

        *                          Director                          
- -----------------------                                      February 19, 1997
Sidney A. Peerless

*By: /s/ Mark E. Magee
     ----------------------
     Attorney-in-Fact
    
                                                                             
         

                                EXHIBIT INDEX


                                                                 SEQUENTIAL
EXHIBIT                                                            PAGE    
  NO.                         DESCRIPTION OF EXHIBIT               NUMBER  
- -------                       ----------------------             ----------

   
  1.1               --   Form of Underwriting Agreement.**
  4.1               --   Form of Pooling and
                         Servicing Agreement
                         relating to Home Equity
                         Loan Asset Backed
                         Certificates.**
  4.2               --   Form of Pooling and
                         Servicing Agreement
                         relating to Mortgage Pass-
                         Through Certificates.**
  4.3               --   Form of Trust Agreement.**
  4.4               --   Form of Indenture.**
  4.5               --   Form of Master Servicing Agreement.**
  5.1               --   Opinion of Keating,
                         Muething & Klekamp, P.L.L.
                         as to the legality of the
                         Securities.**


  8.1               --   Opinion of Brown & Wood LLP
                         as to certain tax
                         matters.**
 23.1               --   Consent of Brown & Wood LLP
                         (included in Exhibit
                         8.1).**
 23.2               --   Consent of Keating,
                         Muething & Klekamp, P.L.L.
                         (included in Exhibit
                         5.1).**

 24.1               --   Power of Attorney (included on page
                         II-3).
    
                    
- --------------------
**To be filed by amendment.




© 2022 IncJournal is not affiliated with or endorsed by the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission